Вы находитесь на странице: 1из 1002

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System

V100R006C10

Maintenance Guide

Issue 01
Date 2013-12-15

HUAWEI TECHNOLOGIES CO., LTD.


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 2013. All rights reserved.
No part of this document may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by any means without prior written
consent of Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Trademarks and Permissions

and other Huawei trademarks are trademarks of Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
All other trademarks and trade names mentioned in this document are the property of their respective holders.

Notice
The purchased products, services and features are stipulated by the contract made between Huawei and the
customer. All or part of the products, services and features described in this document may not be within the
purchase scope or the usage scope. Unless otherwise specified in the contract, all statements, information,
and recommendations in this document are provided "AS IS" without warranties, guarantees or representations
of any kind, either express or implied.

The information in this document is subject to change without notice. Every effort has been made in the
preparation of this document to ensure accuracy of the contents, but all statements, information, and
recommendations in this document do not constitute a warranty of any kind, express or implied.

Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.


Address: Huawei Industrial Base
Bantian, Longgang
Shenzhen 518129
People's Republic of China

Website: http://www.huawei.com
Email: support@huawei.com

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential i


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide About This Document

About This Document

Related Versions
The following table lists the product versions related to this document.

Product Name Version

OptiX RTN 980 V100R006C10

iManager U2000 V200R001C00

Intended Audience
This document provides the guidelines to maintaining the OptiX RTN 980. It also describes the
alarms and performance events that are required for troubleshooting during the maintenance.

This document is intended for:

l Network planning engineer


l Data configuration engineer
l System maintenance engineer

Symbol Conventions
The symbols that may be found in this document are defined as follows.

Symbol Description

Indicates a hazard with a high level of risk,


which if not avoided, will result in death or
serious injury.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential ii


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide About This Document

Symbol Description

Indicates a hazard with a medium or low level


of risk, which if not avoided, could result in
minor or moderate injury.

Indicates a potentially hazardous situation,


which if not avoided, could result in
equipment damage, data loss, performance
degradation, or unexpected results.

Indicates a tip that may help you solve a


problem or save time.

Provides additional information to emphasize


or supplement important points of the main
text.

General Conventions
The general conventions that may be found in this document are defined as follows.

Convention Description

Times New Roman Normal paragraphs are in Times New Roman.

Boldface Names of files, directories, folders, and users are in


boldface. For example, log in as user root.

Italic Book titles are in italics.

Courier New Examples of information displayed on the screen are in


Courier New.

Command Conventions
The command conventions that may be found in this document are defined as follows.

Convention Description

Boldface The keywords of a command line are in boldface.

Italic Command arguments are in italics.

[] Items (keywords or arguments) in brackets [ ] are optional.

{ x | y | ... } Optional items are grouped in braces and separated by


vertical bars. One item is selected.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential iii


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide About This Document

Convention Description

[ x | y | ... ] Optional items are grouped in brackets and separated by


vertical bars. One item is selected or no item is selected.

{ x | y | ... }* Optional items are grouped in braces and separated by


vertical bars. A minimum of one item or a maximum of all
items can be selected.

[ x | y | ... ]* Optional items are grouped in brackets and separated by


vertical bars. Several items or no item can be selected.

GUI Conventions
The GUI conventions that may be found in this document are defined as follows.

Convention Description

Boldface Buttons, menus, parameters, tabs, window, and dialog titles


are in boldface. For example, click OK.

> Multi-level menus are in boldface and separated by the ">"


signs. For example, choose File > Create > Folder.

Change History
Updates between document issues are cumulative. Therefore, the latest document issue contains
all updates made in previous issues.

Updates in Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Based on Product Version V100R006C10


This document is the first issue of the V100R006C10 product version.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential iv


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide Contents

Contents

About This Document.....................................................................................................................ii


1 Safety Precautions.........................................................................................................................1
1.1 General Safety Precautions.............................................................................................................................................2
1.2 Warning and Safety Symbols.........................................................................................................................................3
1.3 Electrical Safety..............................................................................................................................................................4
1.4 Environment of Flammable Gas.....................................................................................................................................7
1.5 Storage Batteries.............................................................................................................................................................7
1.6 Radiation.........................................................................................................................................................................9
1.6.1 Safe Usage of Optical Fibers.......................................................................................................................................9
1.6.2 Electromagnetic Exposure.........................................................................................................................................11
1.6.3 Forbidden Areas........................................................................................................................................................11
1.6.4 Laser..........................................................................................................................................................................11
1.6.5 Microwave.................................................................................................................................................................12
1.7 Working at Heights.......................................................................................................................................................13
1.7.1 Hoisting Heavy Objects.............................................................................................................................................13
1.7.2 Using Ladders............................................................................................................................................................14
1.8 Mechanical Safety........................................................................................................................................................16
1.9 Other Precautions.........................................................................................................................................................17

2 Notices for High-Risk Operations...........................................................................................19


2.1 Operation Guide for the Toggle Lever Switch.............................................................................................................20
2.2 Operation Guide for the IF Jumper...............................................................................................................................22
2.3 Operation Guide for the IF Cables...............................................................................................................................23
2.4 Operation Guide for the IF Board.................................................................................................................................24

3 Routine Maintenance..................................................................................................................26
4 Network Monitoring...................................................................................................................29
4.1 Checking the NE Status................................................................................................................................................30
4.2 Checking the Board Status...........................................................................................................................................31
4.3 Alarm and Performance Data Query............................................................................................................................32
4.3.1 Browsing Current Alarms..........................................................................................................................................32
4.3.2 Browsing Historical Alarms......................................................................................................................................37
4.3.3 Browsing Current Performance Events.....................................................................................................................40

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential v


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide Contents

4.3.4 Browsing Historical Performance Events..................................................................................................................42


4.3.5 Browsing the Performance Event Threshold-Crossing Records...............................................................................43
4.3.6 Browsing UAT Events...............................................................................................................................................45
4.4 Microwave Link Performance Query...........................................................................................................................46
4.4.1 Querying the Historical Transmit Power and Receive Power...................................................................................46
4.4.2 Querying the SNR Values of a Radio Link...............................................................................................................47
4.4.3 Browsing Current Performance Events of the radio link...........................................................................................48
4.4.4 Browsing Historical Performance Data of a Radio Link...........................................................................................50
4.5 Ethernet Performance Query........................................................................................................................................51
4.5.1 Browsing Current Ethernet Performance..................................................................................................................51
4.5.2 Configuring Ethernet Performance Threshold-Crossing Parameters........................................................................55
4.5.3 Setting Parameters for Monitoring Historical Ethernet Performance........................................................................58
4.5.4 Browsing Historical Ethernet Performance Data......................................................................................................59
4.6 Ethernet Port Traffic Monitoring..................................................................................................................................62
4.6.1 Setting Traffic, Physical Bandwidth, or Bandwidth Utilization of Ethernet Ports....................................................62
4.6.2 Querying Traffic, Physical Bandwidth, or Bandwidth Utilization............................................................................63
4.7 Long-term Network Performance Monitoring.............................................................................................................65
4.7.1 Creating a Performance Monitoring Template..........................................................................................................65
4.7.2 Creating a Performance Monitoring Instance............................................................................................................67
4.7.3 Browsing the Real-Time Data of a Performance Monitoring Instance.....................................................................71
4.7.4 Browsing the Historical Data of a Performance Monitoring Instance......................................................................72
4.8 Report Query................................................................................................................................................................73
4.8.1 Querying the Microwave Link Information Report...................................................................................................73
4.8.2 Querying the Network-wide License Report.............................................................................................................74
4.8.3 Querying the Microwave Configuration Report........................................................................................................76
4.8.4 Querying the Board Information Report...................................................................................................................77
4.8.5 Querying the Board Manufacturing Information Report...........................................................................................80
4.8.6 Querying the ODU Information Report.....................................................................................................................81
4.9 Alarm and Performance Management Setting..............................................................................................................82
4.9.1 Configuring the Performance Monitoring Status of NEs..........................................................................................82
4.9.2 Setting Severity and Auto Reporting Status of Alarms.............................................................................................83
4.9.3 Suppressing Alarms for Monitored Objects..............................................................................................................84
4.9.4 Suppressing Alarms for NEs.....................................................................................................................................85
4.9.5 Reversing Alarms for Service Ports..........................................................................................................................86
4.9.6 Setting Trigger Conditions of AIS Insertion.............................................................................................................87
4.9.7 Setting Trigger Conditions of UNEQ Insertion.........................................................................................................87
4.9.8 Setting Bit Error Thresholds for Service Ports..........................................................................................................88
4.9.9 Setting Monitoring and Auto-Report Status of Performance Events........................................................................89
4.9.10 Setting Performance Thresholds..............................................................................................................................90
4.9.11 Resetting Performance Registers.............................................................................................................................90

5 Troubleshooting..........................................................................................................................92

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential vi


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide Contents

5.1 General Troubleshooting Procedure.............................................................................................................................94


5.2 Troubleshooting Service Interruptions.........................................................................................................................96
5.3 Troubleshooting the Radio Link.................................................................................................................................103
5.4 Troubleshooting Bit Errors in TDM Services............................................................................................................110
5.5 Troubleshooting Pointer Justifications.......................................................................................................................115
5.6 Troubleshooting the Interconnection with SDH Equipment......................................................................................119
5.7 Troubleshooting the Interconnection with PDH Equipment......................................................................................123
5.8 Troubleshooting Native Ethernet Service Faults........................................................................................................126
5.9 Troubleshooting Ethernet Service on the EoS/EoPDH Plane....................................................................................134
5.10 Troubleshooting MPLS Tunnels..............................................................................................................................140
5.11 Troubleshooting CES Services.................................................................................................................................144
5.12 Troubleshooting ATM Services...............................................................................................................................149
5.13 Troubleshooting Ethernet Services Carried by PWs................................................................................................153
5.14 Troubleshooting DCN Faults....................................................................................................................................161
5.15 Troubleshooting Orderwire Faults............................................................................................................................165
5.16 Typical Cases............................................................................................................................................................167
5.16.1 Transient Link Unavailability Due to Multi-path Fading......................................................................................167
5.16.2 Transoceanic Link Transient Unavailability Due to Insufficient Height Difference between Diversity Antennas
..........................................................................................................................................................................................169
5.16.3 Link Unavailability Due to Inter-building Reflection...........................................................................................170
5.16.4 Unidirectional Link Availability Due to Interference...........................................................................................171
5.16.5 Bit Errors on Microwave Links.............................................................................................................................172
5.16.6 Poor Reliability Due to Network Planning Errors.................................................................................................173

6 Part Replacement.......................................................................................................................175
6.1 Removing a Board......................................................................................................................................................177
6.2 Inserting a Board........................................................................................................................................................180
6.3 Replacing the SDH Optical Interface Board..............................................................................................................182
6.4 Replacing the Channelized STM-1 Processing Board...............................................................................................183
6.5 Replacing the PDH Interface Board...........................................................................................................................184
6.6 Replacing the Smart E1 Interface Board....................................................................................................................185
6.7 Replacing the Ethernet Interface Board......................................................................................................................186
6.8 Replacing the IF Board...............................................................................................................................................187
6.9 Replacing the CF Card...............................................................................................................................................189
6.10 Replacing the System Control, Switching and Timing Board..................................................................................190
6.11 Replacing the Auxiliary Board.................................................................................................................................193
6.12 Replacing the Fan Board..........................................................................................................................................194
6.13 Replacing the Power Board......................................................................................................................................196
6.14 Replacing the SFP....................................................................................................................................................197
6.15 Replacing the ODU..................................................................................................................................................199
6.16 Replacing the IF Cable.............................................................................................................................................201
6.17 Erasing Data in the Repair Parts...............................................................................................................................202

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential vii


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide Contents

6.17.1 Board Storage Media.............................................................................................................................................202


6.17.2 Removing the CF Card..........................................................................................................................................203
6.17.3 Formatting the Flash Memory...............................................................................................................................203

7 Database Backup and Restoration.........................................................................................205


7.1 NE Database...............................................................................................................................................................206
7.2 Backing Up the Database Manually...........................................................................................................................207
7.3 Setting the Database Backup Policy...........................................................................................................................209
7.3.1 Setting the User-Defined Backup Policy.................................................................................................................209
7.3.2 Enable the Backup Policy of the Device.................................................................................................................211
7.3.3 Disable the Backup Policy of the Device................................................................................................................212
7.4 Restoring the Database by NMS................................................................................................................................213

8 Common Maintenance Operations........................................................................................217


8.1 Microwave Link Troubleshooting..............................................................................................................................219
8.1.1 Monitoring Radio Link Indicators...........................................................................................................................219
8.1.2 Scanning Interfering Signals...................................................................................................................................220
8.1.3 Muting/Unmuting an ODU......................................................................................................................................221
8.1.4 Performing a PRBS Test for the IF Board...............................................................................................................222
8.2 Ethernet Service Troubleshooting..............................................................................................................................225
8.2.1 Querying the Attributes of an Ethernet Port............................................................................................................225
8.2.2 Searching for Service Paths Based on VLANs.......................................................................................................226
8.2.3 Searching for Service Paths Based on MAC Addresses..........................................................................................228
8.2.4 Checking the Layer 2 Protocols Used by Ethernet Services...................................................................................229
8.2.5 Performing Intelligent Service Fault Diagnosis for Ethernet Services....................................................................230
8.2.6 Performing E-LAN Service Loopback Detection....................................................................................................232
8.2.7 Monitoring Ethernet Service Performance and Traffic Volume Based on Service Paths.......................................233
8.2.8 Querying Ethernet Service QoS Configurations Based on Service Paths...............................................................235
8.2.9 Monitoring Ethernet Packets Through Port Mirroring............................................................................................237
8.2.10 Using the Ethernet Test Frames.............................................................................................................................239
8.3 TDM/CES Service Troubleshooting..........................................................................................................................241
8.3.1 Setting the On/Off State of the Laser......................................................................................................................241
8.3.2 Setting the ALS Function........................................................................................................................................242
8.3.3 Performing a PRBS Test for the Smart E1 Processing Board.................................................................................242
8.3.4 Performing a PRBS Test for the Tributary Board...................................................................................................245
8.3.5 Querying the Impedance of an E1 Channel.............................................................................................................248
8.4 Software Loopback.....................................................................................................................................................249
8.4.1 Setting Loopback for the SDH Optical Interface Board..........................................................................................249
8.4.2 Setting Loopback for the Channelized STM-1 Processing Board...........................................................................251
8.4.3 Setting Loopback for the Tributary Board..............................................................................................................253
8.4.4 Setting a Loopback for the Smart E1 Processing Board.........................................................................................254
8.4.5 Setting a Loopback for the Packet-plane Ethernet Interface Board........................................................................256
8.4.6 Setting Loopbacks for the EOS/EoPDH-Plane Ethernet Interface Board...............................................................258

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential viii


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide Contents

8.4.7 Setting Loopback for the IF Board..........................................................................................................................261


8.4.8 Setting Software Loopback for the NE....................................................................................................................264
8.4.9 Setting Software Loopback for the Microwave Link..............................................................................................265
8.4.10 Locating a Fault by Performing Loopback Operations.........................................................................................266
8.5 Hardware Loopback...................................................................................................................................................267
8.6 Reset...........................................................................................................................................................................267
8.6.1 Cold Reset................................................................................................................................................................268
8.6.2 Warm Reset.............................................................................................................................................................268
8.7 Setting the Automatic Release Function....................................................................................................................269
8.8 Querying Power Consumption of Boards...................................................................................................................270
8.9 Switching the System Control Unit and the Cross-Connect Unit..............................................................................270
8.10 Cleaning Fiber Connectors and Adapters.................................................................................................................271
8.10.1 Cleaning Fiber Connectors by Using Cartridge Cleaners.....................................................................................271
8.10.2 Cleaning Fiber Connectors by Using Lens Tissue................................................................................................273
8.10.3 Cleaning Fiber Adapters by Using Optical Cleaning Sticks.................................................................................274

A Alarm Reference.......................................................................................................................276
A.1 Alarm List (in Alphabetical Order)...........................................................................................................................277
A.2 Alarm List (Classified by Logical Boards)................................................................................................................293
A.2.1 AUX........................................................................................................................................................................295
A.2.2 CQ1.........................................................................................................................................................................295
A.2.3 CSHN......................................................................................................................................................................296
A.2.4 EFP8.......................................................................................................................................................................298
A.2.5 EG2D......................................................................................................................................................................298
A.2.6 EG4.........................................................................................................................................................................299
A.2.7 EG4P.......................................................................................................................................................................299
A.2.8 EM6T......................................................................................................................................................................300
A.2.9 EM6TA...................................................................................................................................................................300
A.2.10 EM6F....................................................................................................................................................................301
A.2.11 EM6FA.................................................................................................................................................................301
A.2.12 EMS6....................................................................................................................................................................302
A.2.13 FAN......................................................................................................................................................................302
A.2.14 IF1.........................................................................................................................................................................303
A.2.15 IFU2......................................................................................................................................................................303
A.2.16 IFX2......................................................................................................................................................................304
A.2.17 ISU2......................................................................................................................................................................305
A.2.18 ISV3......................................................................................................................................................................306
A.2.19 ISX2......................................................................................................................................................................307
A.2.20 ML1/MD1.............................................................................................................................................................308
A.2.21 ODU......................................................................................................................................................................308
A.2.22 PIU........................................................................................................................................................................308
A.2.23 PMU......................................................................................................................................................................309

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential ix


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide Contents

A.2.24 SL1D/SL1DA.......................................................................................................................................................309
A.2.25 SL4D.....................................................................................................................................................................310
A.2.26 SP3S/SP3D...........................................................................................................................................................310
A.2.27 TCU......................................................................................................................................................................310
A.3 Alarms and Handling Procedures..............................................................................................................................311
A.3.1 A_LOC...................................................................................................................................................................311
A.3.2 ACR_LOCK_FAIL................................................................................................................................................311
A.3.3 ALM_E1RAI..........................................................................................................................................................313
A.3.4 ALM_GFP_dCSF...................................................................................................................................................314
A.3.5 ALM_GFP_dLFD...................................................................................................................................................315
A.3.6 ALM_IMA_LIF......................................................................................................................................................316
A.3.7 ALM_IMA_LODS.................................................................................................................................................317
A.3.8 ALM_IMA_RE_RX_UNUSABLE........................................................................................................................319
A.3.9 ALM_IMA_RE_TX_UNUSABLE........................................................................................................................320
A.3.10 ALM_IMA_RFI...................................................................................................................................................321
A.3.11 AM_DOWNSHIFT..............................................................................................................................................323
A.3.12 APS_FAIL............................................................................................................................................................324
A.3.13 APS_INDI.............................................................................................................................................................325
A.3.14 APS_MANUAL_STOP........................................................................................................................................327
A.3.15 ATMPW_UNKNOWNCELL_EXC....................................................................................................................328
A.3.16 AU_AIS................................................................................................................................................................329
A.3.17 AU_LOP...............................................................................................................................................................330
A.3.18 B1_EXC................................................................................................................................................................331
A.3.19 B1_SD...................................................................................................................................................................333
A.3.20 B2_EXC................................................................................................................................................................335
A.3.21 B2_SD...................................................................................................................................................................338
A.3.22 B3_EXC................................................................................................................................................................340
A.3.23 B3_EXC_VC3......................................................................................................................................................342
A.3.24 B3_SD...................................................................................................................................................................344
A.3.25 B3_SD_VC3.........................................................................................................................................................346
A.3.26 BAT1TEMP_SENSOR_FAIL.............................................................................................................................349
A.3.27 BAT2TEMP_SENSOR_FAIL.............................................................................................................................350
A.3.28 BD_NOT_INSTALLED.......................................................................................................................................351
A.3.29 BD_STATUS........................................................................................................................................................352
A.3.30 BDTEMP_SENSOR_FAIL..................................................................................................................................354
A.3.31 BIOS_STATUS....................................................................................................................................................355
A.3.32 BIP_EXC..............................................................................................................................................................356
A.3.33 BIP_SD.................................................................................................................................................................358
A.3.34 BOOTROM_BAD................................................................................................................................................360
A.3.35 BUS_ERR.............................................................................................................................................................361
A.3.36 CES_ACR_LOCK_ABN.....................................................................................................................................363

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential x


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide Contents

A.3.37 CES_APS_INDI...................................................................................................................................................364
A.3.38 CES_APS_MANUAL_STOP..............................................................................................................................367
A.3.39 CES_JTROVR_EXC............................................................................................................................................368
A.3.40 CES_JTRUDR_EXC............................................................................................................................................369
A.3.41 CES_K1_K2_M....................................................................................................................................................370
A.3.42 CES_K2_M...........................................................................................................................................................371
A.3.43 CES_LOSPKT_EXC............................................................................................................................................373
A.3.44 CES_MALPKT_EXC...........................................................................................................................................374
A.3.45 CES_MISORDERPKT_EXC...............................................................................................................................375
A.3.46 CES_RDI..............................................................................................................................................................376
A.3.47 CES_STRAYPKT_EXC......................................................................................................................................377
A.3.48 CESPW_OPPOSITE_ACFAULT........................................................................................................................377
A.3.49 CESPW_OPPOSITE_RAI...................................................................................................................................378
A.3.50 CFCARD_FAILED..............................................................................................................................................379
A.3.51 CFCARD_OFFLINE............................................................................................................................................380
A.3.52 CHCS....................................................................................................................................................................382
A.3.53 CLK_LOCK_FAIL...............................................................................................................................................383
A.3.54 CLK_NO_TRACE_MODE..................................................................................................................................384
A.3.55 COMMUN_FAIL.................................................................................................................................................386
A.3.56 COM_EXTECC_FULL........................................................................................................................................388
A.3.57 CONFIG_NOSUPPORT......................................................................................................................................388
A.3.58 DBMS_DELETE..................................................................................................................................................391
A.3.59 DBMS_ERROR....................................................................................................................................................391
A.3.60 DBMS_PROTECT_MODE.................................................................................................................................392
A.3.61 DCNSIZE_OVER.................................................................................................................................................393
A.3.62 DDN_LFA............................................................................................................................................................394
A.3.63 DOWN_E1_AIS...................................................................................................................................................395
A.3.64 DROPRATIO_OVER...........................................................................................................................................396
A.3.65 E1_LOC................................................................................................................................................................397
A.3.66 E1_LOS................................................................................................................................................................398
A.3.67 ELAN_SMAC_FLAPPING.................................................................................................................................400
A.3.68 ENVHUM_SENSOR_FAIL.................................................................................................................................401
A.3.69 ENVTEMP_SENSOR_FAIL...............................................................................................................................402
A.3.70 ENVTEMP1_SENSOR_FAIL.............................................................................................................................403
A.3.71 ENVTEMP2_SENSOR_FAIL.............................................................................................................................405
A.3.72 ERPS_IN_PROTECTION....................................................................................................................................406
A.3.73 ETH_APS_LOST.................................................................................................................................................407
A.3.74 ETH_APS_PATH_MISMATCH.........................................................................................................................408
A.3.75 ETH_APS_SWITCH_FAIL.................................................................................................................................409
A.3.76 ETH_APS_TYPE_MISMATCH..........................................................................................................................410
A.3.77 ETH_AUTO_LINK_DOWN...............................................................................................................................411

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential xi


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide Contents

A.3.78 ETH_CFM_AIS....................................................................................................................................................412
A.3.79 ETH_CFM_LOC..................................................................................................................................................414
A.3.80 ETH_CFM_MISMERGE.....................................................................................................................................416
A.3.81 ETH_CFM_RDI...................................................................................................................................................419
A.3.82 ETH_CFM_UNEXPERI......................................................................................................................................421
A.3.83 ETH_EFM_DF.....................................................................................................................................................424
A.3.84 ETH_EFM_EVENT.............................................................................................................................................425
A.3.85 ETH_EFM_LOOPBACK.....................................................................................................................................427
A.3.86 ETH_EFM_REMFAULT.....................................................................................................................................428
A.3.87 ETH_LOS.............................................................................................................................................................429
A.3.88 ETH_NO_FLOW.................................................................................................................................................431
A.3.89 ETH_PWR_SUPPLY_FAIL................................................................................................................................432
A.3.90 ETHOAM_DISCOVER_FAIL............................................................................................................................433
A.3.91 ETHOAM_RMT_CRIT_FAULT.........................................................................................................................434
A.3.92 ETHOAM_RMT_LOOP......................................................................................................................................436
A.3.93 ETHOAM_RMT_SD...........................................................................................................................................437
A.3.94 ETHOAM_SELF_LOOP.....................................................................................................................................439
A.3.95 ETHOAM_VCG_SELF_LOOP...........................................................................................................................441
A.3.96 EX_ETHOAM_CC_LOS.....................................................................................................................................442
A.3.97 EX_ETHOAM_MPID_CNFLCT.........................................................................................................................444
A.3.98 EXT_SYNC_LOS................................................................................................................................................445
A.3.99 EXT_TIME_LOC.................................................................................................................................................446
A.3.100 FAN_AGING.....................................................................................................................................................447
A.3.101 FAN_FAIL.........................................................................................................................................................448
A.3.102 FCS_ERR...........................................................................................................................................................449
A.3.103 FDBSIZEALM_ELAN.......................................................................................................................................451
A.3.104 FLOW_OVER....................................................................................................................................................452
A.3.105 HARD_BAD.......................................................................................................................................................453
A.3.106 HARD_NONSUPPORT.....................................................................................................................................454
A.3.107 HP_CROSSTR...................................................................................................................................................455
A.3.108 HP_LOM............................................................................................................................................................457
A.3.109 HP_RDI..............................................................................................................................................................458
A.3.110 HP_REI...............................................................................................................................................................459
A.3.111 HP_SLM.............................................................................................................................................................459
A.3.112 HP_TIM..............................................................................................................................................................460
A.3.113 HP_UNEQ..........................................................................................................................................................461
A.3.114 HPAD_CROSSTR..............................................................................................................................................462
A.3.115 IF_CABLE_OPEN.............................................................................................................................................464
A.3.116 IF_INPWR_ABN...............................................................................................................................................465
A.3.117 IF_MODE_UNSUPPORTED............................................................................................................................466
A.3.118 IMA_GROUP_LE_DOWN................................................................................................................................468

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential xii


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide Contents

A.3.119 IMA_GROUP_RE_DOWN...............................................................................................................................469
A.3.120 IMA_TXCLK_MISMATCH..............................................................................................................................470
A.3.121 IN_PWR_ABN...................................................................................................................................................471
A.3.122 IN_PWR_HIGH.................................................................................................................................................472
A.3.123 IN_PWR_LOW..................................................................................................................................................473
A.3.124 INTEMP_SENSOR_FAIL.................................................................................................................................475
A.3.125 J0_MM................................................................................................................................................................476
A.3.126 K1_K2_M...........................................................................................................................................................477
A.3.127 K2_M..................................................................................................................................................................479
A.3.128 LAG_BWMM.....................................................................................................................................................480
A.3.129 LAG_DOWN......................................................................................................................................................481
A.3.130 LAG_MEMBER_DOWN..................................................................................................................................482
A.3.131 LAG_PORT_FAIL.............................................................................................................................................484
A.3.132 LAG_VC_PORT_FAIL.....................................................................................................................................486
A.3.133 LAN_LOC..........................................................................................................................................................488
A.3.134 LASER_CLOSED..............................................................................................................................................489
A.3.135 LASER_MOD_ERR...........................................................................................................................................490
A.3.136 LASER_MOD_ERR_EX...................................................................................................................................491
A.3.137 LASER_SHUT...................................................................................................................................................493
A.3.138 LCAS_FOPR......................................................................................................................................................493
A.3.139 LCAS_FOPT......................................................................................................................................................495
A.3.140 LCAS_PLCR......................................................................................................................................................497
A.3.141 LCAS_PLCT......................................................................................................................................................498
A.3.142 LCAS_TLCR......................................................................................................................................................500
A.3.143 LCAS_TLCT......................................................................................................................................................501
A.3.144 LCD....................................................................................................................................................................503
A.3.145 LCS_LIMITED...................................................................................................................................................504
A.3.146 LFA.....................................................................................................................................................................506
A.3.147 LICENSE_LOST................................................................................................................................................508
A.3.148 LINK_ERR.........................................................................................................................................................509
A.3.149 LMFA.................................................................................................................................................................510
A.3.150 LOOP_ALM.......................................................................................................................................................512
A.3.151 LP_CROSSTR....................................................................................................................................................515
A.3.152 LP_R_FIFO........................................................................................................................................................516
A.3.153 LP_RDI...............................................................................................................................................................517
A.3.154 LP_RDI_VC12...................................................................................................................................................518
A.3.155 LP_RDI_VC3.....................................................................................................................................................519
A.3.156 LP_REI...............................................................................................................................................................520
A.3.157 LP_REI_VC12....................................................................................................................................................521
A.3.158 LP_REI_VC3......................................................................................................................................................522
A.3.159 LP_RFI...............................................................................................................................................................523

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential xiii


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide Contents

A.3.160 LP_SLM.............................................................................................................................................................524
A.3.161 LP_SLM_VC12..................................................................................................................................................524
A.3.162 LP_SLM_VC3....................................................................................................................................................525
A.3.163 LP_T_FIFO.........................................................................................................................................................526
A.3.164 LP_TIM..............................................................................................................................................................527
A.3.165 LP_TIM_VC12...................................................................................................................................................528
A.3.166 LP_TIM_VC3.....................................................................................................................................................529
A.3.167 LP_UNEQ...........................................................................................................................................................531
A.3.168 LP_UNEQ_VC12...............................................................................................................................................532
A.3.169 LP_UNEQ_VC3.................................................................................................................................................533
A.3.170 LPS_UNI_BI_M.................................................................................................................................................534
A.3.171 LPT_CFG_CLOSEPORT...................................................................................................................................535
A.3.172 LPT_INEFFECT.................................................................................................................................................536
A.3.173 LPT_RFI.............................................................................................................................................................538
A.3.174 LSR_BCM_ALM...............................................................................................................................................539
A.3.175 LSR_NO_FITED................................................................................................................................................540
A.3.176 LSR_WILL_DIE................................................................................................................................................541
A.3.177 LTI......................................................................................................................................................................542
A.3.178 MAC_EXT_EXC...............................................................................................................................................544
A.3.179 MAC_FCS_EXC................................................................................................................................................545
A.3.180 MAC_FCS_SD...................................................................................................................................................546
A.3.181 MOD_COM_FAIL.............................................................................................................................................547
A.3.182 MOD_TYPE_MISMATCH...............................................................................................................................548
A.3.183 MP_DELAY.......................................................................................................................................................550
A.3.184 MP_DOWN........................................................................................................................................................551
A.3.185 MPLS_PW_AIS.................................................................................................................................................553
A.3.186 MPLS_PW_CSF.................................................................................................................................................554
A.3.187 MPLS_PW_BDI.................................................................................................................................................555
A.3.188 MPLS_PW_Excess.............................................................................................................................................555
A.3.189 MPLS_PW_LCK................................................................................................................................................556
A.3.190 MPLS_PW_LOCK.............................................................................................................................................557
A.3.191 MPLS_PW_LOCV.............................................................................................................................................558
A.3.192 MPLS_PW_MISMATCH..................................................................................................................................560
A.3.193 MPLS_PW_MISMERGE...................................................................................................................................561
A.3.194 MPLS_PW_OAMFAIL......................................................................................................................................562
A.3.195 MPLS_PW_RDI.................................................................................................................................................563
A.3.196 MPLS_PW_SD...................................................................................................................................................564
A.3.197 MPLS_PW_SF...................................................................................................................................................565
A.3.198 MPLS_PW_UNEXPMEG..................................................................................................................................566
A.3.199 MPLS_PW_UNEXPMEP..................................................................................................................................567
A.3.200 MPLS_PW_UNEXPPER...................................................................................................................................567

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential xiv


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide Contents

A.3.201 MPLS_PW_UNKNOWN...................................................................................................................................568
A.3.202 MPLS_TUNNEL_AIS.......................................................................................................................................569
A.3.203 MPLS_TUNNEL_BDI.......................................................................................................................................570
A.3.204 MPLS_TUNNEL_Excess...................................................................................................................................571
A.3.205 MPLS_TUNNEL_FDI.......................................................................................................................................571
A.3.206 MPLS_TUNNEL_LOCV...................................................................................................................................572
A.3.207 MPLS_TUNNEL_LOCK...................................................................................................................................574
A.3.208 MPLS_TUNNEL_MISMATCH........................................................................................................................575
A.3.209 MPLS_TUNNEL_MISMERGE.........................................................................................................................576
A.3.210 MPLS_TUNNEL_OAMFAIL............................................................................................................................577
A.3.211 MPLS_TUNNEL_RDI.......................................................................................................................................578
A.3.212 MPLS_TUNNEL_SD.........................................................................................................................................578
A.3.213 MPLS_TUNNEL_SF.........................................................................................................................................579
A.3.214 MPLS_TUNNEL_UNEXPMEG........................................................................................................................580
A.3.215 MPLS_TUNNEL_UNEXPMEP........................................................................................................................581
A.3.216 MPLS_TUNNEL_UNEXPPER.........................................................................................................................582
A.3.217 MPLS_TUNNEL_UNKNOWN.........................................................................................................................583
A.3.218 MS_AIS..............................................................................................................................................................584
A.3.219 MS_CROSSTR...................................................................................................................................................585
A.3.220 MS_RDI..............................................................................................................................................................587
A.3.221 MS_REI..............................................................................................................................................................587
A.3.222 MSAD_CROSSTR.............................................................................................................................................588
A.3.223 MULTI_RPL_OWNER......................................................................................................................................589
A.3.224 MW_AM_TEST.................................................................................................................................................590
A.3.225 MW_BER_EXC.................................................................................................................................................591
A.3.226 MW_BER_SD....................................................................................................................................................595
A.3.227 MW_CFG_MISMATCH....................................................................................................................................599
A.3.228 MW_CONT_WAVE..........................................................................................................................................600
A.3.229 MW_E1_LOST...................................................................................................................................................601
A.3.230 MW_FEC_UNCOR............................................................................................................................................602
A.3.231 MW_LIM............................................................................................................................................................605
A.3.232 MW_LOF...........................................................................................................................................................607
A.3.233 MW_RDI............................................................................................................................................................612
A.3.234 NEIP_CONFUSION...........................................................................................................................................613
A.3.235 NESF_LOST.......................................................................................................................................................613
A.3.236 NESOFT_MM....................................................................................................................................................615
A.3.237 NO_BD_SOFT...................................................................................................................................................616
A.3.238 NP1_MANUAL_STOP......................................................................................................................................617
A.3.239 NP1_SW_FAIL..................................................................................................................................................618
A.3.240 NP1_SW_INDI...................................................................................................................................................619
A.3.241 NTP_SYNC_FAIL.............................................................................................................................................620

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential xv


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide Contents

A.3.242 OCD....................................................................................................................................................................621
A.3.243 ODC_BATTERY_CURRENT_ABN................................................................................................................622
A.3.244 ODC_BATTERY_PWRDOWN........................................................................................................................624
A.3.245 ODC_DOOR_OPEN..........................................................................................................................................626
A.3.246 ODC_FAN_FAILED..........................................................................................................................................628
A.3.247 ODC_HUMI_ABN.............................................................................................................................................629
A.3.248 ODC_LOAD_PWRDOWN................................................................................................................................630
A.3.249 ODC_MDL_ABN...............................................................................................................................................633
A.3.250 ODC_POWER_FAIL.........................................................................................................................................635
A.3.251 ODC_SMOKE_OVER.......................................................................................................................................637
A.3.252 ODC_SURGE_PROTECTION_FAIL...............................................................................................................638
A.3.253 ODC_TEC_ALM...............................................................................................................................................640
A.3.254 ODC_TEMP_ABN.............................................................................................................................................641
A.3.255 ODC_WATER_ALM.........................................................................................................................................643
A.3.256 OUT_PWR_ABN...............................................................................................................................................644
A.3.257 OUT1TEMP_SENSOR_FAIL...........................................................................................................................646
A.3.258 OUT2TEMP_SENSOR_FAIL...........................................................................................................................647
A.3.259 PASSWORD_NEED_CHANGE.......................................................................................................................648
A.3.260 PATCH_BD_EXCLUDE...................................................................................................................................649
A.3.261 PATCH_BD_MATCH_FAIL............................................................................................................................649
A.3.262 PATCH_CHGSCC_NOTMATCH.....................................................................................................................650
A.3.263 PATCH_PKGERR.............................................................................................................................................651
A.3.264 PG_LINK_FAIL.................................................................................................................................................652
A.3.265 PG_PRT_DEGRADED......................................................................................................................................652
A.3.266 PLA_CFG_MISMATCH...................................................................................................................................653
A.3.267 PLA_DOWN......................................................................................................................................................655
A.3.268 PLA_MEMBER_DOWN...................................................................................................................................655
A.3.269 PORTMODE_MISMATCH...............................................................................................................................657
A.3.270 PORT_EXC_TRAFFIC......................................................................................................................................658
A.3.271 PORT_MODULE_OFFLINE.............................................................................................................................659
A.3.272 POWER_ABNORMAL.....................................................................................................................................660
A.3.273 POWER_ALM...................................................................................................................................................661
A.3.274 PPP_LCP_FAIL.................................................................................................................................................663
A.3.275 PPP_NCP_FAIL.................................................................................................................................................664
A.3.276 PTP_SOURCE_SWITCH..................................................................................................................................665
A.3.277 PTP_TIMESTAMP_ABN..................................................................................................................................666
A.3.278 PW_DROPPKT_EXC........................................................................................................................................667
A.3.279 PW_NO_TRAFFIC............................................................................................................................................668
A.3.280 PWAPS_LOST...................................................................................................................................................670
A.3.281 PWAPS_PATH_MISMATCH...........................................................................................................................671
A.3.282 PWAPS_SWITCH_FAIL...................................................................................................................................672

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential xvi


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide Contents

A.3.283 PWAPS_TYPE_MISMATCH...........................................................................................................................673
A.3.284 PW_APS_DEGRADED.....................................................................................................................................674
A.3.285 PW_APS_OUTAGE...........................................................................................................................................674
A.3.286 R_LOC................................................................................................................................................................675
A.3.287 R_LOF................................................................................................................................................................676
A.3.288 R_LOS................................................................................................................................................................678
A.3.289 R_OOF................................................................................................................................................................680
A.3.290 RADIO_FADING_MARGIN_INSUFF.............................................................................................................682
A.3.291 RADIO_MUTE..................................................................................................................................................684
A.3.292 RADIO_RSL_BEYONDTH..............................................................................................................................685
A.3.293 RADIO_RSL_HIGH..........................................................................................................................................686
A.3.294 RADIO_RSL_LOW...........................................................................................................................................687
A.3.295 RADIO_TSL_HIGH...........................................................................................................................................688
A.3.296 RADIO_TSL_LOW...........................................................................................................................................689
A.3.297 RELAY_ALARM_CRITICAL..........................................................................................................................690
A.3.298 RELAY_ALARM_IGNORE.............................................................................................................................691
A.3.299 RELAY_ALARM_MAJOR...............................................................................................................................691
A.3.300 RELAY_ALARM_MINOR...............................................................................................................................692
A.3.301 RMFA.................................................................................................................................................................693
A.3.302 RPS_INDI...........................................................................................................................................................694
A.3.303 RS_CROSSTR....................................................................................................................................................696
A.3.304 RTC_FAIL..........................................................................................................................................................697
A.3.305 S1_SYN_CHANGE...........................................................................................................................................698
A.3.306 SCCDATA_BACKUP_FAIL(SYNC_FAIL)....................................................................................................700
A.3.307 SEC_RADIUS_FAIL.........................................................................................................................................701
A.3.308 SECU_ALM.......................................................................................................................................................702
A.3.309 SRV_SHUTDOWN_LD....................................................................................................................................704
A.3.310 SSL_CERT_NOENC.........................................................................................................................................704
A.3.311 SUBNET_RT_CONFLICT................................................................................................................................705
A.3.312 SWDL_ACTIVATED_TIMEOUT....................................................................................................................707
A.3.313 SWDL_AUTOMATCH_INH............................................................................................................................708
A.3.314 SWDL_CHGMNG_NOMATCH.......................................................................................................................709
A.3.315 SWDL_COMMIT_FAIL....................................................................................................................................710
A.3.316 SWDL_INPROCESS.........................................................................................................................................710
A.3.317 SWDL_NEPKGCHECK....................................................................................................................................711
A.3.318 SWDL_PKG_NOBDSOFT................................................................................................................................712
A.3.319 SWDL_PKGVER_MM......................................................................................................................................713
A.3.320 SWDL_ROLLBACK_FAIL...............................................................................................................................713
A.3.321 SYN_BAD..........................................................................................................................................................714
A.3.322 SYNC_C_LOS...................................................................................................................................................715
A.3.323 SYSLOG_COMM_FAIL...................................................................................................................................716

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential xvii


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide Contents

A.3.324 T_ALOS.............................................................................................................................................................717
A.3.325 T_LOC................................................................................................................................................................718
A.3.326 TEM_HA............................................................................................................................................................719
A.3.327 TEM_LA.............................................................................................................................................................720
A.3.328 TEMP_ALARM.................................................................................................................................................721
A.3.329 TEMP_OVER.....................................................................................................................................................722
A.3.330 TF........................................................................................................................................................................724
A.3.331 THUNDERALM................................................................................................................................................724
A.3.332 TIME_LOCK_FAIL...........................................................................................................................................725
A.3.333 TIME_NO_TRACE_MODE..............................................................................................................................726
A.3.334 TR_LOC.............................................................................................................................................................728
A.3.335 TU_AIS...............................................................................................................................................................729
A.3.336 TU_AIS_VC12...................................................................................................................................................731
A.3.337 TU_AIS_VC3.....................................................................................................................................................733
A.3.338 TU_LOP.............................................................................................................................................................735
A.3.339 TU_LOP_VC12..................................................................................................................................................735
A.3.340 TU_LOP_VC3....................................................................................................................................................737
A.3.341 TUNNEL_APS_DEGRADED...........................................................................................................................739
A.3.342 TUNNEL_APS_OUTAGE.................................................................................................................................740
A.3.343 UHCS..................................................................................................................................................................741
A.3.344 UP_E1_AIS........................................................................................................................................................742
A.3.345 USB_PROCESS_FAIL......................................................................................................................................743
A.3.346 V5_VCAIS.........................................................................................................................................................744
A.3.347 VC_AIS..............................................................................................................................................................745
A.3.348 VC_LOC.............................................................................................................................................................747
A.3.349 VC_RDI..............................................................................................................................................................749
A.3.350 VCAT_LOA.......................................................................................................................................................751
A.3.351 VCAT_LOM_VC12...........................................................................................................................................752
A.3.352 VCAT_LOM_VC3.............................................................................................................................................753
A.3.353 VCAT_SQM_VC12...........................................................................................................................................755
A.3.354 VCAT_SQM_VC3.............................................................................................................................................756
A.3.355 VOLT_LOS........................................................................................................................................................758
A.3.356 VP_AIS...............................................................................................................................................................759
A.3.357 VP_LOC.............................................................................................................................................................761
A.3.358 VP_RDI..............................................................................................................................................................763
A.3.359 W_R_FAIL.........................................................................................................................................................765
A.3.360 WRG_BD_TYPE...............................................................................................................................................766
A.3.361 XPIC_LOS..........................................................................................................................................................766

B Performance Event Reference.................................................................................................769


B.1 Performance Events (by Event Type)........................................................................................................................770
B.1.1 SDH/PDH Performance Event List........................................................................................................................770

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential xviii


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide Contents

B.1.2 Radio Performance Events......................................................................................................................................774


B.1.3 MPLS Tunnel/PW Performance Events.................................................................................................................777
B.1.4 Other Performance Events......................................................................................................................................778
B.2 Performance Events (by Logical Board)....................................................................................................................779
B.2.1 CQ1.........................................................................................................................................................................781
B.2.2 CSHN......................................................................................................................................................................784
B.2.3 EG2D......................................................................................................................................................................786
B.2.4 EG4/EG4P...............................................................................................................................................................786
B.2.5 EM6T......................................................................................................................................................................787
B.2.6 EM6TA...................................................................................................................................................................787
B.2.7 EM6F......................................................................................................................................................................788
B.2.8 EM6FA...................................................................................................................................................................788
B.2.9 EFP8........................................................................................................................................................................789
B.2.10 EMS6....................................................................................................................................................................790
B.2.11 IF1.........................................................................................................................................................................791
B.2.12 IFU2/ISU2.............................................................................................................................................................794
B.2.13 IFX2/ISX2.............................................................................................................................................................798
B.2.14 ISV3......................................................................................................................................................................802
B.2.15 ML1/MD1.............................................................................................................................................................807
B.2.16 ODU......................................................................................................................................................................808
B.2.17 SL1D/SL1DA.......................................................................................................................................................809
B.2.18 SL4D.....................................................................................................................................................................811
B.2.19 SP3S/SP3D...........................................................................................................................................................814
B.3 Performance Events and Handling Procedures..........................................................................................................815
B.3.1 ATPC_P_ADJUST and ATPC_N_ADJUST.........................................................................................................815
B.3.2 AMDOWNCNT and AMUPCNT..........................................................................................................................816
B.3.3 AUPJCHIGH, AUPJCLOW, and AUPJCNEW.....................................................................................................817
B.3.4 BDTEMPMAX, BDTEMPMIN, and BDTEMPCUR............................................................................................818
B.3.5 CURPOSITIVEPDV and CURNEGATIVEPDV..................................................................................................818
B.3.6 E1_LCV_SDH, E1_LLOSS_SDH, E1_LES_SDH, and E1_LSES_SDH.............................................................819
B.3.7 E1_BBE, E1_ES, E1_SES, E1_CSES, and E1_UAS.............................................................................................820
B.3.8 FEC_BEF_COR_ER, FEC_COR_BYTE_CNT and FEC_UNCOR_BLOCK_CNT............................................822
B.3.9 HPBBE, HPES, HPSES, HPCSES, and HPUAS...................................................................................................822
B.3.10 HPFEBBE, HPFEES, HPFESES, HPFECSES, and HPFEUAS..........................................................................824
B.3.11 IF_BBE, IF_ES, IF_SES, IF_CSES, and IF_UAS...............................................................................................825
B.3.12 IF_SNR_MAX, IF_SNR_MIN, and IF_SNR_AVG............................................................................................826
B.3.13 LPBBE, LPES, LPSES, LPCSES, and LPUAS....................................................................................................826
B.3.14 LPFEBBE, LPFEES, LPFESES, LPFECSES, and LPFEUAS............................................................................828
B.3.15 MAXFREQDEV, MINFREQDEV, and AVGFREQDEV...................................................................................829
B.3.16 MAXMEANPATHDELAY, MINMEANPATHDELAY, and AVGMEANPATHDELAY...............................829
B.3.17 MAXPHASEOFFSET, MINPHASEOFFSET, and AVGPHASEOFFSET.........................................................830

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential xix


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide Contents

B.3.18 MAXPOSITIVEDELAY, MINPOSITIVEDELAY, and AVGPOSITIVEDELAY............................................831


B.3.19 MPLS_PW_LS, MPLS_PW_SLS, MPLS_PW_CSLS, and MPLS_PW_UAS...................................................831
B.3.20 MSBBE, MSES, MSSES, MSCSES, and MSUAS..............................................................................................832
B.3.21 MSFEBBE, MSFEES, MSFESES, MSFECSES, and MSFEUAS.......................................................................834
B.3.22 OSPITMPMAX, OSPITMPMIN, and OSPITMPCUR........................................................................................835
B.3.23 PG_IF_BBE, PG_IF_ES, PG_IF_SES, PG_IF_CSES, and PG_IF_UAS............................................................835
B.3.24 RPLMAX, RPLMIN, and RPLCUR....................................................................................................................837
B.3.25 RSBBE, RSES, RSSES, RSCSES, and RSUAS..................................................................................................837
B.3.26 RSL_MAX, RSL_MIN, RSL_CUR, and RSL_AVG..........................................................................................839
B.3.27 RSOOF and RSOFS..............................................................................................................................................839
B.3.28 QPSKWS, QPSK_S_WS, QAMWS16, QAM_S_WS16, QAMWS32, QAMWS64, QAMWS128, QAMWS256,
QAMWS512, QAM_L_WS512, QAMWS1024, and QAM_L_WS1024.......................................................................840
B.3.29 TLBMAX, TLBMIN, and TLBCUR....................................................................................................................841
B.3.30 RLHTT, RLLTT, TLHTT, TLLTT......................................................................................................................842
B.3.31 TPLMAX, TPLMIN, and TPLCUR.....................................................................................................................843
B.3.32 TSL_MAX, TSL_MIN, TSL_CUR, and TSL_AVG...........................................................................................843
B.3.33 TUPJCHIGH, TUPJCLOW, and TUPJCNEW....................................................................................................844
B.3.34 XPIC_XPD_VALUE............................................................................................................................................845

C RMON Event Reference..........................................................................................................846


C.1 List of RMON Alarm Entries....................................................................................................................................847
C.2 RMON Performance Entries List on the Packet-Plane..............................................................................................850
C.2.1 EM6F/EM6T/EM6FA/EM6TA/EG4/EG4P/EG2D................................................................................................850
C.2.2 IFU2/IFX2...............................................................................................................................................................857
C.2.3 ISU2/ISX2/ISV3.....................................................................................................................................................863
C.2.4 ML1/MD1...............................................................................................................................................................870
C.2.5 CQ1.........................................................................................................................................................................876
C.2.6 CSHN......................................................................................................................................................................878
C.2.7 EFP8/EMS6............................................................................................................................................................885
C.3 RMON Performance Entries List on the EoS/EoPDH-Plane....................................................................................887
C.3.1 EFP8........................................................................................................................................................................888
C.3.2 EMS6......................................................................................................................................................................892
C.4 RMON Events and Handling Procedures..................................................................................................................897
C.4.1 ETHDROP..............................................................................................................................................................897
C.4.2 ETHEXCCOL.........................................................................................................................................................898
C.4.3 ETHLATECOL.......................................................................................................................................................899
C.4.4 RXBBAD................................................................................................................................................................900
C.4.5 TXDEFFRM...........................................................................................................................................................901
C.4.6 ETHUNDER...........................................................................................................................................................902
C.4.7 ETHOVER..............................................................................................................................................................902
C.4.8 ETHFRG.................................................................................................................................................................903
C.4.9 ETHJAB..................................................................................................................................................................904

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential xx


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide Contents

C.4.10 ETHCOL...............................................................................................................................................................905
C.4.11 ETHFCS................................................................................................................................................................906
C.4.12 ATMPW_LOSPKTS............................................................................................................................................907
C.4.13 ATMPW_MISORDERPKTS...............................................................................................................................907
C.4.14 ATMPW_UNKNOWNCELLS............................................................................................................................908
C.4.15 ATM_CORRECTED_HCSERR..........................................................................................................................909
C.4.16 ATM_UNCORRECTED_HCSERR.....................................................................................................................909
C.4.17 CES_MISORDERPKTS.......................................................................................................................................910
C.4.18 CES_STRAYPKTS..............................................................................................................................................911
C.4.19 CES_MALPKTS...................................................................................................................................................911
C.4.20 CES_JTRUDR......................................................................................................................................................912
C.4.21 CES_JTROVR......................................................................................................................................................913
C.4.22 CES_LOSPKTS....................................................................................................................................................914

D Alarm Management.................................................................................................................915
D.1 NE Alarm Management.............................................................................................................................................916
D.2 Board Alarm Management........................................................................................................................................916
D.2.1 Setting the Alarm Severity......................................................................................................................................916
D.2.2 Alarm Suppression..................................................................................................................................................916
D.2.3 Alarm Auto-Report.................................................................................................................................................917
D.2.4 Alarm Reversion.....................................................................................................................................................917
D.2.5 Setting of the Bit Error Alarm Threshold...............................................................................................................917
D.2.6 AIS Insertion...........................................................................................................................................................918
D.2.7 UNEQ Insertion......................................................................................................................................................919

E Performance Event Management...........................................................................................920


E.1 NE Performance Event Management.........................................................................................................................921
E.2 Board Performance Event Management....................................................................................................................921

F Alarm Suppression Relationship...........................................................................................922


F.1 Alarm Suppression on TDM Plane............................................................................................................................923
F.2 Alarm Suppression on Data Plane..............................................................................................................................926

G Indicators of Boards.................................................................................................................933
H Glossary......................................................................................................................................954

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential xxi


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 1 Safety Precautions

1 Safety Precautions

About This Chapter

This topic describes the safety precautions that you must follow when installing, operating, and
maintaining Huawei devices.

1.1 General Safety Precautions


This topic describes essential safety precautions that instruct you in the selection of measuring
and testing instruments when you install, operate, and maintain Huawei devices.

1.2 Warning and Safety Symbols


Before using the equipment, note the following warning and safety symbols on the equipment.

1.3 Electrical Safety


This topic describes safety precautions for high voltage, lightning strikes, high leakage current,
power cables, fuses, and ESD.

1.4 Environment of Flammable Gas


This topic describes safety precautions for the operating environment of a device.

1.5 Storage Batteries


This topic describes safety precautions for operations of storage batteries.

1.6 Radiation
This topic describes safety precautions for electromagnetic exposure and lasers.

1.7 Working at Heights


This topic describes safety precautions for working at heights.

1.8 Mechanical Safety


This topic describes safety precautions for drilling holes, handling sharp objects, operating fans,
and carrying heavy objects.

1.9 Other Precautions


This topic describes safety precautions for removing and inserting boards, binding signal cables,
and routing cables.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 1


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 1 Safety Precautions

1.1 General Safety Precautions


This topic describes essential safety precautions that instruct you in the selection of measuring
and testing instruments when you install, operate, and maintain Huawei devices.

All Safety Precautions


To ensure the safety of humans and a device, follow the marks on the device and all the safety
precautions in this document when installing, operating, and maintaining a device.

The "CAUTION", "WARNING", and "DANGER" marks in this document do not cover all the
safety precautions that must be followed. They are supplements to the safety precautions.

Local Laws and Regulations


When operating a device, always comply with the local laws and regulations. The safety
precautions provided in the documents are in addition/supplementary to the local laws and
regulations.

Basic Installation Requirements


The installation and maintenance personnel of Huawei devices must receive strict training and
be familiar with the proper operation methods and safety precautions before any operation.

l Only trained and qualified personnel are permitted to install, operate, and maintain a device.
l Only certified professionals are permitted to remove the safety facilities, and to troubleshoot
and maintain the device.
l Only the personnel authenticated or authorized by Huawei are permitted to replace or
change the device or parts of the device (including software).
l The operating personnel must immediately report the faults or errors that may cause safety
problems to the person in charge.

Grounding Requirements
The grounding requirements are applicable to the device that needs to be grounded.

l When installing the device, always connect the grounding facilities first. When removing
the device, always disconnect the grounding facilities last.
l Ensure that the grounding conductor is intact.
l Do not operate the device in the absence of a suitably installed grounding conductor.
l The device must be connected to the PGND permanently. Before operating the device,
check the electrical connections of the device, and ensure that the device is properly
grounded.

Human Safety
l When there is a risk of a lightning strike, do not operate the fixed terminal or touch the
cables.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 2


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 1 Safety Precautions

l When there is risk of a lightning strike, unplug the AC power connector. Do not use the
fixed terminal or touch the terminal or antenna connector.
NOTE
The preceding requirements apply to wireless fixed station terminals.
l To avoid electric shocks, do not connect safety extra-low voltage (SELV) circuits to
telephone-network voltage (TNV) circuits.
l Do not look into optical ports without eye protection. Otherwise, human eyes may be hurt
by laser beams.
l Before operating the device, wear an ESD protective coat, ESD gloves, and an ESD wrist
strap. In addition, you need to get off the conductive objects, such as jewelry and watches,
to prevent electric shock and burn.
l In case of fire, escape from the building or site where the device is located and press the
fire alarm bell or dial the telephone number for fire alarms. Do not enter the burning building
again in any situation.

Device Safety
l Before any operation, install the device firmly on the ground or other rigid objects, such as
on a wall or in a rack.
l When the system is working, ensure that the ventilation hole is not blocked.
l When installing the front panel, use a tool to tighten the screws firmly, if required.
l After installing the device, clean up the packing materials.

1.2 Warning and Safety Symbols


Before using the equipment, note the following warning and safety symbols on the equipment.

Table 1-1 lists the warning and safety symbols of the OptiX RTN 980 and their meanings.

Table 1-1 Warning and safety symbols of the OptiX RTN 980

Symbol Indication

This symbol is for ESD protection.


A notice with this symbol indicates that you should wear
an ES wrist strap or glove when you touch a board.
Otherwise, you may cause damage to the board.

This symbol is for the laser class.


CLASS 1
LASER A notice with this symbol indicates the class of the laser.
PRODUCT Avoid direct exposure to the laser beams. Otherwise, it may
damage you eyes or skin.
LASER
RADIATION

DO NOT VIEW DIRECTLY


WITH OPTICAL
INSTRUMENTS
CLASS 1M LASER
PRODUCT

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 3


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 1 Safety Precautions

Symbol Indication

A notice with this symbol indicates where the subrack is


grounded.

A notice with this symbol indicates that the air filter should
ATTENTION be cleaned periodically.
CLEAN PERIODICALLY

This symbol is for fan safety.


DON'T TOUCH THE
FAN LEAVES BEFORE A notice with this symbol indicates that the fan leaves
THEY SLOW DOWN !
should not be touched when the fan is rotating.

1.3 Electrical Safety


This topic describes safety precautions for high voltage, lightning strikes, high leakage current,
power cables, fuses, and ESD.

High Voltage

DANGER
l A high-voltage power supply provides power for device operations. Direct human contact
with the high voltage power supply or human contact through damp objects can be fatal.
l Unspecified or unauthorized high voltage operations could result in fire or electric shock, or
both.

Thunderstorm
The requirements apply only to wireless base stations or devices with antennas and feeders.

DANGER
Do not perform operations on high voltage, AC power, towers, or backstays in stormy weather
conditions.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 4


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 1 Safety Precautions

High Leakage Current

CAUTION
Before powering on a device, ground the device. Otherwise, the safety of humans and the device
cannot be ensured.

If a high leakage current mark is labeled near the power connector of the device, you must
connect the PGND terminal on the shell to the ground before connecting the device to an A/C
input power supply. This is to prevent the electric shock caused by leakage current of the device.

Power Cables

DANGER
Do not install or remove the power cable with a live line. Transient contact between the core of
the power cable and the conductor may generate electric arc or spark, which may cause fire or
eye injury.

l Before installing or removing power cables, you must power off the device.
l Before connecting a power cable, you must ensure that the label on the power cable is
correct.

Device with Power On

DANGER
Installing or removing a device is prohibited if the device is on.

DANGER
Do not install or remove the power cables of the equipment when it is powered on.

Short Circuits
When installing and maintaining devices, place and use the associated tools and instruments in
accordance with regulations to avoid short-circuits caused by metal objects.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 5


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 1 Safety Precautions

NOTICE
To avoid short-circuits when using a tool (such as a screwdriver), do not place the tool on the
ventilation plate of the subrack.

NOTICE
Prevent any screws from dropping into the subrack or chassis to avoid short-circuits.

Fuse

CAUTION
If the fuse on a device blows, replace the fuse with a fuse of the same type and specifications to
ensure safe operation of the device.

Electrostatic Discharge

NOTICE
The static electricity generated by the human body may damage the electrostatic sensitive
components on the board, such as the large-scale integrated circuit (LSI).

l The human body can generate static electromagnetic fields in the following situations:
physical movement, clothing friction, friction between shoes and the ground, plastics in
the hand. Such static electromagnetic effects can remain for an appreciable time.
l Before operating a device, circuit boards, or ASICs, wear an ESD wrist strap that is properly
grounded. The ESD wrist strap can prevent the electrostatic-sensitive components from
being damaged by the static electricity in the human body.

Figure 1-1 shows the method of wearing an ESD wrist strap.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 6


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 1 Safety Precautions

Figure 1-1 Wearing an ESD wrist strap

1.4 Environment of Flammable Gas


This topic describes safety precautions for the operating environment of a device.

DANGER
Do not place or operate devices in an environment of flammable or explosive air or gas.

Operating an electronic device in an environment of flammable gas causes a severe hazard.

1.5 Storage Batteries


This topic describes safety precautions for operations of storage batteries.

DANGER
Before operating a storage battery, you must read the safety precautions carefully and be familiar
with the method of connecting a storage battery.

l Incorrect operations of storage batteries cause hazards. During operation, prevent any short-
circuit, and prevent the electrolyte from overflowing or leakage.
l If the electrolyte overflows, it causes potential hazards to the device. The electrolyte may
corrode metal parts and the circuit boards, and ultimately damage the circuit boards.
l A storage battery contains a great deal of energy. Misoperations may cause a short-circuit,
which leads to human injuries.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 7


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 1 Safety Precautions

Basic Precautions
To ensure safety, note the following points before installing or maintaining the storage battery:

l Use special insulation tools.


l Wear an eye protector and take effective protection measures.
l Wear rubber gloves and a protection coat to prevent the hazard caused by the overflowing
electrolyte.
l When handling the storage battery, ensure that its electrodes are upward. Leaning or
reversing the storage battery is prohibited.
l Before installing or maintaining the storage battery, ensure that the storage battery is
disconnected from the power supply that charges the storage battery.

Short-Circuit

DANGER
A battery short-circuit may cause human injuries. Although the voltage of an ordinary battery
is low, the instantaneous high current caused by a short-circuit emits a great deal of energy.

Avoid any short-circuit of batteries caused by metal objects. If possible, disconnect the working
battery before performing other operations.

Hazardous Gas

NOTICE
Do not use any unsealed lead-acid storage battery. Lay a storage battery horizontally and fix it
properly to prevent the battery from emitting flammable gas, which may cause fire or device
erosion.

Working lead-acid storage batteries emit flammable gas. Therefore, ventilation and fireproofing
measures must be taken at the sites where lead-acid storage batteries are placed.

Battery Temperature

NOTICE
If a battery overheats, the battery may be deformed or damaged, and the electrolyte may
overflow.

When the temperature of the battery is higher than 60C, you need to check whether the
electrolyte overflows. If the electrolyte overflows, take appropriate measures immediately.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 8


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 1 Safety Precautions

Battery Leakage

NOTICE
In the event of acid overflow or spillage, neutralize the acid and clean it up appropriately.

When handling a leaky battery, protect against the possible damage caused by the acid. When
you find the electrolyte leaks, you can use the following substances to counteract and absorb the
leaking electrolyte:
l Sodium bicarbonate (NaHCO3)
l Sodium carbonate (Na2CO3)

In the event of acid overflow or spillage, neutralize the acid and clean it up as recommended by
the battery manufacturer and any local regulations for acid disposal.
If a person contacts battery electrolyte, clean the skin that contacts the battery electrolyte
immediately by using water. In case of a severe situation, the person must be sent to a hospital
immediately.

1.6 Radiation
This topic describes safety precautions for electromagnetic exposure and lasers.

1.6.1 Safe Usage of Optical Fibers


The laser beam can cause damage to your eyes. Hence, you must exercise caution when using
optical fibers.

DANGER
When installing or maintaining an optical interface board or optical fibers, avoid direct eye
exposure to the laser beams launched from the optical interface board or fiber connectors. The
laser beam can cause damage to your eyes.

Cleaning Fiber Connectors and Optical Interfaces

NOTICE
If fiber connectors or flanges are contaminated, optical power commissioning is seriously
affected. Therefore, the two endfaces and flange of every external fiber must be cleaned before
the fiber is led into the equipment through the ODF for being inserted into an optical interface
on the equipment.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 9


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 1 Safety Precautions

The fiber connectors and optical interfaces of the lasers must be cleaned with the following
special cleaning tools and materials:

l Special cleaning solvent: It is preferred to use isoamylol. Propyl alcohol, however, can also
be used. It is prohibited that you use alcohol and formalin.
l Non-woven lens tissue
l Special compressed gas
l Cotton stick (medical cotton or long fiber cotton)
l Special cleaning roll, used with the recommended cleaning solvent
l Special magnifier for fiber connectors

For cleaning steps, see Task Collection "Cleaning Fiber Connectors and Adapters" in the OptiX
RTN 980 Radio Transmission System Maintenance and Troubleshooting.

Replacing Optical Fibers


When replacing an optical fiber, cover the fiber connector of the unused optical fiber with a
protective cap.

Connecting Optical Fibers


l Use an attenuator if the optical power is excessively high. A high received optical power
damages the optical interface.
l Directly connect an attenuator to a slanting optical interface. Install the attenuator on the
IN port instead of the OUT port.
l Do not directly connect an attenuator to the level optical interface. Use the optical
distribution frame (ODF) to connect an attenuator to a level optical interface.

Figure 1-2 shows a slanting optical interface, and Figure 1-3 shows a level optical interface.

Figure 1-2 Slanting optical interface

Slanting optical
interface

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 10


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 1 Safety Precautions

Figure 1-3 Level optical interface

Level optical
interface

1.6.2 Electromagnetic Exposure


This topic describes safety precautions for electromagnetic exposure.

If multiple transmit antennas are installed on a tower or backstay, keep away from the transmit
directions of the antennas when you install or maintain an antenna locally.

NOTICE
Ensure that all personnel are beyond the transmit direction of a working antenna.

1.6.3 Forbidden Areas


The topic describes requirements for a forbidden area.

l Before entering an area where the electromagnetic radiation is beyond the specified range,
the associated personnel must shut down the electromagnetic radiator or stay at least 10
meters away from the electromagnetic radiator, if in the transmit direction.
l A physical barrier and an eye-catching warning flag should be available in each forbidden
area.

1.6.4 Laser
This topic describes safety precautions for lasers.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 11


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 1 Safety Precautions

CAUTION
When handling optical fibers, do not stand close to, or look into the optical fiber outlet directly
without eye protection.

Laser transceivers are used in the optical transmission system and associated test tools. The laser
transmitted through the bare optical fiber produces a small beam of light, and therefore it has
very high power density and is invisible to human eyes. When a beam of light enters eyes, the
eyes may be damaged.
In normal cases, viewing an un-terminated optical fiber or a damaged optical fiber without eye
protection at a distance greater than 150 mm does not cause eye injury. Eye injury may occur,
however, if an optical tool such as a microscope, magnifying glass, or eye loupe is used to view
an un-terminated optical fiber.

Safety Instructions Regarding Lasers


To avoid laser radiation, obey the following instructions:
l All operations should be performed by authorized personnel who have completed the
required training courses.
l Wear a pair of eye-protective glasses when you are handling lasers or fibers.
l Ensure that the optical source is switched off before disconnecting optical fiber connectors.
l Do not look into the end of an exposed fiber or an open connector when you are not sure
whether the optical source is switched off.
l Use an optical power meter to measure the optical power and ensure that the optical source
is switched off.
l Before opening the front door of an optical transmission device, ensure that you are not
exposed to laser radiation.
l Do not use an optical tool such as a microscope, a magnifying glass, or an eye loupe to
view the optical connector or fiber that is transmitting optical signals.

Instructions Regarding Fiber Handling


Read and abide by the following instructions before handling fibers:
l Only trained personnel are permitted to cut and splice fibers.
l Before cutting or splicing a fiber, ensure that the fiber is disconnected from the optical
source. After disconnecting the fiber, cap to the fiber connectors.

1.6.5 Microwave
When installing and maintaining the equipment of Huawei, follow the safety precautions of
microwave to ensure the safety of the human body and the equipment.

CAUTION
Strong radio frequency can harm the human body.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 12


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 1 Safety Precautions

When installing or maintaining an aerial on the tower or mast that is installed with multiple
aerials, switch off the transmitter in advance.

1.7 Working at Heights


This topic describes safety precautions for working at heights.

CAUTION
When working at heights, be cautious to prevent objects from falling down.

The requirements for working at heights are as follows:

l The personnel who work at heights must be trained.


l Carry and handle the operating machines and tools with caution to prevent them from falling
down.
l Safety measures, such as wearing a helmet and a safety belt, must be taken.
l Wear cold-proof clothes when working at heights in cold areas.
l Check all lifting appliances thoroughly before starting the work, and ensure that they are
intact.

1.7.1 Hoisting Heavy Objects


This topic describes the safety precautions for hoisting heavy objects that you must follow when
installing, operating, and maintaining Huawei devices.

CAUTION
When heavy objects are being hoisted, do not walk below the cantilever or hoisted objects.

l Only trained and qualified personnel can perform hoisting operations.


l Before hoisting heavy objects, check that the hoisting tools are complete and in good
condition.
l Before hoisting heavy objects, ensure that the hoisting tools are fixed to a secure object or
wall with good weight-bearing capacity.
l Issue orders with short and explicit words to ensure correct operations.
l Ensure that the angle between the two cables is less than or equal to 90 degrees during the
lifting, as shown in Figure 1-4.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 13


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 1 Safety Precautions

Figure 1-4 Hoisting heavy objects

1.7.2 Using Ladders


This topic describes safety precautions for using ladders.

Checking Ladders
l Before using a ladder, check whether the ladder is damaged. After checking that the ladder
is in good condition, you can use the ladder.
l Before using a ladder, you should know the maximum weight capacity of the ladder. Avoid
overweighing the ladder.

Placing Ladders
The proper slant angle of the ladder is 75 degrees. You can measure the slant angle of the ladder
with an angle square or your arms, as shown in Figure 1-5. When using a ladder, to prevent the
ladder from sliding, ensure that the wider feet of the ladder are downward, or take protection
measures for the ladder feet. Ensure that the ladder is placed securely.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 14


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 1 Safety Precautions

Figure 1-5 Slanting a ladder

Climbing Up a Ladder
When climbing up a ladder, pay attention to the following points:

l Ensure that the center of gravity of your body does not deviate from the edges of the two
long sides.
l Before operations, ensure that your body is stable to reduce risks.
l Do not climb higher than the fourth rung of the ladder (counted from up to down).

If you want to climb up a roof, ensure that the ladder top is at least one meter higher than the
roof, as shown in Figure 1-6.

Figure 1-6 Ladder top being one meter higher than the roof

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 15


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 1 Safety Precautions

1.8 Mechanical Safety


This topic describes safety precautions for drilling holes, handling sharp objects, operating fans,
and carrying heavy objects.

Drilling Holes

CAUTION
Do not drill holes on the cabinet without prior permission. Drilling holes without complying
with the requirements affects the electromagnetic shielding performance of the cabinet and
damages the cables inside the cabinet. In addition, if the scraps caused by drilling enter the
cabinet, the printed circuit boards (PCBs) may be short-circuited.

l Before drilling a hole on the cabinet, remove the cables inside the cabinet.
l Wear an eye protector when drilling holes. This is to prevent eyes from being injured by
the splashing metal scraps.
l Wear protection gloves when drilling holes.
l Take measures to prevent the metallic scraps from falling into the cabinet. After the drilling,
clean up the metallic scraps.

Sharp Objects

CAUTION
Wear protection gloves when carrying the device. This is to prevent hands from being injured
by the sharp edges of the device.

Fans
l When replacing parts, place the objects such as the parts, screws, and tools properly. This
is to prevent them from falling into the operating fans, which damages the fans or device.
l When replacing the parts near fans, keep your fingers or boards from touching operating
fans before the fans are powered off and stop running. Otherwise, the hands or the boards
are damaged.

Carrying Heavy Objects


Wear protection gloves when carrying heavy objects. This is to prevent hands from being hurt.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 16


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 1 Safety Precautions

CAUTION
l The carrier must be prepared for load bearing before carrying heavy objects. This is to prevent
the carrier from being strained or pressed by the heavy objects.
l When you pull a chassis out of the cabinet, pay attention to the unstable or heavy objects on
the cabinet. This is to prevent the heavy objects on the cabinet top from falling down, which
may hurt you.

l Generally, two persons are needed to carry a chassis. It is prohibited that only one person
carries a heavy chassis. When carrying a chassis, the carriers should stretch their backs and
move stably to avoid being strained.
l When moving or lifting a chassis, hold the handles or bottom of the chassis. Do not hold
the handles of the modules installed in the chassis, such as the power modules, fan modules,
and boards.

1.9 Other Precautions


This topic describes safety precautions for removing and inserting boards, binding signal cables,
and routing cables.

Removing and Inserting a Board

NOTICE
When inserting a board, wear an ESD wrist strap or ESD gloves, and handle the board gently to
avoid distorting pins on the backplane.

l Slide the board along the guide rails.


l Do not contact one board with another to avoid short-circuits or damage.
l When holding a board in hand, do not touch the board circuits, components, connectors,
or connection slots of the board to prevent damage caused by ESD of the human body to
the electrostatic-sensitive components.

Binding Signal Cables

NOTICE
Bind the signal cables separately from the high-current or high-voltage cables.

Routing Cables
In the case of extremely low temperature, heavy shock or vibration may damage the plastic skin
of the cables. To ensure the construction safety, comply with the following requirements:

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 17


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 1 Safety Precautions

l When installing cables, ensure that the environment temperature is above 0C.
l If the cables are stored in a place where the ambient temperature is below 0C, transfer
them to a place at room temperature and store the cables for more than 24 hours before
installation.
l Handle the cables gently, especially in a low-temperature environment. Do not perform
any improper operations, for example, pushing the cables down directly from a truck.

High Temperature

CAUTION
If the ambient temperature exceeds 55C, the temperature of the front panel surface marked the

flag may exceed 70C. When touching the front panel of the board in such an environment,
you must wear the protection gloves.

IF Cables

CAUTION
Before installing or removing an IF cable, you must turn off the power switch of the IF board.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 18


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 2 Notices for High-Risk Operations

2 Notices for High-Risk Operations

About This Chapter

This topic provides notices for the operations that may cause bodily injury or equipment damage
if they are not performed properly during the commissioning and maintenance of microwave
equipment.

2.1 Operation Guide for the Toggle Lever Switch


The ODU-PWR switch on the IF board is a toggle lever switch which must be turned on and off
as per the following instructions to avoid damaging the IF board.

2.2 Operation Guide for the IF Jumper


Before installing or removing IF jumpers, shut down the ODU power supply to prevent personal
injuries and damaged to the IF boards or ODU.

2.3 Operation Guide for the IF Cables


Before installing or removing IF cables, shut down the ODU power supply to prevent personal
injuries and damaged to the IF boards or ODU.

2.4 Operation Guide for the IF Board


Before removing or installing an IF board, turn off the ODU-PWR switch to avoid bodily injury
or damage to the IF board and ODU.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 19


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 2 Notices for High-Risk Operations

2.1 Operation Guide for the Toggle Lever Switch


The ODU-PWR switch on the IF board is a toggle lever switch which must be turned on and off
as per the following instructions to avoid damaging the IF board.

Position and Description of the Toggle Lever Switch


The toggle lever switch is located on the IF board and controls the power that is fed to the ODU,
as shown in Figure 2-1.

Figure 2-1 Toggle lever switch

Turning On the Toggle Lever Switch


1. Gently pull on the toggle lever switch out.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 20


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 2 Notices for High-Risk Operations

2. Turn it to the left.

3. Release the toggle lever switch.

Turning Off the Toggle Lever Switch


1. Gently pull on the toggle lever switch.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 21


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 2 Notices for High-Risk Operations

2. Turn it to the right.

3. Release the toggle lever switch.

2.2 Operation Guide for the IF Jumper


Before installing or removing IF jumpers, shut down the ODU power supply to prevent personal
injuries and damaged to the IF boards or ODU.

Procedure
Step 1 Follow instructions in 2.1 Operation Guide for the Toggle Lever Switch to power off the
ODU.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 22


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 2 Notices for High-Risk Operations

DANGER
Ensure that the ODU is completely powered off before removing or installing the IF jumper.

Step 2 Remove or install the IF jumper.

----End

2.3 Operation Guide for the IF Cables


Before installing or removing IF cables, shut down the ODU power supply to prevent personal
injuries and damaged to the IF boards or ODU.

Procedure
Step 1 Follow instructions in 2.1 Operation Guide for the Toggle Lever Switch to power off the
ODU.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 23


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 2 Notices for High-Risk Operations

2
1

DANGER
Ensure that the ODU is completely powered off before removing or installing the IF cable.

Step 2 Install or remove the IF cables.

----End

2.4 Operation Guide for the IF Board


Before removing or installing an IF board, turn off the ODU-PWR switch to avoid bodily injury
or damage to the IF board and ODU.

Procedure
Step 1 Turn off the ODU-PWR switch on the IF board. For details, see 2.1 Operation Guide for the
Toggle Lever Switch.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 24


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 2 Notices for High-Risk Operations

1 2 3

DANGER
Ensure that the ODU is completely powered off before removing or installing the IF board.

Step 2 Disconnect the IF jumper or IF cable.

Step 3 Remove or install the IF board.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 25


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 3 Routine Maintenance

3 Routine Maintenance

Routine maintenance operations are performed to detect and rectify hidden faults before the
hidden faults cause damage to equipment and affect services. Routine maintenance operations
are preventive measures.

For the, routine maintenance items are classified into routine maintenance items carried out on
the network management system (NMS), field maintenance items for indoor equipment, and
field maintenance items for outdoor equipment.

Routine Maintenance Items Carried Out on the NMS


Maintenance Item Recommen Remarks
ded
Maintenan
ce Cycle

Checking the NE status Every day l If the NE icon is green, the NE operates
properly.
l If the NE icon is gray, the NE is
unreachable due to DCN faults.
l If the NE icon is in other colors, alarms
are reported or exceptions occur. You
need to troubleshoot in time.

Browsing current alarms Every day l Handle the alarms by referring to A.3
Alarms and Handling Procedures.
l For port alarms due to the interconnected
equipment, see 4.3.3 Browsing Current
Performance Events to reduce the
number of alarms and prevent interference
to emergent alarms.

Browsing historical alarms Every week By finding causes of and solutions to


historical alarms, you can take precautions to
avoid related faults.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 26


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 3 Routine Maintenance

Maintenance Item Recommen Remarks


ded
Maintenan
ce Cycle

Browsing abnormal events Every week l Security events are generally records of
normal operations. Investigate the illegal
operations if there are any.
l Abnormal events about equipment have
been properly solved.

Browsing current Every week l Gauge type performance events such as


performance events the board temperature and laser power are
stable.
Browsing historical Every week
l Bit error type performance events meet
performance events
requirements on link availability.

Browsing historical transmit Every week l Historical received signal levels do not
power and receive power exceed the fade margin for a long time.
l When automatic transmit power control
(ATPC) is disabled, historical transmitted
signal levels are allowed to be 3 dB larger
or smaller than the specified value.

Testing IF 1+1 protection Half a year Applies only to the equipment that is
switching configured in 1+1 protection mode. During
the 1+1 protection switching, the protected
services are interrupted. Hence, it is
recommended that you perform the 1+1
protection switching when the traffic is light.

Testing the IF N+1 protection Half a year Applies only to the equipment that is
switching configured with N+1 protection.

Field Maintenance Items for Indoor Equipment


Maintenance Item Recommen Remarks
ded
Maintenan
ce Cycle

Checking the Every two The site environment meets equipment


telecommunications room months operation requirements.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 27


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 3 Routine Maintenance

Field Maintenance Items for Outdoor Equipment


Maintenance Item Recommended Remarks
Maintenance Cycle

Checking the ODUa Half a year The OptiX RTN 980 is


NOTE fixedly mounted and its
Perform a complete check after appearance is in good
a level-8 or higher-level condition, without the
hurricane, an earthquake, or coating being damaged or
other unexpected
corroded.
circumstances.
Checking the hybrid coupler The hybrid coupler is fixedly
mounted and its appearance
is in good condition, without
the coating being damaged or
corroded.

Checking the antenna The antenna is tightly placed


and does not deviate from the
designed angle.

Checking the IF cable and/or The exterior of the cable is


flexible waveguide intact, and the connectors are
properly waterproofed. The
cable is fixed properly with a
feeder fastener or cable ties,
and the cable bending degree
meets the requirement.

Checking the LOS condition A radio link is not blocked by


any visible object.

NOTE

a:An area close to a pollution source refers to the area that covers a radius within any of the following
values:
l 3.7 km away from salty waters (such as an ocean and salty water)
l 3 km away from severe pollution sources (such as iron refinery works, and coal mines)
l 2 km away from intermediate pollution sources (such as chemical plants, rubber processing works, and
electroplating workshops)
l 1 km away from light pollution sources (such as food processing works, leather working plants, and
heating boilers).

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 28


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

4 Network Monitoring

About This Chapter

4.1 Checking the NE Status


You can learn about the basic information such as whether the NE fails to communicate with
the NMS and whether any alarms are reported by checking the NE status.

4.2 Checking the Board Status


You can learn about the board status in a visual manner by checking the slot diagram.

4.3 Alarm and Performance Data Query


This section describes how to query alarms and non RMON-based performance data, such as
SDH performance data and microwave link performance data. You can query real-time and
historical performance data, which are monitored based on a 15minute or 24hour monitoring
period.

4.4 Microwave Link Performance Query


This section describes operations related to microwave link performance query.

4.5 Ethernet Performance Query


This section describes operations related to Ethernet performance query.

4.6 Ethernet Port Traffic Monitoring


This section describes operations related to Ethernet traffic monitoring on Ethernet ports and
microwave ports.

4.7 Long-term Network Performance Monitoring


The U2000 centrally monitors long-term performance of various Huawei devices through the
Performance Management System (PMS).

4.8 Report Query


This section describes operations related to report query. You can obtain network information
from reports.

4.9 Alarm and Performance Management Setting


This section describes operations related to alarm and performance management.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 29


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

4.1 Checking the NE Status


You can learn about the basic information such as whether the NE fails to communicate with
the NMS and whether any alarms are reported by checking the NE status.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Precautions
NOTE

By default, the color of the NE icon on the U2000 indicates the NE status.

Procedure
Step 1 Query NE running status.

Select the View NE running


desired NE. status.

1 4

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 30


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

NOTE

You can also determine NE running status by referring to information on the Legend tab.

NOTE

Complete the following steps to check NE running status from the WebLCT:
1. Query Communication status and Login status of the NE in NE List.
2. If Login status is Offline, log in to the NE.
3. Select the NE and click Log in.
4. Set User Name and Password.

NOTE

The default user name is lct.


The lct account owns system-level rights.
The default password of the lct account is password.
5. View NE status and alarm status.

----End

4.2 Checking the Board Status


You can learn about the board status in a visual manner by checking the slot diagram.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 31


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Query board running status.

3
Determine the board
running status by referring
Right-click to legend information.
the desired
NE.
4

NOTE

Complete the following step to query board running status from the WebLCT:
Click the Slot Layout tab in NE Explorer.

----End

4.3 Alarm and Performance Data Query


This section describes how to query alarms and non RMON-based performance data, such as
SDH performance data and microwave link performance data. You can query real-time and
historical performance data, which are monitored based on a 15minute or 24hour monitoring
period.

4.3.1 Browsing Current Alarms


You can find the faults that occur on the equipment by browsing current alarms.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 32


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

Procedure
Step 1 Open the current alarm window.

1
2

Step 2 Specify filter conditions.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 33


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

Configure the severity, type, and


maintenance status parameters of the
3 alarms to be queried.

Set the occurring time and clearing time


of the alarms to be queried.
4

Click the Alarm Source tab and


specify filter conditions.
5

6
Select the desired
8 NEs.

Configure the filter


type. For example,
you can filter alarms
by NE.
7

10

11

Step 3 View alarm information.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 34


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

Select an alarm and view its details


and possible causes in the following
panes.
12

Alarm details: contain information


about the board and optical port that Alarm handling: contains possible
report the alarm as well as alarm causes for the alarm and reference
parameters. links to alarm handling suggestions

Step 4 Contact troubleshooting personnel in a timely manner for alarm handling.


For details about alarm handling, see A.3 Alarms and Handling Procedures.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 35


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

NOTE

Complete the following steps to browse current alarms from the WebLCT:

Select the NE from the NE Explorer and click in the tool bar.
The Browse Current Alarms tab page is displayed by default.

----End

Related Information
A current alarm refers to an alarm that is not cleared.

By U2000, you can browse the network-wide alarms based on the alarm severity by clicking the
alarm indicators in the upper right corner.

l You can click (red) to browse the network-wide critical alarms.

l You can click (orange) to browse the network-wide major alarms.

l You can click (yellow) to browse the network-wide minor alarms.

l You can click (light-blue) to browse the network-wide warning alarms.


NOTE

By default, the number shown by each indicator indicates the number of current network-wide alarms, which
are not cleared, of the specific severity.

By Web LCT, you can also click an alarm indicator on the toolbar to display the NE alarms of
the specific severity.

From left to right, the alarm indicators and corresponding alarm severities are as follows:
l Red: critical alarm

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 36


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

l Orange: major alarm


l Yellow: minor alarm
l Purple: warning
l Light blue: event

4.3.2 Browsing Historical Alarms


You can know the faults that occur on the equipment in a past period of time by browsing
historical alarms. A historical alarm refers to an alarm that is already cleared.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE monitor authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000
NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the similar to those on the U2000.

Procedure
Step 1 Open the historical alarm window.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 37


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

Step 2 Specify filter conditions.

Configure the severity, type, and maintenance


3 status parameters of the alarms to be queried.

Set the occurring time and clearing time


of the alarms to be queried.
4

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 38


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

Click the Alarm Source tab and


specify filter conditions.
5

6
Select the desired
8 NEs.

Configure the filter


type. For example,
you can filter alarms
by NE.
7

10

11

Step 3 View alarm information.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 39


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

12

Select an alarm and view its details


and possible causes in the following
panes.

Alarm details: contain information about Alarm handling: contains possible


the board and optical port that report the causes for the alarm and reference
alarm as well as alarm parameters. links to alarm handling suggestions

NOTE

Complete the following steps to browse current alarms from the WebLCT:

Select the NE from the NE Explorer and click in the tool bar.
Click the Browse Historical alarms tab.

----End

4.3.3 Browsing Current Performance Events


You can know the running status of the equipment by browsing current SDH/PDH performance
events. The counter of current performance events measures all the performance events that arise
between the start time of the monitoring period and the current time.

Prerequisites
l The performance monitoring function must be enabled. For details about how to enable the
performance monitoring function, see Configuring the Performance Monitoring Status of
NEs.
l You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 40


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the similar to those on the U2000.

Procedure
Step 1 Open the performance data window.

Step 2 View current performance data.

Select performance event types and


4 specify the performance monitoring
6 period.
5

3
Configure the query type.
Select the desired For example, Measure is
NEs. selected here.

(Optional) Output the


performance data.

7 8

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 41


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

NOTE

Complete the following steps to query current performance data from the WebLCT:
Select the desired board in the NE Explorer and choose Performance > Current Performance from the
Function Tree.

----End

4.3.4 Browsing Historical Performance Events


You can know the faults that occur on the equipment in a past period of time by browsing
historical performance events.

Prerequisites
l The performance monitoring function must be enabled. For details about how to enable the
performance monitoring function, see Configuring the Performance Monitoring Status of
NEs.
l You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Open the performance data window.

2
3

Step 2 View historical performance data.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 42


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

Select performance event types and


5 specify the performance monitoring
7 period.

6
4

Select the desired Configure the


NEs. query type. For
example, Count is
selected here.

NOTE

Complete the following steps to query historical performance data from the WebLCT:
Select the desired board in the NE Explorer and choose Performance > Historical Performance from the
Function Tree.

----End

4.3.5 Browsing the Performance Event Threshold-Crossing Records


You can learn about the threshold-crossing information of the performance events of an NE by
browsing the performance event threshold-crossing records.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the similar to those on the U2000.

Procedure
Step 1 Open the Performance Threshold-Crossing Record window.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 43


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

2
3

Step 2 Query performance threshold-crossing records.

Select performance event types


5
and specify the performance
6 monitoring period.

Select the desired


NEs.

NOTE

Complete the following steps to query performance threshold-crossing records from the WebLCT:
Select a desired board in the NE explorer and choose Performance > Threshold-Crossing Record from the
Function Tree.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 44


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

4.3.6 Browsing UAT Events


Learn about the severe abnormalities on the transmission line by browsing UAT events.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Instruments, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the same as those on the U2000.

Context
UAT refers to a period of 10 consecutive seconds during which the bit error ratio per second of
the digital signal in either of the transmission directions of a transmission system is inferior to
10-3. These 10 seconds are considered to be part of the unavailable time.

Procedure
Step 1 Open the UAT window
1

2
3

Step 2 Query UAT events.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 45


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

5
Specify the time period, data source
6 and functional block type.

Select the
desired board.

----End

4.4 Microwave Link Performance Query


This section describes operations related to microwave link performance query.

4.4.1 Querying the Historical Transmit Power and Receive Power


If the radio link requires troubleshooting, query the change trend for the historical transmit power
and receive power for reference.

Prerequisites
l You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.
l The corresponding IF boards and the ODUs connected to the IF boards must be added to
the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the same as those on the U2000.

Procedure
Step 1 Query historical receive power or transmit power information.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 46


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

Set the time range, monitoring period, and


3 power parameters.
In the NE Explorer,
select the desired
ODU. 4

Click Draw.
The power curve is
1 displayed.

----End

4.4.2 Querying the SNR Values of a Radio Link


This section describes how to query the signal-to-noise ratio (SNR) change curve of a radio link,
assisting in handling radio link faults.

Prerequisites
l You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.
l The IF boards and the ODUs to which the IF boards are connected have been added in the
NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the same as those on the U2000.

Procedure
Step 1 Query how the SNR or Root-mean-square (RMS) error changes on microwave links.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 47


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

Set the time range, monitoring period, and


1 3 performance type (SNR or MSE).
In the NE Explorer,
select the desired IF
board. 4

Click Draw.
The SNR or MSE curve is
displayed.

----End

4.4.3 Browsing Current Performance Events of the radio link


You can learn about the current operating status of a radio link by browsing its current
performance data.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE monitor authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the similar to those on the U2000.

Procedure
Step 1 Right-click a microwave link in the main topology and choose Microwave Link Performance
Statistics.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 48


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

1
Right-click the desired
microwave link.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 49


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

NOTE

Uncheck Auto Refresh. Click Save as to save current performance of the microwave link into a TXT file.
Complete the following steps to query current performance of the microwave link from the WebLCT:
Select the desired microwave link in the NE Explorer and choose Configuration > Microwave Link
Performance from the Function Tree.

----End

4.4.4 Browsing Historical Performance Data of a Radio Link


You can learn about the operating status of a radio link by browsing its historical performance
data over a specific period.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE monitor authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000
NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the similar to those on the U2000.

Procedure
Step 1 Query historical performance of the microwave link.

1
Right-click the desired
microwave link.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 50


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

Specify the query period and


monitoring period of the the
3 4 desired performance data.

6 (Optional) Specify the data type to be


displayed. By default, link transmit power and
receive power are displayed. (Optional) Move the cursor
over the desired node to
check link information at a
specific time.
8

NOTE

Complete the following steps to query historical performance of the microwave link from the WebLCT:
Select the desired microwave link in the NE Explorer and choose Configuration > Microwave Link
Performance from the Function Tree.

----End

4.5 Ethernet Performance Query


This section describes operations related to Ethernet performance query.

Context
NOTE

You can query real-time performance data and recent performance data.
Ethernet performance is monitored through RMON. Available performance monitoring periods include 30s, 30
minutes, custom period 1 (15 minutes by default), and custom period 2 (24 hours by default).

4.5.1 Browsing Current Ethernet Performance


After setting the RMON statistics group. you can browse real-time Ethernet performance
statistics.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 51


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

Prerequisites
l You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.
l The corresponding board must be added in the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the similar to those on the U2000.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, navigate to the performance query interfaces for different objects according
to the following tables.

Table 4-1 Packet plane

Performa Browsed Navigation Path


nce Object
Object

Basic Ethernet Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE
performan porta Explorer. Choose Performance > RMON Performance from the
ce Function Tree.
NOTE
Extended a: Packet Ethernet ports include FE/GE ports, Integrated IP radio ports,
performan PORT8 on the EMS6 board, and PORT10 on the EFP8 board.
ce

MPLS MPLS 1. In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object
tunnel Tunnel Tree and choose Configuration > MPLS Management >
performan Unicast Tunnel Management from the Function Tree.
ce 2. Click the Static Tunnel tab.
3. Select one or more tunnels, right-click the tunnel(s), and
choose Browse Performance from the shortcut menu.

L2 VPN- ETH 1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
PW PWE3 Configuration > Ethernet Service Management > E-Line
performan service Service from the Function Tree.
ce 2. Select one or more ETH PWE3 services, right-click the service
(s), and choose Browse Performance from the shortcut menu.

L2 VPN UNI-UNI 1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
performan E-Line Configuration > Ethernet Service Management > E-Line
ce service Service from the Function Tree.
2. Select one or more UNI-UNI E-Line services, right-click the
service(s), and choose Browse Performance from the shortcut
menu.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 52


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

Performa Browsed Navigation Path


nce Object
Object

CES-PW CES 1. In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and
performan service choose Configuration > CES Service Management from the
ce Function Tree.
CES 2. Select one or more CES services, right-click the service(s), and
performan choose Browse Performance from the shortcut menu.
ce

ATM/IMA Smart E1 Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE
(access port Explorer. Choose Performance > RMON Performance from the
side) Function Tree.
performan
ce

ATM-PW ATM 1. In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and
performan PWE3 choose Configuration > ATM Service Management from
ce service the Function Tree.
ATM 2. Select one or more ATM PWE3 services, right-click the
PWE3 service(s), and choose Browse Performance from the shortcut
performan menu.
ce

Port traffic Ports that 1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
classificati perform Configuration > QoS Management > Policy Management
on complex > Port Policy from the Function Tree.
performan traffic 2. Click the Application Object tab.
ce classificati
on 3. Select one or multiple ports, right-click and choose Browse
Performance from the shortcut menu.
NOTE
Complete the operation Creating Traffic before monitoring the port traffic
classification performance.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 53


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

Performa Browsed Navigation Path


nce Object
Object

Port Egress For FE/GE ports:


priority queues 1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
performan Configuration > Interface Management > Ethernet
ce Interface from the Function Tree.
2. Click the Basic Attributes tab.
3. Select one or multiple ports, right-click and choose Browse
Performance from the shortcut menu.
4. Select the desired egress queue in the Object drop-down list.
For Integrated IP radio ports:
1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
Configuration > Interface Management > Microwave
Interface from the Function Tree.
2. Click the Basic Attributes tab.
3. Select one or multiple ports, right-click and choose Browse
Performance from the shortcut menu.
4. Select the desired egress queue in the Object drop-down list.

Port DS Ports in a 1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
domain DS Configuration > QoS Management > Diffserv Domain
performan domain Management > Diffserv Domain Management from the
ce Function Tree.
2. Select the desired DS domain.
3. Click the Application Object tab.
4. Select one or multiple ports, right-click and choose Browse
Performance from the shortcut menu.

Table 4-2 EoS/EoPDH plane

Performa Obrowse Navigation Path


nce Object
Object

Basic Ethernet In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8 or EMS6 board from the
performan portb Object Tree and choose Performance > RMON Performance
ce from the Function Tree.
NOTE
Extended b:
performan EoPDH Ethernet ports include PORT1 to PORT9 on the EFP8 board.
ce
EoS Ethernet ports include PORT1 to PORT7 on the EMS6 board.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 54


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

Performa Obrowse Navigation Path


nce Object
Object

VCG-other VCTRUN
performan K port
ce

NOTE

If you browse current Ethernet performance using the Web LCT: Select the corresponding board from the Object
Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Performance > RMON Performance from the Function Tree.

Step 2 Click the Statistics Group tab.

Step 3 Set the required parameters for the statistics group.


1. Select the desired object or port from the drop-down list.
2. Select the performance items for which statistics need to be collected.
3. Set Sampling Period.
Sampling Period represents the time unit of the performance statistics.

Step 4 Click Resetting begins.


NOTE

If you click Start, the register of the statistics group is not reset to clear the existing data.

----End

4.5.2 Configuring Ethernet Performance Threshold-Crossing


Parameters
After setting the RMON alarm group. you can monitor whether the Ethernet performance value
crosses its threshold for a long time.

Prerequisites
l You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.
l The corresponding boards must be added in the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the similar to those on the U2000.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, navigate to the performance query interfaces for different objects according
to the following tables.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 55


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

Table 4-3 Packet plane

Performa Browsed Navigation Path


nce Object
Object

Basic Ethernet Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE
performan porta Explorer. Choose Performance > RMON Performance from the
ce Function Tree.
NOTE
Extended a: Packet Ethernet ports include FE/GE ports, Integrated IP radio ports,
performan PORT8 on the EMS6 board, and PORT10 on the EFP8 board.
ce

MPLS MPLS 1. In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object
tunnel Tunnel Tree and choose Configuration > MPLS Management >
performan Unicast Tunnel Management from the Function Tree.
ce 2. Click the Static Tunnel tab.
3. Select one or more tunnels, right-click the tunnel(s), and
choose Browse Performance from the shortcut menu.

L2 VPN- ETH 1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
PW PWE3 Configuration > Ethernet Service Management > E-Line
performan service Service from the Function Tree.
ce 2. Select one or more ETH PWE3 services, right-click the service
(s), and choose Browse Performance from the shortcut menu.

L2 VPN UNI-UNI 1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
performan E-Line Configuration > Ethernet Service Management > E-Line
ce service Service from the Function Tree.
2. Select one or more UNI-UNI E-Line services, right-click the
service(s), and choose Browse Performance from the shortcut
menu.

CES-PW CES 1. In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and
performan service choose Configuration > CES Service Management from the
ce Function Tree.
CES 2. Select one or more CES services, right-click the service(s), and
performan choose Browse Performance from the shortcut menu.
ce

ATM/IMA Smart E1 Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE
(access port Explorer. Choose Performance > RMON Performance from the
side) Function Tree.
performan
ce

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 56


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

Performa Browsed Navigation Path


nce Object
Object

ATM-PW ATM 1. In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and
performan PWE3 choose Configuration > ATM Service Management from
ce service the Function Tree.
ATM 2. Select one or more ATM PWE3 services, right-click the
PWE3 service(s), and choose Browse Performance from the shortcut
performan menu.
ce

Port traffic Ports that 1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
classificati perform Configuration > QoS Management > Policy Management
on complex > Port Policy from the Function Tree.
performan traffic 2. Click the Application Object tab.
ce classificati
on 3. Select one or multiple ports, right-click and choose Browse
Performance from the shortcut menu.
NOTE
Complete the operation Creating Traffic before monitoring the port traffic
classification performance.

Port Egress For FE/GE ports:


priority queues 1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
performan Configuration > Interface Management > Ethernet
ce Interface from the Function Tree.
2. Click the Basic Attributes tab.
3. Select one or multiple ports, right-click and choose Browse
Performance from the shortcut menu.
4. Select the desired egress queue in the Object drop-down list.
For Integrated IP radio ports:
1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
Configuration > Interface Management > Microwave
Interface from the Function Tree.
2. Click the Basic Attributes tab.
3. Select one or multiple ports, right-click and choose Browse
Performance from the shortcut menu.
4. Select the desired egress queue in the Object drop-down list.

Port DS Ports in a 1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
domain DS Configuration > QoS Management > Diffserv Domain
performan domain Management > Diffserv Domain Management from the
ce Function Tree.
2. Select the desired DS domain.
3. Click the Application Object tab.
4. Select one or multiple ports, right-click and choose Browse
Performance from the shortcut menu.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 57


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

Table 4-4 EoS/EoPDH plane

Performa Obrowse Navigation Path


nce Object
Object

Basic Ethernet In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8 or EMS6 board from the
performan portb Object Tree and choose Performance > RMON Performance
ce from the Function Tree.
NOTE
Extended b:
performan EoPDH Ethernet ports include PORT1 to PORT9 on the EFP8 board.
ce
EoS Ethernet ports include PORT1 to PORT7 on the EMS6 board.
VCG-other VCTRUN
performan K port
ce

NOTE

If you browse current Ethernet performance using the Web LCT: Select the corresponding board from the Object
Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Performance > RMON Performance from the Function Tree.

Step 2 Click the Event tab and set the corresponding parameters.

Step 3 Click Apply. Close the displayed dialog box.

----End

4.5.3 Setting Parameters for Monitoring Historical Ethernet


Performance
After configuring a historical control group, you can specify how the historical Ethernet
performance data is monitored.

Prerequisites
l You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.
l The corresponding boards must be added in the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the same as those on the U2000.
NOTE
To set parameters for monitoring historical Ethernet performance of multiple NEs on the U2000, choose
Performance > RMON History Control Group Management from the main menu.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 58


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Performance > RMON History
Control Group.

Step 2 Set the parameters of the historical control group.

Step 3 Click Apply. Close the displayed dialog box.

----End

4.5.4 Browsing Historical Ethernet Performance Data


After configuring an history group, you can browse the historical performance statistics.

Prerequisites
l You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.
l The corresponding boards must be added in the NE Panel.
l The objects and performance events to be monitored must be set.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the similar to those on the U2000.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, navigate to the performance query interfaces for different objects according
to the following tables.

Table 4-5 Packet plane

Performa Browsed Navigation Path


nce Object
Object

Basic Ethernet Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE
performan porta Explorer. Choose Performance > RMON Performance from the
ce Function Tree.
NOTE
Extended a: Packet Ethernet ports include FE/GE ports, Integrated IP radio ports,
performan PORT8 on the EMS6 board, and PORT10 on the EFP8 board.
ce

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 59


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

Performa Browsed Navigation Path


nce Object
Object

MPLS MPLS 1. In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object
tunnel Tunnel Tree and choose Configuration > MPLS Management >
performan Unicast Tunnel Management from the Function Tree.
ce 2. Click the Static Tunnel tab.
3. Select one or more tunnels, right-click the tunnel(s), and
choose Browse Performance from the shortcut menu.

L2 VPN- ETH 1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
PW PWE3 Configuration > Ethernet Service Management > E-Line
performan service Service from the Function Tree.
ce 2. Select one or more ETH PWE3 services, right-click the service
(s), and choose Browse Performance from the shortcut menu.

L2 VPN UNI-UNI 1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
performan E-Line Configuration > Ethernet Service Management > E-Line
ce service Service from the Function Tree.
2. Select one or more UNI-UNI E-Line services, right-click the
service(s), and choose Browse Performance from the shortcut
menu.

CES-PW CES 1. In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and
performan service choose Configuration > CES Service Management from the
ce Function Tree.
CES 2. Select one or more CES services, right-click the service(s), and
performan choose Browse Performance from the shortcut menu.
ce

ATM/IMA Smart E1 Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE
(access port Explorer. Choose Performance > RMON Performance from the
side) Function Tree.
performan
ce

ATM-PW ATM 1. In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and
performan PWE3 choose Configuration > ATM Service Management from
ce service the Function Tree.
ATM 2. Select one or more ATM PWE3 services, right-click the
PWE3 service(s), and choose Browse Performance from the shortcut
performan menu.
ce

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 60


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

Performa Browsed Navigation Path


nce Object
Object

Port traffic Ports that 1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
classificati perform Configuration > QoS Management > Policy Management
on complex > Port Policy from the Function Tree.
performan traffic 2. Click the Application Object tab.
ce classificati
on 3. Select one or multiple ports, right-click and choose Browse
Performance from the shortcut menu.
NOTE
Complete the operation Creating Traffic before monitoring the port traffic
classification performance.

Port Egress For FE/GE ports:


priority queues 1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
performan Configuration > Interface Management > Ethernet
ce Interface from the Function Tree.
2. Click the Basic Attributes tab.
3. Select one or multiple ports, right-click and choose Browse
Performance from the shortcut menu.
4. Select the desired egress queue in the Object drop-down list.
For Integrated IP radio ports:
1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
Configuration > Interface Management > Microwave
Interface from the Function Tree.
2. Click the Basic Attributes tab.
3. Select one or multiple ports, right-click and choose Browse
Performance from the shortcut menu.
4. Select the desired egress queue in the Object drop-down list.

Port DS Ports in a 1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
domain DS Configuration > QoS Management > Diffserv Domain
performan domain Management > Diffserv Domain Management from the
ce Function Tree.
2. Select the desired DS domain.
3. Click the Application Object tab.
4. Select one or multiple ports, right-click and choose Browse
Performance from the shortcut menu.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 61


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

Table 4-6 EoS/EoPDH plane

Performa Obrowse Navigation Path


nce Object
Object

Basic Ethernet In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8 or EMS6 board from the
performan portb Object Tree and choose Performance > RMON Performance
ce from the Function Tree.
NOTE
Extended b:
performan EoPDH Ethernet ports include PORT1 to PORT9 on the EFP8 board.
ce
EoS Ethernet ports include PORT1 to PORT7 on the EMS6 board.
VCG-other VCTRUN
performan K port
ce

NOTE

If you browse current Ethernet performance using the Web LCT: Select the corresponding board from the Object
Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Performance > RMON Performance from the Function Tree.

Step 2 Click the History Group tab.

Step 3 Set the parameters of the historical group.


1. Select the desired object or port from the drop-down list.
2. Click and specify the required time span.
3. Select the performance items to browse.
4. Under History Table Type, set the time span for the performance items to be browsed.

Step 4 Click Query.

----End

4.6 Ethernet Port Traffic Monitoring


This section describes operations related to Ethernet traffic monitoring on Ethernet ports and
microwave ports.

4.6.1 Setting Traffic, Physical Bandwidth, or Bandwidth Utilization


of Ethernet Ports
To query the traffic, physical bandwidth, or bandwidth utilization of Ethernet ports within a
certain period, you need to enable the monitoring for the object before that period starts. The
FE/GE ports and the ports on the packet plane support this operation.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 62


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

The flow monitoring function is enabled on the Ethernet port. To enable the flow monitoring
function on a port, see 4.6.1 Setting Traffic, Physical Bandwidth, or Bandwidth Utilization
of Ethernet Ports.

Tools, Instruments, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the similar to those on the U2000.

Background Information
After the flow monitoring function is enabled, the system saves the statistics about the received
traffic and transmitted traffic with an interval of 15 minutes. In normal cases, the system stores
the statistics that are collected in the last 30 days. In the system, every measurement entry shows
the average transmit rate and average receive rate within a period of 15 minutes. You can query
the statistics in the last 30 days.

Procedure
Step 1 Set Ethernet performance monitoring parameters.
1

Select the board where


the desired Ethernet
port resides. 3 Configure whether to flow
monitoring, physical bandwidth
monitoring, and bandwidth
utilization monitoring.

----End

4.6.2 Querying Traffic, Physical Bandwidth, or Bandwidth


Utilization
This section describes how to query the change curve of the traffic, physical bandwidth, or
bandwidth utilization within a certain period. The FE/GE ports and the ports on the packet plane
support this operation.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 63


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

The flow monitoring function is enabled on the Ethernet port. To enable the flow monitoring
function on a port, see 4.6.1 Setting Traffic, Physical Bandwidth, or Bandwidth Utilization
of Ethernet Ports.

Tools, Instruments, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the similar to those on the U2000.

Background Information
After the flow monitoring function is enabled, the system saves the statistics about the received
traffic and transmitted traffic with an interval of 15 minutes. In normal cases, the system stores
the statistics that are collected in the last 30 days. In the system, every measurement entry shows
the average transmit rate and average receive rate within a period of 15 minutes. You can query
the statistics in the last 30 days.

This operation allows only the queries about port-based Ethernet traffic by using U2000. For
how to query tunnel- or PW-based traffic, see 4.5.1 Browsing Current Ethernet
Performance.

Procedure
Step 1 Query traffic, physical bandwidth, and bandwidth utilization.
1

Select the Specify the time period


desired board. 3 and display mode.

4 Specify the data type. Available data


types include the flow data, physical
bandwidth data, and bandwidth usage
data.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 64


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

4.7 Long-term Network Performance Monitoring


The U2000 centrally monitors long-term performance of various Huawei devices through the
Performance Management System (PMS).

4.7.1 Creating a Performance Monitoring Template


This section describes how to create a performance monitoring template. Performance
monitoring templates specify counters used by performance monitoring instances and their
thresholds (if any). When counter values collected exceed the preset thresholds, the system
reports corresponding threshold crossing alerts (TCAs).

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

The Web LCT does not support this operation.

Context
NOTE
You can create data monitoring templates and remote network monitoring (RMON) TCA monitoring
templates. To monitor Ethernet performance counters supporting TCAs, create RMON TCA monitoring
templates. To monitor other counters, create data monitoring templates.

Procedure
Step 1 Create a data monitoring template.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 65


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

2 3

Select the monitoring


resource type.
4

Set the parameters of the


6 data monitoring template.

7
Click Add, and select the
performance monitoring
indicators.

Step 2 Create an RMON TCA monitoring template.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 66


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

2 3

Select the monitoring


resource type.
4

Enter the template name and


set the template type to RMON
6 TAC.

Click Add, and select the


performance monitoring
indicators.

9 Set the monitoring


threshold parameters.

10

----End

4.7.2 Creating a Performance Monitoring Instance


This section describes how to create a performance monitoring instance. A performance
monitoring instance can monitor the performance of multiple objects at the same time. You can
associate a created performance monitoring template and a created performance statistics
collection policy to a performance monitoring instance.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 67


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

The Web LCT does not support this operation.

Procedure
Step 1 Open the Create Monitoring Instance dialog box.

Step 2 Select monitoring resources.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 68


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

Select the desired


NE. Select the desired
4 port.
6

Step 3 Select the monitoring template.

(Optional) Select the desired data (Optional) If there is no desired


monitoring template if it is available. If data monitoring template, create
there is no desired template, go to step one for the instances.
10.
10

11

(Optional) If there is no desired RMON


threshold monitoring template, create one
for the instances.
(Optional) Select the desired RMON
threshold monitoring template if it is
available. If there is no desired template, 12
go to step 12.

13

NOTE

Complete step 9 and step 10 when creating a data monitoring instance.


Complete step 11 and step 12 when creating an RMON TCA monitoring instance.

Step 4 Specify the monitoring time.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 69


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

14

NOTE
Skip this step for the OptiX RTN 980, which does not support the setting of monitoring time.

Step 5 Close the dialog box.

15

NOTE

If a creation success message is displayed, the creation is successful.


If the creation fails, determine the failure cause according to the displayed error information and recreate the
instance.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 70


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

4.7.3 Browsing the Real-Time Data of a Performance Monitoring


Instance
This section describes how to browse the real-time performance data of objects monitored by a
performance monitoring instance.

Prerequisites
l You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.
l There is at least one performance monitoring instance.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

The Web LCT does not support this operation.

Procedure
Step 1 Open the real-time monitoring window.

Right-click the desired


performance monitoring
instance.
1

Step 2 View real-time performance data.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 71


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

(Optional) Set the


performance display
mode. The default value is
(Optional) Set the timeline line chart.
granularity. The default value is 10s. 3 4

----End

4.7.4 Browsing the Historical Data of a Performance Monitoring


Instance
This section describes how to browse the performance data of objects monitored by a
performance monitoring instance in a specific time range.

Prerequisites
l You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.
l There is at least one performance monitoring instance.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

The Web LCT does not support this operation.

Procedure
Step 1 Open the historical performance data window.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 72


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

Right-click the desired


performance monitoring
instance.
1

Step 2 View historical performance data.

----End

4.8 Report Query


This section describes operations related to report query. You can obtain network information
from reports.

4.8.1 Querying the Microwave Link Information Report


You can obtain the current and recent transmit/receive power of microwave links by querying
the microwave link information report.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

The Web LCT does not support this operation.

Procedure
Step 1 Query the microwave link information report.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 73


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

2 3
5

Select the desired


NEs.
4

(Optional) Output the link report.

----End

4.8.2 Querying the Network-wide License Report


By querying the network-wide license report, you can check the license information of each NE.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Instruments, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

The Web LCT does not support this operation.

Procedure
Step 1 Query the license capacity report of NEs.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 74


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

2
3

Select the desired


4 NEs.

(Optional) Output the microwave


capacity report.

Step 2 Query the air-interface license capacity report of the network.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 75


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

(Optional) Output the air-interface


capacity report.

----End

4.8.3 Querying the Microwave Configuration Report


You can output the configuration report into an XLS file.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

The Web LCT does not support this operation.

Procedure
Step 1 Export the microwave configuration report of an RTN NE.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 76


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

Select the types of


configuration data to be
3 exported.

Select the desired NEs. You


can also click the icon in the
red circle to quickly locate
desired NEs.

4 Specify the directory for


saving the report.

----End

4.8.4 Querying the Board Information Report


You can obtain the logic version, and software version of each board by querying the board
information report.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the similar to those on the U2000.

Procedure
Step 1 Open the board information query window.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 77


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

1
2

4
Set Physical
Inventory Type to
Board.
3

Step 2 Specify filter conditions.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 78


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

Specify filter conditions. For


example, you can filter board
information by NE. 6
Select the
7 desired NEs.

Step 3 View query results.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 79


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

(Optional) Output the board


information report.

10

NOTE

Complete the following steps to query the board information report from the WebLCT:
Select the NE from in the NE Explorer and choose Report > Board Information Report from the Function
Tree.
Version information of all boards is displayed in Board Information Report.

----End

4.8.5 Querying the Board Manufacturing Information Report


You can obtain the manufacturing information about each board and the SFP module by querying
the board manufacturing information report.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Query the board manufacturing information report.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 80


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

2 3
5

Select the desired


NEs.
4

(Optional) Output the board


manufacturing information report.

NOTE

Complete the following steps to query the board manufacturing information report from the WebLCT:
Select the NE from in the NE Explorer and choose Report > Board Details Report from the Function Tree.
Manufacturing information of all boards is displayed in Board Details Report.

----End

4.8.6 Querying the ODU Information Report


You can query information about the ODUs on a network by querying the ODU information
report.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Query ODU information.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 81


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

(Optional) Output the ODU


information report.

----End

4.9 Alarm and Performance Management Setting


This section describes operations related to alarm and performance management.

Context
NOTE
The performance management in this section does not cover Ethernet performance

4.9.1 Configuring the Performance Monitoring Status of NEs


By performing this operation task, you can manually enable or disable performance monitoring
for NEs, or set the performance monitoring period.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the same as those on the U2000.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 82


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

Context
NOTE
To perform batch NE configurations on the U2000, choose Performance > Set NE Performance Monitoring
Time from the main menu.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree, and then choose Performance > NE
Performance Monitoring Time from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Configure the performance monitoring parameters of the NEs.
1. Select 15-Minute or 24-Hour.
2. Select Enabled or Disabled in Set 15-Minute Monitoring or Set 24-Hour Monitoring.
3. Set the start time and end time of the performance monitoring of NEs.
NOTE

l Generally, both Set 15-Minute Monitoring and Set 24-Hour Monitoring are enabled.
l You can specify the start time of the performance monitoring function, only after selecting Enabled
in the Set 15-Minute Monitoring or Set 24-Hour Monitoring area.
l You can specify the end time of the performance monitoring function, only after selecting Enabled
and then selecting To in the Set 15-Minute Monitoring or Set 24-Hour Monitoring area.

4. Click Apply. Close the displayed dialog box.

----End

4.9.2 Setting Severity and Auto Reporting Status of Alarms


This section describes how to set the severity and auto reporting status of specific alarms.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Instruments and Materials


U2000

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 83


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the similar to those on the U2000.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the desired object.

Step 2 Choose Alarm > Alarm Severity and Auto Reporting from the Function Tree.

Step 3 Select any items in the column Event and set Severity and Auto Reporting Status for them.

Step 4 Click Apply to save the settings.

Step 5 Close the dialog box that is displayed.


NOTE

The Web LCT does not support this operation.

----End

4.9.3 Suppressing Alarms for Monitored Objects


This section describes how to suppress specific alarms for a specific monitored object.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Instruments and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the similar to those on the U2000.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the desired board.

Step 2 Choose Alarm > Alarm Suppression from the Function Tree.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 84


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

Step 3 Set Monitored Object and click Query.

Step 4 Set Status in Alarm Suppression.

Step 5 Click Apply.

Step 6 Close the dialog box that is displayed.


NOTE

The Web LCT does not support this operation.

----End

4.9.4 Suppressing Alarms for NEs


This section describes how to suppress certain alarms for NEs.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Instruments and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the similar to those on the U2000.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE.

Step 2 Choose Alarm > Alarm Suppression from the Function Tree.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 85


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

Step 3 Set Status in Alarm Suppression.

Step 4 Click Apply.

Step 5 Close the dialog box that is displayed.


NOTE

The Web LCT does not support this operation.

----End

4.9.5 Reversing Alarms for Service Ports


This section describes how to reverse alarms for service ports.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Instruments and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the similar to those on the U2000.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE.

Step 2 Choose Alarm > NE Alarm Attribute from the Function Tree.

Step 3 Set Alarm Reversion to Enable (Manually Restore).

Step 4 Click Apply.

Step 5 Close the dialog box that is displayed.


NOTE

The Web LCT does not support this operation.

Step 6 In the NE Explorer, select the desired board.

Step 7 Choose Alarm > Alarm Reversion from the Function Tree.

Step 8 Set Reversion Status for the required port.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 86


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

Step 9 Click Apply.

Step 10 Close the dialog box that is displayed.


NOTE

The Web LCT does not support this operation.

----End

4.9.6 Setting Trigger Conditions of AIS Insertion


This section describes how to set the trigger conditions of AIS insertion for specific monitored
objects.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Instruments and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the similar to those on the U2000.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the desired board.

Step 2 Choose Alarm > QoS Alarm > AIS Insertion from the Function Tree.

Step 3 Set the trigger conditions of AIS insertion. If you select Enabled under an alarm, the AIS signal
is inserted when this alarm occurs; otherwise, the AIS signal is not inserted when this alarm
occurs.

Step 4 Click Apply.

Step 5 Close the dialog box that is displayed.


NOTE

The Web LCT does not support this operation.

----End

4.9.7 Setting Trigger Conditions of UNEQ Insertion


This section describes how to set the trigger conditions of UNEQ insertion for service ports.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 87


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

Tools, Instruments and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the similar to those on the U2000.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the desired board.

Step 2 Choose Alarm > QoS Alarm > UNEQ Insertion Switch from the Function Tree.

Step 3 Set the trigger conditions of UNEQ insertion. If you select Enabled under an alarm, the UNEQ
signal (all 0s) is inserted when this alarm occurs; otherwise, the UNEQ signal is not inserted
when this alarm occurs.

Step 4 Click Apply.

Step 5 Close the dialog box that is displayed.


NOTE

The Web LCT does not support this operation.

----End

4.9.8 Setting Bit Error Thresholds for Service Ports


This section describes how to set bit error thresholds for service ports.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Instruments and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the similar to those on the U2000.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the desired board.

Step 2 Choose Alarm > QoS Alarm > Bit Error Alarm Threshold from the Function Tree.

Step 3 Set bit error thresholds.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 88


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

Step 4 Click Apply.

Step 5 Close the dialog box that is displayed.


NOTE

The Web LCT does not support this operation.

----End

4.9.9 Setting Monitoring and Auto-Report Status of Performance


Events
This section describes how to set monitoring and auto-report status of specific performance
events for monitored objects.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Instruments and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the similar to those on the U2000.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the desired board.

Step 2 Choose Performance > Performance Monitor Status from the Function Tree.

Step 3 Set the following parameters: Monitor Status, 15-Minute Auto-Report, and 24-Hour Auto-
Report.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 89


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

Step 4 Click Apply.


Step 5 Close the dialog box that is displayed.
NOTE

The Web LCT does not support this operation.

----End

4.9.10 Setting Performance Thresholds


This section describes how to set the thresholds of specific performance events for monitored
objects.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Instruments and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the similar to those on the U2000.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the desired board.
Step 2 Choose Performance > Performance Threshold from the Function Tree.
Step 3 Set Threshold Value.

Step 4 Click Apply.


Step 5 Close the dialog box that is displayed.

----End

4.9.11 Resetting Performance Registers


This section describes how to reset performance registers. After performance registers are reset,
their counts are cleared and they immediately start a new counting period.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 90


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 4 Network Monitoring

Tools, Instruments and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the similar to those on the U2000.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the desired board.

Step 2 Choose Performance > Reset Board Performance Register from the Function Tree.

Step 3 Set Monitored Object and register types.

Step 4 Click Reset.

Step 5 In the Hint dialog box that is displayed, click Yes.

Step 6 Close the dialog box that is displayed.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 91


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

5 Troubleshooting

About This Chapter

This guide describes the general troubleshooting procedure and the methods of rectifying the
common faults.

5.1 General Troubleshooting Procedure


When handling a fault, make a detailed record of the fault phenomena. The customers in China
can contact our 24-hour technical support center at 400-830-2118, and the customers in areas
outside China can contact the local Huawei offices.
5.2 Troubleshooting Service Interruptions
The service interruption fault indicates the service transmission failure due to an equipment fault
or a link fault.
5.3 Troubleshooting the Radio Link
When an NE reports MW_LOF, MW_BER_EXC, MW_BER_SD or MW_FEC_UNCOR due
to failure or performance deterioration of a radio link, there is a radio link fault.
5.4 Troubleshooting Bit Errors in TDM Services
When an NE reports an alarm or a performance event on the IF board, regenerator section (RS),
multiplex section (MS), higher order path (HP), or lower order path (LP), there are bit errors in
services.
5.5 Troubleshooting Pointer Justifications
When an NE reports a large number of justification events about the administrative unit (AU)
pointer or the tributary unit (TU) pointer, there are pointer justification faults.
5.6 Troubleshooting the Interconnection with SDH Equipment
An interconnection fault occurs when the NE fails in transmitting SDH services with other SDH
equipment.
5.7 Troubleshooting the Interconnection with PDH Equipment
An interconnection fault occurs when the NE fails in transmitting PDH services with other PDH
equipment.
5.8 Troubleshooting Native Ethernet Service Faults
An Ethernet service fault may be the Ethernet service interruption or Ethernet service
deterioration.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 92


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

5.9 Troubleshooting Ethernet Service on the EoS/EoPDH Plane


The Ethernet services transmitted on the EoS/EoPDH plane can be transmitted over a TDM
network. The faults of the EoS/EoPDH-plane Ethernet services include service interruption and
service degradation.

5.10 Troubleshooting MPLS Tunnels


This section describes how to troubleshoot MPLS tunnels by using the MPLS OAM function or
MPLS Ping/Traceroute function.

5.11 Troubleshooting CES Services


This section describes how to troubleshoot CES services that are interrupted or degraded.

5.12 Troubleshooting ATM Services


This section describes how to troubleshoot ATM services that are interrupted or degraded.

5.13 Troubleshooting Ethernet Services Carried by PWs


This section describes how to troubleshoot Ethernet services that are carried by PWs and
transmitted in the PSN. These Ethernet services are considered faulty when they are interrupted
or deteriorate.

5.14 Troubleshooting DCN Faults


A data communication network (DCN) fault causes an NE to be unreachable due to failed or
unstable communications between the NE and the NMS.

5.15 Troubleshooting Orderwire Faults


If orderwire calls cannot get through when services are normal, there is an orderwire fault.

5.16 Typical Cases


This section describes typical microwave link troubleshooting cases.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 93


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

5.1 General Troubleshooting Procedure


When handling a fault, make a detailed record of the fault phenomena. The customers in China
can contact our 24-hour technical support center at 400-830-2118, and the customers in areas
outside China can contact the local Huawei offices.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 94


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

General Troubleshooting Procedure

Figure 5-1 General troubleshooting procedure

Start

Record the fault phenomena

2 Yes Other troubleshooting


Caused by external factors?
procedures

3 No
Analyze fault causes and locate
the fault

Is the fault Yes


rectified?

4 No

Report to Huawei

Make a solution together

Attempt to rectify the fault

No
Is the service restored?

Yes

Observe the operation

No Is the fault
rectified?

Yes
Fill in the troubleshooting
report

End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 95


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Table 5-1 General troubleshooting procedure

Comment Description
No.

1 When recording the fault phenomena, make a true and detailed record of the
entire process of the fault. Record the exact time when the fault occurs and
the operations performed before and after the fault occurs. Save the alarms,
performance events, and other important information. You can use the click-
to-collect function on the NMS to collect data.

2 Faults owing to external factors, including the power supply, cables,


environment, and terminal equipment (such as switch devices)

3 Determine the fault type according to preliminary analysis on alarms. Handle


different types of faults as follows:
l 5.2 Troubleshooting Service Interruptions
l 5.3 Troubleshooting the Radio Link
l 5.4 Troubleshooting Bit Errors in TDM Services
l 5.5 Troubleshooting Pointer Justifications
l 5.6 Troubleshooting the Interconnection with SDH Equipment
l 5.7 Troubleshooting the Interconnection with PDH Equipment
l 5.8 Troubleshooting Native Ethernet Service Faults
l 5.9 Troubleshooting Ethernet Service on the EoS/EoPDH Plane
l 5.10 Troubleshooting MPLS Tunnels
l 5.11 Troubleshooting CES Services
l 5.12 Troubleshooting ATM Services
l 5.13 Troubleshooting Ethernet Services Carried by PWs
l 5.14 Troubleshooting DCN Faults
l 5.15 Troubleshooting Orderwire Faults

4 To provide feedbacks or obtain technical support, customers in China can


contact the 24-hour technical support center at 400-830-2118, and the
customers in areas outside China can contact the local Huawei offices.

5.2 Troubleshooting Service Interruptions


The service interruption fault indicates the service transmission failure due to an equipment fault
or a link fault.

Fault Causes
l The operation is improper.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 96


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

The configuration data changes, the loopback is performed, the cable is replaced, or the
board is replaced.
l The transmission NE or link is faulty.
l The interconnection is improper.
If the transmission equipment functions normally and the connection is normal, check
whether the interconnection between the transmission equipment is proper and whether the
switch equipment is faulty.

Fault Locating Methods


1. Check the operations before the service interruption to determine whether the service
interruption results from an incorrect operation.
2. Query alarms on the centralized NMS or the NMS that is used on the site, and then locate
the fault based on the alarm analysis.
If multiple NEs report alarms, analyze the alarms in the following order: equipment alarm,
line alarm, higher order path alarm, and lower order path alarm.
3. If the fault cannot be located through the alarm analysis method, locate the fault by
performing loopback section by section or replacing the corresponding parts.

NOTICE
If the fault cannot be rectified immediately, restore the services quickly by adjusting the service
route or performing a forced switching.

Troubleshooting Procedure
Handle the fault by following the emergency maintenance process.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 97


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Figure 5-2 Description of the general procedure

Start

1 Yes
Is there an incorrect Cancel the operation
operation?

No

2 Service interruoted by Yes Contact related departments


external causes? to handle the problem

No
3

Query NE status and


alarms by using the NMS

4 Yes
NE access successful and Clear the alarm
alaarms cleared?

No
No Is the service
Proceed with the next step
Rectify the fault on site restored?

Yes

No
Is the service restored? Contact Huawei engineers

Yes
5

Check the troubleshooting result

End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 98


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Table 5-2 Description of the main procedure

Comment Description
No.

1 The common incorrect operations are as follows:


l Modifying data configuration
l Performing loopback operations
l Shutting down the laser
l Muting the ODU
l Replacing boards/cables
l Loading the software

2 Faults owing to external factors, including the power supply, cables,


environment, and terminal equipment (such as switch devices)

3 The procedure is as follows:


1. Check the NE status.
2. If the NE is unreachable to the NMS, perform field troubleshooting
according to Figure 5-3. If alarms are reported on the NE, browse the
current alarms.

4 Generally, the following alarms can be cleared on the NMS:


l APS_MANUAL_STOP, APS_FAIL
l ETH_APS_LOST
l BD_NOT_INSTALLED, DBMS_ERROR, NESOFT_MM,
NESF_LOST
l ETH_APS_SWITCH_FAIL, ETH_APS_TYPE_MISMATCH
l HP_TIM, HP_UNEQ
l IMA_GROUP_LE_DOWN, IMA_GROUP_RE_DOWN
l LOOP_ALM
l J0_MM
l LPS_UNI_BI_M
l LP_SLM, LP_TIM, LP_UNEQ
l RADIO_MUTE
l MW_CFG_MISMATCH
l WRG_BD_TYPE
l ETH_CFM_UNEXPERI, ETH_EFM_LOOPBACK

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 99


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Comment Description
No.

5 After the fault is rectified, proceed as follows:


1. Check the alarms, and ensure that the system is running properly.
2. Assign personnel to monitor the operation of the system during the peak
service hour, ensuring that subsequent faults can be handled in time.
3. Fill in the field maintenance operation sheet, record the fault symptoms
and troubleshooting results, and then send them to Huawei. Table 2 shows
the field maintenance operation sheet.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 100


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Figure 5-3 Field troubleshooting sub-procedure

Start

Obvious equipment Yes Repair or replace


damage? the equipment

No
1
Is the PWR indicator No Troubleshoot the
on the PIU on? power input

2 Yes
Browse alarms
locally by using the
LCT

3 Yes
Equipment
Clear the alarm
alarm?

No
4 Yes
Radio link Clear the alarm
alarm?

No
5 High order Yes
Clear the alarm
path alarm?

No
6 Low order Yes
Clear the alarm
path alarm?

No
Faulty inter- 7 Troubleshoot the
connection with Yes
inter-connection
SDH/PDH equipment? faulty

No
8
Yes Troubleshoot the
Packet service packet service fault
fault?
No

Locate the fault by


Proceed to the next No Is the service
performing loopback
operations section by step restored?
section

Yes

End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 101


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Table 5-3 Description of the field troubleshooting sub-procedure

Comment Description
No.

1 The troubleshooting procedure is as follows:


1. Check whether the circuit breaker for the input power is off. If the circuit
breaker is automatically turned off, find the cause (such as short circuits
or insufficient fuse capacity), and rectify the fault accordingly.
2. Check the power cables, especially the connectors of the power cables. If
the power cables or connectors of the power cables are incorrect, replace
the power cables or re-prepare the connectors of the power cables.
3. Check the voltage and polarization of the input power. If the voltage or
polarization of the input power does not meet the requirements, contact
power engineers for troubleshooting.
NOTE
The recommended fuse capacity of 10 A can meet requirements under the maximum
power consumption. The following formula can be used to calculate the fuse capacity:
Fuse capacity = (Total power consumption x 1.5) / (Rated voltage x 87.5%).
The rated voltage of the input power is -48 V/-60 V and the permitted voltage ranges
from -38.4 V to -72.0 V.

2 The troubleshooting procedure is as follows:


1. Logging In to the Web LCT (Through NMS Interface).
2. Creating NEs by Using the Search Method.
3. Logging In to an NE (Web LCT).
4. Checking Alarms.
NOTE
If you fail to log in to the created NE, ensure that the operations you performed are
correct, and then locate and rectify the fault according to the indicators of the system
control, switching, and timing board. For details about the indicators, see the IDU
Hardware Description.

3 Pay special attention to the following alarms:


l HARD_BAD, BD_STATUS, FAN_FAIL
l NESF_LOST
l POWER_ALM, TEMP_ALARM
l RADIO_TSL_HIGH, RADIO_TSL_LOW
l IF_INPWR_ABN, IF_CABLE_OPEN
l VOLT_LOS

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 102


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Comment Description
No.

4 Pay special attention to the following alarms:


l PG_LINK_FAIL, PG_PRT_DEGRADED
l MW_LIM, MW_LOF
l MW_BER_EXC
l RADIO_RSL_HIGH, RADIO_RSL_LOW
l R_LOS, R_LOF, R_LOC
l MS_AIS
l AU_AIS, AU_LOP
l B1_EXC, B2_EXC

5 Pay special attention to the following alarms:


l HP_LOM, HP_UNEQ
l B3_EXC

6 Pay special attention to the following alarms:


l T_ALOS
l E1_LOC
l LP_UNEQ
l TU_AIS, TU_LOP
l BIP_EXC

7 See Troubleshooting the Interconnection with SDH Equipment or


Troubleshooting the Interconnection with PDH Equipment.

8 See Troubleshooting Native Ethernet Service Faults, Troubleshooting


Ethernet Service on the EoS/EoPDH Plane, Troubleshooting CES
Services, Troubleshooting ATM Services, and Troubleshooting Ethernet
Services Carried by PWs.

Experience and Summary


The maintenance personnel need to perform the routine maintenance operations periodically, to
detect and rectify faults before the faults affect the services and therefore to reduce the equipment
fault rate.

5.3 Troubleshooting the Radio Link


When an NE reports MW_LOF, MW_BER_EXC, MW_BER_SD or MW_FEC_UNCOR due
to failure or performance deterioration of a radio link, there is a radio link fault.

Radio Link Faults


Radio link faults are classified into:

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 103


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

l Equipment faults, including outdoor component faults, cable faults, and power supply faults
l Propagation faults, including fading, interference, and poor line of sight (LOS)
l Poor construction quality, including poor antenna/component installation, poor grounding,
and poor waterproofing

Figure 5-4 Radio link faults


Causes of radio
link faults

Propagation Poor construction Equipment


faults quality faults

Antenna Cables
Interference Fading Poor LOS installation

External Rain LOS not Antennas Poor Hardware


interference fading achieved not aligned grounding Faults

Over-reach Multipath Near-field Antennas Poor Power


interference fading blocking loosened or waterproofing faults
offset

Damaged
Reflection cable
components

Fading Phenomena and Causes


During microwave network maintenance, link fading is the main cause for radio link faults. Link
fading is more difficult to locate and handle than hardware faults.

Table 5-4 Fading phenomena and causes

Fading Type Fading Phenomena Fading Cause

Classifie Down The RSL is lower than the RSL l Multi-path fading
d by RSL fading after free space fading. The l Duct-type fading
difference can be tens of
decibels. l Rain fading

Up The RSL is higher than the RSL l Interference


fading in the free space. The difference l Long delay caused by terrain
can be 10-odd decibels. reflection

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 104


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Fading Type Fading Phenomena Fading Cause

Classifie Fast The fading lasts from several l Multi-path fading


d by fading milliseconds to tens of seconds. l Duct-type fading
fading Generally, fast fading is caused
duration l Long delay caused by terrain
by multipath fading. It occurs reflection
periodically. To be specific, fast
fading occurs in the period from
18:00 to 20:00 of a day or in a
certain season of a year.

Slow The fading lasts from tens of l Generally, slow up fading is


fading seconds to several hours. caused by interference.
l Slow down fading is caused
by rain, and therefore is also
called rain fading. Rain
fading occurs on links
working at a frequency of 10
GHz or in areas where heavy
rain occurs.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 105


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Troubleshooting Procedure

Figure 5-5 Procedure for troubleshooting the radio link

Start

1 Yes
Is there an
Undo the operation.
incorrect operation?

No

2 Hardware Yes
alarms exist? Rectify equipment faults.

No

3 Yes
Are there IF or RF
alarms on the link?
4
No Analyze the historical RSL
records and the current
RSL value

Co-channel or adjacent-
5
RSL greater than the Yes channel interference
Troubleshoot the fault as
a non-radio link fault. receiver sensitivity? Long delay caused
by terrain reflection
No
The link is blocked.
6 Is the RSL value Yes
always less than the The antennas are offset.
designed value?
Passive components like
No hybrid couplers or flexible
waveguides are faulty.
7 Yes
Is it raining when the
Rain fading
fault occurs?

No

8 Multipath fading
Does the fault occur Yes
regularly?
Terrain reflection
No
9
Troubleshoot the fault by
replacing the suspected
faulty parts.

Yes
Is the fault rectified? End

No

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 106


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Table 5-5 Description of the procedure for troubleshooting the radio link

Mark Description

1 Check whether any misoperation has been performed:


l Shutting down the power supply, which caused the local or remote NE to be
unreachable to the NMS
l Muting the radio transmitter, which caused the RADIO_MUTE alarm to be
reported
l Looping back IF ports, which caused the LOOP_ALM alarm to be reported
l Configuring incorrect radio link data, which caused the
MW_CFG_MISMATCH alarm to be reported
l Enabling an AM self-check, which caused the MW_AM_TEST alarm
l Enabling IF consecutive wave output

2 Hardware fault alarms include:


l HARD_BAD
l RADIO_TSL_HIGH, RADIO_TSL_LOW

3 IF and RF alarms include:


l MW_LOF, MW_LIM, MW_RDI
l MW_BER_EXC, MW_BER_SD, MW_FEC_UNCOR
l RADIO_RSL_HIGH, RADIO_RSL_LOW
l RADIO_RSL_BEYONDTH
l AM_DOWNSHIFT

4 RSL is the major reference for locating and handling propagation faults. Follow
instructions in 4.4.3 Browsing Current Performance Events of the radio link
and 4.4.4 Browsing Historical Performance Data of a Radio Link to browse and
analyze the historical RSL records and the current RSL value.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 107


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Mark Description

5 l If the receive power fluctuates within a range less than 10 dB, mute the opposite
NE and check the RSL at the local NE.
After the opposite NE is muted, if the RSL value is greater than -90 dBm, there
may be co-channel interference that affects long-term availability and error-
second performance of the system.
1. Follow instructions in 8.1.2 Scanning Interfering Signals or use a
frequency spectrum analyzer to locate the possible interfering frequencies.
2. If a third-party RF device is the interfering source, contact the local frequency
spectrum management department to clear the interference.
If interference is caused due to improper route planning, modify the
frequency plan to minimize the interference impacts.
l If there is an intensively reflective terrain, adjust the mounting height of the
antenna to change the link elevation, therefore minimizing reflection impacts.
Alternatively, replan the route to avoid the intensively reflective terrain.
If receive power changes radically within seconds (fluctuation range varying
from more than 10 dB to dozens of dB) and the change occurs periodically (for
example, always at midnight), there may be a fault caused by terrain reflection.
Check whether there are rivers or lakes on the propagation trail.

6 If the RSL value had been smaller than the designed value for a long time before
the fault occurred, the propagation trail is faulty. Proceed as follows:
l Check whether the antenna connection is loose or the antenna is unaligned. If
yes, re-align the antenna.
l Check whether there are any blocks in the radio transmission trail or in the near
field of the antenna. If yes, adjust the mounting height of the antenna to avoid
blocks, replan the radio link route.
l Check whether loss increases because the antenna, hybrid coupler, and flexible
waveguide are not intact or are wet. If yes, replace the faulty components.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 108


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Mark Description

7 If a radio link fault occurred in poor weather conditions (such as rainy, snowy, or
foggy) and was rectified after the conditions disappeared, the fault cause was
weather fading. For a fault caused by weather fading, check whether the link fading
margin is insufficient.
1. Calculate the actual link availability. Calculate the total link fault time within
one year or half a year. Calculate the actual link availability using the following
formula: <Link availability> = <Total fault time>/<Calculation period>.
l If the actual link availability is lower than the designed value by an order of
magnitude, the link fading margin is insufficient. Re-plan the radio link
parameters.
l If the difference between the actual link availability and the designed value
is small, no special handling operations are required.
2. Before re-planning a radio link, check whether the rain zone parameters, the
refractivity gradient, and the planning algorithm are incorrect. The practicable
measure could be as follows:
l Increase the transmit power or replace the original antenna with a new one
having a larger diameter to increase the system gain and the fading margin.
l Use a frequency band on which rain fading has smaller impacts.

8 If the receive power fluctuates greatly and fast (by more than 10 dB or several 10
dB within several seconds or several 10 seconds), fast fading occurs.
Fast fading may occur due to:
l Multi-path fading: Faults occur periodically, for example, at the day-and-night
alternating time period.
l Duct-type fading: random fast fading
To handle fast fading, proceed as follows:
l Increase the path inclination: That is, adjust the antenna mount heights at both
ends to increase the height differences between the antennas at both ends.
l Reduce surface reflection. For apparent strong reflection surfaces, for example,
large areas of water, flat lands, and bold mountain tops, adjust antennas to move
reflection points out of the strong reflection areas or mask the reflection by using
landforms.
l Reduce the path clearance. With LOS conditions guaranteed, lower antenna
mount heights as much as possible.

9 If all preceding actions cannot rectify the fault, replace the ODU at both ends. Then,
check whether services are functional. If the fault persists, replan the radio link by
changing the operating frequency, using antennas with a larger diameter, changing
the antenna heights, or changing the routes.

Experience and Summary


l During the commissioning, ensure that the antenna is aligned properly, to prevent possible
incipient faults.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 109


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

l Periodically collect and analyze the data about the changes in the transmit power and receive
power so that you can detect and then rectify the incipient faults accordingly in time.

5.4 Troubleshooting Bit Errors in TDM Services


When an NE reports an alarm or a performance event on the IF board, regenerator section (RS),
multiplex section (MS), higher order path (HP), or lower order path (LP), there are bit errors in
services.

Fault Phenomena

Table 5-6 Bit errors

Bit Error Description Related Alarm and Performance Event


Type

IF bit errors Refer to the bit errors that the l MW_BER_EXC, MW_BER_SD
IF board detects through the l IF_BBE, IF_ES, IF_SES, IF_CSES,
self-defined overhead byte in IF_UAS
the microwave frame

RS bit errors Refer to the bit errors that the l B1_EXC, B1_SD
line processing unit or the IF l RS_CROSSTR
board that works in SDH
mode through the B1 l RSBBE, RSES, RSSES, RSCSES,
overhead byte in the RS RSUAS
overhead NOTE
The IF board that works in PDH mode may also
detect the previous RS bit error alarms and
performance events. In this case, the IF board
detects bit error alarms and performance events in
the PDH microwave frame through the self-
defined B1 byte.

MS bit errors Refer to the bit errors that the l B2_EXC, B2_SD
line board detects through the l MS_CROSSTR
B2 byte in the MS overhead
l MSBBE, MSES, MSSES, MSCSES,
MSUAS

HP bit errors Refer to the bit errors that the l B3_EXC, B3_SD
line board detects through the l HP_CROSSTR
B2 byte in the MS overhead
l HPBBE, HPES, HPSES, HPCSES,
HPUAS

LP bit errors Refer to the bit errors that the l BIP_EXC, BIP_SD
tributary board or IF board l LP_CROSSTR
detects through the V5 byte
in the VC-12 overhead l LPBBE, LPES, LPSES, LPCSES,
LPUAS

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 110


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Fault Causes

Table 5-7 Causes of bit errors

Fault Common Fault Cause

There are IF bit errors. l The radio link is faulty.


Check whether the MW_BER_EXC, MW_BER_SD,
MW_FEC_UNCOR, MW_LOF or RPS_INDI alarm is
reported. If yes, the radio link is faulty.
l The services are incorrectly configured.
Check whether the MW_CFG_MISMATCH alarm is reported.
If yes, the number of E1 services is inconsistent on both ends of
the radio link.
l The IF board at the local end or opposite end is faulty.

There are RS bit l The line is faulty.


errors. The common causes for bit errors on the optical line are as
follows: the optical fiber line, the optical power is abnormal,
the fiber performance deteriorates, or the fiber connector is
not clean.
In the case of bit errors on the radio link, check whether the
MW_BER_EXC, MW_BER_SD, MW_FEC_UNCOR or
RPS_INDI alarm is reported. If yes, the radio link is faulty.
l The line processing unit or IF board is faulty.
l The clock unit is faulty.
l The quality of the clock over the network declines.
When the quality of the clock over the network declines, a pointer
justification event occurs.

There are not any RS l The line processing unit or IF board is faulty.
bit errors but there are l The quality of the clock over the network declines.
MS bit errors or HP bit
errors. When the quality of the clock over the network declines, a pointer
justification event occurs.
l The working temperature of the line processing unit or IF board
is excessively high.

There are only LP bit l The tributary board is faulty.


errors. l The cross-connect unit is faulty.
l The working temperature of the board is excessively high.
l The working temperature of the cross-connect unit is excessively
high.
l There is a power surge or an external interference source, or the
equipment is not properly grounded. (This cause does not need
to be considered during the troubleshooting of an IF board.)

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 111


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Fault Locating Methods


1. Analyze the equipment alarms and performance events that are related to service
configuration errors and bit errors.
2. When there are many types of alarms and performance events on a service path, first analyze
RS bit errors, then MS bit errors, HP bit errors, and finally LP bit errors.
3. When multiple paths have bit errors, first check whether the overlapping part of the service
paths is faulty.
4. If you fail to locate the fault by analyzing the alarms and performance events, perform
loopback operations section by section.
5. Replace the parts whose performance may deteriorate with new ones.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 112


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Troubleshooting Procedure

Figure 5-6 Procedure for troubleshooting bit errors

Start

2
1
Is there an Yes
Clear the alarm
equipment alarm?

No
3
Is there a pointer Yes Troubleshoot the pointer
justification event? justification

No SDH optical
interface board Troubleshoot RS bit errors
on the SDH optical interface
board

Is there an If the
RS bit error alarm or a
Yes
alarming
performance board is
event?
4
No IF board Troubleshoot RS bit errors
on the IF board

Is there an
5
MS/ HP alarm or Yes Troubleshoot MS/HP bit
performance errors
event?
No
6
Is there an LP Yes Troubleshoot LP bit
alarm? errors

No
Locate the fault by performing No Is the fault
loopback operations section Proceed with the next step rectified?
by section

Yes

End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 113


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Table 5-8 Description of the procedure for troubleshooting bit errors

Comment Description
No.

1 Pay special attention to the following alarms:


l TEMP_ALARM
l HARD_BAD

2 See 5.5 Troubleshooting Pointer Justifications.

3 The troubleshooting procedure is as follows:


1. Check whether the line board reports the B1_EXC, B1_SD, or
RS_CROSSTR alarm.
2. Interchange the Tx fiber core and the Rx fiber core at both ends of the
service path. If bit errors change after the exchange, it indicates that the
fiber is faulty. Otherwise, the equipment at both ends of the service path
is faulty.
3. In the case of a fiber fault, check whether the fiber between the equipment
and the ODF and the section of the fiber that is led out of the
telecommunications room are pressed. In addition, check whether the fiber
connectors are clean.
4. In the case of faults at both ends of the service path, use a fiber jumper to
loop back the optical ports. If the fault persists after the loopback, the line
board may be faulty.
5. In the case of faults at both ends of the service path, you can also replace
the board where the line unit is located or interchange between the board
and another board of the same type that is working normally. If the alarm
changes after the exchange, it indicates that the board is faulty.

4 The troubleshooting procedure is as follows:


1. Check whether the IF board reports the MW_BER_EXC,
MW_BER_SD, MW_FEC_UNCOR, MW_LOF, RPS_INDI,
B1_EXC, B1_SD, or RS_CROSSTR alarm.
2. If any of the alarms are reported, see 5.3 Troubleshooting the Radio
Link and rectify the fault.

5 The troubleshooting procedure is as follows:


1. Perform a loopback on the line board that reports the alarm.
If the fault persists after the loopback, replace the line board.
If the fault is rectified after the loopback, replace the line board at the
transmit end.
2. If you fail to rectify the fault by replacing the line board, check whether
there is a power surge or an external interference source or whether the
equipment is not properly grounded.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 114


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Comment Description
No.

6 The troubleshooting procedure is as follows:


1. Replace the board where the services are configured based on how the
service paths that have bit errors overlap each other.
2. If you fail to rectify the fault by replacing the board, check whether there
is a power surge or an external interference source or whether the
equipment is not properly grounded.

Experience and Summary


NOTE

The TDM services mentioned refer to Native TDM services.


The handling procedure applies when the STM-1e port is faulty
l During the routine maintenance, check bit error performance events periodically and handle
them in time.
l To locate a fault, prefer the method of analyzing alarms and performance events to the
method of performing loopback operations and the method of replacing the parts.

5.5 Troubleshooting Pointer Justifications


When an NE reports a large number of justification events about the administrative unit (AU)
pointer or the tributary unit (TU) pointer, there are pointer justification faults.

Fault Phenomena
When the position of the first byte of the VC-4 in the AU-4 payload changes, the AU pointer
makes a justification accordingly. The performance events related to the AU pointer justification
are as follows:

l AUPJCHIGH
l AUPJCLOW
l AUPJCNEW
NOTE

The AU pointer justification is made at an upstream NE but is detected and reported at a downstream NE.

When the service is configured to be at the VC-12 level, apply the reframing process to terminate
the AU pointer justification. The terminating method is to transform the AU pointer justification
into the TU pointer justification. The performance events related to the TU pointer justification
are as follows:

l TUPJCHIGH
l TUPJCLOW
l TUPJCNEW

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 115


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

NOTE

The TU pointer justification is made at the NE where the AU pointer is transformed into the TU pointer,
but is detected and reported by the tributary board of the NE where services are terminated.

Fault Causes
l The clock sources or the clock source levels are configured incorrectly. As a result, there
are two clock sources on the same network or a timing loop occurs.
l The fiber connections are incorrect. As a result, a timing loop occurs.
l The quality of the clock source declines, the clock unit is faulty, or there are other clock-
related faults.
l The tributary board is faulty (only for the TU pointer justification).

Fault Locating Methods


When there are both AU pointer justifications and TU pointer justifications on a service path,
first handle the AU pointer justifications and then the TU pointer justifications.

Fault Fault Locating Method

AU pointer justification 1. Analyze and clear clock alarms.


2. Rectify the incorrect data configuration and incorrect fiber
connections.
3. Change the clock configuration to locate the station whose
clock is asynchronous with the entire network.
4. Replace the parts whose performance may deteriorate with
new ones.

TU pointer justification 1. Analyze and clear clock alarms.


2. Rectify the incorrect data configuration and incorrect fiber
connections.
3. Change the clock and service configuration to locate the
station whose clock is asynchronous with the entire
network.
4. Replace the parts whose performance may deteriorate with
new ones.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 116


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Troubleshooting Procedure

Figure 5-7 Procedure for troubleshooting pointer justifications

Start

1 Yes
Is there a clock-related Clear the alarm
alarm?

No
2
Check the clock
configuration

Incorrect Yes Modify the data


configuration? configuration

No
3
Check the fiber
connection

Incorrect fiber Yes


connection? Reconnect the fibers

No
4 5
An AU pointer Yes Locate the NE whose clock
justification event? Locate the faulty board
is out of synchronization

No
6 7
A TU pointer Yes Locate the NE whose clock
justification event? Locate the faulty board
is out of synchronization

No
Proceed with the No
Is the fault rectified?
next step

Yes

End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 117


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Table 5-9 Description of the procedure for troubleshooting pointer justifications

Comment Description
No.

1 Pay special attention to the following alarms:


l TEMP_ALARM
l HARD_BAD
l LTI
l SYNC_C_LOS
l S1_SYN_CHANGE
l EXT_SYNC_LOS

2 Check the following points:


l Check whether there are two clock reference sources on the entire network.
l Check whether a timing loop is generated.

3 Query ECC routes to check whether the fibers are connected correctly. Check
the fiber connections in the east and west directions of the NE that reports the
pointer justification event.

4 The troubleshooting procedure is as follows:


1. Locate a VC-4 channel that reports an AU pointer justification event.
2. Along the service source direction of the VC-4 channel, locate the source
NE of the entire VC-4 service (not the source NE of a timeslot in the VC-4).
3. Set the clock of the source NE to the free-run mode. Set the other NEs to
trace the clock of the source NE along the direction of the VC-4 service.
4. Along the clock tracing direction, locate the line board that is the first to
report the AU pointer justification of the VC-4 path.
The clock of the remote NE to which the line board is connected is
asynchronous with the reference clock. Hence, the line board on the remote
NE that receives the clock signal, the line board that sends the clock signal
to the remote NE, and the clock unit of the remote NE, may be faulty.
5. Set the clock of the sink NE to the free-run mode. Set the other NEs to
trace the clock of the sink NE along the direction of the VC-4 service.
6. Along the clock tracing direction, locate the line board that is the first to
report the AU pointer justification of the VC-4 path.
The clock of the remote NE to which the line board is connected is
asynchronous with the reference clock. Hence, the line board on the NE
that receives the clock signal, the line board that sends the clock signal to
the NE, and the clock unit of the NE, may be faulty.
7. Compare the results and find out the common points.

5 Replace the possibly faulty boards.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 118


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Comment Description
No.

6 The troubleshooting procedure is as follows:


1. Modify the service configuration to ensure that the NE where the clock
reference source functions as the central NE and that the other NEs have
the E1 services of the central NE.
2. Along the clock tracing direction, locate the NE that is the first to report
the TU pointer justification event.
The clock of the NE is asynchronous with the reference clock. Hence, the
line board on the NE that receives the clock signal, the line board that sends
the clock signal to the NE, and the clock unit of the NE, may be faulty.
3. Modify the configuration data to ensure that all the NEs trace the clock
along the other direction.
4. Along the clock tracing direction, locate the NE that is the first to report
the TU pointer justification event.
The clock of the NE is asynchronous with the reference clock. Hence, the
line board on the NE that receives the clock signal, the line board that sends
the clock signal to the NE, and the clock unit of the NE, may be faulty.
5. Compare the results and find out the common points.
NOTE
This method is also applicable to locating an AU pointer justification event.

7 Replace the possibly faulty boards. In the case of a TU pointer justification


event, check whether the line board, the clock board, and the tributary board
are faulty.

Experience and Summary


On a properly synchronized network, there are few pointer justifications (less than six per day
on each port). Hence, monitoring the pointer of an SDH transmission system is an effective way
to check the synchronization status of the system.

5.6 Troubleshooting the Interconnection with SDH


Equipment
An interconnection fault occurs when the NE fails in transmitting SDH services with other SDH
equipment.

Fault Causes
l The VC-12 numbering method of the OptiX equipment is different from the numbering
method of the equipment of certain vendors.
The OptiX equipment applies the timeslot numbering method. The numbering formula is:
VC-12 number = TUG-3 number + (TUG-2 number - 1) x 3 + (TU-12 number - 1) x 21.
This method is also called as the method of numbering by order.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 119


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Certain equipment applies the line numbering method. The numbering formula is: VC-12
number = (TUG-3 number - 1) x 21 + (TUG-2 number - 1) x 3 + TU-12 number. This
method is also called as the interleaved method.
l The overhead bytes at both ends are inconsistent.
l The indexes of the SDH interfaces do not meet the requirements.
NOTE

In the case of interconnection with ATM or Ethernet equipment, the common cause for an interconnection
failure is that the service is not set to the VC-4 pass-through service and thus the overheads are processed
in the terminating mode instead of the pass-through mode.

Fault Locating Methods


Analyze the fault phenomena and alarms that are generated on the equipment. Check the possible
fault causes one after another.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 120


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Troubleshooting Procedure

Figure 5-8 Procedure for troubleshooting the interconnection with SDH equipment

Start

Is the
Set the interconnection
interconnected equipment Yes
service to be the VC-4 pass-
the ATM/IP equipment?
through service

No
Query the VC-12 numbering
method of the interconnected
equipment

Is the Modify the data configuration.


Yes
numbering mode the Use the line numbering
line numbering? method to set the VC-12

No

1 Is there an overhead Yes


setting related alarm? Handle the alarm

No
2

Is the interface the Yes


Check the grounding
STM-1 electrical
interface?

3 No

Test the indexes of interfaces

Do the interfaces meet No Handle the faults of the


relevant standards? interconnected equipment

Yes Go to the next No


step Is the fault cleared?

Handle the faults of the local Yes


equipment

End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 121


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Table 5-10 Description of the procedure for troubleshooting the interconnection with SDH
equipment

Comment Description
No.

1 Pay special attention to the following alarms:


l J0_MM
l HP_TIM
l LP_TIM
l HP_SLM
l LP_SLM

2 Check the following points:


l Check whether all the equipment and the DDF in the equipment room are
jointly grounded.
l Check whether the shielding layer of the coaxial cable connector on the
DDF is connected to the protection ground.
l Check whether the shielding layers of coaxial cables are grounded in the
same way.
NOTE
Disconnect all the signal cables between the interconnecting equipment. Use a
multimeter to measure the level between the shielding layers of the coaxial cables at the
receive and transmit ends of the SDH equipment. In addition, measure the level between
the shielding layers of the coaxial cables at the receive and transmit ends of the opposite
equipment. If the potential difference is large (about 0.5 V), the fault may be caused by
the grounding.

3 Common indexes of the optical interfaces are as follows:


l Mean launched optical power
l Receiver sensitivity
l Overload optical power
l Permitted frequency deviation of the input interface
Common indexes of the electrical interfaces:
l Permitted frequency deviation of the input interface
l Allowed attenuation of the input interface

Experience and Summary


To rectify an interconnection fault, you must be familiar with the characteristics of the interfaces
on the interconnected equipment.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 122


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

5.7 Troubleshooting the Interconnection with PDH


Equipment
An interconnection fault occurs when the NE fails in transmitting PDH services with other PDH
equipment.

Fault Causes
l There is an impedance mismatch between interfaces.
l The equipment is not grounded properly.
l The cable performance deteriorates.
l The indexes of the PDH interfaces do not meet the requirements.

Fault Locating Methods


Analyze the fault phenomena and alarms that are generated on the equipment. Check the possible
fault causes one after another.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 123


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Troubleshooting Procedure

Figure 5-9 Procedure for troubleshooting the interconnection with PDH equipment

Start

1
Check the impedance of
the interfaces.

Is there an Yes Replace the cable or the


impedance mismatch? tributary board

No

2
Is the cable a Yes
Check the grounding.
coaxial cable?

No
3

Check the cables.

No
Is in good conditions? Adjust the cables.

Yes
4
Test the indexes of
Interfaces.

Troubleshoot the faults on


Do the interfaces No
the interconnected
meet standards? Equipment.

Yes
No
Troubleshoot the faults Proceed with the next step. Is the fault rectified?
on the local equipment.

Yes

End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 124


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Table 5-11 Description of the procedure for troubleshooting the interconnection with PDH
equipment

Comment Description
No.

1 Check the impedance of the E1 path. Ensure that the impedance of the E1
path is consistent with the cable type.

2 Check the following points:


l Check whether all the equipment and the DDF in the telecommunications
room are jointly grounded.
l Check whether the shield layers of the coaxial cable connectors on the
DDF are connected to the protection ground.
l Check whether the shield layers of coaxial cables are grounded in the same
manner.
NOTE
Disconnect all the signal cables between the interconnecting equipment sets. Use a
multimeter to measure the level between the shield layers of the coaxial cables at the
receive and transmit ends of the PDH equipment and the level between the shield layers
of the coaxial cables at the receive and transmit ends of the equipment at the opposite
end. If the potential difference is large (about 0.5 V), the fault may be caused due to the
improper grounding.

3 Check the following points:


l Check whether the wires of the cable are correctly connected.
l Check whether the cable is broken or pressed.
l Check whether the cable signal is interfered (for example, when the trunk
cable is bound with the power cable, the cable signal is interfered by the
power signal).
NOTE
Checking the cables involves checking the cables from the DDF to the client side
and checking the cables from the DDF to the transmission equipment side.

4 Check the following indexes:


l Input jitter tolerance
l Permitted frequency deviation of the input interface
l Output jitter
l Output frequency deviation

Experience and Summary


NOTE

The PDH services mentioned refer to Native E1 services.

In the case of interconnection with PDH equipment, improper grounding is the most common
cause for an interconnection failure.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 125


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

5.8 Troubleshooting Native Ethernet Service Faults


An Ethernet service fault may be the Ethernet service interruption or Ethernet service
deterioration.

Fault Phenomena
The Ethernet service interruption indicates that the Ethernet service is interrupted. The Ethernet
service deterioration indicates that the Ethernet service is abnormal. For example, the network
access speed is low, the equipment delay is long, the packet loss occurs, or incorrect packets
exist in the received or transmitted data.

Table 5-12 Common faults of Ethernet services

Symptom Alarm

Ethernet Hardware Such as HARD_BAD, TEMP_ALARM,


services are alarms WRG_BD_TYPE, BD_STATUS, COMMUN_FAIL,
interrupted. and LASER_MOD_ERR.

Link alarms Such as ETH_LOS, ETH_LINK_DOWN,


ETH_EFM_LOOPBACK, LOOP_ALM,
PORTMODE_MISMATCH, and LAG_DOWN.

Service alarms Such as ETH_CFM_AIS, ETH_CFM_LCO, and


ETH_NO_FLOW.

Radio link Such as MW_LOF, MW_LIM.


alarms

Ethernet Hardware Such as HARD_BAD, and TEMP_ALARM.


services suffer alarms
degradation.
Link alarms Such as PORTMODE_MISMATCH, and
LAG_MEMBER_DOWN.

Service alarms Such as FLOW_OVER, MAC_EXT_EXC,


MAC_FCS_EXC, and DROPRATIO_OVER.

Radio link Such as AM_DOWNSHIFT, MW_BER_EXC, and


alarms MW_BER_SD.

Fault Causes
l The possible human factors are as follows:
An Ethernet board loopback or a transmission line loopback occurs.
The parameter settings of the Ethernet ports, such as the port enabled state, working
mode, and flow control, are different from the parameter settings of the Ethernet ports
on the interconnected equipment.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 126


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

The service configuration is incorrect.


l The equipment at the local end is faulty.
l The line board is faulty or has bit errors.
l A LAG or PLA group has faulty member links, resulting in decreased Ethernet bandwidth.
l When the AM function is enabled, the Ethernet service bandwidth decreases due to the
downward AM switch.
l The interconnected equipment is faulty.
l The network cable is faulty.
l External electromagnetic interference is severe.

Fault Locating Methods


1. Rectify the human-caused faults such as a loopback and a data configuration error.
2. Locate the fault cause according to the equipment alarms.
3. Locate the fault cause according to the RMON performance events and alarms.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 127


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Troubleshooting Ethernet Services Configured on a Per NE Basis

Figure 5-10 Procedure for troubleshooting Ethernet services configured on a per NE basis

Start

1 Yes
Incorrect operation? Cancel this operation

No

An equipment Yes
2 alarm or alarm on Clear the alarm
the radio link?
No

3 Yes
An Ethernet alarm? Clear the alarm

No

4 A loop formed by Yes


the E-LAN service Release the loop
trails?
No
5
Query the port and service
traffic and analyze the fault
causes
No
Troubleshoot the fault
6 Any abnormal Yes according to the flow of
RMON performance handling RMON
events? performance events
No

Troubleshoot equipment
faults by performing Proceed No Is the fault
loopbacks section by with the rectified?
next step
section or replacing boards
Yes

End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 128


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Table 5-13 Description of the procedure for troubleshooting Ethernet services configured on a
per NE basis

Comment Description
No.

1 Check the following points:


l Whether a loopback is set for the Ethernet port
l Whether a loopback is set for the transmission line
l Whether the parameter settings of the Ethernet port, such as the port
enabled state, working mode, and flow control, are the same as the
parameter settings of the Ethernet port on the interconnected equipment
l Check whether the Ethernet protocol and the Ethernet service
configuration (especially the attributes of the Ethernet port) are correct.

2 Pay special attention to the following equipment alarms:


l POWER_ALM, FAN_FAIL, HARD_BAD, BD_STATUS,
TEMP_ALARM
l NESF_LOST
l RADIO_TSL_HIGH, RADIO_TSL_LOW
l IF_INPWR_ABN
Pay special attention to the following line alarms:
l MW_LIM
l MW_LOF
l MW_BER_EXC, MW_BER_SD, MW_FEC_UNCOR
l MW_RDI
l RADIO_RSL_HIGH, RADIO_RSL_LOW

3 Pay special attention to the following alarms:


l ETH_LOS
l ETH_NO_FLOW
l LAG_DOWN, LAG_MEMBER_DOWN
l FLOW_OVER

4 Follow the instructions in Detecting E-LAN Service Loops to check whether


E-LAN services are looped back. Release the loops if any are formed.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 129


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Comment Description
No.

5 Query Ethernet service rates on various ports to analyze the service rates
and locate faults.
l If the Ethernet port connecting the peer equipment has a too high or too
low receive rate, the peer equipment is faulty.
l If the rate of the port approaches or reaches the license capacity of the IF
port, the license capacity is too low and you need to apply for a license
allowing for a higher capacity.
l If the transmit rate of the port approaches or reaches the maximum Ethernet
bandwidth of the IF port, the bandwidth of the IF port is too low and needs
to be increased by the network planning personnel.
l If the transmit rate of the port is much lower than the receive rate of the
Ethernet port, or if the receive rate of the port is much higher than the
transmit rate of the Ethernet port, the local end is faulty. Locate the fault
as follows:
Check the Ethernet service configuration and QoS configuration.
By Querying port flow classification or packet loss performance of
egress queues on the NMS, check whether QoS settings are correct
according to the packet loss data.
Check the Ethernet interface board, IF board, and system control,
switching and timing board by means of board replacement.
If the transmitted traffic is equal to the received traffic, create flows specific
to the VLANs in the port policy, and check if sufficient bandwidth is available
for the flows by querying flow traffic.

6 For RMON performance events, see the C RMON Event Reference.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 130


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Figure 5-11 Procedure for troubleshooting an RMON performance event

Start

1
View the statistics group
performance on an Ethernet port

2
Yes Rectify the fault of line bit
Is there any FCS error? errors

No
3
Is there any collision Yes Check the working mode
or fragment? of the port

No
4
Yes Handle the problem on
Are broadcast packets excessive broadcast
excessive? packets
No

Use a meter to perform the test

Yes Rectify the fault of the


Is the test passed?
interconnected equipment
No

5 Yes
Is it a MTU setting Modify the MTU
problem? value
No

Rectify the equipment fault by Proceed with No Is the fault


loopback section by section or the next step rectified?
replacing the board
Yes

End

Table 5-14 Description of the procedure for troubleshooting an RMON performance event

No. Description

1 4.6.2 Querying Traffic, Physical Bandwidth, or Bandwidth Utilization to


obtain the real-time performance statistics data of the Ethernet port.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 131


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

No. Description

2 The troubleshooting procedure is as follows:


l Check the Ethernet cable. If the Ethernet cable is not qualified, replace it
with a new one.
l Change the Ethernet port that accesses the services on the Ethernet board.
If the new port does not have the RMON performance of an FCS error, it
indicates that the hardware of the original port is faulty. Otherwise, the
hardware of the Ethernet port on the equipment at the opposite end is
faulty.

3 Check the following points:


l Whether the port operating rates on the equipment at both ends are the
same
l Whether the working modes (full duplex or half duplex) of the Ethernet
port on the equipment at both ends are the same
l Whether the Ethernet port is set to auto-negotiation mode at one end and
the Ethernet port is set to full duplex mode at the opposite end (When the
Ethernet port is set to auto-negotiation mode at one end, the Ethernet port
must not be set to full duplex mode at the opposite end.)

4 Check for the cause for excessive broadcast packets (for example, you have
set the loopback for the Ethernet interface board or set the VB filtering table
incorrectly) and solve the problem. If the problem is caused on the equipment
at the opposite end, set the threshold of broadcast packet suppression for an
Ethernet port to reduce broadcast packets.

5 Test the MTU of the network by using a test meter. The maximum frame
length that is set for a port should be longer than the MTU of the network.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 132


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Troubleshooting Ethernet Services Configured in an End-to-End Manner

Figure 5-12 Procedure for troubleshooting faults in Ethernet services configured in an end-to-
end manner

Start

1
Yes
Incorrect operation? Cancel this operation.

No

2
Perform intelligent Success
diagnosis on Ethernet Troubleshoot according to the
services. relevant handling suggestions.

Failure

Refer to the procedure for


troubleshooting Ethernet Proceed with the No
Is the fault rectified?
services configured on a per next step.
NE basis.

Yes

End

Table 5-15 Description of the procedure for troubleshooting Ethernet services configured in an
end-to-end manner

Comment Description
No.

1 Check the following points:


l Whether a loopback is set for the Ethernet port
l Whether a loopback is set for the transmission line
l Whether the Ethernet port parameters, such as port enabling/disabling
status, working mode, and flow control, are configured consistently at the
local end and peer end
l Whether Ethernet protocol and Ethernet service configurations (especially
Ethernet port attributes) are correct

2 Intelligent fault diagnosis uses OAM to implement fault diagnosis over


services, PWs, and tunnels, and the physical layer, and supports the output of
diagnostic results for further troubleshooting.
NOTE
Only the Native E-Line services configured end to end support intelligent fault
diagnosis. For the troubleshooting of E-LAN services, see the instructions in the
Troubleshooting Ethernet Services Configured on a Per NE Basis section.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 133


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Experience and Summary


To troubleshoot an Ethernet service fault, you must be familiar with the characteristics, working
mode, and configured protocols of interfaces on the Ethernet equipment.

5.9 Troubleshooting Ethernet Service on the EoS/EoPDH


Plane
The Ethernet services transmitted on the EoS/EoPDH plane can be transmitted over a TDM
network. The faults of the EoS/EoPDH-plane Ethernet services include service interruption and
service degradation.

Fault Phenomena
The Ethernet service interruption indicates that the Ethernet service is completely interrupted.
The Ethernet service deterioration indicates that the Ethernet service is abnormal. For example,
the network access speed is low, the equipment delay is long, the packet loss occurs, or incorrect
packets exist in the received or transmitted data.

Table 5-16 Common faults of Ethernet services

Symptom Alarm Board

Ethernet HARD_BAD, TEMP_ALARM, EMS6/EFP8


services are WRG_BD_TYPE, or BD_STATUS
interrupted.
ALM_GFP_dLFD or ALM_GFP_dCSF

ETH_LOS or LOOP_ALM

LAG_PORT_FAIL,
LAG_VC_PORT_FAIL, LCAS_TLCT, or
LCAS_TLCR

Ethernet HARD_BAD or TEMP_ALARM


services are
abnormal. FLOW_OVER

LCAS_FOPT, LCAS_FOPR, LCAS_PLCT,


or LCAS_PLCR

Fault Causes
l The possible human factors are as follows:
An Ethernet board loopback or a transmission line loopback occurs.
The parameter settings of the Ethernet ports, such as the port enabled state, working
mode, and flow control, are different from the parameter settings of the Ethernet ports
on the interconnected equipment.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 134


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

The configuration of the encapsulation/mapping protocol or the LCAS protocol is


inconsistent on both ends of the link.
The timeslot binding of VCTRUNKs is inconsistent on both ends of the link
The service configuration is incorrect.
l The equipment at the local end is faulty.
l The line board is faulty or has bit errors.
l The interconnected equipment is faulty.
l The network cable is faulty.
l The external electromagnetic interference is severe.

Fault Locating Methods


1. Rectify the human-caused faults such as a loopback and a data configuration error.
2. Locate the fault cause according to the equipment alarms.
3. Locate the fault cause according to the RMON performance events and alarms.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 135


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Troubleshooting Procedure

Figure 5-13 Procedure for troubleshooting Ethernet service faults

Start

11 Yes
Incorrect operation? Cancel this operation

No

2 An equipment alarm Yes


Clear the alarm
or alarm on the radio
link?
No

Yes Query the port and service


3 An Ethernet Clear the alarm traffic and analyze the fault
alarm? causes
No

4 A loop formed by the Yes


Release the loop
E-LAN service trails?

No

Any abnormal Yes Troubleshoot the fault according


5
RMON performance to the flow of handling RMON
events? performance events

No

Fault on the Yes Troubleshoot faults on the


opposite
opposite equipment
equipment?
No
Troubleshoot equipment
Proceed No Is the fault
faults by performing
with the rectified?
loopbacks section by
next step
section or replacing boards
Yes

En
d

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 136


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Table 5-17 Description of the procedure for troubleshooting Ethernet service faults

Comment Description
No.

1 Check the following points:


l Whether a loopback is set for the Ethernet port
l Whether a loopback is set for the transmission line
l Whether the parameter settings of the Ethernet port, such as the port
enabled state, working mode, and flow control, are the same as the
parameter settings of the Ethernet port on the interconnected equipment
l The configuration of the encapsulation/mapping protocol or the LCAS
protocol is inconsistent on both ends of the link.
l The timeslot binding of VCTRUNKs is inconsistent on both ends of the
link.
l Check whether the Ethernet protocol and the Ethernet service
configuration (especially the attributes of the Ethernet port) are correct.

2 Pay special attention to the following equipment alarms:


l POWER_ALM
l FAN_FAIL
l HARD_BAD
l BD_STATUS
l NESF_LOST
l TEMP_ALARM
l RADIO_RSL_HIGH
l RADIO_RSL_LOW
l RADIO_TSL_HIGH
l RADIO_TSL_LOW
l IF_INPWR_ABN
Pay special attention to the following line alarms:
l MW_LIM
l MW_LOF
l R_LOS
l R_LOF
l MS_AIS
l AU_AIS
l AU_LOP
l B1_EXC
l B2_EXC

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 137


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Comment Description
No.

3 Pay special attention to the following alarms:


l ETH_LOS
l FLOW_OVER
l ALM_GFP_dCSF
l ALM_GFP_dLFD
l FCS_ERR
l LCAS_PLCT
l LCAS_TLCT
l LCAS_PLCR
l LCAS_TLCR
l LCAS_FOPT
l LCAS_FOPR

4 If the LOOP_ALM alarm is reported after the configuring the Advanced


Attributes of Ethernet Interfaces operation is performed, it indicates that the
network to which Ethernet ports are connected has loops.

5 For RMON performance events, see B Performance Event Reference.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 138


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Figure 5-14 Procedure for troubleshooting an RMON performance event

Start

1
View the statistics group
performance on an Ethernet port

2
Yes Rectify the fault of line bit
Is there any FCS error? errors

No
3
Is there any collision Yes Check the working mode
or fragment? of the port

No
4
Is there any Yes Handle the flow control
PAUSE frame? problem or increase the
bandwidth
No
5
Yes Handle the problem on
Are broadcast packets excessive broadcast
excessive? packets
No

Use a meter to perform the test

Yes
Is the test passed? Rectify the fault of the
interconnected equipment
No

6 Yes
Is it a MTU setting
Modify the MTU value
problem?
No
Proceed with No Is the fault
Rectify the equipment fault by the next step rectified?
loopback section by section or
replacing the board Yes

End

Table 5-18 Description of the procedure for troubleshooting an RMON performance event

Comment Description
No.

1 View the statistics group performance on an Ethernet port to obtain the


real-time performance statistics data of the Ethernet port.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 139


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Comment Description
No.

2 The troubleshooting procedure is as follows:


l Check the Ethernet cable. If the Ethernet cable is not qualified, replace it
with a new one.
l Change the Ethernet port that accesses the services on the Ethernet board.
If the new port does not have the RMON performance of an FCS error, it
indicates that the hardware of the original port is faulty. Otherwise, the
hardware of the Ethernet port on the equipment at the opposite end is
faulty.

3 Check the following points:


l Whether the port operating rates on the equipment at both ends are the
same
l Whether the working modes (full duplex or half duplex) of the Ethernet
port on the equipment at both ends are the same
l Whether the Ethernet port is set to auto-negotiation mode at one end and
the Ethernet port is set to full duplex mode at the opposite end (When the
Ethernet port is set to auto-negotiation mode at one end, the Ethernet port
must not be set to full duplex mode at the opposite end.)

4 Check the following points:


l Whether the flow control method is the same.
l Whether the Ethernet service traffic exceeds the bandwidth of the
VCTRUNK.

5 Check for the cause for excessive broadcast packets (for example, you have
set the loopback for the Ethernet interface board or set the VB filtering
table incorrectly) and solve the problem. If the problem is caused on the
equipment at the opposite end, set the threshold of broadcast packet
suppression for an Ethernet port to reduce broadcast packets.

6 Test the MTU of the network by using a test meter. The maximum frame
length that is set for a port should be longer than the MTU of the network.

Experience and Summary


To troubleshoot an Ethernet service fault, you must be familiar with the characteristics, working
mode, and configured protocols of interfaces on the Ethernet equipment.

5.10 Troubleshooting MPLS Tunnels


This section describes how to troubleshoot MPLS tunnels by using the MPLS OAM function or
MPLS Ping/Traceroute function.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 140


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Fault Phenomena
Common faults of MPLS tunnels are as follows:

l MPLS tunnels fail to be created, and services are unavailable.


l MPLS tunnels are faulty, and services are interrupted.
l MPLS APS switching fails, services are interrupted, and packet loss or bit errors occur.

Table 5-19 Common faults of MPLS tunnels

Symptom Alarm Board

MPLS HARD_BAD, TEMP_ALARM, CSHN


tunnels are WRG_BD_TYPE, BUS_ERR,
faulty. BD_STATUS, MPLS_TUNNEL_OAM-
FAIL, MPLS_TUNNEL_LOCV,
MPLS_TUNNEL_Excess,
MPLS_TUNNEL_MISMATCH,
MPLS_TUNNEL_MISMERGE,
MPLS_TUNNEL_UNKNOWN,
MPLS_TUNNEL_BDI,
MPLS_TUNNEL_FDI,
MPLS_TUNNEL_SD,
MPLS_TUNNEL_SF,
MPLS_TUNNEL_AIS,
MPLS_TUNNEL_RDI,
MPLS_TUNNEL_UNEXPMEG,
MPLS_TUNNEL_UNEXPMEP,
MPLS_TUNNEL_UNEXPPER

MW_CFG_MISMATCH ISV3, ISU2, ISX2, IFU2 or


MW_LIM IFX2

MW_LOF

Fault Causes
l Incorrect operations are performed.
The transmission link is looped back.
Service configuration data is inconsistent between the local end and the opposite end.
Service configuration is incorrect.
l The local NE is faulty.
l The transmission link is faulty or has bit errors.
l Service bandwidth decreases due to an AM downshift.
l The opposite NE is faulty.
l External electromagnetic interference is severe.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 141


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Fault Locating Methods


1. Check whether the data is modified, whether the line is looped back, and whether any boards
are replaced.
2. Handle the link alarms on the MPLS server trail.
3. Locate the faulty section by using the LSP Traceroute or MPLS-TP OAM function.
4. Locate the fault by replacing boards.

Troubleshooting Procedure

Figure 5-15 Procedure for troubleshooting MPLS tunnels

Start

1 Yes
Any incorrect Cancel the operation.
operation?

No

2 Yes
Any equipment- or
link-related alarm? Clear the alarm.

No

3 Yes
Clear the alarm using
Any alarm related to MPLS
LB/LT/LSP Ping/LSP Tracerout.
tunnel ?

No

Any fault in
Yes
interconnection
Handle the fault.
equipment?

No

Troubleshoot equipment faults by No


Contact Huawei Faults are rectified?
performing loopbacks on sections
technical engineers.
or replacing boards.

Yes

End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 142


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Table 5-20 Description of the procedure for troubleshooting MPLS tunnels

Comment Description
No.

1 Check the following points:


l Whether a loopback is set for E1 ports
l Whether a loopback is set for the transmission link
l Whether the parameter settings such as the working mode of Ethernet ports
match those of the opposite NE
l Whether the parameter settings such as frame format and frame mode at
E1 ports match those of the opposite NE
l Whether MPLS service configuration is correct, especially whether tunnel
attributes are set correctly

2 Pay special attention to the following equipment alarms:


l POWER_ALM
l FAN_FAIL
l HARD_BAD
l BD_STATUS
l BUS_ERR
l NESF_LOST
l TEMP_ALARM
l RADIO_RSL_HIGH
l RADIO_RSL_LOW
l RADIO_TSL_HIGH
l RADIO_TSL_LOW
l IF_INPWR_ABN
l AM_DOWNSHIFT
l MW_CFG_MISMATCH
Pay special attention to the following line alarms:
l MW_LIM
l MW_LOF
l MW_BER_EXC
l MW_BER_SD
l MW_RDI
l MW_FEC_UNCOR

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 143


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Comment Description
No.

3 Check whether the tunnel is faulty using LSP Ping, LSP Tracerout, or MPLS-
TP Tunnel OAM.
Pay special attention to the following alarms:
l MPLS_TUNNEL_BDI
l MPLS_TUNNEL_Excess
l MPLS_TUNNEL_FDI
l MPLS_TUNNEL_LOCV
l MPLS_TUNNEL_MISMATCH
l MPLS_TUNNEL_MISMERGE
l MPLS_TUNNEL_OAMFAIL
l MPLS_TUNNEL_SD
l MPLS_TUNNEL_SF
l MPLS_TUNNEL_UNKNOWN
l MPLS_TUNNEL_AIS
l MPLS_TUNNEL_RDI
l MPLS_TUNNEL_UNEXPMEG
l MPLS_TUNNEL_UNEXPMEP
l MPLS_TUNNEL_UNEXPPER

Experience and Summary


Learn about the working principle and protocol configuration of MPLS tunnels before
troubleshooting MPLS tunnels.

5.11 Troubleshooting CES Services


This section describes how to troubleshoot CES services that are interrupted or degraded.

Fault Phenomena
CES services are interrupted if they are completely unavailable. CES services are degraded if
they have packet loss or incorrect packets.

Table 5-21 Common faults of CES services

Symptom Alarm Board

CES services HARD_BAD, TEMP_ALARM, CSHN, ML1, MD1, CQ1


are WRG_BD_TYPE, BUS_ERR,
interrupted. BD_STATUS, CES_LOSPKT_EXC

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 144


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Symptom Alarm Board

AM_DOWNSHIFT ISV3, ISU2, ISX2, IFU2,


MW_CFG_MISMATCH IFX2

CES services HARD_BAD, TEMP_ALARM, CSHN, ML1, MD1, CQ1


are CES_JTROVR_EXC,
degraded. CES_JTRUDR_EXC,
CES_MALPKT_EXC,
CES_MISORDERPKT_EXC,
CES_STRAYPKT_EXC

AM_DOWNSHIFT ISV3, ISU2, ISX2, IFU2,


MW_CFG_MISMATCH IFX2

Fault Causes
l Incorrect operations are performed.
The transmission link is looped back.
Service configuration data is inconsistent between the local end and the opposite end.
Service configuration is incorrect.
l The clock source is asynchronous.
l Jitters and delays on the network are too great.
l The local NE is faulty.
l The transmission link is faulty or has bit errors.
l Service bandwidth decreases due to an AM downshift.
l The opposite NE is faulty.
l External electromagnetic interference is severe.

Fault Locating Methods


1. Check whether the data is modified, whether the line is looped back, and whether any boards
are replaced.
2. Check whether the PW works properly by using the PW ping function. If the PW is faulty,
check whether the MPLS tunnel works properly by using the LSP ping function. If the
MPLS tunnel works properly, check whether the PW has the same configuration at both
ends. If the configuration is the same, replace the board on the NNI side.
3. If the PW works properly, check whether the PE data configured at both ends is the same.
If the PE data is different, change the PE data to the same.
4. Check whether UNI-side data and CE-side data are consistent.
5. Analyze the RMON performance events of CES services.
6. Check whether there is impedance mismatch on channels and whether any electrical cables
are connected incorrectly.
7. Replace Smart E1 interface boards.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 145


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Troubleshooting Procedure

Figure 5-16 Procedure for troubleshooting CES services

Start

1 Yes
Any incorrect Cancel the operation
operation?

No

2 Yes
Any equipment- or
link-related alarm? Clear the alarm

No

Yes
3
Any alarm related to Clear the alarm
tunnels/PWs?

No

4
Any alarm related to Yes
CES services? Clear the alarm

5 Yes
Any alarm on E1
ports? Clear the alarm

No

6
Any RMON Yes
performance event? Handle the performance event

No

7 Any fault of Yes


interconnection with
Handle the fault
PDH equipment

No

Troubleshoot equipment faults by No


Contact Huawei Faults are rectified?
performing loopbacks on sections
technical engineers
or replacing boards

Yes

End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 146


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Table 5-22 Description of the procedure for troubleshooting CES services

Commen Description
t No.

1 Check the following points:


l Whether a loopback is set for the E1 port
l Whether a loopback is set for the transmission link
l Check whether the parameter settings of CES services, PWs, and tunnels are
consistent at the source end and sink end.
l Check whether the parameter settings of physical ports (including frame
format, code, electrical port impedance, and overhead byte), are consistent.
l Check whether the network bandwidth is sufficient for the service traffic.

2 Pay special attention to the following equipment alarms:


l POWER_ALM
l FAN_FAIL
l HARD_BAD
l BD_STATUS
l BUS_ERR
l NESF_LOST
l TEMP_ALARM
l RADIO_RSL_HIGH
l RADIO_RSL_LOW
l RADIO_TSL_HIGH
l RADIO_TSL_LOW
l IF_INPWR_ABN
l AM_DOWNSHIFT
l MW_CFG_MISMATCH
Pay special attention to the following line alarms:
l MW_LIM
l MW_LOF
l MW_BER_EXC
l MW_BER_SD
l MW_RDI
l MW_FEC_UNCOR

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 147


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Commen Description
t No.

3 Pay special attention to the following alarms:


l MPLS_TUNNEL_BDI
l MPLS_TUNNEL_Excess
l MPLS_TUNNEL_FDI
l MPLS_TUNNEL_LOCV
l MPLS_TUNNEL_MISMATCH
l MPLS_TUNNEL_MISMERGE
l MPLS_TUNNEL_OAMFAIL
l MPLS_TUNNEL_SD
l MPLS_TUNNEL_SF
l MPLS_TUNNEL_UNKNOWN

4 Pay special attention to the following alarms:


l CES_JTROVR_EXC
l CES_JTRUDR_EXC
l CES_LOSPKT_EXC
l CES_MALPKT_EXC
l CES_MISORDERPKT_EXC
l CES_STRAYPKT_EXC

5 Pay special attention to the following alarms:


l T_ALOS
l UP_E1_AIS
l LFA
l LMFA
l ALM_E1RAI

6 Pay special attention to the following alarms:


l CES_MISORDERPKT
l CES_LOSPKT
l CES_MALPKT
l CES_JTRUDR
l CES_JTROVR
l CES_STRAYPKT

7 Troubleshoot the interconnection with the PDH equipment.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 148


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Experience and Summary


Learn about the working principle and protocol configuration of CES services before
troubleshooting CES services.

5.12 Troubleshooting ATM Services


This section describes how to troubleshoot ATM services that are interrupted or degraded.

Fault Phenomena
ATM services are interrupted if they are completely unavailable. ATM services are degraded if
they have packet loss or incorrect packets.

Table 5-23 Common faults of ATM services

Symptom Alarm Board

ATM HARD_BAD, TEMP_ALARM, CSHN, ML1, MD1


services are WRG_BD_TYPE, BUS_ERR,
interrupted. BD_STATUS, ALM_IMA_LIF,
ALM_IMA_LODS,
ALM_IMA_RE_RX_UNUSABLE,
ALM_IMA_RE_TX_UNUSABLE,
IMA_GROUP_LE_DOWN,
IMA_GROUP_RE_DOWN, LCD

AM_DOWNSHIFT ISV3, ISU2, ISX2, IFU2,


MW_CFG_MISMATCH IFX2

ATM HARD_BAD, TEMP_ALARM, CSHN, ML1, MD1


services are ALM_IMA_LIF, ALM_IMA_LODS,
degraded. ALM_IMA_RE_RX_UNUSABLE,
ALM_IMA_RE_TX_UNUSABLE, OCD

AM_DOWNSHIFT ISV3, ISU2, ISX2, IFU2,


MW_CFG_MISMATCH IFX2

Fault Causes
l Incorrect operations are performed.
The transmission link is looped back.
Service configuration data is inconsistent between the local end and the opposite end.
Service configuration is incorrect.
l The local NE is faulty.
l The transmission link is faulty or has bit errors.
l Service bandwidth decreases due to an AM downshift.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 149


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

l The opposite NE is faulty.


l External electromagnetic interference is severe.

Fault Locating Methods


1. Check whether the data is modified, whether the link is looped back, and whether any
boards are replaced.
2. Check whether the PW works properly by using the PW ping function. If the PW is faulty,
check whether the MPLS tunnel works properly by using the LSP ping function. If the
MPLS tunnel works properly, check whether the PW has the same configuration at both
ends. If the configuration is the same, replace the board on the NNI side.
3. If the PW works properly, check whether the PE data configured at both ends is the same.
If the PE data is different, change the PE data to the same.
4. Check whether UNI-side data and CE-side data are consistent.
5. Analyze the RMON performance events of ATM services.
6. Check whether there is impedance mismatch on channels and whether any electrical cables
are connected incorrectly.
7. Replace Smart E1 processing boards.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 150


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Troubleshooting Procedure

Figure 5-17 Procedure for troubleshooting ATM services

Start

1 Yes
Any incorrect Cancel the operation
operation?

No

2 Yes
Any equipment- or
link-related alarm? Clear the alarm

No

3 Yes
Any alarm related to ATM Clear the alarm
services?

No

4
Any alarm at the E1 Yes
port? Clear the alarm

No

5
Any RMON Yes
performance event? Handle the performance event

No

6 Any fault of Yes


interconnection with
Handle the fault
PDH equipment

No

Troubleshoot equipment faults by No


Contact Huawei Faults are rectified?
performing loopbacks on sections
technical engineers
or replacing boards

Yes

End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 151


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Table 5-24 Description of the procedure for troubleshooting ATM services

Comment Description
No.

1 Check the following points:


l Whether a loopback is set for the E1 port
l Whether a loopback is set for the transmission link
l Whether the parameter settings of ATM VPI/VCI, PWE3 CW, PW, and
Tunnel are consistent between the source end and the sink end.
l Whether the parameter settings of interconnected ports are consistent
Whether E1 frame format, coding, overhead bytes, and E1 timeslot
mode (30/31) are correctly configured
Whether IMA parameters (including protocol version, clock mode,
frame length, and maximum differential delay) are correctly
configured
l Check whether the network bandwidth is sufficient for the service traffic.

2 Pay special attention to the following equipment alarms:


l POWER_ALM
l FAN_FAIL
l HARD_BAD
l BD_STATUS
l BUS_ERR
l NESF_LOST
l TEMP_ALARM
l RADIO_RSL_HIGH
l RADIO_RSL_LOW
l RADIO_TSL_HIGH
l RADIO_TSL_LOW
l IF_INPWR_ABN
l AM_DOWNSHIFT
l MW_CFG_MISMATCH
Pay special attention to the following line alarms:
l MW_LIM
l MW_LOF
l MW_BER_EXC
l MW_BER_SD
l MW_RDI
l MW_FEC_UNCOR

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 152


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Comment Description
No.

3 Pay special attention to the following alarms:


l ALM_IMA_LIF
l ALM_IMA_LODS
l ALM_IMA_RE_RX_UNUSABLE
l ALM_IMA_RE_TX_UNUSABLE
l IMA_GROUP_LE_DOWN
l IMA_GROUP_RE_DOWN
l OCD
l LCD

4 Pay special attention to the following alarms:


l T_ALOS
l UP_E1_AIS
l LFA
l LMFA

5 Pay special attention to the following alarms:


l ATMPW_UNKNOWNCELLS
l ATM_UNCORRECTED_HCSERR

6 Troubleshoot the interconnection with the PDH equipment.

Experience and Summary


Learn about the working principle and protocol configuration of ATM services before
troubleshooting ATM services.

5.13 Troubleshooting Ethernet Services Carried by PWs


This section describes how to troubleshoot Ethernet services that are carried by PWs and
transmitted in the PSN. These Ethernet services are considered faulty when they are interrupted
or deteriorate.

Fault Symptoms
Ethernet services are interrupted if they are unavailable. Ethernet services deteriorate if they
have great delays, packet loss, or incorrect packets.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 153


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Table 5-25 Common faults of Ethernet services

Symptom Alarm Board

Ethernet HARD_BAD, TEMP_ALARM, EG4, EG4P, EG2D, EM6TA,


services are WRG_BD_TYPE, BUS_ERR, EM6FA, EM6F or EM6T
interrupted. BD_STATUS

COMMUN_FAIL, LAG_DOWN

ETH_LOS, ETH_EFM_LOOPBACK, or
LOOP_ALM

LASER_MOD_ERR EG4, EG4P, EM6FA, EM6F


or EG2D

Ethernet HARD_BAD or TEMP_ALARM EG4, EG4P, EG2D, EM6TA,


services EM6FA, EM6F or EM6T
deteriorate.
PORTMODE_MISMATCH, FLOW_OVER EG4, EG4P, EG2D, EM6TA,
or LAG_MEMBER_DOWN EM6FA, EM6F or EM6T
MAC_FCS_EXC
MAC_EXT_EXC
DROPRATIO_OVER

AM_DOWNSHIFT ISV3, ISU2, ISX2, IFU2 or


MAC_FCS_EXC IFX2

MAC_EXT_EXC
DROPRATIO_OVER

Fault Causes
l Incorrect operations are performed.
The transmission link is looped back.
Service configuration data is inconsistent between the local end and the opposite end.
Service configuration is incorrect.
l The local NE is faulty.
l The transmission link is faulty or has bit errors.
l Service bandwidth decreases due to an AM downshift.
l The opposite NE is faulty.
l External electromagnetic interference is severe.

Fault Locating Methods


1. Check whether the data is modified, whether the link is looped back, and whether any
boards are replaced.
2. Check whether the PW works properly by using the PW ping or MPLS-TP PW OAM
function. If the PW is faulty, check whether the MPLS tunnel works properly by using the

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 154


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

LSP ping or MPLS-TP Tunnel OAM function. If the MPLS tunnel works properly, check
whether the PW has the same configuration at both ends. If the configuration is the same,
replace the boardon the NNI side.
3. If the PW works properly, check whether the PE data configured at both ends is the same.
If the PE data is different, change the PE data to the same.
4. Check whether UNI-side data and CE-side data are consistent.
5. Analyze the RMON performance events of Ethernet services.
6. Check whether there is impedance mismatch on channels and whether any electrical cables
are connected incorrectly.
7. Replace Ethernet interface board.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 155


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Troubleshooting Ethernet Services Configured on a Per NE Basis

Figure 5-18 Procedure for troubleshooting PW-carried Ethernet services configured on a per
NE basis

Start

1 Yes
Any incorrect Cancel the operation.
operation?

No

2 Any equipment- Yes


or link-related Clear the alarm.
alarm?

No

3 Yes
Any PW-related
Clear the alarm.
alarm?

No

4 Can the PW be Yes


pinged after a PW Handle the UNI-side fault.
ping test is enabled?

No

5
Yes
Any fault in the tunnel Handle the tunnel fault.
that carries the PW?

No

6 Yes
Incorrect PW
configuration? Re-configure the PW.

No
7

Analyze PW traffic.

Contact Huawei No
Is the fault rectified?
technical engineers.

Yes

End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 156


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Table 5-26 Description of the procedure for troubleshooting PW-carried Ethernet services
configured on a per NE basis

No. Description

1 Check the following points:


l Whether a loopback is set for the E1 port
l Whether a loopback is set for the transmission link
l Whether the parameter settings of ATM VPI/VCI, PWE3 CW, PW, and
tunnel are consistent between the source end and the sink end
l Whether the parameter settings of interconnected ports are consistent
Whether E1 frame format, coding, overhead bytes, and E1 timeslot
mode (30/31) are correctly configured
Whether IMA parameters (including protocol version, clock mode,
frame length, and maximum differential delay) are correctly
configured
l Check whether the network bandwidth is sufficient for the service traffic.

2 Pay special attention to the following equipment alarms:


l POWER_ALM
l FAN_FAIL
l HARD_BAD
l BD_STATUS
l BUS_ERR
l NESF_LOST
l TEMP_ALARM
l RADIO_RSL_HIGH
l RADIO_RSL_LOW
l RADIO_TSL_HIGH
l RADIO_TSL_LOW
l IF_INPWR_ABN
l AM_DOWNSHIFT
l MW_CFG_MISMATCH
Pay special attention to the following radio link alarms:
l MW_LIM
l MW_LOF
l MW_BER_EXC
l MW_BER_SD
l MW_RDI
l MW_FEC_UNCOR

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 157


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

No. Description

3 Pay special attention to the following alarms:


l MPLS_TUNNEL_BDI
l MPLS_TUNNEL_Excess
l MPLS_TUNNEL_FDI
l MPLS_TUNNEL_LOCV
l MPLS_TUNNEL_MISMATCH
l MPLS_TUNNEL_MISMERGE
l MPLS_TUNNEL_OAMFAIL
l MPLS_TUNNEL_SD
l MPLS_TUNNEL_SF
l MPLS_TUNNEL_UNKNOWN
l MPLS_TUNNEL_AIS
l MPLS_TUNNEL_RDI
l MPLS_TUNNEL_UNEXPMEG
l MPLS_TUNNEL_UNEXPMEP
l MPLS_TUNNEL_UNEXPPER
l MPLS_PW_AIS
l MPLS_PW_BDI
l MPLS_PW_RDI
l MPLS_PW_Excess
l MPLS_PW_LOCV
l MPLS_PW_MISMATCH
l MPLS_PW_MISMERGE
l MPLS_PW_OAMFAIL
l MPLS_PW_SD
l MPLS_PW_SF
l MPLS_PW_UNEXPMEG
l MPLS_PW_UNEXPMEP
l MPLS_PW_UNEXPPER
l MPLS_PW_UNKNOWN

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 158


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

No. Description

4 Check whether the PW is faulty using PW Ping.


If the PW cannot be pinged, check the following points:
l Whether the UNI-side hardware and cables are normal
l Whether the UNI-side PWE3 service configurations are correct
l Whether the working mode and tag attribute of the UNI are consistent with
those at the peer port
Pay special attention to the following alarms:
l ETH_LOS
l ETH_CFM_UNEXPERI
l ETH_NO_FLOW
l MAC_FCS_EXC
l MAC_EXT_EXC

5 Check whether the MPLS tunnel is faulty using LSP Ping or LSP Tracerout.
Handle tunnel faults by following the instructions in 5.10 Troubleshooting
MPLS Tunnels.

6 Check PW configurations. If the PW configurations are incorrect, re-


configure the PW according to the network plan.

7 Check if packet loss occurs by querying the received and transmitted


packets on L2VPN PWs on the PEs at both ends.
If packet loss occurs, identify the cause by querying packet loss of egress
queues on all nodes of a PW. Handle UNI-side faults by following the
instructions in step 4.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 159


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Troubleshooting Ethernet Services Configured in an End-to-End Manner

Figure 5-19 Procedure for troubleshooting Ethernet services configured in an end-to-end


manner

Start

1
Yes
Incorrect operation? Cancel this operation.

No

2
Perform intelligent Success
diagnosis on Ethernet Troubleshoot according to the
services. relevant handling suggestions.

Failure

Refer to the procedure for


troubleshooting Ethernet Proceed with the No
Is the fault rectified?
services configured on a per next step.
NE basis.

Yes

End

Table 5-27 Description of the procedure for troubleshooting Ethernet services configured in an
end-to-end manner

Comment Description
No.

1 Check the following points:


l Whether a loopback is set for the Ethernet port
l Whether a loopback is set for the transmission link
l Whether the Ethernet port parameters, such as port enabling/disabling
status, working mode, and flow control, are configured consistently at the
local end and peer end
l Whether Ethernet protocol and Ethernet service configurations (especially
Ethernet port attributes) are correct

2 Intelligent fault diagnosis uses OAM to implement fault diagnosis over


services, PWs, and tunnels, and the physical layer, and supports the output of
diagnostic results for further troubleshooting.

Experience and Summary


Learn about the working principle and protocol configuration of Ethernet services carried by
PWs before troubleshooting these services.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 160


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

5.14 Troubleshooting DCN Faults


A data communication network (DCN) fault causes an NE to be unreachable due to failed or
unstable communications between the NE and the NMS.

Context
If links or lines that bear DCN channels, including data communication channels (DCCs) and
inband DCN channels, are faulty, the DCN communication is interrupted. In this case, handle
the fault in the same manner as a service fault. In other cases, the DCN communication between
an NE and the NMS is interrupted or unstable, but the services between them are normal for the
moment. This fault also needs to be rectified in time, otherwise, you will fail to check the NE
information, obtain NE alarms, or change NE configurations when the services become faulty.

Fault Symptoms and Causes

Table 5-28 Fault symptoms and causes

Symptom Possible Cause

NEs connected through their l Cause 1: Services are interrupted.


service ports like air l Cause 2: DCN parameters are incorrectly set.
interfaces and Ethernet ports
are unreachable to their l Cause 3: System control boards are faulty.
NMS.

NEs connected through their l Cause 1: The network cable of the NMS is disconnected
NMS ports are unreachable or damaged.
to their NMS. l Cause 2: DCN parameters are incorrectly set.
l Cause 3: System control boards are faulty.

A few NEs are unreachable l Cause 1: DCN parameters are incorrectly set.
or their connection to the l Cause 2: An NE ID or NE IP address conflict occurs
NMS is unstable. between NEs on the DCN subnet.
l Cause 3: The DCN subnet is too large.
l Cause 4: The system control unit of the NE is faulty.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 161


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Troubleshooting Procedure

Figure 5-20 Procedure for troubleshooting DCN faults

Start

1
Locate a
faulty NE

2
Yes Yes Check for hardware
Icon of the faulty The NMS cannot Hardware
alarms and check
NE in gray reach the NE fault? cable connections

NO
NO 3
Settings Yes Check settings
incorrectly or undo
modified? modifications
NO
4
Yes
Large DCN Divide the DCN
subnet? subnet

5
NM Yes
Too low DCN Increase the DCN
Information channel bandwidth channel bandwidth
loss?

NO
6
No response to Yes SCC boards are Wait for the completion
commands from the being reset of SCC resetting
NMS

NO
Fault rectified

Yes

Contact Huawei technical


End
service engineers

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 162


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Table 5-29 Procedure description for troubleshooting DCN faults

Mark Operation Typical Symptom Measures

1 Locate the faulty Locate the faulty NE l If the faulty NE has a service fault, rectify the service
NE. based on a DCN fault first.
networking diagram. l If an unreachable NE connects to its NMS through
l If all NEs within an an external DCN, verify that the external DCN
area are unreachable to equipment or the cable used for DCN connection is
their NMS, the working correctly.
unreachable NE
closest to a normal NE
is probably the faulty
NE.
l If only one NE is
unreachable to its
NMS, the NE is the
faulty NE.

2 Handle l The faulty NE reports l Handle hardware alarms based on the maintenance
hardware faults. hardware alarms like and fault management procedure.
HARD_BAD. l Remove and then install, or replace the network
l Check whether the cable and optical fibers.
NMS/COM port on the
faulty NE is connected
to a correct cable or
whether the network
cable of the faulty NE
is damaged.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 163


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Mark Operation Typical Symptom Measures

3 Modify The following operations l Check for unplanned NE IDs and NE IP addresses
incorrect are performed before a in the ECC routing table of the faulty NE's upstream
configurations. faulty NE becomes NE. If there is an unplanned NE ID or IP address in
unreachable to its NMS: the ECC routing table, the faulty NE is incorrectly
l Modifying NE configured. To rectify the fault, log in to the faulty
attributes or NE NE using the unplanned NE ID and NE IP address
communication on the NMS and correct the settings.
settings l Change the DCC settings or inband DCN settings of
l Adding a new NE to the faulty NE to interrupt the DCN channel between
the network, or the faulty NE and its upstream NE. Then, check for
replacing the faulty NE the ID and IP address of the faulty NE in the ECC
or its system control routing table of the upstream NE. If the ID and IP
board address of the faulty NE exist in the ECC routing
table of the upstream NE, another NE on the ECC
subnet has the same ID and IP address as the faulty
NE. In this case, correct the settings to ensure that
each NE on the ECC subnet has a unique ID and IP
address.
l If the inband DCN is enabled for the faulty NE and
its upstream NE, verify that the VLAN ID is
correctly set on the upstream NE.
l Verify that static routes are correctly set on the faulty
NE's upstream NE.
l Verify that OSPF parameters are correctly set on the
faulty NE's upstream NE. OSPF parameter settings
must be consistent for all NEs on the same ECC
subnet.

4 Analyze the Check the number of NEs If there is a large number of NEs in the routing table,
DCN subnet in the IP routing table or the DCN subnet is too large in size and some NEs on
size. ECC routing table of the the DCN subnet may occasionally become unreachable
faulty NE's upstream NE. to their NMS. It is recommended that an DCN subnet
consist of no more than 120 NEs, if a 192 kbit/s
bandwidth is provided. If L2 DCN is used, an L2 DCN
subnet consists of not more than 30 NEs.

5 Troubleshoot Some NEs may l Verify that a minimum of 192 kbit/s bandwidth is
NMS occasionally become allocated to the inband DCN. If the allocated
information unreachable to their NMS. bandwidth is lower than 192 kbit/s, packets from the
loss. NMS may be lost.
l Check whether the QoS priority allocated to the
inband DCN by a third-party network is high enough
if inband DCN packets are transmitted over the
third-party network. Lower QoS priority of inband
DCN packets may cause NEs unreachable to the
NMS due to congestive packet loss. The per-hop
behavior (PHB) priority of inband DCN packets
must not lower than expedited forwarding (EF).

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 164


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Mark Operation Typical Symptom Measures

6 Troubleshoot l The NE fails to be l Search for the IP address of the faulty NE on the
no-response logged in to onsite. NMS.
problems. l The NE does not l If the IP address is not found, or if the IP address is
respond to commands. found but the NMS still cannot reach the faulty NE,
restart the OptiX RTN 980 after a power-off, in a
authorized maintenance window which service can
be interrupted.

5.15 Troubleshooting Orderwire Faults


If orderwire calls cannot get through when services are normal, there is an orderwire fault.

Fault Causes
l The phone set is set incorrectly.
l The phone line is connected incorrectly.
l The orderwire is configured incorrectly.
l The orderwire unit is faulty.
l The system control unit is faulty.
l The line unit or radio link is faulty.

Fault Locating Methods


l Check whether the phone set is set correctly, whether the phone line is connected correctly,
and whether the orderwire is configured correctly.
l Replace the possibly faulty board to locate the fault.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 165


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Troubleshooting Procedure

Figure 5-21 Procedure for troubleshooting orderwire faults

Start

Check the phone setting

Is the phone No
Modify the phone setting
correctly set?

Yes

Is the phone line No


Reconnect the phone line
correctly connected?

Yes
2
Check the orderwire
configuration

Is the configuration No
Modify the configuration
correct?

Yes
3
Replace the possibly faulty No
Proceed with the next step Is the fault rectified?
board

Yes

End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 166


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Table 5-30 Description of the procedure for troubleshooting orderwire faults

Comment Description
No.

1 Check the following points:


l Check whether the ring current switch "RING" on the phone set is set to
"ON".
l Check whether the dialing mode switch is set to "T", namely, the dual tone
multi-frequency mode.
l An orderwire phone set should be in on-hook state when it is not in
communication, and the upper-right red indicator in the front view of the
orderwire phone set should be off.
If the red indicator is on, it indicates that the phone set is in off-hook state.
Press the "TALK" button in the front of phone set to hook it up. In certain
occasions, the maintenance personnel press the "TALK" button is pressed
by mistake. As a result, the phone set stay in off-hook state all the time
and the orderwire call from the other NEs cannot get through.

2 Check the following points:


l Whether all orderwire phone numbers on a subnet are of the same length
l Whether all orderwire phone numbers on a subnet are unique
l Whether the overhead bytes of all the NEs on a subnet are the same
l Whether the orderwire port is set correctly

3 Replace the boards where the orderwire unit, system control unit, and
line unit are located to locate the fault.

Experience and Summary


To troubleshoot orderwire faults, you must check the orderwire phone periodically.

5.16 Typical Cases


This section describes typical microwave link troubleshooting cases.

5.16.1 Transient Link Unavailability Due to Multi-path Fading

Fault Symptoms
A 20 km long cross-ocean 1+1 hot standby (HSB) radio link was interrupted intermittently, and
alarms such as B1_SD, HSB_INDI, MW_LOF, and R_LOF, were reported and lasted several
seconds to dozens of seconds.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 167


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Cause Analysis and Handling Procedure


1. Checked the ODU receive power that was recorded during the alarm period.

The difference between the maximum receive power and the minimum receive power was
more than 40 dB, and the minimum receive power was close to or less than the receiver
sensitivity. Therefore, it was inferred that the fault was caused by spatial fading.
2. Checked the network planning design.
The ODU operated at the 8 GHz band, which was less prone to rain fading, and therefore
multipath fading caused intermittent link interruptions. In addition, 1+1 HSB protection
does not well protect radio links against multipath fading.
3. Replaced 1+1 HSB protection with 1+1 space diversity (SD) protection.

Conclusions and Suggestions


l Routinely check whether the receive power reaches the designed value. If not, it is
recommended that you check the configuration, adjust antennas, or replace ODUs so the
receive power reaches the designed value.
l Minimize the impact of multipath fading by using one of the following methods, depending
on the actual conditions:
Use low capacity, low-order modulation schemes, and low bandwidths.
Increase the height difference between antennas at both ends providing that line-of-sight
(LOS) is guaranteed.
Add two antennas and configure an SD protection group.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 168


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

5.16.2 Transoceanic Link Transient Unavailability Due to


Insufficient Height Difference between Diversity Antennas

Fault Symptoms
The received signal levels (RSLs) at both ends of a 1+1 SD cross-ocean radio link fluctuated
dramatically, leading to bit errors or even link interruptions.

Cause Analysis and Handling Procedure


1. Checked the alarms reported by NEs at both ends of the radio link.
The NEs did not report any hardware alarms but frequently reported radio link alarms and
service interruption alarms.
2. Checked the RSLs of the main and standby ODUs at each end.
The RSLs of the main and standby ODUs at each end fluctuated dramatically, with a
fluctuation range over 30 dB. Therefore, the fault was possibly caused by multipath fading.
3. Checked the network plans and the mounting height difference between the main and
standby antennas at each end.
The mounting height difference between the main and standby antennas at each end was
only 4 meters, so space diversity performance was poor.
NOTE
To protect long-distance cross-ocean radio links against multipath fading, take the following measures
during network planning:
l Ensure that the fading margin is greater than or equal to 30 dB.
l Increase the mounting height difference between the main and standby antennas at both ends of a 1
+1 SD radio link.
4. Adjusted the mounting heights of the main antennas to 24 meters and those of the standby
antennas to 10 meters.
The following figure shows the simulation result and illustrates satisfactory diversity
compensation.

NOTE

The value of K generally ranges from 0.67 to 1.33. In this case, the RSLs of the main and standby antennas
are not correlated with each other. When designing mounting heights for main and standby antennas, keep
appropriate antenna spacing for minimizing the impact of reflection on radio links. When reflection causes
high attenuation on the main path, the attenuation on the standby path is low.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 169


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Conclusions and Suggestions


When planning cross-ocean radio links, especially long-distance cross-ocean radio links, take
measures to minimize the impact of multipath fading. 1+1 SD protection is recommended for
these radio links. When mounting the main and standby antennas at one end, keep an appropriate
mounting height difference between them so attenuation has no impact on RSLs. In addition,
the main and standby antennas can be tilted slightly upwards providing that RSLs be not affected.

5.16.3 Link Unavailability Due to Inter-building Reflection

Fault Symptoms
On a 900-meter 1+0 microwave hop, IFX2 boards are used, working with 18 GHz HP ODUs,
at 28 MHz channel bandwidth and in 256QAM modulation, with XPIC disabled. One end of the
link continuously reports MW_LOF alarms and the other end reports MW_RDI alarms.

On this microwave hop, ODUs are mounted onto 0.3-meter diameter dual-polarized antennas
in separate-mount manner. Both ends of the radio hop are located on roofs. Antennas are installed
at the middle of poles about 5 meters high standing on the roofs.

Cause Analysis and Handling Procedure


1. The total hop spans only 900 meters. The receive power is ideal but the MSE is poor. The
faulty microwave link end is surrounded by many buildings, most of which have glass
walls. Therefore, it is suspected that some signals are reflected for many times between the
buildings before reaching the receive end or that some microwave signals are reflected
twice when traveling through the glass walls before reaching the receive end. See Figure
5-22.

Figure 5-22 Microwave link between buildings

Site A

Site B

Reflected signal

Main signal

2. To suppress signal reflection, do as follows:

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 170


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

l Change the pole position.


l Adjust the antenna elevation.
l Increase the antenna mount height.
l Use antennas with a larger diameter.
NOTE

Move poles near the building roof edges to decrease the inter-building reflection possibility or number of
reflection times. Generally, antennas can be adjusted upwards, downwards, leftwards, or rightwards.
During antenna adjustment, notice the MSE changes and ensure that the RSL is within its allowed range.
The larger the antenna diameter, the denser the beams. The smaller the beam angle at the receive end, the
powerful the capabilities to suppress reflection.
3. By means of the preceding methods, you can adjust the MSE values at both ends to be -30
dB to clear alarms.

Conclusions and Suggestions


The addressed problem is characterized by satisfactory receive power, poor MSE, and failure in
clearing alarms. To find out the cause, check whether the equipment hardware is faulty, whether
the equipment operates abnormally, and whether any exceptions occur on the path from an
antenna to an indoor unit (IDU). Then narrow down the cause on the space link, and determine
whether reflection and refraction are possible according to the topography.

5.16.4 Unidirectional Link Availability Due to Interference

Fault Symptoms
The1+0 link formed by NE A and NE B using IF1 board and 8G/HP ODU is available only in
one direction after the link is expanded from mode 5 (QPSK/28M/16E1) to mode 7 (128QAM/
28M/STM-1). The link is available only in one direction after the link is expanded from mode
5 (QPSK/28M/16E1) to mode 7 (128QAM/28M/STM-1).

Cause Analysis and Handling Procedure


1. The ODU supports 128QAM modulation scheme according to query results of NE data in
mode 7 and query of ODU product manual.
2. The receive power is unlikely to fade because the RSL is stable and the link is only 1.27
Km long.
3. The MSE values on the NE A are -35.35 dB and -34.57 dB in the mode 5 and the mode 7
respectively. The MSE values on the NE B are -26.77 dB and -20.56 dB in the mode 5 and
the mode 7 respectively. The MSE value on the NE B is greatly different from the required
modulation threshold from -24 dB to -35 dB in the mode 7. The modulation threshold of
the MSE value in the mode 7 is from -24 dB to -35 dB. When the link is normal, the MSE
value of NE B is also low. It is suspected that interference exists. Because the anti-
interference capability in QPSK modulation is more powerful than that in 128QAM
modulation, signal modulation is successful in QPSK modulation but fails in 128QAM
modulation.
4. Scan the frequency on the NE B to find out the interference source. Change the operating
frequency to eliminate interference.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 171


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Conclusions and Suggestions


For unidirectional link availability in case of modulation upshift, the possible causes are as
follows:
l The ODU cannot support the new IF mode of high modulation and of large capacity after
the link capacity is expanded.
l The link is interrupted because the receive power cannot meet the sensitivity requirement
in the new IF mode.
l The link is interrupted because the MSE value cannot reach the demodulation threshold
due to interference occurrence on the link.

Check the above items to prevent the link from being interrupted before the link capacity
expansion.

5.16.5 Bit Errors on Microwave Links

Fault Symptoms
Bit errors occurred in the services carried by a 2.5 km long radio link between NE A and NE B.
Both NEs used antennas with a diameter of 0.6 meters and 15 GHz ODUs. The IF1 boards on
both NEs worked in mode 5 (28 MHz/QPSK).

Cause Analysis and Handling Procedure


1. Checked the alarms and logs of the two NEs.
The NEs did not report any hardware alarm. NE A reported an MW_FEC_UNCOR alarm,
but NE B did not.
2. Checked the RSLs at the two NEs.
The RSL at NE A was 62 dBm and that at NE B was 70 dBm. These two values were
greater than the receiver sensitivity (85 dBm) in mode 5.
3. Checked for interference signals by muting the ODU at NE B.
The RSL at NE A was 80 dBm. Therefore, interference signals existed.
4. Used one of the following methods for eliminating interference signals:
l Using frequencies that are not affected by interference signals (tests showed that the
sub-bands supported by the ODU were all interfered)
l Using antennas with a diameter greater than 0.6 meters (the workload is heavy and
interference signals are also amplified)
l Changing a polarization direction (cross-polarization discrimination of 30 dB can be
achieved)
5. Changed the polarization direction of the radio link.
The fault was rectified.

Conclusions and Suggestions


If the RSL of an ODU is normal or apparently greater than the receiver sensitivity, frequent and
intermittent radio link interruptions or bit errors are generally caused by interference signals.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 172


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

5.16.6 Poor Reliability Due to Network Planning Errors

Fault Symptoms
A radio link frequently but intermittently reported MW_RDI, R_LOC, and RPS_INDI alarms,
and HSB switchovers were triggered.

Table 5-31 Link information

Protection 1+1 HSB

IF board IF1B boards

IF mode IF mode 7 (28M/128QAM/STM-1)

ODU type SPA ODUs operating at the 8 GHz frequency


band

Receiver sensitivity 70.5 dBm

Transmit power 20 dBm

Receive power 39.5 dBm

Planned availability 99.994%

Predicted annual interruption time 1877 seconds

Cause Analysis and Handling Procedure


1. Queried historical receive power values of the radio link.
The receive power decreased to a value close to the receiver sensitivity when an alarm was
reported. Most alarms were reported during the night or in the early morning. When the
weather was favorable at noon, the receive power was normal. Therefore, intermittent radio
link interruptions were caused by multipath fading.
2. Checked annual interruption time predicted for the radio link.
The actual annual interruption time was longer than the predicted time of 1877 seconds.
Therefore, the fading margin was insufficient.
3. Checked the network planning methods.
The ITU-R-P.530-7/8 method was used. The area covered by the radio link was in the
Middle East, and therefore the ITU-R-P.530-9 method should be used.
4. Used the ITU-R-P.530-9 method to predict annual interruption time without changing other
conditions.
The obtained value was about 175833 seconds, which was longer than the value obtained
using the ITU-R-P.530-7/8 method.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 173


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Figure 5-23 Using the ITU-R-P.530-7/8 method

Figure 5-24 Using the ITU-R-P.530-9 method

5. Deleted 1+1 HSB protection settings and configured 1+1 SD protection. The link
availability met service requirements.

Conclusions and Suggestions


Network planning is crucial to radio link performance. For radio links that are frequently
interrupted due to fading, it is recommended that you first check their network planning
information.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 174


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 6 Part Replacement

6 Part Replacement

About This Chapter

Part replacement is a method frequently used to locate faults. The replacement operation varies
according to the specific part type.

Background Information

Table 6-1 Part replacement description

Part Name Operation Tool

CQ1 6.4 Replacing the Channelized l ESD wrist strap


STM-1 Processing Board l Screwdriver
SL1D, SL1DA 6.3 Replacing the SDH Optical l U2000
Interface Board l Fiber remover

EG4, EG4P, 6.7 Replacing the Ethernet


EM6T, EM6F, Interface Board
EMS6,
EM6TA,
EM6FA, and
EFP8

CF card 6.9 Replacing the CF Card

CSHN 6.10 Replacing the System


Control, Switching and Timing
Board

AUX 6.11 Replacing the Auxiliary


Board

SP3D and SP3S 6.5 Replacing the PDH Interface l ESD wrist strap
Board l Screwdriver

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 175


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 6 Part Replacement

Part Name Operation Tool

ISV3, IF1, 6.8 Replacing the IF Board l U2000


IFU2, ISX2,
ISU2, and IFX2

PIU 6.13 Replacing the Power Board

ML1 and MD1 6.6 Replacing the Smart E1


Interface Board

FAN 6.12 Replacing the Fan Board l ESD wrist strap


l U2000

ODU 6.15 Replacing the ODU l Ejector lever (torque wrench)


l U2000
l Silicon
l Waterproof adhesive tape

IF cable 6.16 Replacing the IF Cable l Multimeter


l Ejector lever
l Electro-technical knife
l File
l Installation parts and
accessories of the connector
l IF cable
l Waterproof adhesive tape

SFP 6.14 Replacing the SFP l ESD wrist strap


l Tweezer fiber remover
l U2000

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 176


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 6 Part Replacement

6.1 Removing a Board


Removing a board is a basic operation for replacing a board.

Procedure
Step 1 Insert one end of the ESD wrist strap into the ESD connector on the cabinet. Wear the ESD wrist
strap.

Figure 6-1 Wear the ESD wrist strap

Step 2 Optional: If cables are connected to the board, make labels for the cables and then remove the
cables.
NOTE

Use fiber removers to remove fibers or network cables.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 177


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 6 Part Replacement

Figure 6-2 Tweezer fiber remover

Step 3 Remove the board.


1. Loosen the screws on the panel of the board.

Figure 6-3 Removing a board (1)

2. Hold the left and right ejector levers with hands. Push them outwards to disengage the board
from the backplane.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 178


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 6 Part Replacement

Figure 6-4 Removing a board (2)

NOTE

As shown in Figure 6-5, there is a latch on each ejector lever of the System control Switch&Timing
board. To remove the System control Switch&Timing board, you need to push the latches when
pulling the ejector levers outward.

Figure 6-5 Removing the System control Switch&Timing board

3. Pull out the board gently along the slot guide rail.

Figure 6-6 Removing a board (3)

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 179


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 6 Part Replacement

NOTICE
Remove the board slowly to prevent the components on the boards from colliding.

Step 4 Put the removed board into the antistatic box or bag.

----End

6.2 Inserting a Board


Inserting a board is a basic operation for replacing a board.

Procedure
Step 1 Insert one end of the ESD wrist strap into the ESD connector on the cabinet. Wear the ESD wrist
strap.

Figure 6-7 Wear the ESD wrist strap

Step 2 Insert the board.


1. Hold the ejector levers on the panel with both hands. Push them outwards so that the angle
between the ejector lever and the panel is about 45 degrees.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 180


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 6 Part Replacement

2. Push the board gently along the slot guide rail until the board cannot slide further.

Figure 6-8 Inserting a board (1)

NOTICE
Insert the board slowly to prevent the components on the boards from colliding.

3. Press the two ejector levers inward with force.

Figure 6-9 Inserting a board (2)

4. Tighten screws on the panel.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 181


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 6 Part Replacement

Figure 6-10 Inserting a board (3)

Step 3 Optional: If cables are connected to the board, recover the original cable connections according
to the labels that are made previously.

----End

6.3 Replacing the SDH Optical Interface Board


When the SDH optical interface board is replaced, the unprotected services on the board are
interrupted.

Prerequisites
l You must know the impact of board replacement.
l You must know the specific position of the board to be replaced.
l You must know the service protection and protection channels of the board to be replaced.
l The spare SDH optical interface board must be available, and the version and type of the
spare board must be the same as the version and type of the board to be replaced. You can
query the board manufacturing information to obtain the version of the board to be
replaced.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


l ESD wrist strap
l Screwdriver
l U2000
l Fiber remover

Procedure
Step 1 Query the current alarms of the board.

Step 2 Optional: If the services on the board are configured with SNCP, ensure that the services are
already switched to the protection channel.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 182


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 6 Part Replacement

1. Query the SNCP protection group.


2. Perform the forced switching, if the port on the board functions as the current working
channel, the current protection channel is not on the board, and the state of the current
protection channel is normal or SD.

Step 3 Optional: If the services on the board are configured with linear MSP, ensure that the services
are already switched to the protection channel.
1. Query the linear MSP group.
2. Perform the forced switching, if the port on the board functions as the current working
channel, the current protection channel is not on the board, and the state of the current
protection channel is normal or SD.

Step 4 Remove the board.

Step 5 Check whether the version and SFP type of the spare board are the same as the version and SFP
type of the board to be replaced.

Step 6 Insert the board.

Step 7 After the board starts to work, check the STAT indicator on the board. The STAT indicator
should be on and green.

Step 8 Query the current alarms of the board.


There should be no new alarms on the board.

Step 9 Optional: If the forced switching has been performed on the board, release the forced switching.

Step 10 Optional: If the linear MSP switching has been performed for the services, release the forced
switching.

----End

6.4 Replacing the Channelized STM-1 Processing Board


When the channelized STM-1 processing board is replaced, the unprotected services on the board
are interrupted.

Prerequisites
l You must know the impact of board replacement.
l You must know the specific position of the board to be replaced.
l You must know the service protection and protection channels of the board to be replaced.
l The spare channelized STM-1 processing board must be available, and the version and type
of the spare board must be the same as the version and type of the board to be replaced.
You can query the board manufacturing information to obtain the version of the board
to be replaced.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


l ESD wrist strap
l Screwdriver

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 183


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 6 Part Replacement

l U2000
l Fiber remover

Procedure
Step 1 Query the current alarms of the board.

Step 2 Optional: If the services on the board are configured with linear MSP, ensure that the services
are already switched to the protection channel.
1. Query the linear MSP group.
2. Perform the forced switching, if the port on the board functions as the current working
channel, the current protection channel is not on the board, and the state of the current
protection channel is normal or SD.

Step 3 Remove the board.

Step 4 Check whether the version and SFP type of the spare board are the same as the version and SFP
type of the board to be replaced.

Step 5 Insert the board.

Step 6 After the board starts to work, check the STAT indicator on the board. The STAT indicator
should be on and green.

Step 7 Query the current alarms of the board.


There should be no new alarms on the board.

Step 8 Optional: If the linear MSP switching has been performed for the services, release the forced
switching.

----End

6.5 Replacing the PDH Interface Board


When the PDH interface board is replaced, the services on the board are interrupted.

Prerequisites
l You must know the impact of board replacement.
l You must know the specific position of the board to be replaced.
l You must know the service protection and protection channels of the board to be replaced.
l The spare board must be made available, and the version and type of the spare board must
be the same as those of the board to be replaced. You can query the board manufacturing
information to obtain the version of the board to be replaced.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


l ESD wrist strap
l Screwdriver
l U2000

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 184


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 6 Part Replacement

Procedure
Step 1 Query the current alarms of the board.

Step 2 Remove the board.

Step 3 Check and ensure that the version and type of the spare board are the same as the version and
type of the board to be replaced.

Step 4 Insert the board.

Step 5 After the board starts to work, check the indicators on the board. The STAT indicator should be
on and green.

Step 6 Query the current alarms of the board.


There should be no new alarms on the board.

----End

6.6 Replacing the Smart E1 Interface Board


When the Smart E1 Interface board is replaced, the services on the board are interrupted.

Prerequisites
l You must know the impact of board replacement.
l You must know the specific position of the board to be replaced.
l You must know the service protection and protection channels of the board to be replaced.
l The spare board must be available, and the version and type of the spare board must be the
same as the version and type of the board to be replaced. You can query the board
manufacturing information to obtain the version of the board to be replaced.

Tools, Instruments and Materials


l ESD wrist strap
l Screwdriver
l U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Query the current alarms of the board to be replaced.

Step 2 Remove the board.

Step 3 Verify that the spare board has the same board version and board type as the board to be replaced.

Step 4 Insert the spare board.

Step 5 After the substitute board starts to work, check the indicators on the board. The STAT indicator
is on and green.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 185


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 6 Part Replacement

NOTE

Smart E1 boards are hot-swappable. After the spare board is installed, it enters initialization state and starts to
work 2 minutes later.

Step 6 Query the current alarms of the substitute board.


There is no new alarm on the board.

----End

6.7 Replacing the Ethernet Interface Board


When the Ethernet interface board is replaced, the unprotected services on the board are
interrupted.

Prerequisites
l You must know the impact of board replacement.
l You must know the specific position of the board to be replaced.
l You must know the service protection and protection channels of the board to be replaced.
l The spare board must be made available, and the version and type of the spare board must
be the same as those of the board to be replaced. You can query the board manufacturing
information to obtain the version of the board to be replaced.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


l ESD wrist strap
l Screwdriver
l U2000
l Fiber remover

Procedure
Step 1 Query the current alarms of the board.

Step 2 Optional: If the services are configured with MPLS APS, ensure that the services are already
switched to the protection tunnel.
1. Querying MPLS APS Status.
2. If the board functions as the current working board, perform the forced switching.

Step 3 Optional: If the services are configured with PW APS, ensure that the services are already
switched to the protection PW.
1. Querying PW APS Status.
2. If the board functions as the current working board, perform the forced switching.

Step 4 Remove the board.

Step 5 Check and ensure that the board version and the model of the SFP module on the spare board
are the same as the board version and the model of the SFP module on the board to be replaced.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 186


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 6 Part Replacement

Step 6 Insert the board.


NOTE

Ethernet interface boards are hot-swappable. After the substitute board is installed, it enters initialization state
and starts working two minutes later.
If dynamic ARP is disabled on the NE at the opposite end of an MPLS tunnel, you need to change the static
ARP table entries of the opposite NE.

Step 7 After the board starts to work, check the indicators on the board. The STAT indicator should be
on and green.

Step 8 Query the current alarms of the board.


There should be no new alarms on the board.

Step 9 Optional: If the forced switching has been performed for the services, release the forced
switching.

----End

6.8 Replacing the IF Board


When the IF board is replaced, the unprotected services on the board are interrupted.

Prerequisites
l You must know the impact of board replacement.
l You must know the specific position of the board to be replaced.
l You must know the service protection and protection channels of the board to be replaced.
l The spare board must be available, and the version and type of the spare board must be the
same as the version and type of the board to be replaced. You can query the board
manufacturing information to obtain the version of the board to be replaced.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


l ESD wrist strap
l Screwdriver
l U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Query the current alarms of the board.

Step 2 Optional: If the services on the board are configured with SNCP, ensure that the services are
already switched to the protection channel.
1. Query the SNCP protection group.
2. If the port on the board functions as the current working channel, the current protection
channel is not on the board, perform the forced switching.

Step 3 Optional: If the services on the radio link are configured with 1+1 protection, switch the service
to the protection IF board.
1. Query the IF 1+1 protection group.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 187


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 6 Part Replacement

2. If the board functions as the current working board, perform the forced switching.

Step 4 Optional: If the services on the radio link are configured with N+1 protection, ensure that the
services are already switched to the protection IF board.
1. Query the IF N+1 protection group.
2. If the board functions as the current working board, perform the forced switching.

Step 5 Optional: If the services are configured with MPLS APS, ensure that the services are already
switched to the protection tunnel.
1. Querying MPLS APS Status.
2. If the board functions as the current working board, perform the forced switching.

Step 6 Optional: If the services are configured with PW APS, ensure that the services are already
switched to the protection PW.
1. Querying PW APS Status.
2. If the board functions as the current working board, perform the forced switching.

Step 7 Optional: If the IF board is configured with the XPIC function, see 8.1.3 Muting/Unmuting
an ODU and mute the ODU at the opposite end.

Step 8 Turn off the ODU-PWR switch on the front panel of the IF board to be replaced.

NOTICE
To turn off the ODU-PWR switch, you need to pull the switch lever outwards slightly and then
set the switch to the "O" position.

Step 9 Remove the board.

Step 10 Check and ensure that the version and type of the spare board are the same as the version and
type of the board to be replaced.

Step 11 Ensure that the ODU-PWR switch on the front panel of the spare IF board is turned off.

Step 12 Insert the board.

Step 13 After the board starts to work, check the indicators on the board. The STAT indicator should be
on and green.

Step 14 Turn on the ODU-PWR switch on the front panel of the IF board.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 188


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 6 Part Replacement

NOTICE
To turn on the ODU-PWR switch, you need to pull the switch lever outwards slightly and then
set the switch to the "I" position.
IF boards are hot-swappable. After the substitute board is installed, it enters initialization state
and starts working two minutes later.
If dynamic ARP is disabled on the NE at the opposite end of an MPLS tunnel, you need to change
the static ARP table entries of the opposite NE.

Step 15 Query the current alarms of the board.


There should be no new alarms on the board.

Step 16 Optional: If the forced switching has been performed for the services, release the forced
switching.

Step 17 Optional: If the forced protection switching has been performed for the radio link, release the
forced switching.

Step 18 If the IF board is configured with the XPIC function, see 8.1.3 Muting/Unmuting an ODU and
unmute the ODU at the opposite end.

----End

6.9 Replacing the CF Card


If the NE is configured with only one System control Switch&Timing board, all the services are
interrupted during the replacement of the CF card.

Prerequisites
l You must be aware of the impact of CF card replacement.
l You must know the specific position of the CF card to be replaced.
l You must be a user with "NE maintainer" authority or higher.
l You must obtain a spare CF card that has the same capacity as the CF card to be replaced.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


l ESD wrist strap
l U2000
l Fiber remover

Procedure
Step 1 Query the current alarms of the board.

Step 2 Optional: If the board is configured with 1+1 protection, ensure that the services are switched
from the current working board to the protection board.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 189


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 6 Part Replacement

1. See 8.9 Switching the System Control Unit and the Cross-Connect Unit, and ensure
that the current working board functions as the protection board.
2. If the board functions as the current working board, perform the manual switching.
Step 3 Remove the board.
Step 4 Remove the CF card according to the illustration in the following figure.

Step 5 Check the spare CF card.


Step 6 Install the spare CF card according to the illustration in the following figure.

Step 7 Insert the board.


Step 8 After the board starts to work, observe the indicators on the board. The STAT indicator should
be on and green.
Step 9 Query the current alarms of the board.
There should be no new alarms.
Step 10 Optional: If the manual switching has been performed on the board, release the manual
switching.

----End

6.10 Replacing the System Control, Switching and Timing


Board
All the services are interrupted during the period of replacing the system control, switching, and
timing board, if the NE is configured with only one system control switch and timing board.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 190


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 6 Part Replacement

Prerequisites
l You must be aware of the impact of board replacement.
l You must know the specific position of the board to be replaced.
l You must know the service protection and protection channels of the board to be replaced.
l The spare board must be made available, and the version and type of the spare board must
be the same as those of the board to be replaced. You can query the board manufacturing
information to learn about the version of the board to be replaced.

Impact on System
If no protection board is available, the replacement of the system control, switching, and timing
board results in service interruption.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


l ESD wrist strap
l Screwdriver
l U2000
l Fiber remover

Context
NOTE

After the NE database is restored successfully, a cold reset is automatically performed on the NE.

Procedure
Step 1 Query the current alarms of the board.

Step 2 Replace the system control, switching, and timing board.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 191


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 6 Part Replacement

If... Then...
One system control, switching, and 1. Notify the onsite maintenance personnel to
timing board is configured remove the board.
2. Verify that the version and type of the spare
board (including the patch version) are
correct.
NOTE
If the spare board and the board to be replaced have
different patch versions, contact Huawei
engineers for loading correct patches.
3. Remove the CF card from the original board
and then install the CF card to the spare board.
For details about how to install the CF card,
see 6.9 Replacing the CF Card.
4. Insert the spare board into the chassis.
5. Press and hold the CF RCV button on the
board for 8 seconds so that the board
automatically restores the NE databases,
system parameters, software packages, and
NE logs from the CF card.
NOTE
l In the process of restoring the NE database, the
PROG indicator on the board blinks green for
about 20 minutes.
l If the database restoration is successful, the
NE resets automatically. After the NE resets
successfully, the STAT and PROG indicators
are on and green.
l If the database restoration fails, the NE does
not reset, and the PROG is red. In this case,
contact Huawei technical support engineers
for rectifying the fault.
NOTE
After the NE starts up normally, the STAT and PROG
indicators on the board are green.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 192


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 6 Part Replacement

If... Then...
Two system control, switching, and 1. Before replacing a working system control,
timing boards are configured switching, and timing board, switch services
from the working board to the protection
board. For details, see 8.9 Switching the
System Control Unit and the Cross-
Connect Unit.
NOTICE
When the data of the working board is being
synchronized to the protection board or
synchronization data is being delivered to the chip
of the protection board, removing the working
board may interrupt services. Before removing the
working board, ensure that the board is in standby
status.
Wait until the protection switchover is completed,
and then go to the next step. A protection
switchover is completed only after the data of the
working board has been synchronized to the
protection board and synchronization data has
been delivered to the chip of the protection board.
2. After completing the protection switchover,
Remove the board to be replaced.
3. Check whether the version and type of the
spare board are the same as the version and
type of the board to be replaced.
4. Insert the spare board.
5. Wait for about 10 minutes to complete the
backup of the data on the main and standby
system control units.
NOTE
After the NE starts up normally, the STAT and PROG
indicators on the board are green.

Step 3 Query the current alarms of the board. There should be no new alarms.

----End

6.11 Replacing the Auxiliary Board


When the auxiliary board is replaced, the services on the auxiliary board are interrupted.

Prerequisites
l You must know the impact of board replacement.
l You must know the specific position of the board to be replaced.
l The spare board must be made available, and the version and type of the spare board must
be the same as those of the board to be replaced. You can query the board manufacturing
information to obtain the version of the board to be replaced.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 193


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 6 Part Replacement

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


l ESD wrist strap
l Screwdriver
l U2000
l Fiber remover

Procedure
Step 1 Query the current alarms of the board.
Step 2 Remove the board.
Step 3 Check and ensure that the version and type of the spare board are the same as the version and
type of the board to be replaced.
Step 4 Insert the spare board.
Step 5 After the board starts to work, check the indicators on the board. The STAT indicator should be
on and green.
Step 6 Query the current alarms of the board.
There should be no new alarms on the auxiliary board.

----End

6.12 Replacing the Fan Board


The IDU cannot perform air cooling in the process of replacing the fan board. Therefore, you
need to replace the fan board quickly.

Prerequisites
l You must be aware of the impact of board replacement.
l You must know the specific position of the board to be replaced.
l The spare board must be made available, and the version and type of the spare board must
be the same as those of the board to be replaced. You can query the board manufacturing
information to learn about the version of the board to be replaced.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


l ESD wrist strap
l U2000

Precautions

CAUTION
Do not touch the blades until the fan has stopped rotating.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 194


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 6 Part Replacement

Procedure
Step 1 Query the current alarms of the board.

Step 2 Move the cables away from the front panel of the fan board assembly.

Step 3 Loosen captive screws.

Step 4 Remove the fan board.

Step 5 Check and ensure that the version and type of the spare board are the same as the version and
type of the board to be replaced.

Step 6 Insert the standby fan board.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 195


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 6 Part Replacement

Step 7 Tighten captive screws.

Step 8 After the board starts to work, observe the indicators on the board. The FAN indicator should
be on and green.

Step 9 Query the current alarms of the board.


There should be no new alarms.

----End

6.13 Replacing the Power Board


If another power board works normally during the replacement period, the services at the IDU
are not affected.

Prerequisites
l You must be aware of the impact of board replacement.
l You must know the specific position of the board to be replaced.
l The spare board must be made available, and the version and type of the spare board must
be the same as those of the board to be replaced. You can query the board manufacturing
information to learn about the version of the board to be replaced.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


l ESD wrist strap
l Screwdriver
l U2000

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 196


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 6 Part Replacement

Precautions

CAUTION
Do not remove or insert the power plug when the power is on. Turn off the power switch before
removing the power cable from the PIU.

Procedure
Step 1 Query the current alarms of the board.

Step 2 Turn off the output power switch for the IDU on the power supply equipment.

Step 3 Remove the cables connected to the board.

Step 4 Remove the power board gently and horizontally along the guide rail.

Step 5 Ensure that the version and type of the spare board are the same as the version and type of the
board to be replaced.

Step 6 Insert the spare board steadily along the guide rail.

Step 7 Reconnect the cables between the board and the power supply equipment.

Step 8 Turn on the output power switch for the IDU.

Step 9 After the board starts to work, observe the indicators on the board. The PWR indicator should
be on and green.

Step 10 Query the current alarms of the board.


There should be no new alarms on the board.

----End

6.14 Replacing the SFP


When the small form pluggable (SFP) is replaced, the unprotected services on the optical/
electrical port are interrupted.

Prerequisites
l You must know the impact of SFP replacement.
l You must know the specific position of the SFP to be replaced.
l You must know the service protection and protection channels of the SFP to be replaced.
l The spare SFP must be available, and the version and type of the spare SFP must be the
same as the version and type of the SFP to be replaced. You can query the board
manufacturing information to obtain the version of the SFP to be replaced.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 197


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 6 Part Replacement

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


l ESD wrist strap
l Tweezer fiber remover
l U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Query the current alarms of the board.

Step 2 Optional: If SNCP is configured for services at the optical interface, ensure that the services
are already switched to the protection channel.
1. Query the status of the SNCP group.
2. If the port on the local board functions as the working channel, the protection channel does
not involve the local board, and the protection channel is in the normal or SD state, perform
forced switching.

Step 3 Optional: If linear MSP is configured for services at the optical interface, ensure that the services
are already switched to the protection channel.
1. Query the status of the linear MSP group.
2. If the port on the local board functions as the working channel, the protection channel does
not involve the local board, and the protection channel is in the normal or SD state, perform
forced switching.

Step 4 Record the cable connections of the SFP, and then disconnect cables.

Step 5 Check the types of the spare SFP and the SFP to be replaced, and remove the SFP module.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 198


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 6 Part Replacement

NOTE

l Hold the extraction lever to remove the optical module.

l Press the release button before removing the STM-1 electrical module.

1 Press the release button.

2 Remove the STM-1 electical module.

Step 6 Insert the standby SFP module and reconnect cables based on the record.

Step 7 Query the current alarms of the board.


There should be no new alarms on the board.

Step 8 Optional: If the forced switching has been performed on the board, release the forced switching.

Step 9 Optional: If the linear MSP switching has been performed for the services, release the forced
switching.

----End

6.15 Replacing the ODU


When the ODU is replaced, the unprotected services on the ODU are interrupted.

Prerequisites
l You must know the impact of ODU replacement.
l You must know the specific positions of the ODU to be replaced and the IF board connected
to the ODU.
l The spare ODU must be at hand, whose type must be the same as the type of the ODU to
be replaced.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 199


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 6 Part Replacement

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


l Ejector lever (torque spanner)
l U2000
l Silicon
l Waterproof adhesive tape

Precautions
Before you replace an ODU that is installed on the coupler, power off the ODU to be replaced,
but do not power off or mute the other ODU. Otherwise, the services may be affected. The
interface of the coupler ejects little RF radiation, thus meeting the safety standards for microwave
radiation.

Do not damage the coating when you replace an ODU. In the case of any coating damage, repair
the coating timely.

Procedure
Step 1 Query the current alarms on the ODU and then record the results.

Step 2 Turn off the ODU-PWR switch on the front panel of the IF board.

Step 3 Remove the IF cable and the PGND cable from the ODU.

Step 4 Remove the ODU.

Option Description
If... Then...
You need to remove the RTN 600 ODU Loosen the four latches of the ODU and
with a waveguide interface disconnect the ODU from the antenna, the
hybrid coupler, or ODU adapter.
You need to remove the RTN 600 ODU Remove the ODU from the post.
with a coaxial interface
You need to remove the RTN XMC ODU Loosen the captive screws on the ODU and
disconnect the ODU from the antenna, the
hybrid coupler, or ODU adapter.

Step 5 Ensure the type of the spare ODU is the same as the type of the ODU to be replaced.

Step 6 Install the ODU.

Option Description
If... Then...
You need to install a new RTN 600 ODU See the RTN 600 ODU Quick Installation
with a waveguide interface Guide.
You need to install a new RTN 600 ODU See the RTN 600 ODU Quick Installation
with a coaxial interface Guide.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 200


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 6 Part Replacement

Option Description
You need to install a new RTN XMC ODU See the RTN XMC ODU Installation Guide.

Step 7 Connect the PGND cable and the IF cable to the ODU.
Step 8 Waterproof the IF interface on the ODU.
Step 9 Turn on the ODU-PWR switch on the front panel of the IF board.
Step 10 After the ODU starts to work, check the LINK indicator and ODU indicator on the IF board.
The ODU indicator and LINK indicator should be on and green.
Step 11 Query the current alarms of the ODU. There should be no new alarms on the ODU.

----End

6.16 Replacing the IF Cable


When the IF cable is replaced, the unprotected services on the IF cable are interrupted.

Prerequisites
l You must know the impact of IF cable replacement.
l You must know the specific positions of the IF cable to be replaced and the IF board
connected to the IF jumper.
l In the case of the RG-8U IF cable or the 1/2-inch IF cable, an IF jumper is required to
connect the IF cable to the IDU and both ends of the IF cable should be terminated with
type-N connectors. In the case of the 5D IF cable, the IF cable is connected directly to the
IDU and the cable end connecting to the IDU should be terminated with the TNC connector
and the cable end connecting to the ODU should be terminated with the type-N connector.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


l Multimeter
l Ejector lever
l Electro-technical knife
l File
l Installation parts and accessories of the connector
l IF cable
l Waterproof adhesive tape

Procedure
Step 1 Query and record the current alarm of the IDU.
Step 2 Turn off the ODU-PWR switch on the front panel of the IF board.
Step 3 Disconnect the IF cable from the IF jumper and from the ODU.
Step 4 Use a multimeter to test the connectivity of the IF cable to determine whether you need to make
new connectors for the IF cable or replace the IF cable with a new one.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 201


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 6 Part Replacement

If... Then...
You need to make new connectors for the See the Installation Reference and make new
IF cable connectors for the IF cable.
You need to replace the IF cable with a new Replace the IF cable with a new one.
one

Step 5 Connect the IF cable to the IF jumper and to the ODU.


Step 6 Waterproof the connectors at the two ends of the IF cable with the waterproof adhesive tape.
Step 7 Turn on the ODU-PWR switch on the front panel of the IF board.
Step 8 After the ODU starts to work, check the LINK and ODU indicators on the IF board.
The ODU indicator and LINK indicator should be on and green.
Step 9 Query the current alarms of the IDU.
There should be no new alarms on the IDU.

----End

6.17 Erasing Data in the Repair Parts


The storage media on the system control board stores NE configuration data. If necessary, erase
data on the board before repair.

6.17.1 Board Storage Media


The storage media on the system control board has the flash memory and CF card.

Overview
OptiX RTN 980 has two types of storage media: CF card and flash memory. Both the CF card
and flash memory may contain configuration data. As shown in Table 6-2, the types of storage
media supported by the system control boards for the OptiX RTN 980 are listed.

Table 6-2 Types of storage media on the system control boards

Board Storage Media

CSHN l Flash memory (integrated on the system


control board)
l CF card (pluggable)

Positions of the Storage Media


DIP switches on the system control board are used for some special maintenance-related
operations, including formatting the flash memory.
For the positions of the CF card and the DIP switches for formatting the flash memory, see "DIP
Switches and CF Card" of the system control board in the IDU Hardware Description.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 202


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 6 Part Replacement

6.17.2 Removing the CF Card


If necessary, remove the CF card from the repaired system control board to ensure data security.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


l ESD wrist strap or ESD glove
l ESD bag for storing the removed CF card

NOTICE
Slowly and carefully remove the CF card, to prevent damages to the CF card or its card slot.

Procedure
Step 1 Wear an ESD wrist strap or ESD gloves during operations.
1. Put your hand through the ESD wrist strap, as shown inFigure 6-11.

Figure 6-11 Wearing an ESD wrist strap

2. Fasten the wrist strap to ensure good contact between the ESD wrist strap and your skin.
3. Connect the ground end of the ESD wrist strap to the ESD jack in the cabinet or chassis.

Step 2 Remove the CF card.

Step 3 Place the removed CF card to an ESD bag.

----End

6.17.3 Formatting the Flash Memory


If necessary, erase data in the flash memory by setting the DIP switches.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


l ESD wrist strap or ESD glove

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 203


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 6 Part Replacement

Procedure
Step 1 Wear an ESD wrist strap or ESD gloves during operations.
1. Put your hand through the ESD wrist strap, as shown inFigure 6-12.

Figure 6-12 Wearing an ESD wrist strap

2. Fasten the wrist strap to ensure good contact between the ESD wrist strap and your skin.
3. Connect the ground end of the ESD wrist strap to the ESD jack in the cabinet or chassis.

Step 2 Format the flash memory.


1. Remove the system control board from the chassis.
2. Set the BIOS DIP switches to binary values "1111".

When the DIP switches are set to "1111", the software will erase all data (except for board
manufacturing information), including data in the file system and the system parameter
area.

NOTE
For the positions of the DIP switches of system control boards, see "DIP Switches and CF Card" of
the system control board in the IDU Hardware Description.
3. Insert the system control board to the backup chassis, and power on the board. Observe the
RUN indicator. If the RUN indicator on the system control board blinks every 1s, the data
on the flash memory has been cleared.
NOTE
If the system control board cannot be powered on or the software fails to start, the preceding method
of clearing data from the flash memory by changing DIP switch settings is inapplicable. In this case,
contact Huawei technical support engineers.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 204


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 7 Database Backup and Restoration

7 Database Backup and Restoration

About This Chapter

The OptiX RTN 980 supports database backup and restoration through the NMS.

7.1 NE Database
An NE database stores communication data, security data, alarm data, performance data, and
configuration data of an NE in a certain structure, to facilitate data query and modification and
to ensure that the data can be restored after the NE is reset.

7.2 Backing Up the Database Manually


The NE configuration data is stored in the database of an NE. To prevent the database from
being damaged due to certain risky operations such as replacing a faulty system control, cross-
connect, and timing board or upgrading the software, you need to manually back up the database
on a regular basis and before performing any risk operation.

7.3 Setting the Database Backup Policy


You can set the policy of backing up a database to realize the function of periodically backing
up the database.

7.4 Restoring the Database by NMS


If the database is damaged, you can restore the NE database by using the database files that are
saved previously.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 205


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 7 Database Backup and Restoration

7.1 NE Database
An NE database stores communication data, security data, alarm data, performance data, and
configuration data of an NE in a certain structure, to facilitate data query and modification and
to ensure that the data can be restored after the NE is reset.

Three types of NE databases are available:

l Memory database (MDB)


The data in the MDB varies according to the configuration and is lost when the system
control unit is reset or when the NE is powered off.
l Dynamic random database (DRDB)
The DRDB automatically stores the data that is checked successfully. The DRDB is resident
in the reserved memory. Hence, the data in the DRDB is not lost when a warm reset is
performed on the system control unit. The data, however, is lost when a cold reset is
performed on the system control unit or when the NE is powered off.
l Flash database (FDB)
The FDB includes FDB0 and FDB1. The FDB is resident in the flash memory on the board.
Hence, the data in the FDB is permanently stored.

NE Database Backup
NE configuration data, after being delivered to the system control unit, is stored in the MDB.
Upon successful verification of the configuration data, the system control unit copies the data
from the MDB to DRDB and delivers the data to boards.

Two modes are available to back up DRDB data to the FDB:

l An NE backs up DRDB data to the FDB within five minutes after NE configuration data
is modified.
l An NE backs up DRDB data to the FDB every 24 hours.

The following modes are available to back up FDB data:

l Upon a scheduled backup of DRDB data to the FDB, the NE backs up FDB data to a
dedicated partition of the flash memory (other than FDB0 and FDB1).
l On the NMS, FDB data can be backed up to an NMS server manually or at specified
intervals.
l A CF card stores NE databases, system parameters (including NE-IPs, NE-IDs, subnet
masks, and LSR IDs), software packages, and NE logs.
NOTE

The software packages on a CF card are synchronized with those on the system control, switching, and
timing board only during package diffusion. Automatic or manual backup is not needed for software
package synchronization.
Ensure that the software version of the system control, switching, and timing board is the same as that in
a CF card. If the software packages on the system control, switching, and timing board are inconsistent
with those in a CF card, the SWDL_CHGMNG_NOMATCH alarm is reported.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 206


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 7 Database Backup and Restoration

NOTE

When you use the NMS to back up FDB data, system parameters such as NE-IPs, NE-IDs, or subnet masks
are not backed up, but LSR IDs are backed up.

NE Database Restoration
l When an NE is warm reset, the system control unit checks whether configuration data is
available in the DRDB. If configuration data is available in the DRDB, the system control
unit restores data from the DRDB. If the configuration data in the DRDB is damaged, the
system control unit restores data from FDB0 and FDB1.
l When the NE is cold reset, the system control unit restores data from FDB0 and FDB1.
l When the data in both FDB0 and FDB1 is damaged, data can be restored from the CF
card.
l On the NMS, the FDB data in flash memory can be restored from an NMS server without
interruption of TDM services.
l After you hold down the CRV button on the system control, switching, and timing board
for 8s, the data stored on the CF card will be synchronized to the board. To synchronize
the NE databases, system parameters, and NE logs from the system control, switching, and
timing board to the CF card, enable the regular backup function. The default backup interval
is 24 hours.

7.2 Backing Up the Database Manually


The NE configuration data is stored in the database of an NE. To prevent the database from
being damaged due to certain risky operations such as replacing a faulty system control, cross-
connect, and timing board or upgrading the software, you need to manually back up the database
on a regular basis and before performing any risk operation.

Prerequisites
l You must be an NM user with NE monitor authority or higher.
l You must log in to the NE.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

The Web LCT does not support this operation.

Procedure
Step 1 On the NMS, choose Administration > NE Software Management > NE Data Backup/
Restoration from the Main Menu.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 207


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 7 Database Backup and Restoration

Step 2 In NE View, click Find.

Step 3 In the Find NE dialog box, set the search conditions and search for the NE that requires database
backup.

Step 4 Click OK.

Step 5 Click Backup.


NOTE

Press and hold the Ctrl button on the keyboard, you can select multiple NEs to back up the data at one time.

Step 6 Set the data backup path to NMS Server or NMS Client according to the requirements.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 208


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 7 Database Backup and Restoration

Step 7 Click Start to start backing up the NE data. In NE View, Operation Status indicates the progress
of backing up the data. After the data backup is successful, Operation Status displays a message,
indicating that the operation is successful.

----End

7.3 Setting the Database Backup Policy


You can set the policy of backing up a database to realize the function of periodically backing
up the database.

Precautions
NOTE

During the database backup by the NMS, do not recover or backup data by USB flash drive.

7.3.1 Setting the User-Defined Backup Policy


Through this task, you can set the backup policy for a specific NE.

Prerequisites
l You must be an NM user with NE monitor authority or higher.
l You must log in to the NE.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

The Web LCT does not support this operation.

Background Information
Each NE has a default data backup policy.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 209


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 7 Database Backup and Restoration

l Database packages are backed up once at 2:00.


l The default backup policy is disabled by default.
l A maximum of five database packages can be backed up at a time.
l Data changes do not trigger any backup operations.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Administration > NE Software Management > NE Backup Policy Management
from the Main Menu.

Then, the NE Backup Policy Management dialog box is displayed.

Step 2 In Auto Backup Policy window, set NE type.


The version, name, and IP address of the selected NE are displayed.

Step 3 Click New Policy.

Step 4 Optional: Click to import the information of the NEs.

Step 5 Optional: Click to export the information of the NEs.


The information of the selected NEs is stored in the specified location.

Step 6 In NE Table, select one or more NEs.

Step 7 Click Next.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 210


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 7 Database Backup and Restoration

Then, the Setting Policy dialog box is displayed.

Step 8 Set Policy Name, Period Backup Policy, and Period Save Policy.
NOTE

l If The Added NE's Policy Status is set to Enable, the NMS performs the backup operation within
the specified period, day, and time.
l If The Added NE's Policy Status is set to Disable, the backup policy is still in the Disable state
although the policy period reaches the specified period, day, and time.

Step 9 Click Advanced Settings, and set Backup Type, Max Backup Num, and Configuration
Change Backup for a certain type of NEs.

Step 10 Click OK.

Step 11 Click OK.

----End

7.3.2 Enable the Backup Policy of the Device


Through this task, you can set the backup policy of a device to the running state.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE monitor authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

The Web LCT does not support this operation.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Administration > NE Software Management > NE Backup Policy Management
from the Main Menu.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 211


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 7 Database Backup and Restoration

Then, the NE Backup Policy Management dialog box is displayed.


Step 2 In Auto Backup Policy window, set NE type.
The version, name, and IP address of the selected NE are displayed.
Step 3 Right click the selected NE, Click Enable Backup Policy.

----End

7.3.3 Disable the Backup Policy of the Device


Through this task, you can set the backup policy of a device to the suspended state.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE monitor authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000
NOTE

The Web LCT does not support this operation.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Administration > NE Software Management > NE Backup Policy Management
from the Main Menu.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 212


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 7 Database Backup and Restoration

Then, the NE Backup Policy Management dialog box is displayed.

Step 2 In Auto Backup Policy window, set NE type.


The version, name, and IP address of the selected NE are displayed.

Step 3 Right click the selected NE, Click Disable Backup Policy.

----End

7.4 Restoring the Database by NMS


If the database is damaged, you can restore the NE database by using the database files that are
saved previously.

Prerequisites
l You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.
l The data to be restored must be backed up.
l You must log in to the NE.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 213


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 7 Database Backup and Restoration

Precautions
NOTE

During the database restoring by the NMS, do not recover or backup data by USB flash drive.

Procedure
Step 1 On the NMS, choose Administration > NE Software Management > NE Data Backup/
Restoration from the Main Menu.
NOTE

The equivalent operations on the Web LCT are as follows:

In NE List, click .
In Login, click OK.
For the DC, the default user name is szhw and the default password is nesoft. For the license tool, the default
user name is lct and the default password is password. If the user name or password has been changed, use the
latest one.

The NE Data Backup/Restoration window is displayed.

Step 2 In NE View, click Find.


Then, the Find NE dialog box is displayed.

Step 3 In the Find NE dialog box, set the search conditions to search for the NEs that need to restore
databases.

Step 4 Click OK.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 214


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 7 Database Backup and Restoration

Step 5 Select the NE whose data needs to be recovered, and click Recover.
NOTE

You can select multiple NEs to recover the data at one time.
Then, the Recover dialog box is displayed.

Step 6 Select Browse in File Name.


Then, the Select File dialog box is displayed.

Step 7 Select files from NMS Server or NMS Client, and then choose the files to be recovered. Click
OK.

Step 8 Set Activate Type to With Service Interruption and select Deliver To Board Activate.

NOTE

l If Activate Type is No Reboot, only database files are overwritten and the NE will not be warm reset. The
database does not take effect until the NE is reset.
l If Activate Type is With Service Interruption, database files will be overwritten, the NE will be warm
reset, and then the database will take effect.
l If Deliver To Board Activate is selected, the EFP8/EMS6 board will be instructed to perform a cold reset
during database activation.
l If Deliver To Board Activate is unselected, the EFP8/EMS6 board will not be cold reset.

Step 9 In the Recover dialog box, click Start.

Step 10 Click Yes in the prompt dialog box.


The system starts recovering the selected data files on the specified NE.
In the NE list of NE View, Operation Status indicates the progress of recovering the data.
After the data is recovered, Operation Status displays a message, indicating that the operation
is successful.

Step 11 In NE View, right-click the NE and choose Active Database from the shortcut menu.
The Active Database dialog box is displayed.

Step 12 Click Start to start activating the database.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 215


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 7 Database Backup and Restoration

NOTE

If the NE transmits data services, select Deliver to Board.


Services are interrupted during the activation of databases.
In NE View, Operation Status indicates the progress of activating the database. After the
database is activated, Operation Status indicates that the operation is successful.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 216


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

8 Common Maintenance Operations

About This Chapter

This section introduces common maintenance operations.

8.1 Microwave Link Troubleshooting


This section describes common maintenance operations related to microwave link
troubleshooting.
8.2 Ethernet Service Troubleshooting
This section describes common maintenance operations related to Ethernet service
troubleshooting.
8.3 TDM/CES Service Troubleshooting
This section describes common maintenance operations related to TDM/CES service
troubleshooting.
8.4 Software Loopback
Software loopback refers to the loopback operation that is implemented by using the NMS.
During software loopback, you need not visit the engineering site. Hence, software loopback is
used more widely than hardware loopback.
8.5 Hardware Loopback
Hardware loopback refers to the loopback operation performed by changing the physical
connection.
8.6 Reset
Reset is an important method of troubleshooting software faults. Reset is classified into cold
reset, warm reset.
8.7 Setting the Automatic Release Function
To protect the communication between the NMS and NE against improper operations, an NE
supports the automatic release of the ODU muting, software loopback, and other operations that
require you to exercise caution. The automatic release time is five minutes by default. You can
set whether to enable the automatic release function and the automatic release time through the
NMS.
8.8 Querying Power Consumption of Boards
This section describes how to query power consumption of the ODU and each board.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 217


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

8.9 Switching the System Control Unit and the Cross-Connect Unit
When the is configured with two system control, cross-connect, and timing boards, you can
manually switch the system control unit and the cross-connect unit as required.

8.10 Cleaning Fiber Connectors and Adapters


The optical connectors are easily contaminated in the maintenance process. The minute dust
particles that can be seen only in the microscope can also affect the quality of optical signals. In
this case, the system performance deteriorates. Hence, the fiber connectors or adapters that are
terminated need to be cleaned in time.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 218


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

8.1 Microwave Link Troubleshooting


This section describes common maintenance operations related to microwave link
troubleshooting.

8.1.1 Monitoring Radio Link Indicators


This section describes how to collect high-density samples about the RSL and MSE indicators
of radio links for monitoring. The longest monitoring duration is 48 hours.

Prerequisites
l You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the same as those on the U2000.

Procedure
Step 1 Navigate to the interface for monitoring the RSL and MSE indicators of radio links.

Step 2 Configure parameters for monitoring the RSL and MSE indicators of radio links.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 219


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

Set the monitoring


5
duration. The
maximum value is
48 hours.

Set the monitored 3 6


4 object.

Step 3 Query the monitoring result.

7 8 9

Set the query type. Set the time range of


The query result of the MSE the query.
is displayed in green and that
of the RSL is displayed in red.

----End

8.1.2 Scanning Interfering Signals


You can learn whether intra-frequency or inter-frequency interference exists by scanning
frequency spectra in microwave channels.

Prerequisites
l You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.
l Mute the ODU at the opposite end, before scanning the reference signal.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 220


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from Object tree in the NE Explorer.
NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the same as those on the U2000.

Step 2 Choose Diagnosis&Maintenance > ODU Frequency Scan.


NOTE

The equivalent operations on the Web LCT are as follows:


Choose Diagnosis&Maintenance > ODU Frequency Scan.
Set the parameters, colick Start to Scan.

Step 3 Set the parameters, click Start to Scan.


NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the similar to those on the U2000.

----End

8.1.3 Muting/Unmuting an ODU


The state of an ODU transmitter can be mute or unmute. When the ODU transmitter is in the
unmute state, the ODU transmits and receives microwave signals normally. When the ODU
transmitter is in the mute state, the ODU transmitter does not work, but the ODU can receive
microwave signals.

Prerequisites
l You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.
l The corresponding IF boards and the ODUs connected to the IF boards must be added to
the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the same as those on the U2000.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 221


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

Procedure
Step 1 Select the ODU from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > ODU
Interface from the Function Tree.

Step 2 Click the Advanced Attributes tab.

Step 3 Set Configure Transmission Status for the ODU.

NOTE

l In normal cases, Configure Transmission Status is set to unmute.


l If Configure Transmission Status is set to mute, the transmitter of the ODU does not work but can
normally receive microwave signals.
l If Configure Transmission Status is set to unmute, the ODU can normally transmit and receive
microwave signals.

Step 4 Click Apply.

----End

8.1.4 Performing a PRBS Test for the IF Board


If a special test tool is unavailable, you can perform the PRBS test by using the embedded test
system on the IF board.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the same as those on the U2000.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 222


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

Precautions

Figure 8-1 PRBS test of the IF board

IF board ODU ODU IF board

PRBS
transmitter
1 1 1

PRBS
transmitter

NE at the local end NE at the opposite end


1 IF port outloop

NOTICE
l During the PRBS test, the services in the tested path are interrupted.
l The PRBS test can be performed only in one path and in one direction at one time.
l The standby IF unit does not support the PRBS test. Before you perform the PRBS test for
the standby IF board of a 1+1 HSB/FD/SD protection group, you must switch the standby
IF board to the working state.

Procedure
Step 1 Configure an outloop on the peer IF board by referring to instructions in 8.4.7 Setting Loopback
for the IF Board and .

Step 2 Start a PRBS test on the IF board.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 223


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

Select the desired IF board.


Configure the
test time. 5
1 4

Select the desired PRBS test type.


Two PRBS test types are available: 3
a. PRBS frames are transmitted through the Select an E1 path.
specified E1 timeslot. This parameter is
b. PRBS frames are transmitted as Ethernet mandatory only for
frames. E1 PRBS tests.

2 6

Step 3 View test results.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 224


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

8
View test results.

Green indicates no
exception.

9 View the test


report.

No bit error is found,


indicating that the link
works properly.

10

----End

8.2 Ethernet Service Troubleshooting


This section describes common maintenance operations related to Ethernet service
troubleshooting.

8.2.1 Querying the Attributes of an Ethernet Port


Through the operation, you can learn about the attributes of an Ethernet port, such as rate.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 225


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

Procedure
Step 1 Optional: Query the attributes of the FE or GE port on the packet plane.
NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the same as those on the U2000.
1. In NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree.
2. Choose Configuration > Interface Management > Ethernet Interface from the Function
Tree.
3. Click the Advanced Attributes tab.
4. Check the parameters such as Port Physical Parameters, Transmitting Rate, and
Receiving Rate.
Step 2 Optional: Querying the attributes of the port.
NOTE

The Web LCT does not support this operation.


1. In NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree.
2. Choose Configuration > Interface Management > Microwave Interface from the
Function Tree.
3. Click the Advanced Attributes tab.
4. Check the parameters such as Transmitting Rate and Receiving Rate.
Step 3 Optional: Query the attributes of the external port on the EFP8 board.
NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the same as those on the U2000.
1. In NE Explorer, select the EFP8 board from the Object Tree.
2. Choose Configuration > Ethernet Interface Management > Ethernet Interface from
the Function Tree.
3. Select External Port.
4. Click the Advanced Attributes tab.
5. Check the parameters such as Transmitting Rate and Receiving Rate.
NOTE

By performing this operation, you can query the attributes of the external ports on the EFP8 board (PORT1 to
PORT8) and the attributes of the bridging port on the EFP8 board (PORT9).

----End

8.2.2 Searching for Service Paths Based on VLANs


For E-Line services, this operation can display the transmission path of the VLAN service flow
on one access port. For E-LAN services, this operation can display the broadcast domain to
which the VLAN belongs.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.
End-to-end Ethernet services have been deployed.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 226


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

Procedure
Step 1 Optional: Search for an E-Line service path.

Step 2 Optional: Search for an E-LAN service path.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 227


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

8.2.3 Searching for Service Paths Based on MAC Addresses


For E-LAN services, this operation allows the information of a MAC address learned by each
NE on a service path to be displayed, illustrating the entire service path through which packets
with the MAC address being the source address travel.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

End-to-end Ethernet services have been deployed.

Procedure
Step 1 Search for an E-LAN service path.

Step 2 Query the Learning of MAC Addresses.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 228


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

----End

8.2.4 Checking the Layer 2 Protocols Used by Ethernet Services


This section describes how to check the Layer 2 protocols, including ERPS, MSTP, and STP,
used by E-LAN services based on service paths.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

End-to-end Ethernet services have been created and the related fibers/cables have been created.

Procedure
Step 1 Search for an E-LAN service path.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 229


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

Step 2 Check the Layer 2 protocols used by the E-LAN services.

----End

8.2.5 Performing Intelligent Service Fault Diagnosis for Ethernet


Services
This section describes how to intelligently diagnose faults of Ethernet services based on service
paths.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.
End-to-end Ethernet services have been deployed.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 230


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

Procedure
Step 1 Search for services.

Step 2 Select a service to be diagnosed by specifying a service port.

Step 3 Diagnose the service and display the result.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 231


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

----End

8.2.6 Performing E-LAN Service Loopback Detection


This section checks whether a loopback occurs on Ethernet services based on service paths.
Users can quickly rectify a data storm on a loop after finding out the loopback point.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

End-to-end Ethernet services have been created and the related fibers/cables have been created.

Procedure
Step 1 Search for an E-LAN service path.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 232


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

Step 2 Perform E-LAN service loopback detection.

NOTE

If a service is looped back, can be seen from the icons .

----End

8.2.7 Monitoring Ethernet Service Performance and Traffic Volume


Based on Service Paths
This section describes how to monitor Ethernet service performance based on service paths.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 233


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

End-to-end Ethernet services have been created and the related fibers/cables have been created.

Procedure
Step 1 Search for service paths.

Step 2 Query the real-time and historical performance data of each measured object on each service
path.

The following figure shows how to query the real-time performance data of priority queues on
a port. Querying the real-time and historical performance data of other measured objects is
similar.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 234


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

----End

8.2.8 Querying Ethernet Service QoS Configurations Based on


Service Paths
This section describes how to query Ethernet service QoS configurations based on service paths.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

End-to-End Ethernet services and associated fibers have been created.

Procedure
Step 1 Search out service paths.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 235


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

Step 2 Select the service to be diagnosed by specifying service ports.

Step 3 Query QoS configurations.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 236


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

----End

8.2.9 Monitoring Ethernet Packets Through Port Mirroring


To monitor and analyze the Ethernet packets at a port, you can enable the port mirroring function
so that the received or transmitted packets on the port are duplicated to another Ethernet port to
which the Ethernet tester is connected. Then, you can monitor and analyze the packets.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the same as those on the U2000.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 237


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

Context

Figure 8-2 Schematic diagram of Ethernet port mirroring


NE under port mirroring

Forwarding
Mirroring Port
Ethernet equipment port

Duplication Ethernet equipment


Monitoring
port

Ethernet tester

The port mirroring can be performed in two directions.

For the physical ports of:

l In the ingress direction


Also in the upstream direction. The equipment duplicates the packets received from the
mirroring port to the observing port, and then transmits the packets from the observing port
to the Ethernet tester.
l In the egress direction
Also in the downstream direction. The equipment duplicates the packets transmitted by the
mirroring port to the observing port, and then transmits the packets from the observing port
to the Ethernet tester.

For the VCTRUNK of EFP8/EMS6:


l In the upstream direction, the ports mirror the data transmitted from the VCTRUNK to the
TDM side.
l In the downstream direction, the ports mirror the data transmitted from the TDM side to
the VCTRUNK.

Procedure
Step 1 Select operations according to the Ethernet board type.

In the case of... Then...

Ethernet boards exclude EFP8/EMS6 Perform Step 2 toStep 5.

EFP8/EMS6 boards Perform Step 6 toStep 9.

Step 2 In NE Explorer, select the NE.

Step 3 Choose Configuration > Port Mirroring from the Function Tree.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 238


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

Step 4 Click New, and set Mirror Name, Select the Direction of Mirror Source Function Point,
Mirror Source Function Point, and Mirror Observation Point.

Step 5 Click OK.

Step 6 In NE Explorer, select the EFP8 or EMS6 board.

Step 7 Choose Configuration > Ethernet Interface Management > Port Mirroring from the
Function Tree.

Step 8 Click New, and set Mirrored Port, Mirrored Upstream Port, and Mirrored Downstream
Port.

Step 9 Click OK.

----End

8.2.10 Using the Ethernet Test Frames


By using the Ethernet test frames, you can check the connectivity of VCTRUNKs. Only the
EFP8 board supports this operation.

Prerequisites
l You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.
l The service traffic is encapsulated or mapped by using the GFP method.

Tools, Instruments, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the same as those on the U2000.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 239


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

Background Information
The Ethernet board uses the specific GFP management frame or Ethernet frame as the test frame.
One frame is transmitted to the opposite Ethernet board per second. After receiving the test
frame, the Ethernet board returns the response frame. Upon receiving the response frame, the
Ethernet service processing board at the local end can judge the connectivity of the VCTRUNK
in between.

Figure 8-3 Ethernet test frames between Ethernet boards

Test frame

Local Remote
Ethernet Ethernet
board board
Response frame

Precautions

NOTICE
Do not use the test frames when the network traffic is heavy.

Procedure
Step 1 In NE Explorer, select the EFP8 board.
Step 2 Choose Configuration > Ethernet Maintenance > Ethernet Test from the Function Tree.
Then, the Ethernet Test dialog box is displayed.
Step 3 Select the test port and click Clear Counters. Select Clear All Counters.
Step 4 Set Send Mode and Frames to Send.
NOTE

It is recommended that you choose "Burst mode", and a maximum of 10 frames can be transmitted each
time.

Step 5 Click Apply.


The system starts transmitting and receiving test frames.
Step 6 After Status displays Finished Sending, click Query.
Step 7 Check Counter of Frames Sent and Counter of Received Response of Test Frame.
Test frames are used to check the network connectivity. If some of the test frames are lost but
no alarm is reported on the SDH side, you can infer that the network is normal. If all the test
frames are lost, you can infer that the network is faulty.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 240


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

Related Information
If you choose the continue mode, the local port transmits test frames continuously until the test
is disabled.

8.3 TDM/CES Service Troubleshooting


This section describes common maintenance operations related to TDM/CES service
troubleshooting.

8.3.1 Setting the On/Off State of the Laser


When performing operations such as testing a fiber cut, you can set the on/off state of the laser
rather than removing and re-inserting the optical fiber on site.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the same as those on the U2000.

Procedure
Step 1 Select the desired SDH optical interface board or the channelized STM-1 processing board from
the Object Tree in the NE Explorer.

Operation object Operation Steps

SDH optical interface board 1. Choose Configuration > SDH


Interface from the Function Tree.
2. Choose By Function.
3. Select Laser Switchfrom the drop-down
list.
4. Select a port, and then set Laser Switch.

channelized STM-1 processing board 1. Choose Configuration > Interface


Management > SDH Interface from the
Function Tree.
2. Select Basic Attributes.
3. Select a port, and then set Laser Interface
Status.

Step 2 Click Apply.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 241


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

A confirmation dialog box is displayed.


Step 3 Click OK.
A prompt is displayed.
Step 4 Click OK.

----End

8.3.2 Setting the ALS Function


The SDH optical interface board supports the automatic laser shutdown (ALS) function. This
function enables the board to turn off a laser when the board does not transmit services, the
optical fiber is faulty, or the received optical signals are lost.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the same as those on the U2000.

Procedure
Step 1 Select the desired SDH optical interface board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer.
Step 2 Choose Configuration > Automatic Laser Shutdown from the Function Tree.
Step 3 Select a port, and then set Automatic Shutdown to Enabled.
Step 4 Click Apply to save the settings.
Step 5 Close the dialog box that is displayed.

----End

8.3.3 Performing a PRBS Test for the Smart E1 Processing Board


If a special test tool is unavailable, you can perform the PRBS test by using the embedded test
system on the Smart E1 processing board.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the same as those on the U2000.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 242


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

Context
The OptiX RTN 980 supports the PRBS test in the UNI direction and in the NNI direction.

The PRBS test in the UNI direction can be performed to check the cable connect to the Smart
E1 processing board, as shown in Figure 8-4.

Figure 8-4 PRBS test in the tributary direction


Smart E1
processing unit
PRBS
Transmitter

PRBS
Recevicer

1 Loopback at the port

The PRBS test in the NNI direction can be performed to check the connection between the Smart
E1 processing board and the remote NE, as shown in Figure 8-5.

Figure 8-5 PRBS test in the NNI direction


Smart E1 Cross-connect ETH service ETH service
processing unit Unit processing unit processing unit
OUT
PRBS
transmitter
1 2 3

PRBS
IN
receiver

NE at the local end NE at the opposite end

1 ETH port inloop 2 ETH port outloop 3 ETH port inloop

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 243


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

Precautions

NOTICE
l During the PRBS test, the services in the tested path are interrupted.
l The PRBS test can be performed only in one path and in one direction at one time.
l A PRBS test can be performed for a CES service that is encapsulated in CESoPSN mode and
is carried by timeslots 1 to 31 on either UNI or NNI side.
l In a PRBS test in the NNI direction for an SATOP CES service, the LOOP_ALM alarm will
be reported on the E1 service where this service is deployed.

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the same as those on the U2000.

Procedure
Step 1 Configure a loopback as required by referring to Figure 8-4 and Figure 8-5.

Step 2 Start a PRBS test for the smart E1 processing board


Specify the port type, frame
Select the desired format, test period, and test
smart E1 board in 3 duration (1 to 255)
the NE Explorer.

Step 3 View test results.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 244


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

View test results, Green


indicates no exception.

The number of bit errors


and BER is 0, indicating
no exception.

----End

8.3.4 Performing a PRBS Test for the Tributary Board


If a special test tool is unavailable, you can perform the PRBS test by using the embedded test
system on the tributary board.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Context
The OptiX RTN 980 supports the PRBS test in the tributary direction and in the cross-connect
direction.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 245


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

The PRBS test in the tributary direction can be performed to check the connection between the
tributary board and the DDF, as shown in Figure 8-6.

Figure 8-6 PRBS test in the tributary direction


DDF frame PDH unit

PRBS
Transmitter

PRBS
Recevicer

1 Loopback at the DDF frame

The PRBS test in the cross-connect direction can be performed to check the connection between
the tributary board and the remote NE, as shown in Figure 8-7.

Figure 8-7 PRBS test in the cross-connect direction


a) IF board working as the line board

PDH interface Cross-connect


board board IF board IF board
OUT
PRBS
transmitter
1 2 3

PRBS
IN
receiver

NE at the local end NE at the opposite end

1 VC-4 inloop or 2 IF port inloop 3 IF port outloop


composite port inloop

b) Line board working as the SDH optical interface board


SDH optical
PDH interface board Cross-connect board interface board
OUT
PRBS
transmitter

1 2 3

PRBS
receiver IN

NE at the local end NE at the opposite end

1 VC-4 inloop 2 Port inloop 3 Port outloop

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 246


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

Precautions

NOTICE
l During the PRBS test, the services in the tested path are interrupted.
l The PRBS test can be performed only in one path and in one direction at one time.
l If you perform a PRBS test in the tributary direction of a port on the SP3S/SP3D board, the
services carried on the other ports may be interrupted transiently.

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the same as those on the U2000.

Procedure
Step 1 Configure a loopback as required by referring to Figure 8-6 and Figure 8-7.

Step 2 Start a PRBS test for the tributary board.


Configure the port type, test
period, and test duration (1
3 to 255).

Select an E1
interface board in the
NE Explorer.
1

Step 3 View test results.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 247


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

View test results. Green


indicates no exception.

The number of bit errors


and the BER are 0,
indicating no exception.

----End

8.3.5 Querying the Impedance of an E1 Channel


The impedance of an E1 channel is 75 ohms or 120 ohms.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the same as those on the U2000.

Procedure
Step 1 Select a PDH tributary board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 248


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

Step 2 Choose Configuration > PDH Interface from the Function Tree.
Step 3 Select By Board/Port(Channel).
Step 4 Select Port in the list.
Step 5 Select a port, and check Port Impedance.

----End

8.4 Software Loopback


Software loopback refers to the loopback operation that is implemented by using the NMS.
During software loopback, you need not visit the engineering site. Hence, software loopback is
used more widely than hardware loopback.

8.4.1 Setting Loopback for the SDH Optical Interface Board


The SDH optical interface board supports the optical/electrical interface inloop/outloop and the
VC-4 path inloop/outloop.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the similar to those on the U2000.

Context
The optical/electrical interface inloop is a process wherein the signals over an SDH port are
looped back at the overhead processing unit towards the backplane.

Figure 8-8 Optical/electrical interface inloop

SDH optical
Backplane interface board

SDH

The optical/electrical interface outloop is a process wherein the signals over an SDH port are
looped back at the overhead processing unit towards the remote equipment.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 249


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

Figure 8-9 Optical/electrical interface outloop

SDH optical
Backplane interface board

SDH

The VC-4 path outloop is a process wherein the signals on a VC-4 path are looped back at the
logic processing unit towards the remote equipment.

Figure 8-10 VC-4 path outloop

SDH optical
Backplane
interface board

VC-4

The VC-4 path inloop is a process wherein the signals on a VC-4 path are looped back at the
logic processing unit towards the backplane.

Figure 8-11 VC-4 path inloop

SDH optical
Backplane
board

VC-4

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 250


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

Precautions

NOTICE
l The services may be interrupted at the port or on the path where the loopback is performed.
l A software loopback may be released automatically after a certain period (five minutes, by
defaults). For details, see 8.7 Setting the Automatic Release Function.

Procedure
Step 1 Select the SDH optical interface board from the NE Explorer.
NOTE
The SDH optical interface boards described in this section include the physical SL1D and SL1DA board and
the logical SL4D board that the physical CSHN board maps.

Step 2 Choose Configuration > SDH Interface from the Function Tree.

Step 3 Select By Function, and select the loopback mode from the drop-down list.

To Perform... Choose...
Optical/electrical interface loopback Optical(Electrical) Interface Loopback
VC-4 path loopback VC4 Loopback

Step 4 Set the loopback status of the port or path based on the requirements.

Step 5 Click Apply.


Then, the Confirm dialog box is displayed.

Step 6 Click OK.

Step 7 Close the dialog box that is displayed.

----End

8.4.2 Setting Loopback for the Channelized STM-1 Processing


Board
The channelized STM-1 processing board supports the optical/electrical interface inloop/
outloop.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 251


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the similar to those on the U2000.

Context
The optical/electrical interface inloop is a process wherein the signals over an STM-1 port are
looped back at the overhead processing unit towards the backplane.

Figure 8-12 Optical/electrical interface inloop

Channelized STM-1
Processing Board
backplane

VC-12

The optical/electrical interface outloop is a process wherein the signals over an STM-1 port are
looped back at the overhead processing unit towards the remote equipment.

Figure 8-13 Optical/electrical interface outloop

Channelized STM-1
backplane Processing Board
VC-12

Precautions

NOTICE
l The services may be interrupted at the port or on the path where the loopback is performed.
l A software loopback may be released automatically after a certain period (five minutes, by
defaults). For details, see 8.7 Setting the Automatic Release Function.

Procedure
Step 1 Select the channelized STM-1 processing board from the Object Tree.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 252


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

Step 2 Choose Configuration > Interface Management > SDH Interface from the Function Tree.
Step 3 Select Advanced Attributes tab.

Step 4 Set the loopback status of the port or path based on the requirements.
Step 5 Click Apply.
Then, the Confirm dialog box is displayed.
Step 6 Click OK.
Step 7 Close the dialog box that is displayed.

----End

8.4.3 Setting Loopback for the Tributary Board


The tributary board supports the tributary inloop and outloop.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the same as those on the U2000.

Context
The tributary inloop is a process wherein the signals over a PDH port are looped back at the
coding/decoding unit towards the backplane.

Figure 8-14 Tributary inloop

Backplane PDH interface board

PDH

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 253


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

The tributary outloop is a process wherein the signals on a tributary path are looped back at the
PDH interface board of the local IDU towards the remote equipment.

Figure 8-15 Tributary outloop

Backplane PDH interface board

PDH

Precautions

NOTICE
The services may be interrupted on the port or on the path where the loopback is performed.

Procedure
Step 1 Select the PDH interface board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer.

Step 2 Choose Configuration > PDH Interface from the Function Tree.

Step 3 Select By Function, and select Tributary Loopback from the drop-down list.

Step 4 Set the loopback status of the path based on the requirements.

Step 5 Click Apply.


Then, the Confirm dialog box is displayed.

Step 6 Click OK.

Step 7 Close the dialog box that is displayed.

----End

8.4.4 Setting a Loopback for the Smart E1 Processing Board


A Smart E1 processing board supports inloops and outloops on E1 ports.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 254


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Instruments, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the similar to those on the U2000.

Context
The E1 inloop is a process wherein the signals over an E1 port are looped back from the coding/
decoding unit to the backplane.

Figure 8-16 E1 inloop

Smart E1
Backplane Processing Board

E1

The E1 outloop is a process wherein the signals over an E1 port are looped back from the Smart
E1 processing board of the local IDU to the remote equipment.

Figure 8-17 E1 outloop

Smart E1
Backplane Processing Boards

E1

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 255


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

Precautions

NOTICE
l The services may be interrupted at the port or on the path where the loopback is performed.
l A software loopback may be released automatically within a period (5 minutes, by default).
For details, see 8.7 Setting the Automatic Release Function.

Procedure
Step 1 Select the Smart E1 processing board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer.

Step 2 Choose Configuration > Interface Management > PDH Interface from the Function Tree.

Smart E1
Backplane Processing Board

E1

Step 3 In the Advanced Attributes tab, select the required port.

Step 4 Set the loopback status of the port as required.

Step 5 Click Apply.


The system displays a prompt dialog box for confirmation.

Step 6 Click OK.

Step 7 Close the dialog box.

----End

8.4.5 Setting a Loopback for the Packet-plane Ethernet Interface


Board
The Packet-plane Ethernet interface board supports the Ethernet port inloop (at the MAC layer
and PHY layer).

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 256


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the similar to those on the U2000.

Context
The Ethernet port MAC inloop is a process wherein the Ethernet physical signals are looped
back at the service processing module of the board at the MAC layer towards the backplane.
The Ethernet port PHY inloop is a process wherein the Ethernet frame signals are looped back
at the interface module of the board at the PHY layer towards the backplane.

Figure 8-18 Ethernet port inloop

Ethernet service
Backplane
processing board

MAC PHY

Precautions
NOTE

The tributary boards described in this section include the physical EM6TA, EM6FA, EM6T and EM6F boards
and the logical EG2D board that the physical CSHN board map.
PORT 10 on the EFP8 board can not be configured with loops.
PORT 8 on the EMS6 board can not be configured with loops.

NOTICE
l A loopback operation results in service interruption.
l A software loopback may be released automatically after a certain period (five minutes, by
defaults). For details, see 8.7 Setting the Automatic Release Function.

NOTICE
When Port Mode of an Ethernet port is set to Layer 3, do not perform any loopback on the port.
In this case, LSP Traceroute is recommended for locating faults.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 257


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

Procedure
Step 1 Select an Ethernet processing board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer.

Step 2 Select the corresponding function options from the Function Tree based on the loopback type.

To Perform... Choose...
PHY loopback 1. Choose Configuration > Interface Management > Ethernet
Interface from the Function Tree.
2. Click the Advanced Attributes tab.
MAC loopback 1. Choose Configuration > Interface Management > Ethernet
Interface from the Function Tree.
2. Click the Advanced Attributes tab.

Step 3 Set the loopback status of the port based on the requirements.

Step 4 Click Apply.


Then, the Confirm dialog box is displayed.

Step 5 Click OK.

Step 6 Close the dialog box that is displayed.

----End

8.4.6 Setting Loopbacks for the EOS/EoPDH-Plane Ethernet


Interface Board
EPF8 board supports the inloop at Ethernet ports (at the MAC layer and PHY layer) and the
inloop in VC-12 paths. EMS6 board supports the inloop at Ethernet ports (at the MAC layer and
PHY layer) and the inloop in VC-3 paths.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the similar to those on the U2000.

Context
A MAC layer inloop is an inloop where the service processing module loops back the Ethernet
physical signals towards the backplane through the MAC layer. A PHY layer inloop is an inloop
where the interface module loops back the Ethernet frame signals towards the backplane through
the PHY layer.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 258


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

NOTE

PORT 9 in the EFP8 board only supports inloop at the MAC layer.
PORT 7 in the EMS6 board only supports inloop at the MAC layer.

Figure 8-19 Ethernet port inloop

Ethernet service
Backplane
processing board

MAC PHY

An inloop in a VC-12 path is an inloop where the logic processing unit of a board loops back
the signals in a specific VC-12 path towards the backplane.

Figure 8-20 VC-12 path inloop

Backplane EFP8

EOPDH

An inloop in a VC-3 path is an inloop where the logic processing unit of a board loops back the
signals in a specific VC-3 path towards the backplane.

Figure 8-21 VC-3 path inloop

Backplane EMS6

EOS

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 259


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

Precautions

NOTICE
l A loopback operation may interrupt the services on the port where the loopback is performed.
l A software loopback may be automatically released within a period (five minutes by default).
For details, see 8.7 Setting the Automatic Release Function.

NOTE

A VC-3 loopback can be performed only after the EMS6 is configured with services.

Procedure
Step 1 In NE Explorer, select the required board from the Object Tree.

Step 2 Select the corresponding function options from the Function Tree according to the loopback
type.

To Perform... Choose...
PHY loopback 1. Choose Configuration > Ethernet Interface Management >
Ethernet Interface from the Function Tree.
2. Select External Port.
3. Click the Basic Attributes tab.
MAC loopback 1. Choose Configuration > Ethernet Interface Management >
Ethernet Interface from the Function Tree.
2. Select External Port.
3. Click the Basic Attributes tab.
VC-12 path inloop 1. Choose Configuration > SDH Interface from the Function Tree.
2. Select By Function.
3. Select the required VC-12 path.
VC-3 path inloop 1. Choose Configuration > SDH Interface from the Function Tree.
2. Select By Board/Port(Channel).
3. Select the required VC-3 path.

Step 3 Set the loopback status of the port as required.

Step 4 Click Apply.


The confirmation dialog box is displayed.

Step 5 Click OK.


The prompt dialog box is displayed.

Step 6 Click OK.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 260


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

Step 7 Close the prompt dialog box.

----End

8.4.7 Setting Loopback for the IF Board


Loopbacks on the IF board are classified into IF port loopback, composite port loopback, and
port MAC loopback. The IF1 board supports the IF port inloop, IF port outloop, composite port
inloop, and composite port outloop. The IFU2/IFX2 board supports the IF port inloop, IF port
outloop, composite port inloop, composite port outloop, and port MAC inloop. The ISU2/ISX2/
ISV3 board supports the IF port inloop, IF port outloop, composite port inloop, and composite
port outloop.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Context
The IF port inloop is a process wherein the IF signals are looped back at the modem unit towards
the backplane.

Figure 8-22 IF port inloop

Backplane IF board

IF signal

The IF port outloop is a process wherein the IF signals are looped back at the modem unit of the
board towards the remote equipment.

Figure 8-23 IF port outloop

Backplane IF board
IF signal

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 261


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

The composite port inloop is a process wherein the microwave baseband signal is looped back
at the MUX/DEMUX unit of the board towards the backplane.

Figure 8-24 Composite port inloop

Backplane IF board
Microwave
baseband signal

The composite outloop is a process wherein the microwave baseband signal is looped back at
the MUX/DEMUX unit of the board towards the remote equipment.

Figure 8-25 Composite port outloop

Backplane IF board
Microwave
baseband
signal

Precautions

NOTICE
l The services may be interrupted at the port or on the path where the loopback is performed.
l A software loopback may be released automatically after a certain period (five minutes, by
defaults). For details, see 8.7 Setting the Automatic Release Function.
l To perform the software loopback on the standby IF board of the 1+1 HSB/FD/SD protection
group, switch the standby IF board to the working state forcedly. Otherwise, the operation
may fail.
l Before performing the loopback operation for the IFU2/IFX2 board, disable the AM function
at both ends of the radio link.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 262


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

NOTICE
When Port Mode of an port is set to Layer 3, do not perform any loopback on the port. In this
case, LSP Traceroute is recommended for locating faults.

Procedure
Step 1 Select the corresponding IF board from the Object Tree in the NE explorer.
NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the same as those on the U2000.

Step 2 Choose Configuration > Interface Management > Microwave Interface from the Function
Tree.
NOTE

The equivalent operations on the Web LCT are as follows:


Select the corresponding function options from the Function Tree based on the loopback type.

To Perform... Choose...
IF port loopback 1. Choose Configuration > IF Interface from the Function
Tree.
2. Select IF Attributes tab.
3. Select the port where the loopback needs to be performed and
set IF Port Loopback.
Composite port loopback 1. Choose Configuration > Digital Interface from the Function
Tree.
2. Select By Function.
3. Choose Optical(Electrical) Interface Loopback from the
drop-down list.
4. Select the port where the loopback needs to be performed and
set Optical (Electrical) Interface Loopback.
MAC loopback 1. Choose Configuration > Interface Management >
Microwave Interface from the Function Tree.
2. Select Advanced Attributes.
3. Select the port where the loopback needs to be performed and
set MAC Loopback.

Step 3 Select Loopback Attributes.


NOTE

The Web LCT does not support this operation.

Step 4 Select the port where the loopback needs to be performed and set loopback type.
NOTE

The Web LCT does not support this operation.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 263


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

Step 5 Click Apply.


NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the same as those on the U2000.
Then, the Confirm dialog box is displayed.

Step 6 Click OK to close the dialog box.


NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the same as those on the U2000.
Then, a dialog box is displayed.

Step 7 Close the dialog box that is displayed.


NOTE

The Web LCT does not support this operation.

----End

8.4.8 Setting Software Loopback for the NE


This task sets the loopback for the object on an NE.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the same as those on the U2000.

Precautions

NOTICE
l The services may be interrupted at the port or on the path where the loopback is performed.
l A software loopback may be released automatically after a certain period (five minutes, by
defaults). For details, see 8.7 Setting the Automatic Release Function.

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE in the NE Explorer.

Step 2 Choose Diagnoses&Maintenance > NE Lookback from the Function Tree.

Step 3 Select the desired loopback status for the desired port in the table.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 264


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

NOTE

Composite loopback displays as Optical(Electrical) Interface Loopback.

Step 4 Click Apply.

----End

8.4.9 Setting Software Loopback for the Microwave Link


This task sets the loopback for the object on a single-hop radio link.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the similar to those on the U2000.

Precautions

NOTICE
The services may be interrupted at the port or on the path where the loopback is performed.

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE in the NE Explorer.

Step 2 ChooseDiagnoses&Maintenance > Radio Link Lookback from the Function Tree.

Step 3 Select the local IF board.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 265


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

Step 4 Select the desired loopback status for the desired object.
Step 5 Click Apply.
Then, the dialog box is displayed.
Step 6 Click OK.

----End

8.4.10 Locating a Fault by Performing Loopback Operations


Loopback is a common method of locating the fault.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Service Trail
Figure 8-26 shows how to locate a fault by performing a loopback operation.

Figure 8-26 Service trail


PDH SDH
Cross-connect IF ODU ODU
IF Cross-connect
tributary
tributary
board board board board
board board

NE1 NE2

PDH SDH
Cross-connect IF IF Cross-connect
tributary ODU ODU tributary
board board board board
board board

NE4 NE3

Optical cable

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 266


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

Precautions
The LSP Traceroute method, instead of sectional loopbacks, is recommended for locating the
faults of PWE3 services.

Procedure
Step 1 If the services are available on the radio links, perform the inter-station loopbacks to narrow
down the fault to a specific hop.
1. Set the outloops for the SDH optical interface boards on NE2 and NE3, and then perform
the inter-station loopbacks to locate the fault.

Step 2 After the fault is located on the specific radio link, perform the intra-station loopbacks to narrow
down the fault to a specific NE or board.
1. Set inloop for the IF board on the NEs at both ends of the radio link where the fault occurs,
to check whether the service receiver or the radio link is faulty.
2. If the fault is located in the service receiver, set outloop for the PDH tributary board to
check whether the interface board or switch unit is faulty.
3. If the radio link is faulty, replace the IF board and ODU to check whether the IF board or
ODU is faulty.

----End

8.5 Hardware Loopback


Hardware loopback refers to the loopback operation performed by changing the physical
connection.

Background Information
Hardware loopback is classified into optical cable loopback, PDH cable loopback, and Ethernet
electrical port loopback.
l Optical cable loopback indicates that the receive and transmit optical fibers are connected
through a fiber jumper on the ODF. In certain occasions, an optical attenuator is added
based on the actual situation, to prevent the optical SFP from being damaged by the
excessive receive optical power.
l PDH cable loopback indicates that the receive and transmit PDH cables are connected
through a short-circuiting cable or connector on the DDF.
l Ethernet electrical port loopback indicates that the receive and transmit service signals on
one Ethernet port are looped back through a special loopback Ethernet cable.

8.6 Reset
Reset is an important method of troubleshooting software faults. Reset is classified into cold
reset, warm reset.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 267


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

8.6.1 Cold Reset


Cold reset is a process wherein the board software is reset and the board is re-initiated. During
the board initialization, the FPGA, if any, is re-loaded.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the same as those on the U2000.

Precautions

NOTICE
Cold reset causes service interruption because it is similar to the procedure of removing and
inserting a board.

Procedure
Step 1 In Running Status of the U2000, right-click the board where the cold reset needs to be
performed.

Step 2 Choose Cold Reset from the shortcut menu.


Then, the dialog box is displayed.

Step 3 Click OK.

Step 4 Close the dialog box that is displayed.

----End

8.6.2 Warm Reset


Warm reset is a process wherein the board software is reset but the board is not re-initiated.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 268


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the same as those on the U2000.

Precautions
During warm reset, the board software is reset but the services are not interrupted.

Procedure
Step 1 In Running Status of the U2000, right-click the board where the warm reset needs to be
performed.

Step 2 Choose Warm Reset from the shortcut menu.


Then, the dialog box is displayed.

Step 3 Click OK.

Step 4 Close the dialog box that is displayed.

----End

8.7 Setting the Automatic Release Function


To protect the communication between the NMS and NE against improper operations, an NE
supports the automatic release of the ODU muting, software loopback, and other operations that
require you to exercise caution. The automatic release time is five minutes by default. You can
set whether to enable the automatic release function and the automatic release time through the
NMS.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > NE Batch Configuration > Automatic Disabling of NE Function
from the Main Menu.

Step 2 Select the desired NE from the Object Tree. Click .

Step 3 In Automatic Disabling of NE Function, set Auto Disabling and Auto Disabling Time
(min).

Step 4 Click Apply to complete the settings for the automatic release function.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 269


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

8.8 Querying Power Consumption of Boards


This section describes how to query power consumption of the ODU and each board.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Instruments, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

The Web LCT does not support this operation.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > NE Batch Configuration > Power Management from the Main
Menu.
Step 2 In the NE Power dialog box, select the Board Power tab.

Step 3 Select the required NE or board from the object tree, and then click .
Step 4 Click Query.
The Query progress bar is displayed.
Step 5 Close the dialog box that is displayed.
Step 6 On the Board Power tab page, browse Nominal Power Consumption and Current Power
Consumption of the selected board.

----End

8.9 Switching the System Control Unit and the Cross-


Connect Unit
When the is configured with two system control, cross-connect, and timing boards, you can
manually switch the system control unit and the cross-connect unit as required.

Prerequisites
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the similar to those on the U2000.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 270


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

Procedure
Step 1 Select the desired NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer.
NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the same as those on the U2000.

Step 2 Choose Configuration > Board 1+1 Protection from the Function Tree.
NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the same as those on the U2000.

Step 3 In 1+1 Protection List, select Cross-Connect Protection Pair.


NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the similar to those on the U2000.

Step 4 Perform the 1+1 protection switching on the board.

If... Then...
Active Board is set to Working Board Click Working/Protection Switching.
Active Board is set to Protection Board Click Restore Working/Protection.

Step 5 In the prompt that is displayed, click OK.


NOTE

Web LCT also supports this operation and the steps are the same as those on the U2000.

----End

8.10 Cleaning Fiber Connectors and Adapters


The optical connectors are easily contaminated in the maintenance process. The minute dust
particles that can be seen only in the microscope can also affect the quality of optical signals. In
this case, the system performance deteriorates. Hence, the fiber connectors or adapters that are
terminated need to be cleaned in time.

8.10.1 Cleaning Fiber Connectors by Using Cartridge Cleaners


When there are special cartridge cleaners (such as the CLETOP cassette cleaner), use them for
cleaning the fiber connectors.

Prerequisites
l Disconnect both ends of the fiber. Ensure that there is no laser light on the fiber connectors.
l Inspect the fiber connector with a fiber microscope to ensure that the fiber connectors are
contaminated.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


Cartridge cleaner

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 271


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

Procedure
Step 1 Press down and hold the lever. Then, the shutter slides back and exposes a new cleaning area.

Figure 8-27 Using the CLETOP cassette cleaner

Step 2 Position the fiber tip slightly against the cleaning area and drag the fiber tip slightly in the
downward direction.

Figure 8-28 Dragging the fiber tip slightly on one cleaning area

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 272


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

Step 3 Repeat the same in the other cleaning area in the same direction as Step 2.

Figure 8-29 Dragging the fiber tip slightly on the other cleaning area

Step 4 Release the lever to close the cleaning area.

----End

8.10.2 Cleaning Fiber Connectors by Using Lens Tissue


When there is no cartridge cleaners, use the lens tissue for cleaning fiber connectors.

Prerequisites
l Disconnect both ends of the fiber. ensure that there is no laser light on the fiber connectors.
l Inspect the fiber connector with a fiber microscope to ensure that the fiber connectors are
contaminated.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


l Clean solvent
l Non-woven lens tissue
l Special compressed gas

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 273


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

NOTE

l The isoamylol is preferred as the clean solvent, and the propyl can also be used as the clean solvent.
Do not use alcohol or formalin.
l The fiber cleaning tissue or lint-free wipes can substitute the non-woven lens tissue.
l The special cleaning roll can substitute the special compressed gas.

Procedure
Step 1 Place a small amount of cleaning solvent on the lens tissue.
Step 2 Drag the fiber tip slightly on the lens tissue.

Figure 8-30 Cleaning the fiber with the lens tissue

Step 3 Repeat Step 2 several times on the areas of the lens tissue that have not been used.
Step 4 Use the compressed gas to blow the fiber tip.
When using compressed gas, note the following points:
l First spray it into the air because the initial spray of condensation may contain certain
sediment.
l Ensure that the injector nozzle is as close as possible to (but does not touch) the connector
surface.

----End

8.10.3 Cleaning Fiber Adapters by Using Optical Cleaning Sticks


The fiber adapters need to be cleaned with optical cleaning sticks. This section describes the
method of cleaning fiber adapters on the optical interface board. The same method can be used
to clean fiber adapters on the optical attenuators and flanges.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 274


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide 8 Common Maintenance Operations

Prerequisites
l Before you clean the fiber adapter, remove the optical fiber and shut down the laser. For
details about how to shut down a laser, see 8.3.1 Setting the On/Off State of the Laser.
l Inspect the fiber adapter with a fiber microscope to ensure that the fiber adapter is
contaminated.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


l Optical cleaning sticks
l Clean solvent
l Special compressed gas
NOTE

l In the case of the SC and FC optical interface, use the cleaning stick with a diameter of 2.5 mm. In the
case of the LC optical interface, use the cleaning stick with a diameter of 1.25 mm.
l The medical cotton or long fiber cotton can substitute the optical cleaning stick.
l The isoamylol is preferred as the clean solvent, and the propyl can also be used as the clean solvent.
Do not use alcohol or formalin.
l The special cleaning roll can substitute the special compressed gas.

Procedure
Step 1 Apply a small amount of cleaning solvent on the optical cleaning stick.

Step 2 Touch the adapter gently with the optical cleaning stick and turn the stick clockwise four to five
times.
Ensure that there is direct contact between the stick tip and fiber tip so that the solvent can clean
the adapter tip.

Step 3 Use the compressed gas to blow the fiber adapter.


When using compressed gas, note the following points:
l First spray the compressed gas into the air because the initial spray of condensation gas may
contain some sediment.
l Ensure that the injector nozzle is as close as possible to (but does not touch) the inner surface
of the connector.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 275


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A Alarm Reference

Alarms are important indicators when abnormalities occur on the equipment. This chapter
describes all the possible alarms on the OptiX RTN 980 and how to handle these alarms.

A.1 Alarm List (in Alphabetical Order)


The following table lists all the possible alarms generated by the OptiX RTN 980 in alphabetical
order.

A.2 Alarm List (Classified by Logical Boards)


This part lists the alarms that are reported by each board.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 276


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.1 Alarm List (in Alphabetical Order)


The following table lists all the possible alarms generated by the OptiX RTN 980 in alphabetical
order.

Table A-1 Alarm list

Alarm Name Description Alarm


Severity

A_LOC Loss of clock in the upstream bus Major

ACR_LOCK_FAIL 1588 ACR locking fails Major

ALM_E1RAI E1 link remote alarm indication Minor

ALM_GFP_dCSF Loss of GFP client signals Critical

ALM_GFP_dLFD Out of frame state of generic framing procedure Major


(GFP) frames

ALM_IMA_LIF Frame delimitation is out-of-frame at the local end Major


of the IMA link.

ALM_IMA_LODS Differential delay of the IMA link crosses the Major


threshold.

ALM_IMA_RE_RX_ The IMA link on the opposite NE fails in the Minor


UNUSABLE receive direction.

ALM_IMA_RE_TX_ The IMA link on the opposite NE fails in the Minor


UNUSABLE transmit direction.

ALM_IMA_RFI Frame delimitation is out-of-frame at the remote Major


end of the IMA link.

AM_DOWNSHIFT Downshift of AM modes Major

APS_FAIL Failure indication of MS protection switching Major

APS_INDI Indication of the APS protection switching Major

APS_MANUAL_ST MS protocol stopped manually Minor


OP

ATMPW_UNKNOW The number of unknown ATM cells exceeds the Major


NCELL_EXC specified threshold in a time unit.

AU_AIS AU alarm indication Major

AU_LOP Loss of AU pointers Major

B1_EXC Excessive regenerator section errors (B1) Minor

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 277


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Alarm Name Description Alarm


Severity

B1_SD Signal degradation due to excessive regenerator Minor


section errors (B1)

B2_EXC Excessive multiplex section errors (B2) Major

B2_SD Signal degradation due to excessive multiplex Minor


section errors (B2)

B3_EXC Excessive higher order path bit errors (B3) Major

B3_EXC_VC3 Excessive B3 bit errors in a VC-3 path Major

B3_SD Signal degradation due to excessive higher order Minor


path bit errors (B3)

B3_SD_VC3 Signal degradation due to excessive VC-3 path Minor


(B3) bit errors

BAT1TEMP_SENSO The temperature sensor of battery group 1 fails. Major


R_FAIL

BAT2TEMP_SENSO The temperature sensor of battery group 2 fails. Major


R_FAIL

BD_NOT_INSTALL The logical board is not added on the NMS. Minor


ED

BD_STATUS The board is out-of-position. Major

BDTEMP_SENSOR_ The board temperature sensor of the cabinet fails. Major


FAIL

BIOS_STATUS The board is in BIOS state. Major

BIP_EXC Excessive BIP errors Minor

BIP_SD Signal degradation due to excessive BIP errors Minor

BOOTROM_BAD BOOTROM data check fails. Major

BUS_ERR Bus errors Critical

CES_ACR_LOCK_A The locking function of CES ACR service clock Minor


BN is abnormal.

CES_APS_INDI Packet MSP protocol state indication Major

CES_APS_MANUA The MSP protocol is disabled manually. Minor


L_STOP

CES_JTROVR_EXC The amount of jitter buffer overflow crosses the Major


specified threshold.

CES_JTRUDR_EXC The amount of jitter buffer underflow crosses the Major


specified threshold.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 278


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Alarm Name Description Alarm


Severity

CES_K1_K2_M K1 and K2 mismatch Minor

CES_K2_M K2 mismatch Minor

CES_LOSPKT_EXC The number of lost packets crosses the specified Major


threshold in a time unit.

CES_MALPKT_EX The number of deformed packets crosses the Major


C specified threshold in a time unit.

CES_MISORDERP The number of lost disordered packets crosses the Major


KT_EXC specified threshold in a time unit.

CES_RDI Remote defect indication Minor

CES_STRAYPKT_E The number of error packets crosses the specified Major


XC threshold in a time unit.

CESPW_OPPOSITE The AC circuit on the opposite NE is faulty. Major


_ACFAULT

CESPW_OPPOSITE Remote alarm indication Major


_RAI

CFCARD_FAILED The operation on the CF card fails. Major

CFCARD_OFFLINE The CF card is offline. Major

CHCS Correctable cell errors Minor

CLK_LOCK_FAIL Clock locking fails Major

CLK_NO_TRACE_ The clock source is not in locked mode. Minor


MODE

COMMUN_FAIL Inter-board communication fails. Major

COM_EXTECC_FU Excessive TCP connections between Major


LL automatically extended ECC NEs

CONFIG_NOSUPPO Configuration is not supported. Major


RT

DBMS_DELETE The status of databases is delete. Major

DBMS_ERROR Errors in the processing of system databases Major

DBMS_PROTECT_ System databases in protection mode Critical


MODE

DCNSIZE_OVER Oversized DCN network Major

DDN_LFA The frame alignment signal of framed E1 services Major


is lost.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 279


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Alarm Name Description Alarm


Severity

DOWN_E1_AIS Alarm indication of 2 Mbit/s downstream signals Minor

DROPRATIO_OVE The number of lost packets due to port congestion Minor


R crosses the threshold.

E1_LOC Loss of 2 Mbit/s clock in upstream signals Major

E1_LOS Loss of 2 Mbit/s line signals Minor

ELAN_SMAC_FLA The source MAC address learned by an E-LAN Major


PPING service flaps.

ENVHUM_SENSOR The ambient humidity sensor of the cabinet fails. Major


_FAIL

ENVTEMP_SENSO The ambient temperature sensor of the cabinet Major


R_FAIL fails.

ENVTEMP1_SENSO The ambient temperature sensor 1 of the cabinet Major


R_FAIL fails.

ENVTEMP2_SENSO The ambient temperature sensor 2 of the cabinet Major


R_FAIL fails.

ERPS_IN_PROTEC- Indicates that a node on the EPRS ring is faulty. Minor


TION

ETH_APS_LOST Loss of APS frames Minor

ETH_APS_PATH_M The working and protection paths of the APS Major


ISMATCH protection group differ between the two ends.

ETH_APS_SWITCH Protection switching failure Minor


_FAIL

ETH_APS_TYPE_M Protection scheme mismatch Major


ISMATCH

ETH_AUTO_LINK_ Automatic link down of Ethernet port Minor


DOWN

ETH_CFM_AIS A local MEP_AIS occurs. Major

ETH_CFM_LOC Loss of connectivity Major

ETH_CFM_MISME Misconnection Major


RGE

ETH_CFM_RDI The maintenance association end point (MEP) Minor


fails to receive CCM packets.

ETH_CFM_UNEXP Error frames Minor


ERI

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 280


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Alarm Name Description Alarm


Severity

ETH_EFM_DF Discovery failure Major

ETH_EFM_EVENT Performance events at the opposite end Major

ETH_EFM_LOOPB A loopback occurs. Major


ACK

ETH_EFM_REMFA Faults occur at the opposite end. Critical


ULT

ETH_LOS Loss of Ethernet port connection Critical

ETH_NO_FLOW No flow on the Ethernet port Major

ETH_PWR_SUPPL Power output failure of an Ethernet port Critical


Y_FAIL

ETHOAM_DISCOV Discovery failure is detected by point-to-point Minor


ER_FAIL Ethernet OAM.

ETHOAM_RMT_C Severe faults are detected by point-to-point Minor


RIT_FAULT Ethernet OAM at the remote end.

ETHOAM_RMT_L A remote loopback is detected by point-to-point Minor


OOP Ethernet OAM.

ETHOAM_RMT_SD Remote Ethernet performance degradation is Minor


detected by point-to-point Ethernet OAM.

ETHOAM_SELF_L An MAC port loopback is detected by point-to- Major


OOP point Ethernet OAM.

ETHOAM_VCG_SE A VCTRUNK port loopback is detected by point- Major


LF_LOOP to-point Ethernet OAM.

EX_ETHOAM_CC_ Loss of periodical continuity check packets Critical


LOS

EX_ETHOAM_MPI Conflict of maintenance point IDs Major


D_CNFLCT

EXT_SYNC_LOS Loss of external clock sources Critical

EXT_TIME_LOC Loss of external time sources Major

FAN_AGING Aged fans Minor

FAN_FAIL Failure of fan boards Major

FCS_ERR Frame check sequence (FCS) errors Critical

FDBSIZEALM_ELA items listed in an E-LAN forwarding table are all Minor


N used

FLOW_OVER Excessive data traffic received by Ethernet ports Minor

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 281


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Alarm Name Description Alarm


Severity

HARD_BAD Hardware faults Critical

HARD_NONSUPPO Board hardware does not support a certain Major


RT function.

HP_CROSSTR Threshold-crossing performance event of the Minor


higher order path

HP_LOM Loss of multiframes in the higher order path Major

HP_RDI Higher order path remote defect indication Minor

HP_REI Higher order path remote error indication Warning

HP_SLM Higher order path signal label mismatch Minor

HP_TIM High order path trace identifier mismatch Minor

HP_UNEQ Unequipped higher order path Minor

HPAD_CROSSTR Adaptation performance threshold-crossing of the Minor


higher order path

IF_CABLE_OPEN IF cables are disconnected. Major

IF_INPWR_ABN The power supplied by an IF board to an ODU is Major


abnormal.

IF_MODE_UNSUP- Preset IF working mode is not supported. Major


PORTED

IMA_GROUP_LE_D The IMA group at the local end fails. Major


OWN

IMA_GROUP_RE_D The IMA group at the remote end fails. Major


OWN

IMA_TXCLK_MIS- The transmit clock modes at the two ends of the Minor
MATCH IMA group are different.

IN_PWR_ABN Abnormal input optical power Major

IN_PWR_HIGH Over high input optical power Critical

IN_PWR_LOW Over low input optical power Critical

INTEMP_SENSOR_ The air intake vent temperature sensor of the Major


FAIL cabinet fails.

J0_MM Trace identifier mismatch Minor

K1_K2_M K1 and K2 mismatch Minor

K2_M K2 mismatch Minor

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 282


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Alarm Name Description Alarm


Severity

LAG_BWMM Bandwidth inconsistency in the LAG group Major

LAG_DOWN The LAG is unavailable. Major

LAG_MEMBER_DO A member port of a link aggregation group (LAG) Minor


WN is unavailable.

LAG_PORT_FAIL A member port of a LAG fails. Minor

LAG_VC_PORT_FA A VCG port of an LAG fails. Minor


IL

LAN_LOC Ethernet communication failure Major

LASER_CLOSED The laser is shut down. Major

LASER_MOD_ERR The type of the pluggable optical module on the Major


board does not match the type of the optical
interface.

LASER_MOD_ERR The type of the pluggable optical module on the Major


_EX board does not match the type of the optical
interface.

LASER_SHUT The laser is shut down. Major

LCAS_FOPR LCAS protocol fails in the receive direction. Major

LCAS_FOPT LCAS protocol fails in the transmit direction. Major

LCAS_PLCR Loss of partial bandwidth in the LCAS receive Minor


direction

LCAS_PLCT Loss of partial bandwidth in the LCAS transmit Minor


direction

LCAS_TLCR Loss of total bandwidth in the LCAS receive Major


direction

LCAS_TLCT Loss of total bandwidth in the LCAS transmit Major


direction

LCD Loss of cell delimitation Major

LCS_LIMITED The capacity of the configured services exceeds Major


the range permitted by the license file.

LFA Out of frame state of E1 frames Major

LICENSE_LOST The NE fails to detect any license file. Major

LINK_ERR Faults occur in a data link. Critical

LMFA Out of frame state of E1 multiframes Major

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 283


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Alarm Name Description Alarm


Severity

LOOP_ALM A loopback occurs. Minor

LP_CROSSTR Performance threshold-crossing of the lower Minor


order path

LP_R_FIFO FIFO overflow on the receive side of the lower Minor


order path

LP_RDI Lower order path remote defect indication Minor

LP_RDI_VC12 VC-12 path remote defect indication Minor

LP_RDI_VC3 VC-3 path remote defect indication Minor

LP_REI Lower order path remote error indication Minor

LP_REI_VC12 VC-12 path remote error indication Minor

LP_REI_VC3 VC-3 path remote bit error indication Minor

LP_RFI Lower order path remote failure indication Minor

LP_SLM Lower order path signal label mismatch Minor

LP_SLM_VC12 VC-12 path signal label mismatch Minor

LP_SLM_VC3 VC-3 path signal label mismatch Minor

LP_T_FIFO FIFO overflow on the transmit side of the lower Minor


order path

LP_TIM Lower order path trace identifier mismatch Minor

LP_TIM_VC12 VC-12 path trace identifier mismatch Minor

LP_TIM_VC3 VC-3 path tracking identification mismatch Minor

LP_UNEQ Unequipped lower order paths Minor

LP_UNEQ_VC12 Unequipped VC-12 paths Minor

LP_UNEQ_VC3 VC-3 path unequipped Minor

LPS_UNI_BI_M The switching mode is single-ended at one end Minor


and dual-ended at the other end.

LPT_CFG_CLOSE- The LPT closes the access port of the local NE. Major
PORT

LPT_INEFFECT LPT function failed Major

LPT_RFI Link state pass-through function fails at the Critical


remote end.

LSR_BCM_ALM Laser bias current crossing the threshold Major

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 284


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Alarm Name Description Alarm


Severity

LSR_NO_FITED Laser not installed Critical

LSR_WILL_DIE Laser going to expire Critical

LTI Loss of clock synchronization source Major

MAC_EXT_EXC The number of bit errors at the MAC layer crosses Major
the threshold.

MAC_FCS_EXC The software detects that the number of bit errors Major
at the MAC layer crosses the threshold.

MAC_FCS_SD Signal degrade bit errors at the MAC layer cross Major
the threshold.

MOD_COM_FAIL Module communication failure Critical

MOD_TYPE_MIS- Port module type mismatch Critical


MATCH

MP_DELAY The group member delay Major

MP_DOWN MP group failure Major

MPLS_PW_AIS PW forward defect indication Major

MPLS_PW_BDI PW backward defect indication Minor

MPLS_PW_CSF MPLS PW Client Signal Fail

MPLS_PW_Excess Excessive trail termination source identifiers Warning


(TTSIs) are received on the PW.

MPLS_PW_LCK The server layer (tunnel) of MPLS PW locked Major


indication

MPLS_PW_LOCK Administration locking of PW layer Major

MPLS_PW_LOCV Loss of PW connectivity Major

MPLS_PW_MISMA The trail termination source identifiers (TTSIs) on Major


TCH the PW do not match with the specified one.

MPLS_PW_MISME The trail termination source identifiers (TTSIs) Major


RGE are mismerged on the PW.

MPLS_PW_OAMFA OAM protocol negotiation failure Minor


IL

MPLS_PW_RDI PW backward defect indication Minor

MPLS_PW_SD Signal degradation on the PW Major

MPLS_PW_SF Signal failure on the PW Major

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 285


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Alarm Name Description Alarm


Severity

MPLS_PW_UNEXP The MEP receives a packet with correct MEG Critical


MEG level but incorrect MEG ID.

MPLS_PW_UNEXP The CCM information of a PW OAM packet is Major


MEP incorrect.

MPLS_PW_UNEXP The PW does not receive a CCM packet in the Major


PER expected period.

MPLS_PW_UNKNO Unknown defects on the PW Major


WN

MPLS_TUNNEL_AI Tunnel forward defect indication Major


S

MPLS_TUNNEL_B Tunnel backward defect indication Minor


DI

MPLS_TUNNEL_Ex Excessive trail termination source identifiers Warning


cess (TTSIs) are received on the tunnel.

MPLS_TUNNEL_FD Tunnel forward defect indication Minor


I

MPLS_TUNNEL_L Administration locking of tunnel layer Major


OCK

MPLS_TUNNEL_L Loss of tunnel connectivity Major


OCV

MPLS_TUNNEL_MI The trail termination source identifiers (TTSIs) on Major


SMATCH the tunnel do not match with the specified one.

MPLS_TUNNEL_MI The trail termination source identifiers (TTSIs) Major


SMERGE are mismerged on the tunnel.

MPLS_TUNNEL_O The OAM protocol negotiation between the two Minor


AMFAIL ends of the tunnel fails.

MPLS_TUNNEL_R Tunnel backward defect indication Minor


DI

MPLS_TUNNEL_SD Signal degradation on the tunnel Major

MPLS_TUNNEL_SF Signal failure on the tunnel Major

MPLS_TUNNEL_U Unexpected MEG ID in the CCM packet Critical


NEXPMEG

MPLS_TUNNEL_U Unexpected MEP ID in the CCM packet Major


NEXPMEP

MPLS_TUNNEL_U Unexpected period of the CCM packet Major


NEXPPER

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 286


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Alarm Name Description Alarm


Severity

MPLS_TUNNEL_U Unknown defects on the tunnel Major


NKNOWN

MS_AIS Multiplex section alarm indication Major

MS_CROSSTR Multiplex section performance threshold- Minor


crossing

MS_RDI Multiplex section remote defect indication Minor

MS_REI Multiplex section remote error indication Warning

MSAD_CROSSTR Multiplex section adaptation performance Minor


threshold-crossing

MULTI_RPL_OWN The ring network has multiple RPL_OWNER Minor


ER nodes.

MW_AM_TEST The IF port is in the AM testing state. Minor

MW_BER_EXC Excessive errors on radio links Minor

MW_BER_SD Signal degradation due to excessive errors on Minor


radio links

MW_CFG_MISMAT Configuration mismatch on radio links Critical


CH

MW_CONT_WAVE Continuous wave Minor

MW_E1_LOST Loss of E1 signals Major

MW_FEC_UNCOR Microwave frames have the errors that cannot be Minor


corrected by using the forward error correction
(FEC) technology.

MW_LIM Label mismatch on radio links Major

MW_LOF Loss of microwave frames Critical

MW_RDI Remote defect indication on radio links Minor

NEIP_CONFUSION IP address is conflict Major

NESF_LOST The NE software is lost. Critical

NESOFT_MM The software in the main area is different from that Major
in the standby area.

NO_BD_SOFT The board software is lost. Critical

NP1_MANUAL_ST The N+1 protection protocol is stopped manually. Minor


OP

NP1_SW_FAIL The N+1 protection switching fails. Major

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 287


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Alarm Name Description Alarm


Severity

NP1_SW_INDI N+1 protection switching indication Major

NTP_SYNC_FAIL Synchronization with the NTP time fails. Minor

OCD Out of cell delimitation Major

ODC_BATTERY_C Abnormal current of the storage battery Major


URRENT_ABN

ODC_BATTERY_P The storage battery fails to supply power for the Major
WRDOWN equipment.

ODC_DOOR_OPEN The door of an outdoor cabinet is open. Critical

ODC_FAN_FAILED Fan failure Major

ODC_HUMI_ABN The relative humidity in the cabinet environment Minor


crosses the specified threshold.

ODC_LOAD_PWRD The secondary load is powered off. Major


OWN

ODC_MDL_ABN The power module is abnormal. Major

ODC_POWER_FAI Exceptions occur in the AC input power voltage. Major


L

ODC_SMOKE_OVE Smoke occurs in an outdoor cabinet. Critical


R

ODC_SURGE_PRO The surge protection function of the outdoor Critical


TECTION_FAIL cabinet fails.

ODC_TEC_ALM The TEC air conditioning module in the cabinet Major


fails.

ODC_TEMP_ABN The ambient temperature of the cabinet or the Minor


temperature of the storage battery is
inappropriate.

ODC_WATER_AL Water in the outdoor cabinet Critical


M

OUT_PWR_ABN Abnormal output optical power Critical

OUT1TEMP_SENS The air outlet temperature sensor of the cabinet Major


OR_FAIL fails.

OUT2TEMP_SENS The external recycling outlet temperature sensor Major


OR_FAIL of the cabinet fails.

PASSWORD_NEED Password of the user who logs in is unchanged. Major


_CHANGE

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 288


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Alarm Name Description Alarm


Severity

PATCH_BD_EXCL Patch isolation Major


UDE

PATCH_BD_MATC Patch matching failure Major


H_FAIL

PATCH_CHGSCC_ Patch package mismatch due to system control Major


NOTMATCH board replacement

PATCH_PKGERR Abnormal patch package Minor

PG_LINK_FAIL Links of the 1+1 protection group fail. Critical

PG_PRT_DEGRAD The working link or protection link of the 1+1 Major


ED protection group is faulty.

PLA_CFG_MISMA Inconsistent PLA configurations Critical


TCH

PLA_DOWN PLA group is faulty Major

PLA_MEMBER_DO Member link of a PLA group is faulty Major


WN

PORTMODE_MIS- The working mode of the remote FE port does not Minor
MATCH match that of the local FE port.

PORT_EXC_TRAFF The traffic is higher than the port bandwidth Warning


IC threshold.

PORT_MODULE_O Port not in position Major


FFLINE

POWER_ABNORM Power input alarm Major


AL

POWER_ALM Power module alarm Major

PPP_LCP_FAIL LCP negotiation failure Major

PPP_NCP_FAIL NCP negotiation failure Major

PTP_SOURCE_SWI PTP time source switching Minor


TCH

PTP_TIMESTAMP_ PTP time stamp abnormality Major


ABN

PW_DROPPKT_EX The number of lost packets in a PW crosses the Warning


C threshold.

PW_NO_TRAFFIC The PW has no traffic. Critical

PWAPS_LOST Loss of APS frames Minor

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 289


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Alarm Name Description Alarm


Severity

PWAPS_PATH_MIS The working and protection paths of the APS Major


MATCH protection group differ between the two ends.

PWAPS_SWITCH_F Protection switching failure Minor


AIL

PWAPS_TYPE_MIS Protection scheme mismatch Major


MATCH

PW_APS_DEGRAD The PW APS protection group is degraded. Major


ED

PW_APS_OUTAGE The PW APS protection group is unavailable. Major

R_LOC Loss of clock on the receive line side Critical

R_LOF Loss of frame on the receive line side Critical

R_LOS Loss of signal or loss of microwave frame on the Critical


receive line side

R_OOF The out-of-frame fault occurs on the receive line Critical


side.

RADIO_FADING_M Radio fading margin is insufficient. Minor


ARGIN_INSUFF

RADIO_MUTE The radio transmitter is muted. Warning

RADIO_RSL_BE- Antennas are not aligned. Minor


YONDTH

RADIO_RSL_HIGH Over high radio receive signal level Critical

RADIO_RSL_LOW Over low radio receive signal level Critical

RADIO_TSL_HIGH Over high radio transmit signal level Critical

RADIO_TSL_LOW Over low radio transmit signal level Critical

RELAY_ALARM_C There are critical alarm inputs. Critical


RITICAL

RELAY_ALARM_I There are warning inputs. Warning


GNORE

RELAY_ALARM_M There are major alarm inputs. Major


AJOR

RELAY_ALARM_M There are minor alarm inputs. Minor


INOR

RMFA Loss of multiframe alignment at the remote end Minor

RPS_INDI Radio protection switching indication Major

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 290


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Alarm Name Description Alarm


Severity

RS_CROSSTR Regenerator section performance threshold- Minor


crossing

RTC_FAIL The real-time clock (RTC) of the system control Major


board fails.

S1_SYN_CHANGE Clock source switching in S1 mode Major

SCCDATA_BACKU Batch backup of SCC boards fails. Minor


P_FAIL

SEC_RADIUS_FAIL RADIUS authentication fails. Major

SECU_ALM Security alarm Major

SRV_SHUTDOWN_ Ethernet services are interrupted. Warning


LD

SSL_CERT_NOENC Certificate file of SSL is not encrypted Major

SUBNET_RT_CON- Subnetwork route conflict Major


FLICT

SWDL_ACTIVATE The commit operation is not performed during Critical


D_TIMEOUT software package loading.

SWDL_AUTOMAT The automatic match function is disabled. Minor


CH_INH

SWDL_CHGMNG_ The board software version and the version of the Critical
NOMATCH running software are inconsistent.

SWDL_COMMIT_F The submit operation fails. Minor


AIL

SWDL_INPROCESS The package diffusion is being performed on the Warning


NE.

SWDL_NEPKGCHE Certain files in the package stored in flash Critical


CK memory are lost.

SWDL_PKG_NOBD The software package does not contain any board Minor
SOFT software.

SWDL_PKGVER_M Software package version consistency check fails. Minor


M

SWDL_ROLLBACK The version rollback on an NE fails. Minor


_FAIL

SYN_BAD Synchronous source degradation Minor

SYNC_C_LOS Loss of synchronization clock sources Warning

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 291


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Alarm Name Description Alarm


Severity

SYSLOG_COMM_F The communication between the NE and the Major


AIL syslog server fails.

T_ALOS Loss of analog signals at 2 Mbit/s interfaces Major

T_LOC Loss of clock on the transmit line side Major

TEM_HA Too high laser temperature Major

TEM_LA Too low laser temperature Major

TEMP_ALARM Excessive board temperature Minor

TEMP_OVER Excessive board temperature Major

TF Laser transmission fails. Critical

THUNDERALM Surge protection fails. Minor

TIME_LOCK_FAIL Time locking fails. Major

TIME_NO_TRACE_ The high precision time of the NE is in the non- Minor


MODE traced status.

TR_LOC Clock failure Major

TU_AIS TU alarm indication Major

TU_AIS_VC12 VC-12 path TU alarm indication Major

TU_AIS_VC3 TU of VC-3 level alarm indication Major

TU_LOP Loss of TU pointers Major

TU_LOP_VC12 Loss of TU pointers in VC-12 paths Major

TU_LOP_VC3 TU of VC-3 level loss of pointer Major

TUNNEL_APS_DE- The tunnel protection group degrades. Major


GRADED

TUNNEL_APS_OUT The tunnel protection group is unavailable Major


AGE

UHCS Uncorrectable cell errors Minor

UP_E1_AIS Alarm indication of 2 Mbit/s upstream signals Minor

V5_VCAIS Bits 5-7 in the V5 byte of a VC-12 path are set to Major
"1"s.

VC_AIS Alarm indication signal of the VC connection Critical

VC_LOC Loss of VC continuity check Major

VC_RDI Remote defect indication of the VC connection Major

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 292


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Alarm Name Description Alarm


Severity

VCAT_LOA Excessive virtual concatenation delay Critical

VCAT_LOM_VC12 Loss of multiframe of VC-12 path virtual Major


concatenation

VCAT_LOM_VC3 The virtually concatenated multiframes in a VC-3 Major


path are lost.

VCAT_SQM_VC12 SQ mismatch of VC-12 path virtual concatenation Major

VCAT_SQM_VC3 SQ mismatch of VC-3 path virtual concatenation Major

VOLT_LOS Loss of voltage Major

VP_AIS Alarm indication signal of the VP connection Critical

VP_LOC Loss of VP continuity check Major

VP_RDI Remote defect indication of the VP connection Major

W_R_FAIL Failure in reading and writing chip registers Major

WRG_BD_TYPE Error board types Major

XPIC_LOS Loss of XPIC compensation signals Critical

A.2 Alarm List (Classified by Logical Boards)


This part lists the alarms that are reported by each board.

NOTE

The NE software consider a physical board as one or more logical boards when managing the physical board.
The NMS also considers a physical board as one or more logical boards when managing the physical board.
Table A-2 shows the logical boards corresponding to all physical boards

Table A-2 Mappings between the physical boards and logical boards

Physical Logical Board


Board

CSHN l CSHN in slot 15 + SL4D in slot 16 + EG2D in slot 17


l CSHN in slot 20 + SL4D in slot 21 + EG2D in slot 22

AUX AUX in the same slot

IF1 IF1 in the same slot

IFU2 IFU2 in the same slot

IFX2 IFX2 in the same slot

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 293


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Physical Logical Board


Board

ISU2 ISU2 in the same slot

ISX2 ISX2 in the same slot

ISV3 ISV3 in the same slot

SL1D SL1D in the same slot

SL1DA SL1DA in the same slot

EM6T EM6T in the same slot

EM6TA EM6TA in the same slot

EM6F EM6F in the same slot

EM6FA EM6FA in the same slot

EG4 EG4 in the same slot

EG4P EG4P in the same slot

EFP8 EFP8 in the same slot

EMS6 EMS6 in the same slot

SP3S SP3S in the same slot

SP3D SP3D in the same slot

ML1 ML1 in the same slot

MD1 MD1 in the same slot

CQ1 CQ1 in the same slot

PIU PIU in the same slot

FAN FAN in the same slot

ODU ODU in the slot whose number is 50 plus the slot number for the IF board
that is connected to the ODU

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 294


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.2.1 AUX
l BD_STATUS
l HARD_BAD
l RELAY_ALARM_CRITICAL
l RELAY_ALARM_IGNORE
l RELAY_ALARM_MAJOR
l RELAY_ALARM_MINOR
l WRG_BD_TYPE

A.2.2 CQ1
l ALM_E1RAI l CES_RDI l LOOP_ALM l PPP_NCP_FAIL
l AU_AIS l CES_STRAYPKT_E l LP_RDI_VC12 l R_LOC
XC l R_LOF
l AU_LOP l LP_REI_VC12
l CESPW_OPPOSITE_ l R_LOS
l B1_EXC l LP_RFI
ACFAULT
l B1_SD l LP_SLM_VC12 l R_OOF
l CESPW_OPPOSITE_
l B2_EXC RAI l LP_TIM_VC12 l TEM_HA

l HARD_BAD l TEM_LA
l B2_SD l LP_UNEQ_VC12
l HP_RDI l TEMP_OVER
l B3_EXC l LSR_BCM_ALM
l HP_REI l TF
l B3_SD l LSR_NO_FITED
l HP_SLM l TR_LOC
l BD_STATUS l LSR_WILL_DIE
l HP_TIM l TU_AIS_VC12
l BIP_EXC l MP_DELAY
l HP_UNEQ l TU_LOP_VC12
l BIP_SD l MP_DOWN
l IN_PWR_ABN l UP_E1_AIS
l BUS_ERR l MS_AIS l V5_VCAIS
l IN_PWR_HIGH
l CES_JTROVR_EXC l MS_RDI l WRG_BD_TYPE
l IN_PWR_LOW
l CES_JTRUDR_EXC l MS_REI
l J0_MM
l CES_LOSPKT_EXC l OUT_PWR_ABN
l LASER_MOD_ERR
l CES_MALPKT_EXC l POWER_ABNORM
l LASER_SHUT
l CES_MISORDERPK AL
l LFA
T_EXC l PPP_LCP_FAIL
l LMFA

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 295


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.2.3 CSHN
l ACR_LOCK_FAIL l LCS_LIMITED l MPLS_TUNNEL_UN l SECU_ALM
l APS_FAIL l LICENSE_LOST EXPMEG l SRV_SHUTDOWN_
l APS_INDI l MPLS_TUNNEL_UN LD
l LPS_UNI_BI_M
EXPMEP l SSL_CERT_NOENC
l APS_MANUAL_ST l LPT_CFG_CLOSE-
l MPLS_TUNNEL_UN l STORM_CUR_QUE
OP PORT
EXPPER NUM_OVER
l BD_NOT_INSTALL l LTI
l MPLS_TUNNEL_UN l SUBNET_RT_CON-
ED
l MAC_EXT_EXC KNOWN FLICT
l BD_STATUS
l MAC_FCS_EXC l NEIP_CONFUSION l SWDL_ACTIVATED
l BIOS_STATUS
l MOD_COM_FAIL l NESF_LOST _TIMEOUT
l BOOTROM_BAD
l MPLS_PW_AIS l NESOFT_MM l SWDL_AUTOMATC
l CES_APS_INDI l NP1_MANUAL_STO H_INH
l MPLS_PW_BDI
l CES_APS_MANUAL P l SWDL_CHGMNG_N
l MPLS_PW_CSF
_STOP l NP1_SW_FAIL OMATCH
l MPLS_PW_Excess
l CES_K1_K2_M l NP1_SW_INDI l SWDL_COMMIT_F
l MPLS_PW_LCK AIL
l CES_K2_M l NTP_SYNC_FAIL
l MPLS_PW_LOCK l SWDL_INPROCESS
l CFCARD_FAILED l PASSWORD_NEED
l MPLS_PW_LOCV _CHANGE l SWDL_NEPKGCHE
l CFCARD_OFFLINE
l MPLS_PW_MISMA CK
l CLK_LOCK_FAIL l PATCH_BD_EXCLU
TCH DE l SWDL_PKG_NOBD-
l CLK_NO_TRACE_ SOFT
l MPLS_PW_MISMER l PATCH_BD_MATC
MODE
GE H_FAIL l SWDL_PKGVER_M
l COM_EXTECC_FUL M
l MPLS_PW_OAMFAI l PATCH_CHGSCC_N
L
L OTMATCH l SWDL_ROLLBACK
l COMMUN_FAIL _FAIL
l MPLS_PW_RDI l PATCH_PKGERR
l DBMS_DELETE l SYN_BAD
l MPLS_PW_SD l PG_LINK_FAIL
l DBMS_ERROR l SYNC_C_LOS
l MPLS_PW_SF l PG_PRT_DEGRADE
l DBMS_PROTECT_ D l SYSLOG_COMM_F
MODE l MPLS_PW_UNEXP
AIL
MEG l PLA_CFG_MISMAT
l DCNSIZE_OVER CH l TEMP_ALARM
l MPLS_PW_UNEXP
l ELAN_SMAC_FLAP MEP l PLA_DOWN l TIME_LOCK_FAIL
PING l TIME_NO_TRACE_
l MPLS_PW_UNEXPP l PLA_MEMBER_DO
l ETH_APS_LOST ER WN MODE
l ETH_APS_PATH_M l MPLS_PW_UNKNO l PORT_EXC_TRAFFI l TUNNEL_APS_DE-
ISMATCH WN C GRADED
l ETH_APS_SWITCH l POWER_ALM l TUNNEL_APS_OUT
l MPLS_TUNNEL_AI
_FAIL AGE
S l PTP_SOURCE_SWI
l ETH_APS_TYPE_MI TCH l WRG_BD_TYPE
l MPLS_TUNNEL_BD
SMATCH I l PTP_TIMESTAMP_
l ETH_NO_FLOW l MPLS_TUNNEL_Ex- ABN
l EXT_SYNC_LOS cess l PW_DROPPKT_EXC

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 296


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

l EXT_TIME_LOC l MPLS_TUNNEL_FD l PW_NO_TRAFFIC


l FDBSIZEALM_ELA I l PWAPS_LOST
N l MPLS_TUNNEL_LO l PWAPS_PATH_MIS-
l FLOW_OVER CK MATCH
l HARD_BAD l MPLS_TUNNEL_LO
l PWAPS_SWITCH_F
CV
l HARD_NONSUPPO AIL
RT l MPLS_TUNNEL_MI
l PWAPS_TYPE_MIS-
SMATCH
l K1_K2_M MATCH
l MPLS_TUNNEL_MI
l K2_M l PW_APS_DEGRAD
SMERGE
ED
l LAG_BWMM l MPLS_TUNNEL_OA
l PW_APS_OUTAGE
l LAN_LOC MFAIL
l RPS_INDI
l MPLS_TUNNEL_RD
I l RTC_FAIL
l MPLS_TUNNEL_SD l S1_SYN_CHANGE
l MPLS_TUNNEL_SF l SCCDATA_BACKU
l MPLS_TUNNEL_UN P_FAIL
EXPMEG l SEC_RADIUS_FAIL

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 297


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.2.4 EFP8
l ALM_GFP_dCSF l ETHOAM_DISCOV l LCAS_FOPR l LP_UNEQ_VC12
l ALM_GFP_dLFD ER_FAIL l LCAS_FOPT l LPT_RFI
l BD_STATUS l ETHOAM_RMT_CR l LCAS_PLCR l NO_BD_SOFT
IT_FAULT
l BIP_EXC l LCAS_PLCT l RMFA
l ETHOAM_RMT_LO
l BIP_SD OP l LCAS_TLCR l TEMP_ALARM
l COMMUN_FAIL l ETHOAM_RMT_SD l LCAS_TLCT l TU_AIS_VC12
l DOWN_E1_AIS l ETHOAM_SELF_LO l LFA l TU_LOP_VC12
l ETH_CFM_AIS OP l LMFA l VCAT_LOA
l ETH_CFM_LOC l ETHOAM_VCG_SE l LOOP_ALM l VCAT_LOM_VC12
l ETH_CFM_MISMER LF_LOOP l LP_RDI_VC12 l VCAT_SQM_VC12
GE l EX_ETHOAM_CC_L l LP_REI_VC12 l W_R_FAIL
l ETH_CFM_RDI OS
l LP_SLM_VC12 l WRG_BD_TYPE
l ETH_CFM_UNEXPE l EX_ETHOAM_MPI
l LP_TIM_VC12
RI D_CNFLCT
l ETH_LOS l FCS_ERR
l FLOW_OVER
l HARD_BAD
l LAG_PORT_FAIL
l LAG_VC_PORT_FA
IL

A.2.5 EG2D
l BD_STATUS l ETH_EFM_DF l LAG_DOWN l MAC_FCS_SD
l COMMUN_FAIL l ETH_EFM_EVENT l LAG_MEMBER_DO l MULTI_RPL_OWNE
l DROPRATIO_OVER WN R
l ETH_EFM_LOOPBA
l ERPS_IN_PROTEC- CK l LASER_MOD_ERR l OUT_PWR_ABN
TION l ETH_EFM_REMFA l LASER_SHUT l PORT_EXC_TRAFFI
l ETH_AUTO_LINK_ ULT l LOOP_ALM C
DOWN l ETH_LOS l LPT_CFG_CLOSE- l PORTMODE_MIS-
l ETH_CFM_AIS PORT MATCH
l ETH_NO_FLOW
l ETH_CFM_LOC l LSR_NO_FITED l TEMP_ALARM
l ETHOAM_SELF_LO
l ETH_CFM_MISMER l LSR_WILL_DIE l TF
OP
GE l MAC_EXT_EXC l WRG_BD_TYPE
l FLOW_OVER
l ETH_CFM_RDI l MAC_FCS_EXC
l HARD_BAD
l ETH_CFM_UNEXPE
RI l IN_PWR_ABN

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 298


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.2.6 EG4
l BD_STATUS l ETH_EFM_DF l LAG_DOWN l MAC_FCS_SD
l BUS_ERR l ETH_EFM_EVENT l LAG_MEMBER_DO l MULTI_RPL_OWNE
l DROPRATIO_OVER WN R
l ETH_EFM_LOOPBA
l ERPS_IN_PROTEC- CK l LASER_MOD_ERR l OUT_PWR_ABN
TION l ETH_EFM_REMFA l LASER_SHUT l PORT_EXC_TRAFFI
l ETH_AUTO_LINK_ ULT l LOOP_ALM C
DOWN l ETH_LOS l LPT_CFG_CLOSE- l PORTMODE_MIS-
l ETH_CFM_AIS PORT MATCH
l ETH_NO_FLOW
l ETH_CFM_LOC l LSR_NO_FITED l TEMP_ALARM
l ETHOAM_SELF_LO
l ETH_CFM_MISMER l LSR_WILL_DIE l TF
OP
GE l MAC_EXT_EXC l WRG_BD_TYPE
l FLOW_OVER
l ETH_CFM_RDI l MAC_FCS_EXC
l HARD_BAD
l ETH_CFM_UNEXPE
RI l IN_PWR_ABN

A.2.7 EG4P
l BD_STATUS l ETH_EFM_DF l IN_PWR_ABN l MAC_FCS_EXC
l BUS_ERR l ETH_EFM_EVENT l LAG_DOWN l MAC_FCS_SD
l DROPRATIO_OVER l ETH_EFM_LOOPBA l LAG_MEMBER_DO l MULTI_RPL_OWNE
l ERPS_IN_PROTEC- CK WN R
TION l ETH_EFM_REMFA l LASER_MOD_ERR l OUT_PWR_ABN
l ETH_AUTO_LINK_ ULT l LASER_SHUT l PORT_EXC_TRAFFI
DOWN l ETH_LOS l LOOP_ALM C
l ETH_CFM_AIS l ETH_NO_FLOW l LPT_CFG_CLOSE- l PORTMODE_MIS-
l ETH_CFM_LOC l ETH_PWR_SUPPLY PORT MATCH

l ETH_CFM_MISMER _FAIL l LSR_NO_FITED l TEMP_ALARM


GE l ETHOAM_SELF_LO l LSR_WILL_DIE l TF
l ETH_CFM_RDI OP l WRG_BD_TYPE
l MAC_EXT_EXC
l ETH_CFM_UNEXPE l FLOW_OVER
RI l HARD_BAD

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 299


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.2.8 EM6T
l BD_STATUS l ETH_CFM_MISMER l ETH_NO_FLOW l MAC_EXT_EXC
l BUS_ERR GE l ETHOAM_SELF_LO l MAC_FCS_EXC
l COMMUN_FAIL l ETH_CFM_RDI OP l MAC_FCS_SD
l DROPRATIO_OVER l ETH_CFM_UNEXPE l FLOW_OVER l MULTI_RPL_OWNE
RI
l ERPS_IN_PROTEC- l HARD_BAD R
TION l ETH_EFM_DF
l LAG_DOWN l PORT_EXC_TRAFFI
l ETH_AUTO_LINK_ l ETH_EFM_EVENT C
l LAG_MEMBER_DO
DOWN l ETH_EFM_LOOPBA WN l PORTMODE_MIS-
l ETH_CFM_AIS CK MATCH
l LOOP_ALM
l ETH_CFM_LOC l ETH_EFM_REMFA
l LPT_CFG_CLOSE- l TEMP_ALARM
ULT
PORT l WRG_BD_TYPE
l ETH_LOS

A.2.9 EM6TA
l BD_STATUS l ETH_CFM_MISMER l ETH_NO_FLOW l MAC_EXT_EXC
l BUS_ERR GE l ETHOAM_SELF_LO l MAC_FCS_EXC
l COMMUN_FAIL l ETH_CFM_RDI OP l MAC_FCS_SD
l DROPRATIO_OVER l ETH_CFM_UNEXPE l FLOW_OVER l MULTI_RPL_OWNE
RI
l ERPS_IN_PROTEC- l HARD_BAD R
TION l ETH_EFM_DF
l LAG_DOWN l PORT_EXC_TRAFFI
l ETH_AUTO_LINK_ l ETH_EFM_EVENT C
l LAG_MEMBER_DO
DOWN l ETH_EFM_LOOPBA WN l PORTMODE_MIS-
l ETH_CFM_AIS CK MATCH
l LOOP_ALM
l ETH_CFM_LOC l ETH_EFM_REMFA
l LPT_CFG_CLOSE- l TEMP_ALARM
ULT
PORT l WRG_BD_TYPE
l ETH_LOS

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 300


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.2.10 EM6F
l BD_STATUS l ETH_CFM_UNEXPE l IN_PWR_ABN l MAC_FCS_EXC
l BUS_ERR RI l LAG_DOWN l MAC_FCS_SD
l ETH_EFM_DF l LAG_MEMBER_DO l MULTI_RPL_OWNE
l COMMUN_FAIL
l ETH_EFM_EVENT WN R
l DROPRATIO_OVER
l ETH_EFM_LOOPBA l LASER_MOD_ERR l OUT_PWR_ABN
l ERPS_IN_PROTEC- CK
TION l LASER_SHUT l PORT_EXC_TRAFFI
l ETH_EFM_REMFA l LOOP_ALM C
l ETH_AUTO_LINK_ ULT
DOWN l LPT_CFG_CLOSE- l PORTMODE_MIS-
l ETH_LOS PORT MATCH
l ETH_CFM_AIS
l ETH_NO_FLOW l LSR_NO_FITED l TEMP_ALARM
l ETH_CFM_LOC
l ETHOAM_SELF_LO l LSR_WILL_DIE l TF
l ETH_CFM_MISMER OP l WRG_BD_TYPE
GE l MAC_EXT_EXC
l FLOW_OVER
l ETH_CFM_RDI l HARD_BAD

A.2.11 EM6FA
l BD_STATUS l ETH_CFM_UNEXPE l IN_PWR_ABN l MAC_FCS_EXC
l BUS_ERR RI l LAG_DOWN l MAC_FCS_SD
l ETH_EFM_DF l LAG_MEMBER_DO l MULTI_RPL_OWNE
l COMMUN_FAIL
l ETH_EFM_EVENT WN R
l DROPRATIO_OVER
l ETH_EFM_LOOPBA l LASER_MOD_ERR l OUT_PWR_ABN
l ERPS_IN_PROTEC- CK
TION l LASER_SHUT l PORT_EXC_TRAFFI
l ETH_EFM_REMFA l LOOP_ALM C
l ETH_AUTO_LINK_ ULT
DOWN l LPT_CFG_CLOSE- l PORTMODE_MIS-
l ETH_LOS PORT MATCH
l ETH_CFM_AIS
l ETH_NO_FLOW l LSR_NO_FITED l TEMP_ALARM
l ETH_CFM_LOC
l ETHOAM_SELF_LO l LSR_WILL_DIE l TF
l ETH_CFM_MISMER OP l WRG_BD_TYPE
GE l MAC_EXT_EXC
l FLOW_OVER
l ETH_CFM_RDI l HARD_BAD

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 301


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.2.12 EMS6
l ALM_GFP_dCSF l ETHOAM_RMT_LO l LCAS_TLCT l MULTI_RPL_OWNE
l ALM_GFP_dLFD OP l LINK_ERR R
l ETHOAM_RMT_SD l LOOP_ALM l NO_BD_SOFT
l B3_EXC_VC3
l ETHOAM_SELF_LO l LP_RDI_VC12 l OUT_PWR_ABN
l B3_SD_VC3
OP l PORT_MODULE_O
l BD_STATUS l LP_RDI_VC3
l EX_ETHOAM_CC_L FFLINE
l BIP_EXC OS l LP_REI_VC12
l TEMP_ALARM
l BIP_SD l EX_ETHOAM_MPI l LP_REI_VC3
l TU_AIS_VC12
D_CNFLCT l LP_SLM_VC12
l BUS_ERR l TU_AIS_VC3
l FCS_ERR l LP_SLM_VC3
l COMMUN_FAIL l TU_LOP_VC12
l FLOW_OVER l LP_TIM_VC12
l ETH_CFM_LOC l TU_LOP_VC3
l HARD_BAD l LP_TIM_VC3
l ETH_CFM_MISMER l VCAT_LOA
GE l IN_PWR_ABN l LP_UNEQ_VC12
l VCAT_LOM_VC12
l LAG_PORT_FAIL l LP_UNEQ_VC3
l ETH_CFM_RDI l VCAT_LOM_VC3
l LAG_VC_PORT_FA l LPT_INEFFECT
l ETH_CFM_UNEXPE l VCAT_SQM_VC12
IL l LPT_RFI
RI
l LCAS_FOPR l VCAT_SQM_VC3
l ETH_LOS l MOD_TYPE_MIS-
l LCAS_FOPT MATCH l WRG_BD_TYPE
l ETHOAM_DISCOV
ER_FAIL l LCAS_PLCR

l ETHOAM_RMT_CR l LCAS_PLCT
IT_FAULT l LCAS_TLCR

A.2.13 FAN
l BD_STATUS
l FAN_AGING
l FAN_FAIL
l POWER_ALM
l WRG_BD_TYPE

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 302


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.2.14 IF1
l AU_AIS l HP_CROSSTR l LICENSE_LOST l MW_LOF
l AU_LOP l HP_LOM l LOOP_ALM l MW_RDI
l B1_EXC l HP_RDI l MS_AIS l R_LOC
l B1_SD l HP_REI l MS_CROSSTR l R_LOF
l B2_EXC l HP_SLM l MS_RDI l R_LOS
l B2_SD l HP_TIM l MS_REI l RS_CROSSTR
l HP_UNEQ
l B3_EXC l MSAD_CROSSTR l T_LOC
l IF_CABLE_OPEN
l B3_SD l MW_CONT_WAVE l TEMP_ALARM
l IF_MODE_UNSUP-
l BD_STATUS PORTED l MW_FEC_UNCOR l VOLT_LOS
l HARD_BAD l LCS_LIMITED l MW_LIM l WRG_BD_TYPE

A.2.15 IFU2
l AM_DOWNSHIFT l ETH_EFM_EVENT l LOOP_ALM l MW_FEC_UNCOR
l BD_STATUS l ETH_EFM_LOOPBA l LP_RDI l MW_LIM
CK l LP_REI l MW_LOF
l BIP_EXC
l ETH_EFM_REMFA l LP_UNEQ l MW_RDI
l BIP_SD
ULT
l DROPRATIO_OVER l MAC_EXT_EXC l PORT_EXC_TRAFFI
l ETHOAM_SELF_LO C
l ERPS_IN_PROTEC- OP l MAC_FCS_EXC
TION l MULTI_RPL_OWNE l R_LOC
l FLOW_OVER
R l R_LOF
l ETH_CFM_AIS l HARD_BAD
l MW_BER_EXC l TEMP_ALARM
l ETH_CFM_LOC l IF_CABLE_OPEN
l MW_BER_SD l TU_AIS
l ETH_CFM_MISMER l LAG_BWMM
GE l MW_CFG_MISMAT l TU_LOP
l LAG_DOWN CH
l ETH_CFM_RDI l VOLT_LOS
l LAG_MEMBER_DO l MW_CONT_WAVE
WN l WRG_BD_TYPE
l ETH_CFM_UNEXPE
l MW_E1_LOST
RI l LCS_LIMITED
l ETH_EFM_DF l LICENSE_LOST

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 303


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.2.16 IFX2
l AM_DOWNSHIFT l ETH_EFM_LOOPBA l LP_REI l MW_RDI
l BD_STATUS CK l LP_UNEQ l PORT_EXC_TRAFFI
l ETH_EFM_REMFA l MAC_EXT_EXC C
l BIP_EXC
ULT l R_LOC
l BIP_SD l MAC_FCS_EXC
l ETHOAM_SELF_LO l R_LOF
l DROPRATIO_OVER OP l MULTI_RPL_OWNE
R l TEMP_ALARM
l ERPS_IN_PROTEC- l FLOW_OVER
TION l MW_BER_EXC l TU_AIS
l HARD_BAD
l MW_BER_SD l TU_LOP
l ETH_CFM_AIS l IF_CABLE_OPEN
l MW_CFG_MISMAT l VOLT_LOS
l ETH_CFM_LOC l LAG_BWMM CH l WRG_BD_TYPE
l ETH_CFM_MISMER l LAG_DOWN l MW_CONT_WAVE
GE l XPIC_LOS
l LAG_MEMBER_DO l MW_E1_LOST
l ETH_CFM_RDI WN
l MW_FEC_UNCOR
l ETH_CFM_UNEXPE l LCS_LIMITED
l MW_LIM
RI l LICENSE_LOST
l MW_LOF
l ETH_EFM_DF l LOOP_ALM
l ETH_EFM_EVENT l LP_RDI

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 304


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.2.17 ISU2
l AM_DOWNSHIFT l ETH_CFM_UNEXPE l LAG_MEMBER_DO l MW_CFG_MISMAT
l AU_AIS RI WN CH
l ETH_EFM_DF l LCS_LIMITED l MW_CONT_WAVE
l AU_LOP
l ETH_EFM_EVENT l LICENSE_LOST l MW_E1_LOST
l B1_EXC
l ETH_EFM_LOOPBA l LOOP_ALM l MW_FEC_UNCOR
l B1_SD CK
l LP_RDI l MW_LIM
l B2_EXC l ETH_EFM_REMFA
l LP_REI l MW_LOF
l B2_SD ULT
l MW_RDI
l B3_EXC l ETHOAM_SELF_LO l LP_UNEQ
OP l PORT_EXC_TRAFFI
l B3_SD l MAC_EXT_EXC
C
l FLOW_OVER l MAC_FCS_EXC
l BD_STATUS l R_LOC
l HARD_BAD l MS_AIS
l BIP_EXC l R_LOF
l HP_CROSSTR l MS_CROSSTR
l BIP_SD l RS_CROSSTR
l HP_LOM
l DROPRATIO_OVER l MS_RDI l T_LOC
l HP_RDI
l ERPS_IN_PROTEC- l MS_REI l TEMP_ALARM
l HP_REI
TION l MSAD_CROSSTR l TU_AIS
l HP_SLM
l ETH_CFM_AIS l MULTI_RPL_OWNE l TU_LOP
l HP_TIM R
l ETH_CFM_LOC l VOLT_LOS
l HP_UNEQ
l ETH_CFM_MISMER l MW_AM_TEST l WRG_BD_TYPE
l IF_CABLE_OPEN
GE l MW_BER_EXC
l LAG_BWMM
l ETH_CFM_RDI l MW_BER_SD
l LAG_DOWN

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 305


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.2.18 ISV3
l AM_DOWNSHIFT l ETH_CFM_UNEXPE l LAG_MEMBER_DO l MW_CFG_MISMAT
l AU_AIS RI WN CH
l ETH_EFM_DF l LCS_LIMITED l MW_CONT_WAVE
l AU_LOP
l ETH_EFM_EVENT l LICENSE_LOST l MW_E1_LOST
l B1_EXC
l ETH_EFM_LOOPBA l LOOP_ALM l MW_FEC_UNCOR
l B1_SD CK
l B2_EXC l LP_RDI l MW_LIM
l ETH_EFM_REMFA
l B2_SD ULT l LP_REI l MW_LOF

l B3_EXC l ETHOAM_SELF_LO l LP_UNEQ l MW_RDI


OP l MAC_EXT_EXC l PORT_EXC_TRAFFI
l B3_SD
l FLOW_OVER l MAC_FCS_EXC C
l BD_STATUS
l HARD_BAD l MS_AIS l R_LOC
l BIP_EXC
l HP_CROSSTR l MS_CROSSTR l R_LOF
l BIP_SD
l HP_LOM l RS_CROSSTR
l DROPRATIO_OVER l MS_RDI
l HP_RDI l T_LOC
l ERPS_IN_PROTEC- l MS_REI
l HP_REI l TEMP_ALARM
TION l MSAD_CROSSTR
l HP_SLM l TU_AIS
l ETH_CFM_AIS l MULTI_RPL_OWNE
l HP_TIM R l TU_LOP
l ETH_CFM_LOC
l HP_UNEQ
l ETH_CFM_MISMER l MW_AM_TEST l VOLT_LOS
l IF_CABLE_OPEN
GE l MW_BER_EXC l WRG_BD_TYPE
l LAG_BWMM
l ETH_CFM_RDI l MW_BER_SD l XPIC_LOS
l LAG_DOWN

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 306


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.2.19 ISX2
l AM_DOWNSHIFT l ETH_CFM_UNEXPE l LAG_MEMBER_DO l MW_CFG_MISMAT
l AU_AIS RI WN CH
l ETH_EFM_DF l LCS_LIMITED l MW_CONT_WAVE
l AU_LOP
l ETH_EFM_EVENT l LICENSE_LOST l MW_E1_LOST
l B1_EXC
l ETH_EFM_LOOPBA l LOOP_ALM l MW_FEC_UNCOR
l B1_SD CK
l B2_EXC l LP_RDI l MW_LIM
l ETH_EFM_REMFA
l B2_SD ULT l LP_REI l MW_LOF

l B3_EXC l ETHOAM_SELF_LO l LP_UNEQ l MW_RDI


OP l MAC_EXT_EXC l PORT_EXC_TRAFFI
l B3_SD
l FLOW_OVER l MAC_FCS_EXC C
l BD_STATUS
l HARD_BAD l MS_AIS l R_LOC
l BIP_EXC
l HP_CROSSTR l MS_CROSSTR l R_LOF
l BIP_SD
l HP_LOM l RS_CROSSTR
l DROPRATIO_OVER l MS_RDI
l HP_RDI l T_LOC
l ERPS_IN_PROTEC- l MS_REI
l HP_REI l TEMP_ALARM
TION l MSAD_CROSSTR
l HP_SLM l TU_AIS
l ETH_CFM_AIS l MULTI_RPL_OWNE
l HP_TIM R l TU_LOP
l ETH_CFM_LOC
l HP_UNEQ
l ETH_CFM_MISMER l MW_AM_TEST l VOLT_LOS
l IF_CABLE_OPEN
GE l MW_BER_EXC l WRG_BD_TYPE
l LAG_BWMM
l ETH_CFM_RDI l MW_BER_SD l XPIC_LOS
l LAG_DOWN

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 307


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.2.20 ML1/MD1
l ALM_E1RAI l CES_LOSPKT_EXC l LCD l TR_LOC
l ALM_IMA_LIF l CES_MALPKT_EXC l LFA l UHCS
l ALM_IMA_LODS l CES_MISORDERPK l LMFA l UP_E1_AIS
l ALM_IMA_RE_RX_ T_EXC l LOOP_ALM l VC_AIS
UNUSABLE l CES_RDI l MP_DELAY l VC_LOC
l ALM_IMA_RE_TX_ l CES_STRAYPKT_E l MP_DOWN l VC_RDI
UNUSABLE XC
l OCD l VP_AIS
l ALM_IMA_RFI l CESPW_OPPOSITE_
ACFAULT l POWER_ABNORM l VP_LOC
l ATMPW_UNKNOW AL
NCELL_EXC l CESPW_OPPOSITE_ l VP_RDI
RAI l PPP_LCP_FAIL l WRG_BD_TYPE
l BD_STATUS
l CHCS l PPP_NCP_FAIL
l BUS_ERR
l HARD_BAD l T_ALOS
l CES_ACR_LOCK_A
BN l IMA_GROUP_LE_D l TEMP_ALARM

l CES_JTROVR_EXC OWN

l CES_JTRUDR_EXC l IMA_GROUP_RE_D
OWN
l IMA_TXCLK_MIS-
MATCH

A.2.21 ODU
l BD_STATUS l LOOP_ALM l RADIO_RSL_BE- l RADIO_TSL_LOW
l CONFIG_NOSUPPO l POWER_ALM YONDTH l TEMP_ALARM
RT l RADIO_FADING_M l RADIO_RSL_HIGH l WRG_BD_TYPE
l HARD_BAD ARGIN_INSUFF l RADIO_RSL_LOW
l IF_INPWR_ABN l RADIO_MUTE l RADIO_TSL_HIGH

A.2.22 PIU
l BD_STATUS
l HARD_BAD
l POWER_ABNORMAL
l TEMP_ALARM
l THUNDERALM
l WRG_BD_TYPE

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 308


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.2.23 PMU
l BAT1TEMP_SENSO l ENVTEMP2_SENSO l ODC_HUMI_ABN l ODC_SURGE_PROT
R_FAIL R_FAIL l ODC_LOAD_PWRD ECTION_FAIL
l BAT2TEMP_SENSO l HARD_BAD OWN l ODC_TEMP_ABN
R_FAIL l ODC_BATTERY_C l ODC_MDL_ABN l ODC_WATER_ALM
l BD_STATUS URRENT_ABN l ODC_POWER_FAIL l WRG_BD_TYPE
l ENVHUM_SENSOR l ODC_BATTERY_P l ODC_SMOKE_OVE
_FAIL WRDOWN R
l ENVTEMP1_SENSO l ODC_DOOR_OPEN
R_FAIL

A.2.24 SL1D/SL1DA
l AU_AIS l HP_CROSSTR l LASER_CLOSE l MSAD_CROSS
l AU_LOP l HP_LOM D TR

l B1_EXC l HP_RDI l LASER_MOD_ l OUT_PWR_AB


ERR_EX N
l B1_SD l HP_REI
l LOOP_ALM l R_LOC
l B2_EXC l HP_SLM
l LSR_BCM_AL l R_LOF
l B2_SD l HP_TIM M l R_LOS
l B3_EXC l HP_UNEQ l LSR_NO_FITE l RS_CROSSTR
l B3_SD l IN_PWR_HIGH D
l T_LOC
l BD_STATUS l IN_PWR_LOW l LSR_WILL_DIE
l TF
l HARD_BAD l J0_MM l MS_AIS
l WRG_BD_TYP
l MS_CROSSTR E
l MS_RDI
l MS_REI

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 309


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.2.25 SL4D
l AU_AIS l HP_CROSSTR l LASER_CLOSE l MSAD_CROSS
l AU_LOP l HP_LOM D TR

l B1_EXC l HP_RDI l LASER_MOD_ l OUT_PWR_AB


ERR_EX N
l B1_SD l HP_REI
l LOOP_ALM l R_LOC
l B2_EXC l HP_SLM
l LSR_BCM_AL l R_LOF
l B2_SD l HP_TIM M l R_LOS
l B3_EXC l HP_UNEQ l LSR_NO_FITE l RS_CROSSTR
l B3_SD l IN_PWR_HIGH D
l T_LOC
l BD_STATUS l IN_PWR_LOW l LSR_WILL_DIE
l TF
l HARD_BAD l J0_MM l MS_AIS
l WRG_BD_TYP
l MS_CROSSTR E
l MS_RDI
l MS_REI

A.2.26 SP3S/SP3D
l A_LOC l E1_LOS l LP_REI l TU_AIS
l BD_STATUS l HARD_BAD l LP_RFI l TU_LOP
l BIP_EXC l HPAD_CROSSTR l LP_SLM l UP_E1_AIS
l BIP_SD l LOOP_ALM l LP_T_FIFO l WRG_BD_TYPE
l DDN_LFA l LP_CROSSTR l LP_TIM
l DOWN_E1_AIS l LP_R_FIFO l LP_UNEQ
l E1_LOC l LP_RDI l T_ALOS

A.2.27 TCU
l BD_STATUS l INTEMP_SENSOR_ l ODC_SURGE_PROT l OUT1TEMP_SENSO
l BDTEMP_SENSOR_ FAIL ECTION_FAIL R_FAIL
FAIL l ODC_DOOR_OPEN l ODC_TEC_ALM l OUT2TEMP_SENSO
l ENVTEMP_SENSOR l ODC_FAN_FAILED l ODC_TEMP_ABN R_FAIL
_FAIL l ODC_SMOKE_OVE l ODC_WATER_ALM l WRG_BD_TYPE
l HARD_BAD R

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 310


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3 Alarms and Handling Procedures


This chapter describes all the alarms on the OptiX RTN 980 in alphabetical order and how to
handle these alarms.

A.3.1 A_LOC

Description
The A_LOC is an alarm indicating that a clock signal is lost in the uplink bus.

packet capturing/Call History Record/Security redline/inteface

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the A_LOC alarm occurs, the services carried by the board are interrupted.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: A certain board is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: A certain board is faulty.
1. Replace the board where the alarmed tributary unit is located.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.2 ACR_LOCK_FAIL

Description
The ACR_LOCK_FAIL is an alarm indicating an IEEE 1588 ACR locking failure. This alarm
is reported when the NE works in 1588 ACR mode and the clock fails to be locked.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 311


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 l 0x01: indicates that the phase-locked loop (PLL) is in holdover or free-run
mode.
l 0x02: indicates that the Sync timestamp remains unchanged when the
Precision Time Protocol (PTP) clock is synchronized.
l 0x03: indicates that the PDV on the transport network exceeds the upper
threshold.
l 0x04: indicates that the ACR algorithm is in the quick lockout phase.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the clock of the downstream NE is abnormal.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The frequency deviation of the clock source or the delay of the intermediate
network exceeds the upper threshold.
l Cause 2: The physical link where the traced clock source resides is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Handle the alarm according to the alarm parameters.

If... Then...

Parameter 1 = 0x01 Go to steps 3 and 4.

Parameter 1 = 0x02 Go to step 4.

Parameter 1 = 0x03 Go to step 3.

Parameter 1 = 0x04 No further action is required. Wait for a while (about 15 minutes). Then,
check whether the alarm is cleared.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 312


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Step 2 Check whether a hardware alarm such as HARD_BAD occurs on the SCC board or interface
board that accesses clocks. If yes, clear the alarm immediately.

Step 3 Query the PDV performance of the NE to determine whether the third-party network is running
properly. If not, ask the customer to optimize the PDV. For details about how to query PDV
performance of the local NE, see B.3.5 CURPOSITIVEPDV and CURNEGATIVEPDV.

Step 4 Check the status of the master NE. If the master NE is abnormal, troubleshoot the abnormality
first.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.3 ALM_E1RAI

Description
The ALM_E1RAI is an alarm indicating that the E1 link on the opposite NE reports alarms. This
alarm is reported on the local NE when the T_ALOS, UP_E1_AIS, DOWN_E1_AIS, LFA, or
LMFA alarm is reported on the opposite NE.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the services on the local NE in the downstream direction are interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The E1 link on the opposite NE reports the T_ALOS, LFA, LMFA, UP_E1_AIS,
or DOWN_E1_AIS alarm.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The E1 link on the opposite NE reports the T_ALOS, LFA, LMFA, UP_E1_AIS, or
DOWN_E1_AIS alarm.

Step 2 Handle these alarms first.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 313


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Related Information
None.

A.3.4 ALM_GFP_dCSF

Description
The ALM_GFP_dCSF is an alarm indicating that the generic framing procedure (GFP) customer
signal is lost. When the source end fails to receive the GFP customer signal, it sends the
management frame to the sink end. The ALM_GFP_dCSF alarm is reported when the sink end
receives the management frame.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Critical Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 The value is always 0x01.
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of the alarmed VCTRUNK. For example, 0x00 0x01
indicate that the alarm is reported in VCTRUNK 1.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, services are interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Timeslot binding is different at the source and sink VCTRUNKs.
l Cause 2: The radio link performance degrades.
l Cause 3: The alarmed board is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Timeslot binding is different at the source and sink VCTRUNKs.
1. Reconfigure the timeslot binding at the source and sink VCTRUNKs.

Step 2 Cause 2: The radio link performance degrades.


1. Troubleshoot the radio link.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 314


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Step 3 Cause 3: The alarmed board is faulty.


1. Replace the faulty board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.5 ALM_GFP_dLFD

Description
The ALM_GFP_dLFD is an alarm indicating that the GFP frame is out of frame. This alarm
occurs when a board detects that the GFP frame is out of frame.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the ID of the logical port, and the value is always 0x01.
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of the alarmed VCTRUNK. For example, 0x00 0x01
indicate that the alarm is reported in VCTRUNK 1.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, services are interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Bit errors occur on certain links or certain links are faulty.
l Cause 2: When the LCAS is disabled, the source and the sink VCTRUNKs are configured
with different timeslots or different numbers of paths.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Bit errors occur on certain links or certain links are faulty.
1. Check whether the links where the service travels have errors or become faulty.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 315


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The links are faulty Rectify the fault.
The links are normal Replace the alarmed board.

Step 2 Cause 2: When the LCAS is disabled, the source and the sink VCTRUNKs are configured with
different timeslots or different numbers of paths.
1. Correct the configuration data. For details, see Configuring VCTRUNKs on an Ethernet
Board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.6 ALM_IMA_LIF

Description
The ALM_IMA_LIF is an alarm indicating that the IMA link is out of frame in the receive
direction. This alarm occurs when the frame alignment is lost on the IMA link in the receive
direction.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1, Parameter 2 Indicate the ATM Trunk ID.

Impact on the System


l When this alarm occurs, the alarmed IMA link is unavailable. Therefore, the number of
available links in the IMA group decreases. If the bandwidth of the services configured for
the IMA group exceeds the total bandwidth of available IMA links, congestion occurs on
the IMA port, causing loss of cells.
l After this alarm is cleared, the affected IMA link becomes available.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 316


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The path that carries the IMA link reports the SDH alarms, such as R_LOS,
R_LOF, and MS_AIS.
l Cause 2: The IMA protocol negotiation fails between the two ends.
l Cause 3: The IMA link is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The path that carries the IMA link reports the SDH alarms, such as R_LOS,
R_LOF, and MS_AIS.

If... Then...
The path reports any SDH alarm Handle the relevant alarms first.
The path does not report any SDH alarm Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The IMA protocol negotiation fails between the two ends.
1. Disable the IMA protocol at the two ends.
2. Check the IMA group configuration at the two ends and ensure that the configuration is
consistent.
3. Enable the IMA protocol at the two ends.
4. Then, check whether the alarm clears.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: The IMA link is faulty.


1. Replace the board. For details, see 6.6 Replacing the Smart E1 Interface Board.

----End

Related Information
Loss of frame alignment

A frame alignment word, provided at the physical layer, occupies the initial position of a frame
and defines the start of information field. An Out Of Frame (OOF) defect is declared when the
position of frame alignment word cannot be determined in the input bit stream.

A.3.7 ALM_IMA_LODS

Description
The ALM_IMA_LODS is an alarm indicating the differential delay on the IMA link crosses the
threshold. This alarm occurs when the maximum differential delay on the IMA link exceeds the
preset value.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 317


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1, Parameter 2 Indicate the ATM Trunk ID.

Impact on the System


The IMA links are unavailable.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The maximum differential delay is configured incorrectly.
l Cause 2: Within one IMA group, the transmission distances of member links have too large
gaps.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The maximum differential delay is configured incorrectly.
1. Change the maximum differential delay to a greater value. For details, see Modifying CES
Service Parameters.

Step 2 Cause 2: Within one IMA group, the transmission distances of member links have too large
gaps.
1. Use the meter to measure the transmission time on E1 links. If the transmission time on
different links has a gap larger than 25 ms (default value), adjust the IMA links or delete
the member link with over long transmission time from the IMA group.

----End

Related Information
Differential delay

Differential delay refers to the service delay difference between E1 links.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 318


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.8 ALM_IMA_RE_RX_UNUSABLE

Description
The ALM_IMA_RE_RX_UNUSABLE is an alarm indicating that the IMA link on the opposite
NE fails in the receive direction.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1, Parameter 2 Indicate the ATM Trunk ID.

Impact on the System


l When this alarm occurs, the alarmed IMA link is unavailable. Therefore, the number of
available links in the IMA group decreases. If the bandwidth of the services configured for
the IMA group exceeds the total bandwidth of available IMA links, congestion occurs on
the IMA port, causing loss of cells.
l After this alarm is cleared, the affected IMA link becomes available.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The path that carries the IMA link reports the SDH alarms, such as R_LOS,
R_LOF, and MS_AIS.
l Cause 2: The IMA protocol negotiation fails between the two ends.
l Cause 3: The IMA link is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The path that carries the IMA link reports the SDH alarms, such as R_LOS,
R_LOF, and MS_AIS.

If... Then...
The path reports any SDH alarm Handle the relevant alarms first.
The path does not report any SDH alarm Go to Cause 2.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 319


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Step 2 Cause 2: The IMA protocol negotiation fails between the two ends.
1. Disable the IMA protocol at the two ends.
2. Check the IMA group configuration at the two ends and ensure that the configuration is
consistent.
3. Enable the IMA protocol at the two ends.
4. Then, check whether the alarm clears.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: The IMA link is faulty.


1. Replace the board. For details, see 6.6 Replacing the Smart E1 Interface Board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.9 ALM_IMA_RE_TX_UNUSABLE

Description
The ALM_IMA_RE_TX_UNUSABLE is an alarm indicating that the IMA link on the opposite
NE fails in the transmit direction.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1, Parameter 2 Indicate the ATM Trunk ID.

Impact on the System


l When this alarm occurs, the alarmed IMA link is unavailable. Therefore, the number of
available links in the IMA group decreases. If the bandwidth of the services configured for

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 320


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

the IMA group exceeds the total bandwidth of available IMA links, congestion occurs on
the IMA port, causing loss of cells.
l After this alarm is cleared, the affected IMA link becomes available.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The path that carries the IMA link reports the SDH alarms, such as R_LOS,
R_LOF, and MS_AIS.
l Cause 2: The IMA protocol negotiation fails between the two ends.
l Cause 3: The IMA link is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The path that carries the IMA link reports the SDH alarms, such as R_LOS,
R_LOF, and MS_AIS.

If... Then...
The path reports any SDH alarm Handle the relevant alarms first.
The path does not report any SDH alarm Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The IMA protocol negotiation fails between the two ends.
1. Disable the IMA protocol at the two ends.
2. Check the IMA group configuration at the two ends and ensure that the configuration is
consistent.
3. Enable the IMA protocol at the two ends.
4. Then, check whether the alarm clears.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: The IMA link is faulty.


1. Replace the board. For details, see 6.6 Replacing the Smart E1 Interface Board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.10 ALM_IMA_RFI

Description
The ALM_IMA_RFI is an alarm indicating that the IMA link on the opposite NE is out of frame
(OOF) in the receive direction. This alarm occurs when the frame alignment is lost on the IMA
link of the opposite NE and the opposite NE notifies the local NE of its OOF state.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 321


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1, Parameter 2 Indicate the ATM Trunk ID.

Impact on the System


l When this alarm occurs, the alarmed IMA link is unavailable. Therefore, the number of
available links in the IMA group decreases. If the bandwidth of the services configured for
the IMA group exceeds the total bandwidth of available IMA links, congestion occurs on
the IMA port, causing loss of cells.
l After this alarm is cleared, the affected IMA link becomes available.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The path that carries the IMA link reports the SDH alarms, such as R_LOS,
R_LOF, and MS_AIS.
l Cause 2: The IMA protocol negotiation fails between the two ends.
l Cause 3: The IMA link is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The path that carries the IMA link reports the SDH alarms, such as R_LOS,
R_LOF, and MS_AIS.

If... Then...
The path reports any SDH alarm Handle the relevant alarms first.
The path does not report any SDH alarm Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The IMA protocol negotiation fails between the two ends.
1. Disable the IMA protocol at the two ends.
2. Check the IMA group configuration at the two ends and ensure that the configuration is
consistent.
3. Enable the IMA protocol at the two ends.
4. Then, check whether the alarm clears.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 322


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: The IMA link is faulty.


1. Replace the board. For details, see 6.6 Replacing the Smart E1 Interface Board.

----End

Related Information
Frame alignment loss

A frame alignment word, provided at the physical layer, occupies the initial position of a frame
and defines the start of information field. An Out Of Frame (OOF) defect is declared when the
position of frame alignment word cannot be determined in the input bit stream.

A.3.11 AM_DOWNSHIFT

Description
The AM_DOWNSHIFT alarm indicates the downshift of the AM scheme. This alarm occurs
after the AM mode is downshifted from the highest-order modulation scheme to the lower-order
modulation scheme. After the AM mode is upshifted from the lower-order modulation scheme
to the highest-order modulation scheme, this alarm is cleared.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the AM_DOWNSHIFT alarm occurs, the transmission capacity is reduced.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The external factors (for example, the climate) cause the degradation of the
working channels.
l Cause 2: There are interferences around the working channels.
l Cause 3: The ODU at the transmit end has abnormal transmit power.
l Cause 4: The ODU at the receive end has abnormal receive power.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 323


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The external factors (for example, the climate) cause the degradation of the working
channels.
1. When the external factors (for example, the climate) cause the degradation of the working
channels, the downshift of the AM scheme is normal. Hence, no measures should be taken
to handle the alarm.

Step 2 Cause 2: There are interferences around the working channels.


1. Eliminate the interferences around the working channels.

Step 3 Cause 3: The ODU at the transmit end has abnormal transmit power.
1. Use the NMS to check whether the transmit power of the ODU at the transmit end is normal.
For details on troubleshooting at the transmit end, see Troubleshooting Microwave
Links.

Step 4 Cause 4: The ODU at the receive end has abnormal receive power.
1. Use the NMS to check whether the receive power of the ODU at the receive end is normal.
For details on troubleshooting at the receive end, see Troubleshooting Microwave
Links.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.12 APS_FAIL

Description
The APS_FAIL is an alarm indicating that the MS protection switching fails.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 324


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the type of the protection group.

l 0x01: linear MS protection


l 0x02: ring MS protection
Parameter 2 Indicates the ID of the alarmed protection group. For example, 0x01 indicates
that the alarm is reported by protection group 1.

Impact on the System


When the APS_FAIL alarm occurs, the services cannot be switched. If the current paths are
unavailable, the services are interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The parameters of the MSP protocol are set incorrectly.
l Cause 2: The parameters of the MSP protocol are lost.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The parameters of the MSP protocol are set incorrectly.
1. Check whether the parameters of the MSP protocol are set correctly.

If... Then...
The parameters are set incorrectly Set the parameters correctly.
The parameters are set correctly Go to the next step.

Step 2 Cause 2: The parameters of the MSP protocol are lost.


1. Check whether the MSP protocol is normal on the network.
2. Check whether the MSP protocol is normal on the network. For details, see Enabling/
Disabling the linear MSP protocol or Enabling/Disabling the ring MSP protocol.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared after the protocol is End the alarm handling.
restarted
The alarm persists after the protocol is Contact Huawei engineers to handle the
restarted alarm.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.13 APS_INDI

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 325


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Description
The APS_INDI is an alarm indicating that the MS protection switching occurs.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the type of the protection group.

l 0x01: linear MS protection.


l 0x02: ring MS protection.
Parameter 2 Indicates the ID of the alarmed protection group. For example, 0x01 indicates
that the alarm is reported by protection group 1.

Impact on the System


During the switching ( 50 ms), the service is interrupted. After the switching is complete, the
services are restored to normal. In the case of 1:N MS protection, after the switching starts and
before the switching is complete, the extra services are interrupted.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The MS protection switching occurs.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The MS protection switching occurs.
1. Query the linear MSP group or query the ring MSP group.
2. Check whether the MSP protocol is in the manual switching state, forced switching state,
or locked switching state. If yes, release the switching and check whether the alarm is
cleared.
3. Check whether the MSP protocol is in the automatic switching state. Do as follows:
a. Handle the R_LOS, R_LOF, MS_AIS, B2_EXC, or B2_SD alarm that the equipment
reports. After the alarms are cleared, wait until the MSP protocol is changed from the
automatic switching state to the normal state. Then, check whether the APS_INDI
alarm is cleared.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 326


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

b. Check whether the service board configured with the MSP protocol is faulty. If yes,
replace the faulty board and then check whether the APS_INDI alarm is cleared.
c. Check whether the currently working system control and cross-connect board is faulty.
If the currently working system control and cross-connect board is faulty and a
protection system control and cross-connect board is available, switch the service to
the protection system control and cross-connect board and replace the faulty system
control and cross-connect board. Then, check whether the APS_INDI alarm is
cleared.

----End

Related Information
This alarm is also reported upon a packet-based linear MSP switching. For querying the packet-
based Linear MSP group, refer toQuerying the Status of a Packet-based Linear MSP Group.

A.3.14 APS_MANUAL_STOP

Description
The APS_MANUAL_STOP is an alarm indicating that the MSP protocol is stopped manually.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Minor Processing alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the type of the protection group.

l 0x01: linear MS protection.


l 0x02: ring MS protection.
Parameter 2 Indicates the ID of the alarmed protection group. For example, 0x01 indicates
that the alarm is reported by protection group 1.

Impact on the System


When the APS_MANUAL_STOP alarm occurs, the MSP protocol may fail and therefore the
protection switching may fail.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 327


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The MSP protocol is stopped manually.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The MSP protocol is stopped manually.
1. Enable/Disable the linear MSP protocol or Enable/Disable the ring MSP protocol.

----End

Related Information
This alarm is also reported upon a packet linear MSP switching. For enabling/disabling the
packet linear MSP protocol, refer toEnabling/Disabling the Linear MSP Protocol.

A.3.15 ATMPW_UNKNOWNCELL_EXC

Description
The ATMPW_UNKNOWNCELL_EXC is an alarm indicating that the number of unknown
cells exceeds the specified threshold in a time unit. This alarm occurs when the board detects
that, within a period (2.5s), the number of unknown cells crosses the specified threshold.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


An unknown cell is discarded once it is detected. As a result, the packet loss rate increases and
services are affected.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: PW control words mismatch.
l Cause 2: PW types mismatch.
l Cause 3: Fragments are received on the network side.

Procedure
Step 1 Check whether the configuration at the two ends of the PW is consistent. If not, modify the
configuration.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 328


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Step 2 Check whether connections are correct. If not, reconnect fibers or reconfigure connections.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.16 AU_AIS

Description
The AU_AIS is an alarm indicating the administrative unit (AU). This alarm occurs when the
board detects the AU pointer of all 1s for three consecutive frames.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the AU_AIS alarm occurs, the service in the alarmed AU-4 path is interrupted. If the
services are configured with protection, protection switching may be triggered.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The opposite NE inserts the AU_AIS alarm.
l Cause 2: The transmit unit of the opposite NE is faulty.
l Cause 3: The receive unit of the local NE is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The opposite NE inserts the AU_AIS alarm.

If... Then...
The alarm that triggers the AU_AIS insertion occurs Clear the alarm immediately.
No such alarms that trigger the AU_AIS insertion occur Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The transmit unit of the opposite NE is faulty.


1. Replace the line board at the opposite end

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 329


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared after replacement The fault is rectified. End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists after replacement Go to the next step.

2. Replace the system control, cross-connect, and timing board at the opposite end.

Step 3 Cause 3: The receive unit of the local NE is faulty.


1. Replace the alarmed board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.17 AU_LOP

Description
The AU_LOP is an alarm indicating the loss of the AU pointer. This alarm occurs when a board
detects the AU pointer of invalid values or with the NDF for eight consecutive frames.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the AU_LOP alarm occurs, the service in the alarmed AU-4 path is interrupted. If the
services are configured with protection, protection switching may be triggered.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The transmit unit of the opposite NE is faulty.
l Cause 2: The receive unit of the local NE is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The transmit unit of the opposite NE is faulty.
1. Replace the line board at the opposite end.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 330


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared after replacement The fault is rectified. End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists after replacement Go to the next step.
2. Replace the system control, cross-connect, and timing board at the opposite end.

Step 2 Cause 2: The receive unit of the local NE is faulty.


1. Replace the alarmed board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.18 B1_EXC

Description
The B1_EXC is an alarm indicating that the B1 errors (in the regenerator section) exceed the
threshold. This alarm occurs when the board detects that the B1 errors exceed the preset B1_EXC
alarm threshold (10-3 by default).

An IF board that works in PDH mode may also report this alarm. This alarm is detected by using
the self-defined overhead byte B1 in PDH microwave frames.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Service alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the B1_EXC alarm occurs, the services on the port are interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by an SDH optical interface
board).
l Cause 2: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by an IF board).
l Cause 3: The network clock quality degrades.
l Cause 4: The board is faulty (if the alarm is reported by an SDH optical interface board).
l Cause 5: The board is faulty (if the alarm is reported by an IF board).

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 331


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by an SDH optical interface
board).
1. Check whether the transmit power at the opposite end and the receive power at the local
end meet the specifications of the optical interfaces. For details, see 4.3.3 Browsing
Current Performance Events.

If... Then...
The transmit power of the opposite NE is over Replace the SFP on the opposite NE.
low
The transmit power of the opposite NE is The fiber is faulty. Go to the next step.
normal, but the receive power of the local NE
is close to the value (for example, within 3
dB) of the receiver sensitivity.

2. Exchange the core fibers of the optical cables in the receive and transmit directions of a
channel.

If... Then...
The errors vary with the change of the fiber The fiber is faulty. Go to the next step.
The errors do not vary with the change of the Ensure that the board is normal.
fiber.

3. If the fiber is faulty, check whether the fiber jumper from the equipment to the optical
distribution frame (ODF) and the fiber that is led out of the equipment room are pressed,
and whether the fiber connector is dirty. If yes, replace the fiber jumper or fiber connector.

Step 2 Cause 2: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by an IF board).
1. Check whether the MW_BER_EXC, MW_BER_SD, MW_FEC_UNCOR or
RPS_INDI alarm is reported. If yes, clear the alarm.

Step 3 Cause 3: The network clock quality degrades.


1. Check the network clock status of the alarmed NE.

If... Then...
The clock source of the local NE is The clock may become asynchronous and B1
different from the clock source of the errors may occur. Reconfigure the clock
opposite NE source, and ensure that the clock is
synchronized on the local NE and opposite
NE.
The clock of the local NE and the clock This may cause errors and even service
of the opposite NE form a timing loop interruption. In this case, reconfigure the clock
source and release the timing loop.

Step 4 Cause 4: The board is faulty (if the alarm is reported by an SDH optical interface board).
1. The board of the SDH line unit on the local NE is faulty. Loop back the optical interfaces
of the NE by using a fiber jumper to locate the fault.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 332


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The fault is not rectified after the optical Replace the board where the alarmed
interfaces are looped back line unit is located on the local NE.
The fault is rectified after the optical Replace the board where the line unit is
interfaces are looped back located on the opposite NE.

Step 5 Cause 5: The board is faulty (if the alarm is reported by an IF board).
1. Perform an inloop for the multiplexing interface of the IF board on the local NE.

If... Then...
The fault is not rectified after the Replace the alarmed IF board on the
multiplexing interface is looped back local NE.
The fault is rectified after the multiplexing Replace the alarmed IF board on the
interface is looped back opposite NE.

----End

Related Information
The handling procedure applies when this alarm is reported by the STM-1e port.

Handle the errors of TDM services.

A.3.19 B1_SD

Description
The B1_SD is an alarm indicating that the signal degrades due to the excessive B1 errors (in the
regenerator section). This alarm occurs when the board detects that the B1 errors exceed the
preset B1_SD alarm threshold (10-6 by default) but do not reach the preset B1_EXC alarm
threshold (10-3 by default).

An IF board that works in PDH mode may also report this alarm. This alarm is detected by using
the self-defined overhead byte B1 in PDH microwave frames.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Service alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the B1_SD alarm occurs, the service performance on the port degrades.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 333


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by an SDH optical interface
board).
l Cause 2: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by an IF board).
l Cause 3: The network clock quality degrades.
l Cause 4: The board is faulty (if the alarm is reported by an SDH optical interface board).
l Cause 5: The board is faulty (if the alarm is reported by an IF board).

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by an SDH optical interface
board).
1. Check whether the transmit power at the opposite end and the receive power at the local
end meet the specifications of the optical interfaces. For details, see 4.3.3 Browsing
Current Performance Events.

If... Then...
The transmit power of the opposite NE is over Replace the SFP on the opposite NE.
low
The transmit power of the opposite NE is The fiber is faulty. Go to the next step.
normal, but the receive power of the local NE
is close to the value (for example, within 3
dB) of the receiver sensitivity
2. Exchange the core fibers of the optical cables in the receive and transmit directions of a
channel.

If... Then...
The errors vary with the change of the fiber The fiber is faulty. Go to the next step.
The errors do not vary with the change of the Ensure that the board is normal.
fiber
3. If the fiber is faulty, check whether the fiber jumper from the equipment to the optical
distribution frame (ODF) and the fiber that is led out of the equipment room are pressed,
and whether the fiber connector is dirty. If yes, replace the fiber jumper or fiber connector.

Step 2 Cause 2: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by an IF board).
1. Check whether the MW_BER_EXC, MW_BER_SD, MW_FEC_UNCOR alarm is
generated. If yes, clear the alarm.

Step 3 Cause 3: The network clock quality degrades.


1. Check the network clock status of the alarmed NE.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 334


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The clock source of the local NE is The clock may become asynchronous and
different from the clock source of the errors may occur. Reconfigure the clock
opposite NE source, and ensure that the clock is
synchronized on the local NE and opposite
NE.
The clock of the local NE and the clock This may cause errors and even service
of the opposite NE form a timing loop interruption. In this case, reconfigure the clock
source and release the timing loop.

Step 4 Cause 4: The board is faulty (if the alarm is reported by an SDH optical interface board).
1. The SDH optical line board of the local NE is faulty. Loop back the optical interfaces of
the NE by using a fiber jumper to locate the fault.

If... Then...
The fault is not rectified after the optical Replace the board where the alarmed
interfaces are looped back line unit is located on the local NE.
The fault is rectified after the optical Replace the board where the line unit is
interfaces are looped back located on the opposite NE.

Step 5 Cause 5: The board is faulty (if the alarm is reported by an IF board).
1. Perform an inloop for the multiplexing interface of the IF board on the local NE.

If... Then...
The fault is not rectified after the Replace the alarmed IF board on the
multiplexing interface is looped back local NE.
The fault is rectified after the multiplexing Replace the alarmed IF board on the
interface is looped back opposite NE.

----End

Related Information
The handling procedure applies when this alarm is reported by the STM-1e port.

Handle the errors of TDM services.

A.3.20 B2_EXC

Description
The B2_EXC is an alarm indicating that the B2 errors (in the multiplex section) exceed the
threshold. This alarm occurs when the board detects that the number of B2 errors exceeds the
preset B2_EXC alarm threshold (10-3 by default).

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 335


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Service alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The services on the port are interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by an SDH optical interface
board).
l Cause 2: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by an IF board).
l Cause 3: The network clock quality degrades.
l Cause 4: The board is faulty (if the alarm is reported by an SDH optical interface board).
l Cause 5: The board is faulty (if the alarm is reported by an IF board).

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by an SDH optical interface
board).
1. Check whether the transmit power at the opposite end and the receive power at the local
end meet the specifications of the optical interfaces. For details, see 4.3.3 Browsing
Current Performance Events.

If... Then...
The transmit power of the opposite NE is over Replace the SFP on the opposite NE.
low
The transmit power of the opposite NE is The fiber is faulty. Go to the next step.
normal, but the receive power of the local NE
is close to the value (for example, within 3
dB) of the receiver sensitivity

2. Exchange the core fibers of the optical cables in the receive and transmit directions of a
channel to locate the fault.

If... Then...
The errors vary with the change of the fiber The fiber is faulty. Go to the next step.
The errors do not vary with the change of the Ensure that the board is normal.
fiber

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 336


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

3. If the fiber is faulty, check whether the fiber jumper from the equipment to the optical
distribution frame (ODF) and the fiber that is led out of the equipment room are pressed,
and whether the fiber connector is dirty. If yes, replace the fiber jumper or fiber connector.

Step 2 Cause 2: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by an IF board).
1. Check whether the MW_BER_EXC, MW_BER_SD, MW_FEC_UNCOR or
RPS_INDI alarm is reported. If yes, clear the alarm.

Step 3 Cause 3: The network clock quality degrades.


1. Check the network clock status of the alarmed NE.

If... Then...
The clock source of the local NE is The clock may become asynchronous and
different from the clock source of the errors may occur. Reconfigure the clock
opposite NE source, and ensure that the clock is
synchronized on the local NE and opposite
NE.
The clock of the local NE and the clock This may cause errors and even service
of the opposite NE form a timing loop interruption. In this case, reconfigure the clock
source and release the timing loop.

Step 4 Cause 4: The board is faulty (if the alarm is reported by an SDH optical interface board).
1. The board of the SDH line unit on the local NE is faulty. Loop back the optical interfaces
of the NE by using a fiber jumper to locate the fault.

If... Then...
The fault is not rectified after the optical Replace the board where the alarmed
interfaces are looped back line unit is located on the local NE.
The fault is rectified after the optical Replace the board where the line unit is
interfaces are looped back located on the opposite NE.

Step 5 Cause 5: The board is faulty (if the alarm is reported by an IF board).
1. Perform an inloop for the multiplexing interface of the IF board on the local NE.

If... Then...
The fault is not rectified after the Replace the alarmed IF board on the
multiplexing interface is looped back local NE.
The fault is rectified after the multiplexing Replace the alarmed IF board on the
interface is looped back opposite NE.

----End

Related Information
The handling procedure applies when this alarm is reported by the STM-1e port.

Handle the errors of TDM services.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 337


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.21 B2_SD

Description
The B2_SD is an alarm indicating that the signal degrades due to the excessive B2 errors (in the
multiplex section). This alarm occurs when the board detects that the number of B2 errors is
higher than the preset B2_SD alarm threshold (10-6 by default) and lower than the preset
B2_EXC alarm threshold (10-3 by default).

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Service alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The service performance on the port degrades.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by an SDH optical interface
board).
l Cause 2: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by an IF board).
l Cause 3: The network clock quality degrades.
l Cause 4: The board is faulty (if the alarm is reported by an SDH optical interface board).
l Cause 5: The board is faulty (if the alarm is reported by an IF board).

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by an SDH optical interface
board).
1. Check whether the transmit power at the opposite end and the receive power at the local
end meet the specifications of the optical interfaces. For details, see 4.3.3 Browsing
Current Performance Events.

If... Then...
The transmit power of the opposite NE is over Replace the SFP on the opposite NE.
low
The transmit power of the opposite NE is The fiber is faulty. Go to the next step.
normal, but the receive power of the local NE
is close to the value (for example, within 3
dB) of the receiver sensitivity

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 338


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

2. Exchange the core fibers of the optical cables in the receive and transmit directions of a
channel to locate the fault.

If... Then...
The errors vary with the change of the fiber The fiber is faulty. Go to the next step.
The errors do not vary with the change of the Ensure that the board is normal.
fiber
3. If the fiber is faulty, check whether the fiber jumper from the equipment to the optical
distribution frame (ODF) and the fiber that is led out of the equipment room are pressed,
and whether the fiber connector is dirty. If yes, replace the fiber jumper or fiber connector.
Step 2 Cause 2: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by an IF board).
1. Check whether the MW_BER_EXC, MW_BER_SD, MW_FEC_UNCOR alarm is
generated. If yes, clear the alarm.
Step 3 Cause 3: The network clock quality degrades.
1. Check the network clock status of the alarmed NE.

If... Then...
The clock source of the local NE is The clock may become asynchronous and
different from the clock source of the errors may occur. Reconfigure the clock
opposite NE source, and ensure that the clock is
synchronized on the local NE and opposite
NE.
The clock of the local NE and the clock This may cause errors and even service
of the opposite NE form a timing loop interruption. In this case, reconfigure the clock
source and release the timing loop.

Step 4 Cause 4: The board is faulty (if the alarm is reported by an SDH optical interface board).
1. The SDH optical/electrical line board of the local NE is faulty. Loop back the optical
interfaces of the station by using a fiber jumper to locate the fault.

If... Then...
The fault is not rectified after the optical Replace the board where the alarmed
interfaces are looped back line unit is located on the local NE.
The fault is rectified after the optical Replace the board where the line unit is
interfaces are looped back located on the opposite NE.

Step 5 Cause 5: The board is faulty (if the alarm is reported by an IF board).
1. Perform an inloop for the multiplexing interface of the IF board on the local NE.

If... Then...
The fault is not rectified after the Replace the alarmed IF board on the
multiplexing interface is looped back local NE.
The fault is rectified after the multiplexing Replace the alarmed IF board on the
interface is looped back opposite NE.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 339


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Related Information
The handling procedure applies when this alarm is reported by the STM-1e port.

Handle the errors of TDM services.

A.3.22 B3_EXC

Description
The B3_EXC is an alarm indicating that the B3 errors (in the higher order path) exceed the
threshold. This alarm occurs when the board detects that the number of B3 errors exceeds the
preset B3_EXC alarm threshold (10-3 by default).

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Service alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the B3_EXC alarm occurs, the service on the alarmed path is interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by an SDH optical interface
board).
l Cause 2: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by an IF board).
l Cause 3: The network clock quality degrades.
l Cause 4: The board is faulty (if the alarm is reported by an SDH optical interface board).
l Cause 5: The board is faulty (if the alarm is reported by an IF board).

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by an SDH optical interface
board).
1. Check whether the transmit power at the opposite end and the receive power at the local
end meet the specifications of the optical interfaces. For details, see 4.3.3 Browsing
Current Performance Events.

If... Then...
The transmit power of the opposite NE is over Replace the SFP on the opposite NE.
low

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 340


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The transmit power of the opposite NE is The fiber is faulty. Go to the next step.
normal, but the receive power of the local NE
is close to the value (for example, within 3
dB) of the receiver sensitivity

2. Exchange the core fibers of the optical cables in the receive and transmit directions of a
channel to locate the fault.

If... Then...
The errors vary with the change of the fiber The fiber is faulty. Go to the next step.
The errors do not vary with the change of the Ensure that the board is normal.
fiber

3. If the fiber is faulty, check whether the fiber jumper from the equipment to the optical
distribution frame (ODF) and the fiber that is led out of the equipment room are pressed,
and whether the fiber connector is dirty. If yes, replace the fiber jumper or fiber connector.

Step 2 Cause 2: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by an IF board).
1. Check whether the MW_BER_EXC, MW_BER_SD, MW_FEC_UNCOR or
RPS_INDI alarm is reported. If yes, clear the alarm.

Step 3 Cause 3: The network clock quality degrades.


1. Check the network clock status of the alarmed NE.

If... Then...
The clock source of the local NE is In this case, the clock may become
different from the clock source of the asynchronous and errors may occur.
opposite NE Reconfigure the clock source, and ensure that
the clock is synchronized on the local NE and
opposite NE.
The clock of the local NE and the clock This may cause errors and even service
of the opposite NE form a timing loop interruption. In this case, reconfigure the clock
source and release the timing loop.

Step 4 Cause 4: The board is faulty (if the alarm is reported by an SDH optical interface board).
1. The board of the SDH line unit on the local NE is faulty. Loop back the optical interfaces
of the NE by using a fiber jumper to locate the fault.

If... Then...
The fault is not rectified after the optical Replace the board where the alarmed
interfaces are looped back line unit is located on the local NE.
The fault is rectified after the optical Replace the board where the line unit is
interfaces are looped back located on the opposite NE.

Step 5 Cause 5: The board is faulty (if the alarm is reported by an IF board).
1. Perform an inloop for the multiplexing interface of the IF board on the local NE.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 341


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The fault is not rectified after the Replace the alarmed IF board on the
multiplexing interface is looped back local NE.
The fault is rectified after the multiplexing Replace the alarmed IF board on the
interface is looped back opposite NE.

----End

Related Information
The handling procedure applies when this alarm is reported by the STM-1e port.

Handle the errors of TDM services.

A.3.23 B3_EXC_VC3

Description
The B3_EXC_VC3 alarm indicates that the number of B3 bit errors in a VC-3 path crosses the
threshold. A board reports this alarm when detecting that the number of B3 bit errors crosses
the B3_EXC_VC3 alarm threshold (10-3, by default).

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Service alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Has a fixed value of 0x01.
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of the VC-3 path that reports the alarm. For example,
0x00 0x01 indicate that the alarm is reported in VC-3 path 1.

Impact on the System


The services in the alarmed path have a large number of bit errors.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Higher-level bit error alarms occur in the system.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 342


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

l Cause 2: The line performance deteriorates (the alarm is reported by an Ethernet optical
port).
l Cause 3: The line performance deteriorates (the alarm is reported by an Ethernet electrical
port).
l Cause 4: A board is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Higher-level bit error alarms occur in the system.
1. Check whether the local or upstream site detects B1_EXC, B1_SD, B2_EXC, B2_SD,
B3_EXC, or B3_SD alarms. If yes, clear the higher-level alarms.
2. Check whether the alarm is cleared.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 2 or Cause 3.

Step 2 Cause 2: The line performance deteriorates (the alarm is reported by an Ethernet optical port).
1. Check whether the transmit power at the opposite site and the receive power at the local
site meet the specifications of the optical ports. For details, see Browsing Current
Performance Events.

If... Then...
The transmit power at the opposite site is Replace the optical module at the
too low opposite site.
The transmit power at the opposite site is A fiber is faulty. Go to the next step.
normal, but the receive power at the local
site is close to the receiver sensitivity (for
example, a difference within 3 dB)

2. Exchange the optical fibers in the receive and transmit directions of an optical path segment.

If... Then...
The number of bit errors changes Go to the next step.
The number of bit errors does not change Go to Cause 4.

3. If a fiber is faulty, check whether the fiber jumper from the equipment to the optical
distribution frame (ODF) and the fiber that is led out from the equipment room are pressed,
and whether any fiber connector is dirty or damaged. If yes, clean or replace the fiber
connector, or replace the fiber jumper. Check whether the alarm is cleared.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 4.

Step 3 Cause 3: The line performance deteriorates (the alarm is reported by an Ethernet electrical port).

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 343


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

1. Check whether the cable grounding, cable connectors, and cables are damaged. If yes,
replace the faulty cables.
2. Check whether the alarm is cleared.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 4.

Step 4 Cause 4: A board is faulty.


1. Perform an inloop at the Ethernet port that connects to the alarmed VC-3 path.

If... Then...
The fault is not rectified after the Replace the alarmed Ethernet processing
Ethernet port is looped back board at the local site.
The fault is rectified after the Ethernet Replace the Ethernet processing board at
port is looped back the opposite site.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.24 B3_SD

Description
The B3_SD is an alarm indicating that the signal degrades due to the excessive B3 errors (in the
higher order path). This alarm occurs when the board detects that the number of B3 errors is
higher than the preset B3_SD alarm threshold (10-6 by default) and lower than the preset
B3_EXC alarm threshold (10-3 by default).

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Minor Service alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The service performance on the port degrades.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 344


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by an SDH optical interface
board).
l Cause 2: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by an IF board).
l Cause 3: The network clock quality degrades.
l Cause 4: The board is faulty (if the alarm is reported by an SDH optical interface board).
l Cause 5: The board is faulty (if the alarm is reported by an IF board).

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by an SDH optical interface
board).
1. Check whether the transmit power at the opposite end and the receive power at the local
end meet the specifications of the optical interfaces. For details, see 4.3.3 Browsing
Current Performance Events.

If... Then...
The transmit power of the opposite NE is over Replace the SFP on the opposite NE.
low
The transmit power of the opposite NE is The fiber is faulty. Go to the next step.
normal, but the receive power of the local NE
is close to the value (for example, within 3
dB) of the receiver sensitivity
2. Exchange the core fibers of the optical cables in the receive and transmit directions of a
channel to locate the fault.

If... Then...
The errors vary with the change of the fiber The fiber is faulty. Go to the next step.
The errors do not vary with the change of the Ensure that the board is normal.
fiber
3. If the fiber is faulty, check whether the fiber jumper from the equipment to the optical
distribution frame (ODF) and the fiber that is led out of the equipment room are pressed,
and whether the fiber connector is dirty. If yes, replace the fiber jumper or fiber connector.

Step 2 Cause 2: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by an IF board).
1. Check whether the MW_BER_EXC, MW_BER_SD, MW_FEC_UNCOR alarm is
generated. If yes, clear the alarm.

Step 3 Cause 3: The network clock quality degrades.


1. Check the network clock status of the alarmed NE.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 345


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The clock source of the local NE is In this case, the clock may become
different from the clock source of the asynchronous and errors may occur.
opposite NE Reconfigure the clock source, and ensure that
the clock is synchronized on the local NE and
opposite NE.
The clock of the local NE and the clock This may cause errors and even service
of the opposite NE form a timing loop interruption. In this case, reconfigure the clock
source and release the timing loop.

Step 4 Cause 4: The board is faulty (if the alarm is reported by an SDH optical interface board).
1. The SDH optical/electrical line board of the local NE is faulty. Loop back the optical
interfaces of the station by using a fiber jumper to locate the fault.

If... Then...
The fault is not rectified after the optical Replace the board where the alarmed
interfaces are looped back line unit is located on the local NE.
The fault is rectified after the optical Replace the board where the line unit is
interfaces are looped back located on the opposite NE.

Step 5 Cause 5: The board is faulty (if the alarm is reported by an IF board).
1. Perform an inloop for the multiplexing interface of the IF board on the local NE.

If... Then...
The fault is not rectified after the Replace the alarmed IF board on the
multiplexing interface is looped back local NE.
The fault is rectified after the multiplexing Replace the alarmed IF board on the
interface is looped back opposite NE.

----End

Related Information
The handling procedure applies when this alarm is reported by the STM-1e port.

Handle the errors of TDM services.

A.3.25 B3_SD_VC3

Description
The B3_SD_VC3 alarm indicates a signal degrade (SD) condition caused by excessive B3 bit
errors in VC-3 paths. A board reports this alarm when detecting that the number of B3 bit errors
crosses the B3_SD_VC3 alarm threshold (10-6, by default).

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 346


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Minor Service alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Has a fixed value of 0x01.
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of the path that reports the alarm. For example, 0x00
0x01 indicate that the alarm is reported in VC-3 path 1.

Impact on the System


When the B3_SD_VC3 alarm occurs, the services in the alarmed path deteriorate.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Higher-level bit error alarms occur in the system.
l Cause 2: The line performance deteriorates (the alarm is reported by an Ethernet optical
port).
l Cause 3: The line performance deteriorates (the alarm is reported by an Ethernet electrical
port).
l Cause 4: A board is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Higher-level bit error alarms occur in the system.
1. Check whether the local or upstream site detects B1_EXC, B1_SD, B2_EXC, B2_SD,
B3_EXC, or B3_SD alarms. If yes, clear the higher-level alarms.
2. Check whether the alarm is cleared.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 2 or Cause 3.

Step 2 Cause 2: The line performance deteriorates (the alarm is reported by an Ethernet optical port).
1. Check whether the transmit power at the opposite site and the receive power at the local
site meet the specifications of the optical ports. For details, see Browsing Current
Performance Events.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 347


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The transmit power at the opposite site is Replace the optical module at the
too low opposite site.
The transmit power at the opposite site is A fiber is faulty. Go to the next step.
normal, but the receive power at the local
site is close to the receiver sensitivity (for
example, a difference within 3 dB)
2. Exchange the optical fibers in the receive and transmit directions of an optical path segment.

If... Then...
The number of bit errors changes Go to the next step.
The number of bit errors does not change Go to Cause 4.
3. If a fiber is faulty, check whether the fiber jumper from the equipment to the optical
distribution frame (ODF) and the fiber that is led out from the equipment room are pressed,
and whether any fiber connector is dirty or damaged. If yes, clean or replace the fiber
connector, or replace the fiber jumper. Check whether the alarm is cleared.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 4.

Step 3 Cause 3: The line performance deteriorates (the alarm is reported by an Ethernet electrical port).
1. Check whether the cable grounding, cable connectors, and cables are damaged. If yes,
replace the faulty cables.
2. Check whether the alarm is cleared.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 4.

Step 4 Cause 4: A board is faulty.


1. Perform an inloop at the Ethernet port that connects to the alarmed VC-3 path.

If... Then...
The fault is not rectified after the Replace the alarmed Ethernet processing
Ethernet port is looped back board at the local site.
The fault is rectified after the Ethernet Replace the Ethernet processing board at
port is looped back the opposite site.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 348


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.26 BAT1TEMP_SENSOR_FAIL

Description
The BAT1TEMP_SENSOR_FAIL is an alarm indicating that the temperature sensor of battery
group 1 fails.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The temperature data of battery group 1 cannot be collected.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The temperature sensor of battery group 1 is faulty.
l Cause 2: The control board of the cabinet is faulty.
l Cause 3: Cables are misconnected or damaged.
l Cause 4: The temperature sensor is not installed.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The temperature sensor of battery group 1 is faulty.
1. Replace the temperature sensor of battery group 1.
2. Then, check whether the alarm clears.

If... Then...
The alarm clears End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The control board of the cabinet is faulty.


1. Replace the cabinet.
2. Then, check whether the alarm clears.

If... Then...
The alarm clears End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: Cables are misconnected or damaged.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 349


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

1. Replace damaged cables.


2. Connect cables correctly.

Step 4 Cause 4: The temperature sensor is not installed.


1. Install the temperature sensor.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.27 BAT2TEMP_SENSOR_FAIL

Description
The BAT2TEMP_SENSOR_FAIL is an alarm indicating that the temperature sensor of battery
group 2 fails.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The temperature data of battery group 2 cannot be collected.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The temperature sensor of battery group 2 is faulty.
l Cause 2: The control board of the cabinet is faulty.
l Cause 3: Cables are misconnected or damaged.
l Cause 4: The temperature sensor is not installed.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The temperature sensor of battery group 2 is faulty.
1. Replace the temperature sensor of battery group 2.
2. Then, check whether the alarm clears.

If... Then...
The alarm clears End the alarm handling.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 350


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The alarm persists Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The control board of the cabinet is faulty.


1. Replace the cabinet.
2. Then, check whether the alarm clears.

If... Then...
The alarm clears End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: Cables are misconnected or damaged.


1. Replace damaged cables.
2. Connect cables correctly.

Step 4 Cause 4: The temperature sensor is not installed.


1. Install the board temperature sensor.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.28 BD_NOT_INSTALLED

Description
The BD_NOT_INSTALLED is an alarm indicating that the physical board is installed in a
certain slot, but the logical board is not added.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Minor Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1, Parameter 2 Indicates the ID of the slot.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 351


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Impact on the System


When the BD_NOT_INSTALLED alarm occurs, the physical board in this slot cannot work.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The logical board is not added in the corresponding logical slot.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The logical board is not added in the corresponding logical slot.
1. Configure the logical board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.29 BD_STATUS

Description
The BD_STATUS is an alarm indicating that the board cannot be detected.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the BD_STATUS alarm occurs, the alarmed board fails to work.

Possible Causes
If the alarm is reported by a board of the IDU, the possible causes are as follows:
l Cause 1 of the alarm reported by a board of the IDU: The board is installed in an incorrect
slot.
l Cause 2 of the alarm reported by a board of the IDU: The board and the backplane are not
connected properly.
l Cause 3 of the alarm reported by a board of the IDU: The slot is faulty.
l Cause 4 of the alarm reported by a board of the IDU: A certain board is faulty.

If the alarm is reported by the ODU, the possible causes are as follows:

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 352


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

l Cause 1 of the alarm reported by the ODU: The other alarms are generated.
l Cause 2 of the alarm reported by the ODU: The ODU is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1 of the alarm reported by a board of the IDU: The board is installed in an incorrect slot.
1. Check whether the logical slot and physical slot of the alarmed board are consistent. For
details, see 4.2 Checking the Board Status.

If... Then...
The alarmed board is installed in an Install the board in a correct slot.
incorrect slot
The alarmed board is installed in a Ensure that the board and the backplane
correct slot are connected properly.

Step 2 Cause 2 of the alarm reported by a board of the IDU: The board and the backplane are not
connected properly.
1. Remove and insert the alarmed board.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared after the board is The fault is rectified. End the alarm
removed and inserted handling.
The alarm persists after the board is Ensure that the board is normal.
removed and inserted

Step 3 Cause 3 of the alarm reported by a board of the IDU: The slot is faulty.
1. Contact Huawei engineers to handle the fault of the slot.
NOTE
Generally, the slot becomes faulty due to the broken pin or bent pin. Remove the board, and use a
torch to observe whether there is any broken pin or bent pin.
2. If a vacant slot is available, insert the board in the vacant slot and add the board again.
Then, the board can work normally.

Step 4 Cause 4 of the alarm reported by a board of the IDU: A certain board is faulty.
1. Replace the alarmed board.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared after the board is The fault is rectified. End the alarm
replaced handling.
The alarm persists after the board is Ensure that the slot is normal.
replaced

Step 5 Cause 1 of the alarm reported by the ODU: The other alarms are generated.
1. Query whether the IF board reports the HARD_BAD, BD_STATUS,
IF_CABLE_OPEN, BD_NOT_INSTALLED or VOLT_LOS alarm.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 353


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The IF board reports any of the preceding alarms Clear the alarm immediately.
The IF board does not report any of the preceding Replace the alarmed ODU.
alarms

Step 6 Cause 2 of the alarm reported by the ODU: The ODU is faulty.
1. Replace the alarmed ODU.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.30 BDTEMP_SENSOR_FAIL

Description
The BDTEMP_SENSOR_FAIL is an alarm indicating that the board temperature sensor of the
cabinet fails.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The board temperature data of the TCU cannot be collected.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The board temperature sensor is faulty.
l Cause 2: The control board of the cabinet is faulty.
l Cause 3: Cables are misconnected or damaged.
l Cause 4: The board temperature sensor is not installed.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The board temperature sensor is faulty.
1. Replace the board temperature sensor.
2. Then, check whether the alarm clears.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 354


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The alarm clears End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The control board of the cabinet is faulty.


1. Replace the cabinet.
2. Then, check whether the alarm clears.

If... Then...
The alarm clears End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: Cables are misconnected or damaged.


1. Replace damaged cables.
2. Connect cables correctly.

Step 4 Cause 4: The board temperature sensor is not installed.


1. Install the board temperature sensor.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.31 BIOS_STATUS

Description
The BIOS_STATUS is an alarm indicating that the board is in BIOS state.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Processing alarm

Parameters

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the slot ID of the board that is in BIOS state.

Impact on the System


The services on the alarmed board are interrupted.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 355


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The board software is lost.
l Cause 2: The board software becomes abnormal.
l Cause 3: The board is reset for three consecutive times.

Procedure
Step 1 Perform a cold reset on the alarmed standby system control, switching, and timing board, and
then check whether the alarm is cleared.

Step 2 If the alarm persists, remove the standby system control, switching, and timing board, and
then reseat the board.

Step 3 If the alarm persists, replace the board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.32 BIP_EXC

Description
The BIP_EXC is an alarm indicating that the BIP errors exceed the threshold. This alarm occurs
when the board detects that the number of BIP-2 errors (in byte V5) exceeds the preset BIP_EXC
alarm threshold (10-3 by default).

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Service alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the BIP_EXC alarm occurs, the service on the alarmed path is interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by an E1 service board).
l Cause 2: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by a Hybrid IF board).
l Cause 3: The board is faulty (if the alarm is reported by an E1 service board).
l Cause 4: The board is faulty (if the alarm is reported by a Hybrid IF board).

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 356


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by an E1 service board).
1. Check whether the performance degradation alarm occurs on the STM-1 path or radio link
along which the E1 service signal travels. If yes, clear the alarm immediately.

The common line performance degradation alarms are as follows:

B1_EXC, B1_SD, B2_EXC, B2_SD, B3_EXC, B3_SD, MW_FEC_UNCOR,


RPS_INDI, MW_BER_EXC, and MW_BER_SD.

If... Then...
There is any of the preceding alarms Clear the alarm immediately.
No such alarms occur Ensure that the board is normal.

Step 2 Cause 2: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by a Hybrid IF board).
1. Check whether any alarm occurs on the tributary board or IF board that transmits the service
signal. If yes, clear the alarm immediately.

Step 3 Cause 3: The board is faulty (if the alarm is reported by an E1 service board).
1. Replace the board where the E1 service unit is located. Then, check whether the alarm
is cleared.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Replace the system control and cross-connect board.

Step 4 Cause 4: The board is faulty (if the alarm is reported by a Hybrid IF board).
1. Replace the Hybrid IF board. Then, check whether the alarm is cleared.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Replace the system control and cross-connect board.

----End

Related Information
Handle the errors of TDM services.

The alarm parameters have the meanings listed in Table A-3 when EMS6 board report the alarm.

Table A-3 Alarm Parameters of EMS6

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 The value is always 0x01.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 357


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning

Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of the path that reports the


alarm. For example, 0x00 0x01 indicate that
the alarm is reported in path 1.

A.3.33 BIP_SD

Description
The BIP_SD is an alarm indicating that the signal degrades due to the BIP errors. This alarm
occurs when the board detects that the number of BIP-2 errors (in byte V5) is higher than the
preset BIP_SD alarm threshold (10-6 by default) and lower than the preset BIP_EXC alarm
threshold (10-3 by default).

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Service alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the BIP_SD alarm occurs, the service on the alarmed path degrades.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by an E1 service board).
l Cause 2: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by a Hybrid IF board).
l Cause 3: The board is faulty (if the alarm is reported by an E1 service board).
l Cause 4: The board is faulty (if the alarm is reported by a Hybrid IF board).

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by an E1 service board).
1. Check whether the performance degradation alarm occurs on the STM-1 path or radio link
along which the E1 service signal travels. If yes, clear the alarm immediately.

The common line performance degradation alarms are as follows:

B1_EXC, B1_SD, B2_EXC, B2_SD, B3_EXC, B3_SD, MW_FEC_UNCOR,


RPS_INDI, MW_BER_EXC, and MW_BER_SD.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 358


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
There is any of the preceding alarms Clear the alarm immediately.
No such alarms occur Ensure that the board is normal.

Step 2 Cause 2: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by a Hybrid IF board).
1. Check whether any alarm occurs on the tributary board or IF board that transmits the service
signal.

If... Then...
An alarm occurs Clear the alarm immediately.
No alarm occurs Ensure that the board is normal.

Step 3 Cause 3: The board is faulty (if the alarm is reported by an E1 service board).
1. Replace the board where the E1 service unit is located. Then, check whether the alarm
is cleared.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Replace the system control and cross-connect board.

Step 4 Cause 4: The board is faulty (if the alarm is reported by a Hybrid IF board).
1. Replace the Hybrid IF board. Then, check whether the alarm is cleared.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Replace the system control and cross-connect board.

----End

Related Information
Handle the errors of TDM services.

The alarm parameters have the meanings listed in Table A-4 when EMS6 board report the alarm.

Table A-4 Alarm Parameters of EMS6

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 The value is always 0x01.

Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of the path that reports the


alarm. For example, 0x00 0x01 indicate that
the alarm is reported in path 1.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 359


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.34 BOOTROM_BAD

Description
The BOOTROM_BAD is an alarm indicating that the BOOTROM data consistency check fails.
This alarm occurs when the BOOTROM data is damaged during a periodical check by the
system.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 The value is always 0x01.
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicates the type of the BOOTROM damage.
l 0x00, 0x01: damage of the basic BIOS
l 0x00, 0x02: damage of the extended BIOS
Parameter 4, Parameter 5 The values are always 0xff 0xff.

Impact on the System


When the BOOTROM_BAD alarm occurs, it indicates that errors occur in the system database
processing. The system configuration may be lost. As a result, the failure indication is returned
for certain query and setting commands, and certain system functions cannot work.

l When the NE is already started, the BOOTROM_BAD alarm does not affect the system
and services.
l If the BOOTROM_BAD alarm occurs and a hard reset is performed on a board, the
board fails to load the BIOS and cannot be started.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The basic BIOS is damaged.
l Cause 2: The extended BIOS is damaged.
l Cause 3: The BOOTROM database is damaged.
l Cause 4: The system control switch and timing boardis faulty.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 360


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Procedure
Step 1 Replace the alarmed board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.35 BUS_ERR

Description
The BUS_ERR alarm indicates bus errors. This alarm occurs when the bus becomes abnormal.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Critical Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 361


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 Indicates the bus error types.

l 0x01: BUS_LOS
l 0x02: BUS_OOF
l 0x03: BUS_LOF
l 0x04: BUS_OOA
l 0x05: BUS_RX_DOWN
l 0x06: BUS_TX_DOWN
l 0x07: BUS_SPI_DOWN
l 0x08: BUS_SCI_ERR
l 0x09: BUS_OPP_CLK_LOC
l 0x0a: BUS_SERDS_ERR
l 0x0b: BUS_MII_ERR
l 0x0c: BUS_HW_ERR
l 0x0d: BUS_FE_ERR
l 0x0e: BUS_EMIF_ERR
l 0x0f: BUS_IIC_ERR
l 0x10: BUS_GE_LINK_ERR
l 0x11: BUS_EMIF

Parameter 2 Indicates the ID of the bus that has errors.

Parameter 3 This parameter is self-defined.

Impact on the System


When the BUS_ERR alarm occurs, the services that travel along the faulty bus are interrupted
or have errors.

Possible Causes
The possible causes of the BUS_ERR alarm are as follows:

l Cause 1: The board is not properly inserted.


l Cause 2: A certain board is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The board is not properly inserted.
1. Remove and insert the board.

Step 2 Cause 2: A certain board is faulty.


1. Perform a cold reset on the alarmed board. Then, check whether the alarm is cleared.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 362


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared The fault is rectified. End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Replace the alarmed board.

----End

Related Information
The alarm parameters have the meanings listed in Table A-5 when EMS6 board report the alarm.

Table A-5 Alarm parameters of EMS6

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 Indicates the bus error type.


0x10: The Serdes bus of the GE bridge is
faulty.

A.3.36 CES_ACR_LOCK_ABN

Description
The CES_ACR_LOCK_ABN is an alarm indicating that the locking function of CES ACR
service clock is abnormal.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Minor Service alarm

Parameters

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 to Parameter 4 Indicate the index of PW that carries the services associated with
the ACR clock source.

Parameter 5 Indicates clock mode.


l 0x01: tracing mode.
l 0x02: holdover mode.
l 0x03: free-run mode.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 363


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning
Parameter 6 Indicates whether the clock is locked.
l 0x00: unlocked.
l 0x01: locked.

Impact on the System


Service quality is affected.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: CES ACR services are unavailable or have alarms.
l Cause 2: The network is unstable.
l Cause 3: NEs on the service path are abnormal.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: CES ACR services are unavailable or have alarms.
1. Query the CES services associated with the ACR clock source. For details, see Configuring
the Primary Clock for an ACR Clock Domain.
2. Check whether these services have alarms. For details, see 4.3.1 Browsing Current
Alarms.

Step 2 Cause 2: The network is unstable.


1. Check for jitters and delays on the network. Query service performance statistics. For
details, see 4.3.3 Browsing Current Performance Events.
2. Analyze service performance statistics. If the network is unstable, rectify the faults on the
network, or switch the affected services to a stable network.

Step 3 Cause 3: NEs on the service path are abnormal.


1. Query alarms reported by the NEs on the service path. For details, see 4.3.1 Browsing
Current Alarms.
2. Handle the alarms. For details, see A.3 Alarms and Handling Procedures.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.37 CES_APS_INDI

Description
The CES_APS_INDI is an alarm indicating the status of the packet linear MSP. This alarm is
reported when the configured packet linear MSP is in the switching state.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 364


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 Indicates the ID of the MSP protection group.

Impact on the System


l When this alarm occurs, automatic protection switching or switching triggered by an
external command occurs. As a result, services are switched to the protection channel for
transmission.
l This alarm does not affect the services. If the protection channel fails at this time, the
services are interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: An external command is issued to trigger switching (such as manual switching,
forced switching, exercise switching, and lockout of switching).
l Cause 2: There is an alarm (such as the R_LOS, R_LOF, MS_AIS, B2_EXC, or B2_SD
alarm) or a cold reset that triggers automatic MSP switching.
l Cause 3: The attributes of the MSP protection group are incorrectly configured.
l Cause 4: The interface board is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: An external command is issued to trigger switching (such as manual switching, forced
switching, exercise switching, and lockout of switching).
1. Check the switching status of the protection group.

If... Then...

The MSP is in the state of manual Clear the switching status. Check whether
switching, forced switching, or exercise the alarm is cleared. If the alarm persists,
switching go to Step 2.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 365


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...

The MSP is not in any of the preceding Go to Step 2.


switching state

Step 2 Cause 2: There is an alarm (such as the R_LOS, R_LOF, MS_AIS, B2_EXC, or B2_SD alarm)
or a cold reset that triggers automatic MSP switching.
1. Check whether the protection group is in the automatic switching state.

If... Then...

The local NE reports the R_LOS, The MSP protection group changes to the
R_LOF, MS_AIS, or B2_EXC alarm switching state, and the CES_APS_INDI alarm
is reported. Clear the alarm immediately. Then
check whether the CES_APS_INDI alarm is
cleared.

If the alarm persists, go to the next step.

The local NE reports the B2_SD alarm Clear the alarm immediately. Then check
whether the CES_APS_INDI alarm is cleared.
If the alarm persists, go to the next step.

The interface board is in the cold After the cold resetting ends, go to step 3 and
resetting state identify the cause of the cold resetting.

The MSP is not in any of the preceding Go to the next step.


switching state

2. Check the method for setting the revertive mode of the protection group.

If... Then...

Revertive Mode is set to Revertive After the working channel recovers, the
services are automatically switched from the
protection channel to the working channel once
the preset wait to restore (WTR) time expires.
The CES_APS_INDI alarm will be cleared
after the switching succeeds.

Wait until the MSP protection group changes


from the switching status to the normal status.
Then check whether the CES_APS_INDI
alarm is cleared. If the alarm persists, go to Step
3.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 366


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...

Revertive Mode is set to Non- The services are not switched from the
Revertive protection channel to the working channel after
the working channel recovers, and the
CES_APS_INDI alarm persists.

To clear the CES_APS_INDI alarm, manually


switch the services from the protection channel
to the working channel. Then go to the next
step.

3. After the manual switching succeeds, check whether the alarm is cleared. If the alarm
persists, go to Step 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: The attributes of the MSP protection group are incorrectly configured.
1. If the packet linear MSP is configured on a per-NE basis, check whether the MSP
parameters such as the protection type, switching mode, and mapping unit are configured
correctly. If any of the preceding parameter values are incorrect, change the values and
apply correct settings to the NE. For details, see Configuring Linear MSP.
2. Check whether the alarm is cleared. If the alarm persists, go to Step 4.

Step 4 Cause 4: The interface board is faulty.


1. Check whether the interface board that is configured with the packet linear MSP is
functioning properly.
2. If a hardware alarm such as HARD_BAD occurs on the interface board, clear the alarm
immediately.
3. Replace the interface board. For details, see 6 Part Replacement.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.38 CES_APS_MANUAL_STOP

Description
The CES_APS_MANUAL_STOP is an alarm indicating that the packet linear MSP protocol is
stopped manually. This alarm is reported when the packet linear MSP protocol is stopped
manually.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Minor Communication alarm

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 367


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 Indicates the ID of the MSP protection group.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the packet linear MSP protocol is stopped and the MSP fails. As a result,
STM-1 services cannot be protected.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The APS protocol for the corresponding protection group is manually stopped.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The APS protocol for the corresponding protection group is manually stopped.
1. Determine the ID of the MSP protection group whose APS protocol is stopped according
to alarm parameters.
2. Restart the MSP protocol for the protection group.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.39 CES_JTROVR_EXC
Description
The CES_JTROVR_EXC is an alarm indicating that the number of jitter buffer overflows
crosses the specified threshold. This alarm occurs when the board detects that, the number of
jitter buffer overflows per second crosses the specified threshold.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 368


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Impact on the System


The buffer area does not have sufficient space for the received frames. As a result, packets are
discarded.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The size of buffer area is set to a low value.
l Cause 2: The PSN network clocks used for the transmission of CES services are not
synchronized.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The size of buffer area is set to a low value.
1. Query the size of buffer area. For details, see Querying CES Service Information.
2. Determine whether the size can be increased according to network planning. If yes, change
the size to a greater value. For details, see Managing CES Services.
Step 2 Cause 2: The PSN network clocks used for the transmission of CES services are not
synchronized.
1. Synchronize the PSN network clock by setting clock synchronization, reducing
transmission nodes, and optimizing transmission routes.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.40 CES_JTRUDR_EXC
Description
The CES_JTRUDR_EXC is an alarm indicating that the number of jitter buffer underflows
crosses the specified threshold. This alarm occurs when the board detects that, within a period
(10s), the number of jitter buffer underflows per second crosses the specified threshold.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, no packets are available in the buffer area for transmission. As a result,
underflows occur in the buffer area.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 369


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Signals degrade on the link.
l Cause 2: The PSN network clocks used for the transmission of CES services are not
synchronized.
l Cause 3: The link is looped.
l Cause 4: The link is congested.
l Cause 5: The size of buffer area is set to a low value.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Signals degrade on the link.
1. Troubleshoot the link. For details, see 5.3 Troubleshooting the Radio Link.

Step 2 Cause 2: The PSN network clocks used for the transmission of CES services are not
synchronized.
1. Synchronize the PSN network clock by setting clock synchronization, reducing
transmission nodes, and optimizing transmission routes.

Step 3 Cause 3: The link is looped.


1. Release the loop.

Step 4 Cause 4: The link is congested.


1. Check the bandwidth utilization. If the bandwidth is exhausted, increase the bandwidth or
eliminate any source that transmits a large amount of invalid data.

Step 5 Cause 5: The size of buffer area is set to a low value.


1. Query the size of buffer area. For details, see Querying CES Service Information.
2. Determine whether the size can be increased according to network planning. If yes, change
the size to a greater value. For details, see Managing CES Services.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.41 CES_K1_K2_M

Description
The CES_K1_K2_M is an alarm indicating that the K1 byte and K2 byte of the packet MSP
mismatch. This alarm is reported when the channel numbers indicated in the transmitted K1 byte
and the received K2 byte are inconsistent and the inconsistency lasts for a period of time (160
ms by default).

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 370


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, MSP fails. If a fiber cut or another fault occurs at this time, services
may be interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: MSP is incorrectly configured.
l Cause 2: The interface board is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: MSP is incorrectly configured.
1. Check whether the MSP configurations are consistent between the local and opposite NEs.
For example, ensure that the other end is configured as the working unit if one end of a
fiber is configured as the working unit; otherwise, the CES_K1_K2_M alarm is reported.
2. Ensure that MSP is configured correctly. Then, check whether the alarm is cleared. If the
alarm persists, go to Step 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The interface board is faulty.


1. Check whether the interface boards on which MSP is configured are functioning properly
on the local and opposite NEs.
2. If a hardware alarm such as HARD_BAD occurs on the interface board, clear the alarm
immediately.
3. If the alarm persists, replace the interface board. For details, see 6.10 Replacing the System
Control, Switching and Timing Board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.42 CES_K2_M

Description
The CES_K2_M is an alarm indicating that a mismatched K2 byte of the packet MSP is detected.
This alarm is reported when the protection mode used on the opposite NE, which is indicated

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 371


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

by bit 5 of the received K2 byte, is different from that used on the local NE for a period of time
(2s by default).

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, MSP fails. If a fiber cut or another fault occurs at this time, services
may be interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Different protection modes are configured at both ends of a protection group.
l Cause 2: The interface board is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Different protection modes are configured at both ends of a protection group.
1. Check whether the same protection mode is configured at both ends of a protection group.
If 1+1 protection is configured at one end and 1:N protection is configured at the other end,
the CES_K2_M alarm is reported. For details, see Creating a Packet-based Linear MSP
Group.

Step 2 Cause 2: The interface board is faulty.


1. Check whether the interface boards on which MSP is configured are functioning properly
on the local and opposite NEs.
2. If a hardware alarm such as HARD_BAD occurs on the interface board, clear the alarm
immediately.
3. If the alarm persists, replace the interface board. For details, see 6.10 Replacing the System
Control, Switching and Timing Board.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 372


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.43 CES_LOSPKT_EXC

Description
The CES_LOSPKT_EXC is an alarm indicating that the number of lost packets of CES services
crosses the threshold in a time unit. This alarm occurs when the board detects that the number
of lost packets per second crosses the specified threshold.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, all 1s are inserted and services are interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Signals degrade on the link.
l Cause 2: The link is looped.
l Cause 3: The link is congested.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Signals degrade on the link.
1. Troubleshoot the link. For details, see 5.3 Troubleshooting the Radio Link.

Step 2 Cause 2: The link is looped.


1. Release the loop.

Step 3 Cause 3: The link is congested.


1. Check the bandwidth utilization. If the bandwidth is exhausted, increase the bandwidth or
eliminate any source that transmits a large amount of invalid data.

----End

Related Information
Packets are lost when the sequence numbers of received packets are greater than expected.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 373


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.44 CES_MALPKT_EXC

Description
The CES_MALPKT_EXC is an alarm indicating that, in a time unit, the number of deformed
frames in CES services crosses the threshold. This alarm occurs when the board detects that the
number of deformed frames in CES services crosses the specified threshold.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


A deformed frame is discarded once it is detected. As a result, the packet loss rate increases and
services are affected.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The RTP head enabling status is different between the two ends of the PW.
l Cause 2: Bit errors occur on the link.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The RTP head enabling status is different between the two ends of the PW.
1. Set the RTP head enabling status to the same on the two ends of the PW. For details, see
Modifying CES Service Parameters.

Step 2 Cause 2: Bit errors occur on the link.


1. Troubleshoot the link. For details, see 5.3 Troubleshooting the Radio Link.

----End

Related Information
If a CESoPSN frame contains valid TDM data and does not contain any error indication, but the
size of the CESoPSN frame is not consistent with the specified size, a deformed CESoPSN frame
is generated.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 374


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.45 CES_MISORDERPKT_EXC

Description
The CES_MISORDERPKT_EXC is an alarm indicating that, in a unit time, the number of lost
disordered packets crosses the specified threshold. This alarm occurs when the board detects
that the number of lost disordered packets per second crosses the specified threshold.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The packets are disordered. As a result, the packet loss rate increases and services are affected.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Signals degrade on the link.
l Cause 2: The link is looped.
l Cause 3: The link is congested.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Signals degrade on the link.
1. See 5.3 Troubleshooting the Radio Link.

Step 2 Cause 2: The link is looped.


1. Release the loop.

Step 3 Cause 3: The link is congested.


1. Check the bandwidth utilization. If the bandwidth is exhausted, increase the bandwidth or
eliminate any source that transmits a large amount of invalid data.

----End

Related Information
Packets are disordered when the sequence numbers of received packets are smaller than
expected.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 375


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.46 CES_RDI

Description
The CES_RDI is an alarm of remote defect indication. When the CES_LOSPKT_EXC alarm is
reported at the remote end, the remote end sets the R bit in control word to 1. Upon receiving a
packet in which the R bit is 1, the local end reports the CES_RDI alarm.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The packet loss rate at the remote end crosses the specified threshold.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Signals degrade on the link.
l Cause 2: The link is looped.
l Cause 3: The link is congested.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Signals degrade on the link.
1. See 5.3 Troubleshooting the Radio Link.

Step 2 Cause 2: The link is looped.


1. Release the loop.

Step 3 Cause 3: The link is congested.


1. Check the bandwidth utilization. If the bandwidth is exhausted, increase the bandwidth or
eliminate any source that transmits a large amount of invalid data.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 376


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.47 CES_STRAYPKT_EXC

Description
The CES_STRAYPKT_EXC is an alarm indicating that, in a time unit, the number of error
packets in CES services crosses the threshold. This alarm occurs when the board detects that the
number of error packets in CES services per second crosses the specified threshold.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


An error packet is discarded once it is detected. As a result, the packet loss rate increases and
services are affected.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: Links are misconnected.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Links are misconnected.
1. Check the link configuration and rectify the fault.

----End

Related Information
Incorrect packets are received when the tracing source field in the RTP head is different from
expected.

A.3.48 CESPW_OPPOSITE_ACFAULT

Description
The CESPW_OPPOSITE_ACFAULT is an alarm indicating that the AC circuit on the remote
NE is faulty. On detection of an AC circuit fault, the remote NE sets the L bit in the control word
to 1. When receiving a packet in which the L bit is 1, the local NE reports the
CESPW_OPPOSITE_ACFAULT alarm.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 377


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, services are interrupted.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The remote NE reports the T_ALOS, UP_E1_AIS, LFA, LMFA, R_LOS, R_LOF, or
MS_AIS alarm.

Procedure
Step 1 Check whether the remote NE reports the T_ALOS, UP_E1_AIS, LFA, LMFA, R_LOS,
R_LOF, or MS_AIS alarm.
1. If yes, handle these alarms.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.49 CESPW_OPPOSITE_RAI

Description
The CESPW_OPPOSITE_RAI is a remote alarm indication. On detection of the RAI alarm, the
remote NE sets the L bit of the control word to 0 and the M field of the control word to 10. When
receiving the packet in which the L bit is 0 and the M field is 10, the local NE reports the
CESPW_OPPOSITE_RAI alarm.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 378


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Impact on the System


The services in the downstream direction of the remote NE are interrupted.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The remote NE detects the RAI alarm.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The remote NE detects the RAI alarm.
1. Clear the ALM_E1RAI alarm on the remote NE.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.50 CFCARD_FAILED

Description
The CFCARD_FAILED is an alarm indicating that the operation on the CF card fails.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the CFCARD_FAILED alarm occurs, the database cannot be backed up to the CF card
or be restored from the CF card. This alarm may cause rollback of the package loading upgrade.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The CF card fails to be initialized.
l Cause 2: The file system of the CF card does not match.
l Cause 3: The system control and communication board is faulty, and the file system of the
CF card fails to be created.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The CF card fails to be initialized.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 379


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Cause 2: The file system of the CF card does not match.

1. Replace the CF card and check whether the alarm is cleared.

If... Then...
Yes End the alarm handling.
No Go to Cause 3.

Step 2 Cause 3: The system control and communication board is faulty, and the file system of the CF
card fails to be created.
1. Check whether the HARD_BAD alarm occurs on the system control and communication
board.
2. If yes, perform a cold reset on the system control and communication board. Then, check
whether the alarm is cleared.

If... Then...
Yes End the alarm handling.
No Replace the system control and communication board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.51 CFCARD_OFFLINE

Description
The CFCARD_OFFLINE is an alarm indicating that the CF card is offline.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the CFCARD_OFFLINE alarm occurs, the database cannot be backed up to the CF card
or be restored from the CF card. This alarm may cause rollback of the package loading upgrade.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The CF card is not inserted.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 380


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

l Cause 2: The CF card is in poor contact with the system control and communication board.
l Cause 3: The CF card is faulty.
l Cause 4: The system control and communication board is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The CF card is not inserted.
1. Check whether the CF card is installed on the system control and communication board.

If... Then...
No Install the CF card.
Yes Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The CF card is in poor contact with the system control and communication board.
1. Check whether the CF card is loosened. If yes, re-insert the CF card.
2. Check whether the alarm is cleared.

If... Then...
Yes End the alarm handling.
No Go to Cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: The CF card is faulty.


1. Replace the CF card.
2. Check whether the alarm is cleared.

If... Then...
Yes End the alarm handling.
No Go to Cause 4.

Step 4 Cause 4: The system control and communication board is faulty.


1. Check whether the HARD_BAD alarm occurs on the system control and communication
board.
2. If yes, perform a cold reset on the system control and communication board. Then, check
whether the alarm is cleared.
3. If the alarm persists, replace the system control and communication board.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 381


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.52 CHCS

Description
The CHCS is an alarm indicating the correctable cell error. When a correctable bit error is
detected in the cell header, the CHCS alarm occurs.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the CHCS alarm occurs, the services are not affected. The alarm only indicates that some
cells with a bit error are detected during cell delimitation at the ATM port.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: A few bit errors occur in the receive tunnel corresponding to the alarmed ATM
port.
l Cause 2: The ATM physical-layer processing chip of the board is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: A few bit errors occur in the receive tunnel corresponding to the alarmed ATM port.
1. On the NMS, check whether the receive tunnel reports any alarms about excessive bit errors,
such as B1_SD, B2_SD, and B3_SD.
2. On the NMS, check whether the service is looped.
3. If yes, modify the service configuration to release the loop, and then check whether the
alarm is cleared.

Step 2 Cause 2: The ATM physical-layer processing chip of the board is faulty.
1. Perform a cold reset on the board that reports the CHCS alarm and check whether the alarm
is cleared. For details, see 8.6.1 Cold Reset.
2. Optional: If the CHCS alarm persists after the cold reset, replace the alarmed board and
check whether the alarm is cleared. For details, see 6.6 Replacing the Smart E1 Interface
Board.
NOTE

Board replacement is not recommended because the alarm does not affect the services.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 382


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Related Information
None.

A.3.53 CLK_LOCK_FAIL

Description
The CLK_LOCK_FAIL is an alarm indicating a clock locking failure.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 l 0x01: indicates that the phase-locked loop (PLL) is in holdover or free-run
mode.
l 0x02: indicates that the timestamp in the Sync message remains the same in
Precision Time Protocol (PTP) synchronization mode.
l 0x03: indicates that the phase discrimination value within the given time has
crossed the upper threshold.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the clock of the slave NE fails to trace that of the master NE, and bit
errors may occur.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Frequency deviation of the clock source has crossed the upper threshold in physical
synchronization mode.
l Cause 2: The physical link where the clock source resides is faulty in physical
synchronization mode.
l Cause 3: Frequency deviation of the clock source has crossed the upper threshold in IEEE
1588v2 synchronization mode.
l Cause 4: The physical link where the clock source resides is faulty in IEEE 1588v2
synchronization mode.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 383


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Frequency deviation of the clock source has crossed the upper threshold in physical
synchronization mode.
1. Check whether high-level bit error alarms or performance events have been reported on
the NMS. If yes, handle them immediately.
2. If there is an external clock source, check whether its clock signals are normal. If no, replace
the external clock source. For details, see Configuring the Clock Sources.
3. Check whether clock configurations are correct. For example, if the input and output modes
of the external clock source do not match each other, modify the configurations. For details,
see Modifying the Parameters of the Clock Output.

Step 2 Cause 2: The physical link where the clock source resides is faulty in physical synchronization
mode.
1. If there is an external clock source, check whether the NE reports the SYNC_C_LOS alarm.
If yes, clear the alarm immediately.
2. If the CLK_LOCK_FAIL alarm persists, 6.10 Replacing the System Control, Switching
and Timing Board.

Step 3 Cause 3: Frequency deviation of the clock source has crossed the upper threshold in IEEE 1588v2
synchronization mode.
1. Check whether high-level bit error alarms or performance events have been reported on
the NMS. If yes, handle them immediately.
2. If there is an external clock source, check whether its clock signals are normal. If no, replace
the IEEE 1588v2 clock port. For details, see Replacing the IEEE 1588v2 Clock Port.

Step 4 Cause 4: The physical link where the clock source resides is faulty in IEEE 1588v2
synchronization mode.
1. If the SYN_BAD alarm exists, clear the alarm immediately.
2. If the alarm persists, contact Huawei technical support engineers to handle the alarm.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.54 CLK_NO_TRACE_MODE

Description
The CLK_NO_TRACE_MODE alarm indicates that a clock source is not in locked mode. This
alarm is reported when the current clock does not trace any clock sources.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Equipment alarm

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 384


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the clock mode.

l 0x01: holdover
l 0x02: free-run

Impact on the System


When the clock source is not in the locked mode, the system clock is not of high quality. Services
may have bit errors when the clocks of the NEs are not synchronized. Pointer justification may
occur in TDM services. If a base station traces a clock that is carried by an Ethernet service, an
alarm indicating a large clock frequency deviation may occur.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The system clock source priority table is not configured.
l Cause 2: All the clock sources in the clock source priority table fail.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The system clock source priority table is not configured.
1. Configure the system clock source priority table. For details, see Configuring the Clock
Sources.

Step 2 Cause 2: All the clock sources in the clock source priority table fail.
1. Troubleshoot the synchronization sources that are listed in the clock source priority table.

If... Then...
The synchronization source is an Handle the EXT_SYNC_LOS alarm.
external clock
The synchronization source is a line Handle the alarm that occurs on the line
clock board.
The synchronization source is an IF Handle the alarm that occurs on the IF board.
clock
The synchronization source is a Handle the alarm that occurs on the tributary
tributary clock board.
The synchronization source is an Handle the alarm that occurs on the Ethernet
Ethernet clock board.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 385


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Related Information
None.

A.3.55 COMMUN_FAIL

Description
The COMMUN_FAIL is an alarm indicating the inter-board communication failure. This alarm
is reported when the communication between a board and the SCC board is interrupted.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the ID of the port. The value is always 0x01.

Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicates the ID of the path on which the alarm is generated.
Parameter 2 is always 0x00. Parameter 3 has the following
meanings:

0x03: inter-board Ethernet communication

Parameter 4, Parameter 5 Parameters 4 and 5 are reserved, and their values are always 0xFF.

Impact on the System


The NE configuration cannot be delivered to the board or the board cannot work. Consequently,
the services cannot be configured or the protection switching function is unavailable.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: A certain board is reset.
l Cause 2: A board and the backplane are connected improperly.
l Cause 3: The alarmed board is faulty.
l Cause 4: A slot is faulty.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 386


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

l Cause 5: When the active and standby system control boards switch over, communication
between them are interrupted transiently.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: A certain board is reset.
1. After you reset the board, the alarm is cleared automatically.

Step 2 Cause 2: A board and the backplane are connected improperly.


1. Remove and insert the alarmed board. For details, see 6.1 Removing a Board and 6.2
Inserting a Board. Then, check whether the alarm is cleared.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared after the board is The fault is rectified. End the alarm
removed and inserted handling.
The alarm persists after the board is Clear the alarm according to the solution
replaced. for the alarm that is generated when a
board is faulty.

Step 3 Cause 3: The alarmed board is faulty.


1. Replace the alarmed board, and then check whether the alarm is cleared. For details, see 6
Part Replacement.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared after the board is The fault is rectified. End the alarm
replaced handling.
The alarm persists after the board is Clear the alarm according to the solution
replaced for the alarm that is generated when a slot
is faulty.

Step 4 Cause 3: A slot is faulty.


1. Contact Huawei engineers to handle the faulty slot.
NOTE
The slot becomes faulty due to broken pins or bent pins. Remove the board, and use a torch to check
whether any pins are broken or bent.
2. If a vacant slot is available, insert the board in the vacant slot, and then update the data
on the NMS so that the board can work normally.

Step 5 Cause 5: When the active and standby system control boards switch over, communication
between them are interrupted transiently.
1. It is normal that this alarm is reported during the switchover, so this alarm does not need
to be handled.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 387


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.56 COM_EXTECC_FULL
Description
The COM_EXTECC_FULL is an alarm indicating an excessive number of TCP connections
between automatically extended ECC NEs.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameters 1 to 5 The value is always 0x00.

Impact on the System


An excessive number of extended ECC NEs impacts NE performance.

Possible Causes
The number of TCP connections between automatically extended ECC NEs is larger than four.

Procedure
Step 1 Set ECC Extended Mode to Specified mode by referring to Configuring Extended ECC
Communication.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.57 CONFIG_NOSUPPORT

Description
The CONFIG_NOSUPPORT is an alarm indicating that the configuration is not supported. This
alarm is reported if the ODU detects that the specified parameters do not meet the requirements
of the ODU.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 388


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates that the configuration data does not meet the requirements.
l 0x01: The frequency is set incorrectly.
l 0x02: The T/R spacing is set incorrectly.
l 0x03: The transmit power is set incorrectly.
l 0x04: The ATPC threshold is set incorrectly.
l 0x05: The bandwidth is set incorrectly.
l 0x06: The modulation mode is set incorrectly.

Impact on the System


When the CONFIG_NOSUPPORT alarm occurs, the ODU fails to work normally. If the
equipment is configured with the 1+1 FD protection, the active ODU generates the
CONFIG_NOSUPPORT alarm. In this case, the IF 1+1 protection switching may be triggered.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The type and configuration parameters of the ODU do not match the requirements.
l Cause 2: The AM parameters are incorrectly changed. (This cause can be verified only
when Parameter 1 is 0x03.)
NOTE

Perform the handling procedure of Cause 2 if the following conditions are met: The AM function is enabled
on the radio link; the transmit power configured for the ODU is lower than the maximum rated power in
AM guaranteed capacity mode.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The type and configuration parameters of the ODU do not match the requirements.
1. Determine the parameter that does not meet the requirement according to the alarm
parameter. Then, handle the fault accordingly.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 389


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The alarm parameter takes a value from Perform the operation described in Step
0x01 to 0x03 1.2.
The alarm parameter takes a value from Perform the operation described in Step
0x04 to 0x06 1.3.

2. Check whether the parameters of the ODU interface meet the requirements of network
planning. For details, see Configuring a Single-Hop Radio Link.

If... Then...
The parameters meet the requirements of Use the ODU of the proper model.
network planning
The parameters do not meet the Modify the ODU interface parameters.
requirements of network planning

3. Check whether the parameters of the IF interface meet the requirements of network
planning. For details, see Configuring a Single-Hop Radio Link.

If... Then...
The parameters meet the requirements of Replace the IF board.
network planning
The parameters do not meet the Modify the IF interface parameters. For
requirements of network planning details, see Configuring a Single-Hop
Radio Link.

Step 2 Cause 2: The AM parameters are incorrectly changed. (This cause can be verified only when
Parameter 1 is 0x03.)
1. Verify that the alarm is caused by incorrect change of AM parameters.

Perform the handling procedure of Cause 2 if the following conditions are met:

l The AM function is enabled on the radio link.


l The transmit power configured for the ODU is lower than the maximum rated power in
AM guaranteed capacity mode

If... Then...
The conditions are met and the transmit Perform a cold reset for the alarmed
power needs to be changed ODU.
The conditions are met but the transmit Change the parameters of ODU interfaces
power does not need to be changed to recover the original value of transmit
power.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 390


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.58 DBMS_DELETE
Description
The DBMS_DELETE alarm indicates that a database is being deleted. This alarm is reported
when a user runs a command to delete the database and the NE is in Deleting Database state.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Critical Equipment alarm

Parameters
None

Impact on the System


All data is lost if an NE is powered off or a system control board is cold reset within 48 hours.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: A database is deleted.

Procedure
Step 1 Follow instructions in 7.4 Restoring the Database by NMS to restore the database.

----End

Related Information
None

A.3.59 DBMS_ERROR
Description
The DBMS_ERROR is an alarm indicating that errors occur in the processing of the system
database.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Processing alarm

Parameters
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 391


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Impact on the System


When the DBMS_ERROR alarm occurs, it indicates that errors occur in the system database
processing. The system configuration may be lost. As a result, the failure indication is returned
for certain query and setting commands, and certain system functions cannot work.

Possible Causes
Cause: The database processing fails or the database is damaged.

Procedure
Step 1 Obtain NE backup data (backed up periodically by the U2000 or backed up manually) or NE
service configuration information.
Step 2 Contact Huawei technical support engineers for handling the alarm.
Step 3 In case of emergency, 6.10 Replacing the System Control, Switching and Timing Board and
restore the database or reconfigure service data.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.60 DBMS_PROTECT_MODE

Description
The DBMS_PROTECT_MODE is an alarm indicating that the system database is in protection
mode.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Critical Processing alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, it indicates that errors occur in the system database processing and the
system configuration may be lost. As a result, the failure indication is returned for some query
and setting commands, and some system functions are unavailable.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The database enters the protection mode due to frequent resets of the NE software.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 392


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The database enters the protection mode due to frequent resets of the NE software.
1. 6.10 Replacing the System Control, Switching and Timing Board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.61 DCNSIZE_OVER

Description
The DCNSIZE_OVER is an alarm indicating an over-sized DCN network.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1, Parameter 2 If these parameters are 0xFF 0xFF, the NE works in L2DCN mode.
Otherwise, these parameters indicate the current size of the DCN
subnet.

Impact on the System


l Some NEs become unreachable to the NMS because DCN packets cannot be forwarded
timely due to insufficient CPU resources.
l The DCN network is prone to route flapping and storms.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The number of NEs on an L3 DCN subnet exceeds 400.

Procedure
Step 1 Replan the DCN network based on actual networking conditions.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 393


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.62 DDN_LFA

Description
The DDN_LFA is an alarm indicating loss of basic frame alignment for framed E1 services.
This alarm occurs when DDN (digital data network) side fails to receive the basic frame
alignment signal for framed E1 services.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


E1 services on the alarmed board are unavailable.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The interconnected user equipment is faulty.
l Cause 2: The service frame format is configured incorrectly.
l Cause 3: The alarmed board has hardware faults.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The interconnected user equipment is faulty.
1. Troubleshoot the interconnected user equipment.

Step 2 Cause 2: The service frame format is configured incorrectly.


1. Set the E1 frame format of the local port to the same as that of the opposite port.

Step 3 Cause 3: The alarmed board has hardware faults.


1. Check whether the alarmed board also reports any hardware alarms, such as
HARD_BAD.
2. If yes, perform a cold reset on the alarmed board and check whether the DDN_LFA alarm
is cleared.

NOTICE
If the service on the alarmed board is not protected, a cold reset on the board causes service
interruptions.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 394


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

3. If the alarm persists, replace the board.

----End

Related Information
Basic frame

As defined in ITU-T G.704, a basic frame is an even frame with frame alignment sequence (FAS)
or an odd frame with non frame alignment sequence (NFAS).

A.3.63 DOWN_E1_AIS

Description
The DOWN_E1_AIS is an alarm of the 2 Mbit/s downlink signal. This alarm occurs when the
tributary board detects the 2 Mbit/s downlink signal of all 1s.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the DOWN_E1_AIS alarm occurs, the E1 signal in the alarmed path is unavailable.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The opposite NE transmits the E1_AIS alarm.
l Cause 2: An upstream alarm triggers this alarm.
l Cause 3: On the local NE, the receive unit of the tributary board or the system control and
cross-connect board is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The opposite NE transmits the E1_AIS alarm.
1. Check whether the opposite NE reports the UP_E1_AIS or T_ALOS alarm.

If... Then...
The opposite NE reports the UP_E1_AIS Clear the alarm immediately.
or T_ALOS alarm
The opposite NE does not report the Ensure that the board on the local NE is
UP_E1_AIS or T_ALOS alarm normal.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 395


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Step 2 Cause 2: An upstream alarm triggers this alarm.


1. Clear the following upstream alarms immediately if there are any.
Upstream alarms that may cause a DOWN_E1_AIS alarm include R_LOS, R_LOF,
MS_AIS, AU_AIS, AU_LOP, MW_LOF, MW_LIM, R_LOF, MS_AIS, AU_AIS,
AU_LOP, MW_LOF, MW_LIM, and R_LOF.

Step 3 Cause 3: On the local NE, the receive unit of the tributary board or the system control and cross-
connect board is faulty.
1. Replace the board where the alarmed tributary unit is located. Then, check whether
the alarm is cleared.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared The fault is rectified. End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Replace the system control and cross-connect board on the
local NE.

----End

Related Information
If EFP8 reports the alarm, the alarm parameters have the meanings listed in Table A-6.

Table A-6 Alarm Parameters of EFP8

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 0x01, indicates optical interface number.

Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicates the number of the path.

A.3.64 DROPRATIO_OVER

Description
The DROPRATIO_OVER alarm indicates that the number of lost packets crosses the threshold
when queue congestion occurs at a port. This alarm is reported when the ratio of lost packets on
an object under performance monitoring is higher than the expected ratio.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Service alarm

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 396


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Parameters

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the direction in which traffic crosses the threshold.

l 0x00: The ratio of lost packets in the receive direction exceeds the threshold.
l 0x01: The ratio of lost packets in the transmit direction exceeds the threshold.

Impact on the System


Service packet loss occurs.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Service configuration is incorrect.
l Cause 2: Actual traffic exceeds the configured port bandwidth or committed information
rate (CIR).

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Service configuration is incorrect.
1. Check and reconfigure services according to the network plan.

Step 2 Cause 2: Actual traffic exceeds the configured port bandwidth or CIR.
1. 4.6.2 Querying Traffic, Physical Bandwidth, or Bandwidth Utilization. If traffic is
large, check whether a network storm has occurred, and eliminate the source that illegally
sends a large amount of data.
2. If the port bandwidth is too low, follow instructions in Modifying the Port Policy to increase
port bandwidth or expand the network.

----End

Related Information
If packet loss is indicated in the receive direction, check the method of handling red packets in
the traffic classification configuration. If the method of handling red packets is non-discard,
packets may not be actually lost in the receive direction.

A.3.65 E1_LOC

Description
The E1_LOC is an alarm indicating that the uplink 2M clock is lost. This alarm occurs when
the tributary board fails to extract the clock from the E1 signal.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 397


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the E1_LOC occurs, the service is not affected.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The opposite NE is faulty.
l Cause 2: The wiring sequence of the cable is incorrect.
l Cause 3: The receive unit of the tributary board on the local NE is faulty.
l Cause 4: The input E1 signal has an abnormal waveform.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The opposite NE is faulty.
1. Rectify the fault on the opposite NE.

Step 2 Cause 2: The wiring sequence of the cable is incorrect.


1. Redo the cable.

Step 3 Cause 3: The receive unit of the tributary board on the local NE is faulty.
1. Replace the board where the line unit is located.

Step 4 Cause 4: The input E1 signal has an abnormal waveform.


1. Check whether any external interference causes the abnormal waveform of the E1 signal.

If... Then...
There is the external interference The fault is rectified. End the alarm handling.
There is no external interference Contact Huawei engineers.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.66 E1_LOS

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 398


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Description
The E1_LOS is an alarm indicating the loss of the E1 signal. This alarm occurs when the tributary
board detects the uplink E1 signal of all 0s.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the E1_LOS alarm occurs, the E1 service is interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The cable is not connected or the cable is faulty.
l Cause 2: The opposite NE is faulty.
l Cause 3: The tributary board on the local NE is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The cable is not connected or the cable is faulty.
1. Check whether the cable is connected properly.

If... Then...
The cable is not connected properly Connect the cable properly.
The cable is prepared incorrectly Redo the cable.

Step 2 Cause 2: The opposite NE is faulty.


1. Rectify the fault on the opposite NE.

Step 3 Cause 3: The tributary board on the local NE is faulty.


1. Replace the board where the tributary unit is located.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 399


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.67 ELAN_SMAC_FLAPPING

Description
The ELAN_SMAC_FLAPPING alarm indicates that the source MAC address learned by a
bridge-based or PW-carried E-LAN service flaps. This alarm is reported when two ports that
carry a bridge-based or PW-carried E-LAN service learn the same source MAC address.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Service alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameters 1 to 6 Indicate the source MAC address that flaps.

Parameter 7, Parameter 8 Indicate the VLAN ID.

Parameter 9 Indicate the type of the port that learns the source MAC address
before the flapping occurs.
l 0: UNI
l 1: NNI

Parameters 10 to 13 Indicate the ID of the UNI or NNI that learns the source MAC
address before the flapping occurs.

Parameter 14 Indicate the type of the port that learns the source MAC address
after the flapping occurs.
l 0: UNI
l 1: NNI

Parameters 15 to 18 Indicate the ID of the UNI or NNI that learns the source MAC
address after the flapping occurs.

Impact on the System


A network storm may occur.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 400


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Possible Causes
Cause: A loop exists on a UNI or NNI that carries the E-LAN service.

Procedure
Step 1 Determine the E-LAN service according to the service ID on the NMS.

Step 2 Check the E-LAN service path by referring to instructions in Detecting an E-LAN Service Loop.

----End

Related Information
None

A.3.68 ENVHUM_SENSOR_FAIL

Description
The ENVHUM_SENSOR_FAIL is an alarm indicating that the ambient humidity sensor of the
cabinet fails.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The ambient humidity data of the PMU cannot be collected.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The ambient humidity sensor is faulty.
l Cause 2: The control board of the cabinet is faulty.
l Cause 3: Cables are misconnected or damaged.
l Cause 4: The ambient humidity sensor is not installed.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The ambient humidity sensor is faulty.
1. Replace the ambient humidity sensor.
2. Then, check whether the alarm clears.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 401


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The alarm clears End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The control board of the cabinet is faulty.


1. Replace the cabinet.
2. Then, check whether the alarm clears.

If... Then...
The alarm clears End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: Cables are misconnected or damaged.


1. Replace damaged cables.
2. Connect cables correctly.

Step 4 Cause 4: The ambient humidity sensor is not installed.


1. Install the ambient humidity sensor.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.69 ENVTEMP_SENSOR_FAIL

Description
The ENVTEMP_SENSOR_FAIL is an alarm indicating that the ambient temperature sensor of
the cabinet fails.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The ambient temperature data of the TCU cannot be collected.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 402


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The ambient temperature sensor is faulty.
l Cause 2: The control board of the cabinet is faulty.
l Cause 3: Cables are misconnected or damaged.
l Cause 4: The ambient temperature sensor is not installed.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The ambient temperature sensor is faulty.
1. Replace the ambient temperature sensor.
2. Then, check whether the alarm clears.

If... Then...
The alarm clears End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The control board of the cabinet is faulty.


1. Replace the cabinet.
2. Then, check whether the alarm clears.

If... Then...
The alarm clears End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: Cables are misconnected or damaged.


1. Replace damaged cables.
2. Connect cables correctly.

Step 4 Cause 4: The ambient temperature sensor is not installed.


1. Install the ambient temperature sensor.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.70 ENVTEMP1_SENSOR_FAIL

Description
The ENVTEMP1_SENSOR_FAIL is an alarm indicating that ambient temperature sensor 1 of
the cabinet fails.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 403


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


Ambient temperature data 1 of the PMU cannot be collected.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Ambient temperature sensor 1 is faulty.
l Cause 2: The control board of the cabinet is faulty.
l Cause 3: Cables are misconnected or damaged.
l Cause 4: Ambient temperature sensor 1 is not installed.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Ambient temperature sensor 1 is faulty.
1. Replace ambient temperature sensor 1.
2. Then, check whether the alarm clears.

If... Then...
The alarm clears End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The control board of the cabinet is faulty.


1. Replace the cabinet.
2. Then, check whether the alarm clears.

If... Then...
The alarm clears End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: Cables are misconnected or damaged.


1. Replace damaged cables.
2. Connect cables correctly.

Step 4 Cause 4: Ambient temperature sensor 1 is not installed.


1. Install ambient temperature sensor 1.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 404


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Related Information
None.

A.3.71 ENVTEMP2_SENSOR_FAIL

Description
The ENVTEMP2_SENSOR_FAIL is an alarm indicating that ambient temperature sensor 2 of
the cabinet fails.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


Ambient temperature data 2 of the PMU cannot be collected.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Ambient temperature sensor 2 is faulty.
l Cause 2: The control board of the cabinet is faulty.
l Cause 3: Cables are misconnected or damaged.
l Cause 4: Ambient temperature sensor 2 is not installed.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Ambient temperature sensor 2 is faulty.
1. Replace ambient temperature sensor 2.
2. Then, check whether the alarm clears.

If... Then...
The alarm clears End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The control board of the cabinet is faulty.


1. Replace the cabinet.
2. Then, check whether the alarm clears.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 405


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The alarm clears End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: Cables are misconnected or damaged.


1. Replace damaged cables.
2. Connect cables correctly.

Step 4 Cause 4: Ambient temperature sensor 2 is not installed.


1. Install ambient temperature sensor 2.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.72 ERPS_IN_PROTECTION

Description
ERPS_IN_PROTECTION indicates that EPRS ring is in protection mode.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Minor Equipment Alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 - Parameter 2 ERPS ID.

Parameter 3 DIR, indicating whether the faulty node is in the east or west
direction of the ERPS RPL-OWNER node.

l 0x01: east
l 0x00: west

Parameter 4 - Parameter 9 NODE ID, indicating the MAC address of the faulty node.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 406


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Impact on the System


At least one node on the ring is unreachable. Services (if any) on this node may be interrupted.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: This alarm is reported when EPRS switching is triggered by a fault on the ERPS ring.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: This alarm is reported when EPRS switching is triggered by a fault on the ERPS ring.
1. Locate the faulty node on the ERPS ring based on the alarm parameters.
2. Locate the ERPS blocked port on the faulty node.
3. Rectify the fault.

----End

Related Information
This alarm is not reported on an ERPS V2 network where virtual channels are disabled.

A.3.73 ETH_APS_LOST

Description
The ETH_APS_LOST is an alarm indicating that the APS frame is lost. This alarm is reported
when an ingress/egress node of a bidirectional tunnel does not receive any APS frames from the
protection channel.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the APS protection may fail.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The opposite NE is not configured with the APS protection.
l Cause 2: The APS protection group is deactivated.
l Cause 3: The settings of the APS protection group differ between the two ends.
l Cause 4: The service on the protection channel is interrupted.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 407


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The opposite NE is not configured with the APS protection.
1. On the NMS, check whether the opposite NE is configured with the APS protection. For
details, see Querying MPLS APS Status.

If... Then...
The opposite NE is not configured with the APS protection Go to the next step.
The opposite NE is configured with the APS protection Go to Cause 2.

2. Create a matching APS protection group on the opposite NE, and activate the APS protocol.
Check whether the alarm clears.
3. If the alarm persists, proceed to cause 4.

Step 2 Cause 2: The APS protection group is deactivated.


1. Check whether the APS protocol is activated at both ends.

If... Then...
The APS protocol is deactivated at one end Activate the APS protocol at the end.
The APS protocol is activated at both ends Go to Cause 3.

2. Check whether the alarm clears. If the alarm persists, go to Cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: The settings of the APS protection group differ between the two ends.
1. On the NMS, check whether the settings of the APS protection group are the same at the
two ends. If the settings differ between the two ends, change them to the same. Then,
deactivate and activate the APS protection group at the two ends.
2. Check whether the alarm clears. If the alarm persists, go to Cause 4.

Step 4 Cause 4: The service on the protection channel is interrupted.


1. Check whether the protection channel reports an alarm related to signal loss or signal
degrade, such as ETH_LOS. If yes, clear the alarm immediately.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.74 ETH_APS_PATH_MISMATCH

Description
The ETH_APS_PATH_MISMATCH is an alarm indicating that the working and protection
paths of the APS protection group differ between the two ends. This alarm is reported when the
working and protection paths of one APS protection group at one end are different from those
at the other end.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 408


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, service protection fails.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The configured working and protection paths differ between the two ends.
l Cause 2: The physical link is connected incorrectly.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The configured working and protection paths differ between the two ends.
1. Check whether the APS settings at the two ends are the same. For details, see Querying
MPLS APS Status.
2. If the APS settings are different, change the settings to the same. Then, deactivate and
activate the APS protection group at the two ends. Then, check whether the alarm clears.
3. If the alarm persists, go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The physical link is connected incorrectly.


1. Check whether the fiber or cable is correctly connected between the two ends. If not,
connect the fiber or cable properly.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.75 ETH_APS_SWITCH_FAIL

Description
The ETH_APS_SWITCH_FAIL is an alarm of a protection switching failure. This alarm is
reported when the request signal in the transmitted Automatic Protection Switching (APS) frame
is different from the bridge signal in the received APS frame and this symptom lasts for 50 ms.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 409


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Minor Processing alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, service protection fails.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The settings of the APS protection group differ between the two ends.Cause 2: APS
fails due to other reasons.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The settings of the APS protection group differ between the two ends.
1. Change the settings to the same. For details, see Creating an MPLS APS Protection Group.
Then, deactivate and activate the APS protection group at the two ends.

Step 2 Cause 2: APS fails due to other reasons.


1. Reactivate APS protection at both ends.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.76 ETH_APS_TYPE_MISMATCH

Description
The ETH_APS_TYPE_MISMATCH is an alarm of protection scheme mismatch. This alarm is
reported when the information in the received Automatic Protection Switching (APS) frame is
different from the APS settings at the local end.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Communication alarm

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 410


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the specific difference.

l 0x01: Indicates that the switching type is different.


l 0x02: Indicates that the switching direction is different.
l 0x03: Indicates that the revertive mode is different.

Impact on the System


This alarm may cause the APS protection failure, and therefore the service protection fails.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The switching type is different.
l Cause 2: The switching direction is different.
l Cause 3: The revertive mode is different.

Procedure
Step 1 Determine the possible cause of the alarm according to the alarm parameters.
1. Change the settings of the APS protection group to the same at the two ends. For details,
see Querying MPLS APS Status. Then, deactivate and activate the APS protection group
at the two ends.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.77 ETH_AUTO_LINK_DOWN

Description
The ETH_AUTO_LINK_DOWN alarm indicates that an Ethernet port is automatically switched
to the link down state upon a fault detected by link-state pass through (LPT).

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Communication alarm

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 411


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The alarmed port cannot carry any services and a switchover may occur on external equipment
connected to the port.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The radio link connected to the alarmed port is faulty.
l Cause 2: The opposite service access port is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The radio link connected to the alarmed port is faulty.
1. Check for MW_LIM, MW_LOF, and MW_RDI alarms on the local and opposite
microwave ports, and clear them if any. Then, check whether the
ETH_AUTO_LINK_DOWN alarm is cleared.

Step 2 Cause 2: The opposite service access port is faulty.


1. Check for ETH_LOS alarm, and optical-module-related alarms on the opposite port, and
clear them if any.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.78 ETH_CFM_AIS
Description
The ETH_CFM_AIS is an alarm indicating that an AIS packet is received by the local MEP.
This alarm is reported when the system receives an AIS packet, which indicates that the Ethernet
server layer is faulty.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 412


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning
Parameters 1 to 4 (port) Indicate the ID of the port that reports the alarm.
Parameters 5 and 6 (VLAN ID) Indicate the VLAN ID of the MEP.
Parameter 7 (direction) Indicate the direction of the local MEP.
l 0x01: The port is in the ingress direction.
l 0x02: The port is in the egress direction.
Parameter 8 (level) Indicates the maintenance domain (MD) level of the local
MEP.
l 0x00: operator MEP level (low)
l 0x01: operator MEP level (medium)
l 0x02: operator MEP level (high)
l 0x03: provider MEP level (low)
l 0x04: provider MEP level (high)
l 0x05: consumer MEP level (low)
l 0x06: consumer MEP level (medium)
l 0x07: consumer MEP level (high)
NOTE
Consumer indicates the customer, provider indicates the supplier,
and operator indicates the carrier.

Impact on the System


l When this alarm occurs, the loopback (LB) and link trace (LT) detection functions are
disabled.
l In addition, the service between the relevant standard MEPs may be interrupted.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The upstream NE detects a fault at the Ethernet server layer.

Procedure
Step 1 Check whether there is any defect in the Ethernet server layer between source and sink NE.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 413


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.79 ETH_CFM_LOC

Description
The ETH_CFM_LOC is an alarm indicating the loss of connectivity. This alarm occurs when
the system fails to receive the CCM packet from the remote MEP in 3.5 connectivity check (CC)
periods successively.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1, Parameter 2, Parameter 3, Indicates the ID of the alarmed port.
Parameter 4 (Port)
Parameter 5, Parameter 6 (VLAN ID) Indicates the VLAN ID of the MEP.
Parameter 7 (Direction) Indicates the direction of the local MEP.
l 0x00: The port is direction insensitive.
l 0x01: The port is in the ingress direction.
l 0x02: The port is in the egress direction.
Parameter 8 (Level) Indicates the MD level of the local MEP.
l 0x00: operator MEP level (low)
l 0x01: operator MEP level (medium)
l 0x02: operator MEP level (high)
l 0x03: provider MEP level (low)
l 0x04: provider MEP level (high)
l 0x05: consumer MEP level (low)
l 0x06: consumer MEP level (medium)
l 0x07: consumer MEP level (high)
NOTE
Consumer indicates the user, provider indicates the
supplier, and operator indicates the carrier.

Parameter 9, Parameter 10 (RMEPID) Indicates the ID of the remote MEP.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 414


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Impact on the System


l When the ETH_CFM_LOC alarm occurs, the LB and LT detection functions of Ethernet
service OAM are unavailable.
l The service between the relevant standard MEPs may be interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The line between the local standard MEP and the remote standard MEP is
interrupted.
l Cause 2: The Ethernet service in the maintenance association (MA) to which the local MEP
belongs is faulty.
l Cause 3: Serious congestion occurs on the network.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The line between the local standard MEP and the remote standard MEP is interrupted.
1. Check whether the physical links (such as network cables and fibers) between the standard
MEPs are connected properly.

If... Then...
The physical links are connected improperly Connect the physical links properly.
The physical links are connected properly Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The Ethernet service in the maintenance association (MA) to which the local MEP
belongs is faulty.
1. Check whether Ethernet service in the maintenance association (MA) to which the local
MEP belongs is configured correctly.

If... Then...
The service is configured incorrectly Modify the configuration of the service to ensure
consistency at two ends.
The service is configured correctly Go to Cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: Serious congestion occurs on the network.


1. Check the utilization of bandwidth. If the bandwidth is exhausted, increase the bandwidth
or eliminate any source that transmits a large amount of invalid data.

----End

Related Information
The Table A-7 describes the meanings of the parameters in the ETH_CFM_LOC alarm reported
by the EoS/EoPDH plane.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 415


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Table A-7 Alarm Parameters

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 to Parameter 4 MD

Parameter 5 to Parameter 8 MA

Parameter 9, Parameter 10 MEP ID

Parameter 11 to Parameter 14 Indicates the ID of the alarmed port.


When these parameters indicate the
VCTRUNK ID, parameter values = (0x01 -
0x10) + 0x80.

Parameter 15, Parameter 16 Indicates the VLAN ID of the MEP.

Parameter 17 Indicates the direction of the local MEP.


l 0x00: The port is direction insensitive.
l 0x01: The port is in the ingress direction.
l 0x02: The port is in the egress direction.

Parameter 18 Indicates the MD level of the local MEP.


l 0x00: operator MEP level (low)
l 0x01: operator MEP level (medium)
l 0x02: operator MEP level (high)
l 0x03: provider MEP level (low)
l 0x04: provider MEP level (high)
l 0x05: consumer MEP level (low)
l 0x06: consumer MEP level (medium)
l 0x07: consumer MEP level (high)
NOTE
Consumer indicates the user, provider indicates
the supplier, and operator indicates the carrier.

Parameter 19, Parameter 20 Indicates the ID of the remote MEP.


NOTE
If the alarmed port is a VCTRUNK, these
parameters are not supported.

A.3.80 ETH_CFM_MISMERGE

Description
The ETH_CFM_MISMERGE is an alarm indicating an incorrect connection. This alarm occurs
when the system receives the CCM packet whose MA mismatches or whose priority is lower.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 416


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1, Parameter 2, Parameter 3, Indicates the ID of the alarmed port.
Parameter 4 (Port)
Parameter 5, Parameter 6 (VLAN ID) Indicates the VLAN ID of the MEP.
Parameter 7 (Direction) Indicates the direction of the local MEP.
l 0x00: The port is direction insensitive.
l 0x01: The port is in the ingress direction.
l 0x02: The port is in the egress direction.
Parameter 8 (Level) Indicates the MD level of the local MEP.
l 0x00: operator MEP level (low)
l 0x01: operator MEP level (medium)
l 0x02: operator MEP level (high)
l 0x03: provider MEP level (low)
l 0x04: provider MEP level (high)
l 0x05: consumer MEP level (low)
l 0x06: consumer MEP level (medium)
l 0x07: consumer MEP level (high)
NOTE
Consumer indicates the user, provider indicates the
supplier, and operator indicates the carrier.

Impact on the System


When the ETH_CFM_MISMERGE alarm occurs, the service between the relevant standard
MEPs may be interrupted, and the data flow may be routed incorrectly.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The names of the maintenance domain and the maintenance alliance that the
standard MEPs correspond to are inconsistent.
l Cause 2: The levels of the maintenance domains that the standard MEPs correspond to are
different.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 417


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

l Cause 3: The physical connection is incorrect.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The names of the maintenance domain and the maintenance alliance that the standard
MEPs correspond to are inconsistent.
1. Check whether the names of the maintenance domain and the maintenance alliance that the
standard MEPs correspond to are consistent.

If... Then...
The names are inconsistent Set the other names of maintenance domain and
maintenance alliance to ensure consistency at both ends.
The names are consistent Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The levels of the maintenance domains that the standard MEPs correspond to are
different.
1. Check whether the MD levels of the standard MEPs are the same.

If... Then...
The levels are different Set the MD levels again to ensure consistency at both ends.
The levels are the same Go to Cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: The physical connection is incorrect.


1. Check the physical connection of the Ethernet service route and rectify the fault of the
physical connection if any.

----End

Related Information
The Table A-8 describes the meanings of the parameters in the ETH_CFM_LOC alarm reported
by the EoS/EoPDH plane.

Table A-8 Alarm Parameters

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 to Parameter 4 MD

Parameter 5 to Parameter 8 MA

Parameter 9, Parameter 10 MEP ID

Parameter 11 to Parameter 14 Indicates the ID of the alarmed port.


When these parameters indicate the
VCTRUNK ID, parameter values = (0x01 -
0x10) + 0x80.

Parameter 15, Parameter 16 Indicates the VLAN ID of the MEP.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 418


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning

Parameter 17 Indicates the direction of the local MEP.


l 0x00: The port is direction insensitive.
l 0x01: The port is in the ingress direction.
l 0x02: The port is in the egress direction.

Parameter 18 Indicates the MD level of the local MEP.


l 0x00: operator MEP level (low)
l 0x01: operator MEP level (medium)
l 0x02: operator MEP level (high)
l 0x03: provider MEP level (low)
l 0x04: provider MEP level (high)
l 0x05: consumer MEP level (low)
l 0x06: consumer MEP level (medium)
l 0x07: consumer MEP level (high)
NOTE
Consumer indicates the user, provider indicates
the supplier, and operator indicates the carrier.

A.3.81 ETH_CFM_RDI

Description
The ETH_CFM_RDI is an alarm indicating the CCM packet with RDI received from the remote
MEP. This alarm occurs when the system receives the CCM packet with RDI from the remote
maintenance end point (MEP).

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1, Parameter 2, Parameter 3, Indicates the ID of the alarmed port.
Parameter 4 (Port)

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 419


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning
Parameter 5, Parameter 6 (VLAN ID) Indicates the VLAN ID of the MEP.
Parameter 7 (Direction) Indicates the direction of the local MEP.
l 0x00: The port is direction insensitive.
l 0x01: The port is in the ingress direction.
l 0x02: The port is in the egress direction.
Parameter 8 (Level) Indicates the MD level of the local MEP.
l 0x00: operator MEP level (low)
l 0x01: operator MEP level (medium)
l 0x02: operator MEP level (high)
l 0x03: provider MEP level (low)
l 0x04: provider MEP level (high)
l 0x05: consumer MEP level (low)
l 0x06: consumer MEP level (medium)
l 0x07: consumer MEP level (high)
NOTE
Consumer indicates the user, provider indicates the
supplier, and operator indicates the carrier.

Parameter 9, Parameter 10 (RMEPID) Indicates the ID of the remote MEP.

Impact on the System


l When the ETH_CFM_RDI alarm occurs, the loopback (LB) and link trace (LT) detection
functions of Ethernet service OAM are unavailable.
l The service between the relevant standard MEPs may be interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The remote MEP fails to receive the correct CCM packet.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The remote MEP fails to receive the correct CCM packet.
1. Determine the alarmed port according to the alarm parameter.
2. Check whether the remote MEP that is connected to the port reports the
ETH_CFM_MISMERGE, ETH_CFM_UNEXPERI, or ETH_CFM_LOC alarm.

----End

Related Information
The Table A-9 describes the meanings of the parameters in the ETH_CFM_LOC alarm reported
by the EoS/EoPDH plane.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 420


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Table A-9 Alarm Parameters

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 to Parameter 4 MD

Parameter 5 to Parameter 8 MA

Parameter 9, Parameter 10 MEP ID

Parameter 11 to Parameter 14 Indicates the ID of the alarmed port.


When these parameters indicate the
VCTRUNK ID, parameter values = (0x01 -
0x10) + 0x80.

Parameter 15, Parameter 16 Indicates the VLAN ID of the MEP.

Parameter 17 Indicates the direction of the local MEP.


l 0x00: The port is direction insensitive.
l 0x01: The port is in the ingress direction.
l 0x02: The port is in the egress direction.

Parameter 18 Indicates the MD level of the local MEP.


l 0x00: operator MEP level (low)
l 0x01: operator MEP level (medium)
l 0x02: operator MEP level (high)
l 0x03: provider MEP level (low)
l 0x04: provider MEP level (high)
l 0x05: consumer MEP level (low)
l 0x06: consumer MEP level (medium)
l 0x07: consumer MEP level (high)
NOTE
Consumer indicates the user, provider indicates
the supplier, and operator indicates the carrier.

Parameter 19, Parameter 20 Indicates the ID of the remote MEP.


NOTE
If the alarmed port is a VCTRUNK, these
parameters are not supported.

A.3.82 ETH_CFM_UNEXPERI

Description
The ETH_CFM_UNEXPERI is an alarm indicating the errored frame. This alarm occurs when
the system receives invalid CCM packets.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 421


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1, Parameter 2, Parameter 3, Indicates the ID of the alarmed port.
Parameter 4 (Port)
Parameter 5, Parameter 6 (VLAN ID) Indicates the VLAN ID of the MEP.
Parameter 7 (Direction) Indicates the direction of the local MEP.
l 0x00: The port is direction insensitive.
l 0x01: The port is in the ingress direction.
l 0x02: The port is in the egress direction.
Parameter 8 (Level) Indicates the MD level of the local MEP.
l 0x00: operator MEP level (low)
l 0x01: operator MEP level (medium)
l 0x02: operator MEP level (high)
l 0x03: provider MEP level (low)
l 0x04: provider MEP level (high)
l 0x05: consumer MEP level (low)
l 0x06: consumer MEP level (medium)
l 0x07: consumer MEP level (high)
NOTE
Consumer indicates the user, provider indicates the
supplier, and operator indicates the carrier.

Impact on the System


l When the ETH_CFM_UNEXPERI alarm occurs, the LB and LT detection functions of
Ethernet service OAM are unavailable.
l The service may become abnormal due to the loop.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: No remote MEP is configured.
l Cause 2: The configuration of the MEPs at both ends is inconsistent. For example, the
connectivity check (CC) periods are different, and the IDs of the MEPs are in conflict.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 422


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

l Cause 3: The service is looped back and the looped packet is received.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: No remote MEP is configured.
1. Check whether the remote MEP is configured. If not, configure the remote MEP first.

Step 2 Cause 2: The configuration of the MEPs at both ends is inconsistent. For example, the
connectivity check (CC) periods are different, and the IDs of the MEPs are in conflict.
1. Check whether the CC periods set at the MEPs are the same.

If... Then...
The CC periods are different Change the CC periods to ensure consistency at both
ends.
The CC periods are the same Go to the next step.

2. Check whether the IDs of the MEPs in the maintenance domain are in conflict.

If... Then...
The IDs are in conflict Change the conflicting IDs.
The IDs are not in conflict Go to Cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: The service is looped back and the looped packet is received.
1. Check whether any loop exists at each IP port of the service trail. If yes, release the loop
and clear the alarm.

----End

Related Information
The Table A-10 describes the meanings of the parameters in the ETH_CFM_LOC alarm
reported by the EoS/EoPDH plane.

Table A-10 Alarm Parameters

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 to Parameter 4 MD

Parameter 5 to Parameter 8 MA

Parameter 9, Parameter 10 MEP ID

Parameter 11 to Parameter 14 Indicates the ID of the alarmed port.


When these parameters indicate the
VCTRUNK ID, parameter values = (0x01 -
0x10) + 0x80.

Parameter 15, Parameter 16 Indicates the VLAN ID of the MEP.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 423


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning

Parameter 17 Indicates the direction of the local MEP.


l 0x00: The port is direction insensitive.
l 0x01: The port is in the ingress direction.
l 0x02: The port is in the egress direction.

Parameter 18 Indicates the MD level of the local MEP.


l 0x00: operator MEP level (low)
l 0x01: operator MEP level (medium)
l 0x02: operator MEP level (high)
l 0x03: provider MEP level (low)
l 0x04: provider MEP level (high)
l 0x05: consumer MEP level (low)
l 0x06: consumer MEP level (medium)
l 0x07: consumer MEP level (high)
NOTE
Consumer indicates the user, provider indicates
the supplier, and operator indicates the carrier.

A.3.83 ETH_EFM_DF

Description
The ETH_EFM_DF is an alarm indicating negotiation failure. This alarm occurs when the point-
to-point OAM protocol negotiation fails at the Ethernet port.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 424


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the reason why the negotiation fails.

l 0x01: The local link is faulty.


l 0x02: The local end fails to receive any OAM packets in a specified period.
l 0x03: The OAM settings of the opposite end do not meet the requirements of
the local end.
l 0x04: The OAM settings of the local end do not meet the requirements of the
opposite end.

Impact on the System


When the ETH_EFM_DF alarm occurs, the service at the alarmed port may be interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The physical port of the local end is faulty.
l Cause 2: The point to point OAM protocol is not enabled at the opposite end.
l Cause 3: The OAM configuration at both ends is inconsistent.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The physical port of the local end is faulty.
1. Check whether the physical port is faulty. If yes, replace the board where the Ethernet
port is located.

Step 2 Cause 2: The point to point OAM protocol is not enabled at the opposite end.
1. Enable the point to point OAM protocol at the opposite end.

Step 3 Cause 3: The OAM configuration at both ends is inconsistent.


1. Reconfigure the point to point OAM protocol and ensure the consistency at both ends.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.84 ETH_EFM_EVENT

Description
The ETH_EFM_EVENT is an alarm indicating the performance event reported on the opposite
NE. This alarm occurs when the local end receives the link error indication packet (OAMPDUM)
from the opposite end.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 425


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the type of the link event.

l 0x01: errored symbol period.


l 0x02: errored frame.
l 0x03: errored frame period.
l 0x04: errored frame seconds summary.

Impact on the System


When the ETH_EFM_EVENT alarm occurs, the service at the alarmed port may be interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The physical port at the local end is faulty.
l Cause 2: The equipment at the opposite end is faulty.
l Cause 3: The line performance deteriorates (the alarm is reported by an Ethernet optical
port).
l Cause 4: The line performance deteriorates (the alarm is reported by an Ethernet electrical
port).

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The physical port at the local end is faulty.
1. Check whether the physical port is faulty. If yes, replace the board where the Ethernet
port is located.

Step 2 Cause 2: The equipment at the opposite end is faulty.


1. Rectify the fault of the equipment at the opposite end.

Step 3 Cause 3: The line performance deteriorates (the alarm is reported by an Ethernet optical port).
1. Check whether the transmit power at the opposite site and the receive power at the local
site meet the specifications of the optical ports. For details, see Browsing Current
Performance Events.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 426


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The transmit power at the opposite site is Replace the optical module at the
too low opposite site.
The transmit power at the opposite site is A fiber is faulty. Go to the next step.
normal, but the receive power at the local
site is close to the receiver sensitivity (for
example, a difference within 3 dB)
2. If a fiber is faulty, check whether the fiber jumper from the equipment to the optical
distribution frame (ODF) and the fiber that is led out from the equipment room are pressed,
and whether any fiber connector is dirty or damaged. If yes, clean or replace the fiber
connector, or replace the fiber jumper. Check whether the alarm is cleared.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 1 or 2.

Step 4 Cause 4: The line performance deteriorates (the alarm is reported by an Ethernet electrical port).
1. Check whether the cable grounding, cable connectors, and cables are damaged. If yes,
replace the faulty cables.
2. Check whether the alarm is cleared.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 1 or 2.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.85 ETH_EFM_LOOPBACK
Description
The ETH_EFM_LOOPBACK is an alarm indicating the loopback. This alarm occurs when the
local end initiates a loopback or responds to a loopback request from the opposite end.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 427


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details


about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the state of the loopback.

l 0x01: The local end initiates a loopback.


l 0x02: The local end responds to a loop request from the opposite end.

Impact on the System


When the ETH_EFM_LOOPBACK alarm occurs, the service at the alarmed port is looped back.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The local end initiates a loopback.
l Cause 2: The opposite end initiates a loopback.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The local end initiates a loopback.
1. According to the alarm parameter, it is determined that the local end initiates a loopback.
Determine the causes of the loopback initiated at the local end and release the loopback as
soon as possible.

Step 2 Cause 2: The opposite end initiates a loopback.


1. According to the alarm parameter, it is determined that the opposite end initiates a loopback.
Determine the causes of the loopback initiated at the opposite port and release the loopback
as soon as possible.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.86 ETH_EFM_REMFAULT

Description
The ETH_EFM_REMFAULT is an alarm indicating the fault on the opposite NE. This alarm
occurs when the local end receives the fault indication packet (OAMPDUM) from the opposite
end.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Critical Communication alarm

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 428


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the fault type at the opposite end.

l 0x01: link fault.


l 0x02: dying gasp.
l 0x03: critical event.

Impact on the System


When the ETH_EFM_REMFAULT alarm occurs, the service at the alarmed port may be
interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The opposite NE is reset.
l Cause 2: The opposite NE is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The opposite NE is reset.
1. Check whether the opposite NE is reset frequently.

If... Then...
The opposite NE is reset frequently Rectify the fault on the opposite NE.
The opposite NE is not reset frequently Reset the opposite NE, and the alarm is
cleared.

Step 2 Cause 2: The opposite NE is faulty.


1. Rectify the fault on the opposite NE.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.87 ETH_LOS

Description
The ETH_LOS is an alarm indicating the loss of Ethernet port connection.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 429


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Critical Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the ETH_LOS alarm occurs, the service at the alarmed port is interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The negotiation fails because the transmit port and receive port work in different
modes.
l Cause 2: The cable or fiber is faulty.
l Cause 3: The local receive end is faulty.
l Cause 4: The remote transmit end is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The negotiation fails because the transmit port and receive port work in different modes.
1. Check whether the transmit port and receive port work in the same mode.

If... Then...
The transmit port and receive port work Correctly set the working modes of the
in different modes transmit port and receive port.
The transmit port and receive port work Go to Cause 2.
in the same mode

Step 2 Cause 2: The cable or fiber is faulty.


1. Check the network cable or fiber jumper connected to the alarmed port.

If... Then...
The network cable is loose or damaged Connect the network cable properly or
replace the damaged network cable.
The connector of the fiber jumper is dirty Clean the connector.
The connector or fiber is damaged Insert the connector properly or replace the
damaged fiber jumper.
The connection is normal Go to Cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: The local receive end is faulty.


1. Check whether any fault occurs on the alarmed port.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 430


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The equipment is faulty Replace the alarmed board on the local.
The equipment is normal Go to Cause 4.

Step 4 Cause 4: The remote transmit end is faulty.


1. Check whether any fault occurs on the equipment interconnected with the alarmed port.
2. Rectify the fault.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.88 ETH_NO_FLOW

Description
The ETH_NO_FLOW is an alarm indicating that the Ethernet port has no flow. This alarm is
reported when an enabled Ethernet port is in link up state but has no flow.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Service alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the MAC port number.
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the path ID.

Parameter 2 indicates the most significant bits and the value is


always 0x00. Parameter 3 indicates the least significant bits and the
value is always 0x01.

Parameter 4 Indicates the direction in which the flow is unavailable.

l 0x00: Rx direction.
l 0x01: Tx direction.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 431


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, it indicates that the alarmed port has no flow.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The port is enabled and in link up state, but is configured with no service.
l Cause 2: The port is enabled and in link up state, but does not transmit any packet due to
the service fault at the local end.
l Cause 3: The port is enabled and in link up state, but does not receive any packet due to
the service fault at the remote end.

Procedure
Step 1 Determine the MAC port number, alarmed board, and cause according to the parameters.
Step 2 Cause 1: No services are configured.
1. Configure the Ethernet service.
Step 3 Cause 2: No services are available.

If... Then...
No services are available in the transmit Check whether the service is normal at the
direction local end.
No services are available in the receive Check whether the service is normal at the
direction remote end.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.89 ETH_PWR_SUPPLY_FAIL
Description
The ETH_PWR_SUPPLY_FAIL is an alarm indicating a power outputting failure of an Ethernet
port. This alarm is reported when an Ethernet port is enabled with the PE function but outputs
no power.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Critical Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 432


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the NE that is connected to the Ethernet port outputs no power.

Possible Causes
l Cause: The board is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause: The board is faulty.
1. 6.7 Replacing the Ethernet Interface Board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.90 ETHOAM_DISCOVER_FAIL

Description
The ETHOAM_DISCOVER_FAIL alarm indicates a discovery failure when the point-to-point
ETH-OAM function is enabled. This alarm occurs when the OAM function is enabled at a port
of a board and the negotiation between the port and the opposite equipment fails.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Minor Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 Indicates the ID of the alarmed port.

Parameter 2, Parameter 3 The values are always 0x00 0x01.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 433


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning

Parameter 4 Indicates the reason why the negotiation fails.

l 0x01: A fault occurs at the local receive link.


l 0x02: The local end fails to transmit OAM packets.
l 0x03: The OAM packets from the opposite end are not received.
l 0x04: The OAM configuration of the opposite end does not meet
the requirements of the local end.
l 0x05: The OAM configuration of the local end does not meet
the requirements of the opposite end.
l 0x06-0xff: other unknown reasons.

Impact on the System


The OAM function based on IEEE 802.3ah is unavailable.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The physical port of the local end is faulty.
l Cause 2: The P2P OAM protocol is not enabled at the opposite end.
l Cause 3: The OAM configuration at both ends is inconsistent.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The physical port of the local end is faulty.
1. Check whether the physical port is faulty. If yes, replace the alarmed board.

Step 2 Cause 2: The P2P OAM protocol is not enabled at the opposite end.
1. Enable the P2P OAM protocol at the opposite end. For details, see Enabling the OAM
Auto-Discovery Function.

Step 3 Cause 3: The OAM configuration at both ends is inconsistent.


1. Reconfigure the P2P OAM protocol and ensure the consistency at both ends. For details,
see Enabling the OAM Auto-Discovery Function.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.91 ETHOAM_RMT_CRIT_FAULT

Description
The ETHOAM_RMT_CRIT_FAULT is an alarm indicating that the point-to-point Ethernet
OAM detects a critical fault at the remote end. This alarm occurs when a port with the OAM

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 434


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

function enabled receives the OAM packets that contain critical fault information from the
opposite end.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Minor Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 Indicates the ID of the alarmed port.

Parameter 2, Parameter 3 The values are always 0x00 0x01.

Parameter 4 Indicates the type of the fault.

l 0x01: A link fault occurs at the port of the opposite end.


l 0x02: Irrecoverable problems such as the power failure occur at
the opposite end.
l 0x03-0xff: other faults.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the services on the link may be interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: A link fault occurs at the remote MEP.
l Cause 2: Irrecoverable problems such as power failure occur at the remote MEP.
l Cause 3: Other faults occur at the remote MEP.

Procedure
Step 1 Determine the fault type according to Parameter 4.

If... Then...
The value of Parameter 4 is 0x01 Go to Cause 1.
The value of Parameter 4 is 0x02 Go to Cause 2.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 435


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
Parameter 4 is a value from 0x03 to 0xff. Go to Cause 3.

Step 2 Cause 1: A link fault occurs at the remote MEP.


1. Handle the ETH_LOS alarm at the remote port.

Step 3 Cause 2: Irrecoverable problems such as power failure occur at the remote MEP.
1. Handle the problems such as power failure at the remote MEP, and recover the power supply
to the remote MEP.

Step 4 Cause 3: Other faults occur at the remote MEP.


1. Contact Huawei technical support engineers.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.92 ETHOAM_RMT_LOOP

Description
The ETHOAM_RMT_LOOP is an alarm indicating that a remote loopback is initiated when the
point-to-point Ethernet OAM function is enabled. This alarm occurs when the local equipment
initiates a remote loopback or responds to the remote loopback initiated by the opposite
equipment.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Minor Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 Indicates the ID of the alarmed port.

Parameter 2, Parameter 3 The values are always 0x00 0x01.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 436


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning

Parameter 4 l 0x01: The loopback is initiated.


l 0x02: The loopback is responded.

Impact on the System


The services are looped back between the local equipment and the opposite equipment. The
services and other protocol packets are interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The local end issues a loopback command and the opposite end responds to the
command.
l Cause 2: The opposite end issues a loopback command and the local end responds to the
command.

Procedure
Step 1 Check the alarm on the NMS and determine the type of loopback according to the alarm
parameters.

If... Then...
The value of Parameter 4 is 0x01 Go to Cause 1.
The value of Parameter 4 is 0x02 Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 1: The local end issues a loopback command and the opposite end responds to the
command.
1. Determine the causes of the loopback at the local end and release the loopback.

Step 3 Cause 2: The opposite end issues a loopback command and the local end responds to the
command.
1. Determine the causes of the loopback at the opposite end and release the loopback.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.93 ETHOAM_RMT_SD

Description
The ETHOAM_RMT_SD alarm indicates that the point-to-point Ethernet-OAM detects the
degradation of remote Ethernet performance. This alarm occurs when a port with the OAM
function enabled receives link event notification packets from the opposite end.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 437


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Minor Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 Indicates the ID of the alarmed port.

Parameter 2, Parameter 3 The values are always 0x00 0x01.

Parameter 4 Indicates the type of the received link event.

l 0x01: errored frame event


l 0x02: errored frame period event
l 0x03: errored frame second event

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the performance of services degrades.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The link event notification function is enabled at the opposite end.
l Cause 2: The link performance thresholds of the opposite end are inappropriate.
l Cause 3: The link performance deteriorates.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The link event notification function is enabled at the opposite end.
1. Check whether the link event notification function is enabled at the opposite end.

If... Then...
If yes Disable the link event notification function at the opposite end.
If not Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The link performance thresholds of the opposite end are inappropriate.
1. Check whether the link performance thresholds of the opposite end are appropriate.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 438


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
If not Set the thresholds to appropriate values.
If yes Go to Cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: The link performance deteriorates.


1. Improve the link performance at the opposite end so that the opposite end does not send
any link event notification packet to the local end. Then, the alarm at the local end is cleared
automatically.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.94 ETHOAM_SELF_LOOP

Description
The ETHOAM_SELF_LOOP is an alarm indicating the loopback of the MAC port that runs the
point-to-point OAM protocol. This alarm occurs when the MAC port of a board receives the
OAM protocol packet sent by the port itself or the board after the loop detection function is
enabled.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Environmental alarms

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 Indicates the loopback type.

l 0x01: selfloop of the port.


l 0x02: selfloop of the board.

Impact on the System


When the ETHOAM_SELF_LOOP alarm occurs, a network storm may occur due to the
loopback.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 439


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The cable connected to the port is self-looped, or the port is connected to a LAN
that has a loopback, or the PHY/MAC loopback is manually configured at the port.
l Cause 2: Two ports of the board are connected through cables or two ports of the board are
connected to the same LAN.

Procedure
Step 1 Determine the loopback type according to Parameter 1, and then handle the loopback
accordingly.

If... Then...
The value of Parameter 1 is 0x01 Go to Cause 1.
The value of Parameter 1 is 0x02 Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 1: The cable connected to the port is self-looped, or the port is connected to a LAN that
has a loopback, or the PHY/MAC loopback is manually configured at the port.

If... Then...
The PHY/MAC loopback is manually Manually release the PHY/MAC loopback (or
configured at the port wait five minutes for the automatic release by
the NE if the automatic loopback release
function is enabled on the NE). Then, the
selfloop is released.
The cable connected to the port is self- Connect the cable properly to release the
looped selfloop.
The port is connected to a LAN that has a Release the loopback on the LAN, or break the
loopback connection between the port and the LAN, to
release the selfloop.

Step 3 Cause 2: Two ports of the board are connected through cables or two ports of the board are
connected to the same LAN.
1. Check whether two ports of the board are connected through cables or whether two ports
of the board are connected to the same LAN.

If... Then...
The two ports are connected through Disconnect the cables to release the
cables selfloop.
The two ports are connected to the same Break the connection between a port and the
network LAN to release the selfloop.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 440


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.95 ETHOAM_VCG_SELF_LOOP

Description
The ETHOAM_VCG_SELF_LOOP alarm indicates that a VCTRUNK port is looped back when
the point-to-point Ethernet OAM function is enabled. This alarm occurs when the loopback
detection function is enabled and the VCTRUNK port receives the OAM protocol packets
transmitted by the port itself or the board where the VCTRUNK port resides.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Environment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 Indicates the loopback type.

l 0x01: The port is self-looped.


l 0x02: The board is self-looped.
l 0x03-0xff: unknown types.

Impact on the System


If the function of automatic shutdown in the case of a selfloop is enabled at the alarmed port,
the services at the alarmed port are interrupted. Otherwise, a network storm may occur.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: A loopback occurs on the lines connected to one VCTRUNK.
l Cause 2: The lines connected to two VCTRUNKs on the same board are interconnected.

Procedure
Step 1 Check the alarm on the NMS and determine the type of loopback according to the alarm
parameters.

If... Then...
The value of Parameter 4 is 0x01 Go to Cause 1.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 441


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The value of Parameter 4 is 0x02 Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 1: The port is self-looped.


1. Release the loopback at the port.
2. Reconfigure the lines connected to the VCTRUNK port and ensure that the port is not self-
looped.

Step 3 Cause 2: The board is self-looped.


1. Reconfigure the lines connected to the VCTRUNK ports and ensure that the lines connected
to any two VCTRUNK ports on the same board are not interconnected.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.96 EX_ETHOAM_CC_LOS

Description
The EX_ETHOAM_CC_LOS is an alarm indicating the loss of periodic connectivity check
(CC) packets. This alarm occurs when the sink MEP fails to receive CC packets from the same
source MEP in a period (3.5 transmission periods of CC packets at the source MEP).

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Critical Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 to Parameter 4 Indicates the ID of the remote MEP.
Parameter 5 to Parameter 8 Indicates the ID of the local MEP.

Parameter 9, Parameter 10 Indicates the ID of the alarmed port.

l PORT number, Parameter 9 is 0x00.


l VCTRUNK number, Parameter 9 is 0x80.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 442


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning

Parameter 11, Parameter 12 Indicates the VLAN ID of the MEP.

Parameter 13 Indicates the MD level of the local MEP.

Parameter 14 to Parameter 17 Indicates the ID of the remote MEP.

Parameter 18 - Parameter 21 Indicates the ID of the local MEP.

Impact on the System


A unidirectional connectivity failure occurs in the Ethernet service between two MEPs.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The line between two MEPs is interrupted.
l Cause 2: The Ethernet services in the MA to which the alarmed MEP belongs are faulty.
l Cause 3: The services between two MEPs are congested or interrupted.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The line between two MEPs is interrupted.
1. Check whether the physical links (such as network cables or optical fibers) that carry
services between the two MEPs are correctly connected.

If... Then...
If not Re-connect the cables to rectify the faults on physical links.
If yes Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The Ethernet services in the MA to which the alarmed MEP belongs are faulty.
1. Check whether the Ethernet services in the MA to which the alarmed MEP belongs are
configured correctly.

If... Then...
If not Modify the configuration to ensure consistency at both ends.
If yes Go to Cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: The services between two MEPs are congested or interrupted.
1. Check the bandwidth utilization. If the bandwidth is exhausted, increase the bandwidth or
eliminate any source that transmits a large amount of invalid data.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 443


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.97 EX_ETHOAM_MPID_CNFLCT

Description
The EX_ETHOAM_MPID_CNFLCT is an alarm indicating the conflict of MPIDs. This alarm
occurs when two MEPs in one MD have the same maintenance point identity (MPID) and one
MEP receives the packets from the other MEP.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Environment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 to Parameter 4 Indicates the ID of the local MEP.

Parameter 5, Parameter 6 Indicates the ID of the alarmed port.

l PORT number, Parameter 9 is 0x00.


l VCTRUNK number, Parameter 9 is 0x80.

Parameter 7, Parameter 8 Indicates the VLAN ID of the MEP.

Parameter 9 Indicates the MD level of the local MEP.

Parameter 10 to Parameter 13 Indicates the ID of the local MEP.

Impact on the System


MPIDs must be unique on a network. When this alarm occurs, the LB and LT functions are
abnormal and OAM packets are received incorrectly.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: At least two MEPs in an MD have the same MPID.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: At least two MEPs in an MD have the same MPID.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 444


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

1. Check the alarm on the NMS and determine the associated MP ID according to the alarm
parameters.
2. Query the information about the MEP. Delete the incorrect MEPs and create MEPs with
unique MP IDs.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.98 EXT_SYNC_LOS

Description
The EXT_SYNC_LOS is an alarm of the loss of the external clock source.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Critical Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 l 0x01: the first external clock source
l 0x02: the second external clock source

Impact on the System


l When the EXT_SYNC_LOS alarm occurs, if only the external clock source and internal
clock source are configured in the clock source priority list, the NE traces the internal clock
source after the external clock source is lost and enters the free-run state 24 hours later.
The system saves 24-hour holdover data. The system works in 24-hour holdover mode
instead of permanent holdover mode.
l If another valid clock source of higher priority and good quality is configured in the clock
source priority list, however, the clock protection switching occurs.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The external clock source is configured in the clock source priority list, but the external
clock source cannot be detected or become invalid.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 445


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The external clock source is configured in the clock source priority list, but the external
clock source cannot be detected or become invalid.
1. Check whether the equipment that provides the external clock source is faulty.

If... Then...
The equipment is faulty Rectify the fault.
The equipment is normal Go to the next step.

2. Check whether the cable that connects the external clock source is normal.

If... Then...
The cable is abnormal Replace the cable.
The cable is normal Replace the alarmed board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.99 EXT_TIME_LOC

Description
The EXT_TIME_LOC is an alarm of the loss of the external time source.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 l 0x01: link failure on a port


l 0x02: unchanged second value in time of day (TOD) information, or
unavailable second pulse, or degraded second pulse
l 0x03: CRC errors in TOD information

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 446


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Impact on the System


The time of a local NE cannot be synchronized to the external time device to which the NE's
enabled external time port is connected.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The link at a port is faulty.
l Cause 2: The external time device is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The link at a port is faulty.
1. Check cable connections. If cables are incorrectly connected, connect the cables again.

Step 2 Cause 2: The external time device is faulty.


1. Check whether the external time device is faulty.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.100 FAN_AGING

Description
The FAN_AGING is an alarm of the aged fan. This alarm occurs when the fan rotates at a speed
lower than eighty percent of the nominal speed.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Minor Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the number of the alarmed fan.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 447


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the temperature of the NE is too high and impacts the long-term
operation of the NE.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The fan is aged.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The fan is aged.
1. Replace the fan.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.101 FAN_FAIL

Description
The FAN_FAIL is an alarm indicating that the fan is faulty.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the number of the fan.

Impact on the System


When the FAN_FAIL alarm occurs, the heat dissipation of the system is affected.

After an alarm is reported, clear it immediately. Otherwise, services may be interrupted or


equipment may be damaged.

When a fan is faulty, perform the following operations:

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 448


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

l Replace the faulty fan with one that works properly within a period of 96 hours if the
ambient temperature ranges from 0C to 40C.
l Replace the faulty fan with one that works properly within a period of 24 hours if the
ambient temperature is higher than 40C.

When multiple fans are faulty, replace them immediately.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The board and the backplane are connected improperly.
l Cause 2: Fan failure occurs.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The board and the backplane are connected improperly.
1. Remove the fan board. Clean the dust on the fan and reinsert the fan board.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared after the board is The fault is rectified. End the alarm
removed and inserted handling.
The alarm persists after the board is Go to Cause 2.
removed and inserted

Step 2 Cause 2: Fan failure occurs.


1. Replace the alarmed fan board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.102 FCS_ERR

Description
The FCS_ERR is an alarm indicating the errors of frame check sequence (FCS). This alarm
occurs when a board detects FCS errors in the received frames.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Critical Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 449


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details


about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 The value is always 0x01.

Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the VCTRUNK number where the alarm occurs.

Impact on the System


When the FCS_ERR alarm occurs, if the encapsulation protocols or encapsulation parameters
are inconsistent at both ends of Ethernet services, the services may have errors and even become
interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The encapsulation protocols or encapsulation parameters are inconsistent at both
ends of services.
l Cause 2: Service channels have errors.
l Cause 3: The alarmed board is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The encapsulation protocols or encapsulation parameters are inconsistent at both ends
of services.
1. Check whether the encapsulation protocols or encapsulation parameters are consistent at
both ends of services.

If... Then...
The protocols are inconsistent Correct the configuration data.
The protocols are consistent Go to the next step.
2. Check whether the encapsulation parameters are consistent at both ends of services.

If... Then...
The parameters are inconsistent Correct the configuration data.
The parameters are consistent Go to the next step.

Step 2 Cause 2: Service channels have errors.


1. Check whether any error alarm or performance event occurs on the board that carries the
services.

If... Then...
Yes Handle the alarm or performance event.
No Go to the next step.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 450


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Step 3 Cause 3: The alarmed board is faulty.


1. Replace the alarmed board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.103 FDBSIZEALM_ELAN

Description
The FDBSIZEALM_ELAN alarm indicates that items listed in an E-LAN forwarding table are
all used. This alarm is reported when the number of actual items in the MAC address table for
the E-LAN service is greater than Address Detection Upper Threshold. This alarm is cleared
automatically when the number of items in the MAC address table of the E-LAN service is lower
than Address Detection Upper Threshold.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Minor Service alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the E-LAN service stops learning new MAC addresses. As a result,
unknown unicast packets in the traffic flow may increase, and broadcast packets may increase
accordingly. In this case, the line rate may be affected.

Possible Causes
The possible causes of the FDBSIZEALM_E-LAN alarm are as follows:

l Cause 1: The value of Address Detection Upper Threshold is too small.


l Cause 2: The E-LAN service is attacked.

Procedure
l Cause 1: The value of Address Detection Upper Threshold is too low.
1. Check whether the value of Address Detection Upper Threshold is too small. For
details, see Configuring the MAC Address Learning Parameters.
2. If yes, set the parameter to a larger value based on actual situations. Check whether
the alarm is cleared. If the alarm persists, go to Cause 2.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 451


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

l Cause 2: The E-LAN service is attacked.


1. Modify the settings so that the E-LAN service discards unknown packets. For details,
see Setting the Mode for Processing an Unknown Frame of the E-LAN Service.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.104 FLOW_OVER

Description
The FLOW_OVER is an alarm indicating the received or transmitted traffic over the threshold
for some performance object

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Minor Service alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the receive or transmit direction in which traffic crosses the specified
threshold.

l 0x00: the receive direction


l 0x01: the transmit direction

Impact on the System


When the FLOW_OVER alarm occurs, the extra data may be discarded.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The traffic threshold is very low.
l Cause 2: The opposite end transmits excessive data flow.
l Cause 3: The network exists data storm.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 452


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The traffic threshold is very low.
1. Increase the traffic threshold to a value that is lower than the rate of the local threshold.

Step 2 Cause 2: The opposite end transmits excessive data flow.


1. Configure the QoS policies at the opposite end to reduce the data flow that the opposite
end transmits.

Step 3 Cause 3: the network exists data storm.


1. Check whether the network exists data storm. Release the loops if exist.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.105 HARD_BAD

Description
The HARD_BAD is an alarm indicating hardware errors.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Critical Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 to Parameter 3 Indicate the internal faults detected by the board.

Impact on the System


The alarmed board fails to work. If the board is configured with the 1+1 protection, protection
switching may be triggered.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The board and the backplane are connected improperly.
l Cause 2: A certain board is faulty.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 453


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

l Cause 3: The slot is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The board and the backplane are connected improperly.
1. Remove and insert the alarmed board. For details, see 6.1 Removing a Board and 6.2
Inserting a Board. Then, check whether the alarm is cleared.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared after the board is The fault is rectified. End the alarm
removed and inserted handling.
The alarm persists after the board is Check for the faults in boards.
removed and inserted

Step 2 Cause 2: A certain board is faulty.


1. Replace the alarmed board, and then check whether the alarm is cleared. For details, see 6
Part Replacement.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared after the board is The fault is rectified. End the alarm
replaced handling.
The alarm persists after the board is Check for the faults in slots.
replaced

Step 3 Cause 3: The slot is faulty.


1. Contact Huawei engineers to handle the faulty slot.
NOTE
Generally, the slot becomes faulty due to the broken pin or bent pin. Remove the board, and use a
torch to observe whether there is any broken pin or bent pin.
2. If a vacant slot is available, insert the board in the vacant slot and add the board again.
Then, the board can work normally.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.106 HARD_NONSUPPORT

Description
The HARD_NONSUPPORT is an alarm indicating that a certain function is not supported by
a board. A function is configured on the device and a command is issued by the system to enable
the function on a board. If the board hardware does not support this function, this alarm is
reported.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 454


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 Indicates functions that are not supported by a board.

l 0x01: ETH PWE3 control word


l 0x02: 2.5 Gbit/s bus rate

Impact on the System


The function is unavailable if this alarm is reported.

Possible Causes
Cause: The board does not support the function even though it is configured on the device.

Procedure
Step 1 Replace the board with a new one that supports the function.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.107 HP_CROSSTR

Description
The HP_CROSSTR is an alarm indicating that the higher order path error crosses the threshold.
This alarm occurs when the board detects that the performance event that the higher order path
error crosses the preset threshold.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 455


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Service alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the performance monitoring period:

l 0x01: 15 minutes
l 0x02: 24 hours
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of a performance event that causes the alarm.

l 0x30: HPBBE
l 0x31: HPES
l 0x32: HPSES
l 0x33: HPFEBBE
l 0x34: HPFEES
l 0x35: HPFESES
l 0x36: HPUAS
l 0x37: HPCSES
l 0x38: HPFECSES
l 0x4c: HPFEUAS

Impact on the System


When the HP_CROSSTR alarm occurs, a large number of errors occur in the service, and the
service may be interrupted.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The higher order path error crosses the preset threshold.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The higher order path error crosses the preset threshold.
1. Check the threshold crossing records to find out the performance event that the higher order
path error crosses the preset threshold. For details, see 4.3.5 Browsing the Performance
Event Threshold-Crossing Records.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 456


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

2. Handle the threshold-crossing performance event.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.108 HP_LOM

Description
The HP_LOM is an alarm indicating the loss of the higher order path multiframe. This alarm
occurs when the board detects that byte H4 is inconsistent with the expected multiframe
sequence.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the HP_LOM alarm occurs, the service on the alarmed path is interrupted. If the services
are configured with protection, Protection switching may be triggered.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The service level is inconsistently configured at both ends.
l Cause 2: The transmit unit of the peer NE is faulty.
l Cause 3: The receive unit of the local NE is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The service level is inconsistently configured at both ends.
1. Verify that cross-connection configurations (signal mapping) are consistent at both ends.
For example, if the VC-12 structure is configured at the local end and the VC-3 structure
is configured at the peer end, rectify the configurations.

Step 2 Cause 2: The transmit unit of the peer NE is faulty.


1. Replace the alarmed board on the local NE. Then, check whether the alarm is cleared.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared The fault is rectified. End the alarm handling.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 457


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The alarm persists Replace the system control, cross-connect, and timing board
on the peer NE.

Step 3 Cause 3: The receive unit of the local NE is faulty.


1. Replace the alarmed board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.109 HP_RDI

Description
The HP_RDI is an alarm indicating the higher order path remote receive failure. This alarm
occurs when the board detects that bit 5 of byte G1 is 1.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the HP_RDI alarm occurs, the service on the local NE is not affected. The service received
by the opposite NE, however, is interrupted.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The local NE detects the message that is returned by the opposite NE and indicates the
higher order path remote receive failure.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The local NE detects the message that is returned by the opposite NE and indicates the
higher order path remote receive failure.
1. Clear the alarms such as HP_LOM and B3_EXC that the AU-4 path reports on the opposite
NE.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 458


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Related Information
None.

A.3.110 HP_REI

Description
The HP_REI is an alarm indicating the higher order path remote error. This alarm occurs when
the board detects that bits 1-4 of G1 take a value from 1 to 8.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Warning Service alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The service on the local site is not affected. The service received by the opposite station, however,
has errors.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The local NE detects the message that is returned by the opposite NE and indicates the
higher order path remote errors.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The local NE detects the message that is returned by the opposite NE and indicates the
higher order path remote receive failure.
1. Handle the HP_BBE performance event that the AU-4 path reports on the opposite NE.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.111 HP_SLM

Description
The HP_SLM is an alarm indicating the lower order path label mismatch. This alarm occurs
when the board detects the C2 byte mismatch.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 459


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


None.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The C2 byte sent from the peer end is not 0 and differs from the C2 byte configured
to be received at the local end.
l Cause 2: Configuration data is incorrect.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The C2 byte sent from the peer end is not 0 and differs from the C2 byte configured to
be received at the local end.
1. Configure the same service type at the source and sink of the AU-4 path. For details, see
Configuring Overhead Bytes.

Step 2 Cause 2: Configuration data is incorrect.


1. If the alarmed port is the SDH port that is interconnected with the ATM/Ethernet equipment,
configure the service as VC-4 pass-through service. For details, see Creating Cross-
Connections of SNCP Services.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.112 HP_TIM

Description
The HP_TIM is an alarm indicating the higher order path trace identifier mismatch. This alarm
occurs when the board detects the J1 byte mismatch.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Communication alarm

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 460


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


If the service is configured with the protection that considers the HP_TIM alarm as a trigger
condition, the protection switching is triggered.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The receivable J1 byte on the local NE does not match with the J1 byte transmitted
on the opposite NE.
l Cause 2: Configuration data is incorrect.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The receivable J1 byte on the local NE does not match with the J1 byte transmitted on
the opposite NE.
1. Disable the receivable J1 byte on the local NE or set the receivable J1 byte on the local NE
to the same as the transmitted J1 byte on the opposite NE. For details, see Configuring
VC-4 POHs.

Step 2 Cause 2: Configuration data is incorrect.


1. If the alarmed port is the SDH port that is interconnected with the ATM/Ethernet equipment,
configure the service as VC-4 pass-through service. For details, see Creating Cross-
Connections of SNCP Services or Creating the Cross-Connections of Point-to-Point
Services.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared after the configuration The fault is rectified. End the alarm
is changed handling.
The alarm persists after the configuration Go to the next step.
is changed

2. Check whether the cross-connections are configured correctly at the intermediate nodes
where the service travels. If not, reconfigure the cross-connections. For details, see Creating
Cross-Connections of SNCP Services or Creating the Cross-Connections of Point-to-Point
Services.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.113 HP_UNEQ

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 461


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Description
The HP_UNEQ is an alarm indicating the unequipped higher order path. This alarm occurs when
the board detects that the C2 byte is 0.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the HP_UNEQ alarm occurs, the service in the alarmed AU-4 path is unavailable. If the
service is configured with the protection that considers the alarm as a trigger condition, the
protection switching is triggered.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The line port at the local NE is configured with services, but the corresponding
line port at the opposite NE is not configured with services.
l Cause 2: Byte C2 is set to 0 at the opposite NE.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The line port at the local NE is configured with services, but the corresponding line
port at the opposite NE is not configured with services.
1. Configure line services on the opposite NE. For details, see Creating Cross-Connections
of SNCP Services or Creating the Cross-Connections of Point-to-Point Services.

Step 2 Cause 2: Byte C2 is set to 0 at the opposite NE.


1. Change the setting of byte C2. For details, see Configuring VC-4 POHs.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.114 HPAD_CROSSTR

Description
The HPAD_CROSSTR is an alarm indicating that the higher order path adaptation performance
crosses the threshold. This alarm occurs when a board detects that the performance event of TU
pointer justification crosses the preset threshold.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 462


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Minor Service alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the performance monitoring period:

l 0x01: 15 minutes
l 0x02: 24 hours
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of a performance event that causes the alarm.

l 0xaa: TUPJCHIGH
l 0xab: TUPJCLOW
l 0xac: TUPJCNEW

Impact on the System


When the HPAD_CROSSTR alarm occurs, bit errors may occur in the service.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The performance event of TU pointer justification crosses the preset threshold.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The performance event of TU pointer justification crosses the preset threshold.
1. Check the threshold crossing records to find out the performance event of TU pointer
justification that crosses the preset threshold. For details, see 4.3.5 Browsing the
Performance Event Threshold-Crossing Records.
2. Handle the threshold-crossing performance event.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 463


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.115 IF_CABLE_OPEN
Description
The IF_CABLE_OPEN is an alarm indicating that the IF cable is open.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the IF_CABLE_OPEN alarm occurs, the service on the alarmed IF port is interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The IF cable is loose or faulty.
l Cause 2: The IF port on the IF board is damaged.
l Cause 3: The power module of the ODU is faulty.
NOTE
When rectifying the faults of the IF cable, IF port, and ODU, you must turn off the ODU before the
operation. You can turn on the ODU only after the operation is complete.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The IF cable is loose or faulty.
1. Check whether the connector of the IF cable is loose or whether the connector is made
properly.
The connectors to be checked include the connector between the IF fiber jumper and the
IF board, the connector between the IF fiber jumper and the IF cable, and the connector
between the IF cable and the ODU.

If... Then...
The connector is loose Connect the connector tightly.
The connector is made improperly See the Installation Reference and make new
connectors for the IF cable.
None of the above Go to the next step.
2. Check whether the surface of the IF fiber jumper and the IF cable is damaged.
If... Then...

The cable does not meet the requirement Replace the cable with a qualified one.

The cable meets the requirement Go to Cause 2 or Cause 3.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 464


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Step 2 Cause 2: The IF port on the IF board is damaged.


1. Replace the alarmed IF board.

Step 3 Cause 3: The power module of the ODU is faulty.


1. Replace the ODU connected to the alarmed IF port.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.116 IF_INPWR_ABN

Description
The IF_INPWR_ABN is an alarm indicating that the power supplied by an IF board to an ODU
is abnormal.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 l 0x01: Indicates that the input power of the ODU is too high.
l 0x02: Indicates that the input power of the ODU is too low.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the services on the ODU are interrupted. If 1+1 protection is configured,
this alarm also triggers 1+1 HSB switching.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The IF board is faulty.
l Cause 2: The IF cable is faulty.
l Cause 3: The ODU is faulty.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 465


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

l Cause 4: The IF fiber jumper and the IF board are connected incorrectly.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The IF board is faulty.
1. Replace the IF board connected to the alarmed ODU.

Step 2 Cause 2: The IF cable is faulty.


1. Check whether the connectors of the IF cable are loose or prepared incorrectly.

The connectors to be checked include the connector between the IF fiber jumper and the
IF board, the connector between the IF fiber jumper and the IF cable, and the connector
between the IF cable and the ODU.

If... Then...

Any of the connectors is loose Connect the connector tightly.

Any of the connectors is prepared See the Installation Reference and make
incorrectly new connectors for the IF cable.

All connectors are normal Go to the next step.

2. Check whether the surface of the IF fiber jumper and the IF cable is damaged or deformed,
and test the connectivity between the IF fiber jumper and the IF cable. For details, see
Testing the Connectivity of the IF Cable.

If... Then...

The IF cable is below standard Replace the IF cable.

The IF cable is up to standard The IF board or ODU may be faulty.

Step 3 Cause 3: The ODU is faulty.


1. Replace the alarmed ODU.

Step 4 Cause 4: The IF fiber jumper and the IF board are connected incorrectly.
1. Connect the IF fiber jumper and the IF board correctly.

----End

Related Information
The logical slot ID of the ODU is obtained by adding 50 to the slot ID of the IF board connected
to the ODU.

A.3.117 IF_MODE_UNSUPPORTED

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 466


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Description
The IF_MODE_UNSUPPORTED is an alarm indicating that the configured IF working mode
is not supported. This alarm occurs if the board is not loaded with the FPGA file that supports
the configured IF working mode.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the ID of the FPGA file that is loaded to the board.

l 0x01 indicates that FPGA file 250 is loaded.


l 0x02 indicates that FPGA file 002 is loaded.

Impact on the System


When the IF_MODE_UNSUPPORTED alarm occurs, the service on the alarmed IF port is
interrupted.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The board is not loaded with the FPGA file that supports the configured IF working
mode, or the FPGA file that supports the configured IF working mode is damaged.

Procedure
l Cause 1: The board is not loaded with the FPGA file that supports the configured IF working
mode, or the FPGA file that supports the configured IF working mode is damaged.
1. Contact Huawei engineers to upgrade the software and the FPGA file.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 467


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.118 IMA_GROUP_LE_DOWN

Description
The IMA_GROUP_LE_DOWN is an alarm indicating that the IMA group at the local end fails.
This alarm occurs when the IMA group is in non-Active state on the local NE or when the
activated links of the IMA group on the local NE are less than the minimum number.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, all links of the alarmed IMA group are unavailable.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The IMA links on the local NE are faulty.
l Cause 2: The activated links of the IMA group on the local NE are less than the minimum
number.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The IMA links on the local NE are faulty.
1. Check whether the T_ALOS alarm is reported at the E1 port. If yes, clear this alarm.
2. Check whether the IMA_GROUP_RE_DOWN alarm is cleared. If the alarm persists,
configure the related services at other ports or replace the related board.

Step 2 Cause 2: The activated links of the IMA group on the local NE are less than the minimum number.

If... Then...
The ALM_IMA_LIF alarm occurs Clear the ALM_IMA_LIF alarm immediately.
Activate the links of the IMA group on the local NE.
No other alarm occurs Reconfigure the links of the IMA group on the local
NE.

When the number of activated links of the IMA group reaches the minimum number, the alarm
clears automatically.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 468


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Related Information
None.

A.3.119 IMA_GROUP_RE_DOWN

Description
The IMA_GROUP_RE_DOWN is an alarm indicating that the IMA group at the remote end
fails. This alarm occurs when the IMA group is in non-Active state on the remote NE or when
the activated links of the IMA group on the remote NE are less than the minimum number.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the ports of the IMA group are congested and services have bit errors.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The IMA links on the remote NE are faulty.
l Cause 2: The activated links of the IMA group on the remote NE are less than the minimum
number.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The IMA links on the remote NE are faulty.
1. Check whether the T_ALOS alarm is reported at the E1 port. If yes, clear this alarm.
2. Check whether the IMA_GROUP_RE_DOWN alarm is cleared. If the alarm persists,
configure the related services at other ports or replace the related board.

Step 2 Cause 2: The activated links of the IMA group on the remote NE are less than the minimum
number.

If... Then...
The ALM_IMA_LIF alarm occurs Clear the ALM_IMA_LIF alarm immediately.
Activate the links of the IMA group on the opposite NE.
No other alarm occurs Reconfigure the links of the IMA group on the remote
NE.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 469


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

When the number of activated links of the IMA group reaches the minimum number, the alarm
clears automatically.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.120 IMA_TXCLK_MISMATCH

Description
The IMA_TXCLK_MISMATCH is an alarm indicating that the transmit clock modes of an IMA
group are inconsistent at the two ends.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The IMA_TXCLK_MISMATCH alarm may cause loss of ATM cells.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The transmit clock modes of an IMA group are inconsistent at the two ends.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The transmit clock modes of an IMA group are inconsistent at the two ends.
1. Check the alarm information and determine the NE, board, and ATM trunk related to the
alarm.
2. Modify the Clock Mode parameter of the alarmed ATM trunk to the same value as that of
the opposite end. Then, check whether the alarm is cleared.

----End

Related Information
The Clock Mode parameter can be set to two modes.

l CTC mode: Common transmit clock mode. In CTC mode, all transmit clocks of the links
in an IMA group are from the same clock source.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 470


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

l ITC mode: Independent transmit clock mode. In ITC mode, the transmit clocks of the links
in an IMA group are from different clock sources. When the IMA group is set to the line
clock mode, the ITC mode is recommended.

A.3.121 IN_PWR_ABN

Description
The IN_PWR_ABN is an alarm indicating that the input optical power is abnormal.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the IN_PWR_ABN alarm occurs, the service at the alarmed optical interface has errors
and even becomes unavailable.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The transmit power of the opposite NE is over high or over low.
l Cause 2: The model of the selected optical module is incorrect.
l Cause 3: The optical module at the receive end is faulty.
l Cause 4: The fiber performance degrades.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The transmit power of the opposite NE is over high or over low.
1. Browse current performance events, and query the performance event of the transmit
optical power on the opposite NE.

If... Then...
The transmit optical power does not meet Replace the optical module.
the requirement
The transmit optical power is over high Add a proper attenuator to reduce the
receive optical power.

Step 2 Cause 2: The model of the selected optical module is incorrect.


1. Query the board manufacturing information report, and check whether the models of
the SFP optical modules used at both ends are correct.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 471


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The models are incorrect Replace the optical module.
The models are correct Go to Cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: The optical module at the receive end is faulty.


1. Use the optical power meter to test the receive optical power, and check whether the receive
optical power meets the requirement. If yes, contact Huawei engineers to replace the optical
module.

Step 4 Cause 4: The fiber performance degrades.

If... Then...
The connector of the fiber jumper is dirty Clean fiber connectors.
The connector or fiber is damaged Insert the connector properly or replace the
damaged fiber jumper.

----End

Related Information
The following table describes the meanings of the parameters in the IN_PWR_ABN alarm
reported by the EMS6.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 Indicates the port number.

Parameter 2, Parameter 3 The value of Parameter 2 is always 0x00, and


the value of Parameter 3 is always 0x01. The
two parameters indicate the path ID.

Parameter 4, Parameter 5 Reserved. The values are always 0xFF.

A.3.122 IN_PWR_HIGH

Description
The IN_PWR_HIGH is an alarm indicating that the input optical power is over high.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Critical Equipment alarm

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 472


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the IN_PWR_HIGH alarm occurs, the service at the alarmed optical interface has errors.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The transmit power of the opposite NE is over high.
l Cause 2: The model of the selected optical module is incorrect.
l Cause 3: The optical module at the receive end is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The transmit power of the opposite site is over high.
1. Browse current performance events, and query the performance event of the transmit
optical power on the opposite NE.

If... Then...
The transmit optical power does not meet Contact Huawei engineers to replace the
the requirement optical module.
The transmit optical power meets the Add a proper attenuator to reduce the
requirement receive optical power.

Step 2 Cause 2: The model of the selected optical module is incorrect.


1. Query the board manufacturing information report, and check whether the models of
the SFP optical modules used at both ends are correct.

If... Then...
The models are incorrect Contact Huawei engineers to replace the optical module.
The models are correct Go to Cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: The optical module at the receive end is faulty.


1. Use the optical power meter to test the receive optical power, and check whether the receive
optical power meets the requirement. If yes, contact Huawei engineers to replace the optical
module.

----End

Related Information
The optical power threshold set for the IN_PWR_HIGH alarm is lower than the overload point.

SDH Interface Performance.

A.3.123 IN_PWR_LOW

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 473


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Description
The IN_PWR_LOW is an alarm indicating that the input optical power is over low.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Critical Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the IN_PWR_LOW alarm occurs, the service at the alarmed optical interface has errors.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The transmit power of the opposite NE is over low.
l Cause 2: The model of the selected optical module is incorrect.
l Cause 3: The optical module at the receive end is faulty.
l Cause 4: The fiber performance degrades.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The transmit power of the opposite NE is over low.
1. Browse current performance events, and query the performance event of the transmit
optical power on the opposite NE.

If... Then...
The transmit optical power does not meet Contact Huawei engineers to replace the
the requirement optical module.
The transmit optical power meets the Go to Cause 2.
requirement

Step 2 Cause 2: The model of the selected optical module is incorrect.


1. Query the board manufacturing information report, and check whether the models of
the SFP optical modules used at both ends are correct.

If... Then...
The models are incorrect Contact Huawei engineers to replace the optical module.
The models are correct Go to Cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: The optical module at the receive end is faulty.


1. Use the optical power meter to test the receive optical power, and check whether the receive
optical power meets the requirement.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 474


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The receive optical power meets the Contact Huawei engineers to replace the
requirement optical module.
The receive optical power does not meet the Go to Cause 4.
requirement

Step 4 Cause 4: The fiber performance degrades.


1. Clean fiber connectors and adapters.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared after the connector is The fault is rectified. End the alarm handling.
cleaned
The alarm persists after the connector is Replace the fiber.
cleaned

----End

Related Information
The optical power threshold set for the IN_PWR_LOW alarm is higher than the sensitivity point.

SDH Interface Performance.

A.3.124 INTEMP_SENSOR_FAIL

Description
The INTEMP_SENSOR_FAILL is an alarm indicating that the air inlet temperature sensor of
the cabinet fails.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The air inlet temperature data of the TCU cannot be collected.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The air inlet temperature sensor is faulty.
l Cause 2: The control board of the cabinet is faulty.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 475


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

l Cause 3: Cables are misconnected or damaged.


l Cause 4: The air inlet temperature sensor is not installed.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The air inlet temperature sensor is faulty.
1. Replace the air inlet temperature sensor.
2. Then, check whether the alarm clears.

If... Then...
The alarm clears End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The control board of the cabinet is faulty.


1. Replace the cabinet.
2. Then, check whether the alarm clears.

If... Then...
The alarm clears End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: Cables are misconnected or damaged.


1. Replace damaged cables.
2. Connect cables correctly.

Step 4 Cause 4: The air inlet temperature sensor is not installed.


1. Install the air inlet temperature sensor.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.125 J0_MM

Description
The J0_MM is an alarm indicating the trace identifier mismatch. This alarm occurs when the
board detects the J0 byte mismatch.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Communication alarm

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 476


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


None.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The receivable J0 byte on the local NE does not match the transmitted J0 byte on the
opposite NE.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The receivable J0 byte on the local NE does not match the transmitted J0 byte on the
opposite NE.
1. Disable the receivable J0 byte on the local NE. For details, see Configuring RSOHs.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.126 K1_K2_M

Description
The K1_K2_M is an alarm indicating the K1/K2 byte mismatch. This alarm occurs when the
board detects inconsistent channel numbers that the transmitted K1 byte (bits 5-8) and the
received K2 byte (bits 1-4) indicate.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 477


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the protection group type.
l 0x01: linear MS protection.
l 0x02: ring MS protection.
Parameter 2 Indicates the ID of the alarmed protection group. For example, 0x01 indicates
that the alarm is reported by protection group 1.

Impact on the System


When the K1_K2_M alarm occurs, the MSP protocol may fail and therefore the protection
switching may fail.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The switching modes configured at both ends are single-ended switching and dual-
ended switching separately.
l Cause 2: The fiber connection is incorrect.
l Cause 3: A certain board is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The switching modes configured at both ends are single-ended switching and dual-
ended switching separately.
1. Check whether the switching modes at both ends are the same.

If... Then...
The switching modes are different Configure the switching modes as the same.
The switching modes are the same Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The fiber connection is incorrect.


1. Check whether the fiber connection is correct. For example, the fiber at the receive or
transmit port may be incorrectly connected, or disconnected.

If... Then...
The fiber connection is incorrect Connect the fiber properly.
The connection is correct Go to Cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: A certain board is faulty.


1. Replace the opposite line board. Then, check whether the alarm is cleared.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared The fault is rectified. End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Replace the alarmed board.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 478


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Related Information
This alarm is also reported upon a packet linear MSP switching. For configuration details on
linear MSP, refer to Creating a Packet-based Linear MSP Group

A.3.127 K2_M

Description
The K2_M is an alarm indicating the K2 byte mismatch. This alarm occurs when the board
detects that the protection mode indicated by the received K2 (bit 5) is different from the
protection mode of the NE.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the protection group type.
l 0x01: linear MS protection.
l 0x02: ring MS protection.
Parameter 2 Indicates the ID of the alarmed protection group. For example, 0x01 indicates
that the alarm is reported by protection group 1.

Impact on the System


When the K2_M alarm occurs, the MSP protocol may fail and therefore the protection switching
may fail.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Two NEs of the linear MSP group are configured with different protection modes
(1+1 or 1:N).
l Cause 2: The MSP protocol is stopped when the protection switching occurs.
l Cause 3: The fiber connection is incorrect.
l Cause 4: A certain board is faulty.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 479


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Two NEs of the linear MSP group are configured with different protection modes (1
+1 or 1:N).
1. Query the status of the linear MSP, and check whether two NEs of the linear MSP group
are configured with different protection modes (1+1 or 1:N).

If... Then...
The protection modes are different Configure the protection modes as the same.
The protection modes are the same Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The MSP protocol is stopped when the protection switching occurs.
1. Query the status of the linear MSP, and check whether the MSP protocol is stopped on the
opposite NE.

If... Then...
The protocol is stopped Restart the MSP protocol on the opposite NE. For details, see
Starting/Stopping the Linear MSP Protocol.
The protocol is running Go to Cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: The fiber connection is incorrect.


1. Check whether the fiber connection is correct. For example, the fiber at the receive or
transmit port may be incorrectly connected, or disconnected.

If... Then...
The connection is incorrect Connect the fiber properly
The connection is correct Go to Cause 4.

Step 4 Cause 4: A certain board is faulty.


1. Replace the opposite line board. Then, check whether the alarm is cleared.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared The fault is rectified. End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Replace the alarmed board.

----End

Related Information
This alarm is also reported upon a packet linear MSP switching. For configuration details on
linear MSP, refer toCreating a Packet-based Linear MSP Group.

A.3.128 LAG_BWMM
Description
LAG_BWMM is an alarm indicating the bandwidth inconsistency in the LAG group.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 480


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


For a LAG group in load-sharing mode, data services may be lost.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: In the LAG group, the license capacities of the ports differ from each other.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: In the LAG group, the license capacities of the ports differ from each other.
1. Query the license capacities of the ports of the LAG group by using the NMS.
2. If the license capacities of the ports differ from each other, reload a license file of an
appropriate capacity.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.129 LAG_DOWN

Description
The LAG_DOWN is an alarm indicating that the link aggregation group (LAG) is unavailable.
This alarm occurs when the LAG does not have activated members.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 481


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Impact on the System


When the LAG_DOWN alarm occurs, the service at the member port of the LAG is interrupted.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: All the member ports of the aggregation group are invalid for the same causes as the
LAG_MEMBER_DOWN alarm.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: All the member ports of the LAG are invalid for the same causes as the
LAG_MEMBER_DOWN alarm.
1. Determine the alarmed port according to the alarm parameter.
2. Rectify the fault at each member port according to the description of
LAG_MEMBER_DOWN.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.130 LAG_MEMBER_DOWN

Description
The LAG_MEMBER_DOWN is an alarm indicating that a member port of a link aggregation
group (LAG) is unavailable. This alarm occurs when a member port of an LAG can neither be
activated nor function as a protection port.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1, Parameter 2 Indicates the slot ID of the alarmed board.
Parameter 3 Indicates the ID of the alarmed subboard. The value is always 0xff.
Parameter 4, Parameter 5 Indicates the ID of the alarmed port.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 482


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning
Parameter 6 Indicates the cause that makes the port unavailable.
l 0x01: The port link is faulty or disabled.
l 0x02: The port fails to receive the LACP packets.
l 0x03: The port works in half-duplex mode.
l 0x04: The port is self-looped.

Impact on the System


The port in the LAG cannot share the service load, and the port does not transmit or receive any
services.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The port link is faulty or disabled.
l Cause 2: The port receives no LACP packets.
l Cause 3: The port works in half-duplex mode or not in Auto-Negotiation mode.
l Cause 4: The port is self-looped.

Procedure
Step 1 Determine the alarmed port and the cause of the alarm according to the alarm parameters.

If... Then...
The value of Parameter 4 is 0x01 Perform the operations described in Step 2.
The value of Parameter 4 is 0x02 Perform the operations described in Step 3.
The value of Parameter 4 is 0x03 Perform the operations described in Step 4.
The value of Parameter 4 is 0x04 Perform the operations described in Step 5.

Step 2 Cause 1: The port link is faulty or disabled.


1. On the NMS, check whether the port in the LAG is enabled. For details, see Querying the
Protocol Information of the LAG.

If... Then...
The port is not enabled Enable the port in the LAG.
The port is enabled Go to the next step.

2. Check the link status of all ports and check whether the ETH_LOS alarm is reported.

If... Then...
The alarm is reported Clear the ETH_LOS alarm immediately and rectify the
fault of the port link.
The alarm is not reported Go to Cause 2.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 483


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Step 3 Cause 2: The port receives no LACP packets.


1. Check whether the local port and the remote port transmit the LACP packets. For details,
see Querying the Protocol Information of the LAG. If the LACP packets are not transmitted,
configure the ports at two ends to ensure that the packets can be normally transmitted.

Step 4 Cause 3: The port works in half-duplex mode or not in Auto-Negotiation mode.
1. On the NMS, check whether the port in the LAG works in half-duplex mode. For details,
see Querying the Protocol Information of the LAG. If the port works in half-duplex mode,
change the working mode of the port into full-duplex.
2. On the NMS, change the working mode of the port into full-duplex and Auto-Negotiation.

Step 5 Cause 4: The port is self-looped.


1. Check whether the port is self-looped. For details, see 8.2.1 Querying the Attributes of
an Ethernet Port. If the port is self-looped, release the selfloop. For details, see 8.4.5
Setting a Loopback for the Packet-plane Ethernet Interface Board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.131 LAG_PORT_FAIL

Description
The LAG_PORT_FAIL is an alarm indicating that a port in the LAG fails. When a port in the
LAG is unavailable, the LAG_PORT_FAIL alarm is reported.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Minor Processing alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 Indicates the number of the IP port.

Parameter 2, Parameter 3 The values are always 0x00 0x01.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 484


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning

Parameter 4 Indicates the cause of the protection failure.

l 0x01: The link of the port is faulty or fails.


l 0x02: The port is in half-duplex mode.
l 0x03: The port fails to receive the LACP packets.
l 0x04: The port detects the selfloop.
l 0x05: Other unknown reasons.

Parameter 5 The value is always 0xff.

Impact on the System


The port in the LAG cannot share the service load, and the port does not transmit or receive any
services.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The port is disabled or the link is faulty.
l Cause 2: The port is in the half-duplex mode.
l Cause 3: The port fails to receive the LCAP packets.
l Cause 4: The port detects a selfloop.
l Cause 5: other unknown reasons

Procedure
Step 1 Determine the port where the alarm occurs and the alarm cause according to the alarm parameter.

If... Then...
The value of Parameter 4 is 0x01 Go to Cause 1.
The value of Parameter 4 is 0x02 Go to Cause 2.
The value of Parameter 4 is 0x03 Go to Cause 3.
The value of Parameter 4 is 0x04 Go to Cause 4.
The value of Parameter 4 is 0x05 Go to Cause 5.

Step 2 Cause 1: The port is disabled or the link is faulty.


1. On the NMS, check whether the port in the LAG is enabled. For details, see Setting the
Basic Attributes of Ethernet Ports.

If... Then...
The port is not enabled Enable the port in the LAG group.
The port is enabled Check the link state of each port. If any link is faulty, rectify
the fault.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 485


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Step 3 Cause 2: The port is in the half-duplex mode.


1. On the NMS, check the working mode of the port in the LAG group. If the port is in half-
duplex mode, change the working mode of the port into full-duplex. For details, see Setting
the Basic Attributes of Ethernet Ports.

Step 4 Cause 3: The port fails to receive the LCAP packets.


1. On the NMS, check whether the LAG group is properly configured on the opposite end.
For details, see Querying the Protocol Information of the LAG.

If... Then...
The LAG group is not properly configured Reconfigure the LAG group.
The LAG group is properly configured Go to the next step.

2. Check whether the local port and the remote port transmit the LACP packets. If the LACP
packets are not transmitted, configure the ports at both ends to ensure that the packets can
be normally transmitted. For details, see Querying the Protocol Information of the LAG.

Step 5 Cause 4: The port detects a selfloop.


1. Release the selfloop of the port with reference to Enabling Self-Loop Detection.

Step 6 Cause 5: other unknown reasons


1. Contact Huawei engineers.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.132 LAG_VC_PORT_FAIL

Description
The LAG_VC_PORT_FAIL is an alarm indicating that a VCG port in the LAG fails. When the
VCTRUNK is unavailable, the alarm is reported.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Minor Processing alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 486


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 The value is always 0x01.

Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the number of the faulty VCG port in the LAG. Parameter
2 indicates the most significant bits and Parameter 3 indicates the
least significant bits.

Parameter 4 Indicates the cause of the protection failure.

l 0x01: The link of the port is faulty or fails.


l 0x03: The port fails to receive the LACP packets.
l 0x04: The link of the port is configured into a loop.
l 0x05: other unknown reasons.

Parameter 5 The value is always 0xff.

Impact on the System


The port in the LAG cannot share the service load, and the port does not transmit or receive any
services.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The link of the port is faulty or fails.
l Cause 2: The port fails to receive the LCAP packets.
l Cause 3: The port detects a selfloop.
l Cause 4: other unknown reasons

Procedure
Step 1 Determine the port where the alarm occurs and the alarm cause according to the alarm parameter.

If... Then...
The value of Parameter 4 is 0x01 Go to Cause 1.
The value of Parameter 4 is 0x03 Go to Cause 2.
The value of Parameter 4 is 0x04 Go to Cause 3.
The value of Parameter 4 is 0x05 Go to Cause 4.

Step 2 Cause 1: The port is disabled or the link is faulty.


1. Check the link state of each VCG port. If any link is faulty, rectify the fault.

Step 3 Cause 2: The port fails to receive the LCAP packets.


1. On the NMS, check whether the LAG group is properly configured on the opposite end.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 487


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The LAG group is not properly configured Reconfigure the LAG group.
The LAG group is properly configured Go to the next step.
2. Check whether the local port and the remote port transmit the LACP packets. If the LACP
packets are not transmitted, configure the ports at both ends to ensure that the packets can
be normally transmitted.

Step 4 Cause 3: The port detects a selfloop.


1. Release the selfloop of the port.

Step 5 Cause 4: other unknown reasons


1. Contact Huawei engineers.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.133 LAN_LOC

Description
The LAN_LOC is an alarm indicating the Ethernet communication failure.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 Indicates the network port ID. For example, 0x01 indicates network
port 1 and 0x02 indicates network port 2.

Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicates the number of the path on which the alarm is reported.

Parameter 2 indicates the most significant bits and the value is


always 0x00. Parameter 3 indicates the least significant bits and the
value is always 0x01.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 488


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Impact on the System


When the alarm is reported, the communication of the network port is interrupted. As a result,
the NE is out of control. The existing services of the NE, however, are not affected.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The cable is not connected to the network port, or the cable is faulty.
l Cause 2: The network port is faulty.
l Cause 3: The system control, switching, and timing board is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 View the alarm on the NMS. Determine the network port ID according to the alarm parameter
1.

Step 2 Cause 1: The cable is not connected to the network port, or the cable is faulty.
1. Check whether the cable of the network port is loose or no cable is connected. Properly
connect the NMS to the network port. The LINK indicator is in green.

Step 3 Cause 2: The network port is faulty.


1. Replace the faulty board. For details, see 6.10 Replacing the System Control, Switching
and Timing Board.

Step 4 Cause 3: The system control, switching, and timing board is faulty.
1. Replace the system control, switching, and timing board. For details, see 6.10 Replacing
the System Control, Switching and Timing Board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.134 LASER_CLOSED

Description
The LASER_CLOSED is an alarm indicating that the laser is shut down. This alarm occurs when
the laser is shut down by using the NMS.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 489


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Impact on the System


When the LASER_CLOSED alarm occurs, the optical interface fails to carry services.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The laser on the local NE is shut down by using the NMS.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The laser on the local NE is shut down by using the NMS.
1. Find out the cause of shutting down the laser and start up the laser as soon as possible.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.135 LASER_MOD_ERR

Description
The LASER_MOD_ERR is an alarm indicating that the type of the pluggable optical module
on the board does not match the type of the optical interface.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the LASER_MOD_ERR alarm occurs, the performance of the optical interface degrades
and serious degradation even causes service interruption.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The optical module installed at the optical interface does not match the rate of the
optical interface.
l Cause 2: The small form-factor pluggable (SFP) module does not match the interface type.
l Cause 3: The optical module is faulty.
l Cause 4: A certain board is faulty.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 490


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The optical module installed at the optical interface does not match the rate of the
optical interface.
1. Check whether the optical module installed at the optical interface matches the rate of the
optical interface. For details, see 4.8.5 Querying the Board Manufacturing Information
Report.

If... Then...
The optical module does not match the Contact Huawei engineers to replace the
rate of the optical interface optical module with one that matches the
rate of the optical interface.
The optical module matches the rate of Go to Cause 2.
the optical interface

Step 2 Cause 2: The SFP module does not match the interface type.
1. Replace the existing SFP module with a proper SFP module.

Step 3 Cause 3: The optical module is faulty.


1. Replace the faulty optical module.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared after the optical module is replaced End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists after the optical module is replaced Go to Cause 3.

Step 4 Cause 4: A certain board is faulty.


1. Replace the alarmed board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.136 LASER_MOD_ERR_EX

Description
The LASER_MOD_ERR is an alarm indicating that the type of the pluggable optical module
on the board does not match the type of the optical interface.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Equipment alarm

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 491


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the LASER_MOD_ERR_EX alarm occurs, the performance of the optical interface
degrades and serious degradation even causes service interruption.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The optical module installed at the optical interface does not match the rate of the
optical interface.
l Cause 2: The small form-factor pluggable (SFP) module does not match the interface type.
l Cause 3: The optical module is faulty.
l Cause 4: A certain board is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The optical module installed at the optical interface does not match the rate of the
optical interface.
1. Check whether the optical module installed at the optical interface matches the rate of the
optical interface. For details, see 4.8.5 Querying the Board Manufacturing Information
Report.

If... Then...
The optical module does not match the Contact Huawei engineers to replace the
rate of the optical interface optical module with one that matches the
rate of the optical interface.
The optical module matches the rate of Go to Cause 2.
the optical interface

Step 2 Cause 2: The SFP module does not match the interface type.
1. Replace the existing SFP module with a proper SFP module.

If.. Then...
The port type is incorrectly set See Configuring an SFP Port.to rectify the port type
setting
The SFP type is incorrect Replace it with an SFP module of the correct type.

Step 3 Cause 3: The optical module is faulty.


1. Replace the faulty optical module.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared after the optical module is replaced End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists after the optical module is replaced Go to Cause 3.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 492


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Step 4 Cause 4: A certain board is faulty.


1. Replace the alarmed board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.137 LASER_SHUT

Description
The LASER_SHUT is an alarm indicating that the laser is shut down. This alarm occurs when
the laser is shut down by using the NMS.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the laser_shut alarm occurs, the optical interface fails to carry services.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The laser on the local NE is shut down by using the NMS.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The laser on the local NE is shut down by using the NMS.
1. Find out the cause of shutting down the laser and start up the laser as soon as possible.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.138 LCAS_FOPR

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 493


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Description
The LCAS_FOPR is an alarm indicating that the LCAS protocol in the receive direction fails.
This alarm occurs if the receive unit of the LCAS module of a board detects an abnormal state
in which the LCAS might fail to negotiate or cannot negotiate correctly.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Processing alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 The value is always 0x01.

Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of the alarmed VCTRUNK. For example, 0x00 0x01
indicate that the alarm is reported in VCTRUNK 1.

Impact on the System


The Ethernet service is not normal.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Configuration data of the LCAS protocol is incorrect.
l Cause 2: The link is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Configuration data of the LCAS protocol is incorrect.
1. Check whether the LCAS enabling state and the LCAS parameters are the same at both
ends of the link.

If... Then...
The settings of the LCAS protocols are Properly enable the LCAS protocols at both
not consistent ends.
The settings of the LCAS protocols at Go to Cause 2.
both ends are consistent
2. Check whether configurations of the local and opposite NEs are correct. For example, check
whether a VCG on one NE is connected to multiple VCGs on the opposite NE.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 494


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The configurations of the local and opposite NEs are Correct the configuration data.
incorrect
The configurations of the local and opposite NEs are Go to Cause 2.
correct

Step 2 Cause 2: The link is faulty.


1. Check whether the link where the service travels has errors or becomes faulty.

If... Then...
The link is faulty Rectify the fault.
The link is normal Go to the next step.

2. Restart the LCAS protocols at both ends. Then, check whether the alarm clears.

If... Then...
The alarm clears End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Replace the alarmed board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.139 LCAS_FOPT

Description
The LCAS_FOPT is an alarm indicating that the LCAS protocol in the transmit direction fails.
This alarm occurs if the transmit unit of the LCAS module of a board detects an abnormal state
in which the LCAS might fail to negotiate or cannot negotiate correctly.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Processing alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 495


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 The value is always 0x01.

Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of the alarmed VCTRUNK. For example, 0x00 0x01
indicate that the alarm is reported in VCTRUNK 1.

Impact on the System


The Ethernet service is not normal.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Configuration data of the LCAS protocol is incorrect.
l Cause 2: The link is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Configuration data of the LCAS protocol is incorrect.
1. Check whether the LCAS enabling state and the LCAS parameters are the same at both
ends of the link.

If... Then...
The settings of the LCAS protocols are Properly enable the LCAS protocols at both
not consistent ends.
The settings of the LCAS protocol at both Go to Cause 2.
ends are consistent

2. Check whether configurations of the local and opposite NEs are correct. For example, check
whether a VCG on one NE is connected to multiple VCGs on the opposite NE.

If... Then...
The configurations of the local and opposite NEs are Correct the configuration data.
incorrect
The configurations of the local and opposite NEs are Go to Cause 2.
correct

Step 2 Cause 2: The link is faulty.


1. Check whether the link where the service travels has errors or becomes faulty.

If... Then...
The link is faulty Rectify the fault.
The link is normal Go to the next step.

2. Restart the LCAS protocols at both ends. Then, check whether the alarm clears.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 496


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The alarm clears End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Replace the alarmed board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.140 LCAS_PLCR

Description
The LCAS_PLCR is an alarm indicating that a part of the LCAS bandwidth in the receive
direction is lost. This alarm occurs when a board detects that the number of paths that carry the
overloads in the receive direction of the VCTRUNK with the LCAS function enabled is less
than the preset number but is not zero.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Service alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 The value is always 0x01.

Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of the alarmed VCTRUNK. For example, 0x00 0x01
indicate that the alarm is reported in VCTRUNK 1.

Impact on the System


The available Ethernet service bandwidth is smaller than the configured bandwidth.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The number of paths or timeslots that are configured for the VCTRUNK at the
remote site is different from that at the local site.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 497


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

l Cause 2: Some paths in the transmit direction of the remote site are faulty.
l Cause 3: Some paths in the receive direction of the local site are faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The number of paths or timeslots that are configured for the VCTRUNK at the remote
site is different from that at the local site.
1. Check whether the VCTRUNKs at the transmit and the receive directions at the local site
are configured with the same number of physical paths and timeslots.

If... Then...
The sink and source VCTRUNKs are Correct the configuration data. For details,
bound with different number of physical see Dynamically Increasing/Decreasing the
paths or bound with different timeslots VCTRUNK Bandwidth.
If yes Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: Some paths in the transmit direction of the remote site are faulty.
1. Check whether any path alarm exists in the transmit direction of the remote site.

If... Then...
Any of the preceding alarms occurs Clear the alarm immediately.
No alarm occurs Go to Cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: Some paths in the receive direction of the local site are faulty.
1. Replace the alarmed board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.141 LCAS_PLCT

Description
The LCAS_PLCT is an alarm indicating that part of the LCAS bandwidth in the transmit
direction is lost. This alarm occurs when a board detects that the number of paths that carry the
overloads in the transmit direction of the VCTRUNK with the LCAS function enabled is less
than the preset number but is not zero.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Minor Service alarm

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 498


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 The value is always 0x01.

Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of the alarmed VCTRUNK. For example, 0x00 0x01
indicate that the alarm is reported in VCTRUN 1.

Impact on the System


The available transmit bandwidth of Ethernet services is less than the preset bandwidth. When
the transmitted services are more than the available transmit bandwidth, packet loss occurs.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The number of paths or timeslots that are configured for the VCTRUNK at the
remote site is different from that at the local site.
l Cause 2: Some paths in the receive direction of the remote site are faulty.
l Cause 3: Some paths in the transmit direction of the local site are faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The number of paths or timeslots that are configured for the VCTRUNK at the remote
site is different from that at the local site.
1. Check whether the sink and source VCTRUNKs are bound with the same number of
physical paths or the same timeslots.

If... Then...
The sink and source VCTRUNKs are Correct the configuration data. For details,
bound with different number of physical see Dynamically Increasing/Decreasing the
paths or different timeslots VCTRUNK Bandwidth.
The sink and source VCTRUNKs are Go to Cause 2.
bound with the same number of physical
paths or the same timeslots

Step 2 Cause 2: Some paths in the receive direction of the remote site are faulty.
1. Check whether any path alarm exists in the receive direction of the remote site.

If... Then...
Any of the preceding alarms occurs Clear the alarm immediately.
No alarm occurs Go to the next step.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 499


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Step 3 Cause 3: Some paths in the transmit direction of the local site are faulty.
1. Replace the alarmed board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.142 LCAS_TLCR

Description
The LCAS_TLCR is an alarm indicating that all the LCAS bandwidth in the receive direction
is lost. This alarm occurs when no path in the receive direction of the VCTRUNK with LCAS
enabled carries the overload but paths are configured to carry the overload.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Service alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 The value is always 0x01.

Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicates the ID of the alarmed VCTRUNK. For example, 0x00
0x01 indicate that the alarm is reported in VCTRUN 1.

Impact on the System


There is no available bandwidth in the receive direction, and the Ethernet services are interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: No VCTRUNK is bound to the remote port.
l Cause 2: Paths in the transmit direction of the remote site are faulty.
l Cause 3: Paths in the receive direction of the local site are faulty.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 500


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: No VCTRUNK is bound to the remote port.
1. Check whether VCTRUNKs have been added in the receive direction at the local end and
in the transmit direction at the remote end.

If... Then...
VCTRUNKs has been added, Correct the configuration data. For details, see
Configuring VCTRUNKs on an Ethernet Board.
No VCTRUNK has been added, Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: Paths in the transmit direction of the remote site are faulty.
1. Check whether any path alarm exists in the transmit direction of the remote site.

If... Then...
Any of the preceding alarms occurs Clear the alarm immediately.
No alarm occurs Go to Cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: Paths in the receive direction of the local site are faulty.
1. Replace the alarmed board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.143 LCAS_TLCT

Description
The LCAS_TLCT is an alarm indicating that all the LCAS bandwidth in the transmit direction
is lost. This alarm occurs when no path in the transmit direction of the VCTRUNK with LCAS
enabled carries the overload but paths are configured to carry the overload.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Service alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 501


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 The value is always 0x01.

Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of the alarmed VCTRUNK. For example, 0x00 0x01
indicate that the alarm is reported in VCTRUNK 1.

Impact on the System


There is no available bandwidth in the transmit direction, and the Ethernet services are
interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: No VCTRUNK is bound to the remote port.
l Cause 2: Paths in the receive direction of the remote site are faulty.
l Cause 3: Paths in the transmit direction of the local site are faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: No VCTRUNK is bound to the remote port.
1. Check whether VCTRUNKs have been added in the receive direction at the local end and
in the transmit direction at the remote end.

If... Then...
VCTRUNKs has been added, Correct the configuration data. For details, see
Configuring VCTRUNKs on an Ethernet Board.
No VCTRUNK has been added, Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: Paths in the receive direction of the remote site are faulty.
1. Check whether any path alarm exists in the receive direction of the remote site.

If... Then...
Any of the preceding alarms occurs Clear the alarm immediately.
No alarm occurs Go to the next step.

Step 3 Cause 3: Paths in the transmit direction of the local site are faulty.
1. Replace the alarmed board.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 502


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.144 LCD

Description
The LCD is an alarm indicating loss of cell delimitation. This alarm occurs when the OCD alarm
continuously occurs within the transmission period of N cells. The letter "N" indicates the LCD
alarm threshold value. For different ports, the threshold value is different.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


l When the LCD alarm occurs, all the services in the receive direction of the port are
interrupted and all the connections at the port insert segment or end AIS cells to the
downstream.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The path connected to the ATM port receives signals in an incorrect manner. For
example, the MS_AIS, AU_AIS or AU_LOP alarm occurs.
l Cause 2: A great number of bit errors occur in the receive path. The receive path reports
alarms indicating excessive bit errors, such as B1_EXC, B2_EXC, and B3_EXC.
l Cause 3: The ATM processing chip of the board is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The path connected to the ATM port receives signals in an incorrect manner. For
example, the MS_AIS, AU_AIS or AU_LOP alarm occurs.
1. Check whether the MS_AIS, AU_AIS, or AU_LOP alarm occurs in the path connected
to the ATM port.
2. If yes, clear these alarms first, and then check whether the LCD alarm is cleared.

Step 2 Cause 2: A great number of bit errors occur in the receive path. The receive path reports alarms
indicating excessive bit errors, such as B1_EXC, B2_EXC, and B3_EXC.
1. Check whether the B1_EXC, B2_EXC, or B3_EXC alarm occurs in the receive path.
2. If yes, clear these alarms first, and then check whether the LCD alarm is cleared.

Step 3 Cause 3: The ATM processing chip of the board is faulty.


1. Perform a cold reset on the board that reports the LCD alarm. For details, see 8.6.1 Cold
Reset.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 503


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

2. If the LCD alarm persists, replace the alarmed board. For details, see 6.6 Replacing the
Smart E1 Interface Board.

----End

Related Information
End and segment

The end point, used to monitor the entire virtual connection, is set at the end of the chain network.

The segment point is used to monitor a segment of the entire link.

Thresholds of generating the LCD alarm at different ports

l For the external ATM port, the threshold of generating the LCD alarm is seven cells.
l For a VC-4 VCTRUNK port, the threshold of generating the LCD alarm is 360 cells.
l For a VC-12 VCTRUNK port, the threshold of generating the ALM_IMA_LINK_LCD
alarm in the bound E1 link is 104 cells. If only one E1 link is bound with the VCTRUNK,
the LCD alarm is reported when the ALM_IMA_LINK_LCD alarm occurs. If the
VCTRUNK is bound with multiple E1 links in the IMA group, and if the number of E1
links in which the ALM_IMA_LINK_LCD alarm occurs is greater than the value derived
from the total number of bound E1 links subtracted by the minimum number of activated
links in the receive direction of the IMA group, the LCD alarm is reported at the VCTRUNK
port. Otherwise, the LCD alarm is not reported.

A.3.145 LCS_LIMITED

Description
The LCS_LIMITED alarm indicates that the configuration capacity of an NE exceeds the
capacity authorized by the license file.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 504


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the alarm cause.

l 0x01: The service capacity exceeds the capacity authorized by the license file.
l 0x02: The AM license file is not loaded.
l 0x03: For IF protection, the bandwidth at the standby port authorized by the
license file is lower than the bandwidth at the main port authorized by the
license file.
l 0x04: The 1588v2 capacity exceeds the capacity authorized by the license
file.
l 0x05: The ATM/IMA capacity exceeds the capacity authorized by the license
file.
l 0x06: The air port LAG capacity exceeds the capacity authorized by the
license file.
l 0x07: The E1 priority capacity exceeds the capacity authorized by the license
file.
l 0x08: The synchronous Ethernet capacity exceeds the capacity authorized by
the license file.
l 0x09: The air port compression capacity exceeds the capacity authorized by
the license file
l 0x0a: The MPLS service license capacity exceeds the capacity authorized by
the license file.
l 0x0b: The PLA license capacity exceeds the capacity authorized by the
license file.
l 0x0c: The total service bandwidth (TDM service bandwidth and data service
bandwidth) exceeds the bandwidth allowed by the Ethernet license file for
the working and protection links.
l 0x0d: The GE port capacity exceeds the capacity authorized by the license
file.
l 0x0e: No XPIC license is available.
l 0x0f: No ERPS license is available.
l 0x10: The number of configured VC-12 cross connections exceeds the
number authorized by the license file.
l 0x11: The number of ports configured high modulation exceeds the number
authorized by the license file.
l 0x12: No microwave 1+1 protection license is available.
l 0x13: No enhanced QoS license is available.
l 0x14: The capacity configured for the COMBO port exceeds the licensed
capacity.
l 0x15: No second-IF-port license is available.
l 0x16: No MPLS-TP OAM license is available.
l 0x17: No WRED license is available.
l 0x18: No AMAC license is available.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 505


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning
l 0x1a: No HQoS license is available.
l 0x1b: No L2DCN license is available.
l 0x1c: No ITU-T Y.1731 license is available.
l 0x1d: No LLDP license is available.
l 0x20: No IS3 mode license is available.

Impact on the System


When the LCS_LIMITED alarm occurs, the change of radio service capacity cannot take effect
on the NE.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The configured capacity exceeds the licensed capacity.
l Cause 2: The configured function is unlicensed.

Procedure
Step 1 Determine the alarm cause according to alarm data on the NMS.

Step 2 Query the capacity of the license on the NMS.

Step 3 Cause 1: The configured capacity exceeds the licensed capacity.


1. Check whether the capacity suggested in the alarm data is required.
2. If yes, purchase and load the license with the desired capacity.
3. If not, rectify the capacity configuration.

Step 4 Cause 2: The configured function is unlicensed.


1. Check whether the configured function is required.
2. If yes, purchase and load the desired license.
3. If not, do not enable the function.

----End

Related Information
For TDM services, radio service capacities of NEs are calculated based on the service cross-
connections on IF boards.

A.3.146 LFA

Description
The LFA is an alarm indicating that the E1 frame alignment at the local end of the inverse
multiplexing for ATM (IMA) link in the receive direction is lost.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 506


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the ID of the optical interface. The value is always 0x01.
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicates the path ID.

Impact on the System


l When this alarm occurs, the alarmed E1 link is unavailable, and the available links in the
IMA group are reduced.
l If the VCTRUNK link binds only one member, the service is interrupted when the LFA
alarm occurs.
l After this alarm clears, the E1 link in the IMA group will be recovered automatically.

Possible Causes
The possible causes of the LFA alarm are as follows:

l Cause 1: The demultiplexing module of the E1 frame cannot perform the frame alignment
function, and therefore the frame alignment loss alarms are reported. These alarms include
TU_LOP, TU_AIS, and alarm indicating that the cross-connection is not configured.
l Cause 2: The alarmed board is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Check for the TU_LOP and TU_AIS alarms on the NMS. If these alarms occur, handle
these alarms first.

Step 2 Cause 2: The alarmed board is faulty.


1. Check whether the HARD_BAD alarm occurs on the board.
2. If the alarm occurs, perform a cold reset on the board that reports the hardware failure
alarm, and check whether the alarm clears.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 507


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

NOTICE
If the service on the board is not protected, a cold reset on the board causes service
interruptions.

3. If the alarm persists, replace the board. For details, see 6.7 Replacing the Ethernet
Interface Board or 6.6 Replacing the Smart E1 Interface Board.

----End

Related Information
Basic frame

As defined in ITU-T G.704, a basic frame is an even frame with frame alignment sequence (FAS)
or an odd frame with non frame alignment sequence (NFAS).

A.3.147 LICENSE_LOST

Description
The LICENSE_LOST is an alarm indicating that the NE fails to detect the license file.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Equipment alarm

Parameters

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the type of the license file.

l 0x01: AM license
l 0x02: Hybrid license
l 0x03: TDM license
l 0x04: 1588V2 license
l 0x05: ATM/IMA license
l 0x06: NE license

Impact on the System


When the LICENSE_LOST alarm occurs, the functions authorized by the license file cannot
take effect.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 508


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Possible Causes
The license file is lost or is not loaded.

Procedure
Step 1 Contact Huawei engineers to reload the license file to the NE.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.148 LINK_ERR

Description
The LINK_ERR alarm indicates that a data link is faulty.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Critical Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the ID of the optical port. For example, 0x01 indicates
that the alarm is reported by optical port 1.
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of the path that reports the alarm. For example, 0x00
0x01 indicate that the alarm is reported by path 1.

Impact on the System


Services in the alarmed path are interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The optical fiber connected to the Ethernet optical port is faulty.
l Cause 2: The working modes of the ports at the local and opposite ends are different.
l Cause 3: The equipment at the local or opposite end is faulty.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 509


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The optical fiber connected to the Ethernet optical port is faulty.
1. Check whether the optical fiber connected to the Ethernet optical port is faulty.

If... Then...
The optical fiber is faulty Replace the fiber.
The optical fiber is not faulty Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The working modes of the ports at the local and opposite ends are different.
1. Check whether the working modes of the ports at the local and opposite ends are different.

If... Then...
The working modes of the ports at the Set the working modes of the ports to the
local and opposite ends are different same.
The working modes of the ports at the Go to the next step.
local and opposite ends are the same

Step 3 Cause 3: The equipment at the local or opposite end is faulty.


1. Use an optical fiber to perform a loopback at the the alarmed port. For details, see 8.5
Hardware Loopback.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared Replace the Ethernet board at the opposite end.
The alarm persists Replace the Ethernet board at the local end.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.149 LMFA
Description
The LMFA is an alarm indicating the E1 multiframe alignment is lost when the E1 frame is a
CRC-4 multiframe.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 510


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details


about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the ID of the optical interface. The value is always 0x01.
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicates the path ID.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the alarmed E1 links become unavailable. As a result, fewer links of
the IMA group are available. If the IMA group is comprised of only one link, services will be
interrupted.

Possible Causes
The possible cause of the LMFA alarm is as follows:
l Cause 1: The alarmed board is faulty.
l Cause 2: The frame format is incorrect.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The alarmed board is faulty.
1. Check whether the HARD_BAD alarm occurs on the board.
2. If the alarm occurs, perform a cold reset on the board that reports the hardware failure
alarm, and check whether the alarm clears.

NOTICE
If the service on the board is not protected, a cold reset on the board causes service
interruptions.

3. If the alarm persists, replace the board.


Step 2 Cause 2: The frame format is incorrect.
1. Check the frame format of the opposite port. For details, see Setting Advanced Attributes
of Smart E1 Ports.
2. Set the frame format to CRC-4 Multiframe if it is incorrect.

----End

Related Information
Basic frame
As defined in ITU-T G.704, a basic frame is an even frame with frame alignment sequence (FAS)
or an odd frame with non frame alignment sequence (NFAS).
Multiframe

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 511


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A multiframe is composed of sixteen PCM frames, and can implement cyclic redundancy check
(CRC).

A.3.150 LOOP_ALM

Description
The LOOP_ALM is an alarm indicating that a loop occurs.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 512


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the type of loopback.

l 0x00: optical/electrical port inloop


l 0x01: optical/electrical port outloop
l 0x02: path inloop
l 0x03: path outloop
l 0x04: loopback on the user side
l 0x05: loopback on the multiplexing side
l 0x08: ATM layer inloop
l 0x09: ATM layer outloop
l 0x0A: PHY layer inloop
l 0x0B: PHY layer outloop
l 0x0C: MAC layer inloop
l 0x0D: MAC layer outloop
l 0x0E: VC-4 timeslot inloop
l 0x0F: VC-4 timeslot outloop
l 0x10: VC-3 timeslot inloop
l 0x11: VC-3 timeslot outloop
l 0x12: VC-12 timeslot inloop
l 0x13: VC-12 timeslot outloop
l 0x14: IF outloop
l 0x15: IF inloop
l 0x16: RF inloop
l 0xFF: any of the preceding loopback modes

Impact on the System


When the LOOP_ALM alarm occurs, the looped port or path cannot carry services.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: A loop is performed on the local NE.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: A loop is performed on the local NE.
1. Determine the type of loopback according to the alarm parameter.
2. Find out the cause of the loopback, and set the loopback status of the alarmed port to Non-
Loopback.
For details, see 8.4 Software Loopback.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 513


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Related Information
This table provides parameters and their meanings for LOOP_ALM alarms reported by ports 1
to 7 on an EMS6 board.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 Indicates the optical port ID. The parameter


takes a fixed value of 0x01.

Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the path ID (the value 1 indicates that


the optical port is looped back).

Parameter 4 Indicates loopback types.


l 0x00: inloops at optical/electrical ports
l 0x01: outloops at optical/electrical ports
l 0x02: inloops at paths
l 0x03: outloops at paths
l 0x04: loopbacks on the client side
l 0x05: loopbacks on the combination wave
side
l 0x08: inloops at the ATM layer
l 0x09: outloops at the ATM layer
l 0x0A: inloops at the PHY layer
l 0x0B: outloops at the PHY layer
l 0x0C: inloops at the MAC layer
l 0x0D: outloops at the MAC layer
l 0x0E: inloops at VC-4 timeslots
l 0x0F: outloops at VC-4 timeslots
l 0x10: inloops at VC-3 timeslots
l 0x11: outloops at VC-3 timeslots
l 0x12: inloops at VC-12 timeslots
l 0x13: outloops at VC-12 timeslots
l 0x14: outloops at IF ports
l 0x15: inloops at IF ports
l 0x16: inloops at RF ports
l 0xFF: any of the preceding loopback
modes

This table provides parameters and their meanings for LOOP_ALM alarms reported by ports
VC-3 channels on an EMS6 board.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 514


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 Indicates the optical port ID. The parameter


takes a fixed value of 0x01.

Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicates the VC-3 channel ID.

A.3.151 LP_CROSSTR

Description
The LP_CROSSTR is an alarm indicating that the lower order path error crosses the threshold.
This alarm occurs when the board detects that the performance event that the lower order path
error crosses the preset threshold.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Service alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the performance monitoring period:

l 0x01: 15 minutes
l 0x02: 24 hours

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 515


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of a performance event that causes the alarm.

l 0x90: LPBBE
l 0x91: LPES
l 0x92: LPSES
l 0x93: LPFEBBE
l 0x94: LPFEES
l 0x95: LPFESES
l 0x96: LPUAS
l 0x8e: LPFEUAS
l 0x97: LPCSES
l 0x98: LPFECSES

Impact on the System


When the LP_CROSSTR alarm occurs, a large number of errors occur in the service, and the
service may even be interrupted.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The lower order path error crosses the preset threshold.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The lower order path error crosses the preset threshold.
1. Check the threshold crossing records to find out the performance event that the lower order
path error crosses the preset threshold.
2. Handle the threshold-crossing performance event.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.152 LP_R_FIFO

Description
The LP_R_FIFO is an alarm indicating that the FIFO overflows on the receive side of the lower
order path.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 516


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Minor Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the LP_R_FIFO alarm occurs, the service has errors.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The clock of the local NE is not synchronized with the clock of the opposite NE.
l Cause 2: A certain board is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The clock of the local NE is not synchronized with the clock of the opposite NE.
1. Browse current performance events, and check whether the performance event of TU
pointer justification occurs on the local NE and the opposite NE.

If... Then...
The TU pointer justification occurs Handle the performance event. For details,
see B.3.33 TUPJCHIGH, TUPJCLOW,
and TUPJCNEW.
The TU pointer justification does not Go to Cause 2.
occur

Step 2 Cause 2: A certain board is faulty.


1. Replace the alarmed board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.153 LP_RDI

Description
The LP_RDI is an alarm indicating the lower order path remote receive failure. This alarm occurs
when the board detects that bit 8 of byte V5 is 1.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 517


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the LP_RDI alarm occurs, the service on the local NE is not affected. The service received
by the opposite NE, however, is interrupted.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The local NE detects the message that is returned by the opposite NE and indicates the
lower order path remote receive failure.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The local NE detects the message that is returned by the opposite NE and indicates the
lower order path remote receive failure.
1. Handle the lower order path alarm on the opposite NE.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.154 LP_RDI_VC12

Description
The LP_RDI_VC12 is an alarm indicating that data reception fails at the remote end of VC-12
lower order path. This alarm occurs when the board detects that bit 8 of byte V5 is 1.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 518


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details


about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the ID of the optical interface. The value is always 0x01.
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of the VC-12 path.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the service on the local NE is not affected. The service received by the
opposite NE, however, is interrupted.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The local site receives a message from the remote site, and the message says that data
reception fails at the remote end of a lower order path.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The local site receives a message from the remote site, and the message says that data
reception fails at the remote end of a lower order path.
1. Handle the alarm of the lower order path on the remote site.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.155 LP_RDI_VC3

Description
The LP_RDI_VC3 alarm indicates that data reception at the remote end of a lower order (VC-3)
path fails. A board reports this alarm when detecting that bit 5 in byte G1 is 1.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 519


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Has a fixed value of 0x01.
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of the VC-3 path that reports the alarm. For example,
0x00 0x01 indicate that the alarm is reported in VC-3 path 1.

Impact on the System


When the LP_RDI_VC3 alarm occurs, the services at the local site are not affected, but the
opposite site cannot receive services.

Possible Causes
The local site receives a message from the opposite site, and the message says that data reception
fails at the remote end of a lower order (VC-3) path.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause: The local site receives a message from the opposite site, and the message says that data
reception fails at the remote end of a lower order (VC-3) path.
1. Handle the alarm in the lower order (VC-3) path at the opposite site.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.156 LP_REI

Description
The LP_REI is an alarm indicating the lower order path remote error. This alarm occurs when
the board detects that bit 3 of V5 is 1.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Service alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the LP_REI alarm occurs, the service on the local NE is not affected. The service received
by the opposite NE, however, has errors.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 520


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The local NE detects the message that is returned by the opposite NE and indicates the
lower order path remote errors.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The local NE detects the message that is returned by the opposite NE and indicates the
lower order path remote errors.
1. Handle the LP_BBE performance event on the opposite NE.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.157 LP_REI_VC12

Description
The LP_REI_VC12 is an alarm indicating that there are bit errors at the remote end of a VC-12
lower order path. This alarm occurs when the board detects that bit 3 of byte V5 is 1.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Service alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the ID of the optical interface. The value is always 0x01.
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of the VC-12 path.

Impact on the System


Bit errors exist in the service in the receive direction of the remote site.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The local site receives a message from the remote site, and the message says that there
are bit errors in the lower order path.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 521


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The local site receives a message from the remote site, and the message says that there
are bit errors in the lower order path.
1. Handle the LPBBE performance event of the remote site.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.158 LP_REI_VC3

Description
The LP_REI_VC3 alarm indicates that there are bit errors at the remote end of a lower order
(VC-3) path. A board reports this alarm when detecting that any one of bits 1 to 4 in byte G1 is
1.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Has a fixed value of 0x01.
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of the VC-3 path that reports the alarm. For example,
0x00 0x01 indicate that the alarm is reported in VC-3 path 1.

Impact on the System


Bit errors exist in received services at the opposite site.

Possible Causes
The local site receives a message from the opposite site, and the message says that there are bit
errors at the remote end of a lower order (VC-3) path.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 522


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Procedure
Step 1 Cause: The local site receives a message from the opposite site, and the message says that there
are bit errors at the remote end of a lower order (VC-3) path.
1. Handle the alarm in the lower order (VC-3) path at the opposite site.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.159 LP_RFI

Description
The LP_RFI is an alarm indicating the lower order path remote failure. This alarm occurs when
the board detects that bit 4 of V5 is 1.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the LP_RFI alarm occurs, the service on the local NE is not affected. The alarm only
indicates that the lower order paths on the opposite NE cannot carry services.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The local NE detects the message that is returned by the opposite NE and indicates the
lower order path remote failure.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The local NE detects the message that is returned by the opposite NE and indicates the
lower order path remote failure.
1. Handle the lower order path alarm on the opposite NE.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 523


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.160 LP_SLM

Description
The LP_SLM is an alarm indicating that a mismatched signal label is detected in the lower order
path. This alarm is reported when the board detects a signal label mismatch between the V5
bytes.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The services in the lower order path are unavailable.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The signal label contained in the V5 byte that is received by the local site does not
match with the signal label contained in the V5 byte that is transmitted by the remote site.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The signal label contained in the V5 byte that is received by the local site does not
match with the signal label contained in the V5 byte that is transmitted by the remote site.
1. Modify the signal label contained in the V5 byte that is to be received by the local site or
is to be transmitted by the remote site. Ensure that the signal labels at both ends match with
each other. For details, see Configuring VC-12 POHs.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.161 LP_SLM_VC12

Description
The LP_SLM_VC12 is an alarm indicating that a mismatched signal label is detected in the
lower order path. This alarm is reported when the board detects a signal label mismatch between
the V5 bytes.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 524


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the ID of the optical interface. The value is always 0x01.
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of the VC-12 path.

Impact on the System


The service in this lower order path is unavailable.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The signal label contained in the V5 byte that is received by the local site does not
match with the signal label contained in the V5 byte that is transmitted by the remote site.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The signal label contained in the V5 byte that is received by the local site does not
match with the signal label contained in the V5 byte that is transmitted by the remote site.
1. Modify the signal label contained in the V5 byte that is to be received by the local site or
is to be transmitted by the remote site. Ensure that the signal labels at both ends match with
each other. For details, see Configuring VC-12 POHs.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.162 LP_SLM_VC3

Description
The LP_SLM_VC3 alarm indicates that a mismatched signal label is detected in a lower order
(VC-3) path. A board reports this alarm when detecting a mismatched signal label in byte C2.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 525


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Has a fixed value of 0x01.
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of the VC-3 path that reports the alarm. For example,
0x00 0x01 indicate that the alarm is reported in VC-3 path 1.

Impact on the System


The services in the lower order (VC-3) path are unavailable.

Possible Causes
The signal label in byte C2 that is received at the local site does not match with the signal label
in byte C2 that is transmitted at the opposite site.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The signal label in byte C2 that is received at the local site does not match with the
signal label in byte C2 that is transmitted at the opposite site.
1. Reset the signal label in byte C2 that is received at the local site or the signal label in byte
C2 that is transmitted at the local site. Ensure that the signal labels are the same at both
sites. For details, see Configuring VC-4 POHs.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.163 LP_T_FIFO

Description
The LP_T_FIFO is an alarm indicating that the FIFO overflows on the transmit side of the lower
order path.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 526


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Minor Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


Bit errors occur in the services.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The frequency offset of the input signal is very large.
l Cause 2: A certain board is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The frequency offset of the input signal is very large.
1. Use an SDH analyzer to check whether the frequency offset of the input signal is within
50 ppm.

If... Then...
The frequency offset is very large Troubleshoot the remote site.
The frequency offset is within 50 ppm Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: A certain board is faulty.


1. Replace the alarmed board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.164 LP_TIM

Description
The LP_TIM is an alarm indicating a mismatched trace identifier is detected in the lower order
path. This alarm is reported when the board detects a mismatch between the J2 bytes at both
ends.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 527


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


None.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The J2 byte to be received by the local site does not match with the J2 byte to be
transmitted by the remote site.
l Cause 2: The data configuration at the intermediate nodes is incorrect.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The J2 byte to be received by the local site does not match with the J2 byte to be
transmitted by the remote site.
1. Set the byte mode of the J2 byte to be received by the local site to the disable mode.
Alternatively, set the J2 byte to be received by the local site to match with the J2 byte to
be transmitted by the remote site. For details, see Configuring VC-12 POHs.

Step 2 Cause 2: The data configuration at the intermediate nodes is incorrect.


1. Check whether the cross-connections of the intermediate nodes where the service travels
are configured correctly. If not, reconfigure the cross-connections. For details, see Querying
TDM Services.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.165 LP_TIM_VC12

Description
The LP_TIM_VC12 is an alarm indicating a mismatched trace identifier is detected in the lower
order path. This alarm is reported when the board detects a mismatch between the J2 bytes at
both ends.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 528


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the ID of the optical interface. The value is always 0x01.
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of the VC-12 path.

Impact on the System


None.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The J2 byte to be received by the local site does not match with the J2 byte to be
transmitted by the remote site.
l Cause 2: The data configuration at the intermediate nodes is incorrect.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The J2 byte to be received by the local site does not match with the J2 byte to be
transmitted by the remote site.
1. Set the byte mode of the J2 byte to be received by the local site to the disable mode.
Alternatively, set the J2 byte to be received by the local site to match with the J2 byte to
be transmitted by the remote site. For details, see Configuring VC-12 POHs.

Step 2 Cause 2: The data configuration at the intermediate nodes is incorrect.


1. Check whether the cross-connections of the intermediate nodes where the service travels
are configured correctly. If not, reconfigure the cross-connections. For details, see Querying
TDM Services.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.166 LP_TIM_VC3

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 529


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Description
The LP_TIM_VC3 alarm indicates that a mismatched trace identifier is detected in a lower order
(VC-3) path. A board reports this alarm when detecting a mismatched trace identifier in byte J1.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Has a fixed value of 0x01.
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of the VC-3 path that reports the alarm. For example,
0x00 0x01 indicate that the alarm is reported in VC-3 path 1.

Impact on the System


None.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Byte J1 to be received at the local site does not match with byte J1 to be transmitted
at the opposite site.
l Cause 2: The data configuration at intermediate sites is incorrect.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Byte J1 to be received at the local site does not match with byte J1 to be transmitted at
the opposite site.
1. Set byte J1 to be received at the local site to the disable mode or the same as byte J1 to be
transmitted at the opposite site. For details, see Configuring VC-4 POHs.
Step 2 Cause 2: The data configuration at intermediate sites is incorrect.
1. Check whether the cross-connections of intermediate sites where the services travel are
configured correctly. If not, reconfigure the cross-connections. For details, see Querying
TDM Services.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 530


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.167 LP_UNEQ

Description
The LP_UNEQ is an alarm indicating that the lower order path is unequipped. This alarm is
reported when the board detects that the V5 byte signal label is 0.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The services in the path are unavailable. If the services are configured with protection, protection
switching may be triggered.

Possible Causes
The data configuration is incorrect.

l Cause 1: The tributary path at the local site is configured with services, but the tributary
path at the remote site is not configured with services.
l Cause 2: The cross-connection configuration at the intermediate nodes is incorrect.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The tributary path at the local site is configured with services, but the tributary path at
the remote site is not configured with services.
1. Check whether the tributary path at the remote site is configured with services. For details,
see Querying TDM Services.

If... Then...
The tributary path at the remote site is not Configure services for the tributary path at
configured with services the remote site.
The tributary path at the remote site is Go to Cause 2.
configured with services

Step 2 Cause 2: The cross-connection configuration at the intermediate nodes is incorrect.


1. Check whether the cross-connection configuration at the intermediate nodes is correct. If
not, reconfigure the cross-connections. For details, see Querying TDM Services.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 531


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Related Information
None.

A.3.168 LP_UNEQ_VC12

Description
The LP_UNEQ_VC12 is an alarm indicating that the VC-12 path is unequipped. This alarm
occurs when the board detects that the V5 byte signal label is 0.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the ID of the optical interface. The value is always 0x01.
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of the VC-12 path.

Impact on the System


If the alarm is generated due to incorrect service configurations, the services are interrupted.

Possible Causes
The data configuration is incorrect.

l Cause 1: The tributary path at the local site is configured with services, but the tributary
path at the remote site is not configured with services.
l Cause 2: The cross-connection configuration at the intermediate nodes is incorrect.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The tributary path at the local site is configured with services, but the tributary path at
the remote site is not configured with services.
1. Check whether the tributary path at the remote site is configured with services. For details,
see Querying TDM Services.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 532


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The tributary path at the remote site is not configured with Configure services.
services
The tributary path at the remote site is configured with services Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The cross-connection configuration at the intermediate nodes is incorrect.


1. Check whether the cross-connection configuration at the intermediate nodes is correct. If
not, reconfigure the cross-connections. For details, see Querying TDM Services.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.169 LP_UNEQ_VC3

Description
The LP_UNEQ_VC3 alarm indicates that a lower order (VC-3) path is unequipped. A board
reports this alarm when detecting that the C2 byte signal label is 0.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Has a fixed value of 0x01.
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of the VC-3 path that reports the alarm. For example,
0x00 0x01 indicate that the alarm is reported in VC-3 path 1.

Impact on the System


The services in the path are unavailable. If the services are configured with protection, protection
switching is triggered.

Possible Causes
The data configuration is incorrect.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 533


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

l Cause 1: The tributary path at the local site is configured with services, but the tributary
path at the opposite site is not.
l Cause 2: The cross-connection configuration at the intermediate sites is incorrect.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The tributary path at the local site is configured with services, but the tributary path at
the opposite site is not.
1. Check whether the tributary path at the opposite site is configured with services. For details,
see Querying TDM Services.

If... Then...
The tributary path at the opposite site is not configured with Configure services.
services
The tributary path at the opposite site is configured with Go to Cause 2.
services

Step 2 Cause 2: The cross-connection configuration at the intermediate sites is incorrect.


1. Check whether the cross-connection configuration at the intermediate sites is correct. If
not, reconfigure the cross-connections. For details, see Querying TDM Services.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.170 LPS_UNI_BI_M

Description
The LPS_UNI_BI_M is an alarm indicating that switching modes (single-ended or dual-ended)
at both ends of the linear MSP do not match with each other.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Minor Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 534


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the type of the protection group.

0x01: linear MS protection.

Parameter 2 Indicates the ID of the alarmed protection group. For example, 0x01 indicates
that the alarm is reported by protection group 1.

Impact on the System


The system performs protection switching in single-ended mode.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The linear MSP is configured incorrectly.

The LPS_UNI_BI_M alarm is generated only when the following conditions are met:

l The switching modes (single-ended or dual-ended) at the local and remote sites are
different.
l The last three bits of the K2 byte are set to the indicated mode.
l The type of the protocol is set to a restructure protocol.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The linear MSP is configured incorrectly.
1. Change the MSP switching modes at both ends, and ensure that they are the same. For
details, see Querying the Status of the Linear MSP.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.171 LPT_CFG_CLOSEPORT

Description
The LPT_CFG_CLOSEPORT is an alarm indicating that the LPT closes the access port of the
local NE. Upon detecting that the convergence port of the local NE or the access port of the
remote NE is faulty, the LPT automatically closes the access port of the local NE. Then, the
LPT_CFG_CLOSEPORT alarm is reported.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Equipment alarm

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 535


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1, Parameter 2 Indicates the board ID.

Parameter 3 Indicates the ID of the sub-board.

Parameter 4, Parameter 5 Indicate the port ID.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, services are switched to the backup network and the LPT closes the
access port of the remote NE at the same time.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The convergence port of the local NE or the access port of the remote NE is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The convergence port of the local NE or the access port of the remote NE is faulty.
1. Check whether the convergence port of the local NE, the access port and the convergence
port of the remote NE report the ETH_LOS alarm or other alarms related to boards and
optical modules.
2. If yes, clear these alarms. Then, check whether the LPT_CFG_CLOSEPORT alarm is
cleared.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.172 LPT_INEFFECT

Description
The LPT_INEFFECT is an alarm indicating that the LPT function fails. If the user configures
the LPT function but the board does not support the LPT function, the LPT_INEFFECT alarm
is reported.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 536


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Processing alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 Indicates the ID of the IP port.

Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the port ID.

The values are always 0x00 0x01.

Parameter 4, Parameter 5 The values are always 0xff 0xff.

Impact on the System


When the alarm is generated, the services are not affected. If the board hardware is of a very
early version, the board software automatically prevents the LPT protocol state machine from
running, but reserves the LPT configuration.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The board hardware is of a very early version, and the user configures the LPT function.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The board hardware is of a very early version, and the user configures the LPT function.
1. Check whether the LPT function is required.

If... Then...
The LPT function is required Replace the board with a board of the proper
version. For details, see 6 Part Replacement.
The LPT function is not required Delete the configuration of the LPT. For details, see
LPT Configuration.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 537


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.173 LPT_RFI

Description
The LPT_RFI is a remote failure indication of the link path through (LPT) function. This alarm
occurs when the LPT function detects the failure of the remote port or the LPT service network.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Critical Service alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the ID of the IP port.
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of the optical interface. The values are always 0x00
0x01.
Parameter 4 The value is always 0xff.

Impact on the System


During the data transmission, the links are unavailable and the services are interrupted when the
LPT function detects the failure of the remote port or the service network. At the same time, the
backup links are enabled. If the backup links are available, the services can be restored on the
backup links.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The remote port fails due to the alarms such as ETH_LOS and
LSR_NO_FITED, or the remote port is disabled.
l Cause 2: The LPT service network is faulty.
The communication link is interrupted.
There are the bit error threshold-crossing alarms BIP_EXC and B3_EXC.
There are the alarms such as TU_LOP, TU_AIS, VCAT_LOA,
VCAT_LOM_VC12, and LP_UNEQ_VC12.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 538


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Procedure
Step 1 Check the alarms on the NMS, determine the board that reports the LPT_RFI alarm, and then
determine the ID of the alarmed port on the board according to Parameter 1.

Step 2 Cause 1: The remote port fails due to the alarms such as ETH_LOS and LSR_NO_FITED, or
the remote port is disabled.
1. Check whether the corresponding opposite port is enabled.

If... Then...
The opposite port is disabled Enable the opposite port.
The opposite port is enabled Go to the next step.

2. Check whether any link fault alarm occurs on the line board.

If... Then...
Any link fault alarm occurs Handle the link fault alarms. Focus on the R_LOS and
MW_LOF alarms and handle them first.
No link fault alarm occurs Go to Cause 2.

Step 3 Cause 2: The LPT service network is faulty.


1. Check whether the following alarms occur on the Ethernet boards of the MEPs at both ends.
Then, handle the alarms.
l ETH_LOS
l LSR_NO_FITED
l BIP_EXC and B3_EXC
l TU_LOP, TU_AIS, VCAT_LOA, VCAT_LOM_VC12, and LP_UNEQ_VC12

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.174 LSR_BCM_ALM

Description
The LSR_BCM_ALM is an alarm indicating a threshold-crossing of the bias current of a laser.
This alarm is reported when the bias current of a laser exceeds the threshold.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Equipment alarm

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 539


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the laser is functioning improperly. An over-high current burns out the
laser, and an over-low current causes insufficient gains. Both can interrupt services.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The laser is aged.
l Cause 2: The laser is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Browse alarms on the NMS and determine the board that reports the alarm.

Step 2 Replace the pluggable optical module. For details, see Replacing Pluggable Optical
Modules.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.175 LSR_NO_FITED

Description
The LSR_NO_FITED is an alarm indicating that the SFP optical module is not installed.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Critical Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The optical interface fails to carry services.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The laser of the local site is not installed.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 540


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

l Cause 2: The optical module is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The SFP optical module of the local site is not installed.
1. Find out why the SFP optical module is not installed, and contact Huawei technical support
engineers for the installation. If SFP module is not needed, see Configuring an SFP Port to
delete this port.

Step 2 Cause 2: The optical module is faulty.


1. 6.14 Replacing the SFP.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.176 LSR_WILL_DIE

Description
The LSR_WILL_DIE is an alarm indicating that the laser is to stop working.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Critical Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, bit errors occur in the service. If the board is not replaced in a timely
manner, services are interrupted after the laser is damaged.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The laser is aged.
l Cause 2: The detection circuit of the board is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The laser is aged.
1. 6.14 Replacing the SFP.

Step 2 Cause 2: The detection circuit of the board is faulty.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 541


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

1. Replacing the alarm Board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.177 LTI

Description
The LTI is an alarm indicating that the synchronization sources are lost. This alarm is reported
when all the synchronization sources for the NE are lost.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 0x01: system priority list

0x02: external clock priority list

Impact on the System


The clock enters the free-run mode and loses synchronization with other NE clocks.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The clock configuration is incorrect.
l Cause 2: All the clock sources in the clock source priority table fail.
l Cause 3: A fiber cut or a cable cut occurs.
l Cause 4: The synchronization source is set to the manual reversion mode.
l Cause 5: No input is available from the external clock source.
l Cause 6: The board is faulty.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 542


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The clock configuration is incorrect.
1. Check whether the data in the clock source priority table meets the network planning
requirement. For details, see Querying the Clock Synchronization Status.

If... Then...
The configuration is incorrect Correct the configuration.
The configuration is correct Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: All the clock sources in the clock source priority table fail.
1. Troubleshoot the synchronization sources based on the clock source priority table.

If... Then...
The synchronization source is an Handle the EXT_SYNC_LOS alarm.
external clock
The synchronization source is a line Handle the alarm that occurs on the line
clock board.
The synchronization source is an IF Handle the alarm that occurs on the IF board.
clock
The synchronization source is a Handle the alarm that occurs on the tributary
tributary clock board.
The synchronization source is an Handle the alarm that occurs on the Ethernet
Ethernet clock board.

Step 3 Cause 3: A fiber cut or a cable cut occurs.


1. Connect the fiber or cable properly.

Step 4 Cause 4: The synchronization source is set to the manual reversion mode.
1. See Modifying the Recovery Parameter of the Clock Source, and set the clock source to
the automatic reversion mode.

Step 5 Cause 5: No input is available from the external clock source.


1. See Configuring Clock Sources for External Clock Output, and configure the clock source
that provides external clock signals.

Step 6 Cause 6: The board is faulty.


1. Replace the board.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 543


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.178 MAC_EXT_EXC

Description
The MAC_EXT_EXC alarm indicates that the number of bit errors at the MAC layer crosses
the threshold.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Communication alarm

Parameters

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the threshold crossing type.

l 0x01: ETHDROP threshold crossing


l 0x02: ETHEXCCOL threshold crossing
l 0x03: RXBBAD threshold crossing

Impact on the System


When the MAC_EXT_EXC alarm occurs, the performance of services degrades.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: ETHDROP threshold crossing. The number of packet loss events crosses the upper
threshold.
l Cause 2: ETHEXCCOL threshold crossing. The number of frames unsuccessfully
transmitted after successive collisions crosses the upper threshold.
l Cause 3: RXBBAD threshold crossing. The number of bytes in received bad packets crosses
the upper threshold.

Procedure
Step 1 Check whether the working modes of the ports at the transmit and receive ends are the same.
1. On the NMS, query the working modes of the ports at the transmit and receive ends.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 544


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The ports at the transmit and receive Set the working modes of the ports at the
ends work in different modes or in half- transmit and receive ends to full-duplex or
duplex mode auto-negotiation. Ensure that the working
modes of the ports at the transmit and receive
ends are the same. For details, see Setting the
Basic Attributes of Ethernet Ports.
The ports at the transmit and receive Go to the next step.
ends work in the same mode and neither
port works in half-duplex mode.

Step 2 Handle the problem that the opposite site transmits packets abnormally.

Step 3 Handle the quality problem with the transmission line.


Check whether the local end reports alarms such as ETH_LOS as the external line is damaged
or over attenuated. If yes, see the related handling method to clear the alarms.

Step 4 Replace the faulty board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.179 MAC_FCS_EXC

Description
The MAC_FCS_EXC alarm indicates that the software detects that the number of bit errors at
the MAC layer crosses the threshold. The software periodically detects the number of bytes
received by the MAC chip and the number of bytes that have bit errors. The MAC_FCS_EXC
alarm is reported when the number of bit errors crosses the threshold.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 545


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 l 0x00: indicates that a performance threshold is crossed.
l 0x01: indicates bit-error-triggered switching.

Impact on the System


When the MAC_FCS_EXC alarm occurs, the performance of services degrades.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The performance of the line signals degrades.
l Cause 2: The input optical power is abnormal.
l Cause 3: A fiber connector is dirty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The performance of the line signals degrades.
1. On the NMS, check for a LOOP_ALM alarm. If there is any, clear it. For details, see 8.4
Software Loopback.
2. If the MAC_FCS_EXC alarm persists, check whether the NMS is under a denial-of-service
(DOS) attack. If yes, eliminate the source that transmits a large amount of invalid data, and
then check whether the MAC_FCS_EXC alarm is cleared.
3. If the MAC_FCS_EXC alarm persists, check whether a cable or fiber is faulty. Replace the
faulty cable or fiber, and then check whether the MAC_FCS_EXC alarm is cleared.

Step 2 Cause 2: The input optical power is abnormal.


1. Check whether the alarmed port reports an IN_PWR_ABN alarm as well.
2. If there is any, clear the IN_PWR_ABN alarm.

Step 3 Cause 3: A fiber connector is dirty.


1. Clean the fiber connector and the optical receive port. For details, see 8.10 Cleaning Fiber
Connectors and Adapters.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.180 MAC_FCS_SD

Description
The MAC_FCS_EXC alarm indicates that bit errors detected at the MAC layer exceed the
threshold. NE software periodically detects the number of bytes received by MAC chips and the
bytes that contain bit errors, and check the number of bit errors against the signal degrade (SD)
threshold. This alarm is reported if bit errors cross the threshold.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 546


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None

Impact on the System


Service performance deteriorates.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Line signals degrade.
l Cause 2: Input optical power is abnormal.
l Cause 3: Fiber connectors are dirty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Line signals degrade.
1. On the NMS, check whether a LOOP_ALM alarm is reported. If a LOOP_ALM alarm is
reported, clear it. For details, see 8.4 Software Loopback.
2. If the MAC_FCS_EXC alarm persists, check whether any source unexpectedly sends a
large amount of data, such as DOS attacks. If yes, eliminate the data source.
3. If the alarm persists, check whether the cable or fiber is faulty. If the cable or fiber is faulty,
replace the faulty cable or fiber.

Step 2 Cause 2: Input optical power is abnormal.


1. Check whether the local port also reports an IN_PWR_ABN alarm.
2. If an IN_PWR_ABN alarm is also reported, clear it.

Step 3 Cause 3: Fiber connectors are dirty.


1. Clean the fiber connectors and the receive port of the processing board. For details, see
8.10 Cleaning Fiber Connectors and Adapters.

----End

Related Information
None

A.3.181 MOD_COM_FAIL

Description
The MOD_COM_FAIL is an alarm indicating that Module communicates abnormally.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 547


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Critical Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 0x11 indicates that the communication between the system control unit and
packet switching unit is failed.

Impact on the System


The related operations cannot be performed by using the NMS and the performance information
of each module cannot be queried.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The software processing of the related modules of the boardis faulty.
l Cause 2: The board hardware is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The software processing of the related modules of the board is faulty.
1. Perform a cold reset on the faulty board by using the NMS. For details, refer to 8.6.1 Cold
Reset.
2. remove the faulty board and insert it again.

Step 2 Cause 2: The board hardware is faulty.


1. Replace the faulty board. For details, refer to 6.10 Replacing the System Control,
Switching and Timing Board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.182 MOD_TYPE_MISMATCH

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 548


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Description
The MOD_TYPE_MISMATCH alarm indicates that a mismatched port module is detected.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Critical Maloperation

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the ID of the port that reports the alarm. For example, 0x01 indicates
that the alarm is reported by port 1.

Impact on the System


The services at the alarmed port are interrupted.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The preset type of the SFP module is different from the actual type of the SFP module.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The preset type of the SFP module is different from the actual type of the SFP module.
1. Find out the port that reports the alarm according to the alarm parameters.
2. Check whether the preset type of the SFP module is the same as the actual type of the SFP
module.

If... Then...
The preset type of the SFP module is the Replace the optical/electrical SFP
same as the actual type of the SFP module module. Ensure that the new SFP module is
of the correct type.
The preset type of the SFP module is Reset the type of the SFP module.
different from the actual type of the SFP
module

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 549


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.183 MP_DELAY

Description
The MP_DELA is an alarm indicating a delay of the Multi-link Point-to-Point (ML-PPP) group.
This alarm is reported when the differential delay between MP group members exceeds the
threshold.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 Indicates the ID of the board.

Parameter 2 Indicates the ID of the subborad.

Parameter 3, Parameter 4 Indicates the ID of the port.

Parameter 5 Indicates the ID of the timeslot or channel.

0xFF indicates that the parameter value is reserved.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the service quality of the MP group deteriorates.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The signal quality of the MP group members deteriorates.
l Cause 2: The maximum differential delay is configured low.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The signal quality of the MP group members deteriorates.
1. Check whether the network is congested. If yes, expand the network and then check whether
the alarm is cleared.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 550


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

2. If the alarm persists, replace the cable connecting to the port that reports the alarm. Then,
check whether the alarm is cleared.

Step 2 Cause 2: The maximum differential delay is configured low.


1. Check whether the maximum differential delay is configured properly on the NMS. For
details, see Creating MP Groups.
2. If the maximum differential delay is configured low, increase the value based on the actual
situation or disable the fragment function.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.184 MP_DOWN

Description
The MP_DOWN is an alarm indicating a failure of the Multi-link Point-to-Point (ML-PPP)
group. This alarm is reported when the number of the valid activated MP group members is less
than that of the specified minimum activated links. The minimum activated links is 1 by default.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 Indicates the cause of the failure.

l 0x00: unknown
l 0x01: indicates that the number of the MP group members is less than the
specified number.
l 0x02: indicates that the configurations at both ends of the MP group are
inconsistent.
l 0x03: indicates that the NCP protocol of the MP group is running improperly.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 551


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Impact on the System


l When this alarm occurs, all services that the MP group carries are interrupted.
l This alarm is cleared automatically when the number of the valid activated MP group
members is greater than the specified minimum activated links and the MP group is
configured with an IP address.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The number of the valid activated MP group members is less than that of the
minimum activated links.
l Cause 2: The configurations at both ends of the MP group are inconsistent.
l Cause 3: The NCP protocol on the member links of the MP group is running improperly.
l Cause 4: The physical link is interrupted.
l Cause 5: The MP group is not configured with an IP address or a subnet mask.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The number of the valid activated MP group members is less than that of the minimum
activated links.
1. On the NMS, check whether the number of the valid activated MP group members is less
than that of the minimum activated links. For details, see Querying the MP Group Protocol
Information.
2. If the number is less than that of the minimum activated links, change the minimum
activated links to a value less than the number of configured MP group members.

Step 2 Cause 2: The configurations at both ends of the MP group are inconsistent.
1. On the NMS, check whether the configurations at both ends of the MP group are consistent.
If not, modify the parameters. For details, see Creating MP Groups.

Step 3 Cause 3: The NCP protocol on the member links of the MP group is running improperly.
1. On the NMS, check whether the PPP_LCP_FAIL or PPP_NCP_FAIL alarm exists on
the member links of the MP group.
2. If yes, clear the PPP_LCP_FAIL or PPP_NCP_FAIL alarm immediately. Then, check
whether the MP_DOWN alarm is cleared.

Step 4 Cause 4: The physical link is interrupted.


1. On the NMS, check whether a signal alarm such as R_LOS or T_ALOS exists on the
member links of the MP group.
2. If yes, clear the R_LOS or T_ALOS alarm immediately.

Step 5 Cause 5: The MP group is not configured with an IP address or a subnet mask.
1. Configure an IP address and a subnet mask for the MP group. For details, see Creating MP
Groups.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 552


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.185 MPLS_PW_AIS

Description
The MPLS_PW_AIS is an alarm indicating a defect in the forward direction of a PW. This alarm
is reported when the Ethernet port receives an AIS packet, indicating that a fault occurs on the
tunnel at the server layer of the PW.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, services may be interrupted.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The MPLS-TP OAM is incorrectly configured for tunnels between upstream NEs.

Cause 2: An upstream NE detects a fault on the tunnel at the PW server layer.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The MPLS-TP OAM is incorrectly configured for tunnels between upstream NEs.
1. Check whether the MPLS-TP OAM is configured correctly for tunnels between the local
NE and its upstream NEs. If not, modify the configuration. For details, see Configuring
MEP Parameters for MPLS-TP PW OAM.

Step 2 Cause 2: An upstream NE detects a fault on the tunnel at the PW server layer.
1. Check whether a tunnel fault occurs on the S-PE. If an alarm such as
MPLS_TUNNEL_LOCV exists, clear the alarm immediately.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 553


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.186 MPLS_PW_CSF

Description
The MPLS_PW_CSF alarm indicates that client signals fail at the peer end of a PW. This alarm
is reported when one end of a PW receives Client Signal Fail (CSF) OAM packets from the peer
end.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


Services may be interrupted.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: A link or hardware is faulty on the UNI side of the peer NE.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: A link or hardware is faulty on the UNI side of the peer NE.
1. Check whether the peer NE reports any link- or hardware-related alarm on the UNI side.
If yes, clear the alarm.

Possible alarms include:

l Link-related alarm: ETH_LOS


l Hardware-related alarm: BD_STATUS, HARD_BAD
l Alarm related to the IEEE 802.3ah protocol: ETH_EFM_DF,
ETH_EFM_LOOPBACK

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 554


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.187 MPLS_PW_BDI
Description
The MPLS_PW_BDI is an alarm of PW backward defect indication. This alarm occurs when
the local NE receives the BDI packet, notifying that the remote NE detects that the PW is faulty.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The services on the transmit side of the local NE are faulty.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The remote NE detects that the PW is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The remote NE detects that the PW is faulty.

If... Then...
A board on the remote NE is reset or faulty Rectify the fault on the remote NE.
The physical link between the local NE and the Rectify the fault on the physical link.
remote NE is faulty
The bandwidth allocated to the PW is fully Increase the bandwidth of the PW.
occupied.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.188 MPLS_PW_Excess
Description
The MPLS_PW_Excess is an alarm indicating that excessive trail termination source identifiers
(TTSIs) are received on the PW. This alarm occurs when five or more correct CV/FFD packets
are received within three consecutive CV/FFD periods.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 555


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Warning Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


Services may be interrupted if excessive redundant packets are received.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Multiple PWs are configured with the same label and PW ID.
l Cause 2: Physical links are misconnected.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Multiple PWs are configured with the same label and PW ID.
1. Check whether multiple PWs are configured with the same label and PW ID.
2. If yes, delete the redundant PWs or change the PW ID and label of each PW to unique
values.
3. Then, check whether the alarm clears.

If... Then...
The alarm clears End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: Physical links are misconnected.


1. Check whether any fiber or cable is misconnected.
2. If yes, rectify the fault.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.189 MPLS_PW_LCK

Description
The MPLS_PW_LCK alarm indicates that a server layer tunnel is administratively locked. This
alarm is reported when the MEP receives a LCK message.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 556


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The server-layer tunnel is locked for diagnostic testing or other administrative purposes.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: Administrative locking is enabled for a tunnel-layer MEP.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Administrative locking is enabled for a tunnel-layer MEP.
1. Check whether tunnel locking is enabled on the nodes along the PW path. If yes, disable
the CLK after administrative locking (for diagnostic testing or other administrative
purpose) is no longer needed.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.190 MPLS_PW_LOCK

Description
The MPLS_PW_LOCK alarm indicates that the locked signal function (LCK) is enabled for the
PW layer.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 557


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Impact on the System


The PW is locked for diagnostic testing or other administrative purposes.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: Administrative locking is enabled for the PW layer.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Administrative locking is enabled for the PW layer.
1. Check whether the LCK is enabled for the PW layer. If yes, disable the CLK after
administrative locking (for diagnostic testing or other administrative purpose) is no longer
needed.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.191 MPLS_PW_LOCV

Description
The MPLS_PW_LOCV is an alarm of PW connectivity loss. This alarm occurs when no
expected CV/FFD packets are received within three consecutive CV/FFD periods.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, services are interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The remote NE of the PW stops transmitting CV/FFD packets.
l Cause 2: The OAM is different between the ends of the PW.
l Cause 3: The PW that carries services is faulty.
l Cause 4: The remote NE of the PW is faulty.
l Cause 5: The service interface is configured incorrectly.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 558


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

l Cause 6: Serious congestion occurs on the network.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The remote NE of the PW stops transmitting CV/FFD packets.
1. Check whether the remote NE of the PW stops transmitting CV/FFD packets.

If... Then...
The remote NE of the PW stops Enable the CV/FFD detection and then
transmitting CV/FFD packets check whether the alarm clears.
The remote NE of the PW keeps Go to Cause 2.
transmitting CV/FFD packets

Step 2 Cause 2: The OAM is different between the ends of the PW.
1. Check whether the OAM is different between the ends of the PW. If no, Setting PW OAM
(Y.1711) Parameters according to the plan. If yes, go to cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: The PW that carries services is faulty.


1. Check whether the local NE and remote NE of the PW report any alarm related to boards.
If yes, clear the alarm. Then, check whether the MPLS_PW_LOCV alarm is cleared.
2. Check whether any link-related alarm is reported. If yes, clear the alarm. Then, check
whether the MPLS_PW_LOCV alarm is cleared.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 4.

Step 4 Cause 4: The remote NE of the PW is faulty.


1. Check whether the interconnected board of the remote NE reports the COMMUN_FAIL
alarm. If yes, the board is being reset. Clear the COMMUN_FAIL alarm and then check
whether the MPLS_PW_LOCV alarm is cleared.
2. If the interconnected board of the remote NE reports other alarms, clear these alarms. Then,
check whether the MPLS_PW_LOCV alarm is cleared.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 5.

Step 5 Cause 5: The service interface is configured incorrectly.


1. Check whether the service interface is configured correctly according to service planning.
2. If not, reconfigure the service interface. Then, check whether the MPLS_PW_LOCV alarm
is cleared.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared End the alarm handling.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 559


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The alarm persists Go to Cause 6.

Step 6 Cause 6: Serious congestion occurs on the network.


1. Check whether the bandwidth allocated to the faulty tunnel is fully occupied.
2. If yes, increase the bandwidth of the PW or eliminate the sources that transmit a large
amount of invalid data.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.192 MPLS_PW_MISMATCH

Description
The MPLS_PW_MISMATCH is an alarm indicating that the trail termination source identifiers
(TTSIs) on the PW do not match with the specified one. This alarm occurs when only the packets
with wrong TTSIs are received within three consecutive CV/FFD periods.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


Services are interrupted or the packets from other PWs are received.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The ingress node or egress node of the faulty PW is configured incorrectly.
l Cause 2: Physical links are misconnected.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The ingress node or egress node of the faulty PW is configured incorrectly.
1. Check whether the ingress node and egress node of the faulty PW are configured correctly
according to NE planning.
2. If the ingress node or egress node is configured incorrectly, correct the configuration and
then check whether the alarm clears.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 560


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Step 2 Cause 2: Physical links are misconnected.


1. Check whether any fiber or cable is misconnected.
2. If yes, rectify the fault.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.193 MPLS_PW_MISMERGE

Description
The MPLS_PW_MISMERGE is an alarm indicating that the trail termination source identifiers
(TTSIs) are mismerged on the PW. This alarm is reported if the CV/FFD packets with correct
TTSIs and those with wrong TTSIs are received in three consecutive CV/FFD periods.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


Services are interrupted or the packets from other PWs are received.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The PW is configured incorrectly.
l Cause 2: Physical links are misconnected.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The PW is configured incorrectly.
1. Check whether the PW are configured correctly according to NE planning.
2. If the PW is configured incorrectly, correct the configuration and then check whether the
alarm clears.

Step 2 Cause 2: Physical links are misconnected.


1. Check whether any fiber or cable is misconnected.
2. If yes, rectify the fault.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 561


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Related Information
None.

A.3.194 MPLS_PW_OAMFAIL

Description
The MPLS_PW_OAMFAIL is an alarm indicating a failure of the OAM protocol negotiation.
This alarm is reported when the OAM protocol negotiation fails on NEs at both ends of the PW.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the PW APS protection switching is triggered, and services are switched
to the protection PW.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The OAM function is enabled only on the NE at one end of the PW.

NOTE

Only the NE that is enabled with the OAM function reports the MPLS_PW_OAMFAIL alarm.

Cause 2: The PW has been interrupted when enabling the OAM function.

NOTE

When the PW is interrupted in the forward or reverse direction, the peer or local NE reports the
MPLS_PW_OAMFAIL alarm.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The OAM function is enabled only on the NE at one end of the PW.
1. On the NMS, query this alarm and check whether the OAM function is enabled on NEs at
both ends of the PW. If the OAM function is enabled only on one NE, set OAM Status to
Enabled on the other NE.

Step 2 Cause 2: The PW has been interrupted when enabling the OAM function.
1. On the NMS, check whether tunnel-related alarms such as A.3.210
MPLS_TUNNEL_OAMFAIL occur on NEs at both ends of the PW. If yes, clear them
immediately.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 562


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

2. Check whether service-related alarms such as A.3.191 MPLS_PW_LOCV occur on NEs


at both ends of the PW. If yes, clear them immediately.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.195 MPLS_PW_RDI

Description
The MPLS_PW_RDI is an alarm indicating a defect in the backward direction of a PW. The
local MEP sends an RDI packet to the remote MEP when detecting a PW fault. The
MPLS_PW_RDI alarm is reported when the remote MEP receives the RDI packet.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, services in the transmit direction on the remote MEP are affected.

Possible Causes
The local MEP NE detects a PW fault.

Procedure
Step 1 Handle the PW fault according to the MPLS-TP OAM-related alarm reported by the remote
MEP.

Step 2 If the alarm persists, check whether the physical link between faulty NEs is faulty. For example,
the optical fiber or cable is damaged or pressed. If yes, replace the faulty optical fiber or cable.

Step 3 Check whether the bandwidth allocated to the PW is used up. If yes, increase the bandwidth
allocated to the PW.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 563


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.196 MPLS_PW_SD

Description
The MPLS_PW_SD is an alarm of signal degrade on the PW. This alarm is reported when the
packet loss rate of the connectivity check (CC) crosses the SD threshold but is lower than the
SF threshold.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


Services degrade and moderate packet loss occurs.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The bandwidth of the PW is fully occupied.
l Cause 2: The physical port has bit errors or packet loss.
l Cause 3: The fiber connector or the optical module is dirty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The bandwidth of the PW is fully occupied.
1. Check whether the bandwidth allocated to the faulty PW is fully occupied.
2. If yes, increase the bandwidth of the PW or eliminate the sources that transmit a large
amount of invalid data. Then, check whether the MPLS_PW_SD alarm is cleared.

Step 2 Cause 2: The physical port has bit errors or packet loss.
1. Check whether the fiber connector is loose. If yes, insert the fiber connector securely.

Step 3 Cause 3: The fiber connector or the optical module is dirty.


1. Clean the fiber connector or the optical module. For details, see Checking and cleaning
fiber connectors.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 564


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.197 MPLS_PW_SF

Description
The MPLS_PW_SF is an alarm of signal failure on the PW. This alarm occurs when the number
of received connectivity check (CC) packets is less than the signal failure (SF) threshold.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


Services fail and severe packet loss occurs.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The bandwidth of the PW is fully occupied.
l Cause 2: The physical port has bit errors or packet loss.
l Cause 3: The fiber connector or the optical module is dirty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The bandwidth of the PW is fully occupied.
1. Check whether the bandwidth allocated to the faulty PW is fully occupied.
2. If yes, increase the bandwidth of the PW or eliminate the sources that transmit a large
amount of invalid data. Then, check whether the MPLS_PW_SF alarm is cleared.

Step 2 Cause 2: The physical port has bit errors or packet loss.
1. Check whether the fiber connector is loose. If yes, insert the fiber connector securely.

Step 3 Cause 3: The fiber connector or the optical module is dirty.


1. Clean the fiber connector or the optical module. For details, see Checking and cleaning
fiber connectors.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 565


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.198 MPLS_PW_UNEXPMEG

Description
The MPLS_PW_UNEXPMEG is an alarm indicating that the MEP receives a packet with correct
MEG level but incorrect MEG ID.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Critical Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the MEP receives CCM packets of other PWs.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: MEG IDs configured on NEs at both ends of the PW are different.
l Cause 2: The PW is configured incorrectly. Multiple PWs use the same label.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: MEG IDs configured on NEs at both ends of the PW are different.
1. Check whether the PW configurations are consistent between NEs at both ends of the PW.
MEG IDs on NEs at both ends of a PW must be set to the same value. For details, see
Querying Information and Running Status of PWs.

Step 2 Cause 2: The PW is configured incorrectly. Multiple PWs use the same label.
1. Check whether the PW label is configured correctly. If multiple PWs use the same label,
reconfigure the PW label. For details, see Querying Information and Running Status of
PWs.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 566


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.199 MPLS_PW_UNEXPMEP

Description
The MPLS_PW_UNEXPMEP is an alarm indicating an error in the PW OAM CCM
information. This alarm is reported when the sink NE of the PW receives a CCM packet with
an unexpected MEP ID.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, services are interrupted or the sink NE receives CCM packets of other
PWs.

Possible Causes
MEP IDs are inconsistent between NEs at both ends of a PW.

Procedure
Step 1 MEP IDs are inconsistent between NEs at both ends of a PW.
1. Check whether the remote MEP ID on the source NE is correctly configured with the MEP
ID of the sink NE. If not, reconfigure the remote MEP ID on the source NE.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.200 MPLS_PW_UNEXPPER

Description
The MPLS_PW_UNEXPPER is an alarm indicating that the PW does not receive the CCM
packet in the expected period. This alarm is reported when the sink NE of the PW receives a
CCM packet with correct MEG level, MEG ID, and MEP ID but in an unexpected period. For
example, the transmit interval configured on the source and sink NEs is 10 ms, but the sink NE
receives the CCM packet from the source NE after 20 ms.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 567


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, services are interrupted or the sink NE receives CCM packets of other
PWs.

Possible Causes
CCM packet periods are inconsistent between the source and sink NEs at both ends of the PW.

Procedure
Step 1 CCM packet periods are inconsistent between the source and sink NEs at both ends of the PW.
1. Check whether PW configurations are consistent between the source and sink NEs. CCM
packet periods on NEs at both ends of a PW must be set to the same value. For details, see
Querying Information and Running Status of PWs.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.201 MPLS_PW_UNKNOWN
Description
The MPLS_PW_UNKNOWN is an alarm of unknown defects on the PW. This alarm occurs
when the connectivity check (CC) packets of unexpected types, periods, and values are received
within three consecutive periods.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 568


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Impact on the System


PW OAM fails.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The PW OAM configuration at the two ends is different.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The PW OAM configuration at the two ends is different.
1. Change the PW OAM configuration to the same at the two ends.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.202 MPLS_TUNNEL_AIS

Description
The MPLS_TUNNEL_AIS is an alarm indicating a defect in the forward direction of a tunnel.
This alarm is reported when the Ethernet port receives an AIS packet, indicating that a fault
occurs on the physical link at the server layer of the tunnel.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, services are interrupted.

Possible Causes
An upstream NE detects a fault on the physical link at the server layer of the tunnel.

Procedure
Step 1 An upstream NE detects a fault on the physical link at the server layer of the tunnel.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 569


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

1. Check whether the physical link is faulty between the local NE and the upstream NE.
Physical link faults may be caused by a fiber cut, a faulty optical module, or a faulty
board. If yes, rectify the faults.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.203 MPLS_TUNNEL_BDI

Description
The MPLS_TUNNEL_BDI is an alarm of tunnel backward defect indication. This alarm occurs
when the port of the local NE receives the backward defect indication (BDI) packet, notifying
that the opposite NE detects that the tunnel is faulty.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the services on the local NE is normal.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The opposite NE detects MPLS alarms.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The opposite NE detects MPLS alarms.
1. Clear the MPLS alarms reported on the opposite NE.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 570


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.204 MPLS_TUNNEL_Excess

Description
The MPLS_TUNNEL_Excess is an alarm indicating that excessive trail termination source
identifiers (TTSIs) are received in the tunnel. This alarm occurs when the Ethernet port of the
local NE receives five or more correct CV/FFD packets within three consecutive CV/FFD
periods.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Warning Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


Services may be interrupted if excessive redundant packets are received.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Physical links are misconnected.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Physical links are misconnected.
1. Check whether any fiber or cable is misconnected between the two ends. If yes, reconnect
the fiber or cable.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.205 MPLS_TUNNEL_FDI

Description
The MPLS_TUNNEL_FDI is an alarm of tunnel forward defect indication. This alarm is
reported when the local NE receives the forward defect indication (FDI) packet, notifying that
the upstream tunnel at the physical layer is faulty.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 571


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, services may be interrupted.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The upstream NE detects that the physical link that carries the tunnel is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The upstream NE detects that the physical link that carries the tunnel is faulty.

If... Then...
The link-related alarms, such as MW_BER_EXC, Clear these alarms first.
MW_BER_SD, MW_FEC_UNCOR and MW_LOF, are
reported
The transmit board of the local NE reports hardware-related Clear these alarms first.
alarms (alarms on the optical modules or boards), such as
HARD_BAD and LSR_NO_FITED

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.206 MPLS_TUNNEL_LOCV

Description
The MPLS_TUNNEL_LOCV is an alarm of tunnel connectivity loss. This alarm occurs when
the port of the local NE fails to receive expected CV/FFD packets within three CV/FFD periods.
(The expected CV/FFD packets must carry correct TTSIs and have the correct type, period, and
value.)

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 572


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the services that the faulty tunnel carries are interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: In detection mode of manual, the MPLS OAM settings, such as detection packet
type and detection packet period, differ at the two ends.
l Cause 2: Severe congestion occurs on the network.
l Cause 3: A certain board is faulty.
l Cause 4: The physical link between the two ends is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: In detection mode of manual, the MPLS OAM settings, such as detection packet type
and detection packet period, differ at the two ends.
1. Check whether the MPLS OAM settings are the same at the two ends.
2. If the MPLS OAM settings are different at the two ends, change them to the same.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: Severe congestion occurs on the network.


1. If the alarm persists, check whether the bandwidth allocated to the faulty tunnel is fully
used. If the bandwidth of the faulty tunnel is exhausted, increase the bandwidth or eliminate
the sources that transmit a large amount of invalid data.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: A certain board is faulty.


1. Check whether the remote NE reports the COMMUN_FAIL alarm. If yes, you can infer
that the remote NE is being reset. Wait until the COMMUN_FAIL alarm clears.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 573


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to the next step.
2. Check whether the local NE and the remote NE report alarms related to optical modules or
boards, such as HARD_BAD and LSR_NO_FITED. If yes, clear these alarms first.
3. Then, check whether the MPLS_TUNNEL_LOCV alarm clears.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 4.

Step 4 Cause 4: The physical link between the two ends is faulty.
1. Check whether any fiber or cable is damaged. If yes, replace the damaged fiber or cable.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.207 MPLS_TUNNEL_LOCK

Description
The MPLS_TUNNEL_LOCK alarm the locked signal function (LCK) is enabled for a tunnel.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Critical Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The tunnel is locked for diagnostic testing or other administrative purposes.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: Administrative locking is enabled for the tunnel layer on the source MEP.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Administrative locking is enabled for the tunnel layer on the source MEP.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 574


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

1. Check whether the LCK is enabled for the tunnel layer. If yes, disable the CLK after
administrative locking (for diagnostic testing or other administrative purpose) is no longer
needed.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.208 MPLS_TUNNEL_MISMATCH

Description
The MPLS_TUNNEL_MISMATCH is an alarm indicating that the trail termination source
identifiers (TTSIs) on the tunnel do not match with the specified one. This alarm is reported if
no CV/FFD packets with correct TTSIs are received in three consecutive CV/FFD periods.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, services are interrupted or packets from other tunnels are received.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The tunnel settings are incorrect. For example, the LSR IDs or tunnel IDs differ
at the two ends of the tunnel.
l Cause 2: Physical links are misconnected.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The tunnel settings are incorrect. For example, the LSR IDs or tunnel IDs differ at the
two ends of the tunnel.
1. Check whether the tunnel settings are the same at the two ends.
l If the source NE is an ingress node, Sink Node is the LSR ID of the sink NE. If the sink
NE is an egress node, Source Node is the LSR ID of the source NE.
l Tunnel IDs of the source NE and sink NE of a tunnel must be set to the same.
2. If the tunnel IDs are different, change them to the same.

Step 2 Cause 2: Physical links are misconnected.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 575


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

1. Check whether any fiber or cable is misconnected between the two ends. If yes, connect
the fiber or cable properly.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.209 MPLS_TUNNEL_MISMERGE

Description
The MPLS_TUNNEL_MISMERGE is an alarm indicating that the trail termination source
identifiers (TTSIs) are mismerged in the tunnel. This alarm is reported if the CV/FFD packets
with correct TTSIs and those with wrong TTSIs are received in three consecutive CV/FFD
periods.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the packets from other tunnels are received.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Multiple tunnels are configured with the same label.
l Cause 2: Physical links are misconnected.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Multiple tunnels are configured with the same label.
1. Check whether multiple tunnels are configured with the same label.
2. If multiple tunnels are configured with the same label, delete the redundant labels or change
the label of each tunnel to a unique value.

Step 2 Cause 2: Physical links are misconnected.


1. Check whether any fiber or cable is misconnected between the two ends. If yes, connect
the fiber or cable properly.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 576


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Related Information
On the NE, the label of each MPLS tunnel is unique.

A.3.210 MPLS_TUNNEL_OAMFAIL

Description
The MPLS_TUNNEL_OAMFAIL is an alarm indicating that the OAM protocol negotiation
between the two ends of the tunnel fails.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, services are switched to the backup network and the LPT closes the
access port of the remote NE at the same time.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The OAM function is enabled and the detection mode is auto-sensing on one end
and is disabled on the other end.
l Cause 2: The tunnel is unavailable when the OAM function is enabled and the detection
mode is auto-sensing.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The OAM function is enabled and the detection mode is auto-sensing on one end and
is disabled on the other end.
1. Enable the OAM function.
Step 2 Cause 2: The tunnel is unavailable when the OAM function is enabled and the detection mode
is auto-sensing.
1. Check whether the sink node of the alarmed tunnel reports the HARD_BAD,
ETH_LOS, or R_LOS alarm.
2. If yes, clear the alarm. After the OAM protocol negotiation succeeds, the
MPLS_TUNNEL_OAMFAIL alarm clears.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 577


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.211 MPLS_TUNNEL_RDI

Description
The MPLS_TUNNEL_RDI is an alarm indicating a defect in the backward direction of a tunnel.
The local MEP sends an RDI packet to the remote MEP when detecting a tunnel fault. The
MPLS_TUNNEL_RDI alarm is reported when the remote MEP receives the RDI packet.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, services are affected in the transmit direction on the remote MEP.

Possible Causes
The local MEP NE detects a tunnel fault.

Procedure
Step 1 Handle the tunnel fault according to the MPLS-TP OAM-related alarm reported by the remote
MEP. Then, check whether the MPLS_TUNNEL_RDI alarm is cleared.

Step 2 If the alarm persists, check whether the physical link is faulty between faulty NEs. For example,
the optical fiber or cable is damaged or pressed. If yes, replace the faulty optical fiber or cable.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.212 MPLS_TUNNEL_SD

Description
The MPLS_TUNNEL_SD is an alarm of signal degrade on the tunnel. This alarm is reported
when the packet loss rate of the CV/FFD crosses the SD threshold but is lower than the SF
threshold.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 578


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


Services degrade and moderate packet loss occurs.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Excessive bit errors occur.
l Cause 2: The bandwidth of the tunnel is fully used.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Excessive bit errors occur.
1. Clear bit errors.
2. If the alarm persists, proceed to cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The bandwidth of the tunnel is fully used.


1. Check whether the bandwidth allocated to the tunnel is fully used. If the bandwidth of the
faulty tunnel is exhausted, increase the bandwidth or eliminate the sources that transmit a
large amount of invalid data. Check whether the alarm clears.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.213 MPLS_TUNNEL_SF

Description
The MPLS_TUNNEL_SF is an alarm indicating that the tunnel signal degrades severely. This
alarm is reported if the loss ratio of the CV/FFD packets is higher than the SF threshold and CV/
FFD packets are received in three consecutive periods.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Communication alarm

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 579


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the quality of service degrades severely and a large number of packets
are lost.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Excessive bit errors occur.
l Cause 2: The bandwidth of the tunnel is fully used.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Excessive bit errors occur.
1. Clear bit errors.
2. If the MPLS_TUNNEL_SF persists, go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The bandwidth of the tunnel is fully used.


1. On the NMS, check whether the bandwidth of the tunnel is fully used. If the bandwidth of
the tunnel is fully used, increase the bandwidth allocated to the tunnel or eliminate any
source that transmits a large amount of invalid data. Check whether the alarm is cleared.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.214 MPLS_TUNNEL_UNEXPMEG

Description
The MPLS_TUNNEL_UNEXPMEG is an alarm indicating an error in the tunnel OAM CCM
information. This alarm is reported when the sink NE receives a CCM packet with an unexpected
MEG ID.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Critical Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 580


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the sink NE receives CCM packets of other tunnels.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: MEG IDs are inconsistent between NEs at both ends of a tunnel.
l Cause 2: There are multiple tunnels with the same label between the source and sink NEs.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: MEG IDs are inconsistent between NEs at both ends of a tunnel.
1. Check whether PW configurations are consistent between the source and sink NEs. MEG
IDs must be set to the same value on NEs at both ends of a tunnel. For details, see Querying
MPLS Tunnel Information.

Step 2 Cause 2: There are multiple tunnels with the same label between the source and sink NEs.
1. Check whether there are multiple tunnels with the same label on the source and sink NEs.
If yes, reconfigure labels for tunnels. For details, see Querying MPLS Tunnel Information.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.215 MPLS_TUNNEL_UNEXPMEP

Description
The MPLS_TUNNEL_UNEXPMEP is an alarm indicating an error in the tunnel OAM CCM
information. This alarm is reported when the sink NE receives a CCM packet with an unexpected
MEP ID.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, services are interrupted or the sink NE receives CCM packets of other
tunnels.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 581


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Possible Causes
MEP IDs are inconsistent between NEs at both ends of the tunnel.

Procedure
Step 1 MEP IDs are inconsistent between NEs at both ends of the tunnel.
1. Check whether the remote MEP ID on the source NE is correctly configured with the MEP
ID of the sink NE. If not, reconfigure the remote MEP ID on the source NE.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.216 MPLS_TUNNEL_UNEXPPER

Description
The MPLS_TUNNEL_UNEXPPER is an alarm indicating that the tunnel does not receive the
CCM packet in the expected period. This alarm is reported when the sink NE of the PW receives
a CCM packet with correct MEG level, MEG ID, and MEP ID but in an unexpected period.

For example, the transmit interval is set to 10 ms on the source and sink NEs, but the sink NE
receives the CCM packet from the source NE after 20 ms.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, services are interrupted or the sink NE receives CCM packets of other
tunnels.

Possible Causes
CCM packet periods are inconsistent between the source and sink NEs at both ends of the tunnel.

Procedure
Step 1 CCM packet periods are inconsistent between the source and sink NEs at both ends of the tunnel.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 582


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

1. Check whether tunnel configurations are consistent between the source and sink NEs. CCM
packet periods on NEs at both ends of a PW must be set to the same value. For details, see
Querying MPLS Tunnel Information.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.217 MPLS_TUNNEL_UNKNOWN

Description
The MPLS_TUNNEL_UNKNOWN is an alarm indicating that certain unknown defects exist
on the tunnel. This alarm is reported when the port receives the CV packets and the FFD packets.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the OAM function is affected.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The OAM settings differ at the two ends.
l Cause 2: The NE receives packets from an unknown source.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The OAM settings differ at the two ends.
1. If the MPLS_TUNNEL_UNKNOWN alarm is reported transiently, check whether Tunnel
OAM configuration is changed on the local NE and the opposite NE.
2. If the local NE and the opposite NE have different Tunnel OAM configuration, the
MPLS_TUNNEL_UNKNOWN alarm is reported transiently and then the
MPLS_TUNNEL_LOCV alarm is reported. Ensure that both ends have the same Tunnel
OAM configuration. Then, check whether the alarm is cleared.

Step 2 Cause 2: The NE receives packets from an unknown source.


1. Check whether there is any service configured between the NE and an unknown source, or
whether the NE is connected to an unknown source.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 583


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

2. If yes, modify the incorrect configuration or reconnect the fibers.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.218 MS_AIS

Description
The MS_AIS is an alarm indicating multiplex section alarms. This alarm is reported when the
board detects that bits 6-8 of the K2 byte in the three consecutive frames are 111.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The services on the line port are interrupted. If the services are configured with protection,
protection switching may be triggered.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The transmit unit of the opposite station is faulty.
l Cause 2: The receive unit of the local site is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The transmit unit of the opposite station is faulty.
1. Replace the line board at the opposite site based on the type of the alarmed board.

If... Then...
The line board reports the alarm Replace the line board at the opposite end.
The IF board reports the alarm Replace the IF board at the opposite end.
2. Replace the board and then check whether the alarm is cleared.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared after replacement End the fault handling.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 584


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The alarm persists after replacement Go to the next step.

3. Replace the system control, cross-connect, and timing board at the opposite end.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared after the board replacement End the fault handling.
The alarm persists after the board replacement Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The receive unit of the local site is faulty.


1. Replace the alarmed board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.219 MS_CROSSTR

Description
The MS_CROSSTR is an alarm indicating that a performance indicator of the multiplex section
crosses the threshold. This alarm is reported when the board detects that the MS BER
performance indicator crosses the preset threshold.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Minor Service alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the performance monitoring period:

l 0x01: 15 minutes
l 0x02: 24 hours

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 585


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Parameter 2 is always 0x00. Parameter 3 indicate the ID of a
performance event that causes the alarm and has the following
meanings:

l 0x10: MSBBE
l 0x11: MSES
l 0x12: MSSES
l 0x13: MSFEBBE
l 0x14: MSFEES
l 0x15: MSFESES
l 0x16: MSUAS
l 0x17: MSCSES
l 0x18: MSFECSES
l 0x21: MSFEUAS

Impact on the System


A large number of bit errors occur in the services, and the services may be interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Services are interrupted for a long time.
l Cause 2: The MS BER performance indicator crosses the preset threshold.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Services are interrupted for a long time.
NOTE
Handle the alarm as follows if the value of parameter 3 is 0x16:
1. Check whether fibers are properly connected. If not, connect the fibers again according to
planning information.
2. Check whether cross-connections are configured for service ports. If not, configure cross-
connections again according to planning information.

Step 2 Cause 2: The MS BER performance indicator crosses the preset threshold.
1. Check the threshold crossing records of MS BER performance events to find out the
performance event that crosses the preset threshold. For details, see 4.3.5 Browsing the
Performance Event Threshold-Crossing Records.
2. Handle the performance event that crosses the threshold.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 586


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.220 MS_RDI

Description
The MS_RDI is an alarm indicating that data reception at the remote end of the multiplex section
fails. This alarm is reported when the board detects that bits 6-8 of the K2 byte are 110.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The services on the local site are not affected. The services received by the opposite station,
however, are interrupted.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The local site receives a message from the opposite station, and the message indicates
that data reception at the remote end of the multiplex section fails.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The local site receives a message from the opposite station, and the message indicates
that data reception at the remote end of the multiplex section fails.
1. Rectify the fault that occurs on the opposite station.

The possible alarms are as follows:

l MS_AIS
l R_LOS
l R_LOF
l B2_EXC
l B2_SD

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.221 MS_REI

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 587


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Description
The MS_REI is an alarm indicating that bit errors occur on the remote end of the multiplex
section. This alarm is reported when the board detects that the M1 byte is non-zero.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Warning Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The services on the local site are not affected. The services received by the opposite station,
however, has bit errors.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The local site receives a message from the opposite station, and the message indicates
that bit errors occur on the remote end of the multiplex section.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The local site receives a message from the opposite station, and the message indicates
that bit errors occur on the remote end of the multiplex section.
1. Handle the MS_BBE performance event on the port of the opposite station.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.222 MSAD_CROSSTR

Description
The MSAD_CROSSTR is an alarm indicating that the adaptation performance indicator of the
multiplex section crosses the threshold. This alarm is reported when the board detects that an
AU pointer adaptation performance indicator crosses the preset threshold.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Service alarm

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 588


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the performance monitoring period:

l 0x01: 15 minutes
l 0x02: 24 hours
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of a performance event that causes the alarm.

l 0x2a: AUPJCHIGH
l 0x2b: AUPJCLOW
l 0x2c: AUPJCNEW

Impact on the System


Bit errors may occur in the services.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: An AU pointer adaptation performance indicator crosses the preset threshold.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: An AU pointer adaptation performance indicator crosses the preset threshold.
1. Check the threshold crossing records of the AU pointer adaptation performance events to
find out the performance event that crosses the preset threshold. For details, see 4.3.5
Browsing the Performance Event Threshold-Crossing Records.
2. Handle the performance event that crosses the threshold.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.223 MULTI_RPL_OWNER

Description
The MULTI_RPL_OWNER is an alarm indicating that the ring network contains several
RPL_OWNER nodes.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 589


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Processing alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1, Parameter 2 Indicate the ID of the ERPS instance.

Impact on the System


The ERPS protection fails and the services configured on the Ethernet ring are interrupted.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The related data is configured incorrectly.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The related data is configured incorrectly.
1. Reconfigure the ERPS protection. For details, see Creating Ethernet Ring Protection
Instances.

----End

Related Information
The following table describes the meanings of the parameters in the MULTI_RPL_OWNER
alarm reported by the EMS6.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 to Parameter 4 Indicates the port ID.

Parameter 5, Parameter 6 Indicate the ID of the ERPS instance.

A.3.224 MW_AM_TEST

Description
The MW_AM_TEST is an alarm indicating that the IF port is in the AM testing state.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 590


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Minor Other alarms

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The transmission capacity is reduced during the AM test, and services with low priorities may
be interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause: The AM testing is enabled.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause: The AM testing is enabled.
1. After the AM testing ends, disable the AM testing.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.225 MW_BER_EXC

Description
The MW_BER_EXC is an alarm indicating that excessive bit errors occur on the radio link. This
alarm is reported when the bit errors on the radio link exceed the specified threshold (10-3 by
default).

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Minor Service alarm

Parameters
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 591


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Impact on the System


When the MW_BER_EXC alarm occurs, the service on the port is interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Signal attenuation on the radio link is very heavy.
l Cause 2: The transmit unit of the opposite station is faulty.
l Cause 3: The receive unit of the local site is faulty.
l Cause 4: An interference event occurs.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Signal attenuation on the radio link is very heavy.
1. At the local end, check whether the receive power of the ODU is normal. If yes, determine
the abnormality and take proper measures. For details, see 4.4.1 Querying the Historical
Transmit Power and Receive Power

If... Then...

The RSL is lower than the receiver Follow the steps:


sensitivity
1. Check the installation of the antenna to ensure
that the azimuth of the antenna meets the
requirement.
2. Check the antenna direction. Check whether
the received signal is from the main lobe.
If the antenna direction does not meet the
requirement, adjust the antenna in a wide
range.
3. Check whether the setting of the polarization
direction of the antenna is correct. Adjust the
incorrect polarization direction.
4. Check whether the antenna gain at both the
transmit and receive ends meets the
specifications. Replace the antennas that do
not meet the requirement.
5. Check whether any mountain or building
obstacle exists in the transmit direction.
If yes, contact the network planning
department for proper modification of the
planning design, hence preventing the block
of the mountain or building obstacle.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 592


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...

The RSL is higher than the specified RSL Slow up fading occurs. Follow the steps:
of the network. The offset value is tens of
decibels. The duration is from tens of 1. Follow instructions in 8.1.2 Scanning
seconds to several hours. Interfering Signals to scan the frequency
spectrum around the radio link and check for
co-frequency interference and bias-
frequency interference.
2. Use a spectrum analyzer to analyze the
interference source.
3. Contact the spectrum management
department to clear the interference spectrum
or change plans to minimize the interference.

The RSL is lower than the specified RSL Slow down fading occurs. Generally, the radio
of the network. The offset value is tens of link may be faulty in both directions, because
decibels. The duration is from tens of slow fading is imposed by the transmission path.
seconds to several hours. Contact the network planning department to
make the following changes:

l Increase the installation height of the antenna.


l Reduce the transmission distance.
l Increase the antenna gain.
l Increase the transmit power.

If the RSL is lower than or higher than Fast fading occurs. Contact the network planning
the specified RSL of the network and if department to make the following changes:
the duration is from several milliseconds
to tens of seconds. l Adjust the position of the antenna to block the
reflected wave or make the reflection point
fall on the ground that has a small reflection
coefficient, therefore reducing the multipath
fading.
l Adjust the RF configuration to make the links
in the 1+1 SD configuration.
l If the links are configured with the 1+1 SD
protection, adjust the height offset between
two antennas to make the receive power of
one antenna stronger than the receive power
of the other antenna.
l Increase the fading margin.

Step 2 Cause 2: The transmit unit of the opposite station is faulty.

Locate the fault by looping back the opposite station and excluding the position one by one.
Follow the steps:

1. Perform an inloop on the IF port at the opposite end. For details, see 8.4.7 Setting Loopback
for the IF Board. Check whether the fault at the opposite end is rectified after the loopback.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 593


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The fault at the opposite end is not rectified Replace the IF board.
The fault at the opposite end is rectified Go to the next step.

2. Check whether the cable connector is prepared according to the requirement. If any cable
connector does not meet the requirement, make a new connector.
3. Check whether the IF cable is wet, broken, or pressed. Replace the cable that does not meet
the requirement.
4. Then, check whether the fault at the opposite end is rectified.

If... Then...
The fault at the opposite end is not rectified Replace the ODU at the opposite end.
The fault at the opposite end is rectified End the alarm handling.

Step 3 Cause 3: The receive unit of the local site is faulty.

Locate the fault by looping back the opposite station and excluding the position one by one.
Follow the steps:

1. Perform an inloop on the IF port at the local end. For details, see 8.4.7 Setting Loopback
for the IF Board. Check whether the fault at the local end is rectified after the loopback.

If... Then...
The fault at the opposite end is not rectified Replace the IF board.
The fault at the opposite end is rectified Go to the next step.

2. Check whether the cable connector is prepared according to the requirement. If any cable
connector does not meet the requirement, make a new connector.
3. Check whether the IF cable is wet, broken, or pressed. Replace the cable that does not meet
the requirement.
4. Then, check whether the fault at the opposite end is rectified.

If... Then...
The fault at the opposite end is not rectified Replace the ODU at the local end.
The fault at the opposite end is rectified End the alarm handling.

Step 4 Cause 4: An interference event occurs.


1. Follow instructions in 8.1.2 Scanning Interfering Signals to scan the frequency spectrum
around the radio link and check for co-frequency interference and bias-frequency
interference.
2. Use a spectrum analyzer to analyze the interference source.
3. Contact the spectrum management department to clear the interference spectrum or change
plans to minimize the interference.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 594


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Related Information
None.

A.3.226 MW_BER_SD

Description
The MW_BER_SD is an alarm indicating that signal deteriorates on the radio link. This alarm
is reported when the bit errors on the radio link exceed the specified threshold (10-6 by default)
but does not reach the MW_BER_EXC alarm threshold (10-3 by default).

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Service alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The service performance on the port deteriorates. If the equipment is configured with 1+1 FD/
SD protection, switching on the channel side may be triggered.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Signal attenuation on the radio link is very heavy.
l Cause 2: The transmit unit of the opposite station is faulty.
l Cause 3: The receive unit of the local site is faulty.
l Cause 4: An interference event occurs.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Signal attenuation on the radio link is very heavy.
1. At the local end, check whether the receive power of the ODU is normal. If yes, determine
the abnormality and take proper measures. For details, see 4.4.1 Querying the Historical
Transmit Power and Receive Power

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 595


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...

The RSL is lower than the receiver Follow the steps:


sensitivity
1. Check the installation of the antenna to ensure
that the azimuth of the antenna meets the
requirement.
2. Check the antenna direction. Check whether
the received signal is from the main lobe.
If the antenna direction does not meet the
requirement, adjust the antenna in a wide
range.
3. Check whether the setting of the polarization
direction of the antenna is correct. Adjust the
incorrect polarization direction.
4. Check whether the antenna gain at both the
transmit and receive ends meets the
specifications. Replace the antennas that do
not meet the requirement.
5. Check whether any mountain or building
obstacle exists in the transmit direction.
If yes, contact the network planning
department for proper modification of the
planning design, hence preventing the block
of the mountain or building obstacle.

The RSL is higher than the specified RSL Slow up fading occurs. Follow the steps:
of the network. The offset value is tens of
decibels. The duration is from tens of 1. Follow instructions in 8.1.2 Scanning
seconds to several hours. Interfering Signals to scan the frequency
spectrum around the radio link and check for
co-frequency interference and bias-
frequency interference.
2. Use a spectrum analyzer to analyze the
interference source.
3. Contact the spectrum management
department to clear the interference spectrum
or change plans to minimize the interference.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 596


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...

The RSL is lower than the specified RSL Slow down fading occurs. Generally, the radio
of the network. The offset value is tens of link may be faulty in both directions, because
decibels. The duration is from tens of slow fading is imposed by the transmission path.
seconds to several hours. Contact the network planning department to
make the following changes:

l Increase the installation height of the antenna.


l Reduce the transmission distance.
l Increase the antenna gain.
l Increase the transmit power.

If the RSL is lower than or higher than Fast fading occurs. Contact the network planning
the specified RSL of the network and if department to make the following changes:
the duration is from several milliseconds
to tens of seconds. l Adjust the position of the antenna to block the
reflected wave or make the reflection point
fall on the ground that has a small reflection
coefficient, therefore reducing the multipath
fading.
l Adjust the RF configuration to make the links
in the 1+1 SD configuration.
l If the links are configured with the 1+1 SD
protection, adjust the height offset between
two antennas to make the receive power of
one antenna stronger than the receive power
of the other antenna.
l Increase the fading margin.

Step 2 Cause 2: The transmit unit of the opposite station is faulty.

Locate the fault by looping back the opposite station and excluding the position one by one.
Follow the steps:

1. Perform an inloop on the IF port at the opposite end. For details, see 8.4.7 Setting Loopback
for the IF Board. Check whether the fault at the opposite end is rectified after the loopback.

If... Then...
The fault at the opposite end is not rectified Replace the IF board.
The fault at the opposite end is rectified Go to the next step.
2. Check whether the cable connector is prepared according to the requirement. If any cable
connector does not meet the requirement, make a new connector.
3. Check whether the IF cable is wet, broken, or pressed. Replace the cable that does not meet
the requirement.
4. Then, check whether the fault at the opposite end is rectified.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 597


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The fault at the opposite end is not rectified Replace the ODU at the opposite end.
The fault at the opposite end is rectified End the alarm handling.

Step 3 Cause 3: The receive unit of the local site is faulty.

Locate the fault by looping back the opposite station and excluding the position one by one.
Follow the steps:

1. Perform an inloop on the IF port at the local end. For details, see 8.4.7 Setting Loopback
for the IF Board. Check whether the fault at the local end is rectified after the loopback.

If... Then...
The fault at the opposite end is not rectified Replace the IF board.
The fault at the opposite end is rectified Go to the next step.

2. Check whether the cable connector is prepared according to the requirement. If any cable
connector does not meet the requirement, make a new connector.
3. Check whether the IF cable is wet, broken, or pressed. Replace the cable that does not meet
the requirement.
4. Then, check whether the fault at the opposite end is rectified.

If... Then...
The fault at the opposite end is not rectified Replace the ODU at the local end.
The fault at the opposite end is rectified End the alarm handling.

Step 4 Cause 4: An interference event occurs.


1. Check whether any co-channel interference occurs.

a. Mute the ODU at the opposite end.


b. Check the RSL at the local end. For details, see Configuring a Single-Hop Radio Link.
If the RSL exceeds -90 dBm, it indicates that there is co-channel interference that may
affect the long-term availability and errored-second performance of the system.
2. Follow instructions in 8.1.2 Scanning Interfering Signals to scan the frequency spectrum
around the radio link and check for co-frequency interference and bias-frequency
interference.
3. Use a spectrum analyzer to analyze the interference source.
4. Contact the spectrum management department to clear the interference spectrum or change
plans to minimize the interference.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 598


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.227 MW_CFG_MISMATCH

Description
The MW_CFG_MISMATCH is an alarm of configuration mismatch on radio links. This alarm
occurs when an NE detects configuration mismatch on both ends of a radio link. For example,
the number of E1 signals, the number of STM-1 signals, AM enabling, 1588 overhead enabling,
modulation mode may be configured differently on both ends of a radio link.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Critical Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the cause of the fault.

l 0x01: The number of E1 signals or the E1 timeslot priority at the local end
of a radio link is different from that at the other end.
l 0x02: The AM enabling is different.
l 0x03: The 1588 overhead enabling is different.
l 0x04: The modulation mode is different.
l 0x05: The service mode is different.
l 0x06: The number of STM-1 signals is different.
l 0x09: The IP header compression enabling is different.
Parameter 2 When the value of Parameter 1 is 0x09:

l 0x01: The air interface compression at L2 is different.


l 0x02: The air interface compression at L3 is different.

When Parameter 1 takes another value, Parameter 2 is reserved.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the service configuration cannot take effect or services are interrupted.
After the NE is power cycled or reset, this alarm may still affect services.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 599


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The number of E1 signals or the E1 timeslot priority at the local end of a radio
link is different from that at the other end.
l Cause 2: The AM enabling is different on both ends of a radio link.
l Cause 3: The 1588 overhead enabling is different on both ends of a radio link.
l Cause 4: The modulation mode is different on both ends of a radio link.
l Cause 5: The service mode is different on both ends of a radio link.
l Cause 6: The IP header compression is different on both ends of a radio link.
l Cause 7: The air interface compression at L2 or L3 is different.
l Cause 8: The number of STM-1 signals is different on both ends of a radio link.

Procedure
Step 1 Determine the possible cause of the alarm according to the alarm parameters.

Step 2 Check the configuration on both ends of the radio link. Ensure that the configuration is the same
on both ends of the radio link. For details, see Managing Radio Links.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.228 MW_CONT_WAVE

Description
The MW_CONT_WAVE is an alarm of continuous wave. This alarm occurs if the continuous
wave is output by the IF board.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Minor Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


If the continuous wave function is enabled, radio links cannot transmit services.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The continuous wave function is enabled.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 600


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

l Cause 2: The MW_LOF alarm exists on the radio link and an outloop is performed on the
IF port or composite port.
l Cause 3: The IF unit is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The continuous wave function is enabled.
1. Disable the continuous wave function. For details, see Setting IF Attributes.

Step 2 Cause 2: The MW_LOF alarm exists on the radio link and an outloop is performed on the IF
port or composite port.
1. Release the loopback by referring to 8.4.7 Setting Loopback for the IF Board.
2. Clear the MW_LOF alarm.

Step 3 Cause 3: The IF unit is faulty.


1. 6.8 Replacing the IF Board.

----End

Related Information
The continuous wave function tests the frequency stability and frequency consistency and should
be disabled after a test is completed.

A.3.229 MW_E1_LOST

Description
The MW_E1_LOST is an alarm indicating that E1 services are lost. When the AM modulation
scheme is downshifted, this alarm is reported by the discarded E1 services.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the timeslots of E1 services.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 601


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Impact on the System


Some E1 services are lost.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The AM downshifts the modulation scheme.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The AM downshifts the modulation scheme.
1. Handle the alarm according to AM_DOWNSHIFT.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.230 MW_FEC_UNCOR

Description
The MW_FEC_UNCOR is an alarm indicating that radio frames forward error correction (FEC)
encoding cannot be corrected.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


Bit errors occur in the services. If the equipment is configured with 1+1 FD/SD protection, HSM
channel protection switching may be triggered.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Signal attenuation on the radio link is very heavy.
l Cause 2: The transmit unit of the opposite station is faulty.
l Cause 3: The receive unit of the local site is faulty.
l Cause 4: An interference event occurs.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 602


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Signal attenuation on the radio link is very heavy.
1. At the local end, check whether the receive power of the ODU is normal. If yes, determine
the abnormality and take proper measures. For details, see 4.4.1 Querying the Historical
Transmit Power and Receive Power.

If... Then...

The RSL is lower than the receiver Follow the steps:


sensitivity
1. Check the installation of the antenna to ensure
that the azimuth of the antenna meets the
requirement.
2. Check the antenna direction. Check whether
the received signal is from the main lobe.
If the antenna direction does not meet the
requirement, adjust the antenna in a wide
range.
3. Check whether the setting of the polarization
direction of the antenna is correct. Adjust the
incorrect polarization direction.
4. Check whether the antenna gain at both the
transmit and receive ends meets the
specifications. Replace the antennas that do
not meet the requirement.
5. Check whether any mountain or building
obstacle exists in the transmit direction.
If yes, contact the network planning
department for proper modification of the
planning design, hence preventing the block
of the mountain or building obstacle.

The RSL is higher than the specified RSL Slow up fading occurs. Follow the steps:
of the network. The offset value is tens of
decibels. The duration is from tens of 1. Check whether intra-frequency or inter-
seconds to several hours. frequency interference exists by scanning
frequency spectra in microwave channels.
For details, see 8.1.2 Scanning Interfering
Signals.
2. Use a spectrum analyzer to analyze the
interference source.
3. Contact the spectrum management
department to clear the interference spectrum
or change plans to minimize the interference.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 603


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...

The RSL is lower than the specified RSL Slow down fading occurs. Generally, the radio
of the network. The offset value is tens of link may be faulty in both directions, because
decibels. The duration is from tens of slow fading is imposed by the transmission path.
seconds to several hours. Contact the network planning department to
make the following changes:

l Increase the installation height of the antenna.


l Reduce the transmission distance.
l Increase the antenna gain.
l Increase the transmit power.

If the RSL is lower than or higher than Fast fading occurs. Contact the network planning
the specified RSL of the network and if department to make the following changes:
the duration is from several milliseconds
to tens of seconds. l Adjust the position of the antenna to block the
reflected wave or make the reflection point
fall on the ground that has a small reflection
coefficient, therefore reducing the multipath
fading.
l Adjust the RF configuration to make the links
in the 1+1 SD configuration.
l If the links are configured with the 1+1 SD
protection, adjust the height offset between
two antennas to make the receive power of
one antenna stronger than the receive power
of the other antenna.
l Increase the fading margin.

Step 2 Cause 2: The transmit unit of the opposite station is faulty.

Locate the fault by looping back the opposite station and excluding the position one by one.
Follow the steps:

1. Perform an inloop on the IF port at the opposite end. For details, see 8.4.7 Setting Loopback
for the IF Board. Check whether the fault at the opposite end is rectified after the loopback.

If... Then...
The fault at the opposite end is not rectified Replace the IF board.
The fault at the opposite end is rectified Go to the next step.
2. Check whether the cable connector is prepared according to the requirement. If any cable
connector does not meet the requirement, make a new connector.
3. Check whether the IF cable is wet, broken, or pressed. Replace the cable that does not meet
the requirement.
4. Then, check whether the fault at the opposite end is rectified.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 604


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The fault at the opposite end is not rectified Replace the ODU at the opposite end.
The fault at the opposite end is rectified End the alarm handling.

Step 3 Cause 3: The receive unit of the local site is faulty.

Locate the fault by looping back the opposite station and excluding the position one by one.
Follow the steps:

1. Perform an inloop on the IF port at the local end. For details, see 8.4.7 Setting Loopback
for the IF Board. Check whether the fault at the local end is rectified after the loopback.

If... Then...
The fault at the opposite end is not rectified Replace the IF board.
The fault at the opposite end is rectified Go to the next step.

2. Check whether the cable connector is prepared according to the requirement. If any cable
connector does not meet the requirement, make a new connector.
3. Check whether the IF cable is wet, broken, or pressed. Replace the cable that does not meet
the requirement.
4. Then, check whether the fault at the opposite end is rectified.

If... Then...
The fault at the opposite end is not rectified Replace the ODU at the local end.
The fault at the opposite end is rectified End the alarm handling.

Step 4 Cause 4: An interference event occurs.


1. Check for co-channel interference. For details, see 8.1.2 Scanning Interfering Signals.
2. Use a spectrum analyzer to analyze the interference source.
3. Contact the spectrum management department to clear the interference spectrum or change
plans to minimize the interference.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.231 MW_LIM

Description
The MW_LIM is an alarm indicating that a mismatched radio link identifier is detected. This
alarm is reported if an IF board detects that the link ID in the radio frame overheads is inconsistent
with the specified link ID.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 605


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


After the IDU IF board reports the MW_LIM alarm, the IF board inserts the AIS alarm into the
received signal. Then, the services on the radio link are interrupted. If the services are configured
with SNCP, protection switching may be triggered.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The link ID of the local site does not match with the link ID of the opposite station.
l Cause 2: The services on other radio links are received due to the incorrect configuration
of the radio link receive frequency at the local or opposite station.
l Cause 3: The antenna receives the radio signals from the other stations, because the
direction of the antenna is set incorrectly.
l Cause 4: The polarization direction of the XPIC is incorrect.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The link ID of the local site does not match with the link ID of the opposite station.
1. Check whether the link ID of the local site matches with the link ID of the opposite station.
For details, see Configuring a Single-Hop Radio Link. If not, set the link IDs of the two
stations to the same value according to the requirements of the networking planning.

Step 2 Cause 2: The services on other radio links are received due to the incorrect configuration of the
radio link receive frequency at the local or opposite station.
1. Check whether the receive and transmit frequencies of the local site are consistent with the
receive and transmit frequencies of the opposite station. For details, see Configuring a
Single-Hop Radio Link. If not, set the receive and transmit frequencies of the two stations
again.

Step 3 Cause 3: The antenna receives radio signals from the other stations, because the direction of the
antenna is set incorrectly.
1. Adjust the direction of the antenna and ensure that the antennas at both ends are aligned.

Step 4 Cause 4: The polarization direction of the XPIC is incorrect.


1. If XPIC protection groups are configured, check whether the XPIC configuration is correct.
For details, see Configuring a Single-Hop Radio Link.
a. Check whether the settings of XPIC IF board in polarization direction-V and
polarization direction-H meet the requirement of the planning.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 606


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...

The polarization direction does not meet Delete the working XPIC group that is
the requirement of the planning configured incorrectly and create the
other working XPIC group again.

The polarization direction meets the Go to the next step.


requirement of the planning

b. Check whether Link ID-V and Link ID-H meet the requirement of the planning.

If... Then...

The link ID does not meet the Reset the ID of the radio link of the XPIC
requirement of the planning IF board according to the planning. For
details, see Creating an XPIC Working
Group.

The link ID meets the requirement of the Go to the next step.


planning

2. Check and modify the XPIC IF board and ODU, and the mapping relationship between the
ODU and the feed bottom. Ensure that the XPIC IF board in the polarization direction V
of the two ends are interconnected with each other through the radio link in the polarization
direction V, and the XPIC IF board in the polarization direction H of the two ends are
interconnected with each other through the radio link in the polarization direction H.

----End

Related Information
The MW_LIM alarm is generated due to the inconsistency between the specified link ID and
the received link ID. When the MW_LOF alarm is generated on the link, the received link ID
is a random value. In this case, the link ID is invalid. The MW_LIM alarm is also suppressed
by the MW_LOF alarm.

A.3.232 MW_LOF
Description
The MW_LOF is an alarm indicating that the radio frame is lost.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Critical Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 607


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Impact on the System


The services are interrupted. If the system is configured with protection, protection switching
may be triggered.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The other alarms are generated.
l Cause 2: In the case of TDM radio services, the IF working modes at the local site and the
opposite station are different. In the case of services, the channel bandwidth and modulation
modes at the local site and the opposite station are different.
l Cause 3: The operating frequency of the ODU at the local site is inconsistent with the
operating frequency of the ODU at the opposite station.
l Cause 4: The transmit unit of the opposite station is faulty.
l Cause 5: The receive unit of the local site is faulty.
l Cause 6: The receive power of the ODU is abnormal.
l Cause 7: An interference event occurs.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The other alarms are generated.
1. Check whether any alarms are generated in the equipment of the local site. If yes, take
priority to clear them.
The relevant alarms are as follows:
l HARD_BAD
l VOLT_LOS
l IF_CABLE_OPEN
l BD_STATUS
l RADIO_RSL_LOW
l CONFIG_NOSUPPORT
l TEMP_ALARM

Step 2 Cause 2: In the case of TDM radio services, the IF working modes at the local site and the
opposite station are different. In the case of services, the channel bandwidth and modulation
modes at the local site and the opposite station are different.
1. In the case of TDM radio services, check whether the working mode of the IF board at the
local site is consistent with the working mode of the IF board at the opposite station. For
details, see Configuring a Single-Hop Radio Link. If not, reset the working mode of the IF
board according to the network planning.

In the case of Hybrid radio services, check whether the channel bandwidth and modulation
modes are the same at both ends. If not, change the channel bandwidth and modulation
modes according to the network planning. For details, see Configuring a Single-Hop Radio
Link.

Step 3 Cause 3: The operating frequency of the ODU at the local site is inconsistent with the operating
frequency of the ODU at the opposite station.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 608


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

1. Ensure that the type of the ODU at the local site is consistent with the type of the ODU at
the opposite station.
2. Reset the operating frequency of the ODU according to the network planning. For details,
see Setting ODU Transmit Frequency Attributes.
Set the transmit frequency of the local site to the same as the receive frequency of the
opposite station. Then, set the receive frequency of the local site to the same as the transmit
frequency of the opposite station.

Step 4 Cause 4: The transmit unit of the opposite station is faulty.


1. Check whether any alarms are generated in the equipment of the local site. If yes, take
priority to clear them.
The relevant alarms are as follows:
l HARD_BAD
l BD_STATUS
l VOLT_LOS
l IF_CABLE_OPEN
l RADIO_MUTE
l RADIO_TSL_HIGH
l RADIO_TSL_LOW
l TEMP_ALARM
2. Locate the fault by looping back the opposite station.

Follow the steps:

a. Perform an inloop on the IF port at the opposite end. For details, see 8.4.7 Setting
Loopback for the IF Board and . Check whether the fault at the opposite end is
rectified after the loopback.

If... Then...
The fault at the opposite end is not rectified Replace the IF board.
The fault at the opposite end is rectified Go to the next step.
b. Check whether the cable connector is prepared according to the requirement. If any
cable connector does not meet the requirement, make a new connector.
c. Check whether the IF cable is wet, broken, or pressed. Replace the cable that does not
meet the requirement.
d. Then, check whether the fault at the opposite end is rectified.

If... Then...
The fault at the opposite end is not Replace the ODU at the opposite end.
rectified
The fault at the opposite end is rectified End the alarm handling.

Step 5 Cause 5: The receive unit of the local site is faulty.


1. Locate the fault by looping back the opposite station.

Follow the steps:

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 609


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

a. Perform an inloop on the IF port at the local end. For details, see 8.4.7 Setting
Loopback for the IF Board and . Check whether the fault at the local end is rectified
after the loopback.

If... Then...
The fault at the opposite end is not rectified Replace the IF board.
The fault at the opposite end is rectified Go to the next step.
b. Check whether the cable connector is prepared according to the requirement. If any
cable connector does not meet the requirement, make a new connector.
c. Check whether the IF cable is wet, broken, or pressed. Replace the cable that does not
meet the requirement.
d. Check whether the fault at the local end is rectified.

Step 6 Cause 6: The receive power of the ODU is abnormal.


1. At the local site, check whether the receive power of the ODU is abnormal. For details, see
Browse history performance events. If yes, determine the abnormality and take proper
measures.

If... Then...

The RSL is lower than the receiver Follow the steps:


sensitivity
1. Check the installation of the antenna to ensure
that the azimuth of the antenna meets the
requirement.
2. Check the antenna direction. Check whether
the received signal is from the main lobe.
If the antenna direction does not meet the
requirement, adjust the antenna in a wide
range.
3. Check whether the setting of the polarization
direction of the antenna is correct. Adjust the
incorrect polarization direction.
4. Check whether the antenna gain at both the
transmit and receive ends meets the
specifications. Replace the antennas that do
not meet the requirement.
5. Check whether any mountain or building
obstacle exists in the transmit direction.
If yes, contact the network planning
department for proper modification of the
planning design, hence preventing the block
of the mountain or building obstacle.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 610


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...

The RSL is higher than the specified RSL Slow up fading occurs. Follow the steps:
of the network. The offset value is tens of
decibels. The duration is from tens of 1. Check for co-channel interference. For
seconds to several hours. details, see 8.1.2 Scanning Interfering
Signals.
2. Use a spectrum analyzer to analyze the
interference source.
3. Contact the spectrum management
department to clear the interference spectrum
or change plans to minimize the interference.

The RSL is lower than the specified RSL Slow down fading occurs. Generally, the radio
of the network. The offset value is tens of link may be faulty in both directions, because
decibels. The duration is from tens of slow fading is imposed by the transmission path.
seconds to several hours. Contact the network planning department to
make the following changes:

l Increase the installation height of the antenna.


l Reduce the transmission distance.
l Increase the antenna gain.
l Increase the transmit power.

If the RSL is lower than or higher than Fast fading occurs. Contact the network planning
the specified RSL of the network and if department to make the following changes:
the duration is from several milliseconds
to tens of seconds. l Adjust the position of the antenna to block the
reflected wave or make the reflection point
fall on the ground that has a small reflection
coefficient, therefore reducing the multipath
fading.
l Adjust the RF configuration to make the links
in the 1+1 SD configuration.
l If the links are configured with the 1+1 SD
protection, adjust the height offset between
two antennas to make the receive power of
one antenna stronger than the receive power
of the other antenna.
l Increase the fading margin.

Step 7 Cause 7: An interference event occurs.


Follow the steps:
1. Check for co-channel interference. For details, see 8.1.2 Scanning Interfering Signals.
2. Use a spectrum analyzer to analyze the interference source.
3. Contact the spectrum management department to clear the interference spectrum or change
plans to minimize the interference.
----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 611


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Related Information
None.

A.3.233 MW_RDI

Description
The MW_RDI is an alarm indicating that there are defects at the remote end of the radio link.
This alarm is reported when the IF board detects an RDI in the radio frame overheads.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


If the local site is configured with the reverse switching function, the 1+1 switching is triggered
on the IF board when the working and protection IF boards receive the MW_RDI alarm at the
same time. This alarm also indicates that the services received by the opposite station are
interrupted.

Possible Causes
After detecting a service alarm that is caused by the fault in a radio link, the receive station
returns a radio link fault indication to the transmit station.

Procedure
Step 1 Clear the radio alarms that occur at the opposite station. The possible alarms are as follows:
l MW_LOF
l R_LOF
l R_LOC
l MW_FEC_UNCOR
l XPIC_LOS
l MW_BER_SD
l MW_BER_EXC

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 612


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.234 NEIP_CONFUSION

Description
The NEIP_CONFUSION alarm indicates an IP address conflict.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 to Parameter 4 Indicate the IP address.

Impact on the System


The NEs associated with the IP address may be unreachable to the NMS.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: An IP address conflict occurs on the network.

Procedure
Step 1 Modify IP addresses for the affected NEs according to the network plan.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.235 NESF_LOST

Description
The NESF_LOST is an alarm indicating that the NE software is lost. This alarm is reported when
the system control, cross-connect, and timing board detects that the NE software is lost.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 613


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Critical Processing alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 The value is always 0x01.

Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of the routine inspection object.

Parameter 4 Indicates the specific alarm cause when a different bit is 1.

l 0x01: If the first bit is 1, it indicates that the file does not exist.
l 0x02: If the second bit is 1, it indicates that verification of the
file fails.

Impact on the System


If the NE software does not exist in the active and standby areas, an NE cannot be restarted after
it is powered off or reset.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: No new NE software is loaded after the existing NE software is erased.
l Cause 2: Loading the NE software is unsuccessful.
l Cause 3: A certain board is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: No new NE software is loaded after the existing NE software is erased.

Cause 2: Loading the NE software is unsuccessful.

1. Check whether the alarm is caused by the loading operation.

If... Then...
The alarm is caused by the loading Contact the Huawei technical support
operation engineers to reload the software.
The alarm is not caused by the loading Go to the next step.
operation

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 614


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Step 2 Cause 3: A certain board is faulty.


1. For details, see 6.10 Replacing the System Control, Switching and Timing Board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.236 NESOFT_MM

Description
The NESOFT_MM is an alarm indicating that the first software system is different from the
second software system. This alarm is reported when the NE detects that the first software system
and the second software system of the system control, cross-connect, and timing board mismatch
with each other.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Processing alarm

Parameters

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the location of the file.
l 0x01: the files in the flash memory
l 0x02: the software that is currently running
l 0x03: the software in the CF card
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the IDs of the inconsistent files in the flash memory of the
system control board if the value of Parameter 1 is 0x01,

Indicate the IDs of the inconsistent files in the currently running


software if the value of Parameter 1 is 0x02.

Parameter 4 Indicate the cause of the alarm.


l 0x04: The file versions in the master and slave areas of a single
system control board are inconsistent.
l 0x08: The file versions in the active and standby system control
boards are inconsistent.
l 0x0c: The file versions in the master and slave areas of a single
system control board are inconsistent and the file versions on
the active and standby system control boards are also
inconsistent.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 615


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Impact on the System


l This alarm affects active/standby switching of system control boards if the active and
standby system control boards have different NE software versions.
l If no NE software exists in the flash memory, the system is unable to restart after power-
off or reset.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The software running on the active and standby SCC boards has different versions.
l Cause 2: The software stored in the ofs1 and ofs2 areas of the active SCC board has different
versions.
l Cause 3: The software stored in the mapping directories of active and standby SCC boards
has different versions.

Procedure
Step 1 Contact Huawei technical support engineers for reloading the software.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.237 NO_BD_SOFT

Description
The NO_BD_SOFT is an alarm indicating that the board software is lost.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Critical Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 The value is always 0x01.
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicates the number of the lost file.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 616


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Impact on the System


l If the board software is lost, the board fails to work normally.
l If the FPGA is lost, the FPGA does not have a backup copy.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The software fails to be loaded.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The software fails to be loaded.
1. Contact the Huawei technical support engineers to reload the software.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.238 NP1_MANUAL_STOP

Description
The NP1_MANUAL_STOP is an alarm indicating that the N+1 protection protocol is disabled
manually.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Minor Processing alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1, Parameter 2 Indicates the ID of the alarmed protection group. For example, 0x01
indicates that the alarm is reported by protection group 1.

Impact on the System


The N+1 protection may fail, or the protection switching may fail.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 617


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The N+1 protection protocol is disabled manually.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The N+1 protection protocol is disabled manually.
1. Start the N+1 protection protocol.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.239 NP1_SW_FAIL

Description
The NP1_SW_FAIL is an alarm indicating that the N+1 protection switching fails.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1, Parameter 2 Indicates the ID of the alarmed protection group. For example, 0x01
indicates that the alarm is reported by protection group 1.

Impact on the System


The services cannot be switched. If the current paths are unavailable, the services are interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The parameters of the N+1 protection for the alarmed node are set incorrectly.
l Cause 2: The network-wide N+1 protection protocol runs abnormally.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 618


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The parameters of the N+1 protection for the alarmed node are set incorrectly.
1. Check whether the parameters of the N+1 protection are set correctly according to the
planning. For details, see Creating an N+1 Protection Group.

If... Then...
The parameters of the N+1 protection are Set the parameters of the N+1 protection
set incorrectly correctly.
The parameters of the N+1 protection are Go to Cause 2.
set correctly

Step 2 Cause 2: The network-wide N+1 protection protocol runs abnormally.


1. Stop and restart the protocol manually. For details, see Starting/Stopping the N+1
Protection Protocol.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared after the protocol is End the alarm handling.
restarted.
The alarm persists after the protocol is Contact the Huawei technical support
restarted engineers to handle the alarm.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.240 NP1_SW_INDI

Description
The NP1_SW_INDI is an alarm indicating that the N+1 protection switching is detected.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 619


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning
Parameter1, Parameter 2 Indicates the ID of the alarmed protection group. For example, 0x01
indicates that the alarm is reported by protection group 1.

Impact on the System


During the N+1 protection switching, the services are interrupted. After the N+1 switching is
complete, the services are restored to normal. After the switching starts and before the switching
is complete, the extra services are interrupted.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The N+1 protection switching is performed.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The N+1 protection switching is performed.
1. Find out the cause of switching, and take appropriate measures.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.241 NTP_SYNC_FAIL

Description
The NTP_SYNC_FAIL is an alarm indicating that NTP time synchronization fails.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


Time on the alarmed NE is different from time on the NTP server. The records on the NE, such
as performance events, alarms, and operations, cannot be kept with exact time.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The NTP server is not configured or is configured incorrectly.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 620


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

l Cause 2: The NTP server cannot communicate with the NE.


l Cause 3: The NTP server fails.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The NTP server is not configured or is configured incorrectly.
1. Configure the NTP server correctly.
2. Re-configure the NTP parameters for the NE.

Step 2 Cause 2: The NTP server cannot communicate with the NE.
1. Check whether the cable connecting the gateway NE to the NTP server is normal. If not,
rectify the connection fault.
2. Check whether the DCN communication between the NTP server and the NE is normal. If
not, configure the DCN communication correctly.

Step 3 Cause 3: The NTP server fails.


1. Troubleshoot the NTP server.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.242 OCD

Description
The OCD is an alarm indicating out-of-cell delimitation. This alarm occurs when the cell
delimitation state machine is in the HUNT or PRESYN state.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the OCD alarm occurs, all the services in the receive direction of the alarmed ATM port
lose cells.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 621


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: A great number of bit errors occur in the receive path. The receive path reports
the alarms indicating excessive bit errors, such as B1_EXC, B2_EXC, and B3_EXC.
l Cause 2: The ATM processing chip of the board is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: A great number of bit errors occur in the receive path. The receive path reports the
alarms indicating excessive bit errors, such as B1_EXC, B2_EXC, and B3_EXC.
1. Check whether the B1_EXC, B2_EXC, or B3_EXC alarm occurs in the receive path.
2. If yes, clear these alarms first, and then check whether the OCD alarm is cleared.

Step 2 Cause 2: The ATM processing chip of the board is faulty.


1. Perform a cold reset on the board that reports the OCD alarm. For details, see 8.6.1 Cold
Reset.
2. If the OCD alarm persists, replace the alarmed board. For details, see 6.6 Replacing the
Smart E1 Interface Board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.243 ODC_BATTERY_CURRENT_ABN

Description
The ODC_BATTERY_CURRENT_ABN is an alarm indicating that the current of the storage
battery is abnormal.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 622


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the cause of the alarm.

l 0x01: The internal current loop of the storage battery is broken.


l 0x02: The recharge current of the storage battery is very high.
l 0x03: The storage battery is discharged unevenly.

Impact on the System


The equipment may fail to work normally, or event the equipment is damaged.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The circuit breaker or fuse of the storage battery in the cabinet is off.
l Cause 2: The positive and negative polarities of the storage battery are connected inversely.
l Cause 3: The power module frame is faulty.
l Cause 4: The power monitoring module is faulty.
l Cause 5: The power module is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The circuit breaker or fuse of the storage battery in the cabinet is off.

If... Then...
The circuit breaker of the storage battery is open Close the circuit breaker.
The fuse of the storage battery is broken Replace the fuse.

Step 2 Cause 2: The positive and negative polarities of the storage battery are connected inversely.
1. Connect the positive and negative polarities of the storage battery correctly.
Step 3 Cause 3: The power module frame is faulty.
1. Check whether the power module frame is damaged. If the power module frame is damaged,
replace the power module frame.
Step 4 Cause 4: The power monitoring module is faulty.
1. Replace the power monitoring module.
Step 5 Cause 5: The power module is faulty.
1. Check whether the ODC_MDL_ABN alarm is reported.

If... Then...
The ODC_MDL_ABN alarm is reported Rectify the fault by referring the solution
to the ODC_MDL_ABN alarm.
The ODC_MDL_ABN alarm is not Replace the power module.
reported

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 623


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Related Information
None.

A.3.244 ODC_BATTERY_PWRDOWN

Description
The ODC_BATTERY_PWRDOWN is an alarm indicating that the storage battery fails to
provide power for the equipment.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the cause of the alarm.

l 0x01: power-off due to low voltage


l 0x02: power-off due to NMS control
l 0x03: power-off due to human interference
l 0x04: power-off due to high temperature

Impact on the System


The equipment does not have backup a power supply.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1 of power-off due to NMS control: The storage battery fails to provide power for
the equipment due to NMS control.
l Cause 1 of power-off due to local human interference: The BAT button on the front panel
of the PMU is set to OFF.
l Cause 1 of power-off due to low voltage: The AC input power is abnormal.
l Cause 2 of power-off due to low voltage: The power module is faulty.
l Cause 3 of power-off due to low voltage: The power monitoring module is faulty.
l Cause 1 of power-off due to high temperature: The temperature that results in power-off
of the storage battery due to high temperature is set to an inappropriate value.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 624


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

l Cause 2 of power-off due to high temperature: The temperature of the storage battery is
very high.
l Cause 3 of power-off due to high temperature: The temperature sensor of the power module
is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Determine the cause of the alarm according to the alarm parameters displayed on the NMS.

Step 2 Cause 1 of power-off due to NMS control: The storage battery fails to provide power for the
equipment due to NMS control.
1. Enable the battery to power on the equipment.

Step 3 Cause 1 of power-off due to local human interference: The BAT button on the front panel of the
PMU is set to OFF.
1. On the front panel of the PMU, hold the BAT ON button for 5-10 seconds to turn on the
storage battery.

Step 4 Cause 1 of power-off due to low voltage: The AC input power is abnormal.
1. Query the threshold that results in an alarm when the AC power voltage is abnormal. Then,
determine whether the threshold is appropriate according to the configuration and planning
information.

If... Then...
The threshold is inappropriate Set the threshold to an appropriate value.
The threshold is appropriate Go to the next step.

2. Check whether the AC circuit breaker is closed.

If... Then...
The AC circuit breaker is open Close the AC circuit breaker.
The AC circuit breaker is closed Go to the next step.

3. Check the connection of the AC power cable.

If... Then...
The connection of the AC power cable is incorrect. Connect the cable properly.
The AC power cable is deteriorated and damaged. Replace the cable.

Step 5 Cause 2 of power-off due to low voltage: The power module is faulty.
1. Rectify the fault of the power module by referring to the solution to the
ODC_MDL_ABN alarm.

Step 6 Cause 3 of power-off due to low voltage: The power monitoring module is faulty.
1. Rectify the fault of the power monitoring module.

Step 7 Cause 1 of power-off due to high temperature: The temperature that results in power-off of the
power module due to high temperature is set to an inappropriate value.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 625


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

1. Query the threshold that results in an alarm due to high temperature. Then, determine
whether the threshold is appropriate according to the configuration and planning
information.

If... Then...
The threshold is inappropriate Set the threshold to an appropriate value.
The threshold is appropriate Perform the operations required when the alarm is
generated by cause 2 of power-off due to high
temperature.

Step 8 Cause 2 of power-off due to high temperature: The temperature of the storage battery is very
high.
1. Replace the storage battery.

Step 9 Cause 3 of power-off due to high temperature: The temperature sensor of the power module is
faulty.
1. Replace the temperature sensor of the power module.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.245 ODC_DOOR_OPEN

Description
The ODC_DOOR_OPEN is an alarm indicating that the door of an outdoor cabinet is open.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Critical Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


If the cabinet door is open, the temperature, ambient humidity, and dust-proof measures of the
equipment are affected by the external environment.

In addition, the equipment may be damaged or stolen.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The door access alarm is set incorrectly.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 626


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

l Cause 2: The cabinet door is open.


l Cause 3: The cable between the door sensor and the monitor device is connected incorrectly.
l Cause 4: The door sensor is faulty.
l Cause 5: The monitor device is faulty.
l Cause 6: No door sensor is installed.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The door access alarm is set incorrectly.
1. Check whether the door access alarm is set correctly according to the configuration and
planning information.

If... Then...
The door access alarm is set correctly Go to Cause 2.
The door access alarm is set incorrectly Set the door access alarm correctly.

Step 2 Cause 2: The cabinet door is open.


1. Close the cabinet door.

Step 3 Cause 3: The cable between the door sensor and the monitor device is connected incorrectly.
1. Check the cable between the door sensor and the monitor device.

If... Then...
The cable is connected incorrectly or is loose Connect the cable properly.
The cable is deteriorated or damaged Replace the cable.
The connection is correct Go to Cause 4.

Step 4 Cause 4: The door sensor is faulty.


1. Rectify the fault of the door sensor.
2. Then, check whether the alarm clears.

If... Then...
The alarm clears End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 5.

Step 5 Cause 5: The monitor device is faulty.


1. Rectify the fault of the monitor device.

Step 6 Cause 6: No door sensor is installed.


1. Install a door sensor.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 627


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.246 ODC_FAN_FAILED
Description
The ODC_FAN_FAILED is an alarm indicating that the fan is faulty.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the position of the fault.

l 0x01: The internal fan is faulty.


l 0x02: The external fan is faulty.

Impact on the System


The cabinet cannot dissipate heat properly. As a result, the equipment may be damaged and the
services may be affected.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The fan cable is connected incorrectly.
l Cause 2: The fan is faulty.
l Cause 3: The fan is not installed.

Procedure
Step 1 Determine the faulty fan according to the alarm parameters displayed on the NMS.
Step 2 Cause 1: The fan cable is connected incorrectly.
1. Connect the cable properly to the fan according to the specified regulations or rules.
Step 3 Cause 2: The fan is faulty.
1. Replace the fan module.
Step 4 Cause 3: The fan is not installed.
1. Install the TEC module that contains a fan.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 628


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Related Information
None.

A.3.247 ODC_HUMI_ABN

Description
The ODC_HUMI_ABN is an alarm indicating that the relative humidity in the cabinet
environment exceeds the specified threshold.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Environment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the cause of the alarm.

l 0x01: The relative humidity is very high.


l 0x02: The relative humidity is very low.

Impact on the System


In the case of high relative humidity, the equipment may be damaged. In the case of low relative
humidity, the life of the equipment may be shortened.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The threshold that results in an alarm is set incorrectly.
l Cause 2: The cable between the humidity sensor and the monitoring equipment is connected
incorrectly.
l Cause 3: The humidity sensor is faulty.
l Cause 4: The associated monitoring equipment is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The threshold that results in an alarm is set incorrectly.
1. Check whether the humidity threshold is set correctly according to the configuration and
planning information.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 629


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The humidity threshold is set correctly Perform the operations required when
the alarm is generated due to cause 2.
The humidity threshold is set incorrectly Set the humidity threshold to an
appropriate value.

Step 2 Cause 2: The cable between the humidity sensor and the monitoring equipment is connected
incorrectly.

If... Then...
The cable is connected incorrectly or is loose Connect the cable properly.
The cable is deteriorated and damaged Handle the exceptions of the cable.
The cable is not deteriorated and damaged Perform the operations required when the
alarm is generated due to cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: The humidity sensor is faulty.


1. Rectify the fault of the sensor.
2. Check whether the alarm is cleared.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Perform the operations required when the alarm is generated
due to cause 4.

Step 4 Cause 4: The monitoring equipment is faulty.


1. Rectify the fault of the monitoring equipment.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.248 ODC_LOAD_PWRDOWN

Description
The ODC_LOAD_PWRDOWN is an alarm indicating that the secondary load is powered off.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Equipment alarm

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 630


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the cause of the alarm.

l 0x01: power-off due to low voltage


l 0x02: power-off due to background control
l 0x03: power-off due to startup in the case of low temperature
l 0x04: power-off due to high temperature

Impact on the System


The services on the secondary load are interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1 of power-off due to NMS control: The load is powered off due to NMS control.
l Cause 1 of power-off due to low voltage: The AC input power is abnormal.
l Cause 2 of power-off due to low voltage: The power module is faulty.
l Cause 3 of power-off due to low voltage: The power monitoring module is faulty.
l Cause 1 of power-off due to low temperature: The cabinet temperature is very low.
l Cause 2 of power-off due to low temperature: The ambient temperature sensor is faulty.
l Cause 1 of power-off due to high temperature: The temperature that results in power-off
of the load due to high temperature is set to an inappropriate value.
l Cause 2 of power-off due to high temperature: The cabinet temperature is very high.
l Cause 3 of power-off due to high temperature: The ambient temperature sensor is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Determine the cause of the alarm according to the alarm parameters displayed on the NMS.

Step 2 Cause 1 of power-off due to NMS control: The load is powered off due to NMS control.
1. Turn on the storage battery for the equipment.

Step 3 Cause 1 of power-off due to low voltage: The AC input power is abnormal.
1. Query the threshold that results in an alarm when the AC power voltage is abnormal. Then,
determine whether the threshold is appropriate according to the configuration and planning
information.

If... Then...
The threshold is inappropriate Set the threshold to an appropriate value.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 631


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The threshold is appropriate Go to the next step.

2. Check whether the AC circuit breaker is closed.

If... Then...
The AC circuit breaker is closed Go to the next step.
The AC circuit breaker is open Close the AC circuit breaker.

3. Check the connection of the AC power cable.

If... Then...
The connection of the AC power cable is Connect the cable properly.
incorrect.
The AC power cable is deteriorated and Handle the exceptions of the cable.
damaged.

Step 4 Cause 2 of power-off due to low voltage: The power module is faulty.
1. Rectify the fault of the power module by referring to the solution to the
ODC_MDL_ABN alarm.

Step 5 Cause 3 of power-off due to low voltage: The power monitoring module is faulty.
1. Rectify the fault of the power monitoring module.

Step 6 Cause 1 of power-off due to low temperature: The cabinet temperature is very low.
1. Check whether the heat exchanger works properly.

If... Then...
The heat exchanger does not work Rectify the fault of the heat exchange.
properly
The heat exchanger works properly Perform the operations required when the
alarm is generated by cause 2 of power-off
due to low temperature.

Step 7 Cause 2 of power-off due to low temperature: The ambient temperature sensor is faulty.
1. Replace the temperature sensor of the power module.

Step 8 Cause 1 of power-off due to high temperature: The temperature that results in power-off of the
load due to high temperature is set to an inappropriate value.
1. Query the threshold that results in an alarm in the case of power-off due to high temperature
of the load. Then, determine whether the threshold is appropriate according to the
configuration and planning information.

If... Then...
The threshold is inappropriate Set the threshold to an appropriate value.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 632


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The threshold is appropriate Perform the operations required when the alarm is
generated by cause 2 of power-off due to high
temperature.

Step 9 Cause 2 of power-off due to high temperature: The cabinet temperature is very high.
1. Check whether the ambient temperature is very high all the time.
2. Check whether the heat exchanger works properly.

If... Then...
The heat exchanger does not work Rectify the fault of the heat exchange.
properly
The heat exchanger works properly Perform the operations required when the
alarm is generated by cause 3 of power-off
due to high temperature.

Step 10 Cause 3 of power-off due to high temperature: The ambient temperature sensor is faulty.
1. Replace the ambient temperature sensor.

----End

Related Information
The secondary load refers to the load that the DC power outlet of the cabinet corresponds to.

A.3.249 ODC_MDL_ABN

Description
The ODC_MDL_ABN is an alarm indicating that the power module is abnormal.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the ID of the alarmed power module.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 633


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicates the cause of the alarm.

l 0x01: The power module is switched off.


l 0x02: The power module is faulty.
l 0x03: The power module stops self-protection.
l 0x04: The power module fails to communicate with the power
monitoring module, or the power module is not in position.
l 0x05: The number of PSUs configured on the NMS is incorrect.
l 0x06: The power module status cannot be identified.

Impact on the System


If the power module is faulty, the loading capability of the power system is affected. As a result,
the storage battery may discharge, or even the entire power system of the equipment is powered
off.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The number of PSUs configured on the NMS is incorrect.
l Cause 2: The power module is not in position.
l Cause 3: The power module is faulty.
l Cause 4: The power monitoring unit is abnormal.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The power module is not configured on the NMS.
1. Set the logical slot of the power module on the NMS.

Step 2 Cause 2: The power module is not in position, or the power module is not inserted properly.

If... Then...
The power module is not in position Install the power module.
The power module is not inserted securely Install the power module properly.

Step 3 Cause 3: The power module is faulty.


1. Replace the power module.

Step 4 Cause 4: The power monitoring unit is abnormal.


1. Rectify the fault of the power monitoring unit.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 634


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.250 ODC_POWER_FAIL

Description
The ODC_POWER_FAIL is an alarm indicating that the AC input power voltage and DC output
power voltage of an outdoor cabinet are abnormal.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the type of the fault.

l 0x56: The AC input power is very high.


l 0x57: The AC input power is very low.
l 0x58: The DC output power is very high.
l 0x59: The DC output power is very low.
l 0x5b: No AC input power is available.
l 0x5c: The AC power voltage is abnormal.

Impact on the System


l If the AC input power voltage is abnormal, the equipment is powered on by the storage
battery and cannot work for a long time.
l If the DC output power voltage is abnormal, the services on the equipment are interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The AC input power voltage is abnormal.
l Cause 2: The DC output power voltage is abnormal.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The AC input power voltage is abnormal.
1. The threshold that results in an alarm due to the AC input power voltage is set incorrectly.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 635


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The threshold is set incorrectly Set the threshold to an appropriate value.
The threshold is set correctly Go to the next step.

2. The AC circuit breaker is open.

If... Then...
The AC circuit breaker is open Close the AC circuit breaker.
The AC circuit breaker is closed Go to the next step.

3. The AC power cable is connected incorrectly.

If... Then...
The cable is connected incorrectly or is loose Connect the cable properly.
The cable is deteriorated and damaged Handle the exceptions of the cable.
The cable is connected correctly Go to the next step.

4. The AC power grid distributes the power abnormally.

If... Then...
The AC power grid distributes the power Rectify the fault of the power module
abnormally at the base station.
The AC power grid distributes the power Go to the next step.
normally

5. The monitoring equipment is faulty.

If... Then...
The monitoring equipment is faulty Rectify the fault of the monitoring
equipment.
The monitoring equipment is not faulty Perform the operations required when the
alarm is generated due to cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The DC output power voltage is abnormal.


1. The threshold that results in an alarm is set incorrectly.

If... Then...
The threshold is set incorrectly Set the threshold to an appropriate value.
The threshold is set correctly Go to the next step.

2. The PSU module is faulty.

If... Then...
The PSU module is faulty Rectify the fault of the PSU module.
The PSU module is not faulty Go to the next step.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 636


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

3. The power of the storage battery is insufficient.

If... Then...
The power of the storage battery is Recharge the storage battery.
insufficient
The power of the storage battery is Rectify the fault of the monitoring
sufficient equipment.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.251 ODC_SMOKE_OVER

Description
The ODC_SMOKE_OVER is an alarm indicating that smoke occurs in an outdoor cabinet.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Critical Environment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The equipment may be burned.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The smoke alarm is set incorrectly.
l Cause 2: A fire and heavy smoke occur at the equipment in the cabinet.
l Cause 3: The cable between the smoke sensor and the monitoring equipment is connected
incorrectly.
l Cause 4: The smoke sensor is faulty.
l Cause 5: The associated monitoring equipment is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The smoke alarm is set incorrectly.
1. Check whether the smoke alarm is set correctly according to the configuration and planning
information.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 637


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The smoke alarm is set correctly Perform the operations required when the
alarm is generated due to cause 2.
The smoke alarm is set incorrectly Set the smoke alarm correctly.

Step 2 Cause 2: A fire and heavy smoke occur at the equipment in the cabinet.
1. Extinguish the fire in the cabinet.

Step 3 Cause 3: The cable between the smoke sensor and the monitoring equipment is connected
incorrectly.
1. Check whether the cable between the sensor and the monitoring equipment is connected
correctly.

If... Then...
The cable is connected incorrectly or is Connect the cable properly.
loose
The cable is deteriorated and damaged Replace the cable.
The cable is not deteriorated and damaged Perform the operations required when
the alarm is generated due to cause 4.

Step 4 Cause 4: The smoke sensor is faulty.


1. Rectify the fault of the sensor.
2. Check whether the alarm is cleared.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Perform the operations required when the alarm is generated
due to cause 5.

Step 5 Cause 5: The associated monitoring equipment is faulty.


1. Rectify the fault of the monitoring equipment.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.252 ODC_SURGE_PROTECTION_FAIL

Description
The ODC_SURGE_PROTECTION_FAIL is an alarm indicating that the surge protection
function of the outdoor cabinet is abnormal.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 638


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Critical Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the type of the alarm.

l 0x01: AC surge protection alarm


l 0x02: DC surge protection alarm

Impact on the System


The AC surge protection function of the cabinet is disabled.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The alarm is set incorrectly.
l Cause 2: The cable between the lightning sensor and the monitoring equipment is connected
incorrectly.
l Cause 3: The lightning sensor is faulty.
l Cause 3: The lightning arrestor is faulty.
l Cause 5: The associated monitoring equipment is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The alarm is set incorrectly.
1. Check whether the alarm is set correctly according to the configuration and planning
information.

If... Then...
The alarm is set correctly Perform the operations required when the alarm is
generated due to cause 2.
The alarm is set incorrectly Set the surge protection alarm correctly.

Step 2 Cause 2: The cable between the lightning sensor and the monitoring equipment is connected
incorrectly.
1. Check the cable connection between the sensor and the monitoring equipment.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 639


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The cable is connected incorrectly or is Connect the cable properly.
loose
The cable is deteriorated and damaged Replace the cable.
The cable is not deteriorated and damaged Perform the operations required when
the alarm is generated due to cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: The lightning sensor is faulty.


1. Rectify the fault of the sensor.
2. Check whether the alarm is cleared.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Perform the operations required when the alarm is generated
due to cause 4.

Step 4 Cause 3: The lightning arrestor is faulty.


1. Check whether the alarm output end of the lightning arrestor works properly.

If... Then...
The alarm output end of the lightning Perform the operations required when the
arrestor works properly alarm is generated due to cause 5.
The alarm output end of the lightning Replace the lightning arrestor.
arrestor does not work properly

Step 5 Cause 5: The associated monitoring equipment is faulty.


1. Rectify the fault of the monitoring equipment.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.253 ODC_TEC_ALM

Description
The ODC_TEC_ALM is an alarm indicating that the TEC air conditioning module in the cabinet
does not work properly.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Equipment alarm

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 640


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


If the TEC air conditioning module does not work properly, the storage battery may operate at
very high or low temperature and therefore the safety performance of the storage battery
degrades.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The TEC cable is connected incorrectly.
l Cause 2: The TEC module is faulty.
l Cause 3: The monitoring equipment is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The TEC cable is connected incorrectly.
1. Connect the TEC cable correctly.

Step 2 Cause 2: The TEC module is faulty.


1. Replace the TEC module.

Step 3 Cause 3: The monitoring equipment is faulty.


1. Rectify the fault of the monitoring equipment.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.254 ODC_TEMP_ABN

Description
The ODC_TEMP_ABN is an alarm indicating that the ambient temperature of the cabinet or
the temperature of the storage battery is abnormal.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Environment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 641


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details


about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the cause of the alarm.

l 0x01: The ambient temperature is higher than the upper threshold.


l 0x01: The ambient temperature is lower than the lower threshold.
Parameter 2 Indicates the temperature type.

l 0x01: The temperature at the air outlet is very high or low.


l 0x0b: Ambient temperature 1 is very high or low.
l 0x0c: Ambient temperature 2 is very high or low.
l 0x0d: The temperature of the battery group is very high or low.

Impact on the System


If the temperature is abnormal, the equipment performance degrades and the life of the equipment
decreases.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The temperature threshold that results in an alarm is set incorrectly.
l Cause 2: The cable between the temperature sensor and the monitoring equipment is
connected incorrectly.
l Cause 3: The temperature sensor is faulty.
l Cause 4: The associated monitoring equipment is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The temperature threshold that results in an alarm is set incorrectly.
1. Check whether the temperature alarm is set correctly according to the configuration and
planning information.

If... Then...
The temperature alarm is set correctly Perform the operations required when
the alarm is generated due to cause 2.
The temperature alarm is set incorrectly Set the temperature alarm correctly.

Step 2 Cause 2: The cable between the temperature sensor and the monitoring equipment is connected
incorrectly.
1. Check whether the cable between the sensor and the monitoring equipment is connected
correctly.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 642


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The cable is connected incorrectly or is Connect the cable properly.
loose
The cable is deteriorated and damaged Handle the exceptions of the cable.
The cable is not deteriorated and damaged Perform the operations required when
the alarm is generated due to cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: The temperature sensor is faulty.


1. Rectify the fault of the sensor.
2. Check whether the alarm is cleared.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Perform the operations required when the alarm is generated
due to cause 4.

Step 4 Cause 4: The monitoring equipment is faulty.


1. Rectify the fault of the monitoring equipment.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.255 ODC_WATER_ALM

Description
The ODC_WATER_ALM is an alarm indicating that certain water enters the cabinet.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Critical Environment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The moisture in the cabinet increases, and the equipment in the cabinet may be damaged.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The water alarm is set incorrectly.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 643


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

l Cause 2: Certain water enters the cabinet.


l Cause 3: The cable between the water sensor and the monitoring equipment is connected
incorrectly.
l Cause 4: The water sensor is faulty.
l Cause 5: The associated monitoring equipment is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The water alarm is set incorrectly.
1. Check whether the water alarm is set correctly according to the configuration and planning
information.

If... Then...
The water alarm is set correctly Perform the operations required when the
alarm is generated due to cause 2.
The water alarm is set incorrectly Set the water alarm correctly.

Step 2 Cause 2: Certain water enters the cabinet.


1. Dry the cabinet and take waterproof measures for the cabinet.
Step 3 Cause 3: The cable between the sensor and the monitoring equipment is connected incorrectly.
1. Check whether the cable between the sensor and the monitoring equipment is connected
correctly.

If... Then...
The cable is connected incorrectly or is Connect the cable properly.
loose
The cable is deteriorated and damaged Handle the exceptions of the cable.
The cable is not deteriorated and damaged Perform the operations required when
the alarm is generated due to cause 4.

Step 4 Cause 4: The sensor is faulty.


1. Rectify the fault of the sensor.
Step 5 Cause 5: The monitoring equipment is faulty.
1. Rectify the fault of the monitoring equipment.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.256 OUT_PWR_ABN
Description
The OUT_PWR_ABN alarm indicates that the output optical power is abnormal.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 644


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Critical Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the port ID.
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the path ID. The parameters have a fixed value of 0x00
0x01.
Parameter 4, Parameter 5 Are reserved. The value is always 0xFF.

Impact on the System


The OUT_PWR_ABN alarm affects the transmission performance of services, and may even
result in service interruption.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The output optical power is too high or low.
l Cause 2: A board is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The output optical power is too high or low.
1. Browse optical power performance events.

If... Then...
The output optical power does not meet the Replace the optical module.
requirement
The output optical power is too high Add a proper attenuator to reduce the input
optical power.

Step 2 Cause 2: A board is faulty.


1. Replace the alarmed board.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 645


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.257 OUT1TEMP_SENSOR_FAIL

Description
The OUT1TEMP_SENSOR_FAIL is an alarm indicating that the air outlet temperature sensor
of the cabinet fails.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The air outlet temperature data of the TCU cannot be collected.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The air outlet temperature sensor is faulty.
l Cause 2: The control board of the cabinet is faulty.
l Cause 3: Cables are misconnected or damaged.
l Cause 4: The air outlet temperature sensor is not installed.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The air outlet temperature sensor is faulty.
1. Replace the air outlet temperature sensor.
2. Then, check whether the alarm clears.

If... Then...
The alarm clears End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The control board of the cabinet is faulty.


1. Replace the cabinet.
2. Then, check whether the alarm clears.

If... Then...
The alarm clears End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: Cables are misconnected or damaged.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 646


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

1. Replace damaged cables.


2. Connect cables correctly.

Step 4 Cause 4: The air outlet temperature sensor is not installed.


1. Install the air outlet temperature sensor.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.258 OUT2TEMP_SENSOR_FAIL

Description
The OUT2TEMP_SENSOR_FAIL is an alarm indicating that the external cycling air outlet
temperature sensor of the cabinet fails.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The external cycling air outlet temperature data of the TCU cannot be collected.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The external cycling air outlet temperature sensor is faulty.
l Cause 2: The control board of the cabinet is faulty.
l Cause 3: Cables are misconnected or damaged.
l Cause 4: The external cycling air outlet temperature sensor is not installed.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The external cycling air outlet temperature sensor is faulty.
1. Replace the external cycling air outlet temperature sensor.
2. Then, check whether the alarm clears.

If... Then...
The alarm clears End the alarm handling.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 647


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The alarm persists Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The control board of the cabinet is faulty.


1. Replace the cabinet.
2. Then, check whether the alarm clears.

If... Then...
The alarm clears End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: Cables are misconnected or damaged.


1. Replace damaged cables.
2. Connect cables correctly.
Step 4 Cause 4: The external cycling air outlet temperature sensor is not installed.
1. Install the external cycling air outlet temperature sensor.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.259 PASSWORD_NEED_CHANGE
Description
The PASSWORD_NEED_CHANGE alarm indicates that the password of the user who logs in
is unchanged. This alarm is reported if any one default user's default password is not changed
in time.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Service alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The default user's default password must be changed to reduce risks.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The default user's default password must be changed to reduce risks.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 648


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Procedure
Step 1 Modify the default user's password.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.260 PATCH_BD_EXCLUDE

Description
The PATCH_BD_EXCLUDE alarm indicates that an error occurs when a patch package is being
loaded to a board. The board is automatically isolated from patch package loading.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
None

Impact on the System


The board is isolated from patch package matching and patch package loading.

Possible Causes
Cause: An error occurs when a patch package is being loaded to the board.

Procedure
Step 1 Re-load the patch package.

----End

Related Information
None

A.3.261 PATCH_BD_MATCH_FAIL

Description
The PATCH_BD_MATCH_FAIL alarm indicates that the patch package does not match the
board to which the patch package is loaded.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 649


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
None

Impact on the System


Patch package loading fails.

Possible Causes
Cause: The patch package does not match the board to which the patch package is loaded.

Procedure
Step 1 Reload a correct patch package to the board.

----End

Related Information
None

A.3.262 PATCH_CHGSCC_NOTMATCH

Description
The PATCH_BD_EXCLUDE alarm indicates a mismatch between the patch package and the
system control board after the system control board is replaced.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
None

Impact on the System


Patch package loading fails.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 650


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Possible Causes
Cause: The system control board is replaced.

Procedure
Step 1 Re-load the patch package.

----End

Related Information
None

A.3.263 PATCH_PKGERR

Description
The PATCH_PKGERR alarm indicates that a patch package is incorrect or has been damaged
or deleted.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor alarm Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


If a patch package is incorrect or has been damaged or deleted, the patch package cannot be
successfully loaded, activated, or run.

NOTE

When this alarm is reported, services are not interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: A patch package is incorrect.
l Cause 2: A patch package has been damaged.
l Cause 3: A patch package has been deleted.

Procedure
Step 1 Load a correct patch package.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 651


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Related Information
None.

A.3.264 PG_LINK_FAIL
Description
The PG_LINK_FAIL is an alarm indicating that the links in a 1+1 protection group fail.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Critical Service alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The services on the radio links are interrupted.

Possible Causes
Cause: Service alarms occur on the main and standby boards.

Procedure
Step 1 Set the Alarm Report Mode to Protection group and board alarms. For details, see Querying
the IF 1+1 Protection Status.
NOTE

When alarms with different priorities occur on a board at the same time, the board reports only the alarms
with the highest priority. Alarms can be arranged in descending order by priority: hardware alarms >
configuration alarms > service alarms.

Step 2 Handle the queried alarms.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.265 PG_PRT_DEGRADED
Description
The PG_PRT_DEGRADED is an alarm indicating that the main link or standby link in a 1+1
protection group is faulty.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 652


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Service alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the board ID.

Impact on the System


The services at the NE are not affected, but radio link protection fails.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Service alarms occur on the main board.
l Cause 2: Service alarms occur on the standby board.

Procedure
Step 1 Locate the faulty board according to the alarm parameter.

Step 2 Set the Alarm Report Mode to Protection group and board alarms. For details, see Querying
the IF 1+1 Protection Status.
NOTE

When service alarms with different priorities occur on a board at the same time, the board reports only the
alarms with the highest priority. Alarms can be arranged in descending order by priority: hardware alarms
> configuration alarms > service alarms.

Step 3 Handle the queried alarms.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.266 PLA_CFG_MISMATCH

Description
The PLA_CFG_MISMATCH alarm indicates that physical link aggregation (PLA)
configurations are inconsistent at two ends of a radio link.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 653


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Critical Service alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1, Parameter 2 Indicate the ID of the PLA group.

Parameter 3, Parameter 4 Indicate the error type.

l 0x00: The PLA group is not configured on the IF board of the


peer NE.
l 0x01: Layer 2 header compression is enabled for only one NE.
l 0x02: Layer 3 header compression is enabled for only one NE.

Impact on the System


The services carried by the radio link are unavailable.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The PLA group is configured on the local NE, but not configured on the peer NE.
l Cause 2: Frame header compression is enabled for only one NE.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The PLA group is configured on the local NE, but not configured on the peer NE.
1. Configure the PLA group on the peer NE by referring to Creating a PLA/EPLA Group.
Step 2 Cause 2: Frame header compression is enabled for only one NE.
1. Determine the port that needs to be re-configured. For details, see Querying the Status of
a PLA/EPLA Group and the network plan.
2. Enable or disable frame header compression on the port to ensure configuration consistency
at both ends. For details, see Configuring Ethernet Frame Header Compression and Error
Frame Discarding over Air Interfaces.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 654


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.267 PLA_DOWN
Description
The PLA_DOWN alarm indicates that a PLA group is faulty. This alarm is reported when the
number of active member links in a PLA group is 0 or smaller than the preset minimum number
of active member links.
NOTE
The PLA in this section refers to EPLA only.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Service alarm

Parameters
Name Meaning

Parameter 1, Parameter 2 Indicate the ID of the PLA group.

Impact on the System


The services carried by the PLA group are interrupted.

Possible Causes
The number of active member links in the PLA group is 0 or smaller than the preset minimum
number of active member links.

Procedure
Step 1 Check whether the specified minimum number of active links is consistent with the network
plan. If not, re-configure the minimum number of active links. For details, see querying PLA
group status.
Step 2 Clear the PLA_MEMBER_DOWN alarm.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.268 PLA_MEMBER_DOWN
Description
The PLA_MEMBER_DOWN alarm indicates that a member link of a PLA group is faulty.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 655


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

NOTE
The PLA in this section refers to EPLA only.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Service alarm

Parameters
Name Meaning

Parameter 1, Parameter 2 Indicate the ID of the PLA group.

Parameter 3 Indicates the board ID of the inactive member.

Impact on the System


If the PLA_DOWN alarm is also reported, services are interrupted. If the PLA_DOWN alarm
is not reported, only the services carried by the faulty member link are interrupted and available
bandwidth of the PLA group decreases.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: A member link of the PLA group is faulty at the local end.
l Cause 2: The IF board configured with the PLA group or related ODU hardware is faulty
at the local end.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: A member link of the PLA group is faulty at the local end.
1. Determine the associated IF board and radio links based on the ID of the PLA group. For
details, see querying PLA group status.
2. Check whether the MW_LOF, MW_LIM, MW_RDI, R_LOC, and R_LOF alarms are
reported the radio links. If yes, clear these alarms.
Step 2 Cause 2: The IF board configured with the PLA group or related ODU hardware is faulty at the
local end.
1. Determine the associated IF board and ODU based on the ID of the PLA group. For details,
see querying PLA group status.
2. Check whether the IF board and ODU report hardware-related alarms, such as
HARD_BAD, BD_STATUS, VOLT_LOS, WRG_BD_TYPE, and RADIO_MUTE. If
yes, clear these alarms.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 656


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.269 PORTMODE_MISMATCH

Description
The PORTMODE_MISMATCH is an alarm indicating that the working mode of the remote FE
port does not match with that of the local FE port. This alarm is reported when the local FE port
works in auto-negotiation mode and the opposite FE port works in non-auto-negotiation mode.

NOTE
Both GE and FE ports support the PORTMODE_MISMATCH alarm.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Service alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1, Parameter 2 Indicate the working mode of the FE port.

Impact on the System


When the PORTMODE_MISMATCH alarm occurs, the service on the local NE is not affected.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The local port works in auto-negotiation mode and the opposite port works in non-
auto-negotiation mode.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The local port works in auto-negotiation mode and the opposite port works in non-
auto-negotiation mode.
1. Disable the opposite port. For details, refer to Setting the Basic Attributes of Ethernet Ports.
2. Enable the opposite port and set work mode of the port to auto-negotiation. For details,
refer to Setting the Basic Attributes of Ethernet Ports.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 657


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.270 PORT_EXC_TRAFFIC

Description
The PORT_EXC_TRAFFIC alarm indicates that the traffic over a port exceeds its threshold.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Warning Service alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the traffic in the receive or transmit direction exceeds its threshold.

l 0x00: indicates the receive direction.


l 0x01: indicates the transmit direction.

Impact on the System


Services are congested.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The configured bandwidth limit is too low.
l Cause 2: The port traffic is too high.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The configured bandwidth limit is too low.
1. Follow instructions in Configuring Traffic Shaping for Egress Queues to check the
configured bandwidth limit.
2. If the configured bandwidth limit is too low, follow instructions in Configuring Traffic
Shaping for Egress Queues to increase the bandwidth limit value or perform network
expansion.

Step 2 Cause 2: The configured port traffic is too high.


1. Follow instruction in 4.6.2 Querying Traffic, Physical Bandwidth, or Bandwidth
Utilization to query the bandwidth utilization over a port.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 658


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

2. If the port bandwidth utilization is higher than its threshold, check whether a network storm
occurs. If a network storm occurs, eliminate the source that transmits a large amount of
invalid data.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.271 PORT_MODULE_OFFLINE

Description
The PORT_MODULE_OFFLINE alarm indicates that a port is offline.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Equipment alarm

Parameters

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the ID of the port that reports the alarm.
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Have a fixed value of 0x00 0x01.
Parameter 4, Parameter 5 Are reserved and have a fixed value of 0xff.

Impact on the System


The services over the alarmed port are interrupted.

Possible Causes
The alarmed port is enabled but house no SFP module.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause: The alarmed port is enabled but house no SFP module.
1. Check whether the alarmed port needs to receive/transmit a service.

If... Then...
The alarmed port needs to receive/ Go to the next step.
transmit a service

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 659


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The alarm port does not need to receive/ Follow instructions in Setting the Basic
transmit a service Attributes of Ethernet Ports to disable the
alarmed port.

2. Check whether the alarmed port houses an SFP module.

If... Then...
The alarmed port houses no SFP Follow instructions in Installing an SFP
module Module to add an SFP module.
The alarmed port houses an SFP Go to the next step.
module

3. Re-install the SFP module.

If... Then...
The alarm clears No further action is required.
The alarm persists Follow instructions in Replacing an SFP Module to replace the
SFP module.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.272 POWER_ABNORMAL

Description
The POWER_ABNORMAL is an alarm indicating that the input power supply is abnormal.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 660


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the number of the voltage channel.

l 0x01: the first channel of voltage


l 0x02: the second channel of voltage
Parameter 2 Indicates the type of the alarm.

l 0x00: voltage loss


l 0x01: undervoltage
l 0x02: overvoltage

Impact on the System


When the POWER_ABNORMAL alarm occurs, the power supply is abnormal, and therefore
the board may fail to work normally.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The power cable is cut, damaged, or incorrectly connected.
l Cause 2: The input power is abnormal.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The power cable is cut, damaged, or incorrectly connected.
1. Check whether the power cable is cut, damaged, or incorrectly connected. If the power
cable is cut or damaged, replace it with a proper power cable. If the power cable is
incorrectly connected, reconnect the power cable.

Step 2 Cause 2: The input power is abnormal.


1. Contact the engineers for power supply to rectify the fault.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.273 POWER_ALM

Description
The POWER_ALM is an alarm indicating that the power module is abnormal.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 661


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 If the POWER_ALM alarm is reported on a board on the IDU, this parameter
indicates the ID of the alarmed power module. For example, 0x01 indicates that
the alarm is reported by power module 1 of the board.

If the POWER_ALM is reported on the ODU, this parameter indicates the type
of the power fault.
l 0x01: The -5 V power supply is faulty.
l 0x02: The power supply for the power amplifier is faulty.

Parameter 2 Indicates the alarm types.


l 0x01: under-voltage
l 0x02: over-voltage

Impact on the System


The power modules are configured with protection. If only one power module reports the
POWER_ALM alarm, the system is not affected.

Possible Causes
If the alarm is reported by a board of the IDU, the possible causes are as follows:
l Cause 1: The input power or the PIU is abnormal.
l Cause 2: The power module is abnormal.

If the alarm is reported on the ODU, the cause is as follows:


l Cause 1: The power module of the ODU is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 (POWER_ALM reported by a board of the IDU) Cause 1: The input power or the PIU is
abnormal.
1. Check whether alarms are reported on the PIU, If yes, clear these alarms immediately.

Step 2 (POWER_ALM reported by a board of the IDU) Cause 2: The power module is abnormal.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 662


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

1. Replace the alarmed board. For details, see 6 Part Replacement.

Step 3 (POWER_ALM reported on the ODU) Cause 1: The power module of the ODU is faulty.
1. Replace the ODU. For details, see 6.15 Replacing the ODU.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.274 PPP_LCP_FAIL

Description
The PPP_LCP_FAIL is an alarm indicating an LCP negotiation failure. This alarm is reported
when the port uses the PPP encapsulation type and fails to negotiate with the opposite port.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Processing alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the LCP negotiation fails and services are interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Parameter configurations on the opposite port are inconsistent with those on the
local port.
l Cause 2: The network is congested or its quality is poor, which causes improper running
of the LCP protocol.
l Cause 3: The physical link is interrupted.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Parameter configurations on the opposite port are inconsistent with those on the local
port.
1. On the NMS, check whether parameter configurations on the peer port are consistent with
those on the local port.
2. If the parameter configurations are inconsistent, modify the parameters. Then, check
whether the alarm is cleared.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 663


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

3. For an optical interface, shut down and then start the laser. Then, check whether the alarm
is cleared.

Step 2 Cause 2: The network is congested or its quality is poor, which causes improper running of the
LCP protocol.
1. On the NMS, check whether the bandwidth for the tunnel connected to the ports is
configured low. For details, see Querying MPLS Tunnel Information.
2. If yes, configure the tunnel with a higher bandwidth. Then, check whether the alarm is
cleared.

Step 3 Cause 3: The physical link is interrupted.


1. Check whether the physical link is connected properly.
2. If not, restore the faulty physical link. Then, check whether the alarm is cleared.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.275 PPP_NCP_FAIL

Description
The PPP_NCP_FAIL is an alarm indicating an NCP negotiation failure. This alarm is reported
when the NCP configuration attributes are inconsistent between the local and opposite NEs.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Processing alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the NCP negotiation fails and services are interrupted.

Possible Causes
l The NCP configurations are inconsistent between the local and opposite NEs.

Procedure
Step 1 The NCP configurations are inconsistent between the local and opposite NEs.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 664


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

1. Reconfigure the NCP attributes on the local and opposite NEs and ensure they are
consistent.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.276 PTP_SOURCE_SWITCH
Description
The PTP_SOURCE_SWITCH is an alarm indicating a switchover between PTP time sources.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1, Parameter 2 Indicates the slot ID of the board before the switching.
Parameter 3 Indicates the ID of the subboard before the switching. 0xFF
indicates that there is no subboard.
Parameter 4, Parameter 5 Indicates the ID of the port before the switching.
Parameters 6 to 9 Indicates the ID 1 of the grandmaster clock before the switching.
Parameters 10 to 13 Indicates the ID 2 of the grandmaster clock before the switching.
Parameter 14, Parameter 15 Indicates the slot ID of the board after the switching.
Parameter 16 Indicates the ID of the subboard after the switching. 0xFF
indicates that there is no subboard.
Parameter 17, Parameter 18 Indicates the ID of the port after the switching.
Parameters 19 to 22 Indicates the ID 1 of the grandmaster clock after the switching.
Parameters 23 to 26 Indicates the ID 2 of the grandmaster clock after the switching.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, a switchover occurs on the IEEE 1588v2 clock source traced by the
NE, which will cause clock switchover in the entire clock domain.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 665


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The physical link between the local NE and the clock source is faulty.
l Cause 2: Information about the grandmaster clock such as the priority 1, quality level, and
priority 2 has changed.
l Cause 3: The network topology has changed.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The physical link between the local NE and the clock source is faulty.
1. Check the physical link between the NE and the clock source for troubleshooting.

Step 2 Cause 2: Information about the grandmaster clock such as the priority 1, quality level, and
priority 2 has changed.
1. If NE configurations are correct, no further action is required.

Step 3 Cause 3: The network topology has changed.


1. Replan the network and modify clock tracing relationships.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.277 PTP_TIMESTAMP_ABN

Description
The PTP_TIMESTAMP_ABN is an alarm indicating an exception of the PTP timestamp. This
alarm is reported when the PTP (IEEE 1588V2) timestamp is abnormal.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 666


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 l 0x02: indicates that timestamp t1 remains unchanged in three consecutive
seconds.
l 0x03: indicates that timestamp t2 remains unchanged in three consecutive
seconds.
l 0x04: indicates that timestamps t1 and t2 remain unchanged in three
consecutive seconds.
Parameter 2 l 0x02: indicates that timestamp t3 remains unchanged in 17 consecutive
seconds.
l 0x03: indicates that timestamp t4 remains unchanged in 17 consecutive
seconds.
l 0x04: indicates that timestamps t3 and t4 remain unchanged in 17 consecutive
seconds.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the slave NE fails to trace the time of the master NE. Bit errors may
occur in the service.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The P/E attributes are different on the PTP ports of the local and opposite NEs.
l Cause 2: The transmit NE is faulty.
l Cause 3: The receive NE is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The P/E attributes are different on the PTP ports of the local and opposite NEs.
1. Reconfigure the P/E attribute. For details, see Setting the PTP NE Attributes.
Step 2 Cause 2: The transmit NE is faulty.
1. Check the transmit NE for troubleshooting, or replace the clock source.
Step 3 Cause 3: The receive NE is faulty.
1. 6.10 Replacing the System Control, Switching and Timing Board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.278 PW_DROPPKT_EXC
Description
The PW_DROPPKT_EXC alarm indicates that the packet loss ratio on a PW exceeds its
threshold.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 667


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Warning Processing alarm

Parameters

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Has a fixed value of 0x00, indicating that the traffic in the ingress or egress
direction crosses its threshold.

Impact on the System


A small number of packets are lost, affecting service real-time performance.

Possible Causes
Cause: A small number of packets are lost on the alarmed PW.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause: A small number of packets are lost on the alarmed PW.
1. Follow instructions in Querying Information and Running Status of PWs to check the
bandwidth utilization of the alarmed PW. If the PW bandwidth is exhausted, increase the
bandwidth or eliminate any source that transmits a large amount of invalid data.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.279 PW_NO_TRAFFIC

Description
The PW_NO_TRAFFIC is an alarm indicating that a PW has no traffic. This alarm is reported
when the PW that carries services has no traffic.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 668


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Critical Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 Indicates the direction in which traffic is unavailable.

l 0x00: RX direction
l 0x01: TX direction

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the PW has no traffic and PW services are interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: No service is configured.
l Cause 2: The local services are abnormal and therefore no packet is transmitted to the peer
end.
l Cause 3: The peer services are abnormal and therefore no packet is transmitted to the local
end.
l Cause 4: The port that corresponds to the faulty PW works improperly.

Procedure
Step 1 Determine the alarmed board, and direction in which traffic is unavailable according to the alarm
information on the NMS.

If... Then...

The PW_NO_TRAFFIC alarm is reported in both the receive and transmit Go to Step 2.
directions

0x00 Go to Step 4.

0x01 Go to Step 3.

Step 2 Cause 1: No service is configured.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 669


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

1. Check whether the port is configured with any services. If not, configure services correctly.

Step 3 Cause 2: The local services are abnormal and therefore no packet is transmitted to the peer end.
1. Check whether the local PW services are correctly configured. For details, see Querying
Information and Running Status of PWs.

Step 4 Cause 3: The peer services are abnormal and therefore no packet is transmitted to the local end.
1. Check whether the opposite PW services are correctly configured.

Step 5 Cause 4: The port that corresponds to the faulty PW works improperly.
1. Replace the board that reports the alarm on the local NE. For details, see 6 Part
Replacement.
2. Check whether the alarm is cleared. If the alarm persists, replace the corresponding board
of the opposite NE.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.280 PWAPS_LOST

Description
The PWAPS_LOST is an alarm indicating that the APS frame is lost. This alarm occurs when
no APS frame is received from the protection channel.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the service protection fails.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The remote NE of the PW is not configured with any protection group.
l Cause 2: The service on the protection channel is interrupted.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The remote NE of the PW is not configured with any protection group.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 670


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

1. Check whether the remote NE of the PW is configured with a protection group. If yes,
ensure that the configuration is the same at the two ends.

Step 2 Cause 2: The service on the protection channel is interrupted.


1. Check whether the protection channel is faulty. If yes, rectify the fault.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.281 PWAPS_PATH_MISMATCH

Description
The PWAPS_PATH_MISMATCH is an alarm indicating that the working and protection paths
of the APS protection group differ between the two ends. This alarm is reported when the
working and protection paths of one APS protection group at one end are different from those
at the other end.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the service protection fails.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The configured working and protection paths differ between the two ends.
l Cause 2: Certain physical links are incorrectly connected.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The configured working and protection paths differ between the two ends.
1. Check whether the APS settings at the two ends are the same.
2. If the APS settings are different, change the settings to the same.

Step 2 Cause 2: Certain physical links are incorrectly connected.


1. Connect the fibers or cables properly.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 671


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Related Information
None.

A.3.282 PWAPS_SWITCH_FAIL

Description
The PWAPS_SWITCH_FAIL is an alarm indicating a switching failure of the PW APS
protection group. This alarm is reported when the request signal in the transmitted Automatic
Protection Switching (APS) frame is different from the bridge signal in the received APS frame
and this symptom lasts for 50 ms.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the service protection fails.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The configured working and protection paths differ between the two ends.
l Cause 2: Certain physical links are incorrectly connected.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The configured working and protection paths differ between the two ends.
1. Check whether the APS settings at the two ends are the same.
2. If the APS settings are different, change the settings to the same.

Step 2 Cause 2: Certain physical links are incorrectly connected.


1. Connect the fibers or cables properly.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 672


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.283 PWAPS_TYPE_MISMATCH

Description
The PWAPS_TYPE_MISMATCH is an alarm indicating that the local NE and the opposite NE
are configured with different PW protection types. This alarm occurs when the information in
the received APS frames is inconsistent with the APS protection scheme configured at the local
end.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the service protection fails.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The configured protection modes (1+1 protection or 1:1 protection) differ at the
two ends of the PW.
l Cause 2: The configured switching modes (single-ended or dual-ended) differ at the two
ends of the PW.
l Cause 3: The configured revertive modes (revertive or non-revertive) differ at the two ends
of the PW.

Procedure
Step 1 Check whether the APS protection settings, such as protection mode, switching mode, and
revertive mode, are the same at the local and remote ends. For details, see Querying PW APS
Status.

Step 2 If the APS protection settings are different, change the settings to the same.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 673


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.284 PW_APS_DEGRADED

Description
The PW_APS_DEGRADED alarm indicates that a PW automatic protection switching (APS)
protection group is degraded. This alarm is reported when a PW in the protection group is faulty
and availability of the protection group declines. This alarm is cleared when both the working
and protection PWs are functional or faulty.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Service alarm

Parameters
None

Impact on the System


Availability of the protection group declines.

Possible Causes
Cause: A PW in the protection group is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Check whether the PWs in the protection group are correctly configured. If the PWs are
incorrectly configured, rectify the configurations.

Step 2 Check whether a PWAPS_PATH_MISMATCH alarm is reported. If the alarm is reported,


handle the alarm.

----End

Related Information
None

A.3.285 PW_APS_OUTAGE

Description
The PW_APS_OUTAGE alarm indicates that a PW automatic protection switching (APS)
protection group is unavailable. This alarm is reported when both the working and protection
PWs in the protection group are faulty and the protection group is unavailable. This alarm is
cleared when a PW becomes available.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 674


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Service alarm

Parameters
None

Impact on the System


The protection group is unavailable and the services carried by the protection group are
interrupted.

Possible Causes
Cause: The working and protection PWs in the protection group are faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Check whether the PWs in the protection group are correctly configured. If the PWs are
incorrectly configured, rectify the configurations.

Step 2 Check whether a PWAPS_PATH_MISMATCH alarm is reported. If the alarm is reported,


handle the alarm.

----End

Related Information
None

A.3.286 R_LOC

Description
The R_LOC is an alarm indicating that the clock is lost on the receive line side. This alarm is
reported when the line board fails to extract clock signal from the line signal or the IF board fails
to extract clock signal from the IF signal.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Critical Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 675


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Impact on the System


The services on the line port or the IF port are interrupted. If the system is configured with
protection, protection switching may be triggered.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The receive unit of the local site is faulty.
l Cause 2: The transmit unit of the opposite station is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The receive unit of the local site is faulty.
1. At the local end, perform an inloop on the port of the alarmed board. For details, see 8.4
Software Loopback.

If... Then...
The alarm persists after the loopback Replace the alarmed local board.
The alarm is cleared after the loopback Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The transmit unit of the opposite station is faulty.


1. Replace alarmed opposite board.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared after the board is The fault is rectified. End the alarm handling.
replaced
The alarm persists after the board is Replace the system control, switch&timing
replaced board at the opposite end.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.287 R_LOF

Description
The R_LOF is an alarm indicating that frames are lost on the receive side. This alarm is reported
when the OOF state lasts for three milliseconds.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Critical Communication alarm

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 676


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The services are interrupted. If the system is configured with protection, protection switching
may be triggered.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Certain alarms are generated (if the alarm is reported by an IF board).
l Cause 2: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by an SDH optical interface
board).
l Cause 3: The transmit unit of the opposite station is faulty.
l Cause 4: The receive unit of the local site is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Certain high-level alarms are generated (if the alarm is reported by an IF board).
1. If the alarm is reported by the IF board, check whether the MW_BER_EXC,
MW_BER_SD, MW_FEC_UNCOR alarm is generated.

If... Then...

The alarm is generated Take priority to clear the


MW_BER_EXC, MW_BER_SD,
MW_FEC_UNCOR alarm.

The alarm is not generated Go to the next step.

2. Set the inloop on the alarmed IF port.

If... Then...

The alarm persists after the inloop is Go to Cause 4.


performed

The alarm is cleared after the inloop is Go to Cause 3.


performed

Step 2 Cause 2: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by an SDH optical interface
board).
1. If the alarm is reported by an optical interface board, exchange the transmit and receive
fiber jumpers at both ends.

If... Then...

The alarm persists after the exchange Go to Cause 3 or 4

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 677


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...

The line port of the opposite station reports Troubleshoot the optical fibers.
the R_LOF alarm

Step 3 Cause 3: The transmit unit of the opposite station is faulty.


1. Replace the opposite board where the line unit is or the opposite IF board.

If... Then...

The alarm is cleared after the board The fault is rectified, and the alarm
replacement handling is complete.

The alarm persists after the board Go to the next step.


replacement

2. Replace the system control and cross-connect board at the opposite end.

If... Then...

The alarm is cleared after the board The fault is rectified, and the alarm
replacement handling is complete.

The alarm persists after the board Go to Cause 4.


replacement

Step 4 Cause 4: The receive unit of the local site is faulty.


1. Replace the alarmed board.

----End

Related Information
The handling procedure applies when this alarm is reported by the STM-1e port.

A.3.288 R_LOS

Description
In the case of SDH boards, the R_LOS is an alarm indicating that the signals on the receive line
side are lost. In the case of IF boards, the R_LOS is an alarm indicating that the radio frames on
the receive line side are lost.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Critical Communication alarm

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 678


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The services are interrupted. If the system is configured with protection, protection switching
may be triggered.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Certain alarms are generated (if the alarm is reported by an IF board).
l Cause 2: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by an SDH line board).
l Cause 3: The transmit unit of the opposite station is faulty.
l Cause 4: The receive unit of the local site is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Certain alarms are generated (if the alarm is reported by an IF board).
1. If the alarm is reported by the IF board, check whether the MW_BER_EXC,
MW_BER_SD, MW_FEC_UNCOR alarm is generated.

If... Then...

The alarm is generated Take priority to clear the


MW_BER_EXC, MW_BER_SD,
MW_FEC_UNCOR alarm.

The alarm is not generated Go to the next step.

2. Set the inloop on the alarmed IF port.

If... Then...

The alarm persists after the inloop is Go to Cause 4.


performed

The alarm is cleared after the inloop is Go to Cause 3.


performed

Step 2 Cause 2: The line performance degrades (if the alarm is reported by an SDH line board).
1. If the alarm is reported by an optical interface board, exchange the transmit and receive
fiber jumpers at both ends.

If... Then...

The alarm persists after the exchange Go to Cause 3 or 4

The line port of the opposite station reports Troubleshoot the optical fibers.
the R_LOF alarm

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 679


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Step 3 Cause 3: The transmit unit of the opposite station is faulty.


1. Replace the opposite board where the line unit is or the opposite IF board.

If... Then...

The alarm is cleared after the board The fault is rectified, and the alarm
replacement handling is complete.

The alarm persists after the board Proceed to the next step.
replacement

2. Replace the system control and cross-connect board at the opposite end.

If... Then...

The alarm is cleared after the board The fault is rectified, and the alarm
replacement handling is complete.

The alarm persists after the board Go to Cause 4.


replacement

Step 4 Cause 4: The receive unit of the local site is faulty.


1. Replace the alarmed board.

----End

Related Information
The handling procedure applies when this alarm is reported by the STM-1e port.

A.3.289 R_OOF

Description
The R_OOF is an alarm indicating an out-of-frame event on the receive side of the line.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Critical Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 680


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Impact on the System


l When this alarm occurs, services are interrupted, and the AIS signal is inserted on the
downstream NE.
l When this alarm occurs, the system automatically returns the MS_RDI message to the
upstream NE. Then, the upstream NE reports the MS_RDI alarm.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The transmit cable is faulty, and the fiber connector is loose or contaminated.
l Cause 2: The receive board on the local NE is faulty.
l Cause 3: The transmit board on the opposite NE is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The transmit cable is faulty, and the fiber connector is loose or contaminated.
1. Check whether the transmit optical power of the board connected to the board that reports
the alarm is within the normal range.

If... Then...

The transmit optical power of the opposite board is abnormal Go to Step 3.

The transmit optical power of the opposite board is normal Go to the next step.

2. On the NMS, check whether the receive optical power of the local board is within the normal
range.

If... Then...

The receive optical power of the local board is too low Go to the next step.

The receive optical power of the local board is too high Go to Step 2.

3. Check whether the bend radius of the fiber jumper is within the normal range. If the bend
radius is less than 6 cm, re-roll the tail fiber. Check whether the alarm is cleared.
4. If the alarm persists, check whether the optical interface on the board is firmly connected
to the fiber jumper. Ensure that the fiber connector is firmly connected. Then, check whether
the R_LOS alarm is cleared.
5. If the alarm persists, check whether the fiber connector is contaminated. If yes, clean the
fiber and fiber connector. For details, see 8.10 Cleaning Fiber Connectors and
Adapters.
6. Check whether the optical cable is aged out, damaged, or pressed. If yes, replace the optical
cable.

Step 2 Cause 2: The receive board on the local NE is faulty.


1. Perform a hardware inloop for the transmit and receive interfaces of the port that reports
the alarm on the local NE. For details, see 8.5 Hardware Loopback.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 681


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

NOTICE
A loopback causes service interruption. To prevent optical power overload during hardware
inloop, you can add an optical attenuator to the optical interface according to the optical
power specifications of the board.

If... Then...

The alarm persists The local board is faulty. Go to the next step.

The alarm is cleared Go to Step 3.

2. Replace the board that reports the R_OOF alarm on the local NE. If the board supports the
pluggable optical module, replace the pluggable optical module. For details, see 6.14
Replacing the SFP. Otherwise, replace the faulty board. For details, see 6.4 Replacing
the Channelized STM-1 Processing Board.

Step 3 Cause 3: The transmit board on the opposite NE is faulty.


1. Rectify the fault on the opposite board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.290 RADIO_FADING_MARGIN_INSUFF

Description
The RADIO_FADING_MARGIN_INSUFF is an alarm indicating that the mean receive power
of the ODUs are lower than the threshold of the receive power (the threshold value is about the
receiver sensitivity + 14 dB).

When the receive power of the ODUs in consecutive six hours is lower than the threshold, the
system reports the alarm. When the mean receive power of the ODUs becomes normal and lasts
for three minutes after the alarm is reported, the alarm is cleared.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Minor Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 682


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Impact on the System


If the MW_BER_EXC, MW_BER_SD, MW_LOF or MW_FEC_UNCOR alarm is not
generated, the service is not affected.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The ODU fault of the transmit end causes the abnormal transmit power.
l Cause 2: The direction of the antenna is deflected.
l Cause 3: The transmission environment changes.
l Cause 4: The fade margin in the case of rain and fog in the network planning is insufficient.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The ODU fault of the transmit end causes the abnormal transmit power.
1. Check whether the ODU at the transmit end reports the RADIO_TSL_LOW alarm.

If... Then...
The ODU at the transmit end reports the Handle the RADIO_TSL_LOW alarm.
RADIO_TSL_LOW alarm
The ODU at the transmit end does not report the Go to Cause 2.
RADIO_TSL_LOW alarm

Step 2 Cause 2: The direction of the antenna is deflected.


1. Check whether the direction of the antenna is deflected.

If... Then...
The direction of the antenna is deflected Adjust the direction of the antenna.
The direction of the antenna is not deflected Go to Cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: The transmission environment changes.


1. Check whether the transmission environment changes. For example, check whether any
building blocks the transmission and increases the link fading significantly.

If... Then...
The transmission environment changes Contact the network planning department for
re-planning the transmission trail.
The transmission environment does not Go to Cause 4.
change

Step 4 Cause 4: The fade margin in the case of rain and fog in the network planning is insufficient.
1. If the alarm is reported frequently, contact the network planning department to increase the
fade margin by re-planning the transmission trail.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 683


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Related Information
None.

A.3.291 RADIO_MUTE

Description
The RADIO_MUTE is an alarm indicating that radio transmitter is muted.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Warning Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The transmitter does not transmit services.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The other alarms are generated.
l Cause 2: The transmitter of the local site is muted manually.
l Cause 3: The IF board is faulty, causing abnormal IF output.
l Cause 4: The data output is abnormal because the ODU is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The other alarms are generated.
1. Check whether the CONFIG_NOSUPPORT or IF_INPWR_ABN alarm is generated. If
yes, take priority to clear the alarm.

Step 2 Cause 2: The transmitter of the local site is muted manually.


1. Check whether the transmitter of the ODU is muted. For details, see Configuring a Single-
Hop Radio Link. If yes, cancel the muting operation. Then, set the transmitting status of
the ODU to unmute.

Step 3 Cause 3: The IF board is faulty, causing abnormal IF output.


1. Replace the IF board.

Step 4 Cause 4: The data output is abnormal because the ODU is faulty.
1. Replace the ODU.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 684


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Related Information
The logical slot ID of the ODU is obtained by adding 20 to the slot ID of the IF board connected
to the ODU.

A.3.292 RADIO_RSL_BEYONDTH

Description
The RADIO_RSL_BEYONDTH is an alarm indicating that the antennas are not aligned. When
the receive power is set on the NE, the NE enables the antenna alignment indication function.
If the actual receive power of the ODU is lower than the power to be received 3 dB, the
RADIO_RSL_BEYONDTH alarm is reported. Then, if the antennas are aligned for continuous
30 minutes, the antenna alignment indication function is disabled automatically. Afterwards, the
RADIO_RSL_BEYONDTH alarm is reported only when the
RADIO_FADING_MARGIN_INSUFF alarm is reported.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


If the MW_BER_EXC, MW_BER_SD, MW_LOF or MW_FEC_UNCOR alarm is not
generated, the service is not affected.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Antennas are not aligned during the equipment commissioning.
l Cause 2: The RADIO_FADING_MARGIN_INSUFF is reported when the NE is running.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Antennas are not aligned during the equipment commissioning.
1. Align the antennas, and ensure that the actual receive power is within the range of preset
receive power +/-3 dB.

Step 2 Cause 2: The RADIO_FADING_MARGIN_INSUFF is reported when the NE is running.


1. Handle the RADIO_FADING_MARGIN_INSUFF alarm. When the
RADIO_FADING_MARGIN_INSUFF alarm is cleared, the RADIO_RSL_BEYONDTH
alarm is cleared.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 685


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Related Information
None.

A.3.293 RADIO_RSL_HIGH

Description
The RADIO_RSL_HIGH is an alarm indicating that the radio receive power is very high. This
alarm is reported if the detected receive power is equal to or higher than the upper threshold of
the ODU (-20 dBm).

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Critical Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The service transmission is affected. If the system is configured with 1+1 protection, protection
switching may be triggered.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The local ODU is faulty.
l Cause 2: There is a strong interference source nearby.
l Cause 3: The transmit power of the opposite ODU is very high.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The local ODU is faulty.
1. 6.15 Replacing the ODU.

Step 2 Cause 2: There is a strong interference source nearby.


1. Check whether any nearby signal source transmits signals whose frequency is close to the
specified range. If yes, check whether the signal source can be shut down or removed. If
not, contact the network planning department for replanning the frequency.

Step 3 Cause 3: The transmit power of the opposite ODU is very high
1. Reset the transmit power of the ODU at the opposite end. For details, see Configuring a
Single-Hop Radio Link.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 686


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Related Information
None.

A.3.294 RADIO_RSL_LOW

Description
The RADIO_RSL_LOW is an alarm indicating that the radio receive power is very low. This
alarm is reported if the detected receive power is equal to or lower than the upper threshold of
the ODU (-90 dBm).

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Critical Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


If no MW_BER_EXC, MW_BER_SD, MW_LOF or MW_FEC_UNCOR alarm is
generated, the services are not affected.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Other alarms occur at the opposite station.
l Cause 2: The transmit power of the opposite station is very low.
l Cause 3: The local ODU is faulty.
l Cause 4: Signal attenuation on the radio link is very heavy.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Other alarms occur at the opposite station.
Check whether any of the following alarms is generated in the equipment of the opposite station.
If yes, take priority to clear the alarm.
l RADIO_MUTE
l CONFIG_NOSUPPORT
l RADIO_TSL_LOW
l BD_STATUS

Step 2 Cause 2: The transmit power of the opposite station is very low.
1. See Configuring a Single-Hop Radio Link. Check whether the transmit power of the
opposite station is normal. If not, replace the ODU of the opposite station.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 687


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Step 3 Cause 3: The local ODU is faulty.


1. Replace the ODU at the local end.

Step 4 Cause 4: Signal attenuation on the radio link is very heavy.


1. Browse history alarms and check whether the alarm is generated continuously.

If the alarm is generated occasionally, contact the network planning department to change
the design to increase the anti-fading performance.
2. Check whether the antennas at both ends are adjusted properly.

If not, align the antennas again.


3. Check whether any mountain or building obstacle exists in the transmit direction.

If yes, contact the network planning department for proper modification of the planning
design, hence preventing the block of the mountain or building obstacle.
4. Check whether the polarization direction of the antenna, ODU, and hybrid coupler is set
correctly.

If not, correct the polarization direction.


5. Check whether the outdoor units such as antennas, combiner, ODU, and flexible waveguide
are wet, damp, or damaged.

If yes, replace the unit that is wet, damp, or damaged. For the operations, see 6 Part
Replacement
6. Check whether the antenna gain at both the transmit and receive ends meets the requirement.

If not, replace the antenna.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.295 RADIO_TSL_HIGH

Description
The RADIO_TSL_HIGH is an alarm indicating that the radio transmit power is too high. This
alarm is reported when the detected transmit power is higher than the upper power threshold of
the ODU.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Critical Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 688


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Impact on the System


The service transmission is affected. If the system is configured with 1+1 protection, protection
switching may be triggered.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The local ODU is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The local ODU is faulty.
1. Replace the ODU.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.296 RADIO_TSL_LOW

Description
The RADIO_TSL_LOW is an alarm indicating that the radio transmit power is very low. This
alarm is reported when the detected transmit power is less than the lower power threshold of the
ODU.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Critical Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The service transmission is affected. If the system is configured with 1+1 protection, protection
switching may be triggered.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The local ODU is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The local ODU is faulty.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 689


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

1. Replace the ODU.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.297 RELAY_ALARM_CRITICAL

Description
The RELAY_ALARM_CRITICAL is an alarm indicating the critical alarm inputs. This alarm
occurs when the user sets the severity of an available alarm input to critical and there is such an
alarm input.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Critical Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the RELAY_ALARM_CRITICAL alarm occurs, it does not affect the operation of the
board or the services on the NE.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: There is a critical alarm input.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: There is a critical alarm input.
1. Clear the alarms of the external equipment according to the defined meanings of the alarms.
Then, the RELAY_ALARM_CRITICAL alarm is cleared.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 690


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.298 RELAY_ALARM_IGNORE

Description
The RELAY_ALARM_IGNORE is an alarm indicating the warning alarm inputs. This alarm
occurs when the user sets the severity of an available alarm input to warning and there is such
an alarm input.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Warning Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the RELAY_ALARM_IGNORE alarm occurs, it does not affect the operation of the board
or the services on the NE.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: There is a warning alarm input.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: There is a warning alarm input.
1. Clear the alarms of the external equipment according to the defined meanings of the alarms.
Then, the RELAY_ALARM_IGNORE alarm is cleared.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.299 RELAY_ALARM_MAJOR

Description
The RELAY_ALARM_MAJOR is an alarm indicating the major alarm inputs. This alarm occurs
when the user sets the severity of an available alarm input to major and there is such an alarm
input.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 691


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the RELAY_ALARM_MAJOR alarm occurs, it does not affect the operation of the board
or or the services on the NE.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: There is a major alarm input.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: There is a major alarm input.
1. Clear the alarms of the external equipment according to the defined meanings of the alarms.
Then, the RELAY_ALARM_MAJOR alarm is cleared.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.300 RELAY_ALARM_MINOR

Description
The RELAY_ALARM_MINOR is an alarm indicating the minor alarm inputs. This alarm occurs
when the user sets the severity of an available alarm input to minor and there is such an alarm
input.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Minor Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 692


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Impact on the System


When the RELAY_ALARM_MINOR alarm occurs, it does not affect the operation of the board
or or the services on the NE.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: There is a minor alarm input.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: There is a minor alarm input.
1. Clear the alarms of the external equipment according to the defined meanings of the alarms.
Then, the RELAY_ALARM_MINOR alarm is cleared.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.301 RMFA
Description
The RMFA is an alarm indicating the loss of multiframe alignment at the remote end. This alarm
occurs when the local end detects all 1s of the remote indication bits in Z consecutive CAS
multiframes (Z = 1-5) of the framed E1/T1 input.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the ID of the optical interface. The value is always 0x01.
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the path ID.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the services at the local site are not affected. The alarm indicates that
the LMFA alarm occurs at the opposite end.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 693


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Possible Causes
The LMFA alarm occurs at the opposite end.

Procedure
Step 1 Check whether the opposite end of the alarmed path reports the LMFA alarm. If yes, clear the
LMFA alarm. Then, the RMFA alarm at the local end clears.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.302 RPS_INDI

Description
The RPS_INDI is an alarm indicating that the radio protection switching is detected.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the ID of the protection group.
Parameter 2 Indicates the type of protection switching.

0x01: HSB protection switching

Impact on the System


l During the HSB protection switching, services are interrupted. After the HSB switching is
complete, the services are restored to normal.
l During the HSM protection switching, no bit errors occur and the services are not affected.

Possible Causes
l The possible causes of the HSB protection switching are as follows:

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 694


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Cause 1: An external switching event occurs


Cause 2: An automatic switching event occurs.
Cause 3: A reverse switching event occurs.
l The possible causes of HSM protection switching are as follows:
The quality of the main channel degrades.
In the case of Hybrid radio, the automatic switching condition of the HSM is that the
quality of the main channel degrades.
In the case of SDH/PDH radio, an alarm that triggers the HSM switching is reported on
the radio link.

Procedure
Step 1 Determine the type of the protection switching based on the alarm parameters.

Step 2 Cause 1 of HSB switching: An external switching event occurs. That is, the NMS issues a
command to trigger the switching.
1. Check whether the switching is the forced switching or manual switching. For details, see
Querying the IF 1+1 Protection Status.

If... Then...
The switching is the forced switching or Find the cause and release the switching
manual switching immediately.
The switching is not the forced Go to Cause 2 of HSB switching.
switching or manual switching

Step 3 Cause 2 of HSB switching: An automatic switching event occurs. That is, the equipment is faulty,
or the service is defective.
1. Check whether the following faults or alarms occur. If yes, rectify the faults or clear the
alarms.
l The hardware of the IF board or the ODU is faulty.
l VOLT_LOS
l RADIO_TSL_HIGH, RADIO_TSL_LOW, or RADIO_RSL_HIGH
l IF_INPWR_ABN or CONFIG_NOSUPPORT
l R_LOC, R_LOF, R_LOS, or MW_LOF
NOTE

l If the switching is non-revertive, the services are not automatically switched to the working path
when the working path is restored to normal, and the RPS_INDI alarm persists. In this case, you
need to manually switch the services from the protection path to the working path. The RPS_INDI
alarm is cleared only when the switching is successful.
l If the switching is revertive, the services are automatically switched to the working path only
when the specified wait-to-restore (WTR) time expires after the working path is restored to
normal. The RPS_INDI alarm is cleared only when the switching is successful.

Step 4 Cause 3 of HSB switching: A reverse switching event occurs.


1. Query whether the active and standby IF boards report the MW_RDI alarm. If yes, take
priority to clear the MW_RDI alarm.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 695


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Step 5 Cause 1 of HSM switching: In the case of Hybrid radio, the quality of the main channel degrades.
1. Check whether the AM_DOWNSHIFT alarm is reported by an IF board. If the alarm is
reported by an IF board, refer to AM_DOWNSHIFT to rectify the fault that causes the
quality of the main channel to degrade. If the alarm is not reported by an IF board, the
quality of the main channel degrades possibly due to the weather. In this case, you do not
need to handle the problem, because this is a normal situation.

Step 6 Cause 2 of HSM switching: In the case of SDH/PDH radio, an alarm that triggers the HSM
switching is reported on the radio link.
1. Check whether any alarm that triggers the HSM switching is reported by an IF board of the
IF 1+1 protection group. If yes, take priority to clear the alarm.
HSM switching may be triggered by any of the following alarms:
l R_LOC, R_LOF, R_LOS, or MW_LOF
l MW_BER_EXC, MW_BER_SD, MW_FEC_UNCOR
l B1_SD or B2_SD

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.303 RS_CROSSTR

Description
The RS_CROSSTR is an alarm indicating that a regenerator section performance indicator
crosses the threshold. This alarm is reported if a board detects that a regenerator section bit error
performance event crosses the preset threshold.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Service alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the performance monitoring period:

l 0x01: 15 minutes
l 0x02: 24 hours

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 696


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Parameter 2 is always 0x00. Parameter 3 indicate the ID of a
performance event that causes the alarm and has the following
meanings:

l 0x01: RSBBE
l 0x02: RSES
l 0x03: RSSES
l 0x04: RSOOF
l 0x05: RSOFS
l 0x06: RSUAS
l 0x07: RSCSES

Impact on the System


A large number of bit errors occur in the services, and the services may be interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Services are interrupted for a long time.
l Cause 2: The regenerator section bit error performance indicator crosses the preset
threshold.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Services are interrupted for a long time.
NOTE
Handle the alarm as follows if the value of parameter 3 is 0x06:
1. Check whether fibers are properly connected. If not, connect the fibers again according to
planning information.
2. Check whether cross-connections are configured for service ports. If not, configure cross-
connections again according to planning information.

Step 2 Cause 2: The regenerator section bit error performance indicator crosses the preset threshold.
1. Find out the performance event that crosses the preset threshold. For details, see 4.3.5
Browsing the Performance Event Threshold-Crossing Records.
2. Handle the performance event that crosses the threshold.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.304 RTC_FAIL

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 697


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Description
The RTC_FAIL is an alarm indicating that the real-time clock (RTC) on the system control
board fails.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The service is not affected.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The RTC on the system control board is abnormal.
l Cause 2: The board temperature is too high.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The RTC on the system control board is abnormal.
1. Replace the system control, switching, and timing board.

Step 2 Cause 2: The board temperature is too high.


1. 4.3.1 Browsing Current Alarms, and if the board reports the TEMP_ALARM alarm,
clear this alarm first.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.305 S1_SYN_CHANGE

Description
The S1_SYN_CHANGE is an alarm indicating that the clock source is switched in S1 byte
mode.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 698


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 0x01: system priority list

0x02: external clock priority list

Impact on the System


If the new clock source has a lower quality, pointer justifications and bit errors are generated
after the switching of clock source. As a result, the quality of services is affected.

Possible Causes
When the SSM protocol or extended SSM protocol is enabled.

l Cause 1: The original clock source is lost.


l Cause 2: The fiber is cut off.
l Cause 3: The external BITS is interrupted.
l Cause 4: The S1_SYN_CHANGE alarm occurs at the upstream station.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The original clock source is lost.
1. Handle the SYNC_C_LOS alarm that is related to the original clock source.

Step 2 Cause 2: The fiber is cut off.


1. Replace the faulty fiber.

Step 3 Cause 3: The external BITS is interrupted.


1. Check whether the cable connect NE to BITS is normal. If not, replace the faulty cable.

Step 4 Cause 4: The S1_SYN_CHANGE alarm reported at the upstream station.


1. Handle the S1_SYN_CHANGE alarm reported at the upstream station.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 699


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Related Information
None.

A.3.306 SCCDATA_BACKUP_FAIL(SYNC_FAIL)

Description
The SCCDATA_BACKUP_FAIL(SYNC_FAIL) is an alarm indicating that the batch backup
on SCC boards fails.

NOTE
SCCDATA_BACKUP_FAIL and SYNC_FAIL indicate the same alarm. SYNC_FAIL is used on NMS
of earlier versions and SCCDATA_BACKUP_FAIL is used on NMS of later versions.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Processing alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the cause of the failure.

l 0x1F: The database backup fails.


l 0x20: Software version verification fails on the main and standby SCC
boards.
l 0x21: Communication between the main and standby SCC boards fails.
l 0x22: The main and standby SCC boards have different data after an upgrade.

Impact on the System


Data synchronization between the main and standby SCC boards fails, and the switching between
the two boards is unavailable.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The main and standby SCC boards have different versions of software.
l Cause 2: Communication between the main and standby SCC boards fails.
l Cause 3: Databases on the main and standby SCC boards are damaged.
l Cause 4: The main and standby SCC boards have different data after an upgrade.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 700


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The main and standby SCC boards have different versions of software.
1. Query and record the software versions of the main and standby SCC boards according to
4.8.4 Querying the Board Information Report.
2. If the software versions are different, determine the correct version based on the version
mapping table and replace the SCC board with an incorrect version. For details, see 6.10
Replacing the System Control, Switching and Timing Board.

Step 2 Cause 2: Communication between the main and standby SCC boards fails.
1. Check whether the system reports the COMMUN_FAIL alarm.
2. If yes, clear the COMMUN_FAIL alarm. The system will start batch backup
automatically.

Step 3 Cause 3: Databases on the main and standby SCC boards are damaged.
1. Check whether the system reports the DBMS_ERROR alarm. For details, see 4.3.1
Browsing Current Alarms.
2. If yes, clear the DBMS_ERROR alarm. Then, check whether the SYNC_FAIL alarm is
cleared.

Step 4 Cause 4: The main and standby SCC boards have different data after an upgrade.
1. Re-install the standby SCC board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.307 SEC_RADIUS_FAIL

Description
The SEC_RADIUS_FAIL is an alarm indicating that RADIUS authentication fails over many
times. This alarm is reported when the RADIUS authentication fails for five consecutive times.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 701


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 to Parameter 16 Indicates the username.

Impact on the System


A user cannot log in to an NE.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The active period of the account expires.
l Cause 2: Configurations on the RADIUS server are incorrect, such as passwords and access
policies.
l Cause 3: There are unauthenticated login attempts.
l Cause 4: The shared key for the NE and the RADIUS server is configured incorrectly.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The active period of the account expires.
1. Use an active account.

Step 2 Cause 2: Configurations on the RADIUS server are incorrect, such as passwords and access
policies.
1. Enter the correct password.
2. Set correct access policies.

Step 3 Cause 3: There are unauthenticated login attempts.


1. Eliminate the source that initiates the unauthenticated login attempts.

Step 4 Cause 4: The shared key for the NE and the RADIUS server is configured incorrectly.
1. Set the shared key correctly.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.308 SECU_ALM

Description
The SECU_ALM is an alarm indicating that an illegal user fails to log in to the NE.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 702


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the terminal type used in the login attempt.
Parameters 2 and 3 Indicate the errors that occur in the login attempt.

Parameters 4 and 5 Indicate the first two characters of the user name.

Impact on the System


The SECU_ALM alarm is ended soon after it is reported, and the alarm does not affect the system
and services.

Possible Causes
An illegal user tries to log in to the NE.

Procedure
Step 1 An illegal user tries to log in to the NE.
1. Query the NE log to check the user name that is used for the login.

----End

Related Information
After a user fails to log in to an NE for five consecutive times (if the interval between two logins
is less than 3 minutes, the two logins are consecutive logins), the SECU_ALM alarm is reported
upon each subsequent login failure and meanwhile the user is locked for 900 seconds. During
the 900 seconds, the user cannot log in to the NE.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 703


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.309 SRV_SHUTDOWN_LD

Description
The SRV_SHUTDOWN_LD alarm indicates that an Ethernet service is deactivated. This alarm
is reported when an Ethernet service is deactivated due to a service loop. This alarm is cleared
after the Ethernet service is reactivated.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Warning Service alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The loop of the alarmed Ethernet service is released, and the Ethernet service is restored.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: A loop occurs in an Ethernet service and therefore the Ethernet service is deactivated.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: A loop occurs in an Ethernet service and therefore the Ethernet service is deactivated.
1. Check whether a service is looped back on the path of the alarmed Ethernet service.
2. Re-configure the preceding service based on the network plan.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.310 SSL_CERT_NOENC

Description
SSL_CERT_NOEN indicates the certificate file of SSL is not encrypted.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Equipment Alarm

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 704


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


Unencrypted certificate file is stored on device, private key of the file maybe be get illegally.

Possible Causes
Certificate file of SSL is not encrypted.

Procedure
Step 1 Download and verify the encrypted SSL certificate by NMS.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.311 SUBNET_RT_CONFLICT

Description
The SUBNET_RT_CONFLICT is an alarm indicating a subnetwork route conflict. This alarm
occurs when the subnet route of an NMS port, that is, the IP subnet route of an NE, covers the
learned route of an OSPF subnet whose mask is longer than that of the IP subnet.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 to Parameter 4 Indicate the IP address of the subnet whose route is covered by
the NE IP subnet route and whose mask is longer than that of the
NE IP subnet. When the routes of multiple subnets are covered
by the IP subnet route, this parameter is the IP address of the
subnet with the longest mask.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 705


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning
Parameter 5 Indicates the mask length.

Impact on the System


The NMS cannot manage the NEs through the NMS port of the NE that report the
SUBNET_RT_CONFLICT alarm.

Possible Causes
The subnet route of an NMS port (the IP subnet route of an NE) covers the learned route of an
OSPF subnet whose mask is longer than that of the IP subnet.

Procedure
Step 1 Collect the information about all NEs that report this alarm and check the DCN networking
based on the planned network topology.

Step 2 Obtain the information about the conflicting subnets and their masks based on the alarm
parameters.

Step 3 Determine the rectification plan based on the network topology and subnet information to ensure
that the subnet masks of non-gateway NEs are consistent with the mask of the gateway NE.
When subnet masks of multiple NEs need to be changed, change their subnet masks from the
farthest NE to the nearest one.

CAUTION
If the mask of a gateway NE needs to be changed, ensure that the DCN route after the change
is correct. If the DCN route is incorrect, NEs may be unreachable to the NMS.

Step 4 Change the subnet masks of NEs according to the plan.

----End

Related Information
The SUBNET_RT_CONFLICT alarm is generally caused by incorrect configurations of subnet
masks on NEs. For example, NE1 and NE2 are connected using air interfaces and the OSPF
protocol is enabled. The communication parameters and routing information of the two NEs are
listed in the following table.

If the NMS whose IP address is 129.9.0.254 is connected to the NMS port of NE1, the route of
packets transmitted from NE1 to the NMS is "129.9.0.0/255.255.255.0/129.9.0.2/OSPF/air
interface" according to the longest match principle. That is, the packets are transmitted from the
air interface of NE1 to the air interface of NE2 and finally to the NMS port of NE2. Therefore,
the NMS cannot manage NE1 properly.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 706


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

NE Parameter

NE1 IP address 129.9.0.1

Subnet mask 255.255.0.0

Main IP routes l 129.9.0.0/255.255.0.0/129.9.0.1/direct/Ethernet


(destination IP address/ l 129.9.0.0/255.255.255.0/129.9.0.2/OSPF/IF
subnet mask/gateway/ l 129.9.0.1/255.255.255.255/127.0.0.1/direct/loop
protocol/interface)
l 129.9.0.2/255.255.255.0/129.9.0.2/direct/IF

NE2 IP address 129.9.0.2

Subnet mask 255.255.255.0

Main IP routes l 129.9.0.0/255.255.255.0/129.9.0.1/direct/Ethernet


(destination IP address/ l 129.9.0.0/255.255.0.0/129.9.0.2/OSPF/air interface
subnet mask/gateway/ l 129.9.0.2/255.255.255.255/127.0.0.1/direct/loop
protocol/interface)
l 129.9.0.1/255.255.255.0/129.9.0.2/direct/IF

A.3.312 SWDL_ACTIVATED_TIMEOUT

Description
The SWDL_ACTIVATED_TIMEOUT is an alarm indicating the activation timeout of the
software package. During the package loading, the system reports the alarm if no data is
submitted within 30 minutes after activation of the NE software or board software.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Critical Processing alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The NE does not perform the submit operation. As a result, the software in the two areas of the
double-area boards on the NE is inconsistent.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The radio link is faulty. As a result, the NE involved in the package loading fails to
receive the submit command.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 707


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The radio link is faulty. As a result, the NE involved in the package loading fails to
receive the submit command.
1. Check whether the radio link is faulty.

If... Then...
The radio link is faulty Troubleshoot the radio link to ensure that the link
between the nodes to be loaded is normal.
The radio link is normal Perform the package loading to the NE again.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.313 SWDL_AUTOMATCH_INH

Description
The SWDL_AUTOMATCH_INH is an alarm indicating that the automatic match function is
disabled. When the automatic match function of the board is disabled, the system reports the
alarm if the board cannot match the software from the system control board.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Processing alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When a board whose version is not consistent with the software version of the NE is installed,
the software versions of the whole NE are not consistent if the board cannot automatically match
the software from the system control board. As a result, certain functions of the NE cannot run
normally.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The automatic match function is disabled.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The automatic match function is disabled.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 708


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

1. Contact the Huawei technical support engineers for troubleshooting.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.314 SWDL_CHGMNG_NOMATCH

Description
The SWDL_CHGMNG_NOMATCH is an alarm of software inconsistency. After an NE is
power recycled and the boards on the NE get online, if the system detects that the system control
board and any other boards are inconsistent in software packages, the system reports the
SWDL_CHGMNG_NOMATCH alarm.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Critical Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the SWDL_CHGMNG_NOMATCH alarm is reported, certain functions of the NE may
be affected.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: After a system control board is replaced, the software package in the new system control
board is inconsistent with that in other boards.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: After a system control board is replaced, the software package in the new system control
board is inconsistent with that in other boards.
1. Re-load the software packages on the NE where the SWDL_CHGMNG_NOMATCH
alarm is reported.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 709


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.315 SWDL_COMMIT_FAIL

Description
The SWDL_COMMIT_FAIL is an alarm indicating that the commission operation on the NE
fails. This alarm is reported when the commission operation fails in the package diffusion.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Processing alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When the SWDL_COMMIT_FAIL alarm occurs, the software versions in the two areas of the
double-area board are inconsistent.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: File backup fails.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: File backup fails.
1. Check whether the loaded package is correct.
2. Perform the package diffusion again on the NE where the alarm is reported.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.316 SWDL_INPROCESS

Description
The SWDL_INPROCESS is an alarm indicating that the NE is loading the software package.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Warning Processing alarm

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 710


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The NE is loading the software package. The operations including modifying configurations,
uploading/downloading files, and backing up the database are prohibited.

Possible Causes
The NE is loading the software package.

Procedure
Step 1 The SWDL_INPROCESS alarm is cleared automatically after the loading or rollback is
complete. Hence, this alarm can be neglected.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.317 SWDL_NEPKGCHECK

Description
The SWDL_NEPKGCHECK is an alarm indicating that a file in the loaded software package
is lost or cannot be recovered after a file check failure. This alarm is reported when the NE
software initiates a package file check, detects the loss of a file, and fails to recover the file from
any complete package in other areas.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Critical Processing alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


l If this alarm occurs during package loading, package loading fails.
l If this alarm occurs in other conditions, automatic file matching fails.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: Certain files of the package are missing and cannot be recovered.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 711


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Certain files of the package are missing and cannot be recovered.
1. Ensure that the loaded software package is correct. Perform the package loading again on
the NE where the SWDL_NEPKGCHECK alarm is reported.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.318 SWDL_PKG_NOBDSOFT

Description
The SWDL_PKG_NOBDSOFT is an alarm indicating that certain board software is missing
from the software package. This alarm is reported when the required software is missing from
the software package during the automatic match of the board.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Processing alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The board cannot perform automatic match, because the board software is missing from the
software package. Therefore, the board software version is inconsistent with the NE software
version, and certain functions of the NE may be affected.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: Certain board software is uninstalled during the software package loading.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Certain board software is uninstalled during the software package loading.
1. Add the required board software to the software package. Alternatively, perform the
software package loading again.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 712


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.319 SWDL_PKGVER_MM

Description
The SWDL_PKGVER_MM is an alarm indicating that the consistency check on the software
package version fails. This alarm is reported when the consistency check on the software package
version fails.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Minor Processing alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The software version of the software package is inconsistent with the software version described
in the software package. As a result, certain functions of the NE may be affected.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The software version information in the description file of the software package is
inconsistent with the actual software version information.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The software version information in the description file of the software package is
inconsistent with the actual software version information.
1. Ensure that the loaded software package is correct. Perform the package diffusion again on
the NE where the alarm is reported.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.320 SWDL_ROLLBACK_FAIL

Description
The SWDL_ROLLBACK_FAIL is an alarm indicating that the rollback on the NE fails. This
alarm is reported when the rollback fails for any board on the NE.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 713


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Processing alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The board software version and the NE software version may mismatch, and certain functions
of the NE may be affected.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: Certain board software is uninstalled during the software package loading.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Certain board software is uninstalled during the software package loading.
1. Add the required board software to the software package. Alternatively, perform the
software package loading again.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.321 SYN_BAD

Description
The SYN_BAD is an alarm indicating that the quality of the synchronization source declines.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The NE clock fails to be locked.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 714


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The quality of the synchronization source declines.
l Cause 2: A certain board is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The quality of the synchronization source declines.
1. Take different measures based on the traced synchronization source.

If... Then...
The traced synchronization source is an Perform Steps Step 1.2 to Step 1.4.
external clock
The traced synchronization source is a Replace the system control,
line clock switching&timing board of the upstream
NE.
2. Check whether the configuration of the external clock is correct.

If... Then...
The configuration is incorrect Change the configuration data.
The configuration is correct Go to the next step.
3. Check whether the opposite equipment that provides the clock source is faulty.

If... Then...
The equipment is faulty Rectify the fault.
The equipment functions normally Go to the next step.
4. Check whether the cable that is connected to the external clock source is in normal status.

If... Then...
The cable is not in normal status Replace the cable.
The cable is in normal status Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: A certain board is faulty.


1. 6.10 Replacing the System Control, Switching and Timing Board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.322 SYNC_C_LOS
Description
The SYNC_C_LOS is an alarm indicating that the synchronization source is lost.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 715


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Warning Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The NE clock degrades or enters the free-run mode.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The clock source is lost.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The clock source is lost.
1. See Querying the Clock Synchronization Status, troubleshoot the synchronization sources
of the lost clock source based on the clock source priority table.

If... Then...
The synchronization source is an Handle the EXT_SYNC_LOS alarm.
external clock
The synchronization source is an IF Handle the alarm that occurs on the IF
clock board.
The synchronization source is a line Handle the alarm that occurs on the line
clock board.
The synchronization source is a Handle the alarm that occurs on the tributary
tributary clock board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.323 SYSLOG_COMM_FAIL

Description
The SYSLOG_COMM_FAIL is an alarm indicating that the communication between the NE
and the syslog server fails.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 716


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The syslog information of the NE cannot be sent to the syslog server.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: In the TCP mode, the connection between the NE and syslog server is interrupted, or
the session between the NE and server is abnormal.

Procedure
Step 1 Rectify the fault of the link between the NE and syslog server, or rectify the fault of the protocol.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.324 T_ALOS

Description
The T_ALOS is an alarm indicating that the 2Mbit/s analog signal is lost at the specific port.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The 2Mbit/s services are interrupted.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 717


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: No 2Mbit/s services are received on the port.
l Cause 2: The opposite NE is faulty.
l Cause 3: The IF cable is faulty.
l Cause 4: The alarmed board is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: No 2Mbit/s services are received on the port.
1. Check whether the alarmed port receives the 2 Mbit/s service.

If... Then...
The services are not received Transmit the services to the port or delete the
unnecessary service configuration.
The services are received Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The equipment at the opposite end is faulty.


1. Check whether the equipment at the opposite end is faulty.

If... Then...
The equipment is faulty Rectify the fault.
The equipment is normal Go to Cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: The IF cable is faulty.


1. Check whether the IF cable is faulty.

If... Then...
The IF cable is faulty Rectify the fault.
The IF cable is not faulty Go to Cause 4.

Step 4 Cause 4: The alarmed board is faulty.


1. Replace the alarmed board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.325 T_LOC

Description
The T_LOC is an alarm indicating that the clock is lost on the transmit line side.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 718


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The services in the alarmed AU-4 path are interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The cross-connect and timing board is faulty.
l Cause 2: The line board is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The cross-connect and timing board is faulty.
1. Replace the cross-connect and timing board at the local site.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared after the board is The fault is rectified. End the alarm
replaced handling.
The alarm persists after the board is Go to Cause 2.
replaced

Step 2 Cause 2: The line board is faulty.


1. Replace the alarmed board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.326 TEM_HA

Description
The TEM_HA is an alarm indicating that the laser temperature is too high.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 719


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the laser is functioning improperly. As a result, services are interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The ambient temperature of the board is too high.
l Cause 2: The optical module is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Check whether the temperature of the equipment room is too high. If yes, decrease the
temperature to an appropriate temperature. Then, check whether the alarm is cleared.

Step 2 If the alarm persists, the optical module may be faulty. Replace the faulty board. For details, see
6.14 Replacing the SFP or Replacing the Alarming Board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.327 TEM_LA

Description
The TEM_LA is an alarm indicating that the laser temperature is too low.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 720


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the laser is functioning improperly. As a result, services are interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The ambient temperature of the board is too low.
l Cause 2: The optical module is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Check whether the temperature of the equipment room is too low. If yes, increase the temperature
to an appropriate temperature. Then, check whether the alarm is cleared.

Step 2 If the alarm persists, the optical module may be faulty. Replace the faulty board. For details, see
6.14 Replacing the SFP or Replacing the Alarming Board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.328 TEMP_ALARM

Description
The TEMP_ALARM is an alarm indicating that the board temperature crosses the threshold.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Environmental alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 l 0x01: The temperature crosses the upper threshold.
l 0x02: The temperature crosses the lower threshold.

Impact on the System


The board fails to work normally.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 721


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The board temperature crosses the threshold.
l Cause 2: The temperature detection circuit of the board is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The board temperature crosses the threshold.
1. If the alarm is reported by the ODU, take appropriate measures (for example, installing a
sunshade) to control the temperature.
2. If the alarm is reported by the board on the IDU, check whether the temperature control
devices, such as air-conditioners, work normally.

If... Then...
The temperature control devices work Adjust the temperature control devices.
abnormally
The temperature control devices work Go to the next step.
normally
3. Check whether the heat dissipation hole on the IDU is covered or blocked.

If... Then...
The heat dissipation hole is covered or Clear or remove the covering materials or
blocked obstacles.
The heat dissipation hole is not covered or Go to Cause 2.
blocked

Step 2 Cause 2: The temperature detection circuit of the board is faulty.


1. If the ambient temperature is normal and no other heat dissipation problems exist, replace
the alarmed board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.329 TEMP_OVER

Description
The TEMP_OVER is an alarm indicating that the working temperature of the board crosses the
threshold.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 722


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 l 0x01: The temperature crosses the upper threshold.
l 0x02: The temperature crosses the lower threshold.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the board cannot work properly.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The board temperature crosses the threshold.
l Cause 2: The temperature detection circuit of the board is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The board temperature crosses the threshold.
1. Check whether temperature control devices, such as air-conditioners, work properly.

If... Then...
The temperature control devices Adjust the temperature control devices.
malfunction
The temperature control devices work Go to the next step.
properly
2. Check whether the heat dissipation hole on the IDU is covered or blocked.

If... Then...
The heat dissipation hole is covered or Clear or remove the covering materials or
blocked obstacles.
The heat dissipation hole is not covered or Go to the next step.
blocked

Step 2 Cause 2: The temperature detection circuit of the board is faulty.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 723


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

1. If the ambient temperature is normal and no other heat dissipation problems exist, replace
the board that reports the alarm. For details see Replacing the Alarming Board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.330 TF
Description
The TF is an alarm indicating that the laser transmission fails. This alarm is reported when a
board detects that the output optical power of the laser exceeds the preset failure alarm threshold.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Critical Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the laser transmission fails. As a result, services are interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The laser module is damaged.
l Cause 2: The laser is aged out.

Procedure
Step 1 6.14 Replacing the SFP.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.331 THUNDERALM
Description
The THUNDERALM is an alarm indicating the surge protection failure. If the system detects
the surge protection circuit fails, the THUNDERALM occurs.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 724


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Environment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the PIU that reports the alarm.

l 0x01: PIU1
l 0x02: PIU2

Impact on the System


When the THUNDERALM occurs, the system operation and services are not affected, but the
surge protection function fails.

Possible Causes
The possible causes of the THUNDERALM alarm are as follows:
l Cause 1: The fuse tube of the surge protection circuit is interrupted.
l Cause 2: A certain board is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The fuse tube of the surge protection circuit is interrupted.
1. Replace the fuse tube, and then check whether the alarm is cleared.
Step 2 Cause 2: A certain board is faulty.
1. Replace the board that reports the THUNDERALM alarm.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.332 TIME_LOCK_FAIL
Description
The TIME_LOCK_FAIL is an alarm indicating a time locking failure.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 725


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
Name Meaning

Parameter 1 l 0x01: indicates that the time synchronization is disabled or the 1588v2 port
is not traced.
l 0x02: indicates that the clock is unlocked because phase discrimination value
within the given time exceeds the upper threshold.
l 0x03: indicates that the forward delay is abnormal.
l 0x04: indicates that the backward delay is abnormal.
l 0x05: indicates that the accumulated offset value within the given time
exceeds 240 ns.
l 0x06: indicates that the accumulated offset value within the given time is
greater than 100 ns but less than 240 ns.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the time of the slave NE fails to trace that of the master NE. Bit errors
may occur in the service.

Possible Causes
The timestamp change on the NE is too large.

Procedure
Step 1 Check whether there are CLK_LOCK_FAIL or TIME_NO_TRACE_MODE alarms on the
NE. If yes, clear them before you proceed.
Step 2 Adjust the time on the upstream NE.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.333 TIME_NO_TRACE_MODE
Description
The TIME_NO_TRACE_MODE is an alarm indicating that the high precision time of the boards
is in the non-traced status. This alarm is reported when the high precision time function of an
NE is enabled and the current tracing source is the internal time source.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 726


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 Indicate the cause of the alarm.

0x01: indicates that the IEEE 1588v2 function is enabled on a port.

0x02: indicates that an external clock interface is set to the input status.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, time between the NE and the upstream NEs cannot be synchronized.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The clock source priority table is not configured when an external clock interface
is used to trace the upstream NE clock.
l Cause 2: The link between the traced upstream time source and the NE is faulty.
l Cause 3: The announce attribute of the local NE is inconsistent with that of the upstream
NE. As a result, the time source cannot be traced.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The clock source priority table is not configured when an external clock interface is
used to trace the upstream NE clock.
1. Set the clock source priority. For details, see Configuring the Clock Sources.

Step 2 Cause 2: The link between the traced upstream time source and the NE is faulty.
1. Check the link fault.

Step 3 Cause 3: The announce attribute of the local NE is inconsistent with that of the upstream NE.
As a result, the time source cannot be traced.
1. Check clock tracing relationships on the entire network based on the network plan.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 727


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.334 TR_LOC

Description
The TR_LOC is an alarm indicating that the clock is faulty. This alarm is reported when a board
detects that the clock signal transmitted from the clock unit to the board is lost.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 Indicates the slot ID of the board that loses the clock.

l 0x01: board with a smaller slot ID.


l 0x02: board with a larger slot ID.
l 0x03: two boards.

Impact on the System


l If the protection cross-connect board is faulty, the services are not affected.
l If the working cross-connect board is faulty, the services are switched, therefore causing
transient service interruption.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: If one board reports this alarm, the board hardware is faulty.
l Cause 2: If multiple boards report this alarm, the clock cable of the cross-connect board is
faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Locate the alarmed board according to the alarm parameter.

Step 2 Cause 1: If one board reports this alarm, the board hardware is faulty.
1. Perform a warm reset on the alarmed board, and then check whether the alarm is cleared.
If the alarm persists, perform a cold reset on the alarmed board. For details, see Resetting
a Boards.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 728


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

2. If the alarm persists, remove the alarmed board and check whether certain pins on the
backplane are bent. Insert the board again, and then check whether the alarm is cleared.
3. If the alarm persists, replace the alarmed board. For details, see Replacing a Board.

Step 3 Cause 2: If multiple boards report this alarm, the clock cable of the cross-connect board is faulty.
1. If the working cross-connect board is faulty, perform 1+1 protection switching on the cross-
connect board. For details, see Performing 1+1 Protection Switching.
2. Perform a cold reset on the protection cross-connect board, and then check whether the
alarm is cleared.
3. If the alarm persists, remove and insert the protection cross-connect board, and then check
whether the alarm is cleared.
4. If the alarm persists, replace the protection cross-connect board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.335 TU_AIS

Description
The AU_AIS is an alarm indicating that the TU has errors. This alarm is reported if a board
detects that the signal in the TU path is all 1s.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The service in the alarmed TU path is interrupted. If the services are configured with protection,
protection switching is also triggered.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Configuration data is incorrect.
l Cause 2: The line is faulty.
l Cause 3: The board at the opposite end is faulty.
l Cause 4: The board at the local end is faulty.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 729


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Configuration data is incorrect.
1. See Creating the Cross-Connections of Point-to-Point Services to check whether the service
data is incorrect.

If... Then...
The service data is incorrect Change the configuration data.
The service data is correct Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The line is faulty.


1. Check whether a line alarm that causes AIS insertion is reported on the service trail.
NOTE
For details about the line alarms that cause AIS insertion, see D.2.6 AIS Insertion.

If... Then...
The line alarm is reported Clear the line alarms that cause AIS insertion.
No line alarms are reported Go to the next step.

2. See 8.4 Software Loopback to locate whether the board at the local end or at the opposite
end is faulty.

If... Then...
The board at the opposite end is faulty Go to Cause 3.
The board at the local end is faulty Go to Cause 4.

Step 3 Cause 3: The board at the opposite end is faulty.


1. Replace the faulty board at the opposite end.

Step 4 Cause 4: The board at the local end is faulty.


1. Replace the board where the local line unit resides.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared after the board is The fault is rectified. End the alarm
replaced handling.
The alarm persists after the board is Go to the next step.
replaced

2. Replace the system control, cross-connect, and timing board at the local end.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared after the board is The fault is rectified. End the alarm
replaced handling.
The alarm persists after the board is Go to the next step.
replaced

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 730


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

3. Replace the alarmed board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.336 TU_AIS_VC12

Description
The TU_AIS_VC12 is an indication of TU alarms at VC-12 level. This alarm occurs when a
board detects TU pointers of all 1s.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the ID of the optical interface. The value is always 0x01.
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of the VC-12 path.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the services in the alarmed VC-12 path are interrupted. If the services
are configured with protection, protection switching is also triggered.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Configuration data is incorrect.
l Cause 2: The line is faulty.
l Cause 3: The board at the opposite site is faulty.
l Cause 4: The board at the local site is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Configuration data is incorrect.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 731


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

1. Check whether the SDH service data is correct. For details, see Creating the Cross-
Connections of Point-to-Point Services.

If... Then...
The SDH service data is incorrect Change the configuration data.
The SDH service data is correct Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The line is faulty.


1. Check whether a line alarm that causes AIS insertion is reported on the service trail.
NOTE
For details about the line alarms that cause AIS insertion, see D.2.6 AIS Insertion.

If... Then...
The line alarm is reported Change the configuration data.
No line alarms are reported Go to Step 3.

Step 3 Check whether the fault occurs at the local site or at the opposite site. For details, see 8.4.6
Setting Loopbacks for the EOS/EoPDH-Plane Ethernet Interface Board.

If... Then...
The board at the opposite site is faulty Go to Cause 3.
The board at the local site is faulty Go to Cause 4.

Step 4 Cause 3: The board at the opposite site is faulty.


1. Replace the faulty board at the opposite site.

Step 5 Cause 4: The board at the local site is faulty.


1. Replace the line board at the local site. For details, see 6.3 Replacing the SDH Optical
Interface Board.

If... Then...
The alarm clears after the board is The fault is rectified. End the alarm
replaced handling.
The alarm persists after the board is Go to the next step.
replaced
2. Replace the alarmed board at the local site.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 732


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.337 TU_AIS_VC3

Description
The TU_AIS_VC3 is a TU-3 alarm indication. The alarm is reported when a board detects TU
pointers of all "1"s.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Has a fixed value of 0x01.
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of the VC-3 path that reports the alarm. For example,
0x00 0x01 indicate that the alarm is reported in VC-3 path 1.

Impact on the System


The services in the alarmed TU-3 paths are interrupted. If the services are configured with
protection, protection switching is triggered.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: SDH service configuration data is incorrect.
l Cause 2: The service path is faulty.
l Cause 3: The board at the opposite end is faulty.
l Cause 4: The board at the local end is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: SDH service configuration data is incorrect.
1. Follow instructions in Creating the Cross-Connections of Point-to-Point Services to check
whether the SDH service configuration data is incorrect.

If... Then...
The SDH service configuration data is Rectify the SDH service configuration
incorrect data.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 733


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The SDH service configuration data is Go to cause 2.
correct

Step 2 Cause 2: The service path is faulty.


1. Check whether a line alarm that will cause AIS insertion is reported on the service path.
NOTE
For the line alarms that will cause AIS insertion, see D.2.6 AIS Insertion.

If... Then...
A line alarm that will cause AIS Rectify the SDH service configuration data.
insertion is reported
No line alarm is reported Go to step 3.

Step 3 Follow instructions in 8.4.5 Setting a Loopback for the Packet-plane Ethernet Interface
Board to identify whether the board at the local end or at the opposite end is faulty.

If... Then...
The board at the opposite end is faulty Go to cause 3.
The board at the local end is faulty Go to cause 4.

Step 4 Cause 3: The board at the opposite end is faulty.


1. Replace the faulty board at the opposite end.

Step 5 Cause 4: The board at the local end is faulty.


1. Follow instructions in 6.3 Replacing the SDH Optical Interface Board to replace the line
board at the local end.

If... Then...
The alarm clears No further action is required.
The alarm persists Go to the next step.

2. Follow instructions in 6.10 Replacing the System Control, Switching and Timing
Board to replace the system control, switching, and timing board.

If... Then...
The alarm clears No further action is required.
The alarm persists Follow instructions in Replacing an Alarmed Board to replace the
board that reports the alarm.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 734


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.338 TU_LOP

Description
The TU_LOP is an alarm indicating that the TU pointer is lost. This alarm is reported if a board
detects that the TU-PTR value is an invalid pointer or NDF reversion in eight consecutive frames.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The service in the alarmed TU path is interrupted. If the services are configured with protection,
protection switching is also triggered.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The system control, cross-connect, and timing board is faulty.
l Cause 2: The tributary board is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The system control, cross-connect, and timing board is faulty.
1. Replace the system control, cross-connect, and timing board at the local end.

If... Then...
The alarm is cleared after the board is The fault is rectified. End the alarm
replaced handling.
The alarm persists after the board is Go to Cause 2.
replaced

Step 2 Cause 2: The tributary board is faulty.


1. Replace the board where the tributary unit resides.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.339 TU_LOP_VC12

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 735


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Description
The TU_LOP_VC12 is an alarm indicating that the VC-12 TU pointer is lost. This alarm is
reported when a board receives invalid pointers or new data flags (NDFs) in eight consecutive
VC-12 frames.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the ID of the optical interface. The value is always 0x01.
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of the VC-12 path.

Impact on the System


Services in the alarmed TU path are interrupted. If the services are configured with protection,
protection switching is also triggered.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Configuration data is incorrect.
l Cause 2: The board at the opposite site is faulty.
l Cause 3: The board at the local site is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Configuration data is incorrect.
1. Check whether the SDH service data is correct. For details, see Creating the Cross-
Connections of Point-to-Point Services.

If... Then...
The SDH service data is incorrect Change the configuration data.
The SDH service data is correct Go to Step 2.

Step 2 Check whether the fault occurs at the local site or at the opposite site. For details, see 8.4.6
Setting Loopbacks for the EOS/EoPDH-Plane Ethernet Interface Board.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 736


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The board at the opposite site is faulty Go to Cause 2.
The board at the local site is faulty Go to Cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 2: The board at the opposite site is faulty.


1. In this case, replace the faulty board at the opposite site.

Step 4 Cause 3: The board at the local site is faulty.


1. Replace the line board at the local site. For details, see 6.3 Replacing the SDH Optical
Interface Board.

If... Then...
The alarm clears after the board is The fault is rectified. End the alarm
replaced handling.
The alarm persists after the board is Go to the next step.
replaced

2. Replace the alarmed board at the local site.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.340 TU_LOP_VC3

Description
The TU_LOP_VC3 alarm indicates that a TU-3 pointer is lost. This alarm is reported if a board
detects that eight consecutive VC-3 TU-PTR values are invalid or the NDF field in eight
consecutive VC-3 TU-PTR values are reversed.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 737


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Has a fixed value of 0x01.
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of the VC-3 path that reports the alarm. For example,
0x00 0x01 indicate that the alarm is reported in VC-3 path 1.

Impact on the System


The services in the alarmed TU-3 path are interrupted. If the services are configured with
protection, protection switching is triggered.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: SDH service configuration data is incorrect.
l Cause 2: The board at the opposite end is faulty.
l Cause 3: The board at the local end is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: SDH service configuration data is incorrect.
1. Follow instructions in Creating the Cross-Connections of Point-to-Point Services to check
whether the SDH service configuration data is incorrect.

If... Then...
The SDH service configuration data is Rectify the SDH service configuration
incorrect data.
The SDH service configuration data is Go to step 2.
correct

Step 2 Follow instructions in 8.4.5 Setting a Loopback for the Packet-plane Ethernet Interface
Board to identify whether the board at the local end or at the opposite end is faulty.

If... Then...
The board at the opposite end is faulty Go to cause 2.
The board at the local end is faulty Go to cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 2: The board at the opposite end is faulty.


1. Replace the faulty board at the opposite end.

Step 4 Cause 3: The board at the local end is faulty.


1. Follow instructions in 6.3 Replacing the SDH Optical Interface Board to replace the line
board at the local end.

If... Then...
The alarm clears No further action is required.
The alarm persists Go to the next step.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 738


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

2. Follow instructions in 6.10 Replacing the System Control, Switching and Timing
Board to replace the system control, switching, and timing board.

If... Then...
The alarm clears No further action is required.
The alarm persists Go to the next step.
3. Follow instructions in Replacing an Alarmed Board to replace the board that reports the
alarm.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.341 TUNNEL_APS_DEGRADED

Description
The TUNNEL_APS_DEGRADED is an alarm indicating that a tunnel protection group
degrades.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Service alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The protection tunnel is faulty and the protection group fails. The working tunnel is unprotected.

Possible Causes
Cause: The protection tunnel in the tunnel protection group is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Check the status of the tunnel protection group, locate the failed tunnel in the protection group.

Step 2 Querying MPLS tunnel information, locate the board and port used by the failed tunnel.

Step 3 If the port is a Ethernet port, refer to Setting the Basic Attributes of Ethernet Ports, check whether
the port is disabled.

Enable the port if it was disabled.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 739


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Step 4 Refer to 4.3.1 Browsing Current Alarms, check whether any relevant Ethernet services alarms
are generated in the port or board. If yes, take priority to clear them.

The relevant alarms are as follows:


l Hardware alarms: Such as HARD_BAD, POWER_ALM, BD_STATUS,
COMMUN_FAIL, and LASER_MOD_ERR.
l Link alarms: Such as ETH_LOS, ETH_AUTO_LINK_DOWN,
ETH_EFM_LOOPBACK, LOOP_ALM, PORTMODE_MISMATCH, and
LAG_DOWN.
l Radio link alarms: Such as MW_LOF, MW_LIM.

Step 5 Refer to 4.3.1 Browsing Current Alarms, check whether any alarms are generated in the failed
tunnel. If yes, take priority to clear them.

The relevant alarms are as follows:


l MPLS_TUNNEL_BDI
l MPLS_TUNNEL_Excess
l MPLS_TUNNEL_FDI
l MPLS_TUNNEL_LOCV
l MPLS_TUNNEL_MISMATCH
l MPLS_TUNNEL_MISMERGE
l MPLS_TUNNEL_OAMFAIL
l MPLS_TUNNEL_SD
l MPLS_TUNNEL_SF
l MPLS_TUNNEL_UNKNOWN
l MPLS_TUNNEL_AIS
l MPLS_TUNNEL_RDI
l MPLS_TUNNEL_UNEXPMEG
l MPLS_TUNNEL_UNEXPMEP
l MPLS_TUNNEL_UNEXPPER

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.342 TUNNEL_APS_OUTAGE

Description
The TUNNEL_APS_OUTAGE alarm indicates that a tunnel APS protection group is
unavailable. This alarm is reported when both the working and protection tunnels of the
protection group fail.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 740


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Service alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The services carried by the protection group are interrupted.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The working and protection tunnels of the tunnel APS protection group fail.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The working and protection tunnels of the tunnel APS protection group fail.
1. Determine the boards and port IDs associated with the faulty tunnels. For details, see
Querying MPLS APS Status.
2. Handle tunnel faults by referring to 5.10 Troubleshooting MPLS Tunnels.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.343 UHCS

Description
The UHCS is an alarm of uncorrected header check sequence. This alarm occurs when multiple
uncorrectable bit errors exist in the cell headers.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 741


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Impact on the System


When the UHCS alarm occurs, some cells with multiple bit errors are detected during cell
delimitation at the ATM port. Consequently, the user cells are lost.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: A few bit errors occur in the receive path related to the ATM port which reports
the UHCS alarm.
l Cause 2: The ATM physical-layer processing chip of the board is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: A few bit errors occur in the receive path connected to the ATM port which reports the
UHCS alarm.
1. On the NMS, check whether the related receive path reports any alarms indicating excessive
bit errors, such as B1_SD, B2_SD, and B3_SD.
2. On the NMS, check whether the service is looped.
3. If yes, modify the service configuration to release the loop, and then check whether the
alarm is cleared.

Step 2 Cause 2: The ATM physical-layer processing chip of the board is faulty.
1. Perform a cold reset on the board that reports the UHCS alarm and check whether the alarm
is cleared. For details, see 8.6.1 Cold Reset.
2. Optional: If the UHCS alarm persists after the cold reset, replace the alarmed board and
check whether the alarm is cleared. For details, see 6.6 Replacing the Smart E1 Interface
Board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.344 UP_E1_AIS

Description
The UP_E1_AIS is an alarm indication of the 2 Mbit/s uplink signal. This alarm is reported
when the tributary board detects that the 2 Mbit/s uplink signal is all 1s.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Communication alarm

Parameters
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 742


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Impact on the System


E1 signals are unavailable.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The opposite equipment transmits the AIS signal.
l Cause 2: The receive unit of the tributary board on the local equipment is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The opposite equipment transmits the AIS signal.
1. Check whether the opposite equipment transmits the AIS signal.

If... Then...
The opposite equipment transmits the Rectify the fault on the opposite equipment.
AIS signal
The opposite equipment does not Go to Cause 2.
transmit the AIS signal

Step 2 Cause 2: The receive unit of the tributary board on the local equipment is faulty.
1. Replace the alarmed board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.345 USB_PROCESS_FAIL

Description
The USB_PROCESS_FAIL is an alarm indicating that data recovery from or data backup to a
USB disk fails.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Minor Equipment alarm

Parameters
Name Meaning
Parameter 1 l 0x01 indicates data recovery.
l 0x02 indicates data backup.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 743


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning
Parameter 2 Indicates the file type.

l 0x01: indicates the software package.


l 0x02: indicates the patch package.
l 0x03: indicates the system parameter area.
l 0x04: indicates the script.
l 0x05: indicates the database.
l 0x06: indicates the license file.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, the database fails to be backed up or recovered. The system status
remains unchanged.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Recovering data from a USB disk fails.
l Cause 2: Backing up data to a USB disk fails.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Recovering data from a USB disk fails.
1. Verify that the USB flash drive can be identified by the NE.
2. Check whether the data in the USB flash drive is correct. If the data is incorrect, upload
the USB flash drive with correct data.
3. Verify that the operations for recovering data from the USB flash drive are correct.

Step 2 Cause 2: Backing up data to a USB disk fails.


1. Verify that the USB flash drive has enough capacity for data backup.
2. Check whether the USB flash drive is properly inserted. If the USB flash drive is not
properly inserted, re-insert the USB flash drive.
3. Replace the USB flash drive and re-back up data.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.346 V5_VCAIS

Description
The V5_VCAIS is an alarm indicating that bits 5-7 in the V5 byte of a VC-12 path are set to
"1"s.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 744


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type

Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, services are interrupted in the TU path of the board.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Hardware fault alarms occur on boards of an upstream NE.
l Cause 2: The alarmed board is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Check whether any hardware fault alarms occur on boards of an upstream NE. If yes, clear them.
Then, check whether the V5_VCAIS alarm is cleared.

Step 2 If the alarm persists, the alarmed board is faulty. Cold Reset the board and check whether the
alarm is cleared.

Step 3 If the alarm persists, Replace the alarming board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.347 VC_AIS

Description
The VC_AIS is an alarm indication of the virtual channel (VC) connection. This alarm occurs
when the VC connection that is set with the segment end point attribute receives the AIS cells,
indicating that the upstream ATM services are abnormal.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Critical Communication alarm

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 745


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 Indicates the direction of ATM connection.

l 0x01: forward
l 0x02: backward

Parameter 2 Indicates the status of ATM connection.

l 0x01: working connection


l 0x00: protection connection

Parameter 3 Indicates the segment and end attribute of ATM connection.

l 0x01: segment
l 0x02: end

Impact on the System


l If the continuity check (CC) sink is enabled on an upstream NE but the upstream NE does
not receive any CC cells, the local NE reports the VP_AIS. Then, the connection, though
not interrupted, is not loaded with any user service.
l In other cases, when the local NE detects that the VC connection is interrupted, the AIS
cells are inserted in the downstream direction and the RDI cells are returned to the upstream
NE.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: An upstream NE reports the VC_LOC, and the AIS cells are inserted to the
downstream.
l Cause 2: On the local NE, the ATM port connected to a faulty upstream SDH path is
abnormal in the receive direction and therefore inserts AIS cells to the downstream.
l Cause 3: The board on the local NE is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: An upstream NE reports the VC_LOC, and the AIS cells are inserted to the downstream.
1. On the NMS, check whether the VC_LOC occurs and the ATM connections that report the
VC_LOC have the same ID.
2. If the VC_LOC occurs, clear the VC_LOC and then the AIS insertion stops.

Step 2 Cause 2: On the local NE, the ATM port connected to a faulty upstream SDH path is abnormal
in the receive direction and therefore inserts AIS cells to the downstream.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 746


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

1. Check whether any alarm, such as the R_LOS, R_LOF, MS_AIS, AU_AIS, AU_LOP,
TU_AIS or TU_LOP occurs in the upstream SDH path.
2. If yes, clear these alarms and then the AIS insertion stops.

Step 3 Cause 3: The board on the local NE is faulty.


1. Perform a cold reset on the alarmed board.
2. If the alarm persists, replace the alarmed board.

----End

Related Information
Unidirectional Connection

A complete bidirectional connection consists of two unidirectional connections: a forward


connection and a backward connection. The direction of the forward and backward connections
is based on the same node.

End and Segment

The end point refers to the termination point in the chain network, and it is used to monitor the
whole virtual connection.

The segment point is, generally, used to monitor a segment of the whole link.

Segment End Point

This is one of the segment end attributes. The segment end attributes include: segment point,
end point, segment and end point, non segment and end point.

l If an NE is set with the segment end point attribute, it can retrieve the alarms that are
generated at the segment and end.
l If an NE is set with the segment point attribute, it can retrieve the alarms that are generated
at a segment.
l If an NE is set with the end point attribute, it can retrieve the alarms that are generated at
an end.
l If an NE is set with the non segment end point attribute, it fails to retrieve the alarms that
are generated at the segment and end.

A.3.348 VC_LOC

Description
The VC_LOC is an alarm indicating loss of connectivity on the virtual channel (VC). This alarm
is reported when the CC is enabled but no cell is received within 3.5s (0.5s).

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Communication alarm

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 747


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 Indicates the direction of ATM connection.

l 0x01: forward
l 0x02: backward

Parameter 2 Indicates the status of ATM connection.

l 0x01: working connection


l 0x00: protection connection

Parameter 3 Indicates the segment and end attribute of ATM connection.

l 0x01: segment
l 0x02: end
l 0x03: segment and end

Impact on the System


l If the CC sink is enabled on the local NE but the local NE does not receive any CC cells,
the service connection, though not interrupted, is not loaded with any user service.
l In other cases, the service is interrupted when the alarm occurs.
l When this alarm occurs, the system automatically inserts AIS cells to the downstream.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The CC sink is enabled on the local NE, but no CC source is enabled on the
upstream NE.
l Cause 2: No bandwidth is available on the local NE.
l Cause 3: On the local NE, the ATM port connected to a faulty upstream SDH path is
abnormal in the receive direction.
l Cause 4: The board on the local NE is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The CC sink is enabled on the local NE, but no CC source is enabled on the upstream
NE.
1. Check whether the CC function on the local NE is activated.
2. If yes, Deactivate the CC function on the local NE. Then, check whether the alarm is cleared.

Step 2 Cause 2: No bandwidth is available on the local NE.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 748


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

1. On the NMS, check whether the bandwidth allocated to the tunnel is fully used.
2. If yes, increase the bandwidth or eliminate the sources that transmit a large amount of
invalid data.

Step 3 Cause 3: On the local NE, the ATM port connected to a faulty upstream SDH path is abnormal
in the receive direction.
1. Check whether any alarm, such as the R_LOS, R_LOF, MS_AIS, AU_AIS, AU_LOP,
TU_AIS or TU_LOP, occurs in an upstream SDH path.
2. If yes, clear these alarms and check whether the VC_LOC is cleared.

Step 4 Cause 4: The board on the local NE is faulty.


1. Perform a cold reset on the alarmed board.
2. If the alarm persists, replace the alarmed board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.349 VC_RDI

Description
The VC_RDI is an alarm indicating that defects occur at the remote end of the virtual channel
(VC) connection. This alarm occurs when a forward or backward VC connection that is set with
the segment end point attribute receives the RDI cells, indicating that the downstream services
are abnormal.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 Indicates the direction of ATM connection.

l 0x01: forward
l 0x02: backward

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 749


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning

Parameter 2 Indicates the status of ATM connection.

l 0x01: working connection


l 0x00: protection connection

Parameter 3 Indicates the segment and end attribute of ATM connection.

l 0x01: segment
l 0x02: end

Impact on the System


l When this alarm occurs, it indicates that a segment end point at the remote end of the VC
connection receives AIS cells and returns RDI cells to the local end, but the services at the
local end are not affected.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The VC_AIS occurs in the receive direction of the downstream VC connection.
l Cause 2: A certain board is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The VC_AIS occurs in the receive direction of the downstream VC connection.
1. Check whether the VC_AIS occurs in the receive direction of the downstream VC
connection.
2. If yes, clear the VC_AIS and then check whether the VC_RDI is cleared.

Step 2 Cause 2: A certain board is faulty.


1. Perform a cold reset on the alarmed board.
2. If the alarm persists, replace the alarmed board.

----End

Related Information
Unidirectional Connection

A complete bidirectional connection consists of two unidirectional connections: a forward


connection and a backward connection. The direction of the forward and backward connections
is based on the same node.

End and Segment

The end point refers to the termination point in the chain network, and it is used to monitor the
whole virtual connection.

The segment point is, generally, used to monitor a segment of the whole link.

Segment End Point

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 750


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

This is one of the segment end attributes. The segment end attributes include: segment point,
end point, segment and end point, non segment and end point.

l If an NE is set with the segment end point attribute, it can retrieve the alarms that are
generated at the segment and end.
l If an NE is set with the segment point attribute, it can retrieve the alarms that are generated
at a segment.
l If an NE is set with the end point attribute, it can retrieve the alarms that are generated at
an end.
l If an NE is set with the non segment end point attribute, it fails to retrieve the alarms that
are generated at the segment and end.

A.3.350 VCAT_LOA

Description
The VCAT_LOA is an alarm indicating alignment loss of virtual concatenations. This alarm is
reported if a board detects that the time delays between the timeslots bound to a VCTRUNK
exceed the permissible limit.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Critical Service alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 The value is always 0x01.
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of the VCTRUNK path.

Impact on the System


The virtually concatenated services are interrupted.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The timeslots bound to a VCTRUNK travel through different physical links, so the
delays between the virtually concatenated links are long.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 751


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The timeslots bound to a VCTRUNK travel through different physical links, so the
delays between the virtually concatenated links are long.
1. Determine the ID of the alarmed VCTRUNK path based on the alarm parameters.
2. Check whether the transmission routes of the paths bound to a VCTRUNK are the same.
If not, adjust their routes to the same.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.351 VCAT_LOM_VC12

Description
The VCAT_LOM_VC12 is an alarm indicating the loss of virtual concatenation multiframes in
the VC-12 path. This alarm is reported if the board detects that the K4 byte of the VC-12 path
does not match the expected multiframe sequence.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the ID of the optical interface. The value is always 0x01.
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of the VC-12 path.

Impact on the System


The alarmed path is unavailable. If the LCAS function is disabled, the services in the path are
interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Bit errors occur on the line.
l Cause 2: The MFI field in the K4 byte sent from the opposite site is incorrect.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 752


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

l Cause 3: The delays between virtual concatenations are over long.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Bit errors occur on the line.
1. Check whether any bit error alarm such as BIP_EXC and BIP_SD occurs.

If... Then...
A bit error alarm occurs Handle the alarm immediately.
No bit error alarm occurs Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The MFI field in the K4 byte sent from the opposite site is incorrect.
1. Replace the board at the opposite site. For details, see 6.7 Replacing the Ethernet
Interface Board.
2. Replace the board and then check whether the alarm clears.

If... Then...
The alarm clears End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: The delays between virtual concatenations are over long.
1. Check whether the VCAT_LOA alarm is reported in this path.

If... Then...
The VCAT_LOA alarm is reported Handle the VCAT_LOA alarm immediately.
The VCAT_LOA alarm is not reported Go to Cause 2.

2. Check whether the VCAT_LOM_VC12 alarm clears after handling the VCAT_LOA
alarm.

If... Then...
The alarm clears End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Replace the alarmed board at the local site. For details, see Replace
the alarmed board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.352 VCAT_LOM_VC3

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 753


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Description
The VCAT_LOM_VC3 alarm indicates the loss of virtually concatenated multiframes in a VC-3
path. A board reports this alarm when detecting that byte H4 in the VC-3 path does not match
the expected multiframe sequence.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Has a fixed value of 0x01.
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of the VC-3 path that reports the alarm. For example,
0x00 0x01 indicate that the alarm is reported in VC-3 path 1.

Impact on the System


The path that reports the alarm is unavailable. If the LCAS function is disabled, services are
interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Bit errors occur in the line.
l Cause 2: The MFI field in byte K4 sent from the opposite site is incorrect.
l Cause 3: The delays between virtual concatenations are too long.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Bit errors occur in the line.
1. Check for the bit error alarms such as BIP_EXC or BIP_SD.

If... Then...
The bit error alarms exist Handle the alarms immediately.
The bit error alarms do not exist Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The MFI field in byte K4 sent from the opposite site is incorrect.
1. Follow instructions in 6.7 Replacing the Ethernet Interface Board to replace the board
at the opposite site.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 754


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

2. Replace the alarmed board and then check whether the alarm clears.

If... Then...
The alarm clears End the alarm handling.
The alarm persists Go to Cause 3.

Step 3 Cause 3: The delays between virtual concatenations are too long.
1. Check whether a VCAT_LOA alarm is reported in this path.

If... Then...
A VCAT_LOA alarm is reported in this Handle the VCAT_LOA alarm
path immediately.
No VCAT_LOA alarm is reported in this Go to Cause 2.
path
2. Check whether the VCAT_LOM_VC3 alarm clears after handling the VCAT_LOA alarm.

If... Then...
The VCAT_LOM_VC3 alarm clears End the alarm handling.
The VCAT_LOM_VC3 alarm persists Follow instructions in 6.7 Replacing the
Ethernet Interface Board to replace the
alarmed board at the local site.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.353 VCAT_SQM_VC12

Description
The VCAT_SQM_VC12 is an alarm indicating the SQ number mismatch of a virtual
concatenation in the VC-12 path. This alarm is reported if the board detects that the SQ of a
virtual concatenation does not match the expected value.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 755


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details


about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the ID of the optical interface. The value is always 0x01.
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of the VC-12 path.

Impact on the System


The alarmed path is unavailable. If the LCAS function is disabled, services are interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Bit errors occur on certain links or certain links are faulty.
l Cause 2: The SQ number sent from the opposite site is incorrect.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Bit errors occur on certain links or certain links are faulty.
1. Check whether bit errors or line alarms occur. Focus on the bit error alarm BIP_EXC or
BIP_SD.

If... Then...
Bit errors or line alarms occur Clear these alarms.
No bit errors or line alarms occur Go to the next step.

2. Replace the alarmed board.

Step 2 Cause 2: The SQ number sent from the opposite site is incorrect.
1. Replace the corresponding board at the opposite site.

If... Then...
The alarm clears after the board is End the alarm handling.
replaced
The alarm persists after the board is Contact Huawei technical support engineers
replaced for handling the alarm.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.354 VCAT_SQM_VC3

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 756


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Description
The VCAT_SQM_VC3 alarm indicates that the sequence (SQ) number mismatch of a virtual
concatenation in a VC-3 path. A board reports this alarm when detecting that the SQ of a virtual
concatenation does not match the expected value.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Has a fixed value of 0x01.
Parameter 2, Parameter 3 Indicate the ID of the VC-3 path that reports the alarm. For example,
0x00 0x01 indicate that the alarm is reported in VC-3 path 1.

Impact on the System


The path that reports the alarm is unavailable. If the LCAS function is disabled, services are
interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Bit errors occur on a link or a link is faulty.
l Cause 2: The SQ number sent from the opposite site is incorrect.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Bit errors occur on a link or a link is faulty.
1. Check for bit error alarms or line alarms, especially BIP_EXC and BIP_SD.

If... Then...
Bit error alarms or line alarms occur Clear these alarms.
No bit error alarms or line alarms occur Go to Cause 2.

2. Replace the alarmed board.

Step 2 Cause 2: The SQ number sent from the opposite site is incorrect.
1. Replace the related board at the opposite site.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 757


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...
The VCAT_SQM_VC3 alarm clears after the End the alarm handling.
board is replaced
The VCAT_SQM_VC3 alarm persists after Contact Huawei technical support
the board is replaced engineers.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.355 VOLT_LOS

Description
The VOLT_LOS is an alarm indicating that the power voltage is unavailable.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 The value is always 0x01.

Impact on the System


The ODU that is connected to the IF board that reports this alarm fails to work.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The output power is abnormal.
l Cause 2: The input power is abnormal.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The output power is abnormal.
1. Check the power switch of the ODU.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 758


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...

The power switch is turned off Turn on the power switch.

The power switch is turned on Go to the next step.

2. Use the multimeter to check the IF fiber jumper, IF cable, or ODU section by section for
a short circuit.

NOTICE
If the alarm is reported due to a short circuit, replace the short-circuited cable or ODU, and
then replace the IF board. Otherwise, the new IF board may be damaged again.

If... Then...

A short circuit exists Replace the short-circuited component,


and then replace the alarmed IF board.

No short circuits exist Replace the alarmed IF board.

Step 2 Cause 2: The input power is abnormal.


1. Replace the alarmed IF board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.356 VP_AIS
Description
The VP_AIS is an alarm indication of the virtual path (VP) connection. When a forward or
backward VP connection that is set with the segment end point attribute receives the AIS cells,
the alarm is reported, indicating that the upstream services are abnormal.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Critical Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 759


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details


about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 Indicates the direction of ATM connection.

l 0x01: forward
l 0x02: backward

Parameter 2 Indicates the status of ATM connection.

l 0x01: working connection


l 0x00: protection connection

Parameter 3 Indicates the segment and end attribute of ATM connection.

l 0x01: segment
l 0x02: end

Impact on the System


l If the continuity check (CC) sink is enabled on an upstream NE but the upstream NE does
not receive any CC cells, the local NE reports the alarm. In this case, the connection, though
not interrupted, is not loaded with any user service.
l In other cases, when the local NE detects that the VP connection is interrupted, the AIS
cells are inserted to the downstream and the RDI cells are returned to the upstream NE.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: An upstream NE reports the VP_LOC, and the AIS cells are inserted to the
downstream.
l Cause 2: On the local NE, the ATM port connected to a faulty upstream SDH path is
abnormal in the receive direction and inserts AIS cells to the downstream.
l Cause 3: The board on the local NE is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: An upstream NE reports the VP_LOC, and the AIS cells are inserted to the downstream.
1. On the NMS, check whether the VP_LOC occurs and the ATM connections that report the
VP_LOC have the same ID.
2. If the VP_LOC occurs, clear the VP_LOC and then the AIS insertion stops.

Step 2 Cause 2: On the local NE, the ATM port connected to a faulty upstream SDH path is abnormal
in the receive direction and therefore inserts AIS cells to the downstream.
1. Check whether any alarm, such as the R_LOS, R_LOF, MS_AIS, TU_AIS, TU_LOP,
AU_AIS or AU_LOP, occurs in an upstream SDH path.
2. If yes, clear these alarms and then the AIS insertion stops.

Step 3 Cause 3: The board on the local NE is faulty.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 760


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

1. Perform a cold reset on the alarmed board.


2. If the alarm persists, replace the alarmed board.

----End

Related Information
Unidirectional Connection

A complete bidirectional connection consists of two unidirectional connections: a forward


connection and a backward connection. The direction of the forward and backward connections
is based on the same node.

End and Segment

The end point refers to the termination point in the chain network, and it is used to monitor the
whole virtual connection.

The segment point is, generally, used to monitor a segment of the whole link.

Segment End Point

This is one of the segment end attributes. The segment end attributes include: segment point,
end point, segment and end point, non segment and end point.

l If an NE is set with the segment end point attribute, it can retrieve the alarms that are
generated at the segment and end.
l If an NE is set with the segment point attribute, it can retrieve the alarms that are generated
at a segment.
l If an NE is set with the end point attribute, it can retrieve the alarms that are generated at
an end.
l If an NE is set with the non segment end point attribute, it fails to retrieve the alarms that
are generated at the segment and end.

A.3.357 VP_LOC

Description
The VP_LOC is an alarm indicating loss of connectivity on the virtual path (VP). This alarm is
reported when the CC is enabled but no cell is received within 3.5s (0.5s). When any cell is
received, the alarm is cleared automatically.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 761


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details


about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 Indicates the direction of ATM connection.

l 0x01: forward
l 0x02: backward

Parameter 2 Indicates the status of ATM connection.

l 0x01: working connection


l 0x00: protection connection

Parameter 3 Indicates the segment and end attribute of ATM connection.

l 0x01: segment
l 0x02: end
l 0x03: segment and end

Impact on the System


l If the CC sink is enabled on the local NE but the local NE does not receive any CC cells,
the service connection, though not interrupted, is not loaded with any user service.
l In other cases, the service is interrupted when the alarm occurs.
l When this alarm occurs, the system automatically inserts AIS cells to the downstream.
l The VP_LOC is suppressed when the VP_AIS occurs.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The CC sink is enabled on the local NE, but no CC source is enabled on the
upstream NE.
l Cause 2: No bandwidth is available on the local NE.
l Cause 3: On the local NE, the ATM port connected to a faulty upstream SDH path is
abnormal in the receive direction.
l Cause 4: A certain board is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The CC sink is enabled on the local NE, but no CC source is enabled on the upstream
NE.
1. Deactivate the CC function on the local NE.

Step 2 Cause 2: No bandwidth is available on the local NE.


1. On the NMS, check whether the bandwidth allocated to the tunnel is fully used.
2. If yes, increase the bandwidth or eliminate the sources that transmit a large amount of
invalid data.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 762


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Step 3 Cause 3: On the local NE, the ATM port connected to a faulty upstream SDH path is abnormal
in the receive direction.
1. Check whether any alarm, such as the R_LOS, R_LOF, MS_AIS, TU_AIS, TU_LOP,
AU_AIS or AU_LOP, occurs in an upstream SDH path.
2. If yes, clear these alarms.

Step 4 Cause 4: A certain board is faulty.


1. Perform a cold reset on the alarmed board.
2. Check whether the alarm is cleared. If not, replace the alarmed board.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.358 VP_RDI

Description
The VP_RDI is an alarm indicating that defects occur at the remote end of the virtual path (VP)
connection. This alarm occurs when a forward or backward VP connection that is set with the
segment end point attribute receives the RDI cells, indicating that the downstream services are
abnormal.

Attribute

Alarm Severity Alarm Type


Major Communication alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning

Parameter 1 Indicates the direction of ATM connection.

l 0x01: forward
l 0x02: backward

Parameter 2 Indicates the status of ATM connection.

l 0x01: working connection


l 0x00: protection connection

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 763


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Name Meaning

Parameter 3 Indicates the segment and end attribute of ATM connection.

l 0x01: segment
l 0x02: end

Impact on the System


l When this alarm occurs, the services are not affected. This alarm just indicates that the
services in the receive direction of the downstream VP connection are abnormal. The AIS
cells are received in a segment point of the connection, and the RDI cells are returned to
the upstream VP connection.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: The VP_AIS occurs in the receive direction of the downstream VP connection.
l Cause 2: A certain board is faulty.

Procedure
l Cause 1: The VP_AIS occurs in the receive direction of the downstream VP connection.
1. Check whether the VP_AIS occurs in the receive direction of the downstream VP
connection.
2. If yes, clear the VP_AIS and then check whether the VP_RDI is cleared.
l Cause 2: A certain board is faulty.
1. Perform a cold reset on the alarmed board. For details, see 8.6.1 Cold Reset.
2. If the alarm persists, replace the alarmed board. For details, see 6.6 Replacing the
Smart E1 Interface Board.

----End

Related Information
Unidirectional Connection

A complete bidirectional connection consists of two unidirectional connections: a forward


connection and a backward connection. The direction of the forward and backward connections
is based on the same node.

End and Segment

The end point refers to the termination point in the chain network, and it is used to monitor the
whole virtual connection.

The segment point is, generally, used to monitor a segment of the whole link.

Segment End Point

This is one of the segment end attributes. The segment end attributes include: segment point,
end point, segment and end point, non segment and end point.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 764


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

l If an NE is set with the segment end point attribute, it can retrieve the alarms that are
generated at the segment and end.
l If an NE is set with the segment point attribute, it can retrieve the alarms that are generated
at a segment.
l If an NE is set with the end point attribute, it can retrieve the alarms that are generated at
an end.
l If an NE is set with the non segment end point attribute, it fails to retrieve the alarms that
are generated at the segment and end.

A.3.359 W_R_FAIL

Description
The W_R_FAIL is an alarm indicating a failure of reading or writing chip register.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
When you view an alarm on the network management system, select the alarm. In the Alarm
Details field display the related parameters of the alarm. The alarm parameters are in the
following format: Alarm Parameters (hex): parameter1 parameter2...parameterN. For details
about each parameter, refer to the following table.

Name Meaning
Parameter 1 Indicates the ID of the chip.

Impact on the System


Services in the alarmed path are interrupted.

Possible Causes
Cause 1: The chip register is faulty or the read/write timing is incorrect.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: The chip register is faulty or the read/write timing is incorrect.
1. Replace the alarmed board.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 765


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

A.3.360 WRG_BD_TYPE
Description
The WRG_BD_TYPE is an alarm indicating that the type of the board is incorrect.

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Major Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


The board fails to work.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Configuration data is incorrect.
l Cause 2: The board of an incorrect type is installed.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Configuration data is incorrect.
1. See Configuring the Logical Board to check whether the board type complies with the
planning requirement.

If... Then...
The board type does not meet the planning Change the configuration data.
requirement
The board type meets the planning requirement Go to Cause 2.

Step 2 Cause 2: The board of an incorrect type is installed.


1. Replace the board of an incorrect type.

----End

Related Information
None.

A.3.361 XPIC_LOS
Description
The XPIC_LOS is an alarm indicating that the XPIC compensation signals are lost.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 766


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

Attribute
Alarm Severity Alarm Type
Critical Equipment alarm

Parameters
None.

Impact on the System


Bit errors may occur in the service at the port, and the service may even be interrupted.

Possible Causes
l Cause 1: Configuration data is incorrect.
l Cause 2: The radio link is faulty.
l Cause 3: The XPIC cable is faulty.
l Cause 4: The IF board or ODU is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Cause 1: Configuration data is incorrect.
1. Check whether the XPIC function needs to be enabled. If not, see Setting IF Attributes to
disable the XPIC function, and then perform a self-loop at the XPIC port on the board by
using the XPIC cable.

Step 2 Cause 2: The radio link is faulty.


1. Check whether the paired board that is connected to the XPIC IF board through the XPIC
cable reports the MW_LOF alarm. If yes, first clear the MW_LOF alarm.

Step 3 Cause 3: The XPIC cable is faulty.


1. Check the connection of the XPIC cable.

If... Then...

The cable is improperly connected Connect the XPIC cable properly.

The cable is properly connected Go to the next step.

2. Test the make and break of the XPIC cable by using the multimeter. If the XPIC cable is
damaged, replace it.

Step 4 Cause 4: The IF board or ODU is faulty.

Locate the fault by replacing the IF board or ODU.

1. Replace the paired board of the XPIC IF board.

The paired board of the XPIC IF board refers to the other XPIC IF board connected to the
alarmed XPIC IF board through the XPIC cable.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 767


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide A Alarm Reference

If... Then...

The alarm is cleared after the board is End the alarm handling.
replaced

The alarm persists after the board is Go to the next step.


replaced

2. Replace the ODU that is connected to the paired XPIC IF board.

If... Then...

The alarm is cleared after the ODU is End the alarm handling.
replaced

The alarm persists after the ODU is Replace the alarmed XPIC IF board.
replaced

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 768


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

B Performance Event Reference

Performance events are important indicators when the equipment performance changes. This
chapter describes all the possible performance events on the and how to handle these
performance events.

B.1 Performance Events (by Event Type)


The list is categorized based on the performance event type, and includes all the events of the
OptiX RTN 980.

B.2 Performance Events (by Logical Board)


This part lists all the performance events that are reported by each board.

B.3 Performance Events and Handling Procedures


Based on the type of a performance event, this chapter describes all the performance events on
the and how to handle these performance events.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 769


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

B.1 Performance Events (by Event Type)


The list is categorized based on the performance event type, and includes all the events of the
OptiX RTN 980.

B.1.1 SDH/PDH Performance Event List


SDH/PDH performance events are classified into six categories: pointer justification,
regenerator section error, multiplex section error, PW carried ATM, CSE and L2VPN Services,
higher order path error, lower order path error, E1 Error Performance Eventsand E1 line side
code violation.

Table B-1 Pointer Justification Performance Events

Event Name Description

AUPJCHIGH Indicates the count of positive AU pointer


justifications.

AUPJCLOW Indicates the count of negative AU pointer


justifications.

AUPJCNEW Indicates the count of new AU pointer


justifications.

TUPJCHIGH Indicates the count of positive TU pointer


justifications.

TUPJCLOW Indicates the count of negative TU pointer


justifications.

TUPJCNEW Indicates the count of new TU pointer


justifications.

Table B-2 Regenerator Section Error Performance Events

Event Name Description

RSBBE Indicates the regenerator section background


block error.

RSES Indicates the regenerator section errored


second.

RSSES Indicates the regenerator section severely


errored second.

RSUAS Indicates the regenerator section unavailable


second.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 770


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Event Name Description

RSCSES Indicates the regenerator section consecutive


severely errored second.

RSOFS Indicates the regenerator section out-of-


frame second.

RSOOF Indicates the count of regenerator section out-


of-frame events.

NOTE

In the case of PDH radio, regenerator section bit error performance events also exist and they are detected
according to the overheads used for detecting frame alignment and bit errors in the PDH microwave frames.

Table B-3 Multiplex Section Error Performance Events

Event Name Description

MSBBE Indicates the multiplex section background


block error.

MSES Indicates the multiplex section errored


second.

MSSES Indicates the multiplex section severely


errored second.

MSCSES Indicates the multiplex section consecutive


severely errored second.

MSUAS Indicates the multiplex section unavailable


second.

MSFEBBE Indicates the multiplex section far end


background block error.

MSFEES Indicates the multiplex section far end errored


second.

MSFESES Indicates the multiplex section far end


severely errored second.

MSFECSES Indicates the multiplex section far end


consecutive severely errored second.

MSFEUAS Indicates the multiplex section far end


unavailable second.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 771


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Table B-4 Higher Order Path Error Performance Events

Event Name Description

HPBBE Indicates the higher order path background


block error.

HPES Indicates the higher order path errored


second.

HPSES Indicates the higher order path severely


errored second.

HPCSES Indicates the higher order path consecutive


severely errored second.

HPUAS Indicates the higher order path unavailable


second.

HPFEBBE Indicates the higher order path far end


background block error.

HPFEES Indicates the higher order path far end errored


second.

HPFESES Indicates the higher order path far end


severely errored second.

HPFECSES Indicates the higher order path far end


consecutive severely errored second.

HPFEUAS Indicates the higher order path far end


unavailable second.

Table B-5 Lower Order Path Error Performance Events

Event Name Description

LPBBE Indicates the lower order path background


block error.

LPES Indicates the lower order path errored second.

LPSES Indicates the lower order path severely


errored second.

LPCSES Indicates the lower order path consecutive


severely errored second.

LPUAS Indicates the lower order path unavailable


second.

LPFEBBE Indicates the lower order path far end


background block error.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 772


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Event Name Description

LPFEES Indicates the lower order path far end errored


second.

LPFESES Indicates the lower order path far end


severely errored second.

LPFECSES Indicates the lower order path far end


consecutive severely errored second.

LPFEUAS Indicates the lower order far end unavailable


second.

Table B-6 E1 Line Side Code Violation Performance Events

Event Name Description

E1_LCV_SDH Indicates the count of E1 line side code


violations.

E1_LLOSS_SDH Indicates the E1 line side loss-of-signal


second.

E1_LES_SDH Indicates the E1 line side code violation


errored second.

E1_LSES_SDH Indicates the E1 line side code violation


severely errored second.

Table B-7 E1 Error Performance Events

Event Name Description

E1_BBE Indicates the E1 background block error.

E1_ES Indicates the E1 errored second.

E1_SES Indicates the E1 severely errored second.

E1_CSES Indicates the E1 consecutive severely errored


second.

E1_UAS Indicates the E1 unavailable second.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 773


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Table B-8 PW carried ATM, CSE and L2VPN Services Performance Events

Event Name Description

MPLS_PW_LS Indicates the packet loss seconds of PW


carried services.

MPLS_PW_SLS Indicates the severe packet loss seconds of


PW carried services.

MPLS_PW_CSLS Indicates the consecutive severe packet loss


seconds of PW carried services.

MPLS_PW_UAS Indicates the unavailable seconds of PW


carried services.

NOTE

Only the SLB2CSHN board supports PW.

B.1.2 Radio Performance Events


The radio performance events are performance events of the radio link bit errors, ATPC, AM,
and power.

Table B-9 Radio power performance events

Event Name Description

TSL_MAX Maximum value of radio transmit signal level

TSL_MIN Minimum value of radio transmit signal level

TSL_CUR Current value of radio transmit signal level

TSL_AVG Average value of radio transmit signal level

RSL_MAX Maximum value of radio receive signal level

RSL_MIN Minimum value of radio receive signal level

RSL_CUR Current value of radio receive signal level

RSL_AVG Average value of radio receive signal level

TLHTT The duration when the ODU at the local end


has a transit power higher than the upper
threshold

TLLTT The duration when the ODU at the local end


has a transit power higher than the lower
threshold

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 774


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Event Name Description

RLHTT The duration when the ODU at the local end


has a receive power lower than the upper
threshold

RLLTT The duration when the ODU at the local end


has a receive power lower than the lower
threshold

Table B-10 FEC performance events

Event Name Description

FEC_BEF_COR_ER FEC bit error rate before correction

FEC_UNCOR_BLOCK_CNT FEC uncorrected block count

FEC_COR_BYTE_CNT The number of bytes that are corrected


through the FEC

Table B-11 Radio link error performance events

Event Name Description

IF_BBE Radio link background block errors

IF_ES Radio link errored seconds

IF_SES Radio link severely errored seconds

IF_UAS Radio link unavailable second

IF_CSES Radio link consecutive severely errored


seconds

IF_BER Radio link bit error rate

Table B-12 ATPC performance events

Event Name Description

ATPC_P_ADJUST Positive ATPC adjustment

ATPC_N_ADJUST Negative ATPC adjustment

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 775


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Table B-13 AM performance events

Event Name Description

QPSKWS Working time of the QPSK mode

QAMWS16 Working time of the 16QAM mode

QAMWS32 Working time of the 32QAM mode

QAMWS64 Working time of the 64QAM mode

QAMWS128 Working time of the 128QAM mode

QAMWS256 Working time of the 256QAM mode

QAMWS512 Working time of the 512QAM mode

QAMWS1024 Working time of the 1024QAM mode

QPSK_S_WS Working time of the QPSKSTRONG mode

QAM_S_WS16 Working time of the 16QAMSTRONG mode

QAM_L_WS512 Working time of the 512QAMLIGHT mode

QAM_L_WS1024 Working time of the 1024QAMLIGHT mode

AMDOWNCNT Count of the downshift of the AM scheme

AMUPCNT Count of the upshift of the AM scheme

Table B-14 XPIC performance events

Event Name Description

XPIC_XPD_VALUE XPIC XPD value

Table B-15 IF 1+1 protection group error performance events

Event Name Description

PG_IF_BBE IF 1+1 protection group background block


errors

PG_IF_ES IF 1+1 protection group errored seconds

PG_IF_SES IF 1+1 protection group severely errored


seconds

PG_IF_UAS IF 1+1 protection group unavailable second

PG_IF_CSES IF 1+1 protection group consecutive severely


errored seconds

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 776


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Table B-16 IF port error performance events

Event Name Description

IF_SNR_MAX Maximum signal to noise ratio

IF_SNR_MIN Minimum signal to noise ratio

IF_SNR_AVG Average signal to noise ratio

B.1.3 MPLS Tunnel/PW Performance Events


This section lists MPLS tunnel/PW performance events.

Table B-17 MPLS tunnel/PW performance events

Event Name Description

MPLS_PW_LS PW packet loss seconds

MPLS_PW_SLS PW severe packet loss seconds

MPLS_PW_CSLS PW consecutive severe packet loss seconds

MPLS_PW_UAS PW unavailable seconds

MPLS_PW_LS_N PW packet loss seconds at the near end

MPLS_PW_SLS_N PW severe packet loss seconds at the near end

MPLS_PW_CSLS_N PW consecutive severe packet loss seconds at


the near end

MPLS_PW_UAS_N PW unavailable seconds at the near end

MPLS_TUNNEL_LS Tunnel packet loss seconds

MPLS_TUNNEL_SLS Tunnel severe packet loss seconds

MPLS_TUNNEL_CSLS Tunnel consecutive severe packet loss


seconds

MPLS_TUNNEL_UAS Tunnel unavailable seconds

MPLS_TUNNEL_LS_N Tunnel packet loss seconds at the near end

MPLS_TUNNEL_SLS_N Tunnel severe packet loss seconds at the near


end

MPLS_TUNNEL_CSLS_N Tunnel consecutive severe packet loss


seconds at the near end

MPLS_TUNNEL_UAS_N Tunnel unavailable seconds at the near end

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 777


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

NOTE

The MPLS tunnel/PW performance events.


The SLB2CSHN supports PW performance events.

B.1.4 Other Performance Events


In addition to the SDH/PDH and radio performance events, the OptiX RTN 980 supports
performance events of the optical power, the temperature, laser, PW and clock.

Table B-18 Optical power performance events

Event Name Description

TPLMAX Maximum value of transmit optical power

TPLMIN Minimum value of transmit optical power

TPLCUR Current value of transmit optical power

RPLMAX Maximum value of receive optical power

RPLMIN Minimum value of receive optical power

RPLCUR Current value of receive optical power

Table B-19 Board temperature performance events

Event Name Description

BDTEMPMAX Maximum value of board temperature

BDTEMPMIN Minimum value of board temperature

BDTEMPCUR Current value of board temperature

Table B-20 Laser temperature performance events

Event Name Description

OSPITMPMAX Maximum temperature of a laser core

OSPITMPMIN Minimum temperature of a laser core

OSPITMPCUR Current temperature of a laser core

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 778


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Table B-21 Transmitted bias current performance events

Performance Event Name Description

TLBMAX Maximum transmitted bias current of the


laser

TLBMIN Minimum transmitted bias current of the laser

TLBCUR Current transmitted bias current of the laser

Table B-22 Clock performance events

Event Name Description

MAXFREQDEV Maximum frequency deviation

MINFREQDEV Minimum frequency deviation

AVGFREQDEV Average frequency deviation

CURPOSITIVEPDV Current positive PDV

MAXPOSITIVEDELAY Maximum positive delay

MINPOSITIVEDELAY Minimum positive delay

AVGPOSITIVEDELAY Average positive delay

MAXPHASEOFFSET Maximum phase offset

MINPHASEOFFSET Minimum phase offset

AVGPHASEOFFSET Average phase offset

MAXMEANPATHDELAY Maximum path delay

MINMEANPATHDELAY Minimum path delay

AVGMEANPATHDELAY Average path delay

B.2 Performance Events (by Logical Board)


This part lists all the performance events that are reported by each board.

NOTE

The NE software consider a physical board as one or more logical boards when managing the physical board.
The NMS also considers a physical board as one or more logical boards when managing the physical board.
Table A-2 shows the logical boards corresponding to all physical boards

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 779


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Table B-23 Mappings between the physical boards and logical boards

Physical Logical Board


Board

CSHN l CSHN in slot 15 + SL4D in slot 16 + EG2D in slot 17


l CSHN in slot 20 + SL4D in slot 21 + EG2D in slot 22

AUX AUX in the same slot

IF1 IF1 in the same slot

IFU2 IFU2 in the same slot

IFX2 IFX2 in the same slot

ISU2 ISU2 in the same slot

ISX2 ISX2 in the same slot

ISV3 ISV3 in the same slot

SL1D SL1D in the same slot

SL1DA SL1DA in the same slot

EM6T EM6T in the same slot

EM6TA EM6TA in the same slot

EM6F EM6F in the same slot

EM6FA EM6FA in the same slot

EG4 EG4 in the same slot

EG4P EG4P in the same slot

EFP8 EFP8 in the same slot

EMS6 EMS6 in the same slot

SP3S SP3S in the same slot

SP3D SP3D in the same slot

ML1 ML1 in the same slot

MD1 MD1 in the same slot

CQ1 CQ1 in the same slot

PIU PIU in the same slot

FAN FAN in the same slot

ODU ODU in the slot whose number is 50 plus the slot number for the IF board
that is connected to the ODU

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 780


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

B.2.1 CQ1
The CQ1 board reports the board temperature performance events, SDH performance events
and Laser Performance Events.

Board temperature performance events

Table B-24 Board temperature performance events

Event Name Description

BDTEMPMAX Maximum value of board temperature

BDTEMPMIN Minimum value of board temperature

BDTEMPCUR Current value of board temperature

SDH Performance Events

Table B-25 Pointer Justification Performance Events

Event Name Description

AUPJCHIGH Indicates the count of positive AU pointer


justifications.

AUPJCLOW Indicates the count of negative AU pointer


justifications.

AUPJCNEW Indicates the count of new AU pointer


justifications.

TUPJCHIGH Indicates the count of positive TU pointer


justifications.

TUPJCLOW Indicates the count of negative TU pointer


justifications.

Table B-26 Regenerator Section Error Performance Events

Event Name Description

RSBBE Indicates the regenerator section background


block error.

RSES Indicates the regenerator section errored


second.

RSSES Indicates the regenerator section severely


errored second.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 781


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Event Name Description

RSUAS Indicates the regenerator section unavailable


second.

RSCSES Indicates the regenerator section consecutive


severely errored second.

Table B-27 Multiplex section error performance events

Event Name Description

MSBBE Multiplex section block of background error

MSES Multiplex section errored second

MSSES Multiplex section severely errored second

MSCSES Multiplex section consecutive severely


errored second

MSUAS Multiplex section unavailable second

MSFEBBE Multiplex section far end block of


background error

MSFEES Multiplex section far end errored second

MSFESES Multiplex section far end severely errored


second

MSFECSES Multiplex section far end consecutive


severely errored second

MSFEUAS Multiplex section far end unavailable second

Table B-28 Higher order path error performance events

Event Name Description

HPBBE Higher order path background errored block

HPES Higher order path errored second

HPSES Higher order path severely errored second

HPCSES Higher order path consecutive severely


errored second

HPUAS Higher order path unavailable second

HPFEBBE Higher order path far end background errored


block

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 782


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Event Name Description

HPFEES Higher order path far end errored second

HPFESES Higher order path far end severely errored


second

HPFECSES Higher order path far end consecutive


severely errored second

HPFEUAS Higher order path far end unavailable second

Table B-29 Lower order path error performance events

Event Name Description

LPBBE Lower order path block of background error

LPES Lower order path errored second

LPSES Lower order path severely errored second

LPCSES Lower order path continuous severe bit error


second

LPUAS Lower order path unavailable second

LPFEBBE Lower order path far end block of background


error

LPFEES Lower order path far end errored second

LPFESES Lower order path far end severely errored


second

LPFECSES Lower order path far end consecutive


severely errored second

LPFEUAS Lower order far end unavailable second

Laser Performance Events

Table B-30 Transmitted bias current performance events

Performance Event Name Description

TLBMAX Maximum transmitted bias current of the


laser

TLBMIN Minimum transmitted bias current of the laser

TLBCUR Current transmitted bias current of the laser

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 783


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Table B-31 Optical power performance events

Event Name Description

TPLMAX Maximum value of transmit optical power

TPLMIN Minimum value of transmit optical power

TPLCUR Current value of transmit optical power

RPLMAX Maximum value of receive optical power

RPLMIN Minimum value of receive optical power

RPLCUR Current value of receive optical power

Table B-32 Laser temperature performance events

Event Name Description

OSPITMPMAX Maximum temperature of a laser core

OSPITMPMIN Minimum temperature of a laser core

OSPITMPCUR Current temperature of a laser core

B.2.2 CSHN
The CSHN board reports four types of performance events: board temperature performance
events, IF 1+1 protection group error performance events, clock performance events, and PW
performance events.

Table B-33 Board temperature performance events

Event Name Description

BDTEMPMAX Indicates the maximum board


temperature.

BDTEMPMIN Indicates the minimum board


temperature.

BDTEMPCUR Indicates the current board temperature.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 784


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Table B-34 IF 1+1 protection group error performance events

Event Name Description

PG_IF_BBE IF 1+1 protection group background block


errors

PG_IF_ES IF 1+1 protection group errored seconds

PG_IF_SES IF 1+1 protection group severely errored


seconds

PG_IF_UAS IF 1+1 protection group unavailable second

PG_IF_CSES IF 1+1 protection group consecutive severely


errored seconds

Table B-35 Clock performance events

Event Name Description

MAXFREQDEV Maximum frequency deviation

MINFREQDEV Minimum frequency deviation

AVGFREQDEV Average frequency deviation

CURPOSITIVEPDV Current positive PDV

MAXPOSITIVEDELAY Maximum positive delay

MINPOSITIVEDELAY Minimum positive delay

AVGPOSITIVEDELAY Average positive delay

MAXPHASEOFFSET Maximum phase offset

MINPHASEOFFSET Minimum phase offset

AVGPHASEOFFSET Average phase offset

MAXMEANPATHDELAY Maximum path delay

MINMEANPATHDELAY Minimum path delay

AVGMEANPATHDELAY Average path delay

Table B-36 PW performance events

Event Name Description

MPLS_PW_LS PW packet loss seconds

MPLS_PW_LS_N PW packet loss seconds at the near end

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 785


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Event Name Description

MPLS_PW_SLS PW severe packet loss seconds

MPLS_PW_SLS_N PW severe packet loss seconds at the near end

MPLS_PW_CSLS PW consecutive severe packet loss seconds

MPLS_PW_CSLS_N PW consecutive severe packet loss seconds at


the near end

MPLS_PW_UAS PW unavailable seconds

MPLS_PW_UAS_N PW unavailable seconds at the near end

B.2.3 EG2D
The EG2D board reports only the optical power performance events.

Table B-37 Optical power performance events

Event Name Description

TPLMAX Maximum value of transmit optical power

TPLMIN Minimum value of transmit optical power

TPLCUR Current value of transmit optical power

RPLMAX Maximum value of receive optical power

RPLMIN Minimum value of receive optical power

RPLCUR Current value of receive optical power

B.2.4 EG4/EG4P
The EG4/EG4P board reports optical power performance events and board temperature
performance events.

Table B-38 Optical power performance events

Event Name Description

TPLMAX Maximum value of transmit optical power

TPLMIN Minimum value of transmit optical power

TPLCUR Current value of transmit optical power

RPLMAX Maximum value of receive optical power

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 786


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Event Name Description

RPLMIN Minimum value of receive optical power

RPLCUR Current value of receive optical power

Table B-39 Board temperature performance events

Event Name Description

BDTEMPMAX Maximum value of board temperature

BDTEMPMIN Minimum value of board temperature

BDTEMPCUR Current value of board temperature

B.2.5 EM6T
The EM6T board reports only the board temperature performance events.

Table B-40 Board temperature performance events

Event Name Description

BDTEMPMAX Maximum value of board temperature

BDTEMPMIN Minimum value of board temperature

BDTEMPCUR Current value of board temperature

B.2.6 EM6TA
The EM6TA board reports only the board temperature performance events.

Table B-41 Board temperature performance events

Event Name Description

BDTEMPMAX Maximum value of board temperature

BDTEMPMIN Minimum value of board temperature

BDTEMPCUR Current value of board temperature

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 787


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

B.2.7 EM6F
The EM6F board reports optical power performance events and board temperature performance
events.

Table B-42 Optical power performance events

Event Name Description

TPLMAX Maximum value of transmit optical power

TPLMIN Minimum value of transmit optical power

TPLCUR Current value of transmit optical power

RPLMAX Maximum value of receive optical power

RPLMIN Minimum value of receive optical power

RPLCUR Current value of receive optical power

Table B-43 Board temperature performance events

Event Name Description

BDTEMPMAX Maximum value of board temperature

BDTEMPMIN Minimum value of board temperature

BDTEMPCUR Current value of board temperature

B.2.8 EM6FA
The EM6FA board reports optical power performance events and board temperature
performance events.

Table B-44 Optical power performance events

Event Name Description

TPLMAX Maximum value of transmit optical power

TPLMIN Minimum value of transmit optical power

TPLCUR Current value of transmit optical power

RPLMAX Maximum value of receive optical power

RPLMIN Minimum value of receive optical power

RPLCUR Current value of receive optical power

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 788


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Table B-45 Board temperature performance events

Event Name Description

BDTEMPMAX Maximum value of board temperature

BDTEMPMIN Minimum value of board temperature

BDTEMPCUR Current value of board temperature

B.2.9 EFP8
The EFP8 board reports the temperature and PDH performance events.

Table B-46 Board temperature performance events

Event Name Description

BDTEMPMAX Maximum value of board temperature

BDTEMPMIN Minimum value of board temperature

BDTEMPCUR Current value of board temperature

Table B-47 Lower order path error performance events

Event Name Description

LPBBE Lower order path block of background error

LPES Lower order path errored second

LPSES Lower order path severely errored second

LPCSES Lower order path continuous severe bit error


second

LPUAS Lower order path unavailable second

LPFEBBE Lower order path far end block of background


error

LPFEES Lower order path far end errored second

LPFESES Lower order path far end severely errored


second

LPFECSES Lower order path far end consecutive


severely errored second

LPFEUAS Lower order far end unavailable second

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 789


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

B.2.10 EMS6
The EMS6 board reports the SDH performance events, board temperature performance events,
laser temperature performance events, and optical power performance events.

Table B-48 Lower order path error performance events

Event Name Description

LPBBE Lower order path block of background error

LPES Lower order path errored second

LPSES Lower order path severely errored second

LPCSES Lower order path continuous severe bit error


second

LPUAS Lower order path unavailable second

LPFEBBE Lower order path far end block of background


error

LPFEES Lower order path far end errored second

LPFESES Lower order path far end severely errored


second

LPFECSES Lower order path far end consecutive


severely errored second

Table B-49 Higher order path error performance events

Event Name Description

HPBBE Higher order path background errored block

HPES Higher order path errored second

HPSES Higher order path severely errored second

HPCSES Higher order path consecutive severely


errored second

HPUAS Higher order path unavailable second

HPFEBBE Higher order path far end background errored


block

HPFEES Higher order path far end errored second

HPFESES Higher order path far end severely errored


second

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 790


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Event Name Description

HPFECSES Higher order path far end consecutive


severely errored second

Table B-50 Board temperature performance events

Event Name Description

BDTEMPMAX Maximum value of board temperature

BDTEMPMIN Minimum value of board temperature

BDTEMPCUR Current value of board temperature

Table B-51 Laser temperature performance events

Event Name Description

OSPITMPMAX Maximum temperature of a laser core

OSPITMPMIN Minimum temperature of a laser core

OSPITMPCUR Current temperature of a laser core

Table B-52 Optical power performance events

Event Name Description

TPLMAX Maximum value of transmit optical power

TPLMIN Minimum value of transmit optical power

TPLCUR Current value of transmit optical power

RPLMAX Maximum value of receive optical power

RPLMIN Minimum value of receive optical power

RPLCUR Current value of receive optical power

B.2.11 IF1
The IF1 board reports three types of performance events: SDH/PDH performance events,
microwave performance events, and temperature performance events.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 791


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

SDH/PDH Performance Events

Table B-53 Pointer justification performance events

Event Name Description

AUPJCHIGH Count of positive AU pointer justification

AUPJCLOW Count of negative AU pointer justification

AUPJCNEW Count of new AU pointer justifications

Table B-54 Regenerator section error performance events

Event Name Description

RSBBE Regenerator section block of background


error

RSES Regenerator section errored second

RSSES Regenerator section severely errored second

RSUAS Regenerator section unavailable second

RSCSES Regenerator section consecutive severely


errored second

RSOFS Regenerator section out-of-frame second

RSOOF Regenerator section out of frame

NOTE

The regenerator section error performance events also occur in the case of the PDH radio. The PDH radio
frame is detected through the overheads that are used for frame location and bit error detection.

Table B-55 Multiplex section error performance events

Event Name Description

MSBBE Multiplex section block of background error

MSES Multiplex section errored second

MSSES Multiplex section severely errored second

MSCSES Multiplex section consecutive severely


errored second

MSUAS Multiplex section unavailable second

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 792


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Event Name Description

MSFEBBE Multiplex section far end block of


background error

MSFEES Multiplex section far end errored second

MSFESES Multiplex section far end severely errored


second

MSFECSES Multiplex section far end consecutive


severely errored second

MSFEUAS Multiplex section far end unavailable second

Table B-56 Higher order path error performance events

Event Name Description

HPBBE Higher order path background block error

HPES Higher order path errored second

HPSES Higher order path severely errored second

HPCSES Higher order path consecutive severely


errored second

HPUAS Higher order path unavailable second

HPFEBBE Higher order path far end background block


error

HPFEES Higher order path far end errored second

HPFESES Higher order path far end severely errored


second

HPFECSES Higher order path far end consecutive


severely errored second

HPFEUAS Higher order path far end unavailable second

Radio Performance Events

Table B-57 FEC performance events

Event Name Description

FEC_BEF_COR_ER FEC bit error rate before correction

FEC_COR_BYTE_CNT Frame count incorrect by FEC

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 793


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Table B-58 IF port error performance events

Event Name Description

IF_SNR_MAX Maximum signal to noise ratio

IF_SNR_MIN Minimum signal to noise ratio

IF_SNR_AVG Average signal to noise ratio

IF_MSE_MAX Maximum MSE value

IF_MSE_MIN Minimum MSE value

IF_MSE_CUR Current MSE value

IF_MSE_AVG Average MSE value

Other Performance Events

Table B-59 Board temperature performance events

Event Name Description

BDTEMPMAX Maximum value of board temperature

BDTEMPMIN Minimum value of board temperature

BDTEMPCUR Current value of board temperature

B.2.12 IFU2/ISU2
The IFU2/ISU2 board reports three types of performance events: SDH performance events, PDH
performance events, radio performance events, and board temperature performance events.

SDH Performance Events (Only reported by ISU2)

Table B-60 Pointer justification performance events

Event Name Description

AUPJCHIGH Count of positive AU pointer justification

AUPJCLOW Count of negative AU pointer justification

AUPJCNEW Count of new AU pointer justifications

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 794


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Table B-61 Regenerator section error performance events

Event Name Description

RSBBE Regenerator section block of background


error

RSES Regenerator section errored second

RSSES Regenerator section severely errored second

RSUAS Regenerator section unavailable second

RSCSES Regenerator section consecutive severely


errored second

RSOFS Regenerator section out-of-frame second

RSOOF Regenerator section out of frame

Table B-62 Multiplex section error performance events

Event Name Description

MSBBE Multiplex section block of background error

MSES Multiplex section errored second

MSSES Multiplex section severely errored second

MSCSES Multiplex section consecutive severely


errored second

MSUAS Multiplex section unavailable second

MSFEBBE Multiplex section far end block of


background error

MSFEES Multiplex section far end errored second

MSFESES Multiplex section far end severely errored


second

MSFECSES Multiplex section far end consecutive


severely errored second

MSFEUAS Multiplex section far end unavailable second

Table B-63 Higher order path error performance events

Event Name Description

HPBBE Higher order path background errored block

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 795


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Event Name Description

HPES Higher order path errored second

HPSES Higher order path severely errored second

HPCSES Higher order path consecutive severely


errored second

HPUAS Higher order path unavailable second

HPFEBBE Higher order path far end background errored


block

HPFEES Higher order path far end errored second

HPFESES Higher order path far end severely errored


second

HPFECSES Higher order path far end consecutive


severely errored second

HPFEUAS Higher order path far end unavailable second

PDH Performance Events

Table B-64 Lower order path error performance events

Event Name Description

LPBBE Lower order path block of background error

LPES Lower order path errored second

LPSES Lower order path severely errored second

LPCSES Lower order path continuous severe bit error


second

LPUAS Lower order path unavailable second

LPFEBBE Lower order path far end block of background


error

LPFEES Lower order path far end errored second

LPFESES Lower order path far end severely errored


second

LPFECSES Lower order path far end consecutive


severely errored second

LPFEUAS Lower order far end unavailable second

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 796


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Radio Performance Events

Table B-65 FEC performance events

Event Name Description

FEC_BEF_COR_ER FEC bit error rate before correction

FEC_UNCOR_BLOCK_CNT FEC uncorrected block count

Table B-66 Radio link error performance events

Event Name Description

IF_BBE Radio link background block errors

IF_ES Radio link errored seconds

IF_SES Radio link severely errored seconds

IF_UAS Radio link unavailable second

IF_CSES Radio link consecutive severely errored


seconds

IF_BER Radio link bit error rate

Table B-67 AM performance events

Event Name Description

QPSKWS Working time of the QPSK mode

QAMWS16 Working time of the 16QAM mode

QAMWS32 Working time of the 32QAM mode

QAMWS64 Working time of the 64QAM mode

QAMWS128 Working time of the 128QAM mode

QAMWS256 Working time of the 256QAM mode

AMDOWNCNT Count of the downshift of the AM scheme

AMUPCNT Count of the upshift of the AM scheme

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 797


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Table B-68 IF port error performance events

Event Name Description

IF_SNR_MAX Maximum signal to noise ratio

IF_SNR_MIN Minimum signal to noise ratio

IF_SNR_AVG Average signal to noise ratio

IF_MSE_MAX Maximum MSE value

IF_MSE_MIN Minimum MSE value

IF_MSE_CUR Current MSE value

IF_MSE_AVG Average MSE value

Other Performance Events

Table B-69 Board temperature performance events

Event Name Description

BDTEMPMAX Maximum value of board temperature

BDTEMPMIN Minimum value of board temperature

BDTEMPCUR Current value of board temperature

B.2.13 IFX2/ISX2
The IFX2/ISX2 board reports three types of performance events: SDH/PDH performance events,
radio performance events, and board temperature performance events.

SDH Performance Events (Only reported by ISX2)

Table B-70 Pointer justification performance events

Event Name Description

AUPJCHIGH Count of positive AU pointer justification

AUPJCLOW Count of negative AU pointer justification

AUPJCNEW Count of new AU pointer justifications

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 798


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Table B-71 Regenerator section error performance events

Event Name Description

RSBBE Regenerator section block of background


error

RSES Regenerator section errored second

RSSES Regenerator section severely errored second

RSUAS Regenerator section unavailable second

RSCSES Regenerator section consecutive severely


errored second

RSOFS Regenerator section out-of-frame second

RSOOF Regenerator section out of frame

Table B-72 Multiplex section error performance events

Event Name Description

MSBBE Multiplex section block of background error

MSES Multiplex section errored second

MSSES Multiplex section severely errored second

MSCSES Multiplex section consecutive severely


errored second

MSUAS Multiplex section unavailable second

MSFEBBE Multiplex section far end block of


background error

MSFEES Multiplex section far end errored second

MSFESES Multiplex section far end severely errored


second

MSFECSES Multiplex section far end consecutive


severely errored second

MSFEUAS Multiplex section far end unavailable second

Table B-73 Higher order path error performance events

Event Name Description

HPBBE Higher order path background errored block

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 799


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Event Name Description

HPES Higher order path errored second

HPSES Higher order path severely errored second

HPCSES Higher order path consecutive severely


errored second

HPUAS Higher order path unavailable second

HPFEBBE Higher order path far end background errored


block

HPFEES Higher order path far end errored second

HPFESES Higher order path far end severely errored


second

HPFECSES Higher order path far end consecutive


severely errored second

HPFEUAS Higher order path far end unavailable second

PDH Performance Events

Table B-74 Lower order path error performance events

Event Name Description

LPBBE Lower order path block of background error

LPES Lower order path errored second

LPSES Lower order path severely errored second

LPCSES Lower order path continuous severe bit error


second

LPUAS Lower order path unavailable second

LPFEBBE Lower order path far end block of background


error

LPFEES Lower order path far end errored second

LPFESES Lower order path far end severely errored


second

LPFECSES Lower order path far end consecutive


severely errored second

LPFEUAS Lower order far end unavailable second

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 800


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Radio Performance Events

Table B-75 FEC performance events

Event Name Description

FEC_BEF_COR_ER FEC bit error rate before correction

FEC_UNCOR_BLOCK_CNT FEC uncorrected block count

Table B-76 Radio link error performance events

Event Name Description

IF_BBE Radio link background block errors

IF_ES Radio link errored seconds

IF_SES Radio link severely errored seconds

IF_UAS Radio link unavailable second

IF_CSES Radio link consecutive severely errored


seconds

IF_BER Radio link bit error rate

Table B-77 AM performance events

Event Name Description

QPSKWS Working time of the QPSK mode

QAMWS16 Working time of the 16QAM mode

QAMWS32 Working time of the 32QAM mode

QAMWS64 Working time of the 64QAM mode

QAMWS128 Working time of the 128QAM mode

QAMWS256 Working time of the 256QAM mode

AMDOWNCNT Count of the downshift of the AM scheme

AMUPCNT Count of the upshift of the AM scheme

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 801


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Table B-78 IF port error performance events

Event Name Description

IF_SNR_MAX Maximum signal to noise ratio

IF_SNR_MIN Minimum signal to noise ratio

IF_SNR_AVG Average signal to noise ratio

IF_MSE_MAX Maximum MSE value

IF_MSE_MIN Minimum MSE value

IF_MSE_CUR Current MSE value

IF_MSE_AVG Average MSE value

Table B-79 XPIC performance events

Event Name Description

XPIC_XPD_VALUE XPIC XPD value

Other Performance Events

Table B-80 Board temperature performance events

Event Name Description

BDTEMPMAX Maximum value of board temperature

BDTEMPMIN Minimum value of board temperature

BDTEMPCUR Current value of board temperature

B.2.14 ISV3
The ISV3 board reports four types of performance events: SDH performance events, PDH
performance events, microwave performance events, and board temperature performance
events.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 802


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

SDH Performance Events

Table B-81 Regenerator section error performance events

Event Name Description

RSBBE Regenerator section block of background


error

RSES Regenerator section errored second

RSSES Regenerator section severely errored second

RSUAS Regenerator section unavailable second

RSCSES Regenerator section consecutive severely


errored second

RSOFS Regenerator section out-of-frame second

RSOOF Regenerator section out of frame

Table B-82 Multiplex section error performance events

Event Name Description

MSBBE Multiplex section block of background error

MSES Multiplex section errored second

MSSES Multiplex section severely errored second

MSCSES Multiplex section consecutive severely


errored second

MSUAS Multiplex section unavailable second

MSFEBBE Multiplex section far end block of


background error

MSFEES Multiplex section far end errored second

MSFESES Multiplex section far end severely errored


second

MSFECSES Multiplex section far end consecutive


severely errored second

MSFEUAS Multiplex section far end unavailable second

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 803


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Table B-83 Higher order path error performance events

Event Name Description

HPBBE Higher order path background errored block

HPES Higher order path errored second

HPSES Higher order path severely errored second

HPCSES Higher order path consecutive severely


errored second

HPUAS Higher order path unavailable second

HPFEBBE Higher order path far end background errored


block

HPFEES Higher order path far end errored second

HPFESES Higher order path far end severely errored


second

HPFECSES Higher order path far end consecutive


severely errored second

HPFEUAS Higher order path far end unavailable second

PDH Performance Events

Table B-84 Lower order path error performance events

Event Name Description

LPBBE Lower order path block of background error

LPES Lower order path errored second

LPSES Lower order path severely errored second

LPCSES Lower order path continuous severe bit error


second

LPUAS Lower order path unavailable second

LPFEBBE Lower order path far end block of background


error

LPFEES Lower order path far end errored second

LPFESES Lower order path far end severely errored


second

LPFECSES Lower order path far end consecutive


severely errored second

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 804


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Event Name Description

LPFEUAS Lower order far end unavailable second

Radio Performance Events

Table B-85 FEC performance events

Event Name Description

FEC_BEF_COR_ER FEC bit error rate before correction

FEC_UNCOR_BLOCK_CNT FEC uncorrected block count

Table B-86 Radio link error performance events

Event Name Description

IF_BBE Radio link background block errors

IF_ES Radio link errored seconds

IF_SES Radio link severely errored seconds

IF_UAS Radio link unavailable second

IF_CSES Radio link consecutive severely errored


seconds

IF_BER Radio link bit error rate

Table B-87 AM performance events

Event Name Description

QPSKWS Working time of the QPSK mode

QAMWS16 Working time of the 16QAM mode

QAMWS32 Working time of the 32QAM mode

QAMWS64 Working time of the 64QAM mode

QAMWS128 Working time of the 128QAM mode

QAMWS256 Working time of the 256QAM mode

QAMWS512 Working time of the 512QAM mode

QAMWS1024 Working time of the 1024QAM mode

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 805


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Event Name Description

QPSK_S_WS Working time of the QPSK strong mode

QAM_S_WS16 Working time of the 16QAM strong mode

QAM_L_WS512 Working time of the 512QAM light mode

QAM_L_WS1024 Working time of the 1024QAM light mode

AMDOWNCNT Count of the downshift of the AM scheme

AMUPCNT Count of the upshift of the AM scheme

Table B-88 IF port error performance events

Event Name Description

IF_SNR_MAX Maximum signal to noise ratio

IF_SNR_MIN Minimum signal to noise ratio

IF_SNR_AVG Average signal to noise ratio

IF_MSE_MAX Maximum MSE value

IF_MSE_MIN Minimum MSE value

IF_MSE_CUR Current MSE value

IF_MSE_AVG Average MSE value

Table B-89 XPIC performance events

Event Name Description

XPIC_XPD_VALUE XPIC XPD value

Other Performance Events

Table B-90 Board temperature performance events

Event Name Description

BDTEMPMAX Maximum value of board temperature

BDTEMPMIN Minimum value of board temperature

BDTEMPCUR Current value of board temperature

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 806


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

B.2.15 ML1/MD1
The ML1/MD1 board reports E1 performance events, PW performance events and board
temperature performance events.

Table B-91 E1 Performance Event List

Event Name Description

E1_LCV_SDH Indicates the count of E1 line side code


violations.

E1_LLOSS_SDH Indicates the E1 line side loss-of-signal


second.

E1_LES_SDH Indicates the E1 line side code violation


errored second.

E1_LSES_SDH Indicates the E1 line side code violation


severely errored second.

Table B-92 PW carried services performance events

Event Name Description

MPLS_PW_LS Indicates the packet loss seconds of PW


carried services

MPLS_PW_SLS Indicates the severe packet loss seconds of


PW carried services

MPLS_PW_CSLS Indicates the consecutive severe packet loss


seconds of PW carried services

MPLS_PW_UAS Indicates the unavailable seconds of PW


carried services

Table B-93 Board Temperature Performance Events

Event Name Description

BDTEMPMAX Indicates the maximum board


temperature.

BDTEMPMIN Indicates the minimum board


temperature.

BDTEMPCUR Indicates the current board temperature.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 807


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

B.2.16 ODU
The ODU reports radio performance events and board temperature performance events.

Table B-94 Radio power performance events

Event Name Description

TSL_MAX Maximum value of radio transmit signal level

TSL_MIN Minimum value of radio transmit signal level

TSL_CUR Current value of radio transmit signal level

TSL_AVG Average value of radio transmit signal level

RSL_MAX Maximum value of radio receive signal level

RSL_MIN Minimum value of radio receive signal level

RSL_CUR Current value of radio receive signal level

RSL_AVG Average value of radio receive signal level

TLHTT The duration when the ODU at the local end


has a transit power higher than the upper
threshold

TLLTT The duration when the ODU at the local end


has a transit power higher than the lower
threshold

RLHTT The duration when the ODU at the local end


has a receive power lower than the upper
threshold

RLLTT The duration when the ODU at the local end


has a receive power lower than the lower
threshold

ODU_SSV_TH The duration (seconds) when the ODU


receive power is lower than sensitivity

Table B-95 ATPC performance events

Event Name Description

ATPC_P_ADJUST Positive ATPC adjustment

ATPC_N_ADJUST Negative ATPC adjustment

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 808


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Table B-96 Board temperature performance events

Event Name Description

BDTEMPMAX Indicates the maximum board


temperature.

BDTEMPMIN Indicates the minimum board


temperature.

BDTEMPCUR Indicates the current board temperature.

B.2.17 SL1D/SL1DA
The SL1D/SL1DA board reports two types of performance events: SDH performance events,
and optical power performance events.

SDH Performance Events

Table B-97 Pointer justification performance events

Event Name Description

AUPJCHIGH Count of positive AU pointer justification

AUPJCLOW Count of negative AU pointer justification

AUPJCNEW Count of new AU pointer justifications

Table B-98 Regenerator section error performance events

Event Name Description

RSBBE Regenerator section block of background


error

RSES Regenerator section errored second

RSSES Regenerator section severely errored second

RSUAS Regenerator section unavailable second

RSCSES Regenerator section consecutive severely


errored second

RSOFS Regenerator section out-of-frame second

RSOOF Regenerator section out of frame

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 809


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Table B-99 Multiplex section error performance events

Event Name Description

MSBBE Multiplex section block of background error

MSES Multiplex section errored second

MSSES Multiplex section severely errored second

MSCSES Multiplex section consecutive severely


errored second

MSUAS Multiplex section unavailable second

MSFEBBE Multiplex section far end block of


background error

MSFEES Multiplex section far end errored second

MSFESES Multiplex section far end severely errored


second

MSFECSES Multiplex section far end consecutive


severely errored second

MSFEUAS Multiplex section far end unavailable second

Table B-100 Higher order path error performance events

Event Name Description

HPBBE Higher order path background errored block

HPES Higher order path errored second

HPSES Higher order path severely errored second

HPCSES Higher order path consecutive severely


errored second

HPUAS Higher order path unavailable second

HPFEBBE Higher order path far end background errored


block

HPFEES Higher order path far end errored second

HPFESES Higher order path far end severely errored


second

HPFECSES Higher order path far end consecutive


severely errored second

HPFEUAS Higher order path far end unavailable second

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 810


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Other Performance Events

Table B-101 Optical power performance events

Event Name Description

TPLMAX Maximum value of transmit optical power

TPLMIN Minimum value of transmit optical power

TPLCUR Current value of transmit optical power

RPLMAX Maximum value of receive optical power

RPLMIN Minimum value of receive optical power

RPLCUR Current value of receive optical power

B.2.18 SL4D
The SL4D board reports SDH performance events and optical power performance events.

SDH Performance Events

Table B-102 Pointer Justification Performance Events

Event Name Description

AUPJCHIGH Indicates the count of positive AU pointer


justifications.

AUPJCLOW Indicates the count of negative AU pointer


justifications.

AUPJCNEW Indicates the count of new AU pointer


justifications.

Table B-103 Regenerator Section Error Performance Events

Event Name Description

RSBBE Indicates the regenerator section background


block error.

RSES Indicates the regenerator section errored


second.

RSSES Indicates the regenerator section severely


errored second.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 811


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Event Name Description

RSUAS Indicates the regenerator section unavailable


second.

RSCSES Indicates the regenerator section consecutive


severely errored second.

RSOFS Indicates the regenerator section out-of-


frame second.

RSOOF Indicates the count of regenerator section out-


of-frame events.

Table B-104 Multiplex Section Error Performance Events

Event Name Description

MSBBE Indicates the multiplex section background


block error.

MSES Indicates the multiplex section errored


second.

MSSES Indicates the multiplex section severely


errored second.

MSCSES Indicates the multiplex section consecutive


severely errored second.

MSUAS Indicates the multiplex section unavailable


second.

MSFEBBE Indicates the multiplex section far end


background block error.

MSFEES Indicates the multiplex section far end errored


second.

MSFESES Indicates the multiplex section far end


severely errored second.

MSFECSES Indicates the multiplex section far end


consecutive severely errored second.

MSFEUAS Indicates the multiplex section far end


unavailable second.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 812


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Table B-105 Higher Order Path Error Performance Events

Event Name Description

HPBBE Indicates the higher order path background


block error.

HPES Indicates the higher order path errored


second.

HPSES Indicates the higher order path severely


errored second.

HPCSES Indicates the higher order path consecutive


severely errored second.

HPUAS Indicates the higher order path unavailable


second.

HPFEBBE Indicates the higher order path far end


background block error.

HPFEES Indicates the higher order path far end errored


second.

HPFESES Indicates the higher order path far end


severely errored second.

HPFECSES Indicates the higher order path far end


consecutive severely errored second.

HPFEUAS Indicates the higher order path far end


unavailable second.

Other Performance Events

Table B-106 Optical Power Performance Events

Event Name Description

TPLMAX Indicates the maximum transmit optical


power at an optical interface.

TPLMIN Indicates the minimum transmit optical


power at an optical interface.

TPLCUR Indicates the current transmit power at an


optical interface.

RPLMAX Indicates the maximum receive optical power


at an optical interface.

RPLMIN Indicates the minimum receive optical power


at an optical interface.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 813


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Event Name Description

RPLCUR Indicates the current receive power at an


optical interface.

B.2.19 SP3S/SP3D
The SP3S/SP3D board reports only the PDH performance events.

Table B-107 Pointer justification performance events

Event Name Description

TUPJCHIGH Count of positive TU pointer justifications

TUPJCLOW Count of negative TU pointer justifications

TUPJCNEW Count of new TU pointer justifications

Table B-108 Lower order path error performance events

Event Name Description

LPBBE Lower order path block of background error

LPES Lower order path errored second

LPSES Lower order path severely errored second

LPCSES Lower order path continuous severe bit error


second

LPUAS Lower order path unavailable second

LPFEBBE Lower order path far end block of background


error

LPFEES Lower order path far end errored second

LPFESES Lower order path far end severely errored


second

LPFECSES Lower order path far end consecutive


severely errored second

LPFEUAS Lower order far end unavailable second

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 814


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Table B-109 E1 Error Performance Events

Event Name Description

E1_BBE Indicates the E1 background block error.

E1_ES Indicates the E1 errored second.

E1_SES Indicates the E1 severely errored second.

E1_CSES Indicates the E1 consecutive severely errored


second.

E1_UAS Indicates the E1 unavailable second.

B.3 Performance Events and Handling Procedures


Based on the type of a performance event, this chapter describes all the performance events on
the and how to handle these performance events.

B.3.1 ATPC_P_ADJUST and ATPC_N_ADJUST

Description
l ATPC_P_ADJUST indicates the positive ATPC adjustment event.
This performance event indicates that the quality of a communication link declines.
Therefore, you must increase the transmit power of the ODU to maintain the
communication quality.
l ATPC_N_ADJUST indicates the negative ATPC adjustment event.
This performance event indicates that the quality of a communication link becomes well
or the transmit power of the ODU is very large. Therefore, you can decrease the transmit
power of the ODU.

Attribute
Attribute Description

Performance event cell ATPCPADJUST (ATPC_P_ADJUST) and


ATPCNADJUST (ATPC_N_ADJUST)

Unit times

Impact on the System


The ATPC adjustment indicates only the stability of a communication link and it does not affect
services. When the value of the performance event is larger, more adjustments are made.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 815


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

When the factors that affect a communication link, such as sudden change of the weather, do
not exist, and when the ATPC adjustment count is very large, the communication link may be
faulty. You must check the communication link to prevent it from failure.

Related Alarms
None.

B.3.2 AMDOWNCNT and AMUPCNT

Description
l AMDOWNCNT indicates the count of the AM downshifts on a board in the current
performance statistics period.
l AMUPCNT indicates the count of the AM upshifts on a board in the current performance
statistics period.

Attribute
Attribute Description

Performance event cell ACMDCNT(AMDOWNCNT) and


ACMUCNT(AMUPCNT)

Unit times

Impact on System
l When the value of the performance event is larger, more AM scheme are made.
l When the factors that affect a communication link, such as sudden change of the weather,
do not exist, and when the AM scheme count is very large, the communication link may
be faulty. You must check the communication link to prevent it from failure.

Related Alarms
AM_DOWNSHIFT

Possible Causes
When the AM function is enabled, the transmission modulation scheme that the IF port on the
IF board uses varies according to the quality of the link. Accordingly, the system counts the
performance events of the modulation scheme shift. When the low-efficiency modulation
scheme is shifted to the high-efficiency modulation scheme, an upshift is recorded and one
AMUPCNT event is counted. Similarly, when the high-efficiency modulation scheme is shifted
to the low-efficiency modulation scheme, a downshift is recorded and one AMDOWNCNT
event is counted.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 816


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

B.3.3 AUPJCHIGH, AUPJCLOW, and AUPJCNEW

Description
l AUPJCHIGH indicates the count of positive AU pointer justifications.
l AUPJCLOW indicates the count of negative AU pointer justifications.
l AUPJCNEW indicates the count of new AU pointer justifications.

Attribute
Attribute Description

Performance event cell PPJE (AUPJCHIGH)


NPJE (AUPJCLOW)
NDF (AUPJCNEW)

Unit Block

Impact on System
Less than six AUPJCHIGH and AUPJCLOW events do not affect the system. If the pointer is
justified for many times, or the AUPJCNEW event occurs, bit errors may occur in the service.

Related Alarms
When the AUPJCHIGH, AUPJCLOW, or AUPJCNEW performance event crosses the preset
threshold, the MSAD_CROSSTR alarm is reported.

Performance Event Default 15-Minute Default 24-Hour


Threshold Threshold

AUPJCHIGH 1500 30000

AUPJCLOW 1500 30000

AUPJCNEW 1500 30000

Possible Causes
The NE clock is out-of-synchronization.

Procedure
Step 1 See 5.5 Troubleshooting Pointer Justifications for handling.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 817


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

B.3.4 BDTEMPMAX, BDTEMPMIN, and BDTEMPCUR

Description
l BDTEMPMAX indicates the maximum temperature of a board.
l BDTEMPMIN indicates the minimum temperature of a board.
l BDTEMPCUR indicates the current temperature of a board.

Attribute
Attribute Description

Performance event cell XCS_TEMP

Unit 0.1C

Impact on System
If the temperature of a board is very high or very low, the performance of the board declines,
and bit errors or other faults occur.

Related Alarms
If the temperature of a board crosses the specific threshold, the TEMP_ALARM alarm is
reported.

B.3.5 CURPOSITIVEPDV and CURNEGATIVEPDV

Description
l CURPOSITIVEPDV indicates the current positive packet delay variation (PDV).
l CURNEGATIVEPDV indicates the current negative PDV.

Attribute
Attribute Description

Performance event cell PTP_N_PDV_15M (15-minute negative


PDV)
PTP_N_PDV_24H (24-hour negative PDV)

Unit ns

Impact on System
The less the PDV, the better the clock performance.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 818


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Related Alarms
When the PDV exceeds the acceptable range, the clock is unlocked and the
ACR_LOCK_FAIL alarm is reported.

B.3.6 E1_LCV_SDH, E1_LLOSS_SDH, E1_LES_SDH, and


E1_LSES_SDH

Description
l The E1_LCV_SDH is a performance event indicating the E1 line side code violation count.
l The E1_LLOSS_SDH is a performance event indicating the E1 line side loss-of-signal
seconds.
l The E1_LES_SDH is a performance event indicating the E1 line side code violation errored
second.
ES refers to a second in which one or more errored blocks are detected.
l The E1_LSES_SDH is a performance event indicating the E1 line side code violation
severely errored second.
An SES refers to a certain second in which 30% or more errored blocks are detected or at
least one serious disturbance period (SDP) exists. The SDP refers to a period of at least
four consecutive blocks or 1 ms (taking the longer one) in which the BER of all the
consecutive blocks is equal to or higher than 10-2 or the signal is lost.

Attribute
Attribute Description

Performance event cell LCV_BPVCNT

Unit None
Second

Impact on the System


If bit errors occur in the services, you need to find out the causes and troubleshoot the problem
in a timely manner. Otherwise, the signal transmission quality will be affected.

Related Alarms
None.

Possible Causes
l External causes:
The fiber performance is degraded, and the fiber has extremely high attenuation.
The fiber connector is dirty or incorrect.
The equipment is improperly grounded.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 819


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

A strong interference source is present near the equipment.


The working temperature is extremely high or extremely low, and the opposite
equipment cannot tolerate such temperature.
l Equipment problems:
The service code types are incorrect.
The board becomes faulty, or the performance of the board is degraded.

Procedure
Step 1 First eliminate external causes, such as poor grounding, too high operating temperature, too low
or too high the receiving optical power of the line board.

Step 2 Check whether the correct E1 service code is selected. If not, modify the code of the services
received by a board by setting the code type of the board.

----End

B.3.7 E1_BBE, E1_ES, E1_SES, E1_CSES, and E1_UAS

Description
l E1_BBE indicates the E1 background block error.
Background block error (BBE) refers to the errored blocks excluding the errored blocks in
the unavailable and severely errored seconds. This performance event can be detected only
when the E1 frame format is CRC-4.
l E1_ES indicates the E1 errored second.
Errored second (ES) refers to a second in which one or more errored blocks are detected.
l E1_SES indicates the E1 severely errored second.
Severely errored second (SES) refers to a second in which 30% or more than 30% errored
blocks exist or at least one severely disturbed period (SDP) exists. SDP is the period in
which the BER of all the consecutive blocks in a period of less than four consecutive blocks
or 1 ms (the longer period is applied) is equal to or higher than 10-2 or the signal is lost.
l E1_CSES indicates the E1 consecutive severely errored second.
Consecutive severely errored second (CSES) refers to a second in which the SES occurs
continuously for less than 10 seconds.
l E1_UAS indicates the E1 unavailable second.
The unavailable time begins at the onset of 10 consecutive SESs, with the 10 SESs included.
When SESs disappear for 10 consecutive seconds, the available time begins from the
eleventh second, with the previous 10 seconds included.

Attribute
Attribute Description

Performance event cell E1CRC_ERR_CNT

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 820


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Attribute Description

Unit Block (E1_BBE)


Second (E1_ES, E1_SES, E1_CSES, and
E1_UAS)

Impact on System
Excessive bit errors interrupt the service (the BER should be less than -3 for the voice service,
and 10-6 for the data service).

Related Alarms
None.

Performance Event Default 15-Minute Default 24-Hour


Threshold Threshold

E1_BBE 1500 15000

E1_ES 50 100

E1_SES 20 50

E1_UAS 20 50

E1_CSES 4 (number of consecutive SESs)

Possible Causes
The system detects the E1 bit errors.

Procedure
Step 1 Check whether the frame format of the local E1 port is the same as that of the opposite port.

Step 2 Check whether the E1 cable is intact. If it is damaged, replace it.

Step 3 Use another E1 port.

Step 4 Troubleshoot the interconnected equipment.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 821


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

B.3.8 FEC_BEF_COR_ER, FEC_COR_BYTE_CNT and


FEC_UNCOR_BLOCK_CNT

Description
l FEC_BEF_COR_ER indicates the BER before the FEC is performed.
This event indicates the impact of the external environment on the transmission.
l FEC_COR_BYTE_CNT indicates the number of bytes corrected through the FEC.
This event indicates the impact of the FEC.
l FEC_UNCOR_BLOCK_CNT indicates the number of frames that cannot be corrected
through the FEC.
This event indicates the number of blocks that cannot be corrected through the FEC.

Attribute
Attribute Description

Performance event cell FECBEFCORER (FEC_BEF_COR_ER)


FECCORBYTECNT
(FEC_COR_BYTE_CNT)
FECUNCORBLOCKCNT
(FEC_UNCOR_BLOCK_CNT)

Unit None (FEC_BEF_COR_ER)


None (FEC_COR_BYTE_CNT)
Block (FEC_UNCOR_BLOCK_CNT)

Impact on System
If the value of FEC_BEF_COR_ER is very high, residual bit errors exist in the service after the
FEC is performed.

If the value of FEC_UNCOR_BLOCK_CNT is not zero, it can be inferred that bit errors that
cannot be corrected exist on a radio link. Bit errors exist in the service accordingly.

Related Alarms
If a byte cannot be corrected, the MW_FEC_UNCOR alarm is reported.

B.3.9 HPBBE, HPES, HPSES, HPCSES, and HPUAS

Description
l HPBBE indicates the higher order path background block error.
BBE refers to the errored blocks excluding the errored blocks in the unavailable and
severely errored seconds.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 822


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

l HPES indicates the higher order path errored second.


ES refers to a second in which one or more errored blocks are detected.
l HPSES indicates the higher order path severely errored second.
SES refers to a second in which 30% or more than 30% errored blocks exist or at least one
SDP exists. SDP is the period in which the BER of all the consecutive blocks in a period
of less than four consecutive blocks or 1 ms (the longer period is applied) is equal to or
higher than 10-2 or the signal is lost.
l HPCSES indicates the higher order path consecutive severely errored second.
CSES refers to a second in which the SES occurs continuously for less than 10 seconds.
l HPUAS indicates the higher order path unavailable second.
The unavailable time begins at the onset of 10 consecutive SESs, with the 10 SESs included.
When SESs disappear for 10 consecutive seconds, the available time begins from the
eleventh second, with the previous 10 seconds included.

Attribute
Attribute Description

Performance event cell B3CNT

Unit Block (HPBBE)


Second (HPES, HPSES, HPCSES, and
HPUAS)

Impact on System
Excessive bit errors interrupt the service (the BER should be less than 10-3 for the voice service,
and 10-6 for the data service).

Related Alarms
When the HPBBE, HPES, HPSES, HPCSES, or HPUAS performance event crosses the preset
threshold, the HP_CROSSTR alarm is reported.

Performance Event Default 15-Minute Default 24-Hour


Threshold Threshold

HPBBE 1500 15000

HPES 50 100

HPSES 20 50

HPUAS 20 50

HPCSES 4 (number of consecutive SESs)

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 823


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Possible Causes
The system detects higher order path bit errors through the B3 byte.

Procedure
Step 1 See 5.4 Troubleshooting Bit Errors in TDM Services for handling.

----End

B.3.10 HPFEBBE, HPFEES, HPFESES, HPFECSES, and HPFEUAS


Description
l HPFEBBE indicates the higher order path far end background block error.
Far end background block error (FEBBE) indicates that the BBE occurs at the opposite
end.
l HPFEES indicates the higher order path far end errored second.
FEES indicates that the ES occurs at the opposite end.
l HPFESES indicates the higher order path far end severely errored second.
FESES indicates that the SES occurs at the opposite end.
l HPFECSES indicates the higher order path far end consecutive severely errored second.
FECSES indicates that the CSES occurs at the opposite end.
l HPFEUAS indicates the higher order path far end unavailable second.
FEUAS indicates that the UAS occurs at the opposite end.

Attribute
Attribute Description

Performance event cell PFEBE

Unit Block (HPFEBBE)


Second (HPFEES, HPFESES, HPFECSES,
and HPFEUAS)

Impact on System
Excessive bit errors interrupt the service (the BER should be less than 10-3 for the voice service,
and 10-6 for the data service).

Related Alarms
The HP_REI alarm is reported at the local end.

Possible Causes
The system detects the higher order path far end bit errors through bits 1 to 4 in the G1 byte.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 824


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Procedure
Step 1 Clear the corresponding performance event at the opposite end.

----End

B.3.11 IF_BBE, IF_ES, IF_SES, IF_CSES, and IF_UAS

Description
l IF_BBE indicates the radio link background block error.
BBE refers to the errored blocks excluding the errored blocks in the unavailable and
severely errored seconds.
l IF_ES indicates the radio link errored second.
ES refers to a second in which one or more errored blocks are detected.
l IF_SES indicates the radio link severely errored second.
SES refers to a second in which 30% or more than 30% errored blocks exist or at least one
SDP exists. SDP is the period in which the BER of all the consecutive blocks in a period
of less than four consecutive blocks or 1 ms (the longer period is applied) is equal to or
higher than 10-2 or the signal is lost.
l IF_CSES indicates the radio link consecutively severely errored second.
CSES refers to a second in which the SES occurs continuously for less than 10 seconds.
l IF_UAS indicates the radio link unavailable second.
The unavailable time begins at the onset of 10 consecutive SESs, with the 10 SESs included.
When SESs disappear for 10 consecutive seconds, the available time begins from the
eleventh second, with the previous 10 seconds included.
l IF_BER indicates the radio link bit error rate.

Attribute
Attribute Description

Performance event cell IF_BIP8


IF_BER_15M(IF_BER)
IF_BER_24H(IF_BER)

Unit IF_BBE(block)
Second(IF_ES, IF_SES, IF_CSES, IF_UAS)

Impact on System
Excessive bit errors interrupt the service (the BER should be less than 10-3 for the voice service,
and 10-6 for the data service).

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 825


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Related Alarms
The MW_BER_SD or MW_BER_EXC alarm is reported when the BER crosses the specific
threshold.

Possible Causes
The system detects bit errors on the radio link through the bit error detection overheads in a radio
frame.

Procedure
Step 1 See 5.4 Troubleshooting Bit Errors in TDM Services for handling.

----End

B.3.12 IF_SNR_MAX, IF_SNR_MIN, and IF_SNR_AVG

Description
l IF_SNR_MAX indicates the maximum signal to noise ratio.
l IF_SNR_MIN indicates the minimum signal to noise ratio.
l IF_SNR_AVG indicates the average signal to noise ratio.

Attribute
Attribute Description

Performance event cell IF_SNR(IF_SNR_MAX, IF_SNR_MIN)


IF_SNR_AVG_15M, and
IF_SNR_AVG_24H(IF_SNR_AVG)

Unit dB

Impact on System
A greater SNR value indicates a steady radio link; a smaller SNR value indicates a worse radio
link, errors and even interruptions occur on the radio link.

Related Alarms
None.

B.3.13 LPBBE, LPES, LPSES, LPCSES, and LPUAS

Description
l LPBBE indicates the lower order path background block error.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 826


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

BBE refers to the errored blocks excluding the errored blocks in the unavailable and
severely errored seconds.
l LPES indicates the lower order path errored second.
ES refers to a second in which one or more errored blocks are detected.
l LPSES indicates the lower order path severely errored second.
SES refers to a second in which 30% or more than 30% errored blocks exist or at least one
SDP exists. SDP is the period in which the BER of all the consecutive blocks in a period
of less than four consecutive blocks or 1 ms (the longer period is applied) is equal to or
higher than 10-2 or the signal is lost.
l LPCSES indicates the lower order path consecutive severely errored second.
CSES refers to a second in which the SES occurs continuously for less than 10 seconds.
l LPUAS indicates the lower order path unavailable second.
The unavailable time begins at the onset of 10 consecutive SESs, with the 10 SESs included.
When SESs disappear for 10 consecutive seconds, the available time begins from the
eleventh second, with the previous 10 seconds included.

Attribute
Attribute Description

Performance event cell LPBIP2CNT

Unit Block (LPBBE)


Second (LPES, LPSES, LPCSES, and
LPUAS)

Impact on System
Excessive bit errors interrupt the service (the BER should be less than 10-3 for the voice service,
and 10-6 for the data service).

Related Alarms
When the LPBBE, LPES, LPSES, LPCSES, or LPUAS performance event crosses the preset
threshold, the LP_CROSSTR alarm is reported.

Performance Event Default 15-Minute Default 24-Hour


Threshold Threshold

LPBBE 1500 15000

LPES 50 100

LPSES 20 50

LPUAS 20 50

LPCSES 4 (number of consecutive SESs)

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 827


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Possible Causes
The system detects lower order path bit errors through the BIP2 in the V5 byte (E1 interface
board or Hybrid IF board).

Procedure
Step 1 See 5.4 Troubleshooting Bit Errors in TDM Services for handling.

----End

B.3.14 LPFEBBE, LPFEES, LPFESES, LPFECSES, and LPFEUAS

Description
l LPFEBBE indicates the lower order path far end background block error.
FEBBE indicates that the BBE occurs at the opposite end.
l LPFEES indicates the lower order path far end errored second.
FEES indicates that the ES occurs at the opposite end.
l LPFESES indicates the lower order path far end severely errored second.
FESES indicates that the SES occurs at the opposite end.
l LPFECSES indicates the lower order path far end consecutive severely errored second.
FECSES indicates that the CSES occurs at the opposite end.
l LPFEUAS indicates the lower order path far end unavailable second.
FEUAS indicates that the UAS occurs at the opposite end.

Attribute
Attribute Description

Performance event cell LPFEBE

Unit Block (LPFEBBE)


Second (LPFEES, LPFESES, LPFECSES,
and LPFEUAS)

Impact on System
Excessive bit errors interrupt the service (the BER should be less than 10-3 for the voice service,
and 10-6 for the data service).

Related Alarms
The LP_REI alarm is reported at the local end.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 828


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Possible Causes
The system detects the lower order path far end bit errors through bit 3 in the V5 byte.

Procedure
Step 1 Clear the corresponding performance event at the opposite end.

----End

B.3.15 MAXFREQDEV, MINFREQDEV, and AVGFREQDEV

Description
l MAXFREQDEV indicates the maximum frequency offset.
l MINFREQDEV indicates the minimum frequency offset.
l AVGFREQDEV indicates the average frequency offset.

Attribute
Attribute Description

Performance event cell PTP_DA

Unit ns

Impact on System
If the frequency offset exceeds the acceptable range, clock signals deteriorate.

Related Alarms
If the frequency offset exceeds the acceptable range, the SYN_BAD alarm is reported.

B.3.16 MAXMEANPATHDELAY, MINMEANPATHDELAY, and


AVGMEANPATHDELAY

Description
l MAXMEANPATHDELAY indicates the maximum path delay between the master and
slave clocks.
l MINMEANPATHDELAY indicates the minimum path delay between the master and slave
clocks.
l AVGMEANPATHDELAY indicates the average path delay between the master and slave
clocks.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 829


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Attribute
Attribute Description

Performance event cell MAXMEANPATHDELAY


(MAXMEANPATHDELAY)
MINMEANPATHDELAY
(MINMEANPATHDELAY)
AVGMEANPATHDELAY
(AVGMEANPATHDELAY)

Unit ns

Impact on System
The deviation between the maximum and minimum path delays indicates the delay and jitter. If
the deviation exceeds the acceptable range, clock performance will be affected.

Related Alarms
None.

B.3.17 MAXPHASEOFFSET, MINPHASEOFFSET, and


AVGPHASEOFFSET

Description
l MAXPHASEOFFSET indicates the maximum time deviation between the master and slave
clocks.
l MINPHASEOFFSET indicates the minimum time deviation between the master and slave
clocks.
l AVGPHASEOFFSET indicates the average time deviation between the master and slave
clocks.

Attribute
Attribute Description

Performance event cell MAXPHASEOFFSET


(MAXPHASEOFFSET),
MINPHASEOFFSET
(MINPHASEOFFSET),
AVGPHASEOFFSET
(AVGPHASEOFFSET)

Unit ns

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 830


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Impact on System
This performance indicates the time deviation between the local and upstream NEs. If the time
deviation exceeds the acceptable range (greater than 100 ns), the time of the upstream NE cannot
be locked, and NE time synchronization fails.

Related Alarms
When the time deviation between the master and slave clocks is greater than 100 ns, the
TIME_LOCK_FAIL alarm is reported.

B.3.18 MAXPOSITIVEDELAY, MINPOSITIVEDELAY, and


AVGPOSITIVEDELAY

Description
l MAXPOSITIVEDELAY indicates the maximum positive delay between the master and
slave clocks.
l MINPOSITIVEDELAY indicates the minimum positive delay between the master and
slave clocks.
l AVGPOSITIVEDELAY indicates the average positive delay between the master and slave
clocks.

Attribute
Attribute Description

Performance event cell PTP_PTD

Unit ns

Impact on System
The deviation between the maximum and minimum positive delays indicates the delay and jitter.
If the deviation exceeds the acceptable range, clock performance will be affected.

Related Alarms
None.

B.3.19 MPLS_PW_LS, MPLS_PW_SLS, MPLS_PW_CSLS, and


MPLS_PW_UAS

Description
l MPLS_PW_LS indicates the packet loss seconds of the PW service.
l MPLS_PW_SLS indicates the severe packet loss seconds of the PW service.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 831


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

l MPLS_PW_CSLS indicates the consecutive severe packet loss seconds of the PW service.
l MPLS_PW_UAS indicates the unavailable seconds of the PW service.

Attribute
Attribute Description

Performance event cell MPLS_PW_FL

Unit s

Impact on System
The greater of the seconds of packets that are lost in one measurement period (for example, 15
minutes or 24 hours), the more packets are lost. Then, the QoS will be affected.

Procedure
Check the bandwidth utilization. If the bandwidth utilization equals to or exceeds the specified
bandwidth threshold, expand the network.

B.3.20 MSBBE, MSES, MSSES, MSCSES, and MSUAS

Description
l MSBBE indicates the multiplex section background block error.
BBE refers to the errored blocks excluding the errored blocks in the unavailable and
severely errored seconds.
l MSES indicates the multiplex section errored second.
ES refers to a second in which one or more errored blocks are detected.
l MSSES indicates the multiplex section severely errored second.
SES refers to a second in which 15% or more than 15% errored blocks exist or at least one
SDP exists. SDP is the period in which the BER of all the consecutive blocks in a period
of less than four consecutive blocks or 1 ms (the longer period is applied) is equal to or
higher than 10-2 or the signal is lost.
l MSCSES indicates the multiplex section consecutive severely errored second.
CSES refers to a second in which the SES occurs continuously for less than 10 seconds.
l MSUAS indicates the multiplex section unavailable second.
The unavailable time begins at the onset of 10 consecutive SESs, with the 10 SESs included.
When SESs disappear for 10 consecutive seconds, the available time begins from the
eleventh second, with the previous 10 seconds included.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 832


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Attribute
Attribute Description

Performance event cell B2CNT

Unit Block (MSBBE)


Second (MSES, MSSES, MSCSES, and
MSUAS)

Impact on System
Excessive bit errors interrupt the service (the BER should be less than 10-3 for the voice service,
and 10-6 for the data service).

Related Alarms
When the MSBBE, MSES, MSSES, MSCSES, or MSUAS performance event crosses the preset
threshold, the MS_CROSSTR alarm is reported.

Performance Event Default 15-Minute Default 24-Hour


Threshold Threshold

MSBBE 1500 15000

MSES 50 100

MSES 20 50

MSUAS 20 50

MSCSES 4 (number of consecutive SESs)

Possible Causes
The system detects multiplex section bit errors through the B2 byte.

Procedure
Step 1 See 5.4 Troubleshooting Bit Errors in TDM Services for handling.

Step 2 When an MSUAS performance event is reported, check whether cross-connections are
configured and whether fibers are properly connected at service ports. If cross-connections are
not configured, configure cross-connections again according to planning information; if fibers
are incorrectly connected, connect the fibers again according to planning information.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 833


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

B.3.21 MSFEBBE, MSFEES, MSFESES, MSFECSES, and MSFEUAS

Description
l MSFEBBE indicates the multiplex section far end background block error.
Far end background block error (FEBBE) indicates that the BBE occurs at the opposite
end.
l MSFEES indicates the multiplex section far end errored second.
Far end errored second (FEES) indicates that the ES occurs at the opposite end.
l MSFESES indicates the multiplex section far end severely errored second.
Far end severely errored second (FESES) indicates that the SES occurs at the opposite end.
l MSFECSES indicates the multiplex section far end consecutive severely errored second.
Far end consecutive severely errored second (FECSES) indicates that the CSES occurs at
the opposite end.
l MSFEUAS indicates the multiplex section far end unavailable second.
Far end unavailable second (FEUAS) indicates that the UAS occurs at the opposite end.

Attribute
Attribute Description

Performance event cell LFEBE

Unit Block (MSFEBBE)


Second (MSFEES, MSFESES, MSFECSES,
and MSFEUAS)

Impact on the System


Excessive bit errors interrupt the service (the BER should be less than 10-3 for the voice service,
and 10-6 for the data service).

Related Alarms
The MS_REI alarm is reported at the local end.

Possible Causes
The system detects multiplex section far end bit errors through the M1 byte.

Procedure
Step 1 Clear the corresponding performance event at the opposite end.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 834


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

B.3.22 OSPITMPMAX, OSPITMPMIN, and OSPITMPCUR

Description
l OSPITMPMAX indicates the maximum temperature of a laser core.
l OSPITMPMIN indicates the minimum temperature of a laser core.
l OSPITMPCUR indicates the current temperature of a laser core.

Attribute
Attribute Description

Performance event cell TMP

Unit C

Impact on System
If the temperature of a laser core is very high or very low, the performance of the laser degrades,
and bit errors or other faults occur.

Relevant Alarms
None.

B.3.23 PG_IF_BBE, PG_IF_ES, PG_IF_SES, PG_IF_CSES, and


PG_IF_UAS

Description
l PG_IF_BBE indicates the protection group background block error.
Background block error (BBE) refers to the errored blocks excluding the errored blocks in
the unavailable and severely errored seconds.
l PG_IF_ES indicates the protection group errored second.
Errored second (ES) refers to a second in which one or more errored blocks are detected.
l PG_IF_SES indicates the protection group severely errored second.
Severely errored second (SES) refers to a second in which 30% or more than 30% errored
blocks exist or at least one severely disturbed period (SDP) exists. SDP is the period in
which the BER of all the consecutive blocks in a period of less than four consecutive blocks
or 1 ms (the longer period is applied) is equal to or higher than 10-2 or the signal is lost.
l PG_IF_CSES indicates the protection group consecutive severely errored second.
Consecutive severely errored second (CSES) refers to a second in which the SES occurs
continuously for less than 10 seconds.
l PG_IF_UAS indicates the protection group unavailable second.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 835


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

The unavailable time begins at the onset of 10 consecutive SESs, with the 10 SESs included.
When SESs disappear for 10 consecutive seconds, the available time begins from the
eleventh second, with the previous 10 seconds included.

Attribute
Attribute Description

Performance event cell IF_BIP8

Unit Block (PG_IF_BBE)


Second (PG_IF_ES, PG_IF_SES,
PG_IF_CSES, and PG_IF_UAS)

Impact on System
Excessive bit errors interrupt the service (the BER should be less than -3 for the voice service,
and 10-6 for the data service).

Related Alarms
None.

Performance Event Default 15-Minute Default 24-Hour


Threshold Threshold

PG_IF_BBE 1500 15000

PG_IF_ES 50 100

PG_IF_SES 20 50

PG_IF_UAS 20 50

PG_IF_CSES 4 (number of consecutive SESs)

Possible Causes
The system detects the protection group bit errors.

Related Alarms
PG_LINK_FAIL, PG_PRT_DEGRADED

Procedure
Step 1 See PG_LINK_FAIL, PG_PRT_DEGRADED.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 836


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

B.3.24 RPLMAX, RPLMIN, and RPLCUR

Description
l RPLMAX indicates the maximum receive optical power at an optical interface.
l RPLMIN indicates the minimum receive optical power at an optical interface.
l RPLCUR indicates the current receive optical power at an optical interface.

Attribute
Attribute Description

Performance event cell IPM

Unit 0.1dBm

Impact on System
In normal cases, the receive optical power should be 3 dB higher than the receiver sensitivity,
and 5 dB lower than the overload power.

If the receive optical power is very low or very high, bit errors occur and even services are
interrupted.

Related Alarms
l If the transmit optical power is lower than the receiver sensitivity, the IN_PWR_LOW
alarm is reported.
l If the receive optical power is higher than the overload power, the IN_PWR_HIGH alarm
is reported.

B.3.25 RSBBE, RSES, RSSES, RSCSES, and RSUAS

Description
l RSBBE indicates the regenerator section background block error.
Background block error (BBE) refers to the errored blocks excluding the errored blocks in
the unavailable and severely errored seconds.
l RSES indicates the regenerator section errored second.
Errored second (ES) refers to a second in which one or more errored blocks are detected.
l RSSES indicates the regenerator section severely errored second.
Severely errored second (SES) refers to a second in which 30% or more than 30% errored
blocks exist or at least one severely disturbed period (SDP) exists. SDP is the period in
which the BER of all the consecutive blocks in a period of less than four consecutive blocks
or 1 ms (the longer period is applied) is equal to or higher than 10-2 or the signal is lost.
l RSCSES indicates the regenerator section consecutive severely errored second.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 837


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Consecutive severely errored second (CSES) refers to a second in which the SES occurs
continuously for less than 10 seconds.
l RSUAS indicates the regenerator section unavailable second.
The unavailable time begins at the onset of 10 consecutive SESs, with the 10 SESs included.
When SESs disappear for 10 consecutive seconds, the available time begins from the
eleventh second, with the previous 10 seconds included.
NOTE

When the IF board works in PDH mode, these performance events may also be reported. These events are
detected through the self-defined overhead byte B1 in the PDH radio frame.

Attribute
Attribute Description

Performance event cell B1CNT

Unit Block (RSBBE)


Second (RSES, RSSES, RSCSES, and
RSUAS)

Impact on System
Excessive bit errors interrupt the service (the BER should be less than 10-3 for the voice service,
and 10-6 for the data service).

Related Alarms
When the RSBBE, RSES, RSSES, RSCSES, or RSUAS performance event crosses the preset
threshold, the RS_CROSSTR alarm is reported.

Performance Event Default 15-Minute Default 24-Hour


Threshold Threshold

RSBBE 1500 15000

RSES 50 100

RSSES 20 50

RSUAS 20 50

RSCSES 4 (number of consecutive SESs)

Possible Causes
The system detects the regenerator section bit errors through the B1 byte.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 838


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Procedure
Step 1 See 5.4 Troubleshooting Bit Errors in TDM Services for handling.

Step 2 When an RSUAS performance event is reported, check whether cross-connections are
configured and whether fibers are properly connected at service ports. If cross-connections are
not configured, configure cross-connections again according to planning information; if fibers
are incorrectly connected, connect the fibers again according to planning information.

----End

B.3.26 RSL_MAX, RSL_MIN, RSL_CUR, and RSL_AVG

Description
l RSL_MAX indicates the maximum radio received signal level.
l RSL_MIN indicates the minimum radio received signal level.
l RSL_CUR indicates the current radio received signal level.
l RSL_AVG indicates the average radio received signal level.

Attribute
Attribute Description

Performance event cell RSL

Unit 0.1dBm

Impact on System
When the radio received signal level is very low or very high, bit errors occur and even services
are interrupted.

Related Alarms
If the radio received signal level crosses the specific threshold, the RADIO_RSL_HIGH or
RADIO_RSL_LOW alarm is reported.

B.3.27 RSOOF and RSOFS

Description
l RSOOF indicates the regenerator section out of frame.
The out-of-frame (OOF) block refers to a data block in which incorrect A1 and A2 bytes
are detected.
l RSOFS indicates the regenerator section out-of-frame second.
The out-of-frame second (OFS) refers to a second in which one or more OOF blocks are
detected.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 839


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Attribute
Attribute Description

Performance event cell OOF

Unit Block (RSOOF)


Second (RSOFS)

Impact on System
The system discards OOF data blocks. Therefore, an RSOOF event is equivalent to a big error
(if one RSOOF exists in a second, the BER is not less than 1.25 x 10-5).

Related Alarms
If RSOOF is received in five consecutive frames, the equipment changes to the OOF state. If
the OOF state lasts for 3 ms, the R_LOF alarm is reported and all the services are interrupted.

Possible Causes
The system detects incorrect A1 and A2 bytes.

Procedure
Step 1 If the R_LOF alarm, as well as the performance event, is reported, eliminate the errors according
to the alarm. Otherwise, see 5.4 Troubleshooting Bit Errors in TDM Services for handling.

----End

B.3.28 QPSKWS, QPSK_S_WS, QAMWS16, QAM_S_WS16,


QAMWS32, QAMWS64, QAMWS128, QAMWS256, QAMWS512,
QAM_L_WS512, QAMWS1024, and QAM_L_WS1024

Description
l QPSKWS indicates the working duration of the QPSK mode.
l QPSK_S_WS indicates the working duration of the QPSKWS Strong mode.
l QAMWS16 indicates the working duration of the 16QAM mode.
l QAM_S_WS16 indicates the working duration of the 16QAM Strong mode.
l QAMWS32 indicates the working duration of the 32QAM mode.
l QAMWS64 indicates the working duration of the 64QAM mode.
l QAMWS128 indicates the working duration of the 128QAM mode.
l QAMWS256 indicates the working duration of the 256QAM mode.
l QAMWS512 indicates the working duration of the 512QAM mode.
l QAM_L_WS512 indicates the working duration of the 512QAM Light mode.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 840


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

l QAMWS1024 indicates the working duration of the 1024QAM mode.


l QAM_L_WS1024 indicates the working duration of the 1024QAM Light mode.

Attribute
Attribute Description

Performance event cell QPSKWSSECOND (QPSK)


QPSK_S_WSSECOND (QPSK Strong)
QAMWS16SECOND (16QAM)
QAM_S_WS16SECOND (16QAM Strong)
QAMWS32SECOND (32QAM)
QAMWS64SECOND (64QAM)
QAMWS128SECOND (128QAM)
QAMWS256SECOND (256QAM)
QAMWS512SECOND (512QAM)
QAM_L_WS512SECOND (512QAM
Light)
QAMWS1024SECOND (1024QAM)
QAM_L_WS1024SECOND (1024QAM
Light)

Unit Second

Impact on System
When the AM function is disabled, the performance event does not affect the system.

When the AM function is enabled, in normal cases, the seconds of the modulation scheme for
maximum capacity should account for a larger percentage. In the duration set for good weather,
if the seconds of the low-efficiency modulation scheme account for a larger percentage, the
performance of the radio link is abnormal.

Related Alarms
None.

B.3.29 TLBMAX, TLBMIN, and TLBCUR

Description
l TLBMAX indicates the maximum transmit bias current of the laser.
l TLBMIN indicates the minimum transmit bias current of the laser.
l TLBCUR indicates the current transmit bias current of the laser.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 841


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Attribute
Attribute Description

Performance event cell LSBCM

Unit 0.1 mA

Impact on System
If the bias current of the laser is over-high or over-low, the laser is damaged.

Related Alarms
If the receive optical power on the opposite NE is abnormal, the IN_PWR_ABN alarm is
reported.

B.3.30 RLHTT, RLLTT, TLHTT, TLLTT

Description
l The RLHTT indicates the duration when the ODU at the local end has a receive power
lower than the upper threshold.
l The RLLTT indicates the duration when the ODU at the local end has a receive power
lower than the lower threshold.
l The TLHTT indicates the duration when the ODU at the local end has a transit power higher
than the upper threshold.
l The TLLTT indicates the duration when the ODU at the local end has a transit power higher
than the lower threshold.

Attribute
Attribute Description

Performance event cell RLHTS(RLHTT), RLLTS(RLLTT), TLHTS


(TLHTT), and TLLTS(TLLTT)

Unit Second

Impact on System
None.

Related Alarms
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 842


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

B.3.31 TPLMAX, TPLMIN, and TPLCUR


Description
l TPLMAX indicates the maximum transmit optical power at an optical interface.
l TPLMIN indicates the minimum transmit optical power at an optical interface.
l TPLCUR indicates the current transmit optical power at an optical interface.

Attribute
Attribute Description

Performance event cell OPM

Unit 0.1dBm

Impact on System
In normal cases, the receive optical power should be 3 dB higher than the receiver sensitivity,
and 5 dB lower than the overload power.
If the transmit optical power is very low or very high, the receive optical power at the opposite
site is accordingly very low or very high. As a result, bit errors occur and even services are
interrupted.

Related Alarms
l If the transmit optical power at the opposite site is lower than the receiver sensitivity, the
IN_PWR_LOW alarm is reported.
l If the receive optical power at the opposite site is higher than the overload power, the
IN_PWR_HIGH alarm is reported.

B.3.32 TSL_MAX, TSL_MIN, TSL_CUR, and TSL_AVG


Description
l TSL_MAX indicates the maximum radio transmitted signal level.
l TSL_MIN indicates the minimum radio transmitted signal level.
l TSL_CUR indicates the current radio transmitted signal level.
l TSL_AVG indicates the average radio transmitted signal level.

Attribute
Attribute Description

Performance event cell TSL

Unit 0.1dBm

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 843


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Impact on System
When the radio transmitted signal level is very low or very high, the radio received signal level
at the opposite site is very low or very high. As a result, bit errors occur and even services are
interrupted.

Related Alarms
If the radio transmitted signal level is not within the range supported by the ODU, the
RADIO_TSL_HIGH or RADIO_TSL_LOW alarm is reported.

B.3.33 TUPJCHIGH, TUPJCLOW, and TUPJCNEW

Description
l TUPJCHIGH indicates the count of positive TU pointer justifications.
l TUPJCLOW indicates the count of negative TU pointer justifications.
l TUPJCNEW indicates the count of new TU pointer justifications.

Attribute
Attribute Description

Performance event cell TUPPJE (TUPJCHIGH)


TUNPJE (TUPJCLOW)
TUNDF (TUPJCNEW)

Unit Block

Impact on System
Less than six TUPJCHIGH and TUPJCLOW events on each port do not affect the system. If the
pointer is justified for many times, or the TUPJCNEW event occurs, bit errors may occur in the
service.

Related Alarms
When the TUPJCHIGH, TUPJCLOW, or TUPJCNEW performance event crosses the preset
threshold, the HPAD_CROSSTR alarm is reported.

Performance Event Default 15-Minute Default 24-Hour


Threshold Threshold

TUPJCHIGH 1500 30000

TUPJCLOW 1500 30000

TUPJCNEW 1500 30000

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 844


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide B Performance Event Reference

Possible Causes
The NE clock is out-of-synchronization.

Procedure
Step 1 See 5.5 Troubleshooting Pointer Justifications for handling.

----End

B.3.34 XPIC_XPD_VALUE

Description
The XPIC_XPD_VALUE indicates the XPD value after the XPIC function is enabled.

Attribute
Attribute Description

Performance event cell XPD

Unit dB

Impact on System
l When the XPIC function is disabled, the performance event does not affect the system.
l When the XPIC function is enabled, a greater XPD value indicates less interference between
H and V polarization directions and better signaling environment; a smaller XPD value
indicates more interference and worse signaling environment. If the XPD value is smaller
than a specific threshold, errors and even interruptions occur on the radio link.

Related Alarms
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 845


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

C RMON Event Reference

RMON events reflect the running of the Ethernet services. This chapter describes the possible
RMON events on the OptiX RTN 980 and how to handle these events.

C.1 List of RMON Alarm Entries


The RMON alarm entries refer to the table entries in the RMON alarm group.

C.2 RMON Performance Entries List on the Packet-Plane


This section lists RMON performance entries on the packet plane by logical board.

C.3 RMON Performance Entries List on the EoS/EoPDH-Plane


This section lists RMON performance entries on the EoS/EoPDH plane by board type.

C.4 RMON Events and Handling Procedures


This chapter describes the RMON events that indicate Ethernet service abnormalities and how
to handle these events.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 846


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

C.1 List of RMON Alarm Entries


The RMON alarm entries refer to the table entries in the RMON alarm group.

Table C-1 List of RMON alarm entries

Alarm Description Remarks Source


Name

ETHDR The number of packet ETHDROP indicates the ISU2, ISX2, IFU2, IFX2,
OP loss events number of packet loss ISV3
events caused by , EG2D, EM6FA,
insufficient Ethernet EM6TA, EG4, EG4P,
chip resources. The EM6T, EM6F
count is not the number
of discarded packets but
the number of times
packet loss is detected.

ETHEX The number of frames Indicates the number of , EG2D, EM6T, EM6F,
CCOL that fail to be transmitted frames that fail to be EM6FA, EM6TA, EG4,
after continuous transmitted due to EG4P
collisions consecutive collisions.

ETHLAT The number of collisions Indicates the number of


ECOL that are detected after a collisions that are
timeslot period elapses detected after a timeslot
period elapses. The late
collisions indicate that
the diameter of a LAN is
too large.

TXDEFF The number of frames Indicates the number of


RM whose transmission is frames whose first
delayed transmission is delayed
because transmission
media are busy,
excluding the number of
frames whose
transmission is delayed
due to collisions.

ETHUN The number of received Undersized packets are


DER undersized packets the packets shorter than
64 bytes (including FCS
bytes but not framing
bits).

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 847


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Alarm Description Remarks Source


Name

ETHOV The number of received Oversized packets are


ER oversized packets the packets larger than
MTU (including FCS
bytes but not framing
bits).

ETHFRG The number of received ETHFRG indicates the


fragmented packets number of received
packets that are shorter
than 64 bytes (including
FCS bytes but not
framing bits) and contain
FCS errors or alignment
errors.

ETHJAB The number of received ETHJAB indicates the


errored oversized number of received
packets packets that are larger
than MTU (including
FCS bytes but not
framing bits) and contain
FCS errors or alignment
errors.

RXBBA The number of bytes in FCS bytes are included ISU2, ISX2, IFU2, IFX2,
D received bad packets but framing bits are ISV3
excluded. , EG2D, EM6FA,
EM6TA, EG4, EG4P,
ETHFCS The number of frames FCS error frames
EM6T, EM6F
that have FCS check exclude oversized
errors frames and undersized
frames.

PORT_R Indicates the bandwidth Bandwidth utilization


X_BW_ utilization at a port in the ratio = (Number of
UTILIZ receive direction. received bytes x 8/
ATION Monitoring period)/
Configured or actual
bandwidth

PORT_T Indicates the bandwidth Bandwidth utilization


X_BW_ utilization at a port in the ratio = (Number of
UTILIZ transmit direction. transmitted bytes x 8/
ATION Monitoring period)/
Configured or actual
bandwidth

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 848


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Table C-2 List of EMS6\EFP8 RMON alarm entries

Alarm Description Remarks Source


Name

ETHDR The number of packet ETHDROP indicates the EMS6, EFP8


OP loss events number of packet loss
events caused by
insufficient Ethernet
chip resources. The
count is not the number
of discarded packets but
the number of times
packet loss is detected.

RXBBA The number of bytes in FCS bytes are included


D received bad packets but framing bits are
excluded.

ETHUN The number of received Undersized packets are


DER undersized packets the packets shorter than
64 bytes (including FCS
bytes but not framing
bits).

ETHOV The number of received Oversized packets are


ER oversized packets the packets larger than
MTU (including FCS
bytes but not framing
bits).

ETHFRG The number of received ETHFRG indicates the


fragmented packets number of received
packets that are shorter
than 64 bytes (including
FCS bytes but not
framing bits) and contain
FCS errors or alignment
errors.

ETHJAB The number of received ETHJAB indicates the


errored oversized number of received
packets packets that are larger
than MTU (including
FCS bytes but not
framing bits) and contain
FCS errors or alignment
errors.

ETHFCS The number of frames FCS error frames


that have FCS check exclude oversized
errors frames and undersized
frames.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 849


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Alarm Description Remarks Source


Name

ETHALI The number of alignment An alignment error


error frames means that the frame
contains a fractional
number of bytes and fails
to pass the FCS check.

C.2 RMON Performance Entries List on the Packet-Plane


This section lists RMON performance entries on the packet plane by logical board.

C.2.1 EM6F/EM6T/EM6FA/EM6TA/EG4/EG4P/EG2D
The RMON performance that the EM6F/EM6T/EM6FA/EM6TA/EG4/EG4P/EG2D board
supports includes basic performance, extended performance, port traffic classification
performance, port priority performance, and Port DS domain performance.

Table C-3 Packet-plane RMON performance entry list (EM6F/EM6T/EM6FA/EM6TA/EG4/EG4P/EG2D)

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

Basic Indicates the packets Bad packets, broadcast packets, and


performanc RXPKTS received (packets). multicast packets are included.
e
ETHDROP Indicates the packet loss ETHDROP indicates the number of
events (times). packet loss events caused by insufficient
Ethernet chip resources. The count is not
the number of discarded packets but the
number of times packet loss is detected.

RXOCTETS Indicates the bytes RXOCTETS indicates the total number


received (bytes). of bytes in received packets (including
bad packets), including framing bits but
not FCS bytes.
NOTE
If the packets received by an EM6T/EM6F
board are larger than MTU, byte count is
calculated based on the MTU.
If the packets received by an EG4/EG4P/
EM6FA/EM6TA/EG2D board are larger than
the MTU, byte count is calculated based on
actual packet size.

RXMULCAST Indicates the multicast RXMULCAST indicates the total


packets received number of received good packets with
(packets). multicast destination addresses,
excluding broadcast packets.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 850


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

RXBRDCAST Indicates the broadcast RXMULCAST indicates the total


packets received number of received good packets with
(packets). multicast destination addresses,
excluding broadcast packets.

ETHOVER Indicates the oversized Oversized packets are the packets larger
packets received than MTU (including FCS bytes but not
(packets). framing bits).
NOTE
For EG4/EG4P boards, an oversized packet
is larger than 1518 bytes.
For other boards, an oversized packet is larger
than the MTU.

ETHJAB Indicates the oversized ETHJAB indicates the number of


error packets received received packets that are larger than
(packets). MTU (including FCS bytes but not
framing bits) and contain FCS errors or
alignment errors.
NOTE
For EG4/EG4P boards, an oversized error
packet is larger than 1518 bytes.
For other boards, an oversized error packet is
larger than the MTU.

ETHUNDER Indicates the undersized Undersized packets are the packets


packets received shorter than 64 bytes (including FCS
(packets). bytes but not framing bits).

ETHFRG Indicates the fragments ETHFRG indicates the number of


received (packets). received packets that are shorter than 64
bytes (including FCS bytes but not
framing bits) and contain FCS errors or
alignment errors. Increase of the count is
normal because noise collisions exist.

ETHCOL Indicates the collisions -


(times).

PORT_RX_BW_UTI- Indicates the bandwidth Bandwidth utilization = (Number of


LIZATION utilization on a port in the received bytes x 8/Monitoring period)/
receive direction. Configured or actual bandwidth

PORT_TX_BW_UTI- Indicates the bandwidth Bandwidth utilization = (Number of


LIZATION utilization on a port in the transmitted bytes x 8/Monitoring
transmit direction. period)/Configured or actual bandwidth

Extended TXPKTS Indicates the packets Bad packets, broadcast packets, and
performanc transmitted (packets). multicast packets are included.
e

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 851


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

TXOCTETS Indicates the bytes Indicates the total number of bytes in


transmitted transmitted packets (including bad
packets), including framing bits but not
FCS bytes.

ETHFCS Indicates the FCS errored Indicates the number of received frames
frames (frames). that are an integral number of octets in
length but do not pass the FCS check.
NOTE
For EG4/EG4P boards, this count includes
undersized frames and oversized frames.
For other boards, this count does not include
undersized frames and oversized frames.

RXBGOOD Indicates the bytes in FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
received good packets are excluded.
(bytes).

TXBGOOD Indicates the bytes in FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
transmitted good packets are excluded.
(bytes).

RXBBAD Indicates the bytes in FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
received bad packets are excluded.
(bytes).

TXUNICAST Indicates the unicast The unicast packets that are discarded or
packets transmitted fail to be transmitted are included.
(packets).

RXUNICAST Indicates the unicast RXUNICAST indicates the number of


packets received good unicast packets.
(packets).

TXMULCAST Indicates the multicast The multicast packets that are discarded
packets transmitted or fail to be transmitted are included.
(packets).

TXBRDCAST Indicates the broadcast The broadcast packets that are discarded
packets transmitted or fail to be transmitted are included.
(packets).

RXGOODFULLFRAME Indicates the rate of good Framing bits (20 bytes) and FCS bytes
SPEED full-frame bytes received are included.
(kbit/s).

TXGOODFULLFRAME Indicates the rate of good Framing bits (20 bytes) and FCS bytes
SPEED full-frame bytes are included.
transmitted (kbit/s).

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 852


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

RXFULLBGOOD Indicates the good full- Framing bits (20 bytes) and FCS bytes
frame bytes received are included.
(bytes).

TXFULLBGOOD Indicates the good full- Framing bits (20 bytes) and FCS bytes
frame bytes transmitted are included.
(bytes).

RXPAUSE Indicates the pause frames RXPAUSE indicates the number of


received (frames). MAC flow control frames with the
PAUSE opcode.

TXPAUSE Indicates the pause frames TXPAUSE indicates the number of


transmitted (frames). MAC flow control frames with the
PAUSE opcode.

ETHLATECOL Indicates the late Indicates the number of collisions that are
collisions (times). detected after a timeslot period elapses.
The late collisions indicate that the
diameter of a LAN is too large.

ETHEXCCOL Indicates the frames -


unsuccessfully
transmitted after
consecutive collisions
(frames).

TXDEFFRM Indicates the frames that Indicates the number of frames whose
are deferred in first transmission is delayed because
transmission (frames). transmission media are busy, excluding
the number of frames whose
transmission is delayed due to collisions.

RX_DROP_RATIO Packet loss rate in the The discarded packets ratio in the ingress
ingress direction direction, that is, number of actually drop
packets/ received packets.

TX_DROP_RATIO Packet loss rate in the The discarded packets ratio in the ingress
egress direction direction, that is, number of actually drop
packets/ transmitted packets.

ETH_RX_THROUGHP Indicates the maximum Maximum throughput = Number of


UT_MAX throughput on a port in the received bytes (including inter-frame
receive direction. gaps and preambles)/Monitoring period

ETH_RX_THROUGHP Indicates the minimum Minimum throughput = Number of


UT_MIN throughput on a port in the received bytes (including inter-frame
receive direction. gaps and preambles)/Monitoring period

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 853


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

ETH_RX_THROUGHP Indicates the average Average throughput = Number of


UT_AVG throughput on a port in the received bytes (including inter-frame
receive direction. gaps and preambles)/Monitoring period

RXBPS Indicates the bit rate in the Bit rate in the receive direction = Number
receive direction of an of received bytes x 8/Monitoring period
Ethernet port.

TXBPS Indicates the bit rate in the Bit rate in the transmit direction =
transmit direction of an Number of transmitted bytes x 8/
Ethernet port. Monitoring period

RXPPS Indicates the packet rate Packet rate in the receive direction =
(packets/second) in the Number of received packets/Monitoring
receive direction of an period
Ethernet port.

TXPPS Indicates the packet rate Packet rate in the transmit direction =
(packets/second) in the Number of transmitted packets/
transmit direction of an Monitoring period
Ethernet port.

Port traffic QOS_PORTCAR_Mar- Indicates the number of -


classificati kedRedPKTS red packets after traffic
on monitoring is enabled.
performanc
e QOS_PORTCAR_Mar- Indicates the number of -
kedYellowPKTS yellow packets after traffic
monitoring is enabled.

QOS_PORTCAR_Mar- Indicates the number of -


kedGreenPKTS green packets after traffic
monitoring is enabled.

QOS_PORTSTRM_RCV Indicates the number of -


MATCHPKTS packets received in the
matched flow.

QOS_PORTSTRM_SND Indicates the number of -


MATCHPKTS packets transmitted in the
matched flow.

PORTSTRM_SHAPING Indicates the number of -


_DROPPKTS packets discarded due to
network congestion when
the traffic shaping
function is enabled in the
egress direction.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 854


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

PORTSTRM_SHAPING Indicates the ratio of Packet loss rate in the egress direction =
_DROPRATIO packet loss due to network Number of discarded packets in the
congestion when the egress direction/Number of packets
traffic shaping function is matching the traffic classification rule in
enabled in the egress the egress direction
direction.

QOS_PORTCAR_Mar- Indicates the proportion of Proportion of packets marked in red in


kedRedRATIO packets marked in red the ingress direction = Number of packets
when the traffic policing marked in red in the ingress direction/
function is enabled. Number of packets matching the traffic
classification rule in the ingress direction

QOS_PORTSTRM_RX_ Indicates the packet rate Packet rate in the receive direction =
PPS (packets/s) in the receive Number of received packets/Monitoring
direction of a matched period
flow.

QOS_PORTSTRM_TX_ Indicates the packet rate Packet rate in the transmit direction =
PPS (packets/s) in the transmit Number of transmitted packets/
direction of a matched Monitoring period
flow.

QOS_PORTSTRM_RCV Indicates the number of -


MATCHBYTESa bytes in the received
packets of a matched flow.

QOS_PORTSTRM_SND Indicates the number of -


MATCHBYTESa bytes in the transmitted
packets of a matched flow.

QOS_PORTSTRM_RX_ Indicates the bit rate in the Bit rate in the receive direction = Number
BPSa receive direction of a of received bytes x 8/Monitoring period
matched flow.

QOS_PORTSTRM_TX_ Indicates the bit rate in the Bit rate in the transmit direction =
BPSa transmit direction of a Number of received bytes x 8/
matched flow. Monitoring period

Port QOS_PORTQUEUE_DR Indicates the ratio of Packet loss rate in an egress queue =
priority OPRATIO packet loss due to Number of discarded packets with a
performanc congestion in egress priority in the egress queue/Number of
e queues with different packets with the priority in the egress
priorities. queue

QOS_PRI_DROPPKTS Indicates the number of -


packets discarded in the
services with different
priorities.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 855


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

QOS_PRI_DROPBYTES Indicates the number of -


bytes discarded in the
services with different
priorities.

PORT_PRI_SNDPKTS Indicates the number of -


packets transmitted in
egress queues with
different priorities.

PORT_PRI_SNDBYTES Indicates the number of -


bytes in the packets
transmitted in egress
queues with different
priorities.

PORT_PRI_TX_BPS Indicates the bit rates of Bit rate = Number of transmitted bytes x
egress queues with 8/Monitoring period
different priorities in the
transmit direction.

PORT_PRI_TX_PPS Indicates the packet rate Packet rate = Number of transmitted


(packets/second) of egress packets/Monitoring period
queues with different
priorities in the transmit
direction.

Port DS DS_CVLANPRI_PKTS Indicates the number of -


domain packets with matched C-
performanc VLAN priorities in the DS
e domain

DS_CVLANPRI_BYTES Indicates the number of -


bytes in the packets with
matched C-VLAN
priorities in the DS
domain.

DS_SVLANPRI_PKTS Indicates the number of -


packets with matched S-
VLAN priorities in the DS
domain.

DS_SVLANPRI_BYTES Indicates the number of -


bytes in the packets with
matched S-VLAN
priorities in the DS
domain.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 856


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

DS_DSCP_PKTS Indicates the number of -


packets with matched IP
DSCP priorities in the DS
domain.

DS_DSCP_BYTES Indicates the number of -


bytes in the packets with
matched IP DSCP
priorities in the DS
domain.

NOTE

a: The EG2D board does not support RMON performance statistics.


Ports whose Port Mode is Layer 3 do not support RMON performance events of traffic classifications or
port DS domains.

C.2.2 IFU2/IFX2
The RMON performance that the IFU2/IFX2 board supported include basic performance,
extended performance, port traffic classification performance, port priority performance, and
Port DS domain performance.

Table C-4 Packet-Plane RMON Performance Entry List (IFU2/IFX2)

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

Basic Indicates the packets Bad packets, broadcast packets, and


performanc RXPKTS received (packets). multicast packets are included.
e
ETHDROP Indicates the packet loss ETHDROP indicates the number of
events (times). packet loss events caused by insufficient
Ethernet chip resources. The count is not
the number of discarded packets but the
number of times packet loss is detected.

RXOCTETS Indicates the bytes RXOCTETS indicates the total number


received (bytes). of bytes in received packets (including
bad packets), including framing bits but
not FCS bytes.
NOTE
If the packets received by an IFU2/IFX2
board are larger than the MTU, byte count is
calculated based on MTU.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 857


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

RXMULCAST Indicates the multicast RXMULCAST indicates the total


packets received number of received good packets with
(packets). multicast destination addresses,
excluding broadcast packets.

RXBRDCAST Indicates the broadcast RXMULCAST indicates the total


packets received number of received good packets with
(packets). multicast destination addresses,
excluding broadcast packets.

PORT_RX_BW_UTI- Indicates the bandwidth Bandwidth utilization = (Number of


LIZATION utilization on a port in the received bytes x 8/Monitoring period)/
receive direction. Configured or actual bandwidth

PORT_TX_BW_UTI- Indicates the bandwidth Bandwidth utilization = (Number of


LIZATION utilization on a port in the transmitted bytes x 8/Monitoring
transmit direction. period)/Configured or actual bandwidth

Extended TXPKTS Indicates the packets Bad packets, broadcast packets, and
performanc transmitted (packets). multicast packets are included.
e
TXOCTETS Indicates the bytes Indicates the total number of bytes in
transmitted transmitted packets (including bad
packets), including framing bits but not
FCS bytes.

ETHFCS Indicates the FCS errored Indicates the number of received frames
frames (frames). that are an integral number of octets in
length but do not pass the FCS check.
NOTE
For the IFU2/IFX2 board, this count does not
include undersized frames and oversized
frames.

RXBGOOD Indicates the bytes in FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
received good packets are excluded.
(bytes).

TXBGOOD Indicates the bytes in FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
transmitted good packets are excluded.
(bytes).

RXBBAD Indicates the bytes in FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
received bad packets are excluded.
(bytes).

TXUNICAST Indicates the unicast The unicast packets that are discarded or
packets transmitted fail to be transmitted are included.
(packets).

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 858


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

RXUNICAST Indicates the unicast RXUNICAST indicates the number of


packets received good unicast packets.
(packets).

TXMULCAST Indicates the multicast The multicast packets that are discarded
packets transmitted or fail to be transmitted are included.
(packets).

TXBRDCAST Indicates the broadcast The broadcast packets that are discarded
packets transmitted or fail to be transmitted are included.
(packets).

RXGOODFULLFRAME Indicates the rate of good Framing bits (20 bytes) and FCS bytes
SPEED full-frame bytes received are included.
(kbit/s).

TXGOODFULLFRAME Indicates the rate of good Framing bits (20 bytes) and FCS bytes
SPEED full-frame bytes are included.
transmitted (kbit/s).

RXFULLBGOOD Indicates the good full- Framing bits (20 bytes) and FCS bytes
frame bytes received are included.
(bytes).

TXFULLBGOOD Indicates the good full- Framing bits (20 bytes) and FCS bytes
frame bytes transmitted are included.
(bytes).

RX_DROP_RATIO Packet loss rate in the The discarded packets ratio in the ingress
ingress direction direction, that is, number of actually drop
packets/ received packets.

TX_DROP_RATIO Packet loss rate in the The discarded packets ratio in the ingress
egress direction direction, that is, number of actually drop
packets/ transmitted packets.

ETH_RX_THROUGHP Indicates the maximum Maximum throughput = Number of


UT_MAX throughput on a port in the received bytes (including inter-frame
receive direction. gaps and preambles)/Monitoring period

ETH_RX_THROUGHP Indicates the minimum Minimum throughput = Number of


UT_MIN throughput on a port in the received bytes (including inter-frame
receive direction. gaps and preambles)/Monitoring period

ETH_RX_THROUGHP Indicates the average Average throughput = Number of


UT_AVG throughput on a port in the received bytes (including inter-frame
receive direction. gaps and preambles)/Monitoring period

RXBPS Indicates the bit rate in the Bit rate in the receive direction = Number
receive direction of an of received bytes x 8/Monitoring period
Ethernet port.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 859


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

TXBPS Indicates the bit rate in the Bit rate in the transmit direction =
transmit direction of an Number of transmitted bytes x 8/
Ethernet port. Monitoring period

RXPPS Indicates the packet rate Packet rate in the receive direction =
(packets/second) in the Number of received packets/Monitoring
receive direction of an period
Ethernet port.

TXPPS Indicates the packet rate Packet rate in the transmit direction =
(packets/second) in the Number of transmitted packets/
transmit direction of an Monitoring period
Ethernet port.

Port traffic QOS_PORTCAR_Mar- Indicates the number of -


classificati kedRedPKTS red packets after traffic
on monitoring is enabled.

QOS_PORTCAR_Mar- Indicates the number of -


kedYellowPKTS yellow packets after traffic
monitoring is enabled.

QOS_PORTCAR_Mar- Indicates the number of -


kedGreenPKTS green packets after traffic
monitoring is enabled.

QOS_PORTSTRM_RCV Indicates the number of -


MATCHPKTS packets received in the
matched flow.

QOS_PORTSTRM_SND Indicates the number of -


MATCHPKTS packets transmitted in the
matched flow.

PORTSTRM_SHAPING Indicates the number of -


_DROPPKTS packets discarded due to
network congestion when
the traffic shaping
function is enabled in the
egress direction.

PORTSTRM_SHAPING Indicates the ratio of Packet loss rate in the egress direction =
_DROPRATIO packet loss due to network Number of discarded packets in the
congestion when the egress direction/Number of packets
traffic shaping function is matching the traffic classification rule in
enabled in the egress the egress direction
direction.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 860


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

QOS_PORTCAR_Mar- Indicates the proportion of Proportion of packets marked in red in


kedRedRATIO packets marked in red the ingress direction = Number of packets
when the traffic policing marked in red in the ingress direction/
function is enabled. Number of packets matching the traffic
classification rule in the ingress direction

QOS_PORTSTRM_RX_ Indicates the packet rate Packet rate in the receive direction =
PPS (packets/s) in the receive Number of received packets/Monitoring
direction of a matched period
flow.

QOS_PORTSTRM_TX_ Indicates the packet rate Packet rate in the transmit direction =
PPS (packets/s) in the transmit Number of transmitted packets/
direction of a matched Monitoring period
flow.

QOS_PORTSTRM_RCV Indicates the number of -


MATCHBYTES bytes in the received
packets of a matched flow.

QOS_PORTSTRM_SND Indicates the number of -


MATCHBYTES bytes in the transmitted
packets of a matched flow.

QOS_PORTSTRM_RX_ Indicates the bit rate in the Bit rate in the receive direction = Number
BPS receive direction of a of received bytes x 8/Monitoring period
matched flow.

QOS_PORTSTRM_TX_ Indicates the bit rate in the Bit rate in the transmit direction =
BPS transmit direction of a Number of transmitted bytes x 8/
matched flow. Monitoring period

Port QOS_PORTQUEUE_DR Indicates the ratio of Packet loss rate in an egress queue =
priority OPRATIO packet loss due to Number of discarded packets with a
congestion in egress priority in the egress queue/Number of
queues with different packets with the priority in the egress
priorities. queue

QOS_PRI_DROPPKTS Indicates the number of -


packets discarded in the
services with different
priorities.

QOS_PRI_DROPBYTES Indicates the number of -


bytes discarded in the
services with different
priorities.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 861


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

PORT_PRI_SNDPKTS Indicates the number of -


packets transmitted in
egress queues with
different priorities.

PORT_PRI_SNDBYTES Indicates the number of -


bytes in the packets
transmitted in egress
queues with different
priorities.

PORT_PRI_TX_BPS Indicates the bit rates of Bit rate = Number of transmitted bytes x
egress queues with 8/Monitoring period
different priorities in the
transmit direction.

PORT_PRI_TX_PPS Indicates the packet rate Packet rate = Number of transmitted


(packets/second) of egress packets/Monitoring period
queues with different
priorities in the transmit
direction.

Port DS DS_CVLANPRI_PKTS Indicates the number of -


domain packets with matched C-
VLAN priorities in the DS
domain

DS_CVLANPRI_BYTES Indicates the number of -


bytes in the packets with
matched C-VLAN
priorities in the DS
domain.

DS_SVLANPRI_PKTS Indicates the number of -


packets with matched S-
VLAN priorities in the DS
domain.

DS_SVLANPRI_BYTES Indicates the number of -


bytes in the packets with
matched S-VLAN
priorities in the DS
domain.

DS_DSCP_PKTS Indicates the number of -


packets with matched IP
DSCP priorities in the DS
domain.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 862


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

DS_DSCP_BYTES Indicates the number of -


bytes in the packets with
matched IP DSCP
priorities in the DS
domain.

NOTE

l Integrated IP radio ports support this parameter.


l Ports whose Port Mode is Layer 3 do not support RMON performance events of traffic classifications
or port DS domains.

C.2.3 ISU2/ISX2/ISV3
The RMON performance that the ISU2/ISX2/ISV3 board supported include basic performance,
extended performance, port traffic classification performance, port priority performance, and
Port DS domain performance.

Table C-5 Packet-Plane RMON Performance Entry List (ISU2/ISX2/ISV3)

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

Basic RXPKTS Indicates the packets Bad packets, broadcast packets, and
performanc received (packets). multicast packets are included.
e
ETHDROP Indicates the packet loss ETHDROP indicates the number of
events (times). packet loss events caused by insufficient
Ethernet chip resources. The count is not
the number of discarded packets but the
number of times packet loss is detected.
NOTE
For the ISV3 board, ETHDROP counts
packet loss events caused by congestion.
For the ISU2 and ISX2 boards, ETHDROP
counts packet loss events caused by
exceptions or congestion.
For other boards, ETHDROP counts packet
loss events caused by insufficient Ethernet
chip resources, but does not count packet loss
events caused by link congestion and other
reasons.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 863


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

RXOCTETS Indicates the bytes RXOCTETS indicates the total number


received (bytes). of bytes in received packets (including
bad packets), including framing bits but
not FCS bytes.
NOTE
If the packets received by an ISU2/ISX2/
ISV3 board are larger than the MTU, byte
count is calculated based on MTU.

RXMULCAST Indicates the multicast RXMULCAST indicates the total


packets received number of received good packets with
(packets). multicast destination addresses,
excluding broadcast packets.

RXBRDCAST Indicates the broadcast RXMULCAST indicates the total


packets received number of received good packets with
(packets). multicast destination addresses,
excluding broadcast packets.

PORT_RX_BW_UTI- Indicates the bandwidth Bandwidth utilization = (Number of


LIZATION utilization on a port in the received bytes x 8/Monitoring period)/
receive direction. Configured or actual bandwidth

PORT_TX_BW_UTI- Indicates the bandwidth Bandwidth utilization = (Number of


LIZATION utilization on a port in the transmitted bytes x 8/Monitoring
transmit direction. period)/Configured or actual bandwidth

RXPKT64 Packets received (64 bytes FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
in length) (packets) are excluded.

RXPKT65 Packets received (65-127 FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
bytes in length) (packets) are excluded.

RXPKT128 Packets received (128-255 FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
bytes in length) (packets) are excluded.

RXPKT256 Packets received (256-511 FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
bytes in length) (packets) are excluded.

RXPKT512 Packets received FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
(512-1023 bytes in length) are excluded.
(packets)

RXPKT1024 Packets received FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
(1024-1518 bytes in are excluded.
length) (packets)

Extended TXPKTS Indicates the packets Bad packets, broadcast packets, and
performanc transmitted (packets). multicast packets are included.
e

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 864


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

TXOCTETS Indicates the bytes Indicates the total number of bytes in


transmitted transmitted packets (including bad
packets), including framing bits but not
FCS bytes.

ETHFCS Indicates the FCS errored Indicates the number of received frames
frames (frames). that are an integral number of octets in
length but do not pass the FCS check.
NOTE
For the ISU2/ISX2/ISV3 board, this count
does not include undersized frames and
oversized frames.

RXBGOOD Indicates the bytes in FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
received good packets are excluded.
(bytes).

TXBGOOD Indicates the bytes in FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
transmitted good packets are excluded.
(bytes).

RXBBAD Indicates the bytes in FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
received bad packets are excluded.
(bytes).

TXUNICAST Indicates the unicast The unicast packets that are discarded or
packets transmitted fail to be transmitted are included.
(packets).

RXUNICAST Indicates the unicast RXUNICAST indicates the number of


packets received good unicast packets.
(packets).

TXMULCAST Indicates the multicast The multicast packets that are discarded
packets transmitted or fail to be transmitted are included.
(packets).

TXBRDCAST Indicates the broadcast The broadcast packets that are discarded
packets transmitted or fail to be transmitted are included.
(packets).

RXGOODFULLFRAME Indicates the rate of good Framing bits (20 bytes) and FCS bytes
SPEED full-frame bytes received are included.
(kbit/s).

TXGOODFULLFRAME Indicates the rate of good Framing bits (20 bytes) and FCS bytes
SPEED full-frame bytes are included.
transmitted (kbit/s).

RXFULLBGOOD Indicates the good full- Framing bits (20 bytes) and FCS bytes
frame bytes received are included.
(bytes).

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 865


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

TXFULLBGOOD Indicates the good full- Framing bits (20 bytes) and FCS bytes
frame bytes transmitted are included.
(bytes).

RX_DROP_RATIO Packet loss rate in the The discarded packets ratio in the ingress
ingress direction direction, that is, number of actually drop
packets/received packets.

TX_DROP_RATIO Packet loss rate in the The discarded packets ratio in the ingress
egress direction direction, that is, number of actually drop
packets/transmitted packets.

RXPKT1519 Indicates the count of FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
received packets with a are excluded.
length of over 1518 bytes
(errored packets included)

TXPKT64 Indicates the count of FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
transmitted 64-byte are excluded.
packets (errored packets
included)

TXPKT65 Indicates the count of FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
transmitted packets with a are excluded.
length of 65 to 127 bytes
(errored packets included)

TXPKT128 Indicates the count of FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
transmitted packets with a are excluded.
length of 128 to 255 bytes
(errored packets included)

TXPKT256 Indicates the count of FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
transmitted packets with a are excluded.
length of 256 to 511 bytes
(errored packets included)

TXPKT512 Indicates the count of FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
transmitted packets with a are excluded.
length of 512 to 1023
bytes (errored packets
included)

TXPKT1024 Indicates the count of FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
transmitted packets with a are excluded.
length of 1024 to 1518
bytes (errored packets
included)

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 866


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

TXPKT1519 Indicates the count of FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
transmitted packets with a are excluded.
length of over 1518 bytes
(errored packets included)

ETH_RX_THROUGHP Indicates the maximum Maximum throughput = Number of


UT_MAX throughput on a port in the received bytes (including inter-frame
receive direction. gaps and preambles)/Monitoring period

ETH_RX_THROUGHP Indicates the minimum Minimum throughput = Number of


UT_MIN throughput on a port in the received bytes (including inter-frame
receive direction. gaps and preambles)/Monitoring period

ETH_RX_THROUGHP Indicates the average Average throughput = Number of


UT_AVG throughput on a port in the received bytes (including inter-frame
receive direction. gaps and preambles)/Monitoring period

RXBPS Indicates the bit rate in the Bit rate in the receive direction = Number
receive direction of an of received bytes x 8/Monitoring period
Ethernet port.

TXBPS Indicates the bit rate in the Bit rate in the transmit direction =
transmit direction of an Number of transmitted bytes x 8/
Ethernet port. Monitoring period

RXPPS Indicates the packet rate Packet rate in the receive direction =
(packets/second) in the Number of received packets/Monitoring
receive direction of an period
Ethernet port.

TXPPS Indicates the packet rate Packet rate in the transmit direction =
(packets/second) in the Number of transmitted packets/
transmit direction of an Monitoring period
Ethernet port.

Port traffic QOS_PORTCAR_Mar- Indicates the number of -


classificati kedRedPKTS red packets after traffic
on monitoring is enabled.

QOS_PORTCAR_Mar- Indicates the number of -


kedYellowPKTS yellow packets after traffic
monitoring is enabled.

QOS_PORTCAR_Mar- Indicates the number of -


kedGreenPKTS green packets after traffic
monitoring is enabled.

QOS_PORTSTRM_RCV Indicates the number of -


MATCHPKTS packets received in the
matched flow.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 867


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

QOS_PORTSTRM_SND Indicates the number of -


MATCHPKTS packets transmitted in the
matched flow.

PORTSTRM_SHAPING Indicates the number of -


_DROPPKTS packets discarded due to
network congestion when
the traffic shaping
function is enabled in the
egress direction.

PORTSTRM_SHAPING Indicates the ratio of Packet loss rate in the egress direction =
_DROPRATIO packet loss due to network Number of discarded packets in the
congestion when the egress direction/Number of packets
traffic shaping function is matching the traffic classification rule in
enabled in the egress the egress direction
direction.

QOS_PORTCAR_Mar- Indicates the proportion of Proportion of packets marked in red in


kedRedRATIO packets marked in red the ingress direction = Number of packets
when the traffic policing marked in red in the ingress direction/
function is enabled. Number of packets matching the traffic
classification rule in the ingress direction

QOS_PORTSTRM_RX_ Indicates the packet rate Packet rate in the receive direction =
PPS (packets/s) in the receive Number of received packets/Monitoring
direction of a matched period
flow.

QOS_PORTSTRM_TX_ Indicates the packet rate Packet rate in the transmit direction =
PPS (packets/s) in the transmit Number of transmitted packets/
direction of a matched Monitoring period
flow.

QOS_PORTSTRM_RCV Indicates the number of -


MATCHBYTES bytes in the received
packets of a matched flow.

QOS_PORTSTRM_SND Indicates the number of -


MATCHBYTES bytes in the transmitted
packets of a matched flow.

QOS_PORTSTRM_RX_ Indicates the bit rate in the Bit rate in the receive direction = Number
BPS receive direction of a of received bytes x 8/Monitoring period
matched flow.

QOS_PORTSTRM_TX_ Indicates the bit rate in the Bit rate in the transmit direction =
BPS transmit direction of a Number of transmitted bytes x 8/
matched flow. Monitoring period

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 868


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

Port QOS_PORTQUEUE_DR Indicates the ratio of Packet loss rate in an egress queue =
priority OPRATIO packet loss due to Number of discarded packets with a
congestion in egress priority in the egress queue/Number of
queues with different packets with the priority in the egress
priorities. queue

QOS_PRI_DROPPKTS Indicates the number of -


packets discarded in the
services with different
priorities.

QOS_PRI_DROPBYTES Indicates the number of -


bytes discarded in the
services with different
priorities.

PORT_PRI_SNDPKTS Indicates the number of -


packets transmitted in
egress queues with
different priorities.

PORT_PRI_SNDBYTES Indicates the number of -


bytes in the packets
transmitted in egress
queues with different
priorities.

PORT_PRI_TX_BPS Indicates the bit rates of Bit rate = Number of transmitted bytes x
egress queues with 8/Monitoring period
different priorities in the
transmit direction.

PORT_PRI_TX_PPS Indicates the packet rate Packet rate = Number of transmitted


(packets/second) of egress packets/Monitoring period
queues with different
priorities in the transmit
direction.

Port DS DS_CVLANPRI_PKTS Indicates the number of -


domain packets with matched C-
VLAN priorities in the DS
domain

DS_CVLANPRI_BYTES Indicates the number of -


bytes in the packets with
matched C-VLAN
priorities in the DS
domain.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 869


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

DS_SVLANPRI_PKTS Indicates the number of -


packets with matched S-
VLAN priorities in the DS
domain.

DS_SVLANPRI_BYTES Indicates the number of -


bytes in the packets with
matched S-VLAN
priorities in the DS
domain.

DS_DSCP_PKTS Indicates the number of -


packets with matched IP
DSCP priorities in the DS
domain.

DS_DSCP_BYTES Indicates the number of -


bytes in the packets with
matched IP DSCP
priorities in the DS
domain.

NOTE

l Integrated IP radio ports support this parameter.


l Ports whose Port Mode is Layer 3 do not support RMON performance events of traffic classifications
or port DS domains.

C.2.4 ML1/MD1
The RMON performance that the ML1/MD1 board supported include ATM PWE3 performance,
ATM/IMA performance events on the access side, CES performance, PW performance, PPP
performance, and MLPPP performance.

Table C-6 Packet-Plane RMON Performance Entry List (ML1/MD1)

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

ATM Indicates the count of


PWE3 ATMPW_SNDCELLS transmitted cells. -
performanc
e ATMPW_RCVCELLS Indicates the count of -
received cells.

ATMPW_UNKNOWN- Indicates the count of -


CELLS unknown cells.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 870


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

ATM/IMA PORT_RX_BW_UTI- Indicates the bandwidth Bandwidth utilization = (Number of


performanc LIZATION utilization on a port in the received bytes x 8/Monitoring period)/
e events on receive direction. Configured or actual bandwidth
the access
side PORT_TX_BW_UTI- Indicates the bandwidth Bandwidth utilization = (Number of
LIZATION utilization on a port in the transmitted bytes x 8/Monitoring
transmit direction. period)/Configured or actual bandwidth

ATM_CORRECTED_H Indicates the number of ATM_CORRECTED_HCSERR is used


CSERR correctable HCS error to evaluate the service quality.
cells received.

ATM_UNCORRECTED Indicates the number of ATM_UNCORRECTED_HCSERR is


_HCSERR uncorrectable HCS error used to determine whether cell loss
cells received. occurs on a port.

ATM_RCVCELLS Indicates the total number ATM_RCVCELLS is used to determine


of received cells. whether ATM connections are normal.

ATM_RCVIDLECELLS Indicates the total number ATM_RCVIDLECELLS is used to


of received idle cells. determine whether cells are properly
processed at the ATM physical layer.

ATM_SNDCELLS Indicates the total number ATM_SNDCELLS is used to determine


of transmitted cells. whether a port transmits services
normally.

ATM_IF_INRATE_MA Indicates the maximum -


X rate of normal cells
received on the port.

ATM_IF_INRATE_MIN Indicates the minimum -


rate of normal cells
received on the port.

ATM_IF_INRATE_AVG Indicates the average rate -


of normal cells received
on the port.

ATM_IF_OUTRATE_M Indicates the maximum -


AX rate of normal cells
transmitted on the port.

ATM_IF_OUTRATE_M Indicates the minimum -


IN rate of normal cells
transmitted on the port.

ATM_IF_OUTRATE_A Indicates the average rate -


VG of normal cells transmitted
on the port.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 871


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

ATM_CELL_AVAILA- Indicates the percentage of Percentage of valid cells = (Total number


BILITY valid cells. of cells - Number of HEC-detected error
cells)/Total number of cells

PORT_RX_BW_UTI- Indicates the bandwidth Bandwidth utilization = (Number of


LIZATION utilization rate (0.01%) of received bytes x 8/Monitoring period)/
the port in the receive Configured or actual bandwidth
direction.

PORT_TX_BW_UTI- Indicates the bandwidth Bandwidth utilization = (Number of


LIZATION utilization rate (0.01%) of transmitted bytes x 8/Monitoring
the port in the transmit period)/Configured or actual bandwidth
direction.

ATM_UNI1_INRATE_ Indicates the maximum ATM_UNI1_INRATE_MAX is based


MAX rate of receiving correct on VPIs/VCIs.
cells on the UNI1 side of
ATM connections.

ATM_UNI1_INRATE_ Indicates the minimum ATM_UNI1_INRATE_MIN is based on


MIN rate of receiving correct VPIs/VCIs.
cells on the UNI1 side of
ATM connections.

ATM_UNI1_INRATE_A Indicates the average rate ATM_UNI1_INRATE_AVG is based


VG of receiving correct cells on VPIs/VCIs.
on the UNI1 side of ATM
connections.

ATM_UNI1_OUTRATE Indicates the maximum ATM_UNI1_OUTRATE_MAX is


_MAX rate of transmitting correct based on VPIs/VCIs.
cells on the UNI1 side of
ATM connections.

ATM_UNI1_OUTRATE Indicates the minimum ATM_UNI1_OUTRATE_MIN is based


_MIN rate of transmitting correct on VPIs/VCIs.
cells on the UNI1 side of
ATM connections.

ATM_UNI1_OUTRATE Indicates the average rate ATM_UNI1_OUTRATE_AVG is based


_AVG of transmitting correct on VPIs/VCIs.
cells on the UNI1 side of
ATM connections.

ATM_UNI2_INRATE_ Indicates the maximum ATM_UNI2_INRATE_MAX is based


MAX rate of receiving correct on VPIs/VCIs.
cells on the UNI2 side of
ATM connections.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 872


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

ATM_UNI2_INRATE_ Indicates the minimum ATM_UNI2_INRATE_MIN is based on


MIN rate of receiving correct VPIs/VCIs.
cells on the UNI2 side of
ATM connections.

ATM_UNI2_INRATE_A Indicates the average rate ATM_UNI2_INRATE_AVG is based


VG of receiving correct cells on VPIs/VCIs.
on the UNI2 side of ATM
connections.

ATM_UNI2_OUTRATE Indicates the maximum ATM_UNI2_OUTRATE_MAX is


_MAX rate of transmitting correct based on VPIs/VCIs.
cells on the UNI2 side of
ATM connections.

ATM_UNI2_OUTRATE Indicates the minimum ATM_UNI2_OUTRATE_MIN is based


_MIN rate of transmitting correct on VPIs/VCIs.
cells on the UNI2 side of
ATM connections.

ATM_UNI2_OUTRATE Indicates the average rate ATM_UNI2_OUTRATE_AVG is based


_AVG of transmitting correct on VPIs/VCIs.
cells on the UNI2 side of
ATM connections.

ATM_UNI1_INCELLS Indicates the total number ATM_UNI1_INCELLS is used to


of receiving correct cells determine whether ATM connections are
on the UNI1 side of ATM normal.
connections.

ATM_UNI1_OUT- Indicates the total number ATM_UNI1_OUTCELLS is used to


CELLS of transmitting correct determine whether ATM connections are
cells on the UNI1 side of normal.
ATM connections.

ATM_UNI2_INCELLS Indicates the total number ATM_UNI2_INCELLS is used to


of receiving correct cells determine whether ATM connections are
on the UNI2 side of ATM normal.
connections.

ATM_UNI2_OUT- Indicates the total number ATM_UNI2_OUTCELLS is used to


CELLS of transmitting correct determine whether ATM connections are
cells on the UNI2 side of normal.
ATM connections.

CES CES_MISORDERPKTS Indicates the number of -


performanc lost disordered packets.
e event
CES_STRAYPKTS Indicates the number of -
mis-connected packets.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 873


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

CES_MALPKTS Indicates the number of -


deformed frames.

CES_JTRUDR Indicates the number of -


jitter buffer underflows.

CES_JTROVR Indicates the number of -


jitter buffer overflows.

CES_LOSPKTS Indicates the number of -


lost packets.

CES_RX_PKTS Indicates the number of -


received packets.

PW PW_RCVPKTS Indicates the number of -


performanc packets received from
e of ATM/ PWs.
CES
PW_RCVBYTES Indicates the number of -
bytes received from PWs.

MPLS_PW_FLR Indicates the packet loss Packet loss rate = (Number of packets
rate on the PW. transmitted by the source - Number of
packets received by the sink)/Number of
packets transmitted by the source

MPLS_PW_FL Indicates the packet loss Number of lost packets = Number of


number on the PW. packets transmitted by the source -
Number of packets received by the sink
(Both numbers are detected by the
performance monitoring scheme of
OAM.)

MPLS_PW_FD Indicates the frame delay Frame delay = Time when the source
on the PW. sends a request packet - Time when the
source receives the response packet

MPLS_PW_FDV Indicates the frame delay Frame delay variation is the difference
variation on the PW. between two frame delay test results.

PPP PPP_TX_PKTS Indicates the number of -


transmitted PPP packets.

PPP_TX_BYTES Indicates the number of -


bytes of transmitted PPP
packets.

PPP_RX_PKTS Indicates the number of -


received PPP packets.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 874


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

PPP_RX_BYTES Indicates the number of -


bytes of received PPP
packets.

PPP_RX_FCSPKTS Indicates the number of -


PPP packets that received
FCS faults.

PPP_TX_LOSPKTS Indicates the number of -


PPP packets dropped in
the transmitting process.

PPP_RX_LOSPKTS Indicates the number of -


relieved abnormal PPP
packets.

PPP_RX_BW_UTILIZA- Indicates the PPP PPP bandwidth usage = (Number of


TION bandwidth usage in the received bytes x 8/Monitoring period)/
receive direction. Configured or actual bandwidth

PPP_TX_BW_UTILIZA- Indicates the PPP PPP bandwidth usage = (Number of


TION bandwidth usage in the transmitted bytes x 8/Monitoring
transmit direction. period)/Configured or actual bandwidth

MLPPP MP_TX_PKTS Indicates the number of -


transmitted MP packets.

MP_TX_BYTES Indicates the number of -


bytes of transmitted MP
packets.

MP_RX_PKTS Indicates the number of -


received MP packets.

MP_RX_BYTES Indicates the number of -


bytes of received MP
packets.

MP_RX_ERRPKTS Indicates the number of -


received MP packets.

MP_TX_TOTALPKTS Indicates the total number The transmitted MP packets include


of transmitted MP service and protocol packets.
packets.

MP_RX_TOTALPKTS Indicates the total number The received MP packets include service
of received MP packets. and protocol packets.

MP_RX_BW_UTILIZA- Indicates the MP MP bandwidth usage = (Number of


TION bandwidth usage in the received bytes x 8/Monitoring period)/
receive direction. Configured or actual bandwidth

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 875


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

MP_TX_BW_UTILIZA- Indicates the MP MP bandwidth usage = (Number of


TION bandwidth usage in the transmitted bytes x 8/Monitoring
transmit direction. period)/Configured or actual bandwidth

C.2.5 CQ1
The RMON performance that the MP1 board supported include CES performance, PW
performance, PPP performance, and MLPPP performance.

Table C-7 Packet-Plane RMON Performance Entry List (CQ1)

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

CES Indicates the number of


performanc CES_MISORDERPKTS lost disordered packets. -
e event
CES_STRAYPKTS Indicates the number of -
mis-connected packets.

CES_MALPKTS Indicates the number of -


deformed frames.

CES_JTRUDR Indicates the number of -


jitter buffer underflows.

CES_JTROVR Indicates the number of -


jitter buffer overflows.

CES_LOSPKTS Indicates the number of -


lost packets.

CES_RX_PKTS Indicates the number of -


received packets.

PW PW_RCVPKTS Indicates the number of -


performanc packets received from
e of CES PWs.

PW_RCVBYTES Indicates the number of -


bytes received from PWs.

PPP PPP_TX_PKTS Indicates the number of -


transmitted PPP packets.

PPP_TX_BYTES Indicates the number of -


bytes of transmitted PPP
packets.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 876


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

PPP_RX_PKTS Indicates the number of -


received PPP packets.

PPP_RX_BYTES Indicates the number of -


bytes of received PPP
packets.

PPP_RX_FCSPKTS Indicates the number of -


PPP packets that received
FCS faults.

PPP_TX_LOSPKTS Indicates the number of -


PPP packets dropped in
the transmitting process.

PPP_RX_LOSPKTS Indicates the number of -


relieved abnormal PPP
packets.

PPP_RX_BW_UTILIZA- Indicates the PPP PPP bandwidth usage = (Number of


TION bandwidth usage in the received bytes x 8/Monitoring period)/
receive direction. Configured or actual bandwidth

PPP_TX_BW_UTILIZA- Indicates the PPP PPP bandwidth usage = (Number of


TION bandwidth usage in the transmitted bytes x 8/Monitoring
transmit direction. period)/Configured or actual bandwidth

MLPPP MP_TX_PKTS Indicates the number of -


transmitted MP packets.

MP_TX_BYTES Indicates the number of -


bytes of transmitted MP
packets.

MP_RX_PKTS Indicates the number of -


received MP packets.

MP_RX_BYTES Indicates the number of -


bytes of received MP
packets.

MP_RX_ERRPKTS Indicates the number of -


received MP packets.

MP_TX_TOTALPKTS Indicates the total number The transmitted MP packets include


of transmitted MP service and protocol packets.
packets.

MP_RX_TOTALPKTS Indicates the total number The received MP packets include service
of received MP packets. and protocol packets.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 877


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

MP_RX_BW_UTILIZA- Indicates the MP MP bandwidth usage = (Number of


TION bandwidth usage in the received bytes x 8/Monitoring period)/
receive direction. Configured or actual bandwidth

MP_TX_BW_UTILIZA- Indicates the MP MP bandwidth usage = (Number of


TION bandwidth usage in the transmitted bytes x 8/Monitoring
transmit direction. period)/Configured or actual bandwidth

C.2.6 CSHN
The RMON performance that the CSHN board supported include L2VPN performance, Tunnel
performance, PW performance of L2VPN, ETH OAM 802.1ag performance, and MPLS-TP
OAM performance.

Table C-8 Packet-plane RMON performance entry list (CSHN)

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

L2VPNa Indicates the number of


performanc packets received at the V-
e VLAN_RCVPKTS UNI VLAN. -

VLAN_RCVBYTES Indicates the number of -


bytes in the packets
received at the V-UNI
VLAN.

VUNI_RCVPKTS Indicates the number of Indicates the number of packets received


packets received on the V- on a V-UNI of a service.
UNI.

VUNI_RCVBYTES Indicates the number of Indicates the number of bytes received on


bytes received on the V- a V-UNI of a service.
UNI.

VLAN_RX_BPS Indicates the bit rate (bits/ Bit rate = Number of received bytes x 8/
second) in the receive Monitoring period
direction of a VLAN to
which a V-UNI belongs.

VLAN_RX_PPS Indicates the packet rate Packet rate = Number of received


(packets/second) in the packets/Monitoring period
receive direction of a
VLAN to which a V-UNI
belongs.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 878


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

Tunnel TUNNEL_REVERSE_R Indicates the number of Indicates the number of packets received
performanc CVPKTS packets received in the in the reverse tunnel of a bidirectional
e reverse tunnel. transit tunnel.

TUNNEL_REVERSE_R Indicates the number of Indicates the number of bytes received in


CVBYTES bytes received in the the reverse tunnel of a bidirectional
reverse tunnel. transit tunnel.

TUNNEL_RCVPKTS Indicates the number of Indicates the number of packets received


packets received in the in a tunnel.
tunnel.

TUNNEL_RCVBYTES Indicates the number of Indicates the number of bytes received in


bytes received in the a tunnel.
tunnel.

TUNNEL_REVERSE_R Indicates the bit rate (bits/ Bit rate = Number of received bytes x 8/
X_BPS second) in the receive Monitoring period
direction of a reverse
tunnel.

TUNNEL_REVERSE_R Indicates the packet rate Packet rate = Number of received


X_PPS (packets/second) in the packets/Monitoring period
receive direction of a
reverse tunnel.

TUNNEL_RX_BPS Indicates the bit rate (bits/ Bit rate = Number of received bytes x 8/
second) in the receive Monitoring period
direction of a monitored
object.

TUNNEL_RX_PPS Indicates the packet rate Packet rate = Number of received


(packets/second) in the packets/Monitoring period
receive direction of a
monitored object.

PW PW_RCVPKTS Indicates the number of -


performanc packets received on the
e of L2VPN PW.

PW_RCVBYTES Indicates the number of -


bytes received on the PW.

PW_DROPPKTS Indicates the number of -


packets discarded on the
PW.

PW_RX_BPS Indicates the bit rate (bits/ Bit rate = Number of received bytes x 8/
second) in the receive Monitoring period
direction of a monitored
object.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 879


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

PW_RX_PPS Indicates the packet rate Packet rate = Number of received


(packets/second) in the packets/Monitoring period
receive direction of a
monitored object.

ETH OAM ETH_CFM_FLR Indicates the E_Line Packet loss rate = (Number of packets
802.1ag service packet loss rate. transmitted by the source MEP - Number
performanc of packets received by the sink MEP)/
e Number of packets transmitted by the
source MEP

ETH_CFM_FL Indicates the number of Number of lost packets = Number of


discarded E_Line service packets transmitted by the source -
packets. Number of packets received by the sink
(Both numbers are detected by the
performance monitoring scheme of
OAM.)

ETH_CFM_FD Indicates the E_Line Frame delay = Time when the source
service delay (s). MEP sends a request packet - Time when
the source MEP receives the response
packet

ETH_CFM_FDV Indicates the E_Line Frame delay variation is the difference


service delay variation between two frame delay test results.
(s).

ETH_CFM_FLR_PRIn Indicates the packet loss Packet loss rate = (Number of packets
NOTE rate of the E-Line service transmitted by the source MEP - Number
0n7 with a priority of n. of packets received by the sink MEP)/
Number of packets transmitted by the
source MEP

ETH_CFM_FL_PRIn Indicates the number of Number of lost packets = Number of


NOTE lost packets in the E-Line packets transmitted by the source -
0n7 service with a priority of n. Number of packets received by the sink
(Both numbers are detected by the
performance monitoring scheme of
OAM.)

ETH_CFM_FD_PRIn Indicates the delay (s) of Bidirectional frame delay = Time when
NOTE the E-Line service with a the source sends a request packet - Time
0n7 priority of n. when the source receives the response
packet

ETH_CFM_FDV_PRIn Indicates the delay Frame delay variation is the difference


NOTE variation (s) of the E- between two frame delay test results.
0n7 Line service with a
priority of n.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 880


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

MPLS-TP MPLS_PW_FLR Indicates the packet loss Packet loss rate = (Number of packets
OAM rate on the PW. transmitted by the source - Number of
performanc packets received by the sink)/Number of
e packets transmitted by the source

MPLS_PW_FLR_N Indicates the packet loss Packet loss rate = (Number of packets
rate on the PW at the near transmitted by the source - Number of
end. packets received by the sink)/Number of
packets transmitted by the source

MPLS_PW_FL Indicates the packet loss Number of lost packets = Number of


number on the PW. packets transmitted by the source -
Number of packets received by the sink
(Both numbers are detected by the
performance monitoring scheme of
OAM.)

MPLS_PW_FL_N Indicates the number of Number of lost packets = Number of


lost packets on the PW at packets transmitted by the source -
the near end. Number of packets received by the sink
(Both numbers are detected by the
performance monitoring scheme of
OAM.)

MPLS_PW_FD Indicates the frame delay Frame delay = Time when the source
(s) on the PW. sends a request packet - Time when the
source receives the response packet

MPLS_PW_FDV Indicates the frame delay Frame delay variation is the difference
variation (s) on the PW. between two frame delay test results.

MPLS_TUNNEL_FLR Indicates the packet loss Packet loss rate = (Number of packets
rate in the tunnel. transmitted by the source - Number of
packets received by the sink)/Number of
packets transmitted by the source

MPLS_TUNNEL_FLR_ Indicates the packet loss Packet loss rate = (Number of packets
N rate on the tunnel at the transmitted by the source - Number of
near end. packets received by the sink)/Number of
packets transmitted by the source

MPLS_TUNNEL_FL Indicates the packet loss Number of lost packets = Number of


number in the tunnel. packets transmitted by the source -
Number of packets received by the sink
(Both numbers are detected by the
performance monitoring scheme of
OAM.)

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 881


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

MPLS_TUNNEL_FL_N Indicates the number of Number of lost packets = Number of


lost packets on the tunnel packets transmitted by the source -
at the near end. Number of packets received by the sink
(Both numbers are detected by the
performance monitoring scheme of
OAM.)

MPLS_TUNNEL_FD Indicates the frame delay Frame delay = Time when the source
(s) in the tunnel. sends a request packet - Time when the
source receives the response packet

MPLS_TUNNEL_FDV Indicates the frame delay Frame delay variation is the difference
variation (s) in the between two frame delay test results.
tunnel.

PLA group RXPKTS Indicates the packets Bad packets, broadcast packets, and
received (packets). multicast packets are included.

ETHDROP Indicates the packet loss ETHDROP indicates the number of


events (times). packet loss events caused by insufficient
Ethernet chip resources. The count is not
the number of discarded packets but the
number of times packet loss is detected.

Indicates the bytes RXOCTETS indicates the total number


received (bytes). of bytes in received packets (including
bad packets), including framing bits but
RXOCTETS not FCS bytes.

RXMULCAST Indicates the multicast RXMULCAST indicates the total


packets received number of received good packets with
(packets). multicast destination addresses,
excluding broadcast packets.

RXBRDCAST Indicates the broadcast RXMULCAST indicates the total


packets received number of received good packets with
(packets). multicast destination addresses,
excluding broadcast packets.

PORT_RX_BW_UTI- Indicates the bandwidth Bandwidth utilization = (Number of


LIZATION utilization on a port in the received bytes x 8/Monitoring period)/
receive direction. Configured or actual bandwidth

PORT_TX_BW_UTI- Indicates the bandwidth Bandwidth utilization = (Number of


LIZATION utilization on a port in the transmitted bytes x 8/Monitoring
transmit direction. period)/Configured or actual bandwidth

RXPKT64 Packets received (64 bytes FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
in length) (packets) are excluded.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 882


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

RXPKT65 Packets received (65-127 FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
bytes in length) (packets) are excluded.

RXPKT128 Packets received (128-255 FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
bytes in length) (packets) are excluded.

RXPKT256 Packets received (256-511 FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
bytes in length) (packets) are excluded.

RXPKT512 Packets received FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
(512-1023 bytes in length) are excluded.
(packets)

RXPKT1024 Packets received FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
(1024-1518 bytes in are excluded.
length) (packets)

TXPKTS Indicates the packets Bad packets, broadcast packets, and


transmitted (packets). multicast packets are included.

TXOCTETS Indicates the bytes Indicates the total number of bytes in


transmitted transmitted packets (including bad
packets), including framing bits but not
FCS bytes.

ETHFCS Indicates the FCS errored Indicates the number of received frames
frames (frames). that are an integral number of octets in
length but do not pass the FCS check.

TXBGOOD Indicates the bytes in FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
received good packets are excluded.
(bytes).

RXBGOOD Indicates the bytes in FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
transmitted good packets are excluded.
(bytes).

RXBBAD Indicates the bytes in FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
received bad packets are excluded.
(bytes).

TXUNICAST Indicates the unicast The unicast packets that are discarded or
packets transmitted fail to be transmitted are included.
(packets).

RXUNICAST Indicates the unicast RXUNICAST indicates the number of


packets received good unicast packets.
(packets).

TXMULCAST Indicates the multicast The multicast packets that are discarded
packets transmitted or fail to be transmitted are included.
(packets).

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 883


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

TXBRDCAST Indicates the broadcast The broadcast packets that are discarded
packets transmitted or fail to be transmitted are included.
(packets).

RXGOODFULLFRAME Indicates the rate of good Framing bits (20 bytes) and FCS bytes
SPEED full-frame bytes received are included.
(kbit/s).

TXGOODFULLFRAME Indicates the rate of good Framing bits (20 bytes) and FCS bytes
SPEED full-frame bytes are included.
transmitted (kbit/s).

RXFULLBGOOD Indicates the good full- Framing bits (20 bytes) and FCS bytes
frame bytes received are included.
(bytes).

TXFULLBGOOD Indicates the good full- Framing bits (20 bytes) and FCS bytes
frame bytes transmitted are included.
(bytes).

TXPKT64 Indicates the count of FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
transmitted 64-byte are excluded.
packets (errored packets
included)

TXPKT65 Indicates the count of FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
transmitted packets with a are excluded.
length of 65 to 127 bytes
(errored packets included)

TXPKT128 Indicates the count of FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
transmitted packets with a are excluded.
length of 128 to 255 bytes
(errored packets included)

TXPKT256 Indicates the count of FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
transmitted packets with a are excluded.
length of 256 to 511 bytes
(errored packets included)

TXPKT512 Indicates the count of FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
transmitted packets with a are excluded.
length of 512 to 1023
bytes (errored packets
included)

TXPKT1024 Indicates the count of FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
transmitted packets with a are excluded.
length of 1024 to 1518
bytes (errored packets
included)

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 884


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

TXPKT1519 Indicates the count of FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
transmitted packets with a are excluded.
length of over 1518 bytes
(errored packets included)

RXPKT1519 Indicates the count of FCS bytes are included, but framing bits
received packets with a are excluded.
length of over 1518 bytes
(errored packets included)

NOTE

l a: L2VPN services include a variety of E-Line and E-LAN services supported by the equipment.
l VUNI represents virtual UNI, represents the sink or source of services on the UNI side.
l The E-LAN services transmitted by the OptiX RTN 980 do not support the VLAN-based and VUNI-
based RMON performance statistics.
l The VUNIs mounted to the E-Line services that are transmitted on the OptiX RTN 980 by exclusively
occupying ports do not support VLAN-based RMON performance statistics.
l Only the SLB2CSHN board supports MPLS-TP OAM.

C.2.7 EFP8/EMS6
The Packet-Plane RMON performance that the EFP8/EMS6 board supported include basic
performance and extended performance.

The EFP8 board's bridging port PORT10 is on the Packet-Plane.

The EMS6 board's bridging port PORT8 is on the Packet-Plane.

Table C-9 Packet-Plane RMON Performance Entry List (EFP8/EMS6)

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

Basic Indicates the packets Bad packets, broadcast packets, and


performanc RXPKTS received (packets). multicast packets are included.
e
ETHDROP Indicates the packet loss ETHDROP indicates the number of
events (times). packet loss events caused by insufficient
Ethernet chip resources. The count is not
the number of discarded packets but the
number of times packet loss is detected.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 885


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

RXOCTETS Indicates the bytes RXOCTETS indicates the total number


received (bytes). of bytes in received packets (including
bad packets), including framing bits but
not FCS bytes.
NOTE
If the packets received by an EFP8/EMS6
board are larger than the MTU, byte count is
calculated based on MTU.

RXMULCAST Indicates the multicast RXMULCAST indicates the total


packets received number of received good packets with
(packets). multicast destination addresses,
excluding broadcast packets.

RXBRDCAST Indicates the broadcast RXMULCAST indicates the total


packets received number of received good packets with
(packets). multicast destination addresses,
excluding broadcast packets.

ETHOVER Indicates the oversized Oversized packets are the packets larger
packets received than MTU (including FCS bytes but not
(packets). framing bits).
NOTE
For the EFP8/EMS6 board, an oversized
packet is larger than the MTU.

ETHJAB Indicates the oversized ETHJAB indicates the number of


error packets received received packets that are larger than
(packets). MTU (including FCS bytes but not
framing bits) and contain FCS errors or
alignment errors.
NOTE
For the EFP8/EMS6 board, an oversized error
packet is larger than the MTU.

Extended ETHFCS Indicates the FCS errored Indicates the number of received frames
performanc frames (frames). that are an integral number of octets in
e length but do not pass the FCS check.
NOTE
For the EFP8/EMS6 board, this count dose
not include undersized frames and oversized
frames.

RXBGOOD Indicates the bytes in FCS bytes are included but framing bits
received good packets are excluded.
(bytes).

TXBGOOD Indicates the bytes in FCS bytes are included but framing bits
transmitted good packets are excluded.
(bytes).

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 886


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Category Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks


Performance Entry Performance Entry

RXBBAD Indicates the bytes in FCS bytes are included but framing bits
received bad packets are excluded.
(bytes).

TXUNICAST Indicates the unicast The unicast packets that are discarded or
packets transmitted fail to be transmitted are included.
(packets).

RXUNICAST Indicates the unicast RXUNICAST indicates the number of


packets received good unicast packets.
(packets).

TXMULCAST Indicates the multicast The multicast packets that are discarded
packets transmitted or fail to be transmitted are included.
(packets).

TXBRDCAST Indicates the broadcast The broadcast packets that are discarded
packets transmitted or fail to be transmitted are included.
(packets).

RXGOODFULLFRAME Indicates the rate of good Framing bits (20 bytes) and FCS bytes
SPEED full-frame bytes received are included.
(Kbit/s).

TXGOODFULLFRAME Indicates the rate of good Framing bits (20 bytes) and FCS bytes
SPEED full-frame bytes are included.
transmitted (Kbit/s).

RXFULLBGOOD Indicates the good full- Framing bits (20 bytes) and FCS bytes
frame bytes received are included.
(bytes).

TXFULLBGOOD Indicates the good full- Framing bits (20 bytes) and FCS bytes
frame bytes transmitted are included.
(bytes).

RXPAUSE Indicates the pause frames RXPAUSE indicates the number of


received (frames). MAC flow control frames with the
PAUSE opcode.

TXPAUSE Indicates the pause frames TXPAUSE indicates the number of


transmitted (frames). MAC flow control frames with the
PAUSE opcode.

C.3 RMON Performance Entries List on the EoS/EoPDH-


Plane
This section lists RMON performance entries on the EoS/EoPDH plane by board type.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 887


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

C.3.1 EFP8
The EFP8 board The RMON performance that the EFP8 Board supported include basic
performance, extended performance, and VCG performance.

The EFP8 board's Ethernet ports PORT1 to PORT8, bridging port PORT9, and internal ports
VCTRUNK1 to VCTRUNK16 are on the EoPDH plane.

Table C-10 EoPDH plane RMON Performance Entry List (EFP8)

Categor Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks Source


y Performance Entry Performance Entry Port

Basic RXOCTETS Indicates the bytes RXOCTETS indicates the total PORT1 to
performa received (bytes). number of bytes in received packets PORT9
nce (including bad packets), including
framing bits but not FCS bytes.

RXBRDCAST Indicates the broadcast RXBRDCAST indicates the total


packets received number of received good packets
(packets). with broadcast destination
addresses, excluding multicast
packets.

RXMULCAST Indicates the broadcast RXMULCAST indicates the total


packets received number of received good packets
(packets). with multicast destination
addresses, excluding broadcast
packets.

ETHOVER Indicates the oversized Oversized packets are the packets


packets received larger than MTU (including FCS
(packets). bytes but not framing bits).

RXPKTS Indicates the packets Bad packets, broadcast packets, and


received (packets). multicast packets are included.

ETHJAB Indicates the oversized ETHJAB indicates the number of


error packets received received packets that are larger than
(packets). MTU (including FCS bytes but not
framing bits) and contain FCS errors
or alignment errors.

ETHFCS The number of frames -


that have FCS check
errors-

ETHUNDER Undersized packets Indicates the number of received PORT1 to


received (packets) packets that are shorter than 64 bytes PORT8
(including FCS bytes but not
framing bits) and do not contain any
other errors except for FCS errors.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 888


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Categor Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks Source


y Performance Entry Performance Entry Port

ETHFRG Fragments received Indicates the total number of


(packets) received packets that have FCS or
alignment errors (FCS bytes are
included but framing bits are
excluded). The count increases
because of noise collisions.

RXPKT64 Packets received (64 FCS bytes are included but framing PORT1 to
bytes in length) bits are excluded. PORT9
(packets)

RXPKT65 Packets received FCS bytes are included but framing


(65-127 bytes in bits are excluded.
length) (packets)

RXPKT128 Packets received FCS bytes are included but framing


(128-255 bytes in bits are excluded.
length) (packets)

RXPKT256 Packets received FCS bytes are included but framing


(256-511 bytes in bits are excluded.
length) (packets)

RXPKT512 Packets received FCS bytes are included but framing


(512-1023 bytes in bits are excluded.
length) (packets)

RXPKT1024 Packets received FCS bytes are included but framing


(1024-1518 bytes in bits are excluded.
length) (packets)

Extended RXCTLPKTS Control frames - PORT1 to


performa received (frames) PORT9
nce
TXOCTETS Bytes transmitted Indicates the total number of bytes
(bytes) (including those in bad packets)
transmitted (including FCS bytes
but not framing bits).

TXPKTS Packets transmitted Bad packets, broadcast packets, and


(packets) multicast packets are included.

TXCTLPKTS Control frames -


transmitted (frame)

TXPKT64 Packets transmitted FCS bytes are included but framing


(64 bytes in length) bits are excluded.
(packets)

TXPKT65 Packets transmitted FCS bytes are included but framing


(65-127 bytes in bits are excluded.
length) (packets)

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 889


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Categor Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks Source


y Performance Entry Performance Entry Port

TXPKT128 Packets transmitted FCS bytes are included but framing


(128-255 bytes in bits are excluded.
length) (packets)

TXPKT256 Packets transmitted FCS bytes are included but framing


(256-511 bytes in bits are excluded.
length) (packets)

TXPKT512 Packets transmitted FCS bytes are included but framing


(512-1023 bytes in bits are excluded.
length) (packets)

TXPKT1024 Packets transmitted FCS bytes are included but framing


(1024-1518 bytes in bits are excluded.
length) (packets)

ETHALI Alignment error An alignment error frame contains a


frames (frames) fractional number of bytes and fails
to pass the FCS check.

PKT64 Packets received and FCS bytes are included but framing
transmitted (64 bytes in bits are excluded.
length) (packets)

PKT65 Packets received and FCS bytes are included but framing
transmitted (65-127 bits are excluded.
bytes in length)
(packets)

PKT128 Packets received and FCS bytes are included but framing
transmitted (128-255 bits are excluded.
bytes in length)
(packets)

PKT256 Packets received and FCS bytes are included but framing
transmitted (256-511 bits are excluded.
bytes in length)
(packets)

PKT512 Packets received and FCS bytes are included but framing
transmitted (512-1023 bits are excluded.
bytes in length)
(packets)

PKT1024 Packets received and FCS bytes are included but framing
transmitted bits are excluded.
(1024-1518 bytes in
length) (packets)

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 890


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Categor Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks Source


y Performance Entry Performance Entry Port

ETH_RX_THROUG Indicates the Maximum throughput = Number of


HPUT_MAX maximum throughput received bytes (including inter-
at a port in the receive frame gaps and preambles)/
direction. Monitoring period

ETH_RX_THROUG Indicates the minimum Minimum throughput = Number of


HPUT_MIN throughput at a port in received bytes (including inter-
the receive direction. frame gaps and preambles)/
Monitoring period

ETH_RX_THROUG Indicates the average Average throughput = Number of


HPUT_AVG throughput at a port in received bytes (including inter-
the receive direction. frame gaps and preambles)/
Monitoring period

RXGOODFULLFRA Indicates the rate of Framing bits (20 bytes) and FCS
MESPEED good full-frame bits bytes are included.
received (Kbit/s).

TXGOODFULLFRA Indicates the rate of Framing bits (20 bytes) and FCS
MESPEED good full-frame bits bytes are included.
transmitted (Kbit/s).

RXFULLBGOOD Indicates the good full- Framing bits (20 bytes) and FCS
frame bytes received bytes are included.
(bytes).

TXFULLBGOOD Indicates the good full- Framing bits (20 bytes) and FCS
frame bytes bytes are included.
transmitted (bytes).

TXMULCAST Indicates the multicast The multicast packets that are


packets transmitted discarded or fail to be transmitted
(packets). are included.

RXUNICAST Indicates the unicast RXUNICAST indicates the number


packets received of good unicast packets.
(packets).

TXUNICAST Indicates the unicast The unicast packets that are


packets transmitted discarded or fail to be transmitted
(packets). are included.

TXBRDCAST Indicates the broadcast The broadcast packets that are


packets transmitted discarded or fail to be transmitted
(packets). are included.

RXPAUSE Indicates the pause RXPAUSE indicates the number of


frames received MAC flow control frames with the
(frames). PAUSE opcode.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 891


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Categor Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks Source


y Performance Entry Performance Entry Port

TXPAUSE Indicates the pause TXPAUSE indicates the number of


frames transmitted MAC flow control frames with the
(frames). PAUSE opcode.

VCG VCG_TXGOODPAC Good packets - VCTRU


performa KETS transmitted (packets) NK1 to
nce VCTRU
VCG_TXPACKETS Packets transmitted Bad packets, broadcast packets, and NK16
(packets) multicast packets are included.

VCG_TXOCTETS Bytes transmitted Bad packets are included (FCS bytes


(bytes) are included but framing bits are
excluded).

VCG_RXGOODPAC Good packets received -


KETS (packets)

VCG_RXPACKETS Packets received Bad packets, broadcast packets, and


(packets) multicast packets are included.

VCG_RXOCTETS Bytes received (bytes) Bad packets are included (FCS bytes
are included but framing bits are
excluded).

VCG_TXSPEED Speed of bytes Bad packets are included (FCS bytes


transmitted (bytes) are included but framing bits are
excluded).

VCG_RXSPEED Speed of bytes Bad packets are included (FCS bytes


received (bytes) are included but framing bits are
excluded).

C.3.2 EMS6
The RMON performance that the EMS6 Board supported include basic performance, extended
performance, and VCG performance.

The EMS6 board's Ethernet ports PORT1 to PORT6, bridging port PORT7, and internal ports
VCTRUNK1 to VCTRUNK8 are on the EoS plane.

Table C-11 EoS plane RMON Performance Entry List (EMS6)

Categor Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks Source


y Performance Entry Performance Entry Port

Basic RXOCTETS Indicates the bytes RXOCTETS indicates the total PORT1 to
performa received (bytes). number of bytes in received packets PORT7
nce (including bad packets), including
framing bits but not FCS bytes.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 892


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Categor Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks Source


y Performance Entry Performance Entry Port

RXBRDCAST Indicates the broadcast RXBRDCAST indicates the total


packets received number of received good packets
(packets). with broadcast destination
addresses, excluding multicast
packets.

RXMULCAST Indicates the broadcast RXMULCAST indicates the total


packets received number of received good packets
(packets). with multicast destination
addresses, excluding broadcast
packets.

ETHOVER Indicates the oversized Oversized packets are the packets


packets received larger than MTU (including FCS
(packets). bytes but not framing bits).

RXPKTS Indicates the packets Bad packets, broadcast packets, and


received (packets). multicast packets are included.

ETHJAB Indicates the oversized ETHJAB indicates the number of


error packets received received packets that are larger than
(packets). MTU (including FCS bytes but not
framing bits) and contain FCS errors
or alignment errors.

ETHFCS The number of frames -


that have FCS check
errors-

ETHUNDER Undersized packets Indicates the number of received


received (packets) packets that are shorter than 64 bytes
(including FCS bytes but not
framing bits) and do not contain any
other errors except for FCS errors.

ETHFRG Fragments received Indicates the total number of


(packets) received packets that have FCS or
alignment errors (FCS bytes are
included but framing bits are
excluded). The count increases
because of noise collisions.

RXPKT64 Packets received (64 FCS bytes are included but framing
bytes in length) bits are excluded.
(packets)

RXPKT65 Packets received FCS bytes are included but framing


(65-127 bytes in bits are excluded.
length) (packets)

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 893


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Categor Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks Source


y Performance Entry Performance Entry Port

RXPKT128 Packets received FCS bytes are included but framing


(128-255 bytes in bits are excluded.
length) (packets)

RXPKT256 Packets received FCS bytes are included but framing


(256-511 bytes in bits are excluded.
length) (packets)

RXPKT512 Packets received FCS bytes are included but framing


(512-1023 bytes in bits are excluded.
length) (packets)

RXPKT1024 Packets received FCS bytes are included but framing


(1024-1518 bytes in bits are excluded.
length) (packets)

ETHALI The number of An alignment error frame contains a PORT3 to


alignment error frames fractional number of bytes and fails PORT6
to pass the FCS check.

Extended RXCTLPKTS Control frames - PORT1 to


performa received (frames) PORT7
nce
TXOCTETS Bytes transmitted Indicates the total number of bytes
(bytes) (including those in bad packets)
transmitted (including FCS bytes
but not framing bits).

TXPKTS Packets transmitted Bad packets, broadcast packets, and


(packets) multicast packets are included.

TXCTLPKTS Control frames -


transmitted (frame)

TXPKT64 Packets transmitted FCS bytes are included but framing


(64 bytes in length) bits are excluded.
(packets)

TXPKT65 Packets transmitted FCS bytes are included but framing


(65-127 bytes in bits are excluded.
length) (packets)

TXPKT128 Packets transmitted FCS bytes are included but framing


(128-255 bytes in bits are excluded.
length) (packets)

TXPKT256 Packets transmitted FCS bytes are included but framing


(256-511 bytes in bits are excluded.
length) (packets)

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 894


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Categor Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks Source


y Performance Entry Performance Entry Port

TXPKT512 Packets transmitted FCS bytes are included but framing


(512-1023 bytes in bits are excluded.
length) (packets)

TXPKT1024 Packets transmitted FCS bytes are included but framing


(1024-1518 bytes in bits are excluded.
length) (packets)

PKT64 Packets received and FCS bytes are included but framing
transmitted (64 bytes in bits are excluded.
length) (packets)

PKT65 Packets received and FCS bytes are included but framing
transmitted (65-127 bits are excluded.
bytes in length)
(packets)

PKT128 Packets received and FCS bytes are included but framing
transmitted (128-255 bits are excluded.
bytes in length)
(packets)

PKT256 Packets received and FCS bytes are included but framing
transmitted (256-511 bits are excluded.
bytes in length)
(packets)

PKT512 Packets received and FCS bytes are included but framing
transmitted (512-1023 bits are excluded.
bytes in length)
(packets)

PKT1024 Packets received and FCS bytes are included but framing
transmitted bits are excluded.
(1024-1518 bytes in
length) (packets)

RXGOODFULLFRA Indicates the rate of Framing bits (20 bytes) and FCS
MESPEED good full-frame bits bytes are included.
received (Kbit/s).

TXGOODFULLFRA Indicates the rate of Framing bits (20 bytes) and FCS
MESPEED good full-frame bits bytes are included.
transmitted (Kbit/s).

RXFULLBGOOD Indicates the good full- Framing bits (20 bytes) and FCS
frame bytes received bytes are included.
(bytes).

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 895


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Categor Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks Source


y Performance Entry Performance Entry Port

TXFULLBGOOD Indicates the good full- Framing bits (20 bytes) and FCS
frame bytes bytes are included.
transmitted (bytes).

TXMULCAST Indicates the multicast The multicast packets that are


packets transmitted discarded or fail to be transmitted
(packets). are included.

RXUNICAST Indicates the unicast RXUNICAST indicates the number


packets received of good unicast packets.
(packets).

TXUNICAST Indicates the unicast The unicast packets that are


packets transmitted discarded or fail to be transmitted
(packets). are included.

TXBRDCAST Indicates the broadcast The broadcast packets that are


packets transmitted discarded or fail to be transmitted
(packets). are included.

RXPAUSE Indicates the pause RXPAUSE indicates the number of


frames received MAC flow control frames with the
(frames). PAUSE opcode.

TXPAUSE Indicates the pause TXPAUSE indicates the number of


frames transmitted MAC flow control frames with the
(frames). PAUSE opcode.

VCG VCG_TXGOODPAC Good packets - VCTRU


performa KETS transmitted (packets) NK1 to
nce VCTRU
VCG_TXPACKETS Packets transmitted Bad packets, broadcast packets, and NK8
(packets) multicast packets are included.

VCG_TXOCTETS Bytes transmitted Bad packets are included (FCS bytes


(bytes) are included but framing bits are
excluded).

VCG_RXGOODPAC Good packets received -


KETS (packets)

VCG_RXPACKETS Packets received Bad packets, broadcast packets, and


(packets) multicast packets are included.

VCG_RXOCTETS Bytes received (bytes) Bad packets are included (FCS bytes
are included but framing bits are
excluded).

VCG_TXSPEED Speed of bytes Bad packets are included (FCS bytes


transmitted (bytes) are included but framing bits are
excluded).

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 896


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Categor Brief Name of a Full Name of a Remarks Source


y Performance Entry Performance Entry Port

VCG_RXSPEED Speed of bytes Bad packets are included (FCS bytes


received (bytes) are included but framing bits are
excluded).

C.4 RMON Events and Handling Procedures


This chapter describes the RMON events that indicate Ethernet service abnormalities and how
to handle these events.

C.4.1 ETHDROP

Description
ETHDROP indicates the number of events in which packet loss occurs due to resource deficiency
of Ethernet chips. An RMON threshold-crossing event is reported when the number of packet
loss events is higher than the upper threshold or lower than the lower threshold.

NOTE

For the ISV3 board, ETHDROP counts packet loss events caused by congestion.
For the ISU2 and ISX2 boards, ETHDROP counts packet loss events caused by exceptions or congestion.
For other boards, ETHDROP counts packet loss events caused by insufficient Ethernet chip resources, but
does not count packet loss events caused by link congestion and other reasons.

Impact on System
When packet loss occurs frequently, services are affected and the system is affected seriously.
Hence, you must rectify the fault immediately.

Possible Causes
This performance event indicates packet loss due to the full MAC buffer, FIFO overflow, or
backward pressure.

l The lower threshold is not set to a non-zero value.


l The hardware at the local end is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Handle this alarm according to the specific performance event.

If... Then...
The number is lower than the lower Change the lower threshold to 0.
threshold

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 897


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

If... Then...
The number is higher than the upper Manually decrease the traffic transmitted from
threshold the opposite end. If the problem persists, go to
the next step.

Step 2 Replace the involved part.

----End

Reference
None.

C.4.2 ETHEXCCOL

Description
ETHEXCCOL indicates the number of frames that fail to be transmitted due to continuous port
collisions. An RMON threshold-crossing event is reported when the number of frames that fail
to be transmitted is higher than the upper threshold or lower than the lower threshold. Generally,
the value indicates that 16 port collisions occur continuously when the same frame is transmitted.

Impact on System
The opposite equipment fails to normally receive services.

Possible Causes
Generally, this event is caused when the local port is connected to a device that work in half-
duplex mode.

Procedure
Step 1 Handle this alarm according to the specific performance event.

If... Then...
The number is lower than the lower threshold Change the lower threshold to 0.
The number is higher than the upper threshold Go to the next step.

Step 2 On the NMS, query the working modes of the ports on the equipment at both ends.

If... Then...
The ports on the equipment at both ends Set the working modes of the ports on the
work in inconsistent modes, or any port equipment at both ends to full-duplex or auto-
works in half-duplex mode negotiation, so that these ports work in
consistent modes.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 898


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

If... Then...
The ports on the equipment at both ends Go to the next step.
work in consistent modes and no ports work
in half-duplex mode

Step 3 Replace the involved part.

----End

Reference
None.

C.4.3 ETHLATECOL
Description
ETHLATECOL indicates the number of collisions detected within a timeslot period after a
packet is transmitted. An RMON threshold-crossing event is reported when the number of
collisions is higher than the upper threshold or lower than the lower threshold.

Impact on System
The opposite equipment fails to normally receive services.

Possible Causes
Generally, this performance event is caused by a large network diameter.

Procedure
Step 1 Handle this alarm according to the specific performance event.

If... Then...
The number is lower than the lower threshold Change the lower threshold to 0.
The number is higher than the upper threshold Go to the next step.

Step 2 On the NMS, query the working modes of the ports on the equipment at both ends.

If... Then...
The ports on the equipment at both ends Set the working modes of the ports on the
work in inconsistent modes, or any port equipment at both ends to full-duplex or auto-
works in half-duplex mode negotiation, so that these ports work in
consistent modes.
The ports on the equipment at both ends Go to the next step.
work in consistent modes and no ports work
in half-duplex mode

Step 3 Check whether the network diameter of the LAN is very large according to the networking
planning information.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 899


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

If... Then...
The network diameter is very large Divide the network and deploy equipment to
different buses or physically shared devices (such as
hubs).
NOTE
In the case of the 10 Mbit/s port rate, the maximum Ethernet
diameter is 2000 m. In the case of the 100 Mbit/s port rate,
the maximum Ethernet diameter is 200 m.

The network diameter is appropriate Go to the next step.

Step 4 Replace the involved part.

----End

Reference
None.

C.4.4 RXBBAD

Description
RXBBAD indicates the total number of bytes in received bad packets, excluding the framing
bit but including the FCS byte. An RMON threshold-crossing event is reported when the total
number of bytes in received bad packets is higher than the upper threshold or lower than the
lower threshold.

Impact on System
A port discards bad packets. This may even interrupt system services.

Possible Causes
1. Errors occur when the opposite end transmits packets.
2. The transmission line is of the poor quality and bit errors exist.
3. The hardware at the local end is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Handle this alarm according to the specific performance event.

If... Then...
The number is lower than the lower threshold Change the lower threshold to 0.
The number is higher than the upper threshold Go to the next step.

Step 2 Correct the errors that occur when the opposite end transmits packets.

Step 3 Handle the problem of poor quality of the transmission line.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 900


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Check whether the ETH_LOS alarm is reported at the local end because the external line is
damaged or over attenuated. If yes, see the related handling method to clear the alarm.

Step 4 Replace the involved part.

----End

Reference
None.

C.4.5 TXDEFFRM

Description
TXDEFFRM indicates the number of frames the first transmission of which is delayed due to
the congestion on the transmission media, excluding the number of frames the first transmission
of which is delayed due to collisions. An RMON threshold-crossing event is reported when the
number of frames that fail to be transmitted is higher than the upper threshold and lower than
the lower threshold.

Impact on System
The rate of frame transmission decreases, and therefore packets are congested at a port and the
throughput of the port decreases.

Possible Causes
Generally, this event is caused when the external port at the local end is connected to a device
that work in half-duplex mode.

Procedure
Step 1 Handle this alarm according to the specific performance event.

If... Then...
The number is lower than the lower threshold Change the lower threshold to 0.
The number is higher than the upper threshold Go to the next step.

Step 2 On the NMS, query the working modes of the ports on the equipment at both ends.

If... Then...
The ports on the equipment at both ends Set the working modes of the ports on the
work in inconsistent modes, or any port equipment at both ends to full-duplex or auto-
works in half-duplex mode negotiation, so that these ports work in
consistent modes.
The ports on the equipment at both ends Go to the next step.
work in consistent modes and no ports work
in half-duplex mode

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 901


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Step 3 Replace the involved part.

----End

Reference
None.

C.4.6 ETHUNDER

Description
ETHUNDER indicates that an RMON threshold-crossing event is reported when the number of
packets that are shorter than 64 bytes and are received on the line side crosses the preset threshold.

Impact on System
The data frames whose length is not within the specific range are discarded. As a result, the
system services are affected.

Possible Causes
1. The length of a data frame that is received at a port is shorter than 64 bytes.
2. The hardware at the local end is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Check whether the opposite equipment transmits the packet that is shorter than 64 bytes.

If... Then...
The opposite equipment transmits the packet Rectify the fault on the opposite equipment.
that is shorter than 64 bytes
The opposite end does not transmit the Go to the next step.
packet that is shorter than 64 bytes

Step 2 Replace the involved part.

----End

Reference
None.

C.4.7 ETHOVER

Description
ETHOVER indicates that an RMON threshold-crossing event is reported when the number of
packets that are longer than MTU and are received at a port crosses the preset threshold.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 902


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Impact on System
If the length of the data frame received at a port is more than the preset maximum frame length,
the data frame is discarded and therefore the system services are affected.

Possible Causes
1. The preset maximum frame length is less than the length of the frame that is received at a
port.
2. The hardware at the local end is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Check whether the opposite equipment transmits the packet that is longer than the maximum
frame length set for the local equipment.

If... Then...
The opposite equipment transmits the Notify the opposite equipment that the length
packet that is longer than the maximum of transmitted frames should be changed.
frame length set for the local equipment
The opposite equipment does not transmit Go to the next step.
the packet that is longer than the maximum
frame length set for the local equipment

Step 2 Replace the involved part.

----End

Reference
None.

C.4.8 ETHFRG

Description
ETHFRG indicates that an RMON threshold-crossing event is reported when the number of
received packets that are shorter than 64 bytes and have FCS or alignment errors exceeds the
preset upper threshold.

Impact on System
Data transmission is delayed or packet loss occurs.

Possible Causes
l The working modes of the ports on the equipment at both ends are not consistent.
l The hardware at the local end is faulty.
l The ports on the equipment at both ends work in half-duplex mode, and the data traffic is
very heavy.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 903


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Procedure
Step 1 Check whether the working modes of the ports on the equipment at both ends are consistent.

If... Then...
The working modes are consistent Go to the next step.
The working modes are not consistent Change the working mode of the local port so that
the ports on the equipment at both ends work in
consistent modes.

Step 2 Check whether the working modes of the ports on the equipment at both ends are set to the half-
duplex mode.

If... Then...
The working modes are not set to the half- Go to the next step.
duplex mode
The working modes are set to the half- Change the working modes of the ports on the
duplex mode equipment at both ends to the full-duplex mode
or adaptive mode.

Step 3 Replace the involved part.

----End

C.4.9 ETHJAB

Description
ETHJAB indicates that an RMON threshold-crossing alarm is reported when the number of
received packets that are longer than MTU and have FCS or alignment errors is higher than the
upper threshold.

Impact on the System


Data transmission is delayed or packet loss occurs.

Possible Causes
l The working modes of the ports on the equipment at both ends are not consistent.
l The hardware at the local end is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Check whether the working modes of the ports on the equipment at both ends are consistent.

If... Then...
The working modes are consistent Go to the next step.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 904


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

If... Then...
The working modes are not consistent Change the working mode of the local port so that
the ports on the equipment at both ends work in
consistent modes.

Step 2 Replace the involved part.

----End

C.4.10 ETHCOL

Description
ETHCOL indicates the number of detected packet collisions. An RMON threshold-crossing
event is reported when the number of collisions is higher than the upper threshold or lower than
the lower threshold.

Impact on System
The opposite equipment fails to normally receive services.

Possible Causes
Generally, this event is caused when the local port is connected to a large number of devices
that work in half-duplex mode.

Procedure
Step 1 Handle this alarm according to the specific performance event.

If... Then...
The number is lower than the lower threshold Change the lower threshold to 0.
The number is higher than the upper threshold Go to the next step.

Step 2 On the NMS, query the working modes of the ports on the equipment at both ends.

If... Then...
The ports on the equipment at both ends Set the working modes of the ports on the
work in inconsistent modes, or any port equipment at both ends to full-duplex or auto-
works in half-duplex mode negotiation, so that these ports work in
consistent modes.
The ports on the equipment at both ends Go to the next step.
work in consistent modes and no ports work
in half-duplex mode

Step 3 Replace the involved part.

----End

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 905


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Reference
None.

C.4.11 ETHFCS

Description
ETHFCS indicates the number of received Ethernet data frames with FCS check errors at the
local end (excluding the oversized and undersized frames). An RMON threshold-crossing event
is reported when the number is higher than the upper threshold or lower than the lower threshold.

Impact on System
Most ports discard the packets with FCS check errors. The system services are interrupted in
the worst case.

Possible Causes
1. The local port and opposite port work in inconsistent modes. For example, one port works
in full-duplex mode, and the opposite port works in half-duplex mode.
2. The transmission line is of the poor quality and bit errors exist.
3. The hardware at the local end is faulty.

Procedure
Step 1 Therefore, handle the alarm according to the specific performance event.

If... Then...
The number is lower than the lower threshold Change the lower threshold to 0.
The number is higher than the upper threshold Go to the next step.

Step 2 On the NMS, query the working modes of the ports on the equipment at both ends.

If... Then...
The ports on the equipment at both ends Change the working modes of the ports on the
work in inconsistent modes equipment at both ends so that they can work
in consistent modes
The ports on the equipment at both ends Go to the next step.
work in consistent modes

Step 3 Replace the involved part.

----End

Reference
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 906


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

C.4.12 ATMPW_LOSPKTS

Description
The ATMPW_LOSPKTS is a performance event indicating the number of lost ATM PW
packets.

Impact on the System


None.

Possible Causes
1. Signals on the radio link deteriorate.
2. A strong interference source is present near the equipment.
3. A board at the transmit or receive end is faulty.
4. The operating temperature of the equipment is very high.

Procedure
Step 1 Handle the fault on the radio link. For details, see 5.3 Troubleshooting the Radio Link.

Step 2 Remove the interference source near the equipment and then check whether the performance
event is cleared.

Step 3 On the NMS, query the working modes of the ports on the equipment at both ends.

Step 4 Replace the faulty board and then check whether the performance event is cleared.

Step 5 Rectify the fault in the fan so that the fan lowers the operating temperature of the equipment.

----End

Related Information
None.

C.4.13 ATMPW_MISORDERPKTS

Description
The ATMPW_MISORDERPKTS is a performance event indicating the number of disordered
ATM PW packets.

Impact on the System


None.

Possible Causes
1. Signals on the radio link deteriorate.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 907


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

2. A strong interference source is present near the equipment.


3. A board at the transmit or receive end is faulty.
4. The operating temperature of the equipment is very high.

Procedure
Step 1 Handle the fault on the radio link. For details, see 5.3 Troubleshooting the Radio Link.

Step 2 Remove the interference source near the equipment and then check whether the performance
event is cleared.

Step 3 On the NMS, query the working modes of the ports on the equipment at both ends.

Step 4 Replace the faulty board and then check whether the performance event is cleared.

Step 5 Rectify the fault in the fan so that the fan lowers the operating temperature of the equipment.

----End

Related Information
None.

C.4.14 ATMPW_UNKNOWNCELLS

Description
The ATMPW_UNKNOWNCELLS a performance event indicating the number of unknown
cells in an ATM PW service.

Impact on the System


None.

Possible Causes
1. Signals on the radio link deteriorate.
2. A strong interference source is present near the equipment.
3. A board at the transmit or receive end is faulty.
4. The operating temperature of the equipment is very high.

Procedure
Step 1 Handle the fault on the radio link. For details, see 5.3 Troubleshooting the Radio Link.

Step 2 Remove the interference source near the equipment and then check whether the performance
event is cleared.

Step 3 On the NMS, query the working modes of the ports on the equipment at both ends.

Step 4 Replace the faulty board and then check whether the performance event is cleared.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 908


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Step 5 Rectify the fault in the fan so that the fan lowers the operating temperature of the equipment.

----End

Related Information
None.

C.4.15 ATM_CORRECTED_HCSERR

Description
The ATM_CORRECTED_HCSERR is a performance event indicating the number of cells that
are received by an ATM port and contain correctable header check sequence (HCS) errors.

Impact on the System


None.

Possible Causes
1. A strong interference source is present near the equipment.
2. A board at the transmit or receive end is faulty.
3. The operating temperature of the equipment is very high.

Procedure
Step 1 Remove the interference source near the equipment and then check whether the performance
event is cleared.

Step 2 On the NMS, query the working modes of the ports on the equipment at both ends.

Step 3 Replace the faulty board and then check whether the performance event is cleared.

Step 4 Rectify the fault in the fan so that the fan lowers the operating temperature of the equipment.

----End

Related Information
None.

C.4.16 ATM_UNCORRECTED_HCSERR

Description
The ATM_UNCORRECTED_HCSERR is a performance event indicating the number of cells
that are received by an ATM port and contain uncorrectable header check sequence (HCS) errors.

Impact on the System


None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 909


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Possible Causes
1. Signals on the radio link deteriorate.
2. A strong interference source is present near the equipment.
3. A board at the transmit or receive end is faulty.
4. The operating temperature of the equipment is very high.

Procedure
Step 1 Refer to 5.3 Troubleshooting the Radio Link and handle the fault on the radio link.

Step 2 Remove the interference source near the equipment and then check whether the performance
event is cleared.

Step 3 Replace the faulty board and then check whether the performance event is cleared.

Step 4 Rectify the fault in the fan so that the fan lowers the operating temperature of the equipment.

----End

Related Information
None.

C.4.17 CES_MISORDERPKTS

Description
The CES_MISORDERPKTS is a performance event indicating the count of lost disordered CES
PW packets.

Impact on the System


The packets are disordered. As a result, the packet loss rate increases and services are affected.

Possible Causes
1. Signals degrade on the link.
2. The link is looped.
3. The link is congested.

Related Alarms
CES_MISORDERPKT_EXC

Procedure
Step 1 See 5.3 Troubleshooting the Radio Link.

Step 2 Release the loop.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 910


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Step 3 Check the bandwidth utilization. If the bandwidth is exhausted, increase the bandwidth or
eliminate any source that transmits a large amount of invalid data.

----End

Related Information
None.

C.4.18 CES_STRAYPKTS

Description
The CES_STRAYPKTS is a performance event indicating the number of misconnected packets
in a period.

Impact on the System


The packets are discarded. As a result, the packet loss rate increases and services are affected.

Possible Causes
1. Links are misconnected.

Related Alarms
CES_STRAYPKT_EXC

Procedure
Step 1 Check the link configuration and rectify the fault.

----End

Related Information
None.

C.4.19 CES_MALPKTS

Description
The CES_MALPKTS is a performance event indicating the number of deformed CES packets
in a period.

Impact on the System


The packets are discarded. As a result, the packet loss rate increases and services are affected.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 911


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Possible Causes
1. The RTP head enabling status is different between the two ends of the PW.
2. Bit errors occur on the link.

Related Alarms
CES_MALPKT_EXC

Procedure
Step 1 Set the RTP head enabling status to the same on the two ends of the PW. For details, see
Modifying CES Service Parameters.

----End

Related Information
None.

C.4.20 CES_JTRUDR

Description
The CES_JTRUDR is a performance event indicating the number of jitter buffer underflows.

Impact on the System


When no packets are transmitted from the jitter buffer, the buffer underflows.

Possible Causes
1. Signals degrade on the link.
2. The PSN network clocks used for the transmission of CES services are not synchronized.
3. The link is looped.
4. The link is congested.
5. The size of buffer area is set to a low value.

Related Alarms
CES_JTRUDR_EXC

Procedure
Step 1 Troubleshoot the link. For details, see 5.3 Troubleshooting the Radio Link.

Step 2 Synchronize the PSN network clock by setting clock synchronization, reducing transmission
nodes, and optimizing transmission routes.

Step 3 Release the loop.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 912


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

Step 4 Check the bandwidth utilization. If the bandwidth is exhausted, increase the bandwidth or
eliminate any source that transmits a large amount of invalid data.

Step 5 Query the size of buffer area. For details, see Querying CES Service Information.

Step 6 Determine whether the size can be increased according to network planning. If yes, change the
size to a greater value. For details, see Managing CES Services.

----End

Related Information
None.

C.4.21 CES_JTROVR

Description
The CES_JTROVR is a performance event indicating the number of jitter buffer overflows.

Impact on the System


The jitter buffer is insufficient. As a result, the buffer overflows.

Possible Causes
1. The jitter buffer area is too small.
2. The clocks are not synchronous.
3. Link quality deteriorates, causing more jitters.
4. There are too many hops of radio link on the network side, causing a large number of jitters.

Related Alarms
CES_JTROVR_EXC

Procedure
Step 1 Allocate a larger jitter buffer area.

Step 2 Check whether the LTI and other clock-related alarms are reported.

Step 3 Handle the fault on the radio link. For details, see 5.3 Troubleshooting the Radio Link.

Step 4 Determine whether the hops can be reduced according to network planning. If yes, reduce the
hops of radio link on the network side.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 913


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide C RMON Event Reference

C.4.22 CES_LOSPKTS

Description
The CES_LOSPKTS is a performance event indicating the number of CES packets lost in a
period.

Impact on the System


When this alarm occurs, all 1s are inserted and services are interrupted.

Possible Causes
1. The link transmission quality is poor.
2. The link is configured as a loop.
3. Link congestion occurs.

Related Alarms
CES_LOSPKT_EXC

Procedure
Step 1 Handle the fault on the radio link. For details, see 5.3 Troubleshooting the Radio Link.

Step 2 Release the loop.

Step 3 Check the bandwidth utilization. If the bandwidth is exhausted, increase the bandwidth or
eliminate any source that transmits a large amount of invalid data.

----End

Related Information
None.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 914


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide D Alarm Management

D Alarm Management

The alarm management on the OptiX RTN 980 is classified into the NE alarm management and
board alarm management.

D.1 NE Alarm Management


The NE alarm management function set by user is applicable to all the boards on the NE.

D.2 Board Alarm Management


The board alarm management function is only applicable to the board on which users have
configured this function.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 915


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide D Alarm Management

D.1 NE Alarm Management


The NE alarm management function set by user is applicable to all the boards on the NE.

The equipment supports the following NE alarm management functions:

l Settings of the alarm storage mode


l Setting of the alarm delay
l Setting of the alarm reversion mode

For details about these functions, see the manuals or online Help of the NMS.

D.2 Board Alarm Management


The board alarm management function is only applicable to the board on which users have
configured this function.

D.2.1 Setting the Alarm Severity


Alarms are classified into four levels: critical, major, minor, and warning, according to their
severities. The maintenance personnel can change the alarm severity by using the NMS.

This function is supported by all the boards.

l Critical alarm: A critical alarm indicates a critical problem with the network. A critical
problem can be the failure, overload, or system restart of mission-critical boards. It must
be cleared immediately. Otherwise, system breakdown may occur.
l Major alarm: A major alarm indicates failure of certain boards or links, such as
communication links. Urgent action is required to rectify the fault as this type of alarms
affects the QoS of the system.
l Minor alarm: A minor alarm indicates a non-service affecting problem that needs to be
solved, for example, fan speed exceeds threshold alarm. This type of alarms does not affect
the QoS of the system, but you need to locate and remove these faults in time.
l Warning alarm: A warning alarm indicates a potential error that may affect the QoS of the
system, for example, License file expiring precaution alarm. This type of alarms needs to
be handled based on actual conditions.

Critical alarms and major alarms need to be handled immediately to avoid system failures and
service interruptions.

D.2.2 Alarm Suppression


The maintenance personnel can change the alarm monitoring attribute by setting the alarm
suppression function. A board detects only the alarms that are not suppressed. The alarm
suppression function helps users to ignore their unconcerned alarms.

This function is supported by all the boards.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 916


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide D Alarm Management

D.2.3 Alarm Auto-Report


If Alarm Auto-Report is set to Reported, all the detected alarms are reported to the NMS in a
timely manner. If Alarm Auto-Report is set to Not Report, the alarms are reported only when
alarm query is performed on the NMS. The maintenance personnel can change the setting on
the NMS.

This function is supported by all the boards.

D.2.4 Alarm Reversion


In the case of a port that is not configured with services, certain alarms may be reported. To filter
the alarms that users are not concerned, set these alarms to be reversed. In this manner, the alarm
status at this port is the opposite to the actual case. That is, the status is displayed as normal
when an alarm is actually reported.

The alarm reversion function is available in three modes, namely, non-reversion, automatic
reversion, and manual reversion.

l Non-revertive (Disable)
In this mode, the alarms are monitored by default and alarm reversion cannot be enabled
for a port.
l Auto restore
In this mode, alarm reversion can be enabled for a port where alarms are reported. After
alarm reversion is enabled at a port, alarms are not reported. When the current alarm is
cleared, the alarm reversion automatically changes to the disabled status. That is, it changes
to the non-reversion mode. Then, the alarm reporting status at the port is the same as the
actual status.
l Manual restore
In this mode, alarm reversion can be enabled for a port regardless of whether any alarms
are reported at the port. After alarm reversion is enabled, the alarm reporting status at the
port is opposite to the actual status. After alarm reversion is manually disabled, the alarm
reversion status changes to the non-reversion mode. Then, the alarm reporting status at the
port is the same as the actual status.

Pay attention to the following points when you set the alarm reversion function:

l For OptiX RTN 980, only R_LOS, T_ALOS, MW_LOF, ETH_LOS, and LAN_LOC
alarms support alarm reversion.
l Alarm reversion is set based on ports. Configurations are required at both the NE level and
the port level.
l Alarm reversion does not change the actual status of alarms on the board, as well as the
indication status of the alarm indicators.
l Alarm reversion is realized on the NE software. The alarm data is the same on the NE and
the NMS, which indicates the status after the alarm reversion. If you directly query the
alarm data of a board, however, the actual alarm status is returned.

D.2.5 Setting of the Bit Error Alarm Threshold


When the number of bit errors detected by a board exceeds a specified number, the board
generates a bit error alarm. This specific number is the bit error alarm threshold, and the setting

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 917


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide D Alarm Management

of this threshold is supported by all the bit error threshold-crossing and degrading alarms on the
NE.

Table D-1 Setting of the bit error alarm threshold

Alarm Name Default Alarm Threshold Applicable Board

B1_EXC 10-3 ISV3, ISX2, ISU2, SL4D,


SL1DA, SL1D, IF1
B1_SD 10-6

B2_EXC 10-3 ISV3, ISX2, ISU2, SL1DA,


SL4D, SL1D, IF1
B2_SD 10-6

B3_EXC 10-3 ISV3, ISX2, ISU2, SL1DA,


SL4D, SL1D, IF1
B3_SD 10-6

BIP_EXC 10-3 ISV3, ISU2, ISX2, EFP8,


EMS6, SP3S, SP3D, IFU2,
BIP_SD 10-6 IFX2

MW_BER_EXC 10-3 ISV3, ISU2, ISX2, IFU2,


IFX2
MW_BER_SD 10-6

D.2.6 AIS Insertion


AIS insertion can be set for certain alarms reported on a board. When the board detects the
alarms, it inserts all 1s into the lower level service to indicate the remote end that the service is
unavailable.

Table D-2 Setting of the AIS insertion

Trigger Condition Default Value Applicable Board

B1_EXC Enabled ISV3, ISX2, ISU2, IF1,


SL1D, SL1DA, SL4D
B2_SD Disabled

B2_EXC Disabled

HP_LOM Enabled

HP_TIM Disabled

HP_SLM Disabled

HP_UNEQ Disabled

B3_EXC Enabled

B3_SD Disabled

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 918


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide D Alarm Management

Trigger Condition Default Value Applicable Board

B1_SD Disabled

LP_TIM Disabled SP3S and SP3D

LP_UNEQ Disabled

LP_SLM Disabled

BIP_EXC Disabled

MW_BER_EXC Enabled ISV3, ISU2, ISX2, IFX2 and


IFU2
MW_BER_SD Disabled

NOTE

l When the SL1D/SL4D/SL1DA//ISU2/ISX2/ISV3 board detects the R_LOS, R_LOF, MS_AIS,


AU_AIS, or AU_LOP alarm, it forcibly inserts the AIS.
l When the IF1/ISU2/ISX2/ISV3 board detects the MW_LOF, MW_LIM, R_LOF, MS_AIS,
AU_AIS, or AU_LOP alarm, it forcibly inserts the AIS.
l When the IFX2 and IFU2 board detect the MW_LOF, MW_LIM, or R_LOF alarm, it forcibly inserts
the AIS.

D.2.7 UNEQ Insertion


When a board detects that the service path is not in use or that the LOS alarm exists, it inserts
all 0s into the service signal to notify the remote end that this signal is unavailable.

Table D-3 Setting of the UNEQ insertion

Trigger Condition Default Value Applicable Board

T_ALOS Disabled SP3S and SP3D

Service path being not in use Disabled

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 919


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide E Performance Event Management

E Performance Event Management

The performance event management is classified into the NE performance event management
and board performance event management.

E.1 NE Performance Event Management


The NE performance event management function set by user is applicable to all the boards on
the NE.

E.2 Board Performance Event Management


The performance event management function is only applicable to the board on which users
have configured this function.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 920


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide E Performance Event Management

E.1 NE Performance Event Management


The NE performance event management function set by user is applicable to all the boards on
the NE.

The supports the following NE performance event management functions:

l Setting NE performance event monitoring


l Setting the start/end time of performance events
l Enabling/Disabling the reporting of UAT events

For details about these functions, see the manuals or online Help of the NMS.

E.2 Board Performance Event Management


The performance event management function is only applicable to the board on which users
have configured this function.

Table E-1 Board performance event management function

Function Applicable Board

Setting 15-minute/24- ISV3, CQ1, SL1DA, EMS6, SL1D, SP3S, SP3D, SL4D, CSHN,
hour performance ODU, IFX2, IFU2, ISU2, ISX2, ML1, MD1, EFP8, IF1
monitoring

Setting 15-minute/24- ISV3, CQ1, SL1DA, EMS6, SL1D, SP3S, SP3D, SL4D, CSHN,
hour performance event ODU, IFX2, IFU2, ISU2, ISX2, ML1, MD1, EFP8, IF1
auto-reporting

Setting performance ISV3, CQ1, SL1DA, EMS6, SL1D, SL4D, SP3S, SP3D, IFX2,
thresholds IFU2, ISU2, ISX2, ML1, MD1CSHN, MP1, EFP8, IF1

Resetting the ISV3, SL1DA, SL1D, SL4D, SP3S, SP3D, ODU, IFX2, IFU2,
performance register ISU2, ISX2, IF1

Generating performance ISV3, CQ1, SL1DA, EMS6, SL1D, SL4D, SP3S, SP3D, ODU,
threshold-crossing IFX2, IFU2, ISU2, ISX2, ML1, MD1, EFP8, IF1
alarms

Monitoring UAT events ISV3, CQ1, SL1DA, EMS6, SL1D, SL4D, SP3S, SP3D, IFX2,
IFU2, ISU2, ISX2, EFP8, IF1

Monitoring CSES ISV3, CQ1, SL1DA, EMS6, SL1D, SL4D, SP3S, SP3D, IFX2,
performance events IFU2, ISU2, ISX2, EFP8, IF1

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 921


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide F Alarm Suppression Relationship

F Alarm Suppression Relationship

When the alarm suppression function is disabled on an NE, the root alarm and certain correlated
alarms are reported if a fault occurs on this NE. After the alarm suppression function is enabled,
the reporting of the correlated alarms is suppressed according to the relationship between alarms
when the root alarm is reported. The alarm suppression relationship can be classified into the
suppression relationship between intra-board alarms and suppression relationship between inter-
board alarms.

F.1 Alarm Suppression on TDM Plane


This section describes the alarm suppression relationship for SDH/PDH signals and IF signals
on the TDM plane.

F.2 Alarm Suppression on Data Plane


This section describes the alarm suppression relationship for Ethernet, MPLS tunnel, PW, ATM/
IMA, PPP/MLPPP, and EoS/EoPDH services.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 922


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide F Alarm Suppression Relationship

F.1 Alarm Suppression on TDM Plane


This section describes the alarm suppression relationship for SDH/PDH signals and IF signals
on the TDM plane.

Intra-board Alarm Suppression on TDM Plane

Table F-1 Suppression relationship between intra-board alarms (IF1 board)

Root Alarm Suppressed Alarm

MW_LOF R_LOS, R_LOC, MW_FEC_UNCOR, R_LOF, MW_LIM,


MW_RDI, B1_EXC, B1_SD, B2_EXC, B2_SD, MS_AIS, MS_RDI,
MS_REI, AU_AIS, AU_LOP, B3_EXC, B3_SD, HP_UNEQ,
HP_TIM, HP_SLM, HP_RDI, HP_LOM, HP_REI

MW_LIM MW_RDI

R_LOC R_LOF, MW_LIM, MW_RDI, B1_EXC, B1_SD, B2_EXC, B2_SD,


MS_AIS, MS_RDI, MS_REI, AU_AIS, AU_LOP, B3_EXC, B3_SD,
HP_UNEQ, HP_TIM, HP_SLM, HP_RDI, HP_LOM, HP_REI

R_LOF MW_LIM, MW_RDI, B1_EXC, B1_SD, B2_EXC, B2_SD, MS_AIS,


MS_RDI, MS_REI, AU_AIS, AU_LOP, B3_EXC, B3_SD,
HP_UNEQ, HP_TIM, HP_SLM, HP_RDI, HP_LOM, HP_REI

MS_AIS MS_RDI, MS_REI, AU_AIS, AU_LOP, B3_EXC, B3_SD,


HP_UNEQ, HP_TIM, HP_SLM, HP_RDI, HP_LOM, HP_REI

B1_EXC B1_SD, MS_REI

B2_EXC B2_SD, MS_REI

AU_AIS AU_LOP, B3_EXC, B3_SD, HP_UNEQ, HP_TIM, HP_SLM,


HP_RDI, HP_LOM, HP_REI

AU_LOP B3_EXC, B3_SD, HP_UNEQ, HP_TIM, HP_SLM, HP_RDI,


HP_LOM, HP_REI

B3_EXC B3_SD

HP_UNEQ HP_TIM

Table F-2 Suppression relationship between intra-board alarms (IFU2/IFX2/ISU2/ISX2/ISV3


board, E1+Ethernet service mode)

Root Alarm Suppressed Alarm

MW_LOF R_LOC, R_LOF, MW_LIM, MW_RDI, MW_BER_EXC,


MW_BER_SD, MW_FEC_UNCOR, MW_E1_LOST

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 923


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide F Alarm Suppression Relationship

Root Alarm Suppressed Alarm

R_LOC R_LOF, MW_LIM, MW_RDI, MW_BER_EXC, MW_BER_SD

R_LOF MW_LIM, MW_RDI, MW_BER_EXC, MW_BER_SD,


MW_E1_LOST

MW_BER_E MW_BER_SD
XC

TU_AIS TU_LOP, LP_TIM, LP_UNEQ, LP_RDI, LP_REI, BIP_EXC,


BIP_SD

TU_LOP LP_TIM, LP_UNEQ, LP_RDI, LP_REI, BIP_EXC, BIP_SD,

LP_UNEQ LP_RDI, LP_RFI

LP_RDI LP_REI

BIP_EXC BIP_SD

Table F-3 Suppression relationship between intra-board alarms (ISU2/ISX2/ISV3 board,


STM-1+Ethernet service mode)

Root Alarm Suppressed Alarm

MW_LOF R_LOC, MW_FEC_UNCOR, R_LOF, MW_LIM, MW_RDI,


B1_EXC, B1_SD, B2_EXC, B2_SD, MS_AIS, MS_RDI, MS_REI,
AU_AIS, AU_LOP, B3_EXC, B3_SD, HP_UNEQ, HP_TIM,
HP_SLM, HP_RDI, HP_LOM, HP_REI, MW_E1_LOST

MW_LIM MW_RDI

R_LOC R_LOF, MW_LIM, MW_RDI, B1_EXC, B1_SD, B2_EXC, B2_SD,


MS_AIS, MS_RDI, MS_REI, AU_AIS, AU_LOP, B3_EXC, B3_SD,
HP_UNEQ, HP_TIM, HP_SLM, HP_RDI, HP_LOM, HP_REI

R_LOF MW_LIM, MW_RDI, B1_EXC, B1_SD, B2_EXC, B2_SD, MS_AIS,


MS_RDI, MS_REI, AU_AIS, AU_LOP, B3_EXC, B3_SD,
HP_UNEQ, HP_TIM, HP_SLM, HP_RDI, HP_LOM, HP_REI,
MW_E1_LOST

MS_AIS MS_RDI, MS_REI, AU_AIS, AU_LOP, B3_EXC, B3_SD,


HP_UNEQ, HP_TIM, HP_SLM, HP_RDI, HP_LOM, HP_REI

B1_EXC B1_SD, MS_REI

B2_EXC B2_SD, MS_REI

AU_AIS AU_LOP, B3_EXC, B3_SD, HP_UNEQ, HP_TIM, HP_SLM,


HP_RDI, HP_LOM, HP_REI

AU_LOP B3_EXC, B3_SD, HP_UNEQ, HP_TIM, HP_SLM, HP_RDI,


HP_LOM, HP_REI

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 924


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide F Alarm Suppression Relationship

Root Alarm Suppressed Alarm

B3_EXC B3_SD

HP_UNEQ HP_TIM

Table F-4 Suppression relationship between intra-board alarms (SL1D/SL1DA/SL4D board)

Root Alarm Suppressed Alarm

LSR_NO_FIT R_LOS, R_LOC, R_LOF, J0_MM, B1_EXC, B1_SD, MS_AIS,


ED B2_EXC, B2_SD, MS_RDI, MS_REI, AU_AIS, AU_LOP, B3_EXC,
B3_SD, HP_UNEQ, HP_TIM, HP_RDI, HP_REI, HP_SLM,
HP_LOM, IN_PWR_LOW, IN_PWR_HIGH, LASER_CLOSED,
LASER_MOD_ERR_EX, TF, OUT_PWR_ABN

R_LOS R_LOF, J0_MM, B1_EXC, B1_SD, MS_AIS, B2_EXC, B2_SD,


MS_RDI, MS_REI, AU_AIS, AU_LOP, B3_EXC, B3_SD,
HP_UNEQ, HP_TIM, HP_RDI, HP_REI, HP_SLM, HP_LOM,
IN_PWR_LOW

R_LOC R_LOF, J0_MM, B1_EXC, B1_SD, MS_AIS, B2_EXC, B2_SD,


MS_RDI, MS_REI, AU_AIS, AU_LOP, B3_EXC, B3_SD,
HP_UNEQ, HP_TIM, HP_RDI, HP_REI, HP_SLM, HP_LOM

R_LOF J0_MM, B1_EXC, B1_SD, MS_AIS, B2_EXC, B2_SD, MS_RDI,


MS_REI, AU_AIS, AU_LOP, B3_EXC, B3_SD, HP_UNEQ,
HP_TIM, HP_RDI, HP_REI, HP_SLM, HP_LOM

MS_AIS B2_EXC, B2_SD, MS_RDI, MS_REI, AU_AIS, AU_LOP, B3_EXC,


B3_SD, HP_UNEQ, HP_TIM, HP_RDI, HP_REI, HP_SLM,
HP_LOM

MS_RDI MS_REI

AU_AIS AU_LOP, B3_EXC, B3_SD, HP_UNEQ, HP_TIM, HP_RDI,


HP_REI, HP_SLM, HP_LOM

AU_LOP B3_EXC, B3_SD, HP_UNEQ, HP_TIM, HP_RDI, HP_REI,


HP_SLM, HP_LOM

HP_UNEQ HP_TIM, HP_RDI, HP_LOM

HP_RDI HP_REI

B1_EXC B1_SD, MS_REI

B2_EXC B2_SD, MS_REI

B3_EXC B3_SD

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 925


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide F Alarm Suppression Relationship

Table F-5 Suppression relationship between intra-board alarms (SP3S/SP3D board)

Root Alarm Suppressed Alarm

TU_AIS TU_LOP, LP_SLM, DOWN_E1_AIS, LP_R_FIFO, LP_UNEQ,


LP_TIM, LP_RFI, LP_RDI, LP_REI, BIP_EXC, BIP_SD

TU_LOP LP_SLM, DOWN_E1_AIS, LP_R_FIFO, LP_UNEQ, LP_TIM,


LP_RFI, LP_RDI, LP_REI, BIP_EXC, BIP_SD

LP_UNEQ LP_TIM, LP_RFI, LP_RDI, BIP_EXC, BIP_SD

LP_RDI LP_REI

BIP_EXC BIP_SD

T_ALOS E1_LOS, UP_E1_AIS, DDN_LFA

E1_LOS UP_E1_AIS

UP_E1_AIS DDN_LFA

Table F-6 Suppression relationship between intra-board alarms (CSHN board)

Root Alarm Suppressed Alarm

PG_LINK_F PG_PRT_DEGRADED
AIL

Inter-board Alarm Suppression on TDM Plane


The inter-board alarm suppression means that, when services are configured between two boards
on the same NE, the service alarm generated by the source board suppresses the service alarm
generated by the sink board. The TDM plane supports alarm suppression between line/IF boards
and tributary boards.

Table F-7 Inter-board Alarm Suppression on TDM Plane

Root Alarm Suppressed Alarm

R_LOS, R_LOC, MS_AIS, AU_AIS, TU_AIS


AU_LOP, R_LOF

MW_LOF, MW_LIM TU_AIS

F.2 Alarm Suppression on Data Plane


This section describes the alarm suppression relationship for Ethernet, MPLS tunnel, PW, ATM/
IMA, PPP/MLPPP, and EoS/EoPDH services.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 926


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide F Alarm Suppression Relationship

Intra-board Alarm Suppression on Data Plane

Table F-8 Suppression relationship between intra-board alarms (Ethernet Port)

Root Alarm Suppressed Alarm

LSR_NO_FIT LASER_SHUT, ETH_LOS, TF, LSR_WILL_DIE, OUT_PWR_ABN


ED

LASER_MO LASER_SHUT, IN_PWR_ABN, OUT_PWR_ABN,


D_ERR LSR_BCM_ALM, TEM_HA, TEM_LA, ETH_LOS, TF,
LSR_WILL_DIE

LASER_SHU LSR_BCM_ALM, LSR_WILL_DIE, OUT_PWR_ABN


T

TF OUT_PWR_ABN, LSR_WILL_DIE

ETH_EFM_D ETH_EFM_REMFAULT
F

ETH_EFM_R ETH_EFM_EVENT
EMFAULT

Table F-9 Suppression relationship between intra-board alarms (MPLS Tunnel)

Root Alarm Suppressed Alarm

MPLS_TUNN MPLS_TUNNEL_MISMATCH, MPLS_TUNNEL_LOCV,


EL_MISMER MPLS_TUNNEL_UNKNOWN, MPLS_TUNNEL_Excess,
GE MPLS_TUNNEL_SF, MPLS_TUNNEL_SD, MPLS_TUNNEL_UN-
EXPMEP, MPLS_TUNNEL_UNEXPPER

MPLS_TUNN MPLS_TUNNEL_LOCV, MPLS_TUNNEL_UNKNOWN,


EL_MISMAT MPLS_TUNNEL_Excess, MPLS_TUNNEL_SF,
CH MPLS_TUNNEL_SD, MPLS_TUNNEL_UNEXPMEP,
MPLS_TUNNEL_UNEXPPER

MPLS_TUNN MPLS_TUNNEL_LOCV, MPLS_TUNNEL_UNKNOWN,


EL_FDI MPLS_TUNNEL_Excess, MPLS_TUNNEL_SF,
MPLS_TUNNEL_SD, MPLS_TUNNEL_UNEXPMEP,
MPLS_TUNNEL_UNEXPPER

MPLS_TUNN MPLS_TUNNEL_MISMATCH, MPLS_TUNNEL_LOCV,


EL_UNEXP MPLS_TUNNEL_UNKNOWN, MPLS_TUNNEL_Excess,
MEG MPLS_TUNNEL_SF, MPLS_TUNNEL_SD, MPLS_TUNNEL_UN-
EXPMEP, MPLS_TUNNEL_UNEXPPER

MPLS_TUNN MPLS_TUNNEL_LOCV, MPLS_TUNNEL_UNKNOWN,


EL_UNEXP MPLS_TUNNEL_Excess, MPLS_TUNNEL_SF,
MEP MPLS_TUNNEL_SD, MPLS_TUNNEL_UNEXPPER

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 927


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide F Alarm Suppression Relationship

Root Alarm Suppressed Alarm

MPLS_TUNN MPLS_TUNNEL_LOCV, MPLS_TUNNEL_UNKNOWN,


EL_AIS MPLS_TUNNEL_Excess, MPLS_TUNNEL_SF,
MPLS_TUNNEL_SD, MPLS_TUNNEL_UNEXPMEP,
MPLS_TUNNEL_UNEXPPER

MPLS_TUNN MPLS_TUNNEL_UNKNOWN, MPLS_TUNNEL_Excess,


EL_LOCV MPLS_TUNNEL_SF

MPLS_TUNN MPLS_TUNNEL_SD
EL_SF

Table F-10 Suppression relationship between intra-board alarms (PW)

Root Alarm Suppressed Alarm

MPLS_PW_ MPLS_PW_MISMATCH, MPLS_PW_LOCV,


MISMERGE MPLS_PW_UNKNOWN, MPLS_PW_Excess, MPLS_PW_SF,
MPLS_PW_SD, MPLS_PW_UNEXPMEP, MPLS_PW_UNEXPPER

MPLS_PW_ MPLS_PW_LOCV, MPLS_PW_UNKNOWN, MPLS_PW_Excess,


MISMATCH MPLS_PW_SF, MPLS_PW_SD, MPLS_PW_UNEXPMEP,
MPLS_PW_UNEXPPER

MPLS_PW_U MPLS_PW_MISMATCH, MPLS_PW_LOCV,


NEXPMEG MPLS_PW_UNKNOWN, MPLS_PW_Excess, MPLS_PW_SF,
MPLS_PW_SD, MPLS_PW_UNEXPMEP, MPLS_PW_UNEXPPER

MPLS_PW_U MPLS_PW_LOCV, MPLS_PW_UNKNOWN, MPLS_PW_Excess,


NEXPMEP MPLS_PW_SF, MPLS_PW_SD, MPLS_PW_UNEXPPER

MPLS_PW_A MPLS_PW_LOCV, MPLS_PW_UNKNOWN, MPLS_PW_Excess,


IS MPLS_PW_SF, MPLS_PW_SD, MPLS_PW_UNEXPMEP,
MPLS_PW_UNEXPPER

MPLS_PW_L MPLS_PW_UNKNOWN, MPLS_PW_Excess, MPLS_PW_SF


OCV

MPLS_PW_S MPLS_PW_SD
F

MPLS_PW_L MPLS_PW_LOCV, MPLS_PW_SF, MPLS_PW_SD


CK

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 928


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide F Alarm Suppression Relationship

Table F-11 Suppression relationship between intra-board alarms (Tunnel APS)

Root Alarm Suppressed Alarm

ETH_APS_P ETH_APS_LOST
ATH_MISM
ATCH

ETH_APS_L ETH_APS_TYPE_MISMATCH, ETH_APS_SWITCH_FAIL


OST

Table F-12 Suppression relationship between intra-board alarms (PW APS)

Root Alarm Suppressed Alarm

PWAPS_SWI PWAPS_LOST, PWAPS_PATH_MISMATCH,


TCH_FAIL PWAPS_TYPE_MISMATCH

PWAPS_LOS PWAPS_PATH_MISMATCH, PWAPS_TYPE_MISMATCH


T

Table F-13 Suppression relationship between intra-board alarms (ETH OAM)

Root Alarm Suppressed Alarm

ETH_CFM_ ETH_CFM_LOC
MISMERGE
ETH_CFM_U
NEXPERI
ETH_CFM_A
IS

Table F-14 Suppression relationship between intra-board alarms (CES services)

Root Alarm Suppressed Alarm

CES_LOSPK CES_STRAYPKT_EXC, CES_JTROVR_EXC, CES_JTRUDR_EXC


T_EXC

CES_STRAY CES_MISORDERPKT_EXC, CES_MALPKT_EXC


PKT_EXC

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 929


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide F Alarm Suppression Relationship

Table F-15 Suppression relationship between intra-board alarms (ATM/IMA services)

Root Alarm Suppressed Alarm

IMA_GROU VC_LOC, VP_LOC


P_LE_DOW
N

ALM_IMA_L ALM_IMA_LODS
IF

ALM_E1RAI ALM_IMA_RFI, ALM_IMA_RE_RX_UNUSABLE

T_ALOS UP_E1_AIS

UP_E1_AIS LFA, ALM_E1RAI

LFA LMFA, ALM_IMA_LIF, ALM_E1RAI

LMFA ALM_IMA_LIF

Table F-16 Suppression relationship between intra-board alarms (PPP)

Root Alarm Suppressed Alarm

PPP_LCP_F PPP_NCP_FAIL
AIL

Table F-17 Suppression relationship between intra-board alarms (EoS/EoPDH)

Root Alarm Suppressed Alarm

TU_AIS_VC1 LP_TIM_VC12, LP_SLM_VC12, LP_UNEQ_VC12, LP_RDI_VC12


2

TU_LOP_VC LP_TIM_VC12, LP_SLM_VC12, LP_UNEQ_VC12LP_RDI_VC12


12

LP_UNEQ_V LFA
C12

BIP_EXC BIP_SD

Table F-18 Suppression relationship between intra-board alarms (Tunnel service - PW service)

Root Alarm Suppressed Alarm

MPLS_TUNN MPLS_PW_LOCV
EL_LOCV

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 930


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide F Alarm Suppression Relationship

Root Alarm Suppressed Alarm

MPLS_TUNN MPLS_PW_BDI
EL_BDI

MPLS_TUNN MPLS_PW_RDI
EL_RDI

MPLS_TUNN MPLS_PW_OAMFAIL
EL_OAMFAI
L

MPLS_TUNN MPLS_PW_LOCV
EL_LOCK

Inter-board Alarm Suppression on Data Plane


The inter-board alarm suppression means that, when services are configured between two boards
on the same NE, the service alarm generated by the source board suppresses the service alarm
generated by the sink board. The data plane supports alarm suppression between interface/IF
boards and switching boards.

Table F-19 Suppression relationship between inter-board alarms (Ethernet Interface board-
Switching board)

Root Alarm Suppressed Alarm

LSR_NO_FIT MPLS_TUNNEL_LOCV, MPLS_TUNNEL_OAMFAIL,


ED, MPLS_TUNNEL_FDI, MPLS_TUNNEL_BDI,
ETH_LOS, MPLS_TUNNEL_AIS, MPLS_TUNNEL_RDI, MPLS_TUNNEL_SF,
LASER_MO MPLS_TUNNEL_SD, MPLS_PW_UNKNOWN, MPLS_PW_Excess,
D_ERR MPLS_TUNNEL_MISMERGE, MPLS_TUNNEL_MISMATCH,
MPLS_PW_UNEXPMEG, MPLS_TUNNEL_UNEXPMEP

Table F-20 Suppression relationship between inter-board alarms (IF board-Switching board)

Root Alarm Suppressed Alarm

R_LOC MPLS_TUNNEL_LOCV, MPLS_TUNNEL_OAMFAIL

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 931


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide F Alarm Suppression Relationship

Table F-21 Suppression relationship between inter-board alarms (PPP interface board-
Switching board)

Root Alarm Suppressed Alarm

PPP_NCP_F MPLS_TUNNEL_LOCV, MPLS_TUNNEL_OAMFAIL,


AIL, MPLS_TUNNEL_BDI
MP_DOWN

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 932


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide G Indicators of Boards

G Indicators of Boards

Indicators of Boards

Table G-1 Status explanation for indicators on the CSHN

Indicator State Meaning

STAT On (green) The board is working properly.

On (red) The board hardware is faulty.

Off l The board is not working.


l The board is not created.
l There is no power supplied to the
board.

PROG Blinks on (green) and off at Software is being loaded to the board
100 ms intervals during the power-on or resetting process
of the board.

Blinks on (green) and off at The board software is in BIOS boot state
300 ms intervals during the power-on or resetting process
of the board.

On (green) l When the board is being powered on


or being reset, the upper layer
software is being initialized.
l When the board is running, the
software is running normally.

Blinks on (red) and off at The BOOTROM self-check fails during


100 ms intervals the power-on or resetting process of the
board.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 933


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide G Indicators of Boards

Indicator State Meaning

On (red) l The memory self-check fails or


loading upper layer software fails
during the power-on or resetting
process of the board.
l The logic file or upper layer software
is lost during the running process of
the board.
l The pluggable storage card is faulty.
l When database synchronization
between the active and standby
system control boards fails, the
PROG indicator on the standby
system control board is steady red.

SYNC On (green) The clock is working properly.

On (red) The clock source is lost or a clock


switchover occurs.

SRV On (green) The system is working properly.

On (red) A critical or major alarm occurs in the


system.

On (yellow) A minor or remote alarm occurs in the


system.

ACT On (green) In a 1+1 protected system, the board


works as the active one.
In an unprotected system, the board has
been activated.

Off In a 1+1 protected system, the board


works as the standby one.
In an unprotected system, the board is not
activated.

LOS1 On (red) The first optical port on the line is


reporting the R_LOS alarm.

Off The first optical port on the line is free of


R_LOS alarms.

LOS2 On (red) The second optical port on the line is


reporting the R_LOS alarm.

Off The second optical port on the line is free


of R_LOS alarms.

LINK1 On (green) The connection at the GE1 port is


working properly.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 934


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide G Indicators of Boards

Indicator State Meaning

Off The connection at the GE1 port is


interrupted.

ACT1 On or blinking (yellow) Data is being transmitted or received at


the GE1 port.

Off No data is being transmitted or received


at the GE1 port.

LINK2 On (green) The connection at the GE2 port is


working properly.

Off The connection at the GE2 port is


interrupted.

ACT2 On or blinking (yellow) Data is being transmitted or received at


the GE2 port.

Off No data is being transmitted or received


at the GE2 port.

CRIT On (red) A critical alarm occurs on the NE.

MAJ On (orange) A major alarm occurs on the NE.

MIN On (yellow) A minor alarm occurs on the NE.

Table G-2 Status explanation for indicators on the IF1

Indicator State Meaning

STAT On (green) The board is working


properly.

On (red) The board hardware is faulty.

Off l The board is not working.


l The board is not created.
l There is no power
supplied to the board.

SRV On (green) The services are normal.

On (red) A critical or major alarm


occurs in the services.

On (yellow) A minor or remote alarm


occurs in the services.

LINK On (green) The radio link is normal.

On (red) The radio link is faulty.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 935


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide G Indicators of Boards

Indicator State Meaning

ODU On (green) The ODU is working


properly.

On (red) l The ODU is reporting


critical or major alarms.
l There is no power
supplied to the ODU.

On (yellow) The ODU is reporting minor


alarms.

Blinks on (yellow) and off at The antennas are not aligned.


300 ms intervals

Off The ODU is offline.

RMT On (yellow) The remote equipment is


reporting defects.

Off The remote equipment is free


of defects.

ACT On (green) l In a 1+1 protected system,


the board works as the
active one.
l In an unprotected system,
the board has been
activated.

Off l In a 1+1 protected system,


the board works as the
standby one.
l In an unprotected system,
the board is not activated.

Table G-3 Status explanation for indicators on the IFU2

Indicator State Meaning

STAT On (green) The board is working properly.

On (red) The board hardware is faulty.

Off l The board is not working.


l The board is not created.
l There is no power supplied to the board.

SRV On (green) The services are normal.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 936


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide G Indicators of Boards

Indicator State Meaning

On (red) A critical or major alarm occurs in the


services.

On (yellow) A minor or remote alarm occurs in the


services.

LINK On (green) The radio link is normal.

On (red) The radio link is faulty.

ODU On (green) The ODU is working properly.

On (red) l The ODU is reporting critical or major


alarms.
l There is no power supplied to the ODU.

On (yellow) The ODU is reporting minor alarms.

Blinks on (yellow) The antennas are not aligned.


and off at 300 ms
intervals

Off The ODU is offline.

RMT On (yellow) The remote equipment is reporting defects.

Off The remote equipment is free of defects.

ACT On (green) l In a 1+1 protected system, the board


works as the active one.
l In an unprotected system, the board has
been activated.

Off l In a 1+1 protected system, the board


works as the standby one.
l In an unprotected system, the board is not
activated.

Table G-4 Status explanation for indicators on the ISU2

Indicator State Meaning

STAT On (green) The board is working


properly.

On (red) The board hardware is faulty.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 937


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide G Indicators of Boards

Indicator State Meaning

Off l The board is not working.


l The board is not created.
l There is no power
supplied to the board.

SRV On (green) The services are normal.

On (red) A critical or major alarm


occurs in the services.

On (yellow) A minor or remote alarm


occurs in the services.

LINK On (green) The radio link is normal.

On (red) The radio link is faulty.

ODU On (green) The ODU is working


properly.

On (red) l The ODU is reporting


critical or major alarms.
l There is no power
supplied to the ODU.

On (yellow) The ODU is reporting minor


alarms.

Blinks on (yellow) and off at The antennas are not aligned.


300 ms intervals

Off The ODU is offline.

RMT On (yellow) The remote equipment is


reporting defects.

Off The remote equipment is free


of defects.

ACT On (green) l In a 1+1 protected system,


the board works as the
active one.
l In an unprotected system,
the board has been
activated.

Off l In a 1+1 protected system,


the board works as the
standby one.
l In an unprotected system,
the board is not activated.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 938


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide G Indicators of Boards

Table G-5 Status explanation for indicators on the IFX2

Indicator State Meaning

XPIC On (green) The XPIC input signal is


normal.

On (red) The XPIC input signal is lost.

Off The XPIC function is


disabled.

STAT On (green) The board is working


properly.

On (red) The board hardware is faulty.

Off l The board is not working.


l The board is not created.
l There is no power
supplied to the board.

SRV On (green) The services are normal.

On (red) A critical or major alarm


occurs in the services.

On (yellow) A minor or remote alarm


occurs in the services.

LINK On (green) The radio link is normal.

On (red) The radio link is faulty.

ODU On (green) The ODU is working


properly.

On (red) l The ODU is reporting


critical or major alarms.
l There is no power
supplied to the ODU.

On (yellow) The ODU is reporting minor


alarms.

Blinks on (yellow) and off at The antennas are not aligned.


300 ms intervals

Off The ODU is offline.

RMT On (yellow) The remote equipment is


reporting defects.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 939


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide G Indicators of Boards

Indicator State Meaning

Off The remote equipment is free


of defects.

ACT On (green) l In a 1+1 protected system,


the board works as the
active one.
l In an unprotected system,
the board has been
activated.

Off l In a 1+1 protected system,


the board works as the
standby one.
l In an unprotected system,
the board is not activated.

Table G-6 Status explanation for indicators on the ISX2

Indicator State Meaning

XPIC On (green) The XPIC input signal is


normal.

On (red) The XPIC input signal is lost.

Off The XPIC function is


disabled.

STAT On (green) The board is working


properly.

On (red) The board hardware is faulty.

Off l The board is not working.


l The board is not created.
l There is no power
supplied to the board.

SRV On (green) The services are normal.

On (red) A critical or major alarm


occurs in the services.

On (yellow) A minor or remote alarm


occurs in the services.

LINK On (green) The radio link is normal.

On (red) The radio link is faulty.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 940


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide G Indicators of Boards

Indicator State Meaning

ODU On (green) The ODU is working


properly.

On (red) l The ODU is reporting


critical or major alarms.
l There is no power
supplied to the ODU.

On (yellow) The ODU is reporting minor


alarms.

Blinks on (yellow) and off at The antennas are not aligned.


300 ms intervals

Off The ODU is offline.

RMT On (yellow) The remote equipment is


reporting defects.

Off The remote equipment is free


of defects.

ACT On (green) l In a 1+1 protected system,


the board works as the
active one.
l In an unprotected system,
the board has been
activated.

Off l In a 1+1 protected system,


the board works as the
standby one.
l In an unprotected system,
the board is not activated.

Table G-7 Status explanation for indicators on an ISV3 board

Indicator State Meaning

XPIC On (green) XPIC input signals are


normal.

On (red) XPIC input signals are lost.

Off XPIC is disabled.

STAT On (green) The board is working


properly.

On (red) The board hardware is faulty.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 941


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide G Indicators of Boards

Indicator State Meaning

Off The board is not working, not


created, or not powered on.

SRV On (green) Services are normal.

On (red) A critical or major alarm has


been reported.

On (yellow) A minor or remote alarm has


been reported.

LINK On (green) The radio link is normal.

On (red) The radio link is faulty.

ODU On (green) The ODU is working


properly.

On (red) The ODU has reported a


critical or major alarm, or
was not powered on.

On (yellow) The ODU has reported a


minor alarm.

Blinks on (yellow) and off at Antennas are not well


300 ms intervals aligned.

Off The ODU is offline.

RMT On (yellow) The remote equipment has


reported a defect.

Off The remote equipment is free


of defects.

ACT On (green) In a 1+1 protected system, the


board is working as the main
board.
In an unprotected system, the
board has been activated.

Off In a 1+1 protected system, the


board is working as the
standby board.
In an unprotected system, the
board has not been activated.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 942


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide G Indicators of Boards

Table G-8 Status explanation for indicators on the EM6T/EM6F

Indicator State Meaning

STAT On (green) The board is working properly.

On (red) The board hardware is faulty.

Off l The board is not working.


l The board is not created.
l There is no power supplied to the board.

SRV On (green) The system is working properly.

On (red) A critical or major alarm occurs in the


system.

On (yellow) A minor alarm occurs in the system.

Off There is no power supplied to the system.

PROG Blinks on (green) and off at Software is being loaded to the board during
100 ms intervals the power-on or resetting process of the
board.

Blinks on (green) and off at The board software is in BIOS boot state
300 ms intervals during the power-on or resetting process of
the board.

On (green) l When the board is being powered on or


being reset, the upper layer software is
being initialized.
l When the board is running, the software
is running normally.

Blinks on (red) and off at 100 The BOOTROM self-check fails during the
ms intervals power-on or resetting process of the board.

On (red) l The memory self-check fails or loading


upper layer software fails during the
power-on or resetting process of the
board.
l The logic file or upper layer software is
lost during the running process of the
board.
l The pluggable storage card is faulty.

LINK1a On (green) The GE1 port is connected correctly and is


not receiving or transmitting data.

Blinking (green) The GE1 port is receiving or transmitting


data.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 943


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide G Indicators of Boards

Indicator State Meaning

Off The GE1 port is not connected or is


connected incorrectly.

LINK2a On (green) The GE2 port is connected correctly and is


not receiving or transmitting data.

Blinking (green) The GE2 port is receiving or transmitting


data.

Off The GE2 port is not connected or is


connected incorrectly.
NOTE
a: The LINK1 and LINK2 indicators are available only on the EM6F and indicate the states of the
corresponding GE ports.

Table G-9 Status explanation for indicators on the EM6TA/EM6FA

Indicator State Meaning

STAT On (green) The board is working properly.

On (red) The board hardware is faulty.

Off l The board is not working.


l The board is not created.
l There is no power supplied to the board.

SRV On (green) The system is working properly.

On (red) A critical or major alarm occurs in the


system.

On (yellow) A minor alarm occurs in the system.

Off There is no power supplied to the system.

PROG Blinks on (green) and off at Software is being loaded to the board during
100 ms intervals the power-on or resetting process of the
board.

Blinks on (green) and off at The board software is in BIOS boot state
300 ms intervals during the power-on or resetting process of
the board.

On (green) l When the board is being powered on or


being reset, the upper layer software is
being initialized.
l When the board is running, the software
is running normally.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 944


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide G Indicators of Boards

Indicator State Meaning

Blinks on (red) and off at 100 The BOOTROM self-check fails during the
ms intervals power-on or resetting process of the board.

On (red) The memory self-check fails or loading


upper layer software fails during the power-
on or resetting process of the board.
The logic file or upper layer software is lost
during the running process of the board.
The pluggable storage card is faulty.

L/A1a On (green) The GE1 port is connected correctly and is


not receiving or transmitting data.

Blinking (yellow) The GE1 port is receiving or transmitting


data.

Off The GE1 port is not connected or is


connected incorrectly.

L/A2a On (green) The GE2 port is connected correctly and is


not receiving or transmitting data.

Blinking (yellow) The GE2 port is receiving or transmitting


data.

Off The GE2 port is not connected or is


connected incorrectly.
NOTE
a: The L/A1 and L/A2 indicators are available only on the EM6FA and indicate the states of the
corresponding GE ports.

Table G-10 Status explanation for indicators on an EG4/EG4P board

Indicator State Meaning

STAT On (green) The board is working properly.

On (red) The board hardware is faulty.

Off The board is not working, not created, or not


powered on.

SRV On (green) Services are normal.

On (red) A critical or major alarm has been reported.

On (yellow) A minor alarm has been reported.

Off No service is configured.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 945


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide G Indicators of Boards

Indicator State Meaning

L/A1 On (green) Port GE1 is connected correctly but is not


(optical/ receiving or transmitting data.
electrical
port 1) Blinks on (red) and off at 300 Port GE1 has received extremely high
ms intervals optical power (applicable only to an optical
port).

Blinks on (red) for 300 ms and Port GE1 has received extremely low optical
off for 700 ms at 1000 ms power (applicable only to an optical port).
intervals

Blinks (yellow) Port GE1 is receiving or transmitting data.

Off Port GE1 is not connected or is incorrectly


connected.

L/A2 On (green) Port GE2 is connected correctly but is not


(optical/ receiving or transmitting data.
electrical
port 2) Blinks on (red) and off at 300 Port GE2 has received extremely high
ms intervals optical power (applicable only to an optical
port).

Blinks on (red) for 300 ms and Port GE2 has received extremely low optical
off for 700 ms at 1000 ms power (applicable only to an optical port).
intervals

Blinks (yellow) Port GE2 is receiving or transmitting data.

Off Port GE2 is not connected or is incorrectly


connected.

L/A3 On (green) Port GE3 is connected correctly but is not


(electrical receiving or transmitting data.
port 3)
Blinks (yellow) Port GE3 is receiving or transmitting data.

Off Port GE3 is not connected or is incorrectly


connected.

L/A4 On (green) Port GE4 is connected correctly but is not


(electrical receiving or transmitting data.
port 4)
Blinks (yellow) Port GE4 is receiving or transmitting data.

Off Port GE4 is not connected or is incorrectly


connected.

P1 On (green) Power over Ethernet port 1 is enabled.

Off Power over Ethernet port 1 is disabled or is


working abnormally.

P2 On (green) Power over Ethernet port 2 is enabled.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 946


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide G Indicators of Boards

Indicator State Meaning

Off Power over Ethernet port 2 is disabled or is


working abnormally.
NOTE
Indicators P1 and P2 are available only on the front panels of EG4P boards, indicating the power supply
status of power-over-Ethernet ports.

Table G-11 Status explanation for indicators on the EMS6

Indicator State Meaning

STAT On (green) The board is working properly.

On (red) The board hardware is faulty.

Off l The board is not working.


l The board is not created.
l There is no power supplied to the board.

PROG Blinks on (green) and off at Software is being loaded to the board during
100 ms intervals the power-on or resetting process of the
board.

Blinks on (green) and off at The board software is in BIOS boot state
300 ms intervals during the power-on or resetting process of
the board.

On (green) l The upper layer software is being


initialized during the power-on or
resetting process of the board.
l The software is running properly during
the running process of the board.

Blinks on (red) and off at 100 The BOOTROM self-check fails during the
ms intervals power-on or resetting process of the board.

On (red) l The memory self-check fails or loading


upper layer software fails during the
power-on or resetting process of the
board.
l The logic file or upper layer software is
lost during the running process of the
board.
l The pluggable storage card is faulty.

SRV On (green) The system is working normally.

On (red) A critical or major alarm occurs in the


system.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 947


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide G Indicators of Boards

Indicator State Meaning

On (yellow) A minor alarm occurs in the system.

Off There is no power supplied to the system.

LINK1 On (green) The GE1 port is connected correctly.

Blinks on (red) and off at 300 The receive optical power at the GE1 optical
ms intervals port is higher than the upper threshold.

Blinks 300 ms on (red) and 700 The receive optical power at the GE1 optical
ms off port is lower than the lower threshold.

Off The GE1 port is not connected or is


connected incorrectly.

ACT1 Blinking (yellow) The GE1 port is receiving or transmitting


data.

Off The GE1 port is not receiving or


transmitting data.

LINK2 On (green) The GE2 port is connected correctly.

Blinks on (red) and off at 300 The receive optical power at the GE2 optical
ms intervals port is higher than the upper threshold.

Blinks 300 ms on (red) and 700 The receive optical power at the GE2 optical
ms off port is lower than the lower threshold.

Off The GE1 port is not connected or is


connected incorrectly.

ACT2 Blinking (yellow) The GE2 port is receiving or transmitting


data.

Off The GE2 port is not receiving or


transmitting data.

Table G-12 Status explanation for indicators on the EFP8

Indicator State Meaning

STAT On (green) The board is working properly.

On (red) The board hardware is faulty.

Off l The board is not working.


l The board is not created.
l There is no power supplied to the board.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 948


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide G Indicators of Boards

Indicator State Meaning

PROG Blinks on (green) and off at Software is being loaded to the board during
100 ms intervals the power-on or resetting process of the
board.

Blinks on (green) and off at The board software is in BIOS boot state
300 ms intervals during the power-on or resetting process of
the board.

On (green) l When the board is being powered on or


being reset, the upper layer software is
being initialized.
l When the board is running, the software
is running normally.

Blinks on (red) and off at 100 The BOOTROM self-check fails during the
ms intervals power-on or resetting process of the board.

On (red) l The memory self-check fails or loading


upper layer software fails during the
power-on or resetting process of the
board.
l The logic file or upper layer software is
lost during the running process of the
board.
l The pluggable storage card is faulty.

SRV On (green) The system is working properly.

On (red) A critical or major alarm occurs in the


system.

On (yellow) A minor alarm occurs in the system.

Off There is no power supplied to the system.

Table G-13 Status explanation for indicators on the SL1D/SL1DA

Indicator State Meaning

STAT On (green) The board is working


properly.

On (red) The board hardware is faulty.

Off l The board is not working.


l The board is not created.
l There is no power
supplied to the board.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 949


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide G Indicators of Boards

Indicator State Meaning

SRV On (green) The services are normal.

On (red) A critical or major alarm


occurs in the services.

On (yellow) A minor or remote alarm


occurs in the services.

Off The services are not


configured.

LOS1 On (red) The first port of the SL1D/


SL1DA is reporting the
R_LOS alarm.

Off The first port of the SL1D/


SL1DA is free of R_LOS
alarms.

LOS2 On (red) The second port of the


SL1D/SL1DA is reporting
the R_LOS alarm.

Off The second port of the


SL1D/SL1DA is free of
R_LOS alarms.

Table G-14 Status explanation for indicators on the SP3S/SP3D


Indicator State Meaning

STAT On (green) The board is working


properly.

On (red) The board hardware is faulty.

Off l The board is not working.


l The board is not created.
l There is no power
supplied to the board.

SRV On (green) The services are normal.

On (red) A critical or major alarm


occurs in the services.

On (yellow) A minor or remote alarm


occurs in the services.

Off The services are not


configured.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 950


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide G Indicators of Boards

Table G-15 Status explanation for indicators on the ML1/MD1

Indicator State Meaning

STAT On (green) The board is working


properly.

On (red) The board hardware is faulty.

Off l The board is not working.


l The board is not created.
l There is no power
supplied to the board.

SRV On (green) The services are normal.

On (red) A critical or major alarm


occurs in the services.

On (yellow) A minor or remote alarm


occurs in the services.

Off The services are not


configured.

Table G-16 Status explanation for indicators on a CQ1 board

Indicator State Meaning

STAT On (green) The board is working


properly.

On (red) The board hardware is faulty.

Off The board is not working, not


created, or not powered on.

SRV On (green) Services are normal.

On (red) A critical or major alarm has


been reported.

On (yellow) A minor or remote alarm has


been reported.

Off No service is configured.

LOS1 On (red) The first port has reported an


R_LOS alarm.

Off The first port does not report


any R_LOS alarms.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 951


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide G Indicators of Boards

Indicator State Meaning

LOS2 On (red) The second port has reported


an R_LOS alarm.

Off The second port does not


report any R_LOS alarms.

LOS3 On (red) The third port has reported an


R_LOS alarm.

Off The third port does not report


any R_LOS alarms.

LOS4 On (red) The fourth port has reported


an R_LOS alarms.

Off The fourth port does not


report any R_LOS alarms.

Table G-17 Status explanation for indicators on the AUX

Indicator State Meaning

STAT On (green) The board is working properly.

On (red) The board hardware is faulty.

Off l The board is not working.


l The board is not created.
l There is no power supplied to the
board.

SRV On (green) The system is working properly.

On (red) A critical or major alarm occurs in the


system.

On (yellow) A minor or remote alarm occurs in the


system.

Off There is no power supplied to the system.

Table G-18 Status explanation for indicators on the PIU

Indicator Status Description

PWR On (green) The power supply is normal.

Off There is no power supply.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 952


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide G Indicators of Boards

Indicator Status Description

ALM On (orange) The board is in the initialization state.

On (red) An alarm is reported on the PIU.

Off No alarm occurs.

Table G-19 Status explanation for indicators on the FAN

Indicator State Meaning

FAN On (green) The fan is working properly.

On (red) The fan is faulty.

Off The fan is not powered on or is not installed.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 953


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide H Glossary

H Glossary

Numerics
3G See 3rd Generation.
3GPP 3rd Generation Partnership Project
3rd Generation (3G) The third generation of digital wireless technology, as defined by the International
Telecommunications Union (ITU). Third generation technology is expected to deliver
data transmission speeds between 144 kbit/s and 2 Mbit/s, compared to the 9.6 kbit/s to
19.2 kbit/s offered by second generation technology.
802.1Q in 802.1Q A VLAN feature that allows the equipment to add a VLAN tag to a tagged frame. The
(QinQ) implementation of QinQ is to add a public VLAN tag to a frame with a private VLAN
tag to allow the frame with double VLAN tags to be transmitted over the service
provider's backbone network based on the public VLAN tag. This provides a layer 2
VPN tunnel for customers and enables transparent transmission of packets over private
VLANs.

A
A/D analog/digit
ABR See available bit rate.
ACAP See adjacent channel alternate polarization.
ACL See access control list.
ADC analog to digital converter
ADM add/drop multiplexer
AF See assured forwarding.
AIS alarm indication signal
ALS See automatic laser shutdown.
AM See adaptive modulation.
APS automatic protection switching
ARP See Address Resolution Protocol.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 954


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide H Glossary

ASBR See autonomous system boundary router.


ASIC See application-specific integrated circuit.
ATM asynchronous transfer mode
ATPC See automatic transmit power control.
AU See administrative unit.
Address Resolution An Internet Protocol used to map IP addresses to MAC addresses. The ARP protocol
Protocol (ARP) enables hosts and routers to determine link layer addresses through ARP requests and
responses. The address resolution is a process by which the host converts the target IP
address into a target MAC address before transmitting a frame. The basic function of
ARP is to use the target equipment's IP address to query its MAC address.
access control list A list of entities, together with their access rights, which are authorized to access a
(ACL) resource.
adaptive modulation A technology that is used to automatically adjust the modulation mode according to the
(AM) channel quality. When the channel quality is favorable, the equipment uses a high-
efficiency modulation mode to improve the transmission efficiency and the spectrum
utilization of the system. When the channel quality is degraded, the equipment uses the
low-efficiency modulation mode to improve the anti-interference capability of the link
that carries high-priority services.
adjacent channel A channel configuration method, which uses two adjacent channels (a horizontal
alternate polarization polarization wave and a vertical polarization wave) to transmit two signals.
(ACAP)
administrative unit The information structure that enables adaptation between the higher order path layer
(AU) and the multiplex section layer. The administrative unit consists of an information
payload (the higher order VC) and an AU pointer, which indicates the offset of the
payload frame start relative to the multiplex section frame start.
alarm suppression A method to suppress alarms for the alarm management purpose. Alarms that are
suppressed are no longer reported from NEs.
analog signal A signal in which information is represented with a continuously variable physical
quantity, such as voltage. Because of this constant changing of the wave shape with
regard to its passing a given point in time or space, an analog signal might have a virtually
indefinite number of states or values. This contrasts with a digital signal that is expressed
as a square wave and therefore has a very limited number of discrete states. Analog
signals, with complicated structures and narrow bandwidth, are vulnerable to external
interference.
application-specific A special type of chip that starts out as a nonspecific collection of logic gates. Late in
integrated circuit the manufacturing process, a layer is added to connect the gates for a specific function.
(ASIC) By changing the pattern of connections, the manufacturer can make the chip suitable for
many needs.
assured forwarding One of the four per-hop behaviors (PHB) defined by the Diff-Serv workgroup of IETF.
(AF) It is suitable for certain key data services that require assured bandwidth and short delay.
For traffic within the bandwidth limit, AF assures quality in forwarding. For traffic that
exceeds the bandwidth limit, AF degrades the service class and continues to forward the
traffic instead of discarding the packets.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 955


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide H Glossary

attenuator A device used to increase the attenuation of an Optical Fiber Link. Generally used to
ensure that the signal at the receive end is not too strong.
automatic laser A technique (procedure) to automatically shutdown the output power of laser transmitters
shutdown (ALS) and optical amplifiers to avoid exposure to hazardous levels.
automatic transmit A method of adjusting the transmit power based on fading of the transmit signal detected
power control (ATPC) at the receiver
autonomous system A router that exchanges routing information with other ASs.
boundary router
(ASBR)
available bit rate (ABR) A kind of service categories defined by the ATM forum. ABR only provides possible
forwarding service and applies to the connections that does not require the real-time
quality. It does not provide any guarantee in terms of cell loss or delay.

B
B-ISDN See broadband integrated services digital network.
BDI See backward defect indication.
BE See best effort.
BER bit error rate
BFD See Bidirectional Forwarding Detection.
BGP Border Gateway Protocol
BIOS See basic input/output system.
BIP See bit interleaved parity.
BPDU See bridge protocol data unit.
BSC See base station controller.
BTS base transceiver station
Bidirectional A fast and independent hello protocol that delivers millisecond-level link failure
Forwarding Detection detection and provides carrier-class availability. After sessions are established between
(BFD) neighboring systems, the systems can periodically send BFD packets to each other. If
one system fails to receive a BFD packet within the negotiated period, the system regards
that the bidirectional link fails and instructs the upper layer protocol to take actions to
recover the faulty link.
backbone network A network that forms the central interconnection for a connected network. The
communication backbone for a country is WAN. The backbone network is an important
architectural element for building enterprise networks. It provides a path for the exchange
of information between different LANs or subnetworks. A backbone can tie together
diverse networks in the same building, in different buildings in a campus environment,
or over wide areas. Generally, the backbone network's capacity is greater than the
networks connected to it.
backward defect A function that the sink node of a LSP, when detecting a defect, uses to inform the
indication (BDI) upstream end of the LSP of a downstream defect along the return path.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 956


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide H Glossary

bandwidth A range of transmission frequencies a transmission line or channel can carry in a network.
In fact, the bandwidth is the difference between the highest and lowest frequencies in
the transmission line or channel. The greater the bandwidth, the faster the data transfer
rate.
base station controller A logical entity that connects the BTS with the MSC in a GSM/CDMA network. It
(BSC) interworks with the BTS through the Abis interface, the MSC through the A interface.
It provides the following functions: radio resource management, base station
management, power control, handover control, and traffic measurement. One BSC
controls and manages one or more BTSs in an actual network.
basic input/output Firmware stored on the computer motherboard that contains basic input/output control
system (BIOS) programs, power-on self test (POST) programs, bootstraps, and system setting
information. The BIOS provides hardware setting and control functions for the computer.
baud rate The number of times per second the signal can change on a transmission line. Commonly,
the transmission line uses only two signal states, making the baud rate equal to the
number of bits per second that can be transferred. The underlying transmission technique
may use some of the bandwidth, so it may not be the case that user data transfers at the
line's specified bit rate.
best effort (BE) A traditional IP packet transport service. In this service, the diagrams are forwarded
following the sequence of the time they reach. All diagrams share the bandwidth of the
network and routers. The amount of resource that a diagram can use depends of the time
it reaches. BE service does not ensure any improvement in delay time, jitter, packet loss
ratio, and high reliability.
bit interleaved parity A method of error monitoring. With even parity, the transmitting equipment generates
(BIP) an X-bit code over a specified portion of the signal in such a manner that the first bit of
the code provides even parity over the first bit of all X-bit sequences in the covered
portion of the signal, the second bit provides even parity over the second bit of all X-bit
sequences within the specified portion, and so forth. Even parity is generated by setting
the BIP-X bits so that an even number of 1s exist in each monitored partition of the
signal. A monitored partition comprises all bits in the same bit position within the X-bit
sequences in the covered portion of the signal. The covered portion includes the BIP-X.
bridge A device that connects two or more networks and forwards packets among them. Bridges
operate at the physical network level. Bridges differ from repeaters because bridges store
and forward complete packets, while repeaters forward all electrical signals. Bridges
differ from routers because bridges use physical addresses, while routers use IP
addresses.
bridge protocol data Data messages exchanged across switches within an extended LAN that uses a spanning
unit (BPDU) tree protocol (STP) topology. BPDU packets contain information on ports, addresses,
priorities, and costs, and they ensure that the data reaches its intended destination. BPDU
messages are exchanged across bridges to detect loops in a network topology. These
loops are then removed by shutting down selected bridge interfaces and placing
redundant switch ports in a backup, or blocked, state.
broadband integrated A standard defined by the ITU-T to handle high-bandwidth applications, such as voice.
services digital network It currently uses the ATM technology to transmit data over SONNET-based circuits at
(B-ISDN) 155 to 622 Mbit/s or higher speed.
broadcast A means of delivering information to all members in a network. The broadcast range is
determined by the broadcast address.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 957


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide H Glossary

broadcast domain A group of network stations that receives broadcast packets originating from any device
within the group. The broadcast domain also refers to the set of ports between which a
device forwards a multicast, broadcast, or unknown destination frame.

C
CAR committed access rate
CBR See constant bit rate.
CBS See committed burst size.
CC See continuity check.
CCDP See co-channel dual polarization.
CDMA See Code Division Multiple Access.
CE See customer edge.
CES See circuit emulation service.
CGMP Cisco Group Management Protocol
CIST See Common and Internal Spanning Tree.
CLNP connectionless network protocol
CM connection management
CORBA See Common Object Request Broker Architecture.
CPU See central processing unit.
CRC See cyclic redundancy check.
CSES consecutive severely errored second
CSMA/CD See carrier sense multiple access with collision detection.
CTC common transmit clock
CW control word
Code Division Multiple A communication scheme that uses frequency expansion technology to form different
Access (CDMA) code sequences. When the CDMA scheme is used, subscribers with different addresses
can use different code sequences for multi-address connection.
Common Object A specification developed by the Object Management Group in 1992 in which pieces of
Request Broker programs (objects) communicate with other objects in other programs, even if the two
Architecture (CORBA) programs are written in different programming languages and are running on different
platforms. A program makes its request for objects through an object request broker, or
ORB, and therefore does not need to know the structure of the program from which the
object comes. CORBA is designed to work in object-oriented environments.
Common and Internal The single spanning tree jointly calculated by STP and RSTP, the logical connectivity
Spanning Tree (CIST) using MST bridges and regions, and MSTP. The CIST ensures that all LANs in the
bridged local area network are simply and fully connected.
cable tie A tie used to bind cables.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 958


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide H Glossary

carrier sense multiple Carrier sense multiple access with collision detection (CSMA/CD) is a computer
access with collision networking access method in which:
detection (CSMA/CD)
l A carrier sensing scheme is used.
l A transmitting data station that detects another signal while transmitting a frame,
stops transmitting that frame, transmits a jam signal, and then waits for a random
time interval before trying to send that frame again.
central processing unit The computational and control unit of a computer. The CPU is the device that interprets
(CPU) and executes instructions. The CPU has the ability to fetch, decode, and execute
instructions and to transfer information to and from other resources over the computer's
main data-transfer path, the bus.
channel A telecommunication path of a specific capacity and/or speed between two or more
locations in a network. The channel can be established through wire, radio (microwave),
fiber, or any combination of the three. The amount of information transmitted per second
in a channel is the information transmission speed, expressed in bits per second. For
example, b/s (100 bit/s), kb/s (103 bit/s), Mb/s (106 bit/s), Gb/s (109 bit/s), and Tb/s
(1012 bit/s).
circuit emulation A function with which the E1/T1 data can be transmitted through ATM networks. At the
service (CES) transmission end, the interface module packs timeslot data into ATM cells. These ATM
cells are sent to the reception end through the ATM network. At the reception end, the
interface module re-assigns the data in these ATM cells to E1/T1 timeslots. The CES
technology guarantees that the data in E1/T1 timeslots can be recovered to the original
sequence at the reception end.
clock tracing The method of keeping the time on each node synchronized with a clock source in the
network.
co-channel dual A channel configuration method, which uses a horizontal polarization wave and a vertical
polarization (CCDP) polarization wave to transmit two signals. The Co-Channel Dual Polarization has twice
the transmission capacity of the single polarization.
committed burst size A parameter used to define the capacity of token bucket C, that is, the maximum burst
(CBS) IP packet size when information is transferred at the committed information rate. This
parameter must be greater than 0 but should be not less than the maximum length of an
IP packet to be forwarded.
constant bit rate (CBR) A kind of service categories defined by the ATM forum. CBR transfers cells based on
the constant bandwidth. It is applicable to service connections that depend on precise
clocking to ensure undistorted transmission.
continuity check (CC) An Ethernet connectivity fault management (CFM) method used to detect the
connectivity between MEPs by having each MEP periodically transmit a Continuity
Check Message (CCM).
cross polarization A technology used in the case of the Co-Channel Dual Polarization (CCDP) to eliminate
interference the cross-connect interference between two polarization waves in the CCDP.
cancellation (XPIC)
customer edge (CE) A part of the BGP/MPLS IP VPN model that provides interfaces for directly connecting
to the Service Provider (SP) network. A CE can be a router, switch, or host.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 959


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide H Glossary

cyclic redundancy A procedure used to check for errors in data transmission. CRC error checking uses a
check (CRC) complex calculation to generate a number based on the data transmitted. The sending
device performs the calculation before performing the transmission and includes the
generated number in the packet it sends to the receiving device. The receiving device
then repeats the same calculation. If both devices obtain the same result, the transmission
is considered to be error free. This procedure is known as a redundancy check because
each transmission includes not only data but extra (redundant) error-checking values.

D
DC direct current
DC-C See DC-return common (with ground).
DC-I See DC-return isolate (with ground).
DC-return common A power system, in which the BGND of the DC return conductor is short-circuited with
(with ground) (DC-C) the PGND on the output side of the power supply cabinet and also on the line between
the output of the power supply cabinet and the electric equipment.
DC-return isolate (with A power system, in which the BGND of the DC return conductor is short-circuited with
ground) (DC-I) the PGND on the output side of the power supply cabinet and is isolated from the PGND
on the line between the output of the power supply cabinet and the electric equipment.
DCC See data communications channel.
DCN See data communication network.
DDF digital distribution frame
DDN See digital data network.
DE discard eligible
DM See delay measurement.
DS boundary node A DS node that connects one DS domain to a node either in another DS domain or in a
domain that is not DS-capable.
DS interior node A DS node located at the center of a DS domain. It is a non-DS boundary node.
DS node A DS-compliant node, which is subdivided into DS boundary node and ID interior node.
DSCP See differentiated services code point.
DVMRP See Distance Vector Multicast Routing Protocol.
DiffServ See Differentiated Services.
Differentiated Services An IETF standard that defines a mechanism for controlling and forwarding traffic in a
(DiffServ) differentiated manner based on CoS settings to handle network congestion.
Distance Vector An Internet gateway protocol based primarily on the RIP. The DVMRP protocol
Multicast Routing implements a typical dense mode IP multicast solution and uses IGMP to exchange
Protocol (DVMRP) routing datagrams with its neighbors.
data communication A communication network used in a TMN or between TMNs to support the data
network (DCN) communication function.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 960


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide H Glossary

data communications The data channel that uses the D1-D12 bytes in the overhead of an STM-N signal to
channel (DCC) transmit information on the operation, management, maintenance, and provisioning
(OAM&P) between NEs. The DCC channel composed of bytes D1-D3 is referred to as
the 192 kbit/s DCC-R channel. The other DCC channel composed of bytes D4-D12 is
referred to as the 576 kbit/s DCC-M channel.
delay measurement The time elapsed since the start of transmission of the first bit of the frame by a source
(DM) node until the reception of the last bit of the loopbacked frame by the same source node,
when the loopback is performed at the frame's destination node.
differentiated services According to the QoS classification standard of the Differentiated Service (Diff-Serv),
code point (DSCP) the type of services (ToS) field in the IP header consists of six most significant bits and
two currently unused bits, which are used to form codes for priority marking.
Differentiated services code point (DSCP) is the six most important bits in the ToS. It is
the combination of IP precedence and types of service. The DSCP value is used to ensure
that routers supporting only IP precedence can be used because the DSCP value is
compatible with IP precedence. Each DSCP maps a per-hop behavior (PHB). Therefore,
terminal devices can identify traffic using the DSCP value.
digital data network A data transmission network that is designed to transmit data on digital channels (such
(DDN) as the fiber channel, digital microwave channel, or satellite channel).
digital modulation A method that controls the changes in amplitude, phase, and frequency of the carrier
based on the changes in the baseband digital signal. In this manner, the information can
be transmitted by the carrier.
dual-polarized antenna An antenna intended to simultaneously radiate or receive two independent radio waves
orthogonally polarized.

E
E-Aggr See Ethernet aggregation.
E-LAN See Ethernet local area network.
E-Line See Ethernet line.
ECC See embedded control channel.
EMC See electromagnetic compatibility.
EMI See electromagnetic interference.
EPL See Ethernet private line.
EPLAN See Ethernet private LAN service.
EPLD See erasable programmable logical device.
ERPS Ethernet ring protection switching
ESD electrostatic discharge
ETS European Telecommunication Standards
ETSI See European Telecommunications Standards Institute.
EVPL See Ethernet virtual private line.
EVPLAN See Ethernet virtual private LAN service.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 961


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide H Glossary

Ethernet A LAN technology that uses the carrier sense multiple access with collision detection
(CSMA/CD) media access control method. The Ethernet network is highly reliable and
easy to maintain. The speed of an Ethernet interface can be 10 Mbit/s, 100 Mbit/s, 1000
Mbit/s, or 10,000 Mbit/s.
Ethernet aggregation A type of Ethernet service that is based on a multipoint-to-point EVC (Ethernet virtual
(E-Aggr) connection).
Ethernet line (E-Line) A type of Ethernet service that is based on a point-to-point EVC (Ethernet virtual
connection).
Ethernet local area A type of Ethernet service that is based on a multipoint-to-multipoint EVC (Ethernet
network (E-LAN) virtual connection).
Ethernet private LAN A type of Ethernet service provided by SDH, PDH, ATM, or MPLS server layer
service (EPLAN) networks. This service is carried over dedicated bandwidth between multipoint-to-
multipoint connections.
Ethernet private line A type of Ethernet service provided by SDH, PDH, ATM, or MPLS server layer
(EPL) networks. This service is carried over dedicated bandwidth between point-to-point
connections.
Ethernet virtual A type of Ethernet service provided by SDH, PDH, ATM, or MPLS server layer
private LAN service networks. This service is carried over shared bandwidth between multipoint-to-
(EVPLAN) multipoint connections.
Ethernet virtual A type of Ethernet service provided by SDH, PDH, ATM, or MPLS server layer
private line (EVPL) networks. This service is carried over shared bandwidth between point-to-point
connections.
European A standards-setting body in Europe. Also the standards body responsible for GSM.
Telecommunications
Standards Institute
(ETSI)
electromagnetic A condition which prevails when telecommunications equipment is performing its
compatibility (EMC) individually designed function in a common electromagnetic environment without
causing or suffering unacceptable degradation due to unintentional electromagnetic
interference to or from other equipment in the same environment.
electromagnetic Any electromagnetic disturbance that interrupts, obstructs, or otherwise degrades or
interference (EMI) limits the performance of electronics/electrical equipment.
embedded control A logical channel that uses a data communications channel (DCC) as its physical layer
channel (ECC) to enable the transmission of operation, administration, and maintenance (OAM)
information between NEs.
engineering label A mark on a cable, a subrack, or a cabinet for identification.
erasable A logical array device which can be used to implement the required functions by
programmable logical programming the array. In addition, a user can modify and program the array repeatedly
device (EPLD) until the program meets the requirement.

F
FD See frequency diversity.
FDDI See fiber distributed data interface.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 962


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide H Glossary

FDI See forward defect indication.


FEC See forward error correction.
FFD fast failure detection
FFD packet A path failure detection method independent from CV. Different from a CV packet, the
frequency for generating FFD packets is configurable to satisfy different service
requirements. By default, the frequency is 20/s. An FFD packet contains information the
same as that in a CV packet. The destination end LSR processes FFD packets in the same
way for processing CV packets.
FIFO See first in first out.
FPGA See field programmable gate array.
FTP File Transfer Protocol
fiber distributed data A standard developed by the American National Standards Institute (ANSI) for high-
interface (FDDI) speed fiber-optic LANs. FDDI provides specifications for transmission rates of 100
megabits per second on token ring networks.
field programmable A semi-customized circuit that is used in the Application Specific Integrated Circuit
gate array (FPGA) (ASIC) field and developed based on programmable components. FPGA remedies many
of the deficiencies of customized circuits, and allows the use of many more gate arrays.
first in first out (FIFO) A stack management method in which data that is stored first in a queue is also read and
invoked first.
forward defect A packet generated and traced forward to the sink node of the LSP by the node that first
indication (FDI) detects defects. It includes fields to indicate the nature of the defect and its location. Its
primary purpose is to suppress alarms being raised at affected higher level client LSPs
and (in turn) their client layers.
forward error A bit error correction technology that adds correction information to the payload at the
correction (FEC) transmit end. Based on the correction information, the bit errors generated during
transmission can be corrected at the receive end.
fragmentation A process of breaking a packet into smaller units when transmitting over a network node
that does not support the original size of the packet.
frequency diversity A diversity scheme in which two or more microwave frequencies with a certain
(FD) frequency interval are used to transmit/receive the same signal and selection is then
performed between the two signals to ease the impact of fading.

G
GCRA generic cell rate algorithm
GFC generic flow control
GFP See Generic Framing Procedure.
GNE See gateway network element.
GPS See Global Positioning System.
GTS See generic traffic shaping.
GUI graphical user interface

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 963


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide H Glossary

Generic Framing A framing and encapsulated method that can be applied to any data type. GFP is defined
Procedure (GFP) by ITU-T G.7041.
Global Positioning A global navigation satellite system that provides reliable positioning, navigation, and
System (GPS) timing services to users worldwide.
gateway A device that connects two network segments using different protocols. It is used to
translate the data in the two network segments.
gateway network An NE that serves as a gateway for other NEs to communicate with a network
element (GNE) management system.
generic traffic shaping A traffic control measure that proactively adjusts the output speed of the traffic. This is
(GTS) to adapt the traffic to network resources that can be provided by the downstream router
to avoid packet discarding and congestion.

H
HDLC High-Level Data Link Control
HQoS See hierarchical quality of service.
HSDPA See High Speed Downlink Packet Access.
HSM hitless switch mode
High Speed Downlink A modulating-demodulating algorithm put forward in 3GPP R5 to meet the requirement
Packet Access for asymmetric uplink and downlink transmission of data services. It enables the
(HSDPA) maximum downlink data service rate to reach 14.4 Mbit/s without changing the
WCDMA network topology.
hierarchical quality of A type of QoS that controls the traffic of users and performs the scheduling according
service (HQoS) to the priority of user services. HQoS has an advanced traffic statistics function, and the
administrator can monitor the usage of bandwidth of each service. Hence, the bandwidth
can be allocated reasonably through traffic analysis.
hybrid radio The hybrid transmission of Native E1 and Native Ethernet signals. Hybrid radio supports
the AM function.

I
I/O input/output
ICMP See Internet Control Message Protocol.
IDU See indoor unit.
IEEE See Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers.
IF See intermediate frequency.
IGMP See Internet Group Management Protocol.
IGMP snooping A multicast constraint mechanism running on a layer 2 device. This protocol manages
and controls the multicast group by listening to and analyzing Internet Group
Management Protocol (IGMP) packets between hosts and Layer 3 devices. In this
manner, the spread of the multicast data on layer 2 network can be prevented efficiently.
IGP See Interior Gateway Protocol.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 964


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide H Glossary

IMA See inverse multiplexing over ATM.


IP Internet Protocol
IPv4 See Internet Protocol version 4.
IPv6 See Internet Protocol version 6.
IS-IS See Intermediate System to Intermediate System.
ISDN integrated services digital network
ISO International Organization for Standardization
IST internal spanning tree
ITU See International Telecommunication Union.
IWF Interworking Function
Institute of Electrical A professional association of electrical and electronics engineers based in the United
and Electronics States, but with membership from numerous other countries. The IEEE focuses on
Engineers (IEEE) electrical, electronics, and computer engineering, and produces many important
technology standards.
Interior Gateway A routing protocol that is used within an autonomous system. The IGP runs in small-
Protocol (IGP) sized and medium-sized networks. The commonly used IGPs are the routing information
protocol (RIP), the interior gateway routing protocol (IGRP), the enhanced IGRP
(EIGRP), and the open shortest path first (OSPF).
Intermediate System to A protocol used by network devices (routers) to determine the best way to forward
Intermediate System datagram or packets through a packet-based network.
(IS-IS)
International A United Nations agency, one of the most important and influential recommendation
Telecommunication bodies, responsible for recommending standards for telecommunication (ITU-T) and
Union (ITU) radio networks (ITU-R).
Internet Control A network layer protocol that provides message control and error reporting between a
Message Protocol host server and an Internet gateway.
(ICMP)
Internet Group One of the TCP/IP protocols for managing the membership of Internet Protocol multicast
Management Protocol groups. It is used by IP hosts and adjacent multicast routers to establish and maintain
(IGMP) multicast group memberships.
Internet Protocol The current version of the Internet Protocol (IP). IPv4 utilizes a 32bit address which is
version 4 (IPv4) assigned to hosts. An address belongs to one of five classes (A, B, C, D, or E) and is
written as 4 octets separated by periods and may range from 0.0.0.0 through to
255.255.255.255. Each IPv4 address consists of a network number, an optional
subnetwork number, and a host number. The network and subnetwork numbers together
are used for routing, and the host number is used to address an individual host within the
network or subnetwork.
Internet Protocol An update version of IPv4, which is designed by the Internet Engineering Task Force
version 6 (IPv6) (IETF) and is also called IP Next Generation (IPng). It is a new version of the Internet
Protocol. The difference between IPv6 and IPv4 is that an IPv4 address has 32 bits while
an IPv6 address has 128 bits.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 965


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide H Glossary

indoor unit (IDU) The indoor unit of the split-structured radio equipment. It implements accessing,
multiplexing/demultiplexing, and intermediate frequency (IF) processing for services.
intermediate frequency The transitional frequency between the frequencies of a modulated signal and an RF
(IF) signal.
inverse multiplexing A technique that involves inverse multiplexing and de-multiplexing of ATM cells in a
over ATM (IMA) cyclical fashion among links grouped to form a higher bandwidth logical link whose rate
is approximately the sum of the link rates.

L
L2VPN Layer 2 virtual private network
LACP See Link Aggregation Control Protocol.
LAG See link aggregation group.
LAN See local area network.
LAPS Link Access Protocol-SDH
LB See loopback.
LCAS See link capacity adjustment scheme.
LM See loss measurement.
LOS See loss of signal.
LPT link-state pass through
LSDB link state database
LSP See label switched path.
LSP tunnel An LSP over which traffic is transmitted based on labels that are assigned to FECs on
the ingress. The traffic is transparent to the intermediate nodes
LSR See label switching router.
LTE Long Term Evolution
Layer 2 switching A data forwarding method. In a LAN, a network bridge or 802.3 Ethernet switch
transmits and distributes packet data based on the MAC address. Since the MAC address
is at the second layer of the OSI model, this data forwarding method is called Layer 2
switching.
Link Aggregation A dynamic link aggregation protocol that improves the transmission speed and
Control Protocol reliability. The two ends of the link send LACP packets to inform each other of their
(LACP) parameters and form a logical aggregation link. After the aggregation link is formed,
LACP maintains the link status in real time and dynamically adjusts the ports on the
aggregation link upon detecting the failure of a physical port.
label switched path A sequence of hops (R0...Rn) in which a packet travels from R0 to Rn through label
(LSP) switching mechanisms. A label-switched path can be chosen dynamically, based on
common routing mechanisms or through configuration.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 966


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide H Glossary

label switching router Basic element of an MPLS network. All LSRs support the MPLS protocol. The LSR is
(LSR) composed of two parts: control unit and forwarding unit. The former is responsible for
allocating the label, selecting the route, creating the label forwarding table, creating and
removing the label switch path; the latter forwards the labels according to groups
received in the label forwarding table.
laser A component that generates directional optical waves of narrow wavelengths. The laser
light has better coherence than ordinary light. Semi-conductor lasers provide the light
used in a fiber system.
line rate The maximum packet forwarding capacity on a cable. The value of line rate equals the
maximum transmission rate capable on a given type of media.
linear MSP linear multiplex section protection
link aggregation group An aggregation that allows one or more links to be aggregated together to form a link
(LAG) aggregation group so that a MAC client can treat the link aggregation group as if it were
a single link.
link capacity LCAS in the virtual concatenation source and sink adaptation functions provides a
adjustment scheme control mechanism to hitless increase or decrease the capacity of a link to meet the
(LCAS) bandwidth needs of the application. It also provides a means of removing member links
that have experienced failure. The LCAS assumes that in cases of capacity initiation,
increases or decreases, the construction or destruction of the end-to-end path is the
responsibility of the network and element management systems.
local area network A network formed by the computers and workstations within the coverage of a few square
(LAN) kilometers or within a single building, featuring high speed and low error rate. Current
LANs are generally based on switched Ethernet or Wi-Fi technology and run at 1,000
Mbit/s (that is, 1 Gbit/s).
loopback (LB) A troubleshooting technique that returns a transmitted signal to its source so that the
signal or message can be analyzed for errors. The loopback can be a inloop or outloop.
loss measurement (LM) A method used to collect counter values applicable for ingress and egress service frames
where the counters maintain a count of transmitted and received data frames between a
pair of MEPs.
loss of signal (LOS) No transitions occurring in the received signal.

M
MA maintenance association
MAC See Media Access Control.
MADM multiple add/drop multiplexer
MBS maximum burst size
MD See maintenance domain.
MD5 See message digest algorithm 5.
MDI medium dependent interface
MEP maintenance association end point
MIB See management information base.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 967


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide H Glossary

MIP maintenance intermediate point


MLPPP Multi-Link Point-to-Point Protocol
MP maintenance point
MPLS See Multiprotocol Label Switching.
MPLS L2VPN A network that provides the Layer 2 VPN service based on an MPLS network. In this
case, on a uniform MPLS network, the carrier is able to provide Layer 2 VPNs of different
media types, such as ATM, FR, VLAN, Ethernet, and PPP.
MPLS TE multiprotocol label switching traffic engineering
MPLS VPN See multiprotocol label switching virtual private network.
MPLS-TP See MultiProtocol Label Switching Transport Profile.
MS multiplex section
MSP See multiplex section protection.
MST region See Multiple Spanning Tree region.
MSTI See multiple spanning tree instance.
MSTP See Multiple Spanning Tree Protocol.
MTBF See mean time between failures.
MTTR See mean time to repair.
MTU See maximum transmission unit.
Media Access Control A protocol at the media access control sublayer. The protocol is at the lower part of the
(MAC) data link layer in the OSI model and is mainly responsible for controlling and connecting
the physical media at the physical layer. When transmitting data, the MAC protocol
checks whether to be able to transmit data. If the data can be transmitted, certain control
information is added to the data, and then the data and the control information are
transmitted in a specified format to the physical layer. When receiving data, the MAC
protocol checks whether the information is correct and whether the data is transmitted
correctly. If the information is correct and the data is transmitted correctly, the control
information is removed from the data and then the data is transmitted to the LLC layer.
MultiProtocol Label A packet transport technology proposed by IETF that combines the packet experience
Switching Transport of MPLS with the operational experience of transport networks.
Profile (MPLS-TP)
Multiple Spanning A protocol that can be used in a loop network. Using an algorithm, the MSTP blocks
Tree Protocol (MSTP) redundant paths so that the loop network can be trimmed as a tree network. In this case,
the proliferation and endless cycling of packets is avoided in the loop network. The
protocol that introduces the mapping between VLANs and multiple spanning trees. This
solves the problem that data cannot be normally forwarded in a VLAN because in STP/
RSTP, only one spanning tree corresponds to all the VLANs.
Multiple Spanning A region that consists of switches that support the MSTP in the LAN and links among
Tree region (MST them. Switches physically and directly connected and configured with the same MST
region) region attributes belong to the same MST region.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 968


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide H Glossary

Multiprotocol Label A technology that uses short tags of fixed length to encapsulate packets in different link
Switching (MPLS) layers, and provides connection-oriented switching for the network layer on the basis of
IP routing and control protocols.
maintenance domain The network or the part of the network for which connectivity is managed by connectivity
(MD) fault management (CFM). The devices in a maintenance domain are managed by a single
Internet service provider (ISP).
management A type of database used for managing the devices in a communications network. It
information base (MIB) comprises a collection of objects in a (virtual) database used to manage entities (such as
routers and switches) in a network.
maximum transmission The largest packet of data that can be transmitted on a network. MTU size varies,
unit (MTU) depending on the network576 bytes on X.25 networks, for example, 1500 bytes on
Ethernet, and 17,914 bytes on 16 Mbit/s token ring. Responsibility for determining the
size of the MTU lies with the link layer of the network. When packets are transmitted
across networks, the path MTU, or PMTU, represents the smallest packet size (the one
that all networks can transmit without breaking up the packet) among the networks
involved.
mean time between The average time between consecutive failures of a piece of equipment. It is a measure
failures (MTBF) of the reliability of the system.
mean time to repair The average time that a device will take to recover from a failure.
(MTTR)
message digest A hash function that is used in a variety of security applications to check message
algorithm 5 (MD5) integrity. MD5 processes a variable-length message into a fixed-length output of 128
bits. It breaks up an input message into 512-bit blocks (sixteen 32-bit little-endian
integers). After a series of processing, the output consists of four 32-bit words, which
are then cascaded into a 128-bit hash number.
multicast A process of transmitting data packets from one source to many destinations. The
destination address of the multicast packet uses Class D address, that is, the IP address
ranges from 224.0.0.0 to 239.255.255.255. Each multicast address represents a multicast
group rather than a host.
multiple spanning tree A type of spanning trees calculated by MSTP within an MST Region, to provide a simply
instance (MSTI) and fully connected active topology for frames classified as belonging to a VLAN that
is mapped to the MSTI by the MST Configuration. A VLAN cannot be assigned to
multiple MSTIs.
multiplex section A function, which is performed to provide capability for switching a signal between and
protection (MSP) including two multiplex section termination (MST) functions, from a "working" to a
"protection" channel.
multiprotocol label An Internet Protocol (IP) virtual private network (VPN) based on the multiprotocol label
switching virtual switching (MPLS) technology. It applies the MPLS technology for network routers and
private network switches, simplifies the routing mode of core routers, and combines traditional routing
(MPLS VPN) technology and label switching technology. It can be used to construct the broadband
Intranet and Extranet to meet various service requirements.

N
N+1 protection A radio link protection system composed of N working channels and one protection
channel.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 969


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide H Glossary

NE network element
NE Explorer The main operation interface of the NMS, which is used to manage the
telecommunication equipment. In the NE Explorer, a user can query, manage, and
maintain NEs, boards, and ports.
NNI network-to-network interface
NPE network provider edge
NSAP See network service access point.
NSF non-stop forwarding
network service access A network address defined by ISO, at which the OSI Network Service is made available
point (NSAP) to a Network service user by the Network service provider.
network storm A phenomenon that occurs during data communication. To be specific, mass broadcast
packets are transmitted in a short time; the network is congested; transmission quality
and availability of the network decrease rapidly. The network storm is caused by network
connection or configuration problems.
node A managed device in the network. For a device with a single frame, one node stands for
one device. For a device with multiple frames, one node stands for one frame of the
device.
non-GNE See non-gateway network element.
non-gateway network A network element that communicates with the NM application layer through the
element (non-GNE) gateway NE application layer.

O
O&M operation and maintenance
OAM See operation, administration and maintenance.
OAMPDU operation, administration and maintenance protocol data unit
ODF optical distribution frame
ODU See outdoor unit.
OSPF See Open Shortest Path First.
Open Shortest Path A link-state, hierarchical interior gateway protocol (IGP) for network routing that uses
First (OSPF) cost as its routing metric. A link state database is constructed of the network topology,
which is identical on all routers in the area.
operation, A set of network management functions that cover fault detection, notification, location,
administration and and repair.
maintenance (OAM)
orderwire A channel that provides voice communication between operation engineers or
maintenance engineers of different stations.
outdoor unit (ODU) The outdoor unit of the split-structured radio equipment. It implements frequency
conversion and amplification for radio frequency (RF) signals.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 970


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide H Glossary

P2P See point-to-point service.


PBS See peak burst size.
PCB See printed circuit board.
PDH See plesiochronous digital hierarchy.
PDU protocol data unit
PE See provider edge.
PHB See per-hop behavior.
PIR peak information rate
PLA See physical link aggregation.
PLL See phase-locked loop.
PPP Point-to-Point Protocol
PRBS See pseudo random binary sequence.
PRI primary rate interface
PSN See packet switched network.
PSTN See public switched telephone network.
PTN packet transport network
PTP Precision Time Protocol
PTP clock See Precision Time Protocol clock.
PVP See permanent virtual path.
PW See pseudo wire.
PWE3 See pseudo wire emulation edge-to-edge.
Precision Time A type of high-decision clock defined by the IEEE 1588 V2 standard. The IEEE 1588
Protocol clock (PTP V2 standard specifies the precision time protocol (PTP) in a measurement and control
clock) system. The PTP protocol ensures clock synchronization precise to sub-microseconds.
packet switched A telecommunications network that works in packet switching mode.
network (PSN)
paired slots Two slots of which the overheads can be passed through by using the bus on the
backplane.
peak burst size (PBS) A parameter that defines the capacity of token bucket P, that is, the maximum burst IP
packet size when the information is transferred at the peak information rate.
per-hop behavior IETF Diff-Serv workgroup defines forwarding behaviors of network nodes as per-hop
(PHB) behaviors (PHB), such as, traffic scheduling and policing. A device in the network should
select the proper PHB behaviors, based on the value of DSCP. At present, the IETF
defines four types of PHB. They are class selector (CS), expedited forwarding (EF),
assured forwarding (AF), and best-effort (BE).
permanent virtual path Virtual path that consists of PVCs.
(PVP)

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 971


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide H Glossary

phase-locked loop A circuit that consists essentially of a phase detector that compares the frequency of a
(PLL) voltage-controlled oscillator with that of an incoming carrier signal or reference-
frequency generator. The output of the phase detector, after passing through a loop filter,
is fed back to the voltage-controlled oscillator to keep it exactly in phase with the
incoming or reference frequency.
physical link Being a technology providing load balancing based on physical layer bandwidths,
aggregation (PLA) physical link aggregation (PLA) combines Ethernet transmission paths in several
Integrated IP radio links into a logical Ethernet link for higher Ethernet bandwidth and
Ethernet transmission reliability.
plesiochronous digital A multiplexing scheme of bit stuffing and byte interleaving. It multiplexes the minimum
hierarchy (PDH) rate 64 kit/s into rates of 2 Mbit/s, 34 Mbit/s, 140 Mbit/s, and 565 Mbit/s.
point-to-point service A service between two terminal users. In P2P services, senders and recipients are
(P2P) terminal users.
polarization A kind of electromagnetic wave, the direction of whose electric field vector is fixed or
rotates regularly. Specifically, if the electric field vector of the electromagnetic wave is
perpendicular to the plane of horizon, this electromagnetic wave is called vertically
polarized wave; if the electric field vector of the electromagnetic wave is parallel to the
plane of horizon, this electromagnetic wave is called horizontal polarized wave; if the
tip of the electric field vector, at a fixed point in space, describes a circle, this
electromagnetic wave is called circularly polarized wave.
printed circuit board A board used to mechanically support and electrically connect electronic components
(PCB) using conductive pathways, tracks, or traces, etched from copper sheets laminated onto
a non-conductive substrate.
provider edge (PE) A device that is located in the backbone network of the MPLS VPN structure. A PE is
responsible for managing VPN users, establishing LSPs between PEs, and exchanging
routing information between sites of the same VPN. A PE performs the mapping and
forwarding of packets between the private network and the public channel. A PE can be
a UPE, an SPE, or an NPE.
pseudo random binary A sequence that is random in the sense that the value of each element is independent of
sequence (PRBS) the values of any of the other elements, similar to a real random sequence.
pseudo wire (PW) An emulated connection between two PEs for transmitting frames. The PW is established
and maintained by PEs through signaling protocols. The status information of a PW is
maintained by the two end PEs of a PW.
pseudo wire emulation An end-to-end Layer 2 transmission technology. It emulates the essential attributes of a
edge-to-edge (PWE3) telecommunication service such as ATM, FR or Ethernet in a packet switched network
(PSN). PWE3 also emulates the essential attributes of low speed time division
multiplexing (TDM) circuit and SONET/SDH. The simulation approximates to the real
situation.
public switched A telecommunications network established to perform telephone services for the public
telephone network subscribers. Sometimes it is called POTS.
(PSTN)

Q
QAM See quadrature amplitude modulation.
QPSK See quadrature phase shift keying.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 972


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide H Glossary

QinQ See 802.1Q in 802.1Q.


QoS See quality of service.
quadrature amplitude Both an analog and a digital modulation scheme. It conveys two analog message signals,
modulation (QAM) or two digital bit streams, by changing (modulating) the amplitudes of two carrier waves,
using the amplitude-shift keying (ASK) digital modulation scheme or amplitude
modulation (AM) analog modulation scheme. These two waves, usually sinusoids, are
out of phase with each other by 90 and are thus called quadrature carriers or quadrature
components hence the name of the scheme.
quadrature phase shift A modulation method of data transmission through the conversion or modulation and
keying (QPSK) the phase determination of the reference signals (carrier). It is also called the fourth period
or 4-phase PSK or 4-PSK. QPSK uses four dots in the star diagram. The four dots are
evenly distributed on a circle. On these phases, each QPSK character can perform two-
bit coding and display the codes in Gray code on graph with the minimum BER.
quality of service (QoS) A commonly-used performance indicator of a telecommunication system or channel.
Depending on the specific system and service, it may relate to jitter, delay, packet loss
ratio, bit error ratio, and signal-to-noise ratio. It functions to measure the quality of the
transmission system and the effectiveness of the services, as well as the capability of a
service provider to meet the demands of users.

R
RADIUS See Remote Authentication Dial In User Service.
RADIUS accounting An accounting mode in which the BRAS sends the accounting packets to the RADIUS
server. Then the RADIUS server performs accounting.
RDI remote defect indication
RED See random early detection.
REI remote error indication
RF See radio frequency.
RFC See Request For Comments.
RMEP remote maintenance association end point
RMON remote network monitoring
RNC See radio network controller.
RSL See received signal level.
RSSI See received signal strength indicator.
RSTP See Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol.
RSVP See Resource Reservation Protocol.
RTN radio transmission node
RTSP Real-Time Streaming Protocol
Rapid Spanning Tree An evolution of the Spanning Tree Protocol (STP) that provides faster spanning tree
Protocol (RSTP) convergence after a topology change. The RSTP protocol is backward compatible with
the STP protocol.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 973


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide H Glossary

Remote Authentication A security service that authenticates and authorizes dial-up users and is a centralized
Dial In User Service access control mechanism. RADIUS uses the User Datagram Protocol (UDP) as its
(RADIUS) transmission protocol to ensure real-time quality. RADIUS also supports the
retransmission and multi-server mechanisms to ensure good reliability.
Request For Comments A document in which a standard, a protocol, or other information pertaining to the
(RFC) operation of the Internet is published. The RFC is actually issued, under the control of
the IAB, after discussion and serves as the standard. RFCs can be obtained from sources
such as InterNIC.
Resource Reservation A protocol that reserves resources on every node along a path. RSVP is designed for an
Protocol (RSVP) integrated services Internet.
RoHS restriction of the use of certain hazardous substances
radio frequency (RF) A type of electric current in the wireless network using AC antennas to create an
electromagnetic field. It is the abbreviation of high-frequency AC electromagnetic wave.
The AC with the frequency lower than 1 kHz is called low-frequency current. The AC
with frequency higher than 10 kHz is called high-frequency current. RF can be classified
into such high-frequency current.
radio network A device in a radio network subsystem that is in charge of controlling the usage and
controller (RNC) integrity of radio resources.
random early detection A packet loss algorithm used in congestion avoidance. It discards the packet according
(RED) to the specified higher limit and lower limit of a queue so that global TCP synchronization
resulting from traditional tail drop can be prevented.
real-time variable bit A parameter intended for real-time applications, such as compressed voice over IP
rate (rt-VBR) (VoIP) and video conferencing. The rt-VBR is characterized by a peak cell rate (PCR),
sustained cell rate (SCR), and maximum burst size (MBS). You can expect the source
device to transmit in bursts and at a rate that varies with time.
received signal level The signal level at a receiver input terminal.
(RSL)
received signal strength The received wide band power, including thermal noise and noise generated in the
indicator (RSSI) receiver, within the bandwidth defined by the receiver pulse shaping filter, for TDD
within a specified timeslot. The reference point for the measurement shall be the antenna
receiver sensitivity The minimum acceptable value of mean received power at point Rn (a reference point
at an input to a receiver optical connector) to achieve a 1x10-12 BER when the FEC is
enabled.
regeneration The process of receiving and reconstructing a digital signal so that the amplitudes,
waveforms and timing of its signal elements are constrained within specified limits.
route The path that network traffic takes from its source to its destination. Routes can change
dynamically.
router A device on the network layer that selects routes in the network. The router selects the
optimal route according to the destination address of the received packet through a
network and forwards the packet to the next router. The last router is responsible for
sending the packet to the destination host. Can be used to connect a LAN to a LAN, a
WAN to a WAN, or a LAN to the Internet.
rt-VBR See real-time variable bit rate.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 974


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide H Glossary

S
SAI service area identifier
SAToP Structure-Agnostic Time Division Multiplexing over Packet
SCSI Small Computer System Interface
SD See space diversity.
SDH See synchronous digital hierarchy.
SEC security screening
SES severely errored second
SETS SDH equipment timing source
SF See signal fail.
SFP small form-factor pluggable
SLA See service level agreement.
SNCP subnetwork connection protection
SNMP See Simple Network Management Protocol.
SNR See signal-to-noise ratio.
SSL See Secure Sockets Layer.
SSM See Synchronization Status Message.
STM See synchronous transport module.
STM-1 See Synchronous Transport Module level 1.
STM-4 Synchronous Transport Module level 4
STM-N Synchronous Transport Module level N
STP Spanning Tree Protocol
Secure Sockets Layer A security protocol that works at a socket level. This layer exists between the TCP layer
(SSL) and the application layer to encrypt/decode data and authenticate concerned entities.
Simple Network A network management protocol of TCP/IP. It enables remote users to view and modify
Management Protocol the management information of a network element. This protocol ensures the
(SNMP) transmission of management information between any two points. The polling
mechanism is adopted to provide basic function sets. According to SNMP, agents, which
can be hardware as well as software, can monitor the activities of various devices on the
network and report these activities to the network console workstation. Control
information about each device is maintained by a management information block.
Synchronization Status A message that carries the quality levels of timing signals on a synchronous timing link.
Message (SSM) SSM messages provide upstream clock information to nodes on an SDH network or
synchronization network.
Synchronous Synchronous transfer mode at 155 Mbit/s.
Transport Module level
1 (STM-1)

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 975


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide H Glossary

service level agreement A service agreement between a customer and a service provider. SLA specifies the
(SLA) service level for a customer. The customer can be a user organization (source domain)
or another differentiated services domain (upstream domain). An SLA may include
traffic conditioning rules which constitute a traffic conditioning agreement as a whole
or partially.
signal fail (SF) A signal indicating that associated data has failed in the sense that a near-end defect
condition (non-degrade defect) is active.
signal-to-noise ratio The ratio of the amplitude of the desired signal to the amplitude of noise signals at a
(SNR) given point in time. SNR is expressed as 10 times the logarithm of the power ratio and
is usually expressed in dB.
single-ended switching A protection mechanism that takes switching action only at the affected end of the
protected entity in the case of a unidirectional failure.
single-polarized An antenna intended to radiate or receive radio waves with only one specified
antenna polarization.
space diversity (SD) A diversity scheme that enables two or more antennas separated by a specific distance
to transmit/receive the same signal and selection is then performed between the two
signals to ease the impact of fading. Currently, only receive SD is used.
subnet mask The technique used by the IP protocol to determine which network segment packets are
destined for. The subnet mask is a binary pattern that is stored in the device and is matched
with the IP address.
synchronous digital A transmission scheme that follows ITU-T G.707, G.708, and G.709. SDH defines the
hierarchy (SDH) transmission features of digital signals, such as frame structure, multiplexing mode,
transmission rate level, and interface code. SDH is an important part of ISDN and B-
ISDN.
synchronous transport An information structure used to support section layer connections in the SDH. It consists
module (STM) of information payload and Section Overhead (SOH) information fields organized in a
block frame structure which repeats every 125. The information is suitably conditioned
for serial transmission on the selected media at a rate which is synchronized to the
network. A basic STM is defined at 155 520 kbit/s. This is termed STM-1. Higher
capacity STMs are formed at rates equivalent to N times this basic rate. STM capacities
for N = 4, N = 16 and N = 64 are defined; higher values are under consideration.

T
T1 A North American standard for high-speed data transmission at 1.544Mbps. It provides
24 x 64 kbit/s channels.
TCI tag control information
TCP See Transmission Control Protocol.
TCP/IP Transmission Control Protocol/Internet Protocol
TD-SCDMA See Time Division-Synchronous Code Division Multiple Access.
TDD time division duplex
TDM See time division multiplexing.
TDMA See Time Division Multiple Access.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 976


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide H Glossary

TE See traffic engineering.


TEDB See traffic engineering database.
TIM trace identifier mismatch
TMN See telecommunications management network.
TOS test operation system
TTL See time to live.
TUG tributary unit group
Telnet A standard terminal emulation protocol in the TCP/IP protocol stack. Telnet allows users
to log in to remote systems and use resources as if they were connected to a local system.
Telnet is defined in RFC 854.
Time Division Multiple An approach used for allocating a single channel among many users, by dividing the
Access (TDMA) channel into different timeslots during which each user has access to the medium.
Time Division- A 3G mobile communications standard found in UMTS mobile telecommunications
Synchronous Code networks in China as an alternative to W-CDMA. TD-SCDMA integrates technologies
Division Multiple of CDMA, TDMA, and FDMA, and makes use of technologies including intelligent
Access (TD-SCDMA) antenna, joint detection, low chip rate (LCR), and adaptive power control. With the
flexibility of service processing, a TD-SCDMA network can connect to other networks
through the RNC.
Transmission Control The protocol within TCP/IP that governs the breakup of data messages into packets to
Protocol (TCP) be sent using Internet Protocol (IP), and the reassembly and verification of the complete
messages from packets received by IP. A connection-oriented, reliable protocol (reliable
in the sense of ensuring error-free delivery), TCP corresponds to the transport layer in
the ISO/OSI reference model.
tail drop A congestion management mechanism, in which packets arrive later are discarded when
the queue is full. This policy of discarding packets may result in network-wide
synchronization due to the TCP slow startup mechanism.
tangent ring A concept borrowed from geometry. Two tangent rings have a common node between
them. The common node often leads to single-point failures.
telecommunications A protocol model defined by ITU-T for managing open systems in a communications
management network network. TMN manages the planning, provisioning, installation, and OAM of
(TMN) equipment, networks, and services.
time division A multiplexing technology. TDM divides the sampling cycle of a channel into time slots
multiplexing (TDM) (TSn, n=0, 1, 2, 3), and the sampling value codes of multiple signals engross time slots
in a certain order, forming multiple multiplexing digital signals to be transmitted over
one channel.
time to live (TTL) A specified period of time for best-effort delivery systems to prevent packets from
looping endlessly.
trTCM See two rate three color marker.
traffic engineering (TE) A technology that is used to dynamically monitor the traffic of the network and the load
of the network elements, to adjust in real time the parameters such as traffic management
parameters, route parameters and resource restriction parameters, and to optimize the
utilization of network resources. The purpose is to prevent the congestion caused by
unbalanced loads.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 977


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide H Glossary

traffic engineering A type of database that every router generates after collecting the information about TE
database (TEDB) of every links in its area. TEDB is the base of forming the dynamic TE path in the MPLS
TE network.
tributary loopback A fault can be located for each service path by performing loopback to each path of the
tributary board. There are three kinds of loopback modes: no loopback, outloop, and
inloop.
tunnel A channel on the packet switching network that transmits service traffic between PEs.
In VPN, a tunnel is an information transmission channel between two entities. The tunnel
ensures secure and transparent transmission of VPN information. In most cases, a tunnel
is an MPLS tunnel.
two rate three color An algorithm that meters an IP packet stream and marks its packets based on two rates,
marker (trTCM) Peak Information Rate (PIR) and Committed Information Rate (CIR), and their
associated burst sizes to be either green, yellow, or red. A packet is marked red if it
exceeds the PIR. Otherwise it is marked either yellow or green depending on whether it
exceeds or does not exceed the CIR.

U
UART universal asynchronous receiver/transmitter
UAS unavailable second
UBR unspecified bit rate
UBR+ Unspecified Bit Rate Plus
UDP See User Datagram Protocol.
UI user interface
UNI See user-to-network interface.
UPC See usage parameter control.
User Datagram A TCP/IP standard protocol that allows an application program on one device to send a
Protocol (UDP) datagram to an application program on another. UDP uses IP to deliver datagrams. UDP
provides application programs with the unreliable connectionless packet delivery
service. That is, UDP messages may be lost, duplicated, delayed, or delivered out of
order. The destination device does not actively confirm whether the correct data packet
is received.
unicast The process of sending data from a source to a single recipient.
usage parameter During communications, UPC is implemented to monitor the actual traffic on each virtual
control (UPC) circuit that is input to the network. Once the specified parameter is exceeded, measures
will be taken to control. NPC is similar to UPC in function. The difference is that the
incoming traffic monitoring function is divided into UPC and NPC according to their
positions. UPC locates at the user/network interface, while NPC at the network interface.
user-to-network The interface between user equipment and private or public network equipment (for
interface (UNI) example, ATM switches).

V
V-NNI virtual network-network interface

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 978


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide H Glossary

V-UNI See virtual user-network interface.


VB virtual bridge
VBR See variable bit rate.
VC See virtual container.
VCC See virtual channel connection.
VCCV virtual circuit connectivity verification
VCG See virtual concatenation group.
VCI virtual channel identifier
VCTRUNK A virtual concatenation group applied in data service mapping, also called the internal
port of a data service processing board.
VLAN virtual local area network
VPI See virtual path identifier.
VPLS virtual private LAN segment
VPN virtual private network
VSWR voltage standing wave ratio
variable bit rate (VBR) One of the traffic classes used by ATM (Asynchronous Transfer Mode). Unlike a
permanent CBR (Constant Bit Rate) channel, a VBR data stream varies in bandwidth
and is better suited to non real time transfers than to real-time streams such as voice calls.
virtual channel A VC logical trail that carries data between two end points in an ATM network. A point-
connection (VCC) to-multipoint VCC is a set of ATM virtual connections between two or multiple end
points.
virtual circuit A channel or circuit established between two points on a data communications network
with packet switching. Virtual circuits can be permanent virtual circuits (PVCs) or
switched virtual circuits (SVCs) .
virtual concatenation A group of co-located member trail termination functions that are connected to the same
group (VCG) virtual concatenation link.
virtual container (VC) An information structure used to support path layer connections in the SDH. A VC
consists of a payload and path overhead (POH), which are organized in a block frame
structure that repeats every 125 s or 500 s.
virtual path identifier The field in the Asynchronous Transfer Mode (ATM) cell header that identifies to which
(VPI) virtual path the cell belongs.
virtual user-network A virtual user-network interface, works as an action point to perform service
interface (V-UNI) classification and traffic control in HQoS.

W
WCDMA See Wideband Code Division Multiple Access.
WDM wavelength division multiplexing
WEEE waste electrical and electronic equipment
WFQ See weighted fair queuing.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 979


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System
Maintenance Guide H Glossary

WRED See weighted random early detection.


WRR weighted round robin
WTR See wait to restore.
Web LCT The local maintenance terminal of a transport network, which is located at the NE
management layer of the transport network.
Wi-Fi See Wireless Fidelity.
Wideband Code A standard defined by the ITU-T for the third-generation wireless technology derived
Division Multiple from the Code Division Multiple Access (CDMA) technology.
Access (WCDMA)
Wireless Fidelity (Wi- A short-distant wireless transmission technology. It enables wireless access to the
Fi) Internet within a range of hundreds of feet wide.
wait to restore (WTR) The number of minutes to wait before services are switched back to the working line.
weighted fair queuing A fair queue scheduling algorithm based on bandwidth allocation weights. This
(WFQ) scheduling algorithm allocates the total bandwidth of an interface to queues, according
to their weights and schedules the queues cyclically. In this manner, packets of all priority
queues can be scheduled.
weighted random early A packet loss algorithm used for congestion avoidance. It can prevent the global TCP
detection (WRED) synchronization caused by traditional tail-drop. WRED is favorable for the high-priority
packet when calculating the packet loss ratio.
winding pipe A tool for fiber routing, which acts as the corrugated pipe.

X
XPIC See cross polarization interference cancellation.

Issue 01 (2013-12-15) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential 980


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Вам также может понравиться